Press Alt + R to read the document text or Alt + P to download or print.
This document contains no pages.
HomeMy WebLinkAboutContract - Volume 1
Award Date: April 30, 2024 CAG-24-060
Awarded to: Northwest Cascade, Inc. P.O. Box 73399 Puyallup, WA 98373
Award Amount: $6,790,790.00
City of Renton
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186
SWP-27-4186
CONSTRUCTION DOCUMENTS
Volume 1 of 2
City of Renton
1055 South Grady Way
Renton WA 98057
Project Manager: Katie Medina, 425-430-7335
KMedina@Rentonwa.gov
Volume 1 - City of Renton Forms,
Contract Forms, Conditions of the
Contract, and Specifications
Volume 2 – Construction Plans
Emergency Contact List
Windsor Hills U�lity Improvements
Northwest Cascade Inc
Name Title Contact Phone
Number
Eric Wright Emergency 253-405-1355
Joseph Hawks Project Manager 253-579-6391
Steve Ober Foreman 253-381-2248
Casondra Mossuto Propel Insurance (Insurance Agent) 253-761-3454
Christopher Kinyon Propel Surety (Bonding Agent) 253-310-4041
a
RESOLUTION OF CORPORATE AUTHORJTY
OF
NORTHWEST CASCADE,INC.
Be it resolved that Greg Potts be appointed the Chief Executive Officer,President and an officer of
Northwest Cascade,Inc.Be it resolved that Jason Perry be appointed Chief Operating Officer and an
officer of Northwest Cascade,Inc.Be it resolved that Clint Myers be appoionted Vice President and an
officer of Nort-west Cascade,Inc.Be it resolved that Ron Innian be appointed Vice Presideint and an
officer of Northwest Cascade,Inc.Be it resolved that Tracey Schwartz be appointed Secretary and an
officer of Northwest Cacade Inc.
This authority shall remain in effect until revoked by action of the Board of Directors.Dated this 21st Day
of December,2021
7;:27
Secretary
I certify that this is a true copy of the Resolution dated December 21,2021.
Mark Perry (Jan 22,2OLL 05:40 CST)
Chairman of the Board
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 / SWP-27-4186
CAG-24-060
CONTRACT DOCUMENT TABLE OF CONTENTS
VOLUME I
1. Summary of Fair Practices Policy
2. Summary of Americans with Disability Act Policy
3. Scope of Work
4. Vicinity Map and Site Map
5. Instructions to Bidders
6. Call for Bids
7. Proposal and Combined Affidavit & Certificate Form:
Non-Collusion
Anti-Trust Claims
Minimum Wage
8. Proposal Bid Bond Form
9. Department of Labor and Industries Certificate of Registration
10. Schedule of Prices
11. Acknowledgement of Receipt of Addenda
12. Certification of Compliance with Wage Payment Statutes
13. Subcontractor List
14. Contract Bond to the City of Renton
15. Fair Practices Policy Affidavit of Compliance
16. Contract Agreement
17. Retainage Selection and Retainage Bond
18. City of Renton Insurance Requirements and Certificate of Insurance (COI)
19. Washington State Prevailing Minimum Hourly Wage Rates Reference
20. Traffic Control Information
21. City of Renton Special Provisions
22. City of Renton Standard Plans
23. Drainage Report with Geotechnical Engineering Report & SWPPP
VOLUME II - Construction Plans (reduced 11x17)
1 Summary of Fair Practices Policy\
2 Summary of Americans with Disability Act Policy\
3 Scope of Work\
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 / SWP-27-4186
SCOPE OF WORK
The work involved under the terms of this contract document shall be full and complete installation of
the facilities, as shown on the plans and as described in the construction specifications, to include but
not be limited to:
• Construction surveying, staking, and production of as-built drawings.
• Temporary traffic control measures in accordance with the contract documents and applicable
City of Renton and MUTCD standards.
• Installing and maintaining adequate TESC measures and restoring all disturbed areas.
• Installing new storm system of approximately 4,300 linear feet of 8-inch, 12-inch, and 18-inch
diameter storm sewer pipe, including 59 Type 1 and Type 2 catch basins.
• Improving 3 private property stormwater drainage ditches.
• Installing new water system of approximately 7,000 linear feet of 8-inch diameter class 52
cement-lined restrained-joint ductile iron water pipe with polywrap, restrained-joint fittings, gate
valves, fire hydrant assemblies, and thrust blocking.
• Testing, poly-pigging, disinfecting, and flushing of water mains.
• Installing (136) 1-inch, (1) 1.5-inch, and (1) 2-inch water service connections and transfer of
domestic water services.
• Connection of new water system to existing water system.
• Trench excavation, including removal of existing unsuitable material, disposal of excavated
material, shoring, and dewatering.
• Trench backfill with suitable material and compaction to required standards,
• Installing hot mix asphalt patch for utility trenches.
• Removal and replacement of asphalt concrete pavement, asphalt grinding, hot mix asphalt
overlay.
• Removal and replacement of concrete curbs, gutters, sidewalks, curb ramps, and driveways.
• Protecting existing utilities, utility potholing and resolution of utility conflicts.
• Adjusting utility and monument cases to grade.
• Performing landscape and property restoration.
The estimated project cost is $9,000,000 to $10,000,000
For Bid Item Payment Descriptions see Special Provisions Section 1-09.14
Any contractor connected with this project shall comply with all Federal, State, County, and City codes
and regulations applicable to such work and perform the work in accordance with the plans and
specifications of this Contract Document. A total of 300 working days is allowed for completion of the
project.
The City reserves the right to reject any and all bids.
52,592
4,383
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements Project
This map is a user generated static output from an Internet mapping site and
is for reference only. Data layers that appear on this map may or may not be
accurate, current, or otherwise reliable.
2/15/2024
Legend
2,9800 1,490
THIS MAP IS NOT TO BE USED FOR NAVIGATION
Feet
Notes
2,980
WGS_1984_Web_Mercator_Auxiliary_Sphere
Katie Medina
kmedina@Rentonwa.gov
Renton City Boundary
Parks
VICINITY MAP
PROJECT AREA
I-405
S
R
-
1
6
7
I-
4
0
5
LAKE
WASHINGTON
NE 4TH ST
6,574
548
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements Project
This map is a user generated static output from an Internet mapping site and
is for reference only. Data layers that appear on this map may or may not be
accurate, current, or otherwise reliable.
Site Map
2/15/2024
Legend
3730 186
THIS MAP IS NOT TO BE USED FOR NAVIGATION
Feet
Notes
373
WGS_1984_Web_Mercator_Auxiliary_Sphere
Katie Medina
kmedina@Rentonwa.gov
ParcelsSITE MAP
SUNS
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
GRAND
E
Y
W
A
Y
N
E
BRON
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
WINDSOR
W
A
Y
N
E
ED
M
O
N
D
S
A
V
E
N
E
WI
N
D
S
O
R
P
L
N
E
BRO
N
S
O
N
P
L
N
E
NE
4
T
H
S
T
VU
E
M
O
N
T
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR HILLS
PARK
PROJECT AREA
I-4
0
5
5 Instructions to Bidders\ 1
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 / SWP-27-4186
INSTRUCTIONS TO BIDDERS
1. Sealed bids for this proposal will be received by the City of Renton at the lobby of Renton City Hall, until
the time and date specified in the Call for Bids. No mailed, Fedex, or UPS delivered bids will be
accepted.
The bids will be publicly opened and read via a Zoom video-conferencing 60 minutes after the bid
closing, after which the bids will be considered and the award made as early as practicable.
No proposal may be changed or withdrawn after the time set for receiving bids. Proposals shall be
submitted on the forms attached hereto.
2. Any omissions, discrepancies or need for interpretation should be brought, in writing, to the attention
of the Project Engineer. Written addenda to clarify questions that arise may then be issued. If a bidder
has any questions regarding the project, the bidder may:
Submit questions via email to kmedina@rentonwa.gov. The bidder shall include "Bid Question –
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements Project” in the subject line.
No oral statements by Owner, Engineer, or other representative of the owner shall, in any way,
modify the contract documents, whether made before or after letting the contract.
Questions received less than 4 business days prior to the date of sealed bid submittal may not be
answered. The City will not be responsible for other explanations or interpretations of the bid
documents.
3. The work to be done is shown in the plans and / or specifications. Quantities are understood to be
only approximate. Final payment will be based on actual quantities and at the unit price bid. The City
reserves the right to add or to eliminate portions of that work as deemed necessary.
4. Plans, specifications, addenda, and plan holders list for this project are available on-line through
Builders Exchange of Washington, Inc., at http://www/bxwa.com. Click on “bxwa.com”; “Posted
Projects”; “Public Works”, “City of Renton”, “Projects Bidding”. (Note: Bidders are encouraged to
“Register as a Bidder,” in order to receive automatic email notification of future addenda and to be
placed on the “Bidders List.” Bidders shall satisfy themselves as to the local conditions by inspection
of the site.
5. The bid price for any item must include the performance of all work necessary for completion of that
item as described in the specifications.
6. The bid price shall be stated in terms of the units indicated and as to a total amount. In the event of
errors, the unit price bid will govern. Illegible figures will invalidate the bid.
7. The right is reserved to reject any and/or all bids and to waive informalities if it is deemed
advantageous to the City to do so.
5 Instructions to Bidders\ 2
8. A certified check or satisfactory bid bond made payable without reservation to the Director of Finance
of the City of Renton in an amount not less than 5% of the total amount of the bid shall accompany
each bid proposal. Checks will be returned to unsuccessful bidders immediately following the decision
as to award of contract. The check of the successful bidder will be returned provided he enters into a
contract and furnishes a satisfactory performance bond covering the full amount of the work within
ten days after receipt of notice of intention to award contract. Should he fail, or refuse to do so, the
check shall be forfeited to the City of Renton as liquidated damage for such failure.
9. All bids must be self-explanatory. No opportunity will be offered for oral explanation except as the
City may request further information on particular points.
10. The bidder shall, upon request, furnish information to the City as to his financial and practical ability
to satisfactorily perform the work.
11. Payment for this work will be made in Cash Warrants.
12. The Contractor shall obtain such construction insurance (e.g. fire and extended coverage, worker's
compensation, public liability, and property damage as identified within Special Provisions,
Specification Section 1-07.18 “Public Liability and Property Damage Insurance”.
13. The Contractor, prior to the start of construction, shall provide the City of Renton a detailed bar chart
type construction schedule for the project.
14. Before starting work under this contract, the Contractor is required to supply information to the City
of Renton on all chemical hazards Contractor is bringing to the jobsite and potentially exposing City of
Renton Employees.
15. Payment of retainage shall be done in accordance with Section 1-09.9(1) "Retainage”.
16. Basis For Approval
The construction contract will be awarded by the City of Renton to the lowest, responsible,
responsive bidder. The bidder shall bid on all bid schedules items of all schedules set forth in the bid
forms to be considered responsive for award. The total price of all schedules will be used to
determine the successful low responsive bidder.
Partial bids will not be accepted. The owner reserves the right to award any or all schedules of the Bid
to meet the needs of the City. The intent is to award to only one Bidder.
17. Trench Excavation Safety Systems
As required by RCW 39.04.180, on public works projects in which trench excavation will exceed a
depth of four feet, any contract therefore shall require adequate safety systems for the trench
excavation that meet the requirements of the Washington Industrial Safety and Health Act, Chapter
49.17 RCW. These requirements shall be included in the Bid Schedule as a separate item. The costs
of trench safety systems shall not be considered as incidental to any other contract item and any
attempt to include the trench safety systems as an incidental cost is prohibited.
5 Instructions to Bidders\ 3
18. Payment of Prevailing Wages
In accordance with Revised Code of Washington Chapters 39.12 and 49.28 as amended or
supplemented herein, there shall be paid to all laborers, workmen or mechanics employed on this
contract the prevailing rate of wage for an hour's work in the same trade or occupation in the area of
work regardless of any contractual relationship which may exist, or be alleged to exist, between the
Contractor and any laborers, workmen, mechanics or subconsultants.
The Contractor is responsible for obtaining updated issues of the prevailing wage rate forms as they
become available during the duration of the contract. The wage rates shall be included as part of any
subcontracts the Contractor may enter into for work on this project.
19. Pollution Control Requirements
Work under this contract shall meet all local, state and federal requirements for the prevention of
environmental pollution and the preservation of public natural resources. The Contractor shall
conduct the work in accordance with all applicable pollution control laws. The Contractor shall comply
with and be liable for all penalties, damages, and violations under Chapter 90.48 RCW, in performance
of the work. The Contractor shall also comply with Article 4 in the Puget Sound Air Pollution Control
Agency Regulation III regarding removal and encapsulation of asbestos materials.
20. Standard Specifications
All work under this contract shall be performed in accordance with the following standard
specifications except as may be exempted or modified by the City of Renton Supplemental
Specifications, Special Provisions other sections of these contract documents. These standard
specifications are hereby made a part of this contract and shall control and guide all activities within
this project whether referred to directly, paragraph by paragraph, or not.
1. WSDOT/APWA "2023 Standard Specifications for Road, Bridge and Municipal Construction" and
"Division 1 APWA Supplement" hereinafter referred to by the abbreviated title "Standard
Specifications."
A. Any reference to "State," "State of Washington," "Department of Transportation,"
"WSDOT," or any combination thereof in the WSDOT/APWA standards shall be modified to
read "City of Renton," unless specifically referring to a standard specification or test
method.
B. All references to measurement and payment in the WSDOT/APWA standards shall be
detected and the measurement and payment provisions of Section 1-09.14, Measurement
and Payment (added herein) shall govern.
21. If a soils investigation has been completed, a copy may be included as an appendix to this document.
If one has not been provided for this project by the City or Engineer, the Bidders shall familiarize
themselves adequately with the project site and existing subsurface condition as needed to submit
their bid. Upon approval of the City, the Bidder may make such subsurface explorations and
investigations as they see fit. The Bidder shall be responsible for protection of all existing facilities,
utilities and other buried or surface improvements and shall restore the site to the satisfaction of the
City.
5 Instructions to Bidders\ 4
26. Bidder’s Checklist
It is the responsibility of each bidder to ascertain if all the documents listed on the attached index
are included in their copy of the bid specifications. If documents are missing, it is the sole
responsibility of the Bidder to contact the City of Renton to obtain the missing documents prior to
bid opening time.
Have you submitted, as part of your bid, all documents marked in the index as “Submit With Bid”?
Has bid bond or certified check been enclosed?
Is the amount of the bid guaranty at least 5 percent (5%) of the total amount of bid?
Has the proposal been signed?
Have you bid on ALL ITEMS?
Sales Tax for this project is bid at 10.3%
Have you submitted the Subcontractors List?
Have you reviewed the Prevailing Wage Requirements?
Have you submitted the Proposal and Combined Affidavit & Certificate Form?
Have you submitted Department of Labor and Industries Certificate of Registration Form?
Have you certified Receipt of Addenda, if any have been issued?
City of Renton
CALL FOR BIDS
1
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements Project
CAG-24-060
WTR-27-4186 / SWP-27-4186
Submittal Deadline: 2:00 PM, April 30, 2024
Sealed bids will be received until 2:00 p.m., Tuesday, April 30, 2024, at the lobby of Renton City Hall, 1055
South Grady Way, Renton WA 98057. No mailed, USPS, Fedex, or UPS delivered will be accepted. Please
include bidder’s name, address, and the name of the project on the envelope. Sealed bids will be opened
and publicly read via the Zoom video-conferencing web application at 3:00 p.m., Tuesday, April 30, 2024
(60 minutes after published bid submittal time). Any bids received after the published bid submittal time
cannot be considered and will not be accepted.
The bid opening meeting can be accessed via videoconference by:
•Clicking this link to join the Zoom meeting:
•https://us02web.zoom.us/j/86593598747?pwd=aSttUmRRUEtuVkFUUURveFN4MEZKZz09
•Using the Zoom app: Meeting ID: 865 9359 8747; Passcode: 577427;
•Via telephone by dialing: +12532050468,,86593598747#,,,,*577427# US
•Zoom is free to use and is available at https://zoom.us/.
The improvement for which Bids will be received is described below:
Construct the Windsor Hills Utility Improvements project. The work includes but is not limited to:
•Installing new storm system of approximately 4,300 linear feet of 8-inch, 12-inch, and 18-inch
diameter storm sewer pipe, including 59 Type 1 and Type 2 catch basins.
•Improving 3 private property stormwater drainage ditches.
•Installing new water system of approximately 7,000 linear feet of 8-inch diameter class 52
cement-lined restrained-joint ductile iron water pipe with polywrap, restrained-joint fittings, gate
valves, fire hydrant assemblies, and thrust blocking.
•Installing (136) 1-inch, (1) 1.5-inch, and (1) 2-inch water service connections and transfer of
domestic water services.
•Testing, poly-pigging, disinfecting, and flushing of water mains.
•Trench excavation, including removal of existing unsuitable material, disposal of excavated
material, shoring, and dewatering.
•Trench backfill with suitable material and compaction to required standards.
•Removal and replacement of asphalt concrete pavement, asphalt grinding and HMA overlay.
•Protecting of existing utilities, utility potholing and resolution of utility conflicts.
•Construction surveying, staking, and production of as-built drawings.
•Temporary traffic control measures in accordance with the contract documents and applicable
City of Renton and MUTCD standards.
•Installing and maintaining adequate Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control measures and
restoring all disturbed areas.
The estimated project cost is $9,000,000 to $10,000,000. A total of 300 working days is allowed for
completion of the project.
CAG-24-060
6 Call for Bids\ 2
The City reserves the right to reject any and/or all bids and to waive any and/or all informalities.
Bid documents will be available Tuesday, April 9, 2024. Plans, specifications, addenda, and the plan
holders list for this project are available online through Builders Exchange of Washington, Inc., at
http://www.bxwa.com. Click on “bxwa.com”; “Posted Projects”, “Public Works”, “City of Renton”,
“Projects Bidding”. (Note: Bidders are encouraged to “Register as a Bidder,” in order to receive automatic
email notification of future addenda and to be placed on the “Bidders List”). Bid documents will also be
available at http://rentonwa.gov/bids/ under “Calls for Bids”.
Should you require further assistance, contact Builder Exchange of Washington at (425) 258-1303. Bidders
are not to contact the City of Renton or the Engineer to obtain bidding documents.
Women and Minority Business Enterprises (WMBE) are encouraged to bid.
The city's Fair Practices, Non-Discrimination, and Americans with Disability Act Policies shall apply.
Questions about the project shall be addressed to: Katie Medina, Public Works Department,
kmedina@rentonwa.gov. Questions received less than 4 business days prior to the date of sealed bid
submittal may not be answered. The City will not be responsible for other explanations or interpretations
of the bid documents.
A certified check or bid bond in the amount of five percent (5%) of the total of each bid must accompany
each bid.
Jason A. Seth, MMC, City Clerk
Dates of Publication:
Daily Journal of Commerce April 9, 2024
Daily Journal of Commerce April 16, 2024
Daily Journal of Commerce April 23, 2024
Public Works Department
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
CAG-24-060
Documents to be Submitted with Bid
PROPOSAL & COMBINED AFFIDAVIT & CERTIFICATE FORM
PROPOSAL BID BOND FORM
DEPARTMENT OF LABOR AND INDUSTRIES CERTIFICATE OF REGISTRATION
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT OF RECEIPT OF ADDENDA
CERTIFICATION OF COMPLIANCE WITH WAGE PAYMENT STATUTES
SUBCONTRACTOR LIST
CITY OF RENTON
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 /SWP-27-4186
Proposal &Combined Affidavit &Certificate Form
TOTHE CITY OF RENTON
RENTON,WASHINGTON
Ladies and/or Gentlemen:
The undersigned hereby certify that the bidder has examined the site of the proposed work and have read
and thoroughly understand the plans,specifications and contract governing the work embraced in this
improvement,and the method by which payment will be made for said work,and hereby propose to
undertake and complete the work embraced in this improvement,or as much thereof as can be completed
with the money available,in accordance with the said plans,specifications and contract and the following
schedule of rates and prices:
(Note:Unit prices for all items,all extensions,and total
amount of bid should be shown.Show unit prices
both in writing and in figures.)
The undersigned further certifies and agrees to the following provisions:
NON-COLLUSION AFFIDAVIT
Being duly sworn,deposes and says,that he is the identical person who submitted the foregoing proposal or
bid,and that such bid is genuine and not sham or collusive or made in the interest or on behalf of any person
not therein named,and further,that the deponent has not directly induced or solicited any other Bidder on
the foregoing work or equipment to put in a sham bid,or any other person or corporation to refrain from
bidding,and that deponent has not in any manner sought by collusion to secure to himself or to any other
person any advantage over other Bidder or Bidders.
AND
CERTIFICATION RE:ASSIGNMENT OF
ANTI-TRUST CLAIMS TO PURCHASER
Vendor and purchaser recognize that in actual economic practice overcharges resulting from anti-trust
violations are in fact usually borne by the purchaser.Therefore,vendor hereby assigns to purchaser any and
all claims for such over-charges as to goods and materials purchased in connection with this order or
contract,except as to overcharges resulting from anti-trust violations commencing after the date of the bid,
quotation,or other event establishing the price under this order or contract.In addition,vendor warrants
and represents that such of his suppliers and subcontractors shall assign any and all such claims to purchaser,
subject to the aforementioned exception.
AND
MINIMUM WAGE AFFIDAVIT FORM
I,the undersigned,having been duly sworn,deposed,say and certify that in connection with the
performance of the work of this project,I will pay each classification of laborer,workman,or mechanic
employed in the performance of such work;not less than the prevailing rate of wage or not less than the
minimum rate of wages as specified in the principal contract.
7 Proposal &Combined Affidavit &Certificate Form\1
I
ha
v
e
re
a
d
th
e
ab
o
v
e
an
d
fo
r
e
g
o
i
n
g
st
a
t
e
m
e
n
t
s
an
d
ce
r
t
i
f
i
c
a
t
e
,
kn
o
w
th
e
co
n
t
e
n
t
s
th
e
r
e
o
f
an
d
th
e
su
b
s
t
a
n
c
e
as
se
t
fo
r
t
h
th
e
r
e
i
n
is
tr
u
e
to
my
kn
o
w
l
e
d
g
e
an
d
be
l
i
e
f
.
FO
R
:
PR
O
P
O
S
A
L
,
NO
N
CO
L
L
U
S
I
O
N
AF
F
I
D
A
V
I
T
,
AS
S
I
G
N
M
E
N
T
OF
AN
T
I
-
T
R
U
S
T
CL
A
I
M
S
TO
PU
R
C
H
A
S
E
R
AN
D
MI
N
I
M
U
M
WA
G
E
AF
F
I
D
A
V
I
T
ñ21bh
4
k
)
o
s
-
1
-
CL
1
L
Na
m
e
of
Bi
d
d
e
r
’
s
Fi
r
m
Pr
i
n
t
e
d
Na
m
e
:
LU
4
_
f
b
ñ
H
L41Y6
Ad
d
r
e
s
s
:
Pu
])
X
75
1
PA
J
J
L
L
L
L
L
P
I
IA
J
4
gg
r
Co
n
t
a
c
t
Na
m
e
(p
l
e
a
s
e
pr
i
n
t
)
:
(2
,
L
u
y
)
)1
[
,
4
J
’
Ph
o
n
e
:
8U
8
3
7
)
Em
a
i
l
:
Qb
t
Ci
i
C
e
i
&
C’
)
1
Na
m
e
s
of
Me
m
b
e
r
s
of
Pa
r
t
n
e
r
s
h
i
p
:
OR
Na
m
e
of
Pr
e
s
i
d
e
n
t
of
Co
r
p
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
Y?
j
Pb
t
1
s
Na
m
e
of
Se
c
r
e
t
a
r
y
of
Co
r
p
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
1’
I
1
3
j
I
.
L
’
C_
L
4
t
,
)
Z
r
t
)
Co
r
p
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
Or
g
a
n
i
z
e
d
un
d
e
r
th
e
la
w
s
of
Wi
t
h
Ma
i
n
Of
f
i
c
e
in
St
a
t
e
of
Wa
s
h
i
n
g
t
o
n
at
1I
c
-
3
L
L
T(
L
-
V
L
L
4
’
D
.
L
t
1
.
LA
)
c
L
1A
J
A
S
7
3
Su
b
s
c
r
i
b
e
d
an
d
sw
o
r
n
to
be
f
o
r
e
me
on
th
i
s
__
_
_
_
_
_
da
y
of
__
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
Pu
b
(
t
_
cH
A
R
L
O
-
n
-
E
A
BA
S
K
E
T
T
No
t
a
r
y
in
an
d
fo
r
th
e
St
a
t
e
of
Wa
s
h
i
n
g
t
o
n
co
m
m
i
s
s
i
o
n
#
15
4
9
3
0
St
a
t
e
of
Wa
s
h
i
n
g
t
o
n
No
t
a
r
y
(P
r
i
n
t
)
1,
i
i
_
r
/
o
+
f
r
_
1S
i
sl
_
_
t
f
r
I
My
co
m
m
.
Ex
p
i
r
e
s
Au
g
My
ap
p
o
i
n
t
m
e
n
t
ex
p
i
r
e
s
:
I1
A
t
L
+
?b
7
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
&
Co
m
b
i
n
e
d
Af
f
i
d
a
v
i
t
&
Ce
r
t
i
f
i
c
a
t
e
Fo
r
m
\
2
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
Bi
d
Bo
n
d
KN
O
W
AL
L
ME
N
BY
TH
E
S
E
PR
E
S
E
N
T
S
,
Th
a
t
we
,
fC
o
n
t
r
a
c
t
o
r
j
No
r
t
h
w
e
s
t
Ca
s
c
a
d
e
,
In
c
•
__
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
o
f
[a
d
d
r
e
s
s
j
PB
o
x
,
f
a
I
I
u
,
W
A
98
3
7
3
as
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
,
an
d
[S
u
r
e
t
y
]
Fi
d
e
l
i
t
y
an
d
De
p
o
s
i
t
Co
m
p
a
n
y
of
Ma
y
p
d
a
co
r
p
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
du
l
y
or
g
a
n
i
z
e
d
un
d
e
r
th
e
la
w
s
of
t
h
e
St
a
t
e
of
ji
j
n
_
an
d
au
t
h
o
r
i
z
e
d
to
do
bu
s
i
n
e
s
s
in
th
e
St
a
t
e
of
W
a
s
h
i
r
i
g
t
o
n
,
as
Su
r
e
t
y
,
ar
e
he
l
d
ar
i
d
fi
r
m
l
y
bo
u
n
d
un
t
o
th
e
Ci
t
y
of
Re
n
t
o
n
in
th
e
su
m
of
fi
v
e
(5
)
pe
r
c
e
n
t
of
th
e
to
t
a
l
am
o
u
n
t
of
th
e
bi
d
pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
of
sa
i
d
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
fo
r
th
e
wo
r
k
he
r
e
i
n
a
f
t
e
r
de
s
c
r
i
b
e
d
,
fo
r
th
e
pa
y
m
e
n
t
of
wh
i
c
h
we
l
l
an
d
tr
u
l
y
to
be
ma
d
e
,
we
bi
n
d
ou
r
s
e
l
v
e
s
,
ou
r
he
i
r
s
ex
e
c
u
t
o
r
s
ad
m
i
n
i
s
t
r
a
t
o
r
s
an
d
as
s
i
g
n
s
,
an
d
su
c
c
e
s
s
o
r
s
an
d
as
s
i
g
n
s
,
j
o
i
n
t
l
y
a
n
d
s
e
v
e
r
a
l
y
,
fi
r
m
l
y
by
th
e
s
e
pr
e
s
e
n
t
s
.
Th
e
co
n
d
i
t
i
o
n
of
th
i
s
bo
n
d
is
su
c
h
,
th
a
t
wh
e
r
e
th
e
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
he
r
e
i
n
is
he
r
e
w
i
t
h
su
b
m
i
t
t
i
n
g
hi
s
/
h
e
r
or
it
s
se
a
l
e
d
pr
o
p
o
s
a
t
f
o
r
t
h
e
fo
f
l
o
w
i
n
g
p
r
o
j
e
c
t
,
tO
wi
t
:
Wi
n
d
s
o
r
Hi
f
I
s
i
J
t
i
I
i
t
y
J
n
i
p
r
o
v
e
m
e
n
t
7-
4
1
8
6
sa
i
d
bi
d
an
d
pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
,
by
re
f
e
r
e
n
c
e
th
e
r
e
t
à
,
be
i
n
g
ma
d
e
a
pa
r
t
he
r
e
o
f
.
NO
W
,
TH
E
R
E
F
O
R
E
,
if
th
e
sa
i
d
pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
bi
d
by
sa
i
d
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
be
ac
c
e
p
t
e
d1
an
d
th
e
co
n
t
r
a
c
t
be
aw
a
r
d
e
d
to
sa
i
d
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
an
d
if
sa
i
d
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
sh
a
l
l
du
l
y
ma
k
e
an
d
en
t
e
r
in
t
o
an
d
ex
e
c
u
t
e
sa
i
d
co
n
t
r
a
c
t
an
d
sh
a
l
l
fu
r
n
i
s
h
pe
r
f
o
r
m
a
n
c
e
bo
n
d
as
re
q
u
i
r
e
d
by
th
e
Ci
t
y
of
Re
n
t
o
n
wi
t
h
i
n
a
pe
r
i
o
d
of
te
n
(1
0
)
da
y
s
fr
o
m
an
d
af
t
e
r
sa
i
d
aw
a
r
d
,
ex
c
l
u
s
i
v
e
of
t
h
e
da
y
of
su
c
h
aw
a
r
d
,
t
h
e
n
th
i
s
ob
l
i
g
a
t
i
o
n
sh
a
l
l
be
nu
l
l
an
d
vo
i
d
,
ot
h
e
r
w
i
s
e
it
sh
a
l
l
re
m
a
i
n
an
d
be
in
fu
l
l
fo
r
c
e
an
d
ef
f
e
c
t
.
IN
TH
E
EV
E
N
T
th
e
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
,
fo
l
l
o
w
i
n
g
aw
a
r
d
,
fa
i
l
s
to
ex
e
c
U
t
e
an
Ag
r
ê
e
r
n
e
h
t
wi
t
h
th
e
Ci
t
y
of
Re
n
t
o
n
in
ac
c
o
r
d
a
n
c
e
wi
t
h
th
e
te
r
m
s
of
th
e
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
an
d
fu
r
n
i
s
h
a
pe
r
f
o
r
m
a
n
c
e
bo
n
d
wi
t
h
Su
r
e
t
y
or
Su
r
e
t
i
e
s
ap
p
r
o
v
e
d
by
th
e
Ci
t
y
of
Re
n
t
o
n
wi
t
h
i
n
te
n
(1
0
)
da
y
s
fr
o
m
an
d
af
t
e
r
sa
i
d
aw
a
r
d
,
th
e
n
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
sh
a
l
l
fo
r
f
e
i
t
th
e
Bi
d
Bo
n
d
/
B
i
d
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
De
p
o
s
i
t
or
Su
r
e
t
y
sh
a
l
l
im
m
e
d
i
a
t
e
l
y
pa
y
an
d
fo
r
f
e
i
t
to
th
e
Ci
t
y
of
Re
n
t
o
n
th
e
am
o
u
n
t
of
th
e
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
Bd
Bo
n
d
,
as
se
t
fo
r
t
h
in
RC
W
35
A
.
4
0
.
2
0
0
an
d
RC
W
35
.
2
3
3
5
2
,
IN
TE
S
T
I
M
O
N
Y
WH
E
R
E
O
F
,
th
e
Pr
i
n
c
i
p
a
l
an
d
Su
r
e
t
y
ha
v
e
ca
u
s
e
d
th
e
s
e
pr
e
s
e
n
t
s
to
be
si
g
n
e
d
an
d
se
a
l
e
d
th
i
s
__
_
_
_
_
da
y
o
f
_
_
_
_
_
A
p
i
i
_
—
No
r
t
h
w
e
s
t
Ca
s
c
a
d
e
,
In
c
.
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
Fi
d
e
l
i
t
y
an
d
De
p
o
s
i
t
Co
m
p
a
n
y
of
Ma
r
y
l
a
n
d
E
--
[S
i
g
n
a
ur
e
of
au
t
h
o
ze
d
of
f
i
c
i
a
l
]
.
[S
i
g
n
a
t
u
r
e
of
au
t
h
iz
e
fi
c
i
a
l
]
e1
—V
ii
./
i
c
d
SY
:
9
E
J
X
2
!
L
.
80
0
5t
h
Ay
e
,
Su
i
t
e
38
1
0
[A
d
d
r
e
s
s
]
Se
a
t
t
l
e
,
WA
98
:
l
p
4
(2
0
6
)
62
2
-
1
1
0
1
[T
e
l
e
p
h
o
n
e
Nu
m
b
e
r
]
Ap
p
r
o
v
e
d
by
th
e
Ci
t
y
At
t
o
r
n
e
y
on
6/
0
3
/
1
3
8
Pr
o
p
o
s
a
l
Bi
d
Bo
n
d
Fo
r
m
\
ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY
COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY
FIDELITY AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND
POWER OF ATTORNEY
KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS:That the ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY.a corporation ofthe State of New
York,the COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY.a corporation of the State of Illinois,and the FIDELITY
AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND a corporation ofthe State oflllinois (herein collectively called the “Companies”),by Robert
D.Murray,Vice President,in pursuance ofauthority granted by Article V,Section 8,ofthe By-Laws ofsaid Companies,which are set forth
on the reverse side hereof and are hereby certified to be in full force and effect on the date hereof,do hereby nominate,constitute,and
appoint Julie R.TRUITT,Lindsey Elaine JORGENSEN,Holli ALBERS,Jarnie L.MARQUES,Carley ESPIRTTU,Christopher
KINYON,Brent E.HEILESEN,Annelies M.RICHIE,Amelia G.BURRILL,Sarah WHITAKER of Tacoma.Washington,its
true and lawful agent and Attorney-in-Fact,to make,execute,seal and deliver,for,and on its behalf as surety,and as its act and deed:any
and all bonds and undertakings,and the execution of such bonds or undertakings in pursuance ofthese presents,shall be as binding upon
said Companies,as fully and amply,to all intents and purposes,as ifthey had been duly executed and acknowledged by the regularly elected
officers ofthe ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY at its office in New York,New York.,the regularly elected officers of the
COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY at its office in Owings Mills,Maryland.,and the regularly elected
officers ofthe FIDELITY AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND at its office in Owings Mills,Maryland..in their own proper
persons.
The said Vice President does hereby certify that the extract set forth on the reverse side hereof is a true copy of Article V,Section 8.of
the By-Laws of said Companies,and is now in force.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF,the said Vice-President has hereunto subscribed his/her names and affixed the Corporate Seals of the said
ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY,COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY,and
FIDELITY AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND,this 25th day of September,AD.2023.
ATTEST:
ZURICh AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY
COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY
FIDELITY A]D DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND
By:Robert I).Murray
Vice Presidentat’
By:I)awn E.Brown
Secretary
State of Maryland
County of Baltimore
on this 25th day of September,AD.2023,before the subscriber,a Notary Public of the State of Maryland,duly commissioned and qualified,Robert
D.Murray,Vice President and Dawn E.Brown,Secretary of the Companies,to me personally known to be the individuals and officers described in and
who executed the preceding instrument,and acknowledged the execution of same,and being by me duly sworn,deposeth and saith,that he/she is the said
officer ofthe Company aforesaid,and that the seals affixed to the preceding instrument are the Corporate Seals ofsaid Companies,and that the said Corporate
Seals and the signature as such officer were duly affixed and subscribed to the said instrument by the authority and direction ofthe said Corporations.
IN TESTIMONY WhEREOF,I have hereunto set my hand and affixed my Official Seal the day and year first above written.
Genevieve lv!.Maison
GENEVIEVE M.MAISON
NOTARYPUBLIC
BALTIMORE COUNTY,MD
My Commission Expires JANUARY 27,2025
Authenticity of this bond can be confirmed at bondvalidator.zurichna.com or 410-559-8790
t
EXTRACT FROM BY-LAWS OF THE COMPANIES
“Article V.Section 8.Attorneys-in-Fact.The Chief Executive Officer.the President.or any Executive Vice President or Vice President
may,by written instrument under the attested corporate seal.appoint attorneys-in-fact with authority to execute bonds.policies.
recognizances.stipulations.undertakings.or other like instruments on behalf of the Company.and may authorize any officer or an such
attorney-in-fact to affix the corporate seal thereto;and may with or without cause modify of revoke any such appointment or authority at any
time.”
CERTIFICATE
I.the undersigned.Vice President of the ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY,the COLONIAL AMERICAN
CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY,and the FII)ELITY AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND.do hereby certify that the
foregoing Power of Attorney is still in full force and effect on the date of this certificate:and I do further certify that Article V.Section 8.of
the fly-Laws ofthe Companies is still in force.
This Power of Attorney and Certificate may be signed by facsimile under and by authority of the following resolution of the Board of
Directors ofthe ZURICH AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY at a meeting duly called and held on the 15th day ofDecember 1998.
RESOLVED:“That the signature ofthe President or a Vice President and the attesting signature ofa Secretary or an Assistant Secretary
and the Seal ofthe Company may be affixed by facsimile on any Power ofAttorney...Any such Power or any certificate thereofbearing such
facsimile signature and seal shall be valid and binding on the Company.”
This Power of Attorney and Certificate may be signed by facsimile tinder and by authority of the following resolution of the Board of
Directors of the COLONIAL AMERICAN CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY at a meeting duly called and held on the 5th day of
May.1994.and the following resolution of the Board of Directors of the FIDELITY AND DEPOSIT COMPANY OF MARYLAND at a
meeting duly called and held on the 10th day ofMay,1990.
RESOLVED:“That the facsimile or mechanically reproduced seal ofthe company and facsimile or mechanically reproduced signature
of any Vice-President.Secretary,or Assistant Secretary of the Company.whether made heretofore or hereafter,wherever appearing upon a
certified copy of any power of attorney issued by the Company,shall be valid and binding upon the Company with the same force and effect
as though manually affixed.
TN TETIMONY WHEEOF.I have hereunto subscribed my name and affixed the corporate seals ofthe said Companies,
this 3Q1dayof /1pi’I
Thomas 0.McClellan
Vice President
TO REPORT A CLAIM WITH REGARD TO A SURETY BOND,PLEASE SUBMIT A COMPLETE DESCRIPTION
OF THE CLAIM INCLUDING THE PRINCIPAL ON THE BOND,THE BOND NUMBER,AND YOUR CONTACT
INFORMATION TO:
Zurich Surety Claims
1299 Zurich Way
Schaurnburg,IL 60 196-1056
reportsfc laims()zurichna.corn
800-626-4577
Authenticity ofthis bond can be confirmed at bondvalidator.zurichna.com or 410-559-8790
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 /SWP-27-4186
Department of Labor and Industries
Certificate of Registration
Name on Registration:fl,OA.,N1/’1UJJ S+_ft.SC&tLQ 1/i/iL
Registration Number:)JO2_7}H!]i.-LJS
Expiration Date:10)011 lc—
Note:A copy of the certificate will be requested as part of contract execution when project is awarded.
9 Department of Labor and Industries Certificate of Registration\
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
WTR-27-4186 I SWP-27-4 186
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
*Note:Show price per unit in figures only.Figures written to the right of the dot (decimal)in the price per unit column shall be interpreted as cents.
SEE SECTION 1-09.14 OF THE SPECIAL PROVISIONS FOR PAYMENT INFORMATION ON BID ITEMS.
I ITEM I I SPEC.I APPROX.ITEM WITH UNIT PRICED BID I I I UNIT PRICE I TOTAL AMOUNT
I NO.
I I
SECTION I QUANTITY
I I
BID SCHEDULE A -GENERAL
Mobilization &Demobilization 1AOl(MaximumBidlo%ofScheduleTotal)1-09 LumpSum PIr Lump Sum
Construction Surveying,Staking,and As-Built 1A021-05 t22O.oDrawingsLumpSumPe(Lump Sum
1A03ProjectTemporaryTrafficControl1-10 DOC).Pt,
Lump Sum Per Lump Sum
1A04ErosionControlandWaterPollutionControl1-07 23 O1o,o.oo i..3G Of,o,ôj,
Lump Sum Per Lump Sum
Spill Prevention,Control and Countermeasure Plan 1A051-07 COO.DO DOandImplementationLumpSumPerLumpSum
1 ‘D,p.pv O,oC)o.DoA06LandscapeandPrivatePropertyRestoration8-02
Lump Sum Per Lump Sum
1A07RemoveandReplacePavementMarkings8-22 2 0,‘1).Or?2.0,I Do.
Lump Sum Per Lump Sum
Subtotal Schedule A /7..SO,2D
10.3%Sales Tax Schedule A /1)O,7çO
Total Schedule A*,,/77)
*The Contractor shall collect from the Contracting Agency retail sales tax on the Schedule A contract price per Section 1-07.2(2)and WAC 458-20-170.
10 Schedule of Prices\Page 1 of 7
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
WTR-27 -4186 /SWP-27-4186
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
*Note:Show price per unit in figures only.Figures written to the right of the dot (decimal)in the price per unit column shall be interpreted as cents.
SEE SECTION 1-09.14 OF THE SPECIAL PROVISIONS FOR PAYMENT INFORMATION ON BID ITEMS.
I ITEM I I SPEC.I APPROX.ITEM WITH UNIT PRICED BID I I UNIT PRICE I TOTAL AMOUNT
I
NO.I I
SECTION I QUANTITY
BID SCHEDULE B -SURFACE WATER
1BOlTrenchSafetySystems2-09 2L1()1S7,t —/7 1’l
Lump Sum Per Limp Sum
870
B02 Crushed Surfacing Top Course 4-04 7!.(pt),7 7iD.DOTonPerTon
1750 r1coo.L9oB03GravelBorrowforTrenchBackfill2-03 Ton Per Ton
1120
B04 HMA Cl.1/2-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch 5-04 1 ‘)I.Dt’2.-2_S /2 ()£0TonPerTon
1310B05HMACI.1/2-inchPG58H-22forOverlay 5-04 )b7.tp 2_PR,77i2ooTonPerTon
450
B06 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Sidewalk 8-14 J 2.2...00 cSquareYardPerSquareYard
410 17.VcB07RemoveandReplaceCementConcreteDriveway8-06 Square Yard Per Square Yard
Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Curb Ramp,1
B08 8-14TypeParallelA Each L’D i
Per Each
870
B09 Remove and Replace Concrete Curb and Gutter 8-04 Dc’‘—JS 2_9t DD
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation 210BlO2-03 /S DVMaterialTonPerTon
60B11ControlledDensityFill2-09 3 ,1i2 lD11ODDt
Cubic Yard Per Cubic Yard
1 150000
B12 Minor Changes 1-04 $150,000EstimatePerEstimate
4330
B13 CCTV Inspection 7-04 1 15D1’
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
1408148-inch HDPE Storm Drain Pipe 7-04 1 t bO LO
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
1200B1512-inch DI Storm Drain Pipe 7-04 1/7,,Q /j I,,Dfl)
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
10 Schedule of Prices\Page 2 of 7
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
WTR-27-4186 /SWP-27-4186
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
*Note:Show price per unit in figures only.Figures written to the right of the dot (decimal)in the price per unit column shall be interpreted as cents.
SEE SECTION 1-09.14 OF THE SPECIAL PROViSIONS FOR PAYMENT INFORMATION ON BID ITEMS.
ITEM SPEC.APPROX.ITEM WiTH UNIT PRICED BID UNIT PRICE TOTAL AMOUNTNO.SECTION QUANTITf a.Oo /2 I,1780
B16 12-inch Polypropylene Storm Drain Pipe 7-04 -/--=-I--—Linear Foot
Linear Foot
910
LinearFootB1712-inch C900 PVC Storm Drain Pipe 7-04
Per Linear Foot
300
B18 18-inch Polypropylene Storm Drain Pipe 7-04 7£00 lU..,,
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
70
B19 Quarry Spalls 8-15 )Ton Per Ton
3 -i__cc.DoB20YardDrain1-09 Each Jj ç’OPoD
Per Each
43
B21 Catch Basin Type 1 7-05
Each i,7ctD gc1
Per Each
16
Each C1 tDI?ov 9)B22 Catch Basin Type 2,48 In.Diam.7-05
Per Each
1
B23 Bird Cage Overflow Structure 1-09 Each <t c..—,‘7
Per Each
2
B24 Connect New Storm Pipe to Existing Catch Basin 7-OS Each €Y7So /,75too
Per Each
50
B25 Side Sewer Replacement 7-18 ‘1 2.5ocô
Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
1 40000
B26 Resolution of Utility Conflicts 1-07 $40,000EstimatePerEstimate
B27 Survey Monument Restoration 8-13
Each Per Each
Total Schedule B*
*All applicable sales tax shall be included in the unit and lump sum bid price per Section 1-07.2(1)and WAC 458-20-171.
1 c&3c7.()
10 Schedule of Prices\Page 3of7
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
WTR-27-4186 /SWP-27-4 186
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
*Note:Show price per unit in figures only.Figures written to the right of the dot (decimal)in the price per unit column shall be interpreted as cents.
SEE SECTiON 1-09.14 OF THE SPECIAL PROViSIONS FOR PAYMENT INFORMATION ON BID ITEMS.
I ITEM SPEC.I APPROX.I I
ITEM WiTH UNIT PRICED BID I I I UNIT PRICE I TOTAL AMOUNT
I
NO.
I SECTION I QUANTITY I I
BID SCHEDULE C -WASTEWATER
1COlTrenchSafetySystems2-09 3)3)LumpSum rLumpSum
10C02CrushedSurfacingTopCourse4-04 7 C’?bttTonPerTon
80C03GravelBorrowforTrenchBackfill2-03 Ton Per Ton
20C04HMACl.1/2-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch 5-04 2 0)P2 0 iOTonPerTon
10C05ControlledDensityFill2-09 3 L)CD PDCubicYardPerCucYard
1 5000
C06 Minor Changes 1-04 $5,000EstimatePerEstimate
60C07CCTVInspection7-17 I cc O 8’1P,E)Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
60C086-inch SDR35 PVC Sewer Pipe 7-17 7’,Linear Foot Per Linear Foot
1C0948-inch Sanitary Sewer Manhole 7-OS
Each 7tOD )71YD.0b
Per Each
1 5000
ClO Resolution of Utility Conflicts 1-07 $5,000EstimatePerEstimate
37DoSubtotalScheduleC(,,.
10.3%Sales Tax Schedule C
_________________
Total Schedule C*
_________________
-—J’‘It
*The Contractor shall collect from the Contracting Agency retail sales tax on the Schedule A contract price per Section 1-07.2(2)and WAC 458-20-170.
G1c21u
Lc.q-7.1/
10 Schedule of Prices\Page 4 of 7
t
CI
T
Y
OF
RE
N
T
O
N
PU
B
L
I
C
WO
R
K
S
DE
P
A
R
T
M
E
N
T
Wi
n
d
s
o
r
Hi
l
l
s
Ut
i
l
i
t
y
Im
p
r
o
v
e
m
e
n
t
s
WT
R
-
2
7
-
4
1
8
6
/
SW
P
-
2
7
-
4
1
8
6
SC
H
E
D
U
L
E
OF
PR
I
C
E
S
*N
o
t
e
:
Sh
o
w
pr
i
c
e
pe
r
un
i
t
in
fi
g
u
r
e
s
on
l
y
.
Fi
g
u
r
e
s
wr
i
t
t
e
n
to
th
e
ri
g
h
t
of
th
e
do
t
(d
e
c
i
m
a
l
)
in
th
e
pr
i
c
e
pe
r
un
i
t
co
l
u
m
n
sh
a
l
l
be
in
t
e
r
p
r
e
t
e
d
as
ce
n
t
s
.
SE
E
SE
C
T
I
O
N
1-
0
9
.
1
4
OF
TH
E
SP
E
C
I
A
L
PR
O
V
i
S
I
O
N
S
FO
R
PA
Y
M
E
N
T
IN
F
O
R
M
A
T
I
O
N
ON
BI
D
IT
E
M
S
.
I
IT
E
M
I
SP
E
C
.
I
AP
P
R
O
X
.
I
I
IT
E
M
WI
T
H
UN
I
T
PR
I
C
E
D
BI
D
I
i
I
UN
I
T
PR
I
C
E
I
TO
T
A
L
AM
O
U
N
T
I
NO
.
I
SE
C
T
I
O
N
I
QU
A
N
T
I
T
Y
I
BI
D
SC
H
E
D
U
L
E
D
-
WA
T
E
R
00
1
Tr
e
n
c
h
Sa
f
e
t
y
Sy
s
t
e
m
s
2-
0
9
/5
I
Ot
9
cO
Lu
m
p
Su
m
Pe
r
du
m
p
Su
m
24
5
0
D0
2
Cr
u
s
h
e
d
Su
r
f
a
c
i
n
g
To
p
Co
u
r
s
e
4-
0
4
t0
/
7
‘
/
s’
.
e
To
n
Pe
r
To
n
30
8
0
00
3
Gr
a
v
e
l
Bo
r
r
o
w
f
o
r
T
r
e
n
c
h
Ba
c
k
f
i
l
l
2-
0
3
/3
L,
g
lr
.
t
c
To
n
Pe
r
To
n
18
4
0
00
4
HM
A
C
I
.
1/
2
-
I
n
c
h
PG
58
H
-
2
2
fo
r
F
i
n
a
l
T
r
e
n
c
h
Pa
t
c
h
5-
0
4
).
.
(
.
Ot
’
3i
’
?1
‘“
)
b
.
D
O
To
n
Pe
r
To
n
21
7
0
D0
5
HM
A
CI
.
1/
2
-
I
n
c
h
PG
58
H
-
2
2
fo
r
Ov
e
r
l
a
y
5-
0
4
/
2.
0.
To
n
Pe
r
To
n
70
0
00
6
Re
m
o
v
e
an
d
Re
p
l
a
c
e
Ce
m
e
n
t
Co
n
c
r
e
t
e
Si
d
e
w
a
l
k
8-
1
4
/2
1
?t
’
t
2
.
bD
Sq
u
a
r
e
Ya
r
d
Pe
r
Sq
u
a
r
e
Ya
r
d
22
0
D0
7
Re
m
o
v
e
an
d
Re
p
l
a
c
e
Ce
m
e
n
t
Co
n
c
r
e
t
e
Dr
i
v
e
w
a
y
8-
0
6
/7
,
j
3
‘.
7
2
b
Sq
u
a
r
e
Ya
r
d
Pe
r
Sq
u
a
r
e
Ya
r
d
Re
m
o
v
e
an
d
Re
p
l
a
c
e
Ce
m
e
n
t
Co
n
c
r
e
t
e
Cu
r
b
Ra
m
p
,
1
D0
8
8-
1
4
,
5O
i
3,
S—
D
.
o
Ty
p
e
Pa
r
a
l
l
e
l
A
Ea
c
h
/
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
10
4
0
00
9
Re
m
o
v
e
an
d
Re
p
l
a
c
e
Co
n
c
r
e
t
e
Cu
r
b
an
d
Gu
t
t
e
r
8-
0
4
SZ
.
‘f
D’
O
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Pe
r
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Re
m
o
v
a
l
an
d
Re
p
l
a
c
e
m
e
n
t
of
Un
s
u
i
t
a
b
l
e
Fo
u
n
d
a
t
i
o
n
33
0
01
0
2-
0
3
•?
l
.
c
o
.2
-
3
,
’
-
1
3
0
.
D
D
Ma
t
e
r
i
a
l
To
n
Pe
r
To
n
50
Dl
i
Co
n
t
r
o
l
l
e
d
De
n
s
i
t
y
Fi
l
l
2-
0
9
C_
Q
Dt
1
7,
D
OD
oO
Cu
b
i
c
Ya
r
d
Pe
r
Cu
b
i
c
Ya
r
d
1
15
0
,
0
0
0
01
2
Mi
n
o
r
Ch
a
n
g
e
s
1-
0
4
$1
5
0
,
0
0
0
Es
t
i
m
a
t
e
Pe
r
Es
t
i
m
a
t
e
Du
c
t
i
l
e
Ir
o
n
Cl
a
s
s
52
6-
i
n
c
h
Di
a
m
e
t
e
r
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
14
0
01
3
Wa
t
e
r
Pi
p
e
an
d
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
Fi
t
t
i
n
g
s
wi
t
h
7-
0
9
/2
.
cc
1
7,
L1
0.
DO
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Po
l
y
w
r
a
p
Pe
r
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Du
c
t
i
l
e
Ir
o
n
Cl
a
s
s
52
8-
i
n
c
h
Di
a
m
e
t
e
r
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
69
2
0
01
4
Wa
t
e
r
Pi
p
e
an
d
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
Fi
t
t
i
n
g
s
wi
t
h
7-
0
9
J
2
6.
‘
c,
2
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Po
l
y
w
r
a
p
Pe
r
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Du
c
t
i
l
e
Ir
o
n
Cl
a
s
s
52
10
-
i
n
c
h
Di
a
m
e
t
e
r
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
70
01
5
Jo
i
n
t
Wa
t
e
r
Pi
p
e
an
d
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
Fi
t
t
i
n
g
s
wi
t
h
7-
0
9
2-
‘
‘.
p
.2
-
0
,
1
D
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
Po
l
y
w
r
a
p
Pe
r
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
10
Sc
h
e
d
u
l
e
of
Pr
i
c
e
s
\
Pa
g
e
5
of
7
CI
T
Y
OF
RE
N
T
O
N
PU
B
L
I
C
WO
R
K
S
DE
P
A
R
T
M
E
N
T
Wi
n
d
s
o
r
Hi
l
l
s
Ut
i
l
i
t
y
Im
p
r
o
v
e
m
e
n
t
s
WT
R
-
2
7
-
4
1
8
6
/
SW
P
-
2
7
-
4
1
8
6
SC
H
E
D
U
L
E
OF
PR
I
C
E
S
*N
o
t
e
:
Sh
o
w
pr
i
c
e
pe
r
un
i
t
in
fi
g
u
r
e
s
on
l
y
.
Fi
g
u
r
e
s
wr
i
t
t
e
n
to
th
e
ri
g
h
t
of
th
e
do
t
(d
e
c
i
m
a
l
)
in
th
e
pr
i
c
e
pe
r
un
i
t
co
l
u
m
n
sh
a
l
l
be
in
t
e
r
p
r
e
t
e
d
as
ce
n
t
s
.
SE
E
SE
C
T
I
O
N
1-
0
9
.
1
4
OF
TH
E
SP
E
C
I
A
L
PR
O
V
I
S
I
O
N
S
FO
R
PA
Y
M
E
N
T
IN
F
O
R
M
A
T
I
O
N
ON
BI
D
IT
E
M
S
.
IT
E
M
SP
E
C
.
AP
P
R
O
X
.
IT
E
M
Wi
T
H
UN
I
T
PR
I
C
E
D
BI
D
UN
I
T
PR
I
C
E
TO
T
A
L
AM
O
U
N
T
NO
.
SE
C
T
I
O
N
QU
A
N
T
I
T
Y
Du
c
t
i
l
e
Ir
o
n
Cl
a
s
s
52
12
-
i
n
c
h
Di
a
m
e
t
e
r
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
20
D1
6
Jo
i
n
t
Wa
t
e
r
Pi
p
e
an
d
Re
s
t
r
a
i
n
e
d
-
J
o
i
n
t
Fi
t
t
i
n
g
s
wi
t
h
7-
0
9
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
1’
6’
32
.
ôi
2
Po
l
y
w
r
a
p
Pe
r
Li
n
e
a
r
Fo
o
t
1
L’
99
O
.
t
O
D1
7
12
-
i
n
c
h
x
8-
i
n
c
h
Ta
p
p
i
n
g
Te
e
an
d
Va
l
v
e
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
Ea
c
h
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
1
D1
8
16
-
i
n
c
h
x
8
-
i
n
c
h
T
a
p
p
i
n
g
T
e
e
a
n
d
V
a
l
v
e
A
s
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
/0
,
D0
c
.
v
t
)t
2
,
fX
0
.
b
O
Ea
c
h
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
3
D1
9
6-
i
n
c
h
Ga
t
e
Va
l
v
e
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
Ea
c
h
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
25
3,
2
2
c
o
o
3,
,2
c
c
°
D2
0
8-
i
n
c
h
Ga
t
e
Va
l
v
e
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
Ea
c
h
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
3
D2
1
10
-
i
n
c
h
Ga
t
e
Va
l
v
e
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
/
I
ç—
o
.
CD
Ea
c
h
/
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
2
D2
2
12
-
i
n
c
h
Ga
t
e
Va
l
v
e
A
s
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
Ea
c
h
c1
o
3S
O
c
o
“P
e
r
Ea
c
h
3
D2
3
1-
i
n
c
h
Ai
r
an
d
Va
c
u
u
m
Re
l
e
a
s
e
Va
l
v
e
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
2
Ea
c
h
b
/
c
?o
p
.
1
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
15
D2
4
Fi
r
e
Hy
d
r
a
n
t
As
s
e
m
b
l
y
7-
1
4
Ea
c
h
,3
2
S
o
/2
,
7
5
a
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
1-
i
n
c
h
Wa
t
e
r
Se
r
v
i
c
e
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
,
Ty
p
e
A
wi
t
h
1-
I
n
c
h
38
s_
i
D2
5
Pr
e
s
s
u
r
e
Re
d
u
c
i
n
g
Va
l
v
e
(P
R
V
)
7-
1
5
Ea
c
h
97
c
D0
P
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
‘-
-
,
1
1-
i
n
c
h
Wa
t
e
r
Se
r
v
i
c
e
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
,
Ty
p
e
B
wi
t
h
1-
I
n
c
h
28
D2
6
Pr
e
s
s
u
r
e
Re
d
u
c
i
n
g
Va
l
v
e
(P
R
V
)
7-
1
5
Ea
c
h
/2
lp
o
.
o
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
1-
i
n
c
h
Wa
t
e
r
Se
r
v
i
c
e
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
,
Ty
p
e
C
wi
t
h
1-
I
n
c
h
70
D2
7
Pr
e
s
s
u
r
e
Re
d
u
c
i
n
g
Va
l
v
e
(P
R
V
)
7-
1
5
Ea
c
h
3,
8
7S
00
2-
7
/
,
2
cü
.
£X
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
1.
5
-
i
n
c
h
Wa
t
e
r
Se
r
v
i
c
e
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
,
Ty
p
e
C
wi
t
h
1.
5
-
1
D2
8
7-
1
5
In
c
h
Pr
e
s
s
u
r
e
Re
d
u
c
i
n
g
Va
l
v
e
(P
R
V
)
Ea
c
h
00
27
C
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
1
D2
9
2-
i
n
c
h
Wa
t
e
r
Se
r
v
i
c
e
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
7-
1
5
Ea
c
h
c)
C5
à
O
1Pe
r
Ea
c
h
13
Ea
c
h
31I2
5
c
D,
’
2
c
o
O
D3
0
Co
n
n
e
c
t
i
o
n
to
Ex
i
s
t
i
n
g
Wa
t
e
r
Ma
i
n
7-
0
9
Pe
r
Ea
c
h
10
Sc
h
e
d
u
l
e
of
Pr
i
c
e
s
\
Pa
g
e
6
of
7
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
WTR-27-4186 I SWP-27-4186
SCHEDULE OF PRICES
*Note:Show price per unit in figures only Figures written to the right of the dot (decimal)in the price per unit column shall be interpreted as cents.
SEE SECTION 1-09.14 OF THE SPECIAL PROVISIONS FOR PAYMENT INFORMATION ON BID ITEMS.
ITEM SPEC.APPROX.ITEM WiTH UNIT PRICED BID UNIT PRICE TOTAL AMOUNTNXSECTIONQUANTITY
90
D31 Concrete for Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Anchors 7-09 o.00 ‘1 ,4 &‘L-ôô
Cubic Yard Per Cubic Yard
1
D32 Abandon Existing Water Main 7-09 //)(f?OO.()
LumpSum erLumpSum
5300
D33 Additional Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Fittings 7-09 7.Sc 1,7St2OD
Pound Per Pound
130
D34 Side Sewer Replacement 7-18 /12 tL)o.ooLinearFootPerLinearFoot
1 30,000
D35 Resolution of Utility Conflicts 1-07 $30,000EstimatePerEstimate
2D36SurveyMonumentRestoration8-13 7 1,7 S0.DO
Each Per Each
I
7g0 79O.oo
Subtotal Schedule D’3 —9
10.3%Sales Tax ScheduleD 35?573.‘-1)
TotalScheduleD*
_____________
*The Contractor shall collect from the Contracting Agency retail sales tax on the Schedule A contract price per Section 1-07.2(2)and WAC 458-20-170.
/1
/,1272 .icvSummary:
Total Schedule A brought forward =$
Total Schedule B brought forward =$
Total Schedule C brought forward =$
Total Schedule D brought forward =$
Total Bid Amount,Schedules A,B,C,&D =$
Note:Determination of low bidder will be based solely on the Total Bid.
D
;5?Z-ii
10 Schedule of Prices\Page 7 of 7
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 I SWP-27-4186
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT OF RECEIPT OF ADDENDA
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT OF RECEIPT OF ADDENDA N
NO.______DATE:____________________
NO.______DATE:_____________________
NO.______DATE:_____________________
NO.______DATE:____________________
NO.______DATE:____________________
SIG
TI
NAME OF COMPANY:
ADDRESS:
CITY!STATE!ZIP:
TELEPHONE:
OscecLc LL’lL
1o T53’1 9
1u4 qg33
31 I
11 Acknowledgement of Receipt of Addenda\
This form must be submitted with the Bid Proposal.
Certification of Compliance with Wage Payment Statutes
The bidder hereby certifies that,within the three-year period immediately preceding the bid
solicitation date,the bidder is not a “willful”violator,as defined in RCW 49.48.082,of any provision
of chapters 49.46,49.48,or 49.52 RCW,as determined by a final and binding citation and notice of
assessment issued by the Department of Labor and Industries or through a civil judgment entered by
a court of limited or general jurisdiction.
I certify under penalty of perjury under the laws of the State of Washington that the foregoing is true
and correct.
1291i&c 1-t&ceu,,tii
Bidder’Busi ess Name
Signature of Authoriz Official*
&(%?$Th J1ttfS
Printed Name
Viu Piwciduw
Title 9tt1uLtL/J
Date City State
Check One:
Sole Proprietorship Partnership Joint Venture Corporation LLC
State of lncorporation;or if not a corporation,State where business entity was formed:
too
If a co-pn7rp,give firm name under which business is transacted:
*/f a corporation,proposal must be executed in the corporate name by the president or vice-president (or any other corporate
officer accompanied by evidence of authority to sign).If a co-partnership,proposal must be executed by a partner.
Template updated 2-12-19
12 Certificate of Compliance with Wage Payment Statutes\
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 I SWP-27-4186
SUBCONTRACTOR LIST
For all public works contracts exceeding $1,000,000 the bidder shall submit the names of the subcontractors
with whom the bidder,if awarded the contract,will subcontract for the following work:
•All heating,ventilation and air conditioning,and plumbing subcontractors as described in chapter 18.106
RCW,and electrical subcontractors as described in chapter 19.28 RCW (this also includes the control
system integrator subcontractor as well as other electrical subcontractors)shall be submitted as part of
the bid.
•All structural steel installation and rebar installation subcontractors shall be submitted as part of the bid.
If the work does not apply to this contract,check the box “Not Applciable”.If the work will be self performed
by the bidder,check the box “Self Performed”.
If the subcontractors names are not submitted with the bid OR if two or more subcontractors are named to
perform the same work,the bid shall be considered nonresponsive and,therefore,void.
If subcontractors vary with bid alternates,please complete a separate form indicating which subcontractors will
be used for which bid alternate.
Complete the following:
If awarded the l.I1L will contract with the following
subcontractors for the performance of heating,ventilation and air conditioning,plumbing,electrical
(including automatic controls)work,structural steel installation,and rebar installation (If no subcontractors
will be required,still submit the form indicating “not applicable”for each discipline):
The following list of subcontracts is due with the bid.
Category of Work Heating,Ventilation &Air Conditioning (HVAC)
Subcontractors Name
Address
Phone No.Contractor’s License No.
Plumbing (per RCW 18.106)Not Applicable
jC/f i”14 wk,;.P Self Performed
1bi es1-,r cw+e 2J30 //‘/I4/(4 .J-%.7,S0 £3
2 cg Contractor’s License No./p’-k-7 47,1 a
Electrical (per RCW 19.28)Not Applicable
-Self Performedf
___
‘7&5 r4-f!IviJ 2t0 ,‘r-vi’,ic hc 7ThG3
Contractor’s License No.f/pj *-7q0f3 k-I
In accordance with RCW 39.30-060:
Not Applicable ,.1
Self Performed 1
Category of Work
Subcontractors Name
Address
Phone No.
Category of Work
Subcontractors Name
Address
Phone No.
13 Subcontractor List\Rev iscd 3/3 i202 I cib
Page 2
Category of Work Structural Steel and Rebar Installation Not Applicable
Subcontractors Name Self Performed
Address
Phone No.Contractor’s License No.
“I certify (or declare)under penalty of perjury under the laws of
the State of Washington that the information provided by bidder
in the subcontractor listing form is true and correct to the best of
my knowledge and belief”
Signature:
________________________________________________
Printed Name:I!&JU2/))ltj’t’i5 PfldidiA
Date:0 g [o /DcL1
13 Subcontractor List\Revised 3/31/2021 clb
Public Works Department
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
CAG-24-060
Documents to be Submitted After
Notice of Award
CONTRACT BOND TO THE CITY OF RENTON
CITY OF RENTON FAIR PRACTICES POLICY AFFIDAVIT OF COMPLIANCE
CONTRACT AGREEMENT
RETAINAGE SELECTION AND RETAINAGE BOND
CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE
Insurance Guidelines for the City of Renton
The City of Renton requires current insurance certificates for one or
more of the following lines of coverage and minimum insurance limits:
Revised 6/8/23
•$1,000,000 per occurrence and $2,000,000 aggregate for Commercial General Liability
(CGL) or Special Event coverage. Limits may be increased for higher than usual or special
liability exposures.
•$1,000,000 combined single limit for Auto Liability. Required if a commercial vehicle will
be used in performance of work or delivery of products, beyond normal commutes.
•Proof of Workers’ Compensation coverage, as required by the State of Washington
(provide the Washington L&I or excess coverage policy number).
•Excess Liability or Umbrella. Required only if needed to reach minimum CGL or auto
liability coverage limits.
•$1,000,000 Professional Liability. Required if professional services (e.g. architect,
engineering, surveying, legal, or medical) are being provided to the city and if those
professional services are excluded from the CGL policy.
•$1,000,000 Pollution Liability. Required if work involves a pollution risk to the
environment.
•$2,000,000 Cyber Liability Insurance. Required for information technology professional
services agreements. Limits may be higher for special liability exposures.
•Builders Risk. May be required up to the amount of the completed value of a new
building or major construction project.
•$1,000,000 per occurrence Aircraft Liability (Single Limit Bodily Injury and Property
Damage Liability). Required coverage only for aircraft tie-down leases.
Additional requirements unique to the City of Renton:
•Name the City of Renton as a certificate holder and a Primary and Non-Contributory
Additional Insured on the policy.
This requirement applies to Commercial General, Auto Liability, Excess/ Umbrella, Special
Event, and Aircraft Liability policies; it does not apply to Professional Liability, Workers’
Compensation, nor Cyber Insurance.
•The Certificate Holder should read:
•The City shall be provided with written notice of any policy cancellation within a
minimum of two business days of receipt of such notice by the policy holder.
•The city does not represent that the minimum required insurance coverage or limits are
adequate to protect the vendor/contractor/consultant from all liabilities.
•Insurance certificate requirements and minimum limits can only be waived or modified
with Risk Manager approval.
Direct any questions, comments, or concerns to: Krista Kolaz, Risk Management
425-430-7669
kkolaz@rentonwa.gov
City of Renton
ATTN: [your City contact’s name & department]
1055 South Grady Way
Renton, WA 98057
INSR ADDL SUBR
LTR INSR WVD
DATE (MM/DD/YYYY)
PRODUCER CONTACT
NAME:
FAXPHONE
(A/C, No):(A/C, No, Ext):
E-MAIL
ADDRESS:
INSURER A :
INSURED INSURER B :
INSURER C :
INSURER D :
INSURER E :
INSURER F :
POLICY NUMBER
POLICY EFF POLICY EXPTYPE OF INSURANCE LIMITS(MM/DD/YYYY)(MM/DD/YYYY)
COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY
AUTOMOBILE LIABILITY
UMBRELLA LIAB
EXCESS LIAB
WORKERS COMPENSATION
AND EMPLOYERS' LIABILITY
DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS / LOCATIONS / VEHICLES (ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, may be attached if more space is required)
AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAIC #
Y / N
N / A
(Mandatory in NH)
ANY PROPRIETOR/PARTNER/EXECUTIVE
OFFICER/MEMBER EXCLUDED?
EACH OCCURRENCE $
DAMAGE TO RENTED $PREMISES (Ea occurrence)CLAIMS-MADE OCCUR
MED EXP (Any one person)$
PERSONAL & ADV INJURY $
GENERAL AGGREGATE $GEN'L AGGREGATE LIMIT APPLIES PER:
PRODUCTS - COMP/OP AGG $
$
PRO-
OTHER:
LOCJECT
COMBINED SINGLE LIMIT
$(Ea accident)
BODILY INJURY (Per person)$ANY AUTO
OWNED SCHEDULED BODILY INJURY (Per accident)$AUTOS ONLY AUTOS
AUTOS ONLY
HIRED PROPERTY DAMAGE $AUTOS ONLY (Per accident)
$
OCCUR EACH OCCURRENCE $
CLAIMS-MADE AGGREGATE $
DED RETENTION $$
PER OTH-
STATUTE ER
E.L. EACH ACCIDENT $
E.L. DISEASE - EA EMPLOYEE $
If yes, describe under
E.L. DISEASE - POLICY LIMIT $DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS below
POLICY
NON-OWNED
SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE
THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS.
THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD
INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS
CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS,
EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS.
THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS
CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES
BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED
REPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER.
IMPORTANT: If the certificate holder is an ADDITIONAL INSURED, the policy(ies) must have ADDITIONAL INSURED provisions or be endorsed.
If SUBROGATION IS WAIVED, subject to the terms and conditions of the policy, certain policies may require an endorsement. A statement on
this certificate does not confer any rights to the certificate holder in lieu of such endorsement(s).
COVERAGES CERTIFICATE NUMBER:REVISION NUMBER:
CERTIFICATE HOLDER CANCELLATION
© 1988-2015 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved.
The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORDACORD 25 (2016/03)
ACORDTM CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE
National Union Fire Ins Co of Pittsburg
Navigators Insurance Company
Axis Surplus Insurance Company
Continental Casualty Company
Homesite Insurance Company
5/15/2024
Propel Insurance
1201 Pacific Avenue; Suite 1000
COM Construction
Tacoma, WA 98402-4321
Casondra Mossuto
800 499-0933 866 577-1326
casondra.mossuto@propelinsurance.com
Northwest Cascade Inc. dba Honey Bucket;
Liberty Site Services
PO Box 73399
Puyallup, WA 98373
19445
42307
26620
20443
A X
X
X
GL3296838 05/01/2024 05/01/2025 1,000,000
300,000
5,000
1,000,000
2,000,000
2,000,000
A
X
X X
CA2507760 05/01/2024 05/01/2025 1,000,000
B
E
X
X
X 0
SE24EXCZ0346EIC
CXP00023203
05/01/2024
05/01/2024
05/01/2025
05/01/2025
5,000,000
10,000,000
2nd Layer 5,000,000
A
N
WC048240166 - AOS
WC48240167 - CA
WC048241069 - OR
Stop Gap Included
05/01/2024
05/01/2024
05/01/2024
05/01/2025
05/01/2025
05/01/2025
X
1,000,000
1,000,000
1,000,000
C
D
D
Pollution
Leased Equipment
Inst. Floater
CP002899072024
7037189578
7037189578
05/01/2024
05/01/2024
05/01/2024
05/01/2025
05/01/2025
05/01/2025
$2M Occ/Agg. $25k Ded.
$600k / $5k Ded.
$100k/$25k/$5k Ded.
RE: Renton Windsor Hills Utility Improvements CAG-24-060
The City of Renton:
Additional Insured Status applies per attached form(s).
City of Renton
Attn: Krista Kolaz - Risk Management
1055 South Grady Way
Renton, WA 98057
1 of 1
#S6650869/M6603335
NORTCASC1Client#: 12831
SMH01
1 of 1
#S6650869/M6603335
This page has been left blank intentionally.
POLICY NUMBER: COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY
CG 20 10 12 19
THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY.
CG 20 10 12 19 © Insurance Services Office, Inc., 2018 Page 1 of 2
ADDITIONAL INSURED – OWNERS, LESSEES OR
CONTRACTORS – SCHEDULED PERSON OR
ORGANIZATION
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
SCHEDULE
Name Of Additional Insured Person(s)
Or Organization(s) Location(s) Of Covered Operations
Information required to complete this Schedule, if not shown above, will be shown in the Declarations.
A.Section II – Who Is An Insured is amended to
include as an additional insured the person(s) or
organization(s) shown in the Schedule, but only
with respect to liability for "bodily injury", "property
damage" or "personal and advertising injury"
caused, in whole or in part, by:
1.Your acts or omissions; or
2.The acts or omissions of those acting on your
behalf;
in the performance of your ongoing operations for
the additional insured(s) at the location(s)
designated above.
However:
1.The insurance afforded to such additional
insured only applies to the extent permitted by
law; and
2.If coverage provided to the additional insured is
required by a contract or agreement, the
insurance afforded to such additional insured
will not be broader than that which you are
required by the contract or agreement to
provide for such additional insured.
B.With respect to the insurance afforded to these
additional insureds, the following additional
exclusions apply:
This insurance does not apply to "bodily injury" or
"property damage" occurring after:
1.All work, including materials, parts or
equipment furnished in connection with such
work, on the project (other than service,
maintenance or repairs) to be performed by or
on behalf of the additional insured(s) at the
location of the covered operations has been
completed; or
2.That portion of "your work" out of which the
injury or damage arises has been put to its
intended use by any person or organization
other than another contractor or subcontractor
engaged in performing operations for a
principal as a part of the same project.
PER THE CONTRACT OR AGREEMENTANY PERSON OR ORGANIZATION WHO YOU
BECOME OBLIGATED TO INCLUDE AS AN
ADDITIONAL INSURED AS A RESULT OF ANY
CONTRACT OR AGREEMENT YOU HAVE ENTERED INTO.
GL 329-68-38
Page 2 of 2 © Insurance Services Office, Inc., 2018 CG 20 10 12 19
C. With respect to the insurance afforded to these
additional insureds, the following is added to
Section III – Limits Of Insurance:
If coverage provided to the additional insured is
required by a contract or agreement, the most we
will pay on behalf of the additional insured is the
amount of insurance:
1. Required by the contract or agreement; or
2. Available under the applicable limits of
insurance;
whichever is less.
This endorsement shall not increase the
applicable limits of insurance.
POLICY NUMBER: COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY
CG 20 37 12 19
THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY.
CG 20 37 12 19 © Insurance Services Office, Inc., 2018 Page 1 of 1
ADDITIONAL INSURED – OWNERS, LESSEES ORCONTRACTORS – COMPLETED OPERATIONS
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
PRODUCTS/COMPLETED OPERATIONS LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
SCHEDULE
Name Of Additional Insured Person(s)
Or Organization(s)Location And Description Of Completed Operations
Information required to complete this Schedule, if not shown above, will be shown in the Declarations.
A.Section II – Who Is An Insured is amended to
include as an additional insured the person(s) or
organization(s) shown in the Schedule, but only
with respect to liability for "bodily injury" or
"property damage" caused, in whole or in part, by
"your work" at the location designated and
described in the Schedule of this endorsement
performed for that additional insured and included
in the "products-completed operations hazard".
However:
1.The insurance afforded to such additional
insured only applies to the extent permitted by
law; and
2.If coverage provided to the additional insured is
required by a contract or agreement, the
insurance afforded to such additional insured
will not be broader than that which you are
required by the contract or agreement to
provide for such additional insured.
B.With respect to the insurance afforded to these
additional insureds, the following is added to
Section III – Limits Of Insurance:
If coverage provided to the additional insured is
required by a contract or agreement, the most we
will pay on behalf of the additional insured is the
amount of insurance:
1.Required by the contract or agreement; or
2.Available under the applicable limits of
insurance;
whichever is less.
This endorsement shall not increase the
applicable limits of insurance.
ANY PERSON OR ORGANIZATION WHO YOU
BECOME OBLIGATED TO INCLUDE AS AN
ADDITIONAL INSURED AS A RESULT OF ANY
CONTRACT OR AGREEMENT YOU HAVE ENTERED INTO.
PER THE CONTRACT OR AGREEMENT
GL 329-68-38
POLICY NUMBER: GL 329-68-38 COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY
CG 20 01 12 19
THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY.
PRIMARY AND NONCONTRIBUTORY -
OTHER INSURANCE CONDITION
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
LIQUOR LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
PRODUCTS/COMPLETED OPERATIONS LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
The following is added to the Other Insurance
Condition and supersedes any provision to the
contrary:
Primary And Noncontributory Insurance
This insurance is primary to and will not seek
contribution from any other insurance available
to an additional insured under your policy
provided that:
(1)The additional insured is a Named Insured
under such other insurance; and
(2)You have agreed in writing in a contract or
agreement that this insurance would be
primary and would not seek contribution
from any other insurance available to the
additional insured.
CG 20 01 12 19 Insurance Services Office, Inc., 2018 Page 1 of 1
Name Of Person(s) Or Organization(s):
Information required to complete this Schedule, if not shown above, will be shown in the Declarations.
POLICY NUMBER: GL 329-68-38 COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY
CG 24 04 12 19
WAIVER OF TRANSFER OF RIGHTS OF RECOVERY
AGAINST OTHERS TO US (WAIVER OF SUBROGATION)
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
ELECTRONIC DATA LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
LIQUOR LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
POLLUTION LIABILITY COVERAGE PART DESIGNATED SITES
POLLUTION LIABILITY LIMITED COVERAGE PART DESIGNATED SITES
PRODUCTS/COMPLETED OPERATIONS LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
RAILROAD PROTECTIVE LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
UNDERGROUND STORAGE TANK POLICY DESIGNATED TANKS
SCHEDULE
Pursuant to applicable written contract or agreement you enter into.
The following is added to Paragraph 8. Transfer Of
Rights Of Recovery Against Others To Us of
Section IV – Conditions:
We waive any right of recovery against the
person(s) or organization(s) shown in the Schedule
above because of payments we make under this
Coverage Part. Such waiver by us applies only to
the extent that the insured has waived its right of
recovery against such person(s) or organization(s)
prior to loss. This endorsement applies only to the
person(s) or organization(s) shown in the Schedule
above.
CG 24 04 12 19 Insurance Services Office, Inc., 2018 Page 1 of 1
ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement, effective 12:01 A.M. 05/01/2024
forms a part of Policy No. CA 250-77-60
issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
by NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
WAIVER OF TRANSFER OF RIGHTS OF RECOVERY AGAINST OTHERS TO US
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
BUSINESS AUTO COVERAGE FORM
Section IV -Business Auto Conditions, A. -Loss Conditions, 5. -Transfer of Rights of Recovery
Against Others to Us, is amended to add:
However, we will waive any right of recover we have against any person or organization with whom you have
entered into a contract or agreement because of payments we make under this Coverage Form arising out of
an "accident" or " loss" if:
( 1)The "accident" or "loss" is due to operations undertaken in accordance with the contract existing
between you and such person or organization; and
(2)The contract or agreement was entered into prior to any "accident" or "loss".
No waiver of the right of recovery will directly or indirectly apply to your employees or employees of the
person or organization, and we reserve our rights or lien to be reimbursed from any recovery funds obtained
by any injured employee.
AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
62897 (6/95) Includes copyrighted material of Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission. Page 1 of 1
ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement, effective 12:01 A.M. 05/01/2024
forms a part of Policy No. CA250-77-60
issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
by NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
INSURANCE PRIMARY AS TO CERTAIN ADDITIONAL INSUREDS
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
BUSINESS AUTO COVERAGE FORM
Section IV -Business Auto Conditions, B., General Conditions, 5., Other Insurance, c., is
amended by the addition of the following sentence:
The insurance afforded under this policy to an additional insured will apply as primary insurance
for such additional insured where so required under an agreement executed prior to the date of
accident. We will not ask any insurer that has issued other insurance to such additional insured to
contribute to the settlement of loss arising out of such accident.
All other terms and conditions remain unchanged.
Authorized Representative or Countersignature (in States Where Applicable)
74445 (10/99) Includes copyrighted material of Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission. Page 1 of 1
ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement, effective 12:01 A.M. 05/01/2024
forms a part of Policy No. CA250-77-60
issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
by NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
ADDITIONAL INSURED - WHERE REQUIRED UNDER CONTRACT OR AGREEMENT
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
BUSINESS AUTO COVERAGE FORM
SCHEDULE
ADDITIONAL INSURED:
ANY PERSON OR ORGANIZATION FOR WHOM YOU ARE CONTRACTUALLY BOUND TO PROVIDE ADDITIONAL INSURED STATUS BUT ONLY TO THE EXTENT OF SUCH PERSON'S OR ORGANIZATION'S LIABILITY ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF A COVERED "AUTO".
I.SECTION II -COVERED AUTOS LIABILITY COVERAGE, A. Coverage, 1 . -Who Is Insured, is
amended to add:
d.Any person or organization, shown in the schedule above, to whom you become obligated
to include as an additional insured under this policy, as a result of any contract or agreement
you enter into which requires you to furnish insurance to that person or organization of the
type provided by this policy, but only with respect to liability arising out of use of a covered
"auto". However, the insurance provided will not exceed the lesser of:
( 1)The coverage and/or limits of this policy, or
(2)The coverage and/or limits required by said contract or agreement.
AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
87950 (9/14) Includes copyrighted material of Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission. Page 1 of 1
ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement, effective 12:01 A.M. 05/01/2024
forms a part of Policy No. CA250-77-60
issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
by NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
LIMITED ADVICE OF CANCELLATION PROVIDED VIA E-MAIL
TO ENTITIES OTHER THAN THE FIRST NAMED INSURED
This policy is amended as follows:
In the event that the Insurer cancels this policy for any reason other than non-payment of premium, and
1.the cancellation effective date is prior to this policy's expiration date;
2.the First Named Insured is under an existing contractual obligation to notify a certificate holder
when this policy is canceled (hereinafter, the "Certificate Holder(s) ") and has provided to the
Insurer, either directly or through its broker of record, the email address of a contact at each
such entity; and
3.the Insurer received this information after the First Named Insured receives notice of cancellation
of this policy and prior to this policy's cancellation effective date, via an electronic spreadsheet
that is acceptable to the Insurer,
the Insurer will provide advice of cancellation (the "Advice") via e-mail to each such Certificate Holders withi
n 3Q days after the First Named Insured provides such information to the Insurer; provided, however, that if
a specific number of days is not stated above, then the Advice will be provided to such Certificate Holder(s)
as soon as reasonably practicable after the First Named Insured provides such information to the Insurer.
Proof of the Insurer emailing the Advice, using the information provided by the First Named Insured, will
serve as proof that the Insurer has fully satisfied its obligations under this endorsement.
This endorsement does not affect, in any way, coverage provided under this policy or the cancellation of
this policy or the effective date thereof, nor shall this endorsement invest any rights in any entity not
insured under this policy.
The following Definitions apply to this endorsement:
1 . First Named Insured means the Named Insured shown on the Declarations Page of this policy.
2.Insurer means the insurance company shown in the header on the Declarations page of this policy.
All other terms, conditions and exclusions shall remain the same.
Authorized Representative
107414 (3/11) Includes copyrighted material of Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission. Page 1 of 1
WAIVER OF OUR RIGHT TO RECOVER FROM OTHERS ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement changes the policy to which it is attached effective on inception date of the policy unless a different
date is indicated below.
This endorsement, effective 12:01 AM 05/01 / 2024
Issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
forms a part of Policy No. WC 048-24-0166
By NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
We have the right to recover our payments from anyone liable for an injury covered by this policy. We will not enforce
our right against the person or organization named in the Schedule. This agreement applies only to the extent that you
perform work under a written contract that requires you to obtain this agreement from us.
This agreement shall not operate directly or indirectly to benefit any one not named in the Schedule.
Schedule
ANY PERSON OR ORGANIZATION TO WHOM YOU BECOME OBLIGATED TO WAIVE YOUR RIGHTS OF RECOVERY AGAINST, UNDER ANY WRITTEN CONTRACT OR AGREEMENT YOU ENTER INTO PRIOR TO THE OCCURRENCE OF LOSS.
This form is not applicable in Kansas for private construction contracts as defined in K.S.A. 16-1801 through K.S.A
16-1807 or public construction contracts as defined in K.S.A. 16-1901 through 16-1908, except where permitted by
statute or other applicable law, such as for use in wrap-up insurance programs.
Any person or organization for which the employer has agreed by written contract, executed prior to loss, may execute
a waiver of subrogation. However, for purposes of work performed by the employer in Missouri, this waiver of
subrogation does not apply to any construction group of classifications as designated by the waiver of right to recover
from others (subrogation) rule in our manual.
This form is not applicable in California, Kentucky, New Hampshire, New Jersey, Texas, or Utah.
WC 00 0313
(Ed. 04/84)
Countersigned by -----------------------
Authorized Representative
BLANKET WAIVER OF OUR RIGHT TO RECOVER FROM OTHERS ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement changes the policy to which it is attached effective on the inception date of the policy unless a different
date is indicated below.
(The following "attaching clause" need be completed only when this endorsement is issued subsequent to preparation of the policy).
This endorsement, effective 12:01 AM 05/01 / 2024
Issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
forms a part of Policy No. WC 048-24-0167
By NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
We have a right to recover our payments from anyone liable for an injury covered by this policy. We will not enforce
our right against any person or organization with whom you have a written contract that requires you to obtain this
agreement from us, as regards any work you perform for such person or organization.
The additional premium for this endorsement shall be 2. 00 % of the total estimated workers compensation premium
for this policy.
WC 04 03 61
(Ed. 11/90)
Countersigned by __________________ ��� � ��
Authorized Representative
TEXAS WAIVER OF OUR RIGHT TO RECOVER FROM OTHERS ENDORSEMENT
This endorsement changes the policy to which it is attached and is effective on the date issued unless otherwise stated.
(The information below is required only when this endorsement is issued subsequent to preparation of the policy.)
This endorsement, effective 12:01 AM 05/01/2024
Issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
forms a part of Policy No. WC 048-24-0166
By NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
This endorsement applies only to the insurance provided by the policy because Texas is shown in Item 3.A. of the
Information Page.
We have the right to recover our payments from anyone liable for an injury covered by this policy. We will not enforce
our right against the person or organization named in the Schedule, but this waiver applies only with respect to bodily
injury arising out of the operations described in the Schedule where you are required by a written contract to obtain this
waiver from us.
This endorsement shall not operate directly or indirectly to benefit anyone not named in the Schedule.
The premium for this endorsement is shown in the Schedule.
Schedule
1.( ) Specific Waiver
Name of person or organization
( X)Blanket Waiver
Any person or organization for whom the Named Insured has agreed by written contract to furnish this waiver.
2.Operations: ALL TEXAS OPERATIONS
3.Premium:
The premium charge for this endorsement shall be � percent of the premium developed on payroll in
connection with work performed for the above person(s) or organization(s) arising out of the operations described.
4.Advance Premium:
WC 42 03 04 B
(Ed. 6-14)
$
3
,
60 7
Countersigned by _________________ -������
Authorized Representative
4)Copyright 2014 National Council on Compensation Insurance, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY.
This endorsement changes the policy to which it is attached effective on the inception date of the policy unless a different
date is indicated below.
(The following "attaching clause" need be completed only when this endorsement is issued subsequent to preparation of the policy).
This endorsement, effective 12:01 AM 05/01/2024
Issued to NORTHWEST CASCADE , I NC .
forms a part of Policy No. WC 048-24-0167
By NATIONAL UNION FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY OF PITTSBURGH, PA.
LIMITED ADVICE OF CANCELLATION PROVIDED VIA E-MAIL
TO ENTITIES OTHER THAN THE NAMED INSURED
(WORKERS' COMPENSATION ONLY)
This policy is amended as follows:
In the event that the Insurer cancels this policy for any reason other than non-payment of premium, and
1.the cancellation effective date is prior to this policy's expiration date;
2.the Named Insured or, if applicable, any other employers named in Item 1 of the Information Page is under an
existing contractual obligation to notify a certificate holder when this policy is canceled {hereinafter, the
"Certificate Holder(s)") and the Named Insured has provided to the Insurer, either directly or through its
broker of record, the email address of a contact at each such entity; and
3.the Insurer received this information after the Named Insured receives notice of cancellation of this policy and
prior to this policy's cancellation effective date, via an electronic spreadsheet that is acceptable to the Insurer,
the Insurer will provide advice of cancellation (the "Advice") via e-mail to each such Certificate Holders within 30 days
after the Named Insured provides such information to the Insurer; provided, however, that if a specific number of days
is not stated above, then the Advice will be provided to such Certificate Holder(s) as soon as reasonably practicable
after the Named Insured provides such information to the Insurer.
Proof of the Insurer emailing the Advice, using the information provided by the First Named Insured, will serve as
proof that the Insurer has fully satisfied its obligations under this endorsement.
This endorsement does not affect, in any way, coverage provided under this policy or the cancellation of this policy or
the effective date thereof, nor shall this endorsement invest any rights in any entity not insured under this policy.
The following definitions apply to this endorsement:
1.Named Insured means the insured first named employer in Item 1 of the Information Page of this policy.
2.Insurer means the insurance company shown in the header on the Information Page of this policy.
All other terms, conditions and exclusions shall remain the same.
WC 99 00 56 (Ed. 04/11)
AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE
NAV-EXC-348A (01/11)Page 1 of 1Navigators Specialty Insurance Company
Contains copyrighted material of the
Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission.
COMMERCIAL EXCESS LIABILITY
THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY.
AMENDMENT OF CONDITIONS OTHER INSURANCE PRIMARY AND NON-CONTRIBUTING
This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following:
COMMERCIAL EXCESS LIABILITY COVERAGE PART
SCHEDULE
When required by written contract executed before the "loss."
A. Section IV - Conditions, 9. Other Insurance is deleted and replaced by the following:
9. This insurance is excess over any other insurance available to the insured except:
a. insurance that is purchased specifically to apply in excess of this policy; or
b. insurance available to the person or organization shown in the Schedule of this
endorsement as an additional insured on the “controlling underlying insurance.”
B. When this insurance applies on a primary and non-contributing basis, the Limits of Insurance
available for the additional insured will be the lesser of:
1. the amounts shown in item 3 of the Declarations of this policy; or
2. the amount of insurance you are required to provide the additional insured in the written
contract or agreement.
All other terms of the policy remain unchanged.
NAV-EXC-001 (04/10) Page 7 of 7
Navigators Specialty Insurance Company
Contains copyrighted material of the
Insurance Services Office, Inc. with its permission.
“Fungi” means any type or form of fungus, including mold or mildew and any mycotoxins,
spores, scents or byproducts produced or released by fungi. But “fungi” does not include
mushrooms cultivated for human consumption.
“Loss” means bodily injury, property damage, personal and advertising injury or other loss
defined by and to which the “controlling underlying insurance” applies.
“Policy period” means the period of time between the effective date shown in the Declarations
and the earlier of the expiration date shown in the Declarations or the expiration date shown
in an endorsement to this policy.
“Silica” means silicon dioxide, occurring in crystalline, amorphous or impure forms, silica
particles, silica dust or silica compounds.
“Silica related dust” means a mixture or combination of silica and other dust particles.
“Underlying limits” means the amounts shown in the Declarations as the minimum limits of
insurance to be provided by “controlling underlying insurance.”
In Witness Whereof, the issuing Company has caused this policy to be signed officially
below, and countersigned on the Declarations page by a duly authorized representative of
said Company.
dismissal, discharge or termination of employment, whether actual, constructive or
retaliatory;
failure or refusal to hire or promote;
discipline, demotion, coercion or retaliatory treatment;
failure to grant tenure;
negligent employment evaluation;e.
sexual or other workplace harassment, including quid pro quo and hostile work
environment;
f.
employment discrimination;g.
invasion of privacy, violation of employment related civil rights, employment related
libel, slander or defamation;
creating or enforcing or failing to create or enforce employment related policies or
procedures; or
i.
actual or alleged violations of the Family and Medical Leave Act of 1993 or its
amendments.
j.
“Event” means an accident, incident, occurrence, offense, wrongful act or other “loss” causing
“event” defined by and to which the “controlling underlying insurance” applies.
a.
b.
c.
d.
h.
Kevin Barnett
Secretary
Ross Fisher
President
This page has been left blank intentionally.
19 Washington State Prevailing Minimum Hourly Wage Rates\
WASHINGTON STATE PREVAILING WAGE RATES
FOR PUBLIC WORKS CONTRACTS
REFERENCE
The State of Washington Prevailing Wage Rates applicable for this public works contract, which is
located in _King_ County, may be found at the following website address of the Department of Labor
and Industries: https://secure.lni.wa.gov/wagelookup/
Check with the Department of Labor and Industries for any questions regarding Prevailing Wage
Rates, and for a copy of all trade classifications.
Based on the bid submittal deadline for this project, the applicable effective date for prevailing
wages for this project is April 2024.
A copy of the applicable prevailing wages rates is also available for viewing at the office of the
Owner, located at _Renton City Hall, 1055 South Grady Way, Renton, Washington.
Upon request, the Owner will mail a hard copy of the applicable prevailing wage rates for this
project.
The State of Washington “Statement of Intent to Pay Prevailing Wages – Public Works Contract” and
“Affidavit of Wages Paid – Public Works Contract” may be filed online with the Department of Labor
and Industries.
20 Traffic Control\
TRAFFIC CONTROL INFORMATION
20 Traffic Control Information\
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
WTR-27-4186 / SWP-27-4186
TRAFFIC CONTROL
The City of Renton requires any contractor, firm, corporation, or other public/private agency to
prepare a traffic control plan and obtain City’s approval of that plan when construction, repair,
or maintenance work is to be conducted within the City’s right-of-way. The plan shall be
consistent with the provisions found in the State of Washington Manual on Uniform Traffic
Control Devices (MUTCD) for Streets and Highways, Special Provisions Section 1-10.2(2) and the
Contract Documents. Traffic Control Plan shall be submitted to the City for review at or prior to
the Preconstruction Meeting.
Traffic Control Standard Plans, application and requirements can be found on the City’s
website:
https://rentonwa.gov/city_hall/public_works/transportation_systems/operations/traffic/traffic
_control_plans
Typical details for lane closures are attached.
The Contractor shall be responsible for assuring that traffic control is installed and maintained in
conformance to established standards. The Contractor shall continuously evaluate the operation
of the traffic control plan and take prompt action to correct any problems that become evident
during operation.
See Special Provisions Section 1-10 for additional requirements.
Note: The Applicant is responsible for compliance with all codes and regulations, whether or not described in this document.
DEPARTMENT OF PUBLIC WORKS
Page 1 of 3 | Published: 10/27/2021
Transportation Division | 1055 South Grady Way, 5th Floor | Renton, WA 98057 | 425-430-7380
Website: rentonwa.gov
TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN APPLICATION
Published: 10/27/2021
TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN (TCP) MUST BE SUBMITTED TO PUBLIC WORKS TRANSPORTATION DIVISION
FOR REVIEW/APPROVAL AT LEAST FIVE (5) WORKING DAYS BEFORE THE DATE OF WORK.
The City of Renton requires any contractor, firm, corporation, or other public/private agency to prepare a traffic control
plan (TCP) and obtain city's approval of that plan when construction, repair, or maintenance work is to be conducted
within the city's right-of-way.
1. Fill out the Traffic Control Plan (TCP) Application form and prepare required submittal documents.
2. The following items are all required for submittal of the TCP Application :
☐ Electronic Copy of the TCP Application
☐ Electronic Copy of the TCP Layout, on 11” X 17” paper size format, which shall:
Include map(s) showing the location of the project and work area.
Be legible lettering and clear, contrasting, symbols of viewing or printing.
Must indicate street names, and north arrow and scale.
Types of plans required:
o Work hour plan – show all mobility impacts during construction hours.
o Non-work plan - show all mobility impacts after work hours when limited or no work is
happening in the right-of-way (ROW), if applicable.
o Changing construction phases – show construction sequence and each construction phase
change even if the traffic control is not modified, if applicable.
o Pedestrian access/detour plan, if applicable.
- Shall conform to the Washington State Traffic Control Flagger Certification handbook, by the
Evergreen Safety Council.
3. Submit Application via email to TCP@rentonwa.gov with the subject line “TCP Application – [Project Name].”
Project Name: Permit #:
Site Address:
Work Date: From _____________ To _____________ Work Time: Start ______________ End ______________
Construction Company:
Contact Name: Phone/Cell: _________________________
Business Address: City/State: Zip:
Description of Work:
Approval By: _________________________________________________ Date:____________________
Transportation Engineering
Note: The Applicant is responsible for compliance with all codes and regulations, whether or not described in this document.
Page 2 of 3 | Published: 10/27/2021
PERMIT HOLDER AGREES TO ALL THE FOLLOWING:
Must have approved Traffic Control Plan (TCP) prior to commencing the work.
Maintain existing pedestrian access. The work on pedestrian facilities, shall be limited to one corner at a time,
with the least possible inconvenience or delay to pedestrians.
WORK TIME begins when any street or travel lane is fully or partially closed. This includes set up within the
traveled way.
Comply with all traffic regulations of the City of Renton and the State of Washington.
Prepare a traffic control plan and obtain City approval of that plan. That plan shall be implemented for all street
and lane closures, and the plan shall be performed in compliance with the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control
Devices.
Notify emergency services (253-852-2121) twenty-four (24) hours before any street or lane closures.
Contractor or entity must call Renton School District (425-204-4455) or any public/private agency, including public
transit, to be affected by a temporary lane or road closure a minimum of five business days (excluding weekends
and holidays) prior to starting any work.
Contractor or entity must notify King County Metro in writing at construction.coord@kingcounty.gov a minimum
of five business days (excluding weekends and holidays) prior to starting any work impacting bus stops, a
temporary lane or road closure. Work requiring removing a bus shelter or sign requires notification in writing a
minimum of 30 business days (excluding weekends and holidays). Please call King County Metro at 206-477-1140
with any questions.
Any lane or street closures not in conformance with the approved traffic control plan and/or without notification
of emergency services may result in receiving a citation for violation of R.C.W. 47.36.200 Signs or Flaggers at
thoroughfare work sites and R.C.W. 9A.36.050 Reckless Endangerment, and other applicable State and City codes.
Indemnify and hold harmless the City of Renton from any and all claims, actions, and judgments, including all
costs of defense and attorney’s fees incurred in defending against same, arising from and related to
implementation of the approved traffic control plans including claims arising from towing of private vehicles and
the acts of the Permit Holder’s agents and employees.
The City of Renton shall be entitled, in its reasonable discretion, to settle claims prior to suit or judgment, and in
such event shall indemnify and hold harmless the City for any such claims paid, including the City’s reasonable
attorney’s fees and litigation costs incurred resulting from such claim.
In the event any claim or suit is brought against City within the scope of this Agreement, Permit Holder will pay for
legal counsel chosen by the City to defend against same.
Flagger and sign placement are subject to revision by the City Inspector on site, if needed to address traffic or
pedestrian safety or travel.
All permit conditions shall be met.
NOTES:
Total road closure lasting more than twenty-four (24) hours is subject to the approval by the City Council.
Work Zone Traffic Control shall be in accordance with the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (MUTCD)
and shown by a traffic control plan layout or reference to WSDOT.
Approved Temporary Traffic Control Plan must be at the work site during work hours.
Complete assistance and accommodation shall be provided to all kinds of pedestrian traffic when sidewalk or
walkway is impeded to safely redirect pedestrians around a work zone.
Signage shall be used to warn motorcyclists/bicyclists of the potential hazards on any uneven surfaced or slippery
road conditions during work and non-work hours.
Any vehicle, equipment, barricade, or portable tow-away sign used within the work area must display a company
logo or any legally acceptable sign showing the company name, address, and telephone number at a conspicuous
place on the vehicle or equipment.
Note: The Applicant is responsible for compliance with all codes and regulations, whether or not described in this document.
Page 3 of 3 | Published: 10/27/2021
In the case of Temporary No Parking Zones, all the following apply in addition to previous:
Contractor must complete form to show limits of Temporary No Parking Zone identifying barricade locations for
vacate parking or curb lane usage.
Contractor must post notice of dates and time of Temporary No Parking Zone with at least two signs per block
seventy-two (72) hours in advance of effective date and time.
The cover sheet of this Traffic Control Plan form must be attached to each Temporary No Parking Sign on the
project site.
Temporary traffic control devices must be removed immediately when work is done or no construction activities
are going on. If deemed abandoned, City crews will remove and store them at the City’s maintenance shop (3555
NE 2nd Street).
I certify that the information on this application and within the submittal documents are accurate to the best of my
knowledge and I acknowledge all the requirements on this application.
Applicant’s Signature Date
Applicant’s Name (Print)
D
R
A
W
N
B
Y
:
E
L
E
N
A
B
R
U
N
S
T
E
I
N
APPROVED FOR PUBLICATION
DATESTATE DESIGN ENGINEER
Washington State Department of Transportation
SHEET 1 OF 1 SHEETSHEET 1 OF 1 SHEET
SINGLE LANE CLOSURE
WITH ENCROACHMENT
STANDARD PLAN K-24.20-00
SHEET 1 OF 1 SHEET
FOR LOCAL AGENCY USE ONLY
NOT FOR USE ON STATE ROUTES
ST A TEOFWASHI
NGT
O
N
R
EGISTEREDP
R
OFE
S
SIONAL ENGINEER
25335
THEO DORE J. TR
EPA
NI
E
R
EXPIRES AUGUST 9, 2007
SIGN LOCATION
CHANNELIZING DEVICES
PROTECTIVE VEHICLE ~ RECOMMENDED
LEGEND
PCMS
EXISTING EDGE STRIPE
EXISTING LANE STRIPE
TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICE
ARROW PANEL
PORTABLE CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGN
LATERAL BUFFER ~ 4’
EXISTING LANE EXISTING
SHOULDER
2’
ASECTION
WORK AREATEMPORARY LANE ~ 12’ MIN.
EXISTING LANEEXISTING
SHOULDER
ROAD
WORK
AHEAD
END
ROAD WORK
100’
WORK AREA
B L X X
W20-1
P
C
M
S
SEE NOTE 5
RIGHT LANE
CLOSED
AHEAD
W20-5R
X1
ROAD
NARROWS
W5-1
A
G20-2A OR
DOWNSTREAM TAPER TO SHOW
END OF WORK AREA ~ SEE NOTE 6
SEE NOTE 2
W4-2L
~ COMPLIANCE DATE 12/23/13
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
NOTES
6.
7.
8.
MINIMUM WEIGHT 15,000 LBS.
(MAXIMUM WEIGHT SHALL BE
IN ACCORDANCE WITH MANU-
FACTURER RECOMMENDATION)
TYPICAL PROTECTIVE VEHICLE WITH TMA (SEE NOTE 1)
LOADED WEIGHT
ROLL AHEAD STOPPING DISTANCE = 30 FEET MIN.
(DRY PAVEMENT ASSUMED)
45 50 55 60
360 425 495 570
POSTED SPEED (MPH)
LONGITUDINAL BUFFER SPACE = B
LENGTH B (FEET)
1
4 YARD DUMP TRUCK,
SERVICE TRUCK,
FLAT BED, ETC.
BUFFER DATA
VEHICLE TYPE
25 30 35
155 200 250
40
305 25 30 35 40 45 50 55
540
550
600
550
605
660
660
720
POSTED SPEED (MPH)
10
11
12
MINIMUM TAPER LENGTH = L
60 65 70
(FEET)
450
495
500
780 840
LANE WIDTH
(FEET)
125
165
180
205
225
245
270
294
320
105
115
150 ---
--
8040
POSTED SPEED
(MPH)
50 / 70
IN TANGENT
(FEET)
IN TAPER
(FEET)
CHANNELIZING DEVICE SPACING
35 / 45 30 60
8040
POSTED SPEED
(MPH)
50 / 70
IN TANGENT
(FEET)
IN TAPER
(FEET)
CHANNELIZING DEVICE SPACING
25 / 30 20 40
RURAL ROADS & URBAN ARTERIALS
URBAN STREETS
RURAL ROADS, URBAN ARTERIALS,
RESIDENTIAL & BUSINESS DISTRICTS
25 MPH OR LESS
35 / 40 MPH
25 / 30 MPH
45 / 55 MPHRURAL ROADS
60 / 65 MPHRURAL HIGHWAYS
100’ 35/64 (2)
200’ 35/64 (2)
350’ 35/64
500’ 35/64
800’ 35/64
ALL SIGNS ARE BLACK ON ORANGE UNLESS DESIGNATED OTHERWISE
SIGN SPACING = X (1)
(1) ALL SIGN SPACING MAY BE ADJUSTED TO ACCOMMODATE
AT-GRADE INTERSECTIONS, AND DRIVEWAYS.
(2) THIS SIGN SPACING MAY BE REDUCED IN URBAN AREAS TO FIT
ROADWAY CONDITIONS.
A Protective Vehicle is recommended regardless if a Truck
Mounted Attenuator (TMA) is available; a work vehicle may
be used. When no TMA is used, the Protective Vehicle
shall be strategically located to shield workers, with no
specific Roll-Ahead Stopping Distance.
Extend device taper (L/3) across shoulder ~ recommended.
Portable Changeable Message Sign (PCMS)
~ recommended.
Traffic Safety Drums for all tapers on high speed roadway
~ recommended.
Transverse Devices in closed lane every 1000’ 35/64
~ recommended.
Channelizing Device spacing for the downstream taper
option shall be 20’ O.C.
Use advanced notice for any overwidth loads prior to lane
closure for altenative routes if applicable ~ recommended.
For signs size refer to Manual on Uniform Traffic Control
Devices (MUTCD) and WSDOT Sign Fabrication Manual
M55-05.
Ken L. Smith 02-15-07
N
O
T
E
:
T
H
I
S
P
L
A
N
I
S
N
O
T
A
L
E
G
A
L
E
N
G
I
N
E
E
R
I
N
G
D
O
C
U
M
E
N
T
B
U
T
A
N
E
L
E
C
T
R
O
N
I
C
D
U
P
L
I
C
A
T
E
.
T
H
E
O
R
I
G
I
N
A
L
,
S
I
G
N
E
D
B
Y
T
H
E
E
N
G
I
N
E
E
R
A
N
D
A
P
P
R
O
V
E
D
F
O
R
P
U
B
L
I
C
A
T
I
O
N
,
I
S
K
E
P
T
O
N
F
I
L
E
A
T
T
H
E
W
A
S
H
I
N
G
T
O
N
S
T
A
T
E
D
E
P
A
R
T
M
E
N
T
O
F
T
R
A
N
S
-
P
O
R
T
A
T
I
O
N
.
A
C
O
P
Y
M
A
Y
B
E
O
B
T
A
I
N
E
D
U
P
O
N
R
E
Q
U
E
S
T
.
APPROVED FOR PUBLICATION
DATESTATE DESIGN ENGINEER
Washington State Department of Transportation
SHEET 1 OF 1 SHEETSHEET 1 OF 1 SHEET
RURAL ROADS & URBAN ARTERIALS
URBAN STREETS
RURAL ROADS, URBAN ARTERIALS,
RESIDENTIAL & BUSINESS DISTRICTS
25 MPH OR LESS
35 / 40 MPH
25 / 30 MPH
45 / 55 MPHRURAL ROADS
350’ 35/64
500’ 35/64
D
R
A
W
N
B
Y
:
E
L
E
N
A
B
R
U
N
S
T
E
I
N
1.
2.
3.
4.
NOTES
ALL SIGNS ARE BLACK ON ORANGE UNLESS DESIGNATED OTHERWISE
8040
POSTED SPEED
(MPH)
50 / 70
IN TANGENT
(FEET)
IN TAPER
(FEET)
CHANNELIZING DEVICE SPACING
35 / 45 30 60
8040
POSTED SPEED
(MPH)
50 / 70
IN TANGENT
(FEET)
IN TAPER
(FEET)
CHANNELIZING DEVICE SPACING
25 / 30 20 40
END
ROAD WORK
G20-2A
WORK
AREA
ROAD
WORK
AHEAD
W20-1
X
ROAD
WORK
AHEAD
W20-1
X
END
ROAD WORK
G20-2A
W20-1
ROAD
WORK
AHEAD
X
RIGHT LANE
TURN RIGHT
MUST R3-7R
B/W
ROAD
WORK
AHEAD
W20-1
X
END
ROAD WORK
G20-2A
SIGN SPACING = X
100’ 35/64
200’ 35/64
XX
X
X
L
L
/
2
X
R4-7
B/W
SIGN LOCATION
CHANNELIZING DEVICES
LEGEND
25 30
10
11
12
LANE WIDTH
(FEET)
125
165
180
105
115
150
35 40
POSTED SPEED (MPH)
205
225
245
270
294
320
45 50 55
540
550
600
550
605
660
450
495
500
MINIMUM TAPER LENGTH = L (FEET)
OBLITERATED MARKING
R3-2
R/W
R3-2
R/W
R3-2
R/W
ARROW PANEL
SEE N
O
T
E
1
(
T
Y
P
.
)
THRU
TRAFFIC
MERGE
LEFT
W4-7
W4-2L
~ COMPLIANCE DATE 12/23/13
STANDARD PLAN K-32.80-00
INTERSECTION
~ HALF ROAD CLOSURE
WITH LANE SHIFT
SHEET 1 OF 1 SHEET
FOR LOCAL AGENCY USE ONLY
NOT FOR USE ON STATE ROUTES
BARRICADE ~ TYPE 3 L
45
270
POSTED SPEED (MPH)
LONGITUDINAL BUFFER SPACE = B
LENGTH B (FEET)
25 30 35
120
40
1705585
B
W20-5L
LEFT LANE
CLOSED
AHEAD
END
ROAD WORK
G20-2A
5.
6.
7.
ALL SIGN SPACING MAY BE ADJUSTED TO ACCOMMODATE
AT-GRADE INTERSECTIONS AND DRIVEWAYS.
ST A TEOFWASHI
NGT
O
N
R
EGISTEREDP
R
OFE
S
SIONAL ENGINEER
25335
THEO DORE J. TR
EPA
NI
E
R
EXPIRES AUGUST 9, 2007
NO LEFT TURN signs are to be used if traffic volumes are too high or
there is an operating signal. Close the left turn pocket if there is one on
the side street.
When turn prohibitions are implemented, two turn prohibition signs should
be used, one on the near side and, space permitting, one on on the far
side of the intersection.
If the work space extends a crosswalk, the crosswalk should be closed
(see Standard Plan K-34.20).
Flashing Warning Lights (Type A per MUTCD) should be used, as needed,
to mark barricades at night.
Steady Burning Warning Lights (Type C per MUTCD) shall be used to
mark channelizing devices at night.
For long term projects conflicting pavement markings that are no longer
applicable shall be removed or obliterated. Temporary markings
shall be used.
For signs size refer to Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices
(MUTCD) and WSDOT Sign Fabrication Manual M55-05.
N
O
T
E
:
T
H
I
S
P
L
A
N
I
S
N
O
T
A
L
E
G
A
L
E
N
G
I
N
E
E
R
I
N
G
D
O
C
U
M
E
N
T
B
U
T
A
N
E
L
E
C
T
R
O
N
I
C
D
U
P
L
I
C
A
T
E
.
T
H
E
O
R
I
G
I
N
A
L
,
S
I
G
N
E
D
B
Y
T
H
E
E
N
G
I
N
E
E
R
A
N
D
A
P
P
R
O
V
E
D
F
O
R
P
U
B
L
I
C
A
T
I
O
N
,
I
S
K
E
P
T
O
N
F
I
L
E
A
T
T
H
E
W
A
S
H
I
N
G
T
O
N
S
T
A
T
E
D
E
P
A
R
T
M
E
N
T
O
F
T
R
A
N
S
-
P
O
R
T
A
T
I
O
N
.
A
C
O
P
Y
M
A
Y
B
E
O
B
T
A
I
N
E
D
U
P
O
N
R
E
Q
U
E
S
T
.
02-15-07Ken L. Smith
21 City of Renton Special Provisions\
CITY OF RENTON
SPECIAL PROVISIONS
CITY OF RENTON, WASHINGTON
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
ISSUED FOR BID
MARCH 2024
SPECIAL PROVISIONS
CERTIFICATE PAGE
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements
The engineering material and data contained in the Special Provisions were prepared under the
supervision and direction of the undersigned, whose seal as a registered professional engineer is affixed
below.
Rebecca Loveday Ochiltree, P.E.
BHC Consultants, LLC
Madison Taylor McCrosky, P.E.
BHC Consultants, LLC
Zachary Joseph Miles, P.E.
BHC Consultants, LLC
03/08/2024
03/08/2024
03/08/2024
i
SPECIAL PROVISIONS 1
DIVISION 1 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS 2
1-01 DEFINITIONS AND TERMS 2
1-01.1 General 2
1-01.3 Definitions 2
1-02 BID PROCEDURES AND CONDITIONS 6
1-02.1 Prequalification of Bidders 6
1-02.2 Plans and Specifications 6
1-02.4(1) General 6
1-02.4(2) Subsurface Information 7
1-02.5 Proposal Forms 7
1-02.6 Preparation of Proposal 7
1-02.6(1) Certification of Compliance with Wage Payment Statutes 8
1-02.7 Bid Deposit 8
1-02.7(1) Bid Bond, Cashier’s Check, Postal Money Order 9
1-02.9 Delivery of Proposal 9
1-02.10 Withdrawing, Revising, or Supplementing Proposal 10
1-02.12 Public Opening of Proposals 10
1-02.13 Irregular Proposals 10
1-02.14 Disqualification of Bidders 12
1-02.15 Pre Award Information 13
1-03 AWARD AND EXECUTION OF CONTRACT 14
1-03.1 Consideration of Bids 14
1-03.2 Award of Contract 14
1-03.3 Execution of Contract 15
1-03.4 Contract Bond 15
1-03.7 Judicial Review 16
1-04 SCOPE OF WORK 16
1-04.2 Coordination of Contract Documents, Plans, Special Provisions Specifications, and Addenda 16
1-04.2(1) Contractor-Discovered Discrepancies 17
1-04.4 Changes 17
1-04.4(1) Minor Changes 17
1-04.6 Variation in Estimated Quantities 17
ii
1-04.8 Progress Estimates and Payments 18
1-04.11 Final Cleanup 18
1-05 CONTROL OF WORK 18
1-05.4 Conformity With and Deviation from Plans and Stakes 18
1-05.4(3) Contractor Supplied Surveying 19
1-05.4(4) Contractor Provided As-Built Information 20
1-05.7 Removal of Defective and/or Unauthorized Work 20
1-05.10 Guarantees 21
1-05.11 Final Inspection 22
1-05.11(1) Substantial Completion Date 22
1-05.11(2) Final Inspection and Physical Completion Date 23
1-05.11(3) Operational Testing 23
1-05.12 Final Acceptance 24
1-05.13 Superintendents, Labor and Equipment of Contractor 24
1-05.14 Cooperation with Other Contractors 24
1-05.15 Method of Serving Notices 25
1-05.16 Water and Power 25
1-05.17 Oral Agreements 25
1-05.18 Contractor's Daily Diary 25
1-06 CONTROL OF MATERIAL 27
1-06.1 Approval of Materials Prior to Use 27
1-06.1(2) Request for Approval of Materials (RAM) 27
1-06.2(1) Samples and Tests for Acceptance 27
1-06.2(2) Statistical Evaluation of Materials for Acceptance 27
1-06.6 Recycled Materials 28
1-07 LEGAL RELATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITIES TO THE PUBLIC 28
1-07.1 Laws to be Observed 28
1-07.2 State Sales Tax 29
1-07.2(1) State Sales Tax – Rule 171 29
1-07.2(2) State Sales Tax – Rule 170 29
1-07.2(3) Services 30
1-07.5 Environmental Regulations 30
1-07.5(1) General 30
iii
1-07.6 Permits and Licenses 30
1-07.7 Load Limits 31
1-07.9 Wages 31
1-07.11 Requirements for Non-Discrimination 31
1-07.11(11) City of Renton Affidavit of Compliance 31
1-07.13 Contractor’s Responsibility for Work 31
1-07.13(1) General 31
1-07.15 Temporary Water Pollution/Erosion Control 32
1-07.16 Protection and Restoration of Property 34
1-07.16(1) Private/Public Property 34
1-07.17 Utilities and Similar Facilities 35
1-07.17(4) Interruption of Services 37
1-07.17(5) Resolution of Utility Conflicts 37
1-07.18 Insurance 38
1-07.18(1) General Requirements 38
1-07.18(2) Additional Insured 39
1-07.18(3) Subcontractors 39
1-07.18(4) Verification of Coverage 40
1-07.18(5) Coverage and Limits 40
1-07.22 Use of Explosives 42
1-07.23 Public Convenience and Safety 43
1-07.23(1) Construction Under Traffic 43
1-07.23(2) Construction and Maintenance of Detours 44
1-07.24 Rights-of-Way 44
1-07.28 Confined Space Entry 45
1-08 PROSECUTION AND PROGRESS 46
1-08.0 Preliminary Matters 46
1-08.0(1) Preconstruction Conference 46
1-08.0(2) Hours of Work 47
1-08.0(3) Reimbursement for Overtime Work of Contracting Agency Employees 48
1-08.1 Subcontracting 48
1-08.2 Assignment 49
1-08.3 Progress Schedule 49
iv
1-08.4 Notice to Proceed and Prosecution of the Work 50
1-08.5 Time For Completion 51
1-08.6 Suspension of Work 53
1-08.7 Maintenance During Suspension 53
1-08.9 Liquidated Damages 53
1-08.11 Contractor's Plant and Equipment 54
1-08.12 Attention to Work 54
1-09 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 55
1-09.1 Measurement of Quantities 55
1-09.2 Weighing Equipment 56
1-09.2(1) General Requirements for Weighing Equipment 56
1-09.2(5) Measurement 56
1-09.3 Scope of Payment 56
1-09.6 Force Account 57
1-09.7 Mobilization 57
1-09.9 Payments 57
1-09.9(1) Retainage 59
1-09.9(2) Contracting Agency’s Right to Withhold and Disburse Certain Amounts 60
1-09.9(3) Final Payment 61
1-09.11 Disputes and Claims 62
1-09.11(2) Claims 62
1-09.11(3) Time Limitations and Jurisdiction 62
1-09.13 Claims Resolutions 63
1-09.13(4) Venue for Litigation 64
1-09.14 Payment Schedule 64
GENERAL 64
1-09.14(1) Scope 64
1-09.14(2) Bid Items 65
1-10 TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL 97
1-10.1 General 97
1-10.2(2) Traffic Control Plans 99
1-10.3 Traffic Control Labor, Procedures, and Devices 99
1-11 RENTON SURVEYING STANDARDS 100
v
1-11.1(1) Responsibility for Surveys 100
1-11.1(2) Survey Datum and Precision 100
1-11.1(3) Subdivision Information 101
1-11.1(4) Field Notes 101
1-11.1(5) Corners and Monuments 101
1-11.1(6) Control or Base Line Survey 102
1-11.1(7) Precision Levels 102
1-11.1(8) Radial and Station -- Offset Topography 102
1-11.1(9) Radial Topography 103
1-11.1(10) Station--Offset Topography 103
1-11.1(11) As-Built Survey 103
1-11.1(12) Monument Setting and Referencing 103
1-11.2 Materials 104
1-11.2(1) Property/Lot Corners 104
1-11.2(2) Monuments 104
1-11.2(3) Monument Case and Cover 104
DIVISION 2 EARTHWORK 105
2-01 CLEARING, GRUBBING, AND ROADSIDE CLEANUP 105
2-01.1 Description 105
2-01.2 Disposal of Usable Material and Debris 105
2-01.3(1) Clearing 105
2-02 REMOVAL OF STRUCTURES AND OBSTRUCTIONS 105
2-02.3(3) Removal of Pavement, Sidewalks, Curbs, and Gutters 105
2-03 ROADWAY EXCAVATION AND EMBANKMENT 106
2-03.3 Construction Requirements 106
2-04 HAUL 107
2-04.5 Payment 107
2-06 SUBGRADE PREPARATION 107
2-06.5 Measurement and Payment 107
2-09 STRUCTURE EXCAVATION 107
2-09.1 Description 107
2-09.4 Measurement 108
2-09.5 Payment 108
vi
DIVISION 5 SURFACE TREATMENTS AND PAVEMENTS 109
5-04 Hot Mix Asphalt (Non-Statistical, Commercial) 109
5-04.1 Description 109
5-04.2 Materials 109
5-04.2(1) How to Get an HMA Mix Design on the QPL 110
5-04.2(2) Mix Design – Obtaining Project Approval 111
5-04.3 Construction Requirements 112
5-04.3(1) Weather Limitations 112
5-04.3(2) Paving Under Traffic 112
5-04.3(3) Equipment 113
5-04.3(4) Preparation of Existing Paved Surfaces 115
5-04.3(5) Producing/Stockpiling Aggregates and RAP 118
5-04.3(6) Mixing 118
5-04.3(7) Spreading and Finishing 119
5-04.3(8) Aggregate Acceptance Prior to Incorporation in HMA 119
5-04.3(9) HMA Mixture Acceptance 119
5-04.3(10) HMA Compaction Acceptance 123
5-04.3(11) Reject Work 125
5-04.3(12) Joints 127
5-04.3(13) Surface Smoothness 128
5-04.3(14) Planing (Milling) Bituminous Pavement 128
5-04.3(15) Sealing Pavement Surfaces 132
5-04.3(16) HMA Road Approaches 132
5-04.3(17) Construction Joint Sealing 132
5-04.3(18) Incidental Uses for HMA 132
5-04.3(19) Vacant 132
5-04.3(20) Vacant 132
5-04.3(21) Temporary Pavement Marking 132
5-04.4 Measurement 133
5-04.5 Payment 133
5-07 TEMPORARY RESTORATION IN PAVEMENT AREA 134
5-07.1 Description 134
5-07.2 Materials 134
vii
5-07.3 Construction Requirements 134
DIVISION 7 DRAINAGE STRUCTURES, STORM SEWERS, WATER MAINS, AND CONDUITS 135
7-01 DRAINS 135
7-01.2 Materials 135
7-01.3 Construction Requirements 135
7-02 CULVERTS 135
7-02.2 Materials 135
7-04 STORM SEWERS 136
7-04.2 Materials 136
7-04.2(2) Temporary Stormwater Diversion 137
7-04.3(1) Cleaning and Testing 137
7-04.3(2) CCTV Inspection 138
7-04.3(3) Direct Pipe Connections 139
7-05 MANHOLES, INLETS, AND CATCH BASINS 139
7-05.3 Construction Requirements 139
7-05.3(1) Adjusting Manholes and Catch Basins to Grade 139
7-05.3(2) Abandon Existing Manholes 140
7-05.3(3) Connections to Existing Structures 141
7-05.3(5) Manhole Coatings 141
7-08 GENERAL PIPE INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS 142
7-08.3 Construction Requirements 142
7-09 WATER MAINS 145
7-09.3(15) Laying of Pipe on Curves 146
7-09.3(17) Laying Ductile Iron Pipe and Fittings with Polyethylene Encasement 147
7-09.3(21) Concrete Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Block 149
7-09.3(23) Hydrostatic Pressure Test 149
7-09.3(24) Disinfection of Water Mains 152
7-09.3(26) Abandonment of Existing Water Pipe 153
7-12 VALVES FOR WATER MAINS 154
7-12.3(1) Installation of Valve Marker Post 154
7-12.3(2) Adjust Existing Valve Box to Grade 154
7-14 HYDRANTS 154
7-14.3(1) Setting Hydrants 154
viii
7-14.3(3) Resetting Existing Hydrants 155
7-14.3(7) Remove and Salvage Hydrant 155
7-14.3(8) Abandoned Valves 155
7-15 SERVICE CONNECTIONS 156
7-15.3 Construction Requirements 156
7-17 SANITARY SEWERS 157
7-17.2 Materials 157
7-17.3 Construction Requirements 157
7-17.3(1) Protection of Existing Sewerage Facilities 157
7-18 SIDE SEWERS 159
7-18.1 Description 159
7-18.2 Materials 159
7-18.3 Construction Requirements 160
7-18.3(6) Side Sewer Replacement 160
DIVISION 8 MISCELLANEOUS CONSTRUCTION 162
8-01 EROSION CONTROL AND WATER POLLUTION CONTROL 162
8-01.1 Description 162
8-01.3 Construction Requirements 162
8-01.3(1) General 162
8-01.3(8) Street Cleaning 164
8-01.3(16) Removal 164
8-01.3(17) Protection of Existing Trees and Shrubs 165
8-02 ROADSIDE RESTORATION 165
8-02.2 Materials 165
8-02.3(1) Responsibility During Construction 165
8-02.3(10) Lawn Installation 166
8-02.3(17) Protection of Private Property and Property Restoration 167
8-04 CURBS, GUTTERS, AND SPILLWAYS 167
8-04.1 Description 167
8-04.3 Construction Requirements 168
8-04.3(3) Painting of Curbs 168
8-06 CEMENT CONCRETE DRIVEWAY ENTRANCES 168
8-06.1 Description 168
ix
8-06.2 Materials 168
8-06.3 Construction Requirements 169
8-13 MONUMENT CASES 169
8-13.1 Description 169
8-13.3 Construction Requirements 169
8-14 CEMENT CONCRETE SIDEWALKS 170
8-14.2 Materials 170
8-14.3 Construction Requirements 170
8-14.3(4) Curing 171
8-14.3(6) Curb Ramps 171
8-14.3(7) Cold Weather Work 172
8-18 MAILBOX SUPPORT 172
8-18.3 Construction Requirements 172
8-19 ADJUST UTILITY APPURTENANCES 172
8-19.1 Description 172
8-19.3 Construction Requirements 172
8-19.3(1) Valve Boxes 172
8-22 PAVEMENT MARKING 173
8-22.1 Description 173
8-22.2 Materials 173
8-22.3 Construction Requirements 173
8-22.3(6) Removing Pavement Markings 174
8-23 TEMPORARY PAVEMENT MARKINGS 174
8-23.5 Payment 174
DIVISION 9 MATERIALS 175
9-03 AGGREGATES 175
9-03.8(7) HMA Tolerances and Adjustments 175
9-03.12 Gravel Backfill 175
9-03.12(6) Underdrain Aggregate 175
9-05 DRAINAGE STRUCTURES, CULVERTS, AND CONDUITS 176
9-05.2 Underdrain Pipe 176
9-05.2(9) Slotted PVC Underdrain Pipe 176
9-05.4 Steel Culvert Pipe and Pipe Arch (RC) 176
x
9-05.7(2) Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe 176
9-05.7(2) Reinforced Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe (RC) 176
9-05.7(3) Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe Joints (RC) 177
9-05.7(4) Testing Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe Joints (RC) 177
9-05.9 Steel Spiral Rib Storm Sewer Pipe (RC) 177
9-05.12(3) CPEP Sewer Pipe 178
9-05.17 Aluminum Spiral Rib Storm Sewer Pipe 178
9-05.20 Corrugated Polyethylene Storm Sewer Pipe (CPEP) 179
9-05.20(1) Description 179
9-05.20(2) Pipe Material and Fabrication 179
9-05.20(3) Fittings and Gaskets 179
9-05.20(4) Installation 179
9-05.23 High Density Polyethylene Piping 179
9-05.24 Polypropylene Culvert Pipe, Polypropylene Storm Sewer Pipe, and Polypropylene Sanitary
Sewer Pipe 180
9-05.24(1) Polypropylene Culvert Pipe and Storm Sewer Pipe 181
9-05.24(2) Polypropylene Sanitary Sewer Pipe 181
9-05.52 Dense Foam 181
9-08 PAINTS 181
9-08.9 Manhole Coating System Products 181
9-08.9(1) Coating Systems Specification 181
9-14 EROSION CONTROL AND ROADSIDE PLANTING 182
9-14.2 Topsoil 182
9-14.2(1) Topsoil Type A 182
9-14.3 Seed 182
9-23 CONCRETE CURING MATERIALS AND ADMIXTURES 183
9-23.9 Fly Ash (RC) 183
9-30 WATER DISTRIBUTION MATERIALS 183
9-30.1 Pipe 183
9-30.1(1) Ductile Iron Pipe 183
9-30.1(2) Polyethylene Encasement 184
9-30.2 Fittings 184
9-30.2(1) Ductile Iron Pipe 184
xi
9-30.2(2) Galvanized Iron Pipe 185
9-30.2(3) Steel Casing Pipe 185
9-30.2(6) Restrained-Joint Pipe and Restrained-Joint Fittings 186
9-30.2(7) Bolted, Sleeve-Type Couplings for Plain End Pipe 186
9-30.3 Valves 186
9-30.3(1) Gate Valves (3 to 16 inches) 187
9-30.3(3) Butterfly Valves 187
9-30.3(4) Valve Boxes 187
9-30.3(5) Valve Marker Posts 188
9-30.3(6) Valve Stem Extensions 188
9-30.3(7) Combination Air Release/Air Vacuum Valves 188
9-30.3(8) Tapping Sleeve and Valve Assembly 188
9-30.3(9) Blow-Off Assembly 188
9-30.5 Hydrants 189
9-30.5(1) End Connections 189
9-30.5(2) Hydrant Dimensions 189
9-30.5(4) Hydrant Restraints 189
9-30.6 Water Service Connections (2 inches and Smaller) 190
9-30.6(3) Service Pipes 190
9-30.6(4) Service Fittings 190
9-30.6(5) Meter Setters 190
9-30.6(7) Meter Boxes 190
1
SPECIAL PROVISIONS
The work on this project shall be accomplished in accordance with the Standard Specifications for Road,
Bridge and Municipal Construction, 2023 edition, as issued by the Washington State Department of
Transportation (WSDOT) and the American Public Works Association (APWA), Washington State Chapter
(hereafter “Standard Specifications”). The Standard Specifications, as modified or supplemented by the
Amendments to the Standard Specifications and these Special Provisions, all of which are made a part of
the Contract Documents, shall govern all of the Work.
These Special Provisions are made up of both General Special Provisions (GSPs) from various sources,
which may have project-specific fill-ins, and project-specific Special Provisions. Each Provision
supplements, modifies, or replaces the comparable Standard Specification, or is a new Provision. The
deletion, amendment, alteration, or addition to any subsection or portion of the Standard Specifications
is meant to pertain only to that particular portion of the section, and in no way should it be interpreted
that the balance of the section does not apply.
Also incorporated into the Contract Documents by reference are:
• Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (MUTCD) for Streets and Highways, currently adopted
edition, with Washington State modifications, if any
• Standard Plans for Road, Bridge and Municipal Construction, WSDOT/APWA, current edition
• City of Renton Standard Plans, City of Renton Public Works Department, Current Edition
• Public Rights-Of-Way Accessibility Guidelines (PROWAG), current edition
Contractor shall obtain copies of these publications, at Contractor’s own expense.
The symbol (******) indicates a Project-Specific Special Provision (PSP), that is a Special Provision that
normally appears only in this contract. A GSP that has been modified is identified as a PSP.
When the Local Agency GSPs revise only a part of a paragraph(s) in a section of the WSDOT/APWA
Standard Specifications, the entire paragraph is repeated, with new text underlined for clarity, and
deleted text crossed out. When the entire paragraph or section is revised, underlines are not used.
Third-Party Beneficiary: All parties agree that the State of Washington shall be, and is hereby, named as
an express third-party beneficiary of this Contract, with full rights as such.
2
DIVISION 1 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
1-01 DEFINITIONS AND TERMS
1-01.1 General
Section 1-01.1 is supplemented with:
(******)
Whenever reference is made to the State, State of Washington, Commission, Department of
Transportation, Secretary of Transportation, Owner, Contracting Agency or Engineer, such reference
shall be deemed to mean the City of Renton acting through its City Council, employees, and duly
authorized representatives for all contracts administered by the City of Renton.
All references to “State Materials Laboratory” shall be revised to read “Contracting Agency designated
location”.
1-01.3 Definitions
Section 1-01.3 is revised and supplemented by the following:
(******)
Delete the heading Completion Dates and the three paragraphs that follow it, and replace them with the following:
Dates
Bid Opening Date
The date on which the Contracting Agency publicly opens and reads the Bids.
Award Date
The date of the formal decision of the Contracting Agency to accept the lowest responsible and
responsive Bidder for the Work.
Contract Execution Date
The date the Contracting Agency officially binds the Agency to the Contract.
Notice to Proceed Date
The date stated in the Notice to Proceed on which the Contract time begins.
Substantial Completion Date
The day the Engineer determines the Contracting Agency has full and unrestricted use and benefit
of the facilities, both from the operational and safety standpoint, any remaining traffic disruptions
will be rare and brief, and only minor incidental work, replacement of temporary substitute
facilities, plant establishment periods, or correction or repair remains for the Physical Completion
of the total Contract.
Physical Completion Date
The day all of the Work is physically completed on the project. All documentation required by the
Contract and required by law does not necessarily need to be furnished by the Contractor by this
date.
3
Completion Date
The day all the Work specified in the Contract is completed and all the obligations of the
Contractor under the contract are fulfilled by the Contractor. All documentation required by the
Contract and required by law must be furnished by the Contractor before establishment of this
date.
Final Acceptance Date
The date on which the Contracting Agency accepts the Work as complete.
Supplement this Section with the following:
All references in the Standard Specifications or WSDOT General Special Provisions, to the terms
“Department of Transportation”, “Washington State Transportation Commission”, “Commission”,
“Secretary of Transportation”, “Secretary”, “Headquarters”, and “State Treasurer” shall be revised to
read “Contracting Agency”.
All references to the terms “State” or “state” shall be revised to read “Contracting Agency” unless the
reference is to an administrative agency of the State of Washington, a State statute or regulation, or
the context reasonably indicates otherwise.
All references to “State Materials Laboratory” shall be revised to read “Contracting Agency designated
location”.
All references to “final contract voucher certification” shall be interpreted to mean the Contracting
Agency form(s) by which final payment is authorized, and final completion and acceptance granted.
Additive
A supplemental unit of work or group of bid items, identified separately in the Bid Proposal, which
may, at the discretion of the Contracting Agency, be awarded in addition to the base bid.
Alternate
One of two or more units of work or groups of bid items, identified separately in the Bid Proposal,
from which the Contracting Agency may make a choice between different methods or material of
construction for performing the same work.
Business Day
A business day is any day from Monday through Friday except holidays as listed in Section 1-08.5.
Contract Bond
The definition in the Standard Specifications for “Contract Bond” applies to whatever bond form(s)
are required by the Contract Documents, which may be a combination of a Payment Bond and a
Performance Bond.
Contract Documents
See definition for “Contract”.
Contract Time
The period of time established by the terms and conditions of the Contract within which the Work
must be physically completed.
4
Notice of Award
The written notice from the Contracting Agency to the successful Bidder signifying the Contracting
Agency’s acceptance of the Bid Proposal.
Notice to Proceed
The written notice from the Contracting Agency or Engineer to the Contractor authorizing and
directing the Contractor to proceed with the Work and establishing the date on which the Contract
time begins.
Traffic
Both vehicular and non-vehicular traffic, such as pedestrians, bicyclists, wheelchairs, and equestrian
traffic.
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
Act of God
"Act of God" means an earthquake, flood, cyclone, or other cataclysmic phenomenon of nature. A
rain, windstorm, high water or other natural phenomenon of unusual intensity for the specific locality
of the Work, which might reasonably have been anticipated from historical records of the general
locality of the Work, shall not be construed as an act of God.
Biologist
Shall consist of a biologist representing the Contracting Agency.
Consulting Engineer
The Contracting Agency's design consultant, who may or may not administer the construction
program for the Contracting Agency.
Contract Price
Either the unit price, the unit prices, or lump sum price or prices named in the proposal, or in properly
executed change orders.
Day
Unless otherwise designated, day(s) as used in the Contract Documents, shall be understood to mean
working days.
Engineer
The City Engineer or duly authorized representative, or an authorized member of a licensed consulting
firm retained by the Owner for the construction engineering of a specific public works project.
Inspector
The Owner’s authorized representative assigned to make necessary observations of the Work
performed or being performed, or of materials furnished or being furnished by the Contractor.
Landscape Architect
Shall be the Landscape Architect of record for the Contract Documents.
5
Or Equal
Where the term "or equal" is used herein, the Contracting Agency, or the Contracting Agency on
recommendation of the Engineer, shall be the sole judge of the quality and suitability of the proposed
substitution. The responsibility and cost of furnishing necessary evidence, demonstrations, or other
information required to obtain the approval of alternative materials or processes by the Owner shall
be entirely borne by the Contractor.
Owner
The City of Renton or its authorized representative also referred to as Contracting Agency.
Performance and Payment Bond
Same as “Contract Bond” defined in the Standard Specifications.
Plans
The Contract Plans and/or Standard Plans which show location, character, and dimensions of
prescribed Work including layouts, profiles, cross-sections, and other details. Drawings may either be
bound in the same book as the balance of the Contract Documents or bound in separate sets, and are
a part of the Contract Documents, regardless of the method of binding. The terms "Standard
Drawings" or "Standard Details" generally used in Specifications refers to drawings bound either with
the specification documents or included with the Plans or the City of Renton Standard Plans.
Points
Wherever reference is made to the Engineer’s points, this shall mean all marks, bench marks,
reference points, stakes, hubs, tack, etc., established by the Engineer for maintaining horizontal and
vertical control of the Work.
Provide
Means “furnish and install” as specified and shown in the Plans.
Secretary, Secretary of Transportation
The chief executive officer of the Department and other authorized representatives. The chief
executive officer to the Department shall also refer to the Department of Public Works Administrator.
Shop Drawings
Same as “Working Drawings” defined in the Standard Specifications.
Special Provisions
Modifications to the Standard Specifications and their amendments that apply to an individual
project. The special provisions may describe Work the Specifications do not cover. Such Work shall
comply first with the Special Provisions and then with any Specifications that apply. The Contractor
shall include all costs of doing this Work within the bid prices.
State
The state of Washington acting through its representatives. The State shall also refer to The City of
Renton and its authorized representatives where applicable.
6
Supplemental Drawings and Instructions
Additional instructions by the Engineer at request of the Contractor by means of drawings or
documents necessary, in the opinion of the Engineer, for the proper execution of the Work. Such
drawings and instructions are consistent with the Contract Documents.
Utility
Public or private fixed improvement for the transportation of fluids, gases, power, signals, or
communications and shall be understood to include tracks, overhead and underground wires, cables,
pipelines, conduits, ducts, sewers, or storm drains.
1-02 BID PROCEDURES AND CONDITIONS
1-02.1 Prequalification of Bidders
Delete this Section and replace it with the following:
(******)
Bidders shall be qualified by experience, financing, equipment, and organization to do the Work called
for in the Contract Documents. The Contracting Agency reserves the right to take whatever action it
deems necessary to ascertain the ability of the bidder to perform the Work satisfactorily.
1-02.2 Plans and Specifications
Delete this Section and replace it with the following:
(******)
Information as to where Bid Documents can be obtained or reviewed will be found in the Call for Bids
(Advertisement for Bids) for the Work.
After award of the Contract, Plans and Specifications will be issued to the Contractor at no cost as
detailed below:
To Prime Contractor No. of Sets Basis of Distribution
Reduced Plans (11” x 17”) 4 Furnished automatically upon award
Contract Provisions (Contract
documents, special provisions, etc)
4 Furnished automatically upon award
Large Plans (22” x 34”) 4 Furnished only upon request
CAD Drawings N/A Furnished only upon request
1-02.4(1) General
The first sentence of the ninth paragraph, beginning with “Prospective Bidder desiring…”, is revised to
read:
(******)
Prospective Bidders desiring an explanation or interpretation of the Bid Documents, shall request the
explanation or interpretation in writing by close of business 5 business days preceding the bid opening
to allow a written reply to reach all prospective Bidders before the submission of their Bids.
7
1-02.4(2) Subsurface Information
Section 1-02.4(2) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
If a geotechnical study was prepared for the project, then the findings and recommendations are
summarized in a report which is made available for the bidders’ convenience but is not a part of the
contract. Information contained in the geotechnical report is for informational purposes only.
1-02.5 Proposal Forms
Delete this Section and replace it with the following:
(******)
At the request of the bidder, the Contracting Agency will provide a proposal form for any project on
which the bidder is eligible to bid.
The proposal form will identify the project and its location and describe the Work. It will also list
estimated quantities, units of measurement, the items of Work, and the materials to be furnished at
the unit bid prices. The bidder shall complete spaces on the proposal form that call for, but are not
limited to, unit bid prices; extensions; summations; the total bid amount; signatures; date; and, where
applicable, retail sales taxes and acknowledgement of addenda; the bidder’s name, address,
telephone number, and signature; a State of Washington Contractor’s Registration Number; Unified
Business Identifier (UBI); Industrial Insurance Account Number; Employment Security Department
Number and State Excise Tax Registration Number. Bids shall be completed by typing or shall be
printed in ink by hand, preferably in black ink. The required certifications are included as part of the
proposal form.
The Contracting Agency reserves the right to arrange the proposal forms with alternates and
additives, if such be to the advantage of the Contracting Agency. The bidder shall bid on all alternates
and additives set forth in the proposal forms unless otherwise specified.
Any correction to a bid made by interlineations, alteration, or erasure, shall be initialed by the signer
of the bid. The bidder shall make no stipulation on the Bid Form, nor qualify the bid in any manner.
1-02.6 Preparation of Proposal
Supplement the second paragraph with the following:
(******)
4. If a minimum bid amount has been established for any item, the unit or lump sum price must
equal or exceed the minimum amount stated.
5. Any correction to a bid made by interlineation, alteration, or erasure, shall be initialed by the
signer of the bid.
Delete the last two paragraphs, and replace them with the following:
The Bidder shall submit with their Bid a completed Contractor Certification Wage Law Compliance
form, provided by the Contracting Agency. Failure to return this certification as part of the Bid
Proposal package will make this Bid Nonresponsive and ineligible for Award. A Contractor Certification
of Wage Law Compliance form is included in the Proposal Forms.
8
The Bidder shall make no stipulation on the Bid Form, nor qualify the bid in any manner.
A bid by a corporation shall be executed in the corporate name, by the president or a vice president
(or other corporate officer accompanied by evidence of authority to sign).
A bid by a partnership shall be executed in the partnership name, and signed by a partner. A copy of
the partnership agreement shall be submitted with the Bid Form if any Under-Utilized Disadvantaged
Business Enterprise (UDBE) requirements are to be satisfied through such an agreement.
A bid by a joint venture shall be executed in the joint venture name and signed by a member of the
joint venture. A copy of the joint venture agreement shall be submitted with the Bid Form if any UDBE
requirements are to be satisfied through such an agreement.
Section 1-02.6 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Evidence of the signatory’s authority to sign the Bid Proposal on behalf of the business entity shall
be submitted with the Bid Proposal. Otherwise, the submitted Bid Proposal will be considered
irregular and non-responsive and may be rejected.
1-02.6(1) Certification of Compliance with Wage Payment Statutes
Section 1-02.6(1) is an added new section:
(******)
The Bidder shall submit with the Bid a completed and signed “Contractor Certification, Wage Law
Compliance – Responsibility Criteria, Washington State Public Works Contracts” document where the
Bidder under penalty of perjury verifies that the Bidder is in compliance with responsible bidder
criteria in RCW 39.04.350 subsection (1)(g), as required per Section 1-02.14. Otherwise, the submitted
Bid Proposal will be considered irregular and non-responsive and will be rejected.
The Bidder may use the form provided in the Bid Documents. The form is also available at
http://wsdot.wa.gov/forms/pdfForms.html. The Bidder may download, print, complete and sign the
form to include with Bid. The DOT Form, DOT Form Number and revision date must match the form
included in the Bid Documents, otherwise the Bid will be regarded as irregular and non-responsive
and the Bid will be rejected.
1-02.7 Bid Deposit
Section 1-02.7 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Bid bonds shall contain the following:
1. Contracting Agency-assigned number for the project;
2. Name of the project;
3. The Contracting Agency named as obligee;
4. The amount of the bid bond stated either as a dollar figure or as a percentage which
represents five percent (5%) of the maximum bid amount that could be awarded;
9
5. Signature of the bidder’s officer empowered to sign official statements. The signature of the
person authorized to submit the bid should agree with the signature on the bond, and the
title of the person must accompany the said signature;
6. The signature of the surety’s officer empowered to sign the bond and the power of attorney.
If so stated in the Contract Provisions, bidder must use the bond form included in the Contract
Provisions.
If so stated in the Contract Provisions, cash will not be accepted for a bid deposit.
1-02.7(1) Bid Bond, Cashier’s Check, Postal Money Order
Section 1-02.7(1) is an added new section:
(******)
As evidence of good faith, pursuant to RCW 35.23.352(1), an original Bid Proposal Deposit in the form
of either a bid bond, cashier’s check or postal money order in an amount equal to five percent (5%)
of the Total Bid Amount shall be submitted with the Bid Proposal.
If the Bidder elects to provide a bid bond, the Proposal Bid Bond form included in the Bid Documents
shall be used. Otherwise, the Bid Proposal will be considered irregular and non-responsive and the
Bid Proposal will be rejected.
If the Bidder elects to provide a cashier’s check, it shall be made payable to the City of Renton.
If the Bidder elects to provide a postal money order, it shall be made payable to the City of Renton.
Cash will not be accepted for a bid deposit.
1-02.9 Delivery of Proposal
Revise the first and second paragraph to read:
(******)
Each Proposal shall be submitted in a sealed envelope, with the Project Name and Project Number as
stated in the Call for Bids clearly marked on the outside of the envelope, or as otherwise required in
the Bid Documents, to ensure proper handling and delivery.
Proposals that are received as required will be publicly opened and read as specified in Section
1-02.12. The Contracting Agency will not open or consider any Bid Proposal that is received after the
time specified in the Call for Bids for receipt of Bid Proposals, or received in a location other than that
specified in the Call for Bids. The Contracting Agency will not open or consider any “Supplemental
Information” (Disadvantaged Business Enterprise (DBE) confirmations, or Good Faith Efforts (GFE)
documentation) that is received after the time specified above, or received in a location other than
that specified in the Call for Bids.
If an emergency or unanticipated event interrupts normal work processes of the Contracting Agency
so that Proposals cannot be received at the office designated for receipt of bids as specified in Section
1-02.12 the time specified for receipt of the Proposal will be deemed to be extended to the same time
of day specified in the solicitation on the first work day on which the normal work processes of the
Contracting Agency resume.
10
1-02.10 Withdrawing, Revising, or Supplementing Proposal
Delete this Section, and replace it with the following:
(******)
After submitting a physical Bid Proposal to the Contracting Agency, the Bidder may withdraw, revise,
or supplement it if:
1. The Bidder submits a written request signed by an authorized person and physically delivers
it to the place designated for receipt of Bid Proposals, and
2. The Contracting Agency receives the request before the time set for receipt of Bid Proposals,
and
3. The revised or supplemented Bid Proposal (if any) is received by the Contracting Agency
before the time set for receipt of Bid Proposals.
If the Bidder’s request to withdraw, revise, or supplement its Bid Proposal is received before the time
set for receipt of Bid Proposals, the Contracting Agency will return the unopened Proposal package to
the Bidder. The Bidder must then submit the revised or supplemented package in its entirety. If the
Bidder does not submit a revised or supplemented package, then its bid shall be considered
withdrawn.
Late revised or supplemented Bid Proposals or late withdrawal requests will be date recorded by the
Contracting Agency and returned unopened. Mailed, emailed, or faxed requests to withdraw, revise,
or supplement a Bid Proposal are not acceptable.
1-02.12 Public Opening of Proposals
Section 1-02.12 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contracting Agency reserves the right to postpone the date and/or time that sealed bids are due
and the bid opening. Notification to bidders of any change will be by addenda.
1-02.13 Irregular Proposals
Delete this Section and replace it with the following:
(******)
1. A Proposal will be considered irregular and will be rejected if:
a. The Bidder is not prequalified when so required;
b. The authorized Proposal form furnished by the Contracting Agency is not used or is altered;
c. The completed Proposal form contains any unauthorized additions, deletions, alternate Bids,
or conditions;
d. The Bidder adds provisions reserving the right to reject or accept the award, or enter into the
Contract;
e. A unit price (price per unit) cannot be determined from the Bid Proposal;
f. The Proposal form is not properly executed;
11
g. The Bidder fails to submit with their proposal, an original Bid Proposal Deposit in an amount
equal to five percent (5%) of the Total Bid Amount, as required in Section 1 02.7;
h. The Bidder elects to provide a Proposal Bid Bond for the Bid Proposal Deposit and does not
submit or properly execute the Proposal Bid Bond form included in the Bid Documents, as
required in Section 1-02.7;
i. The Bidder fails to submit or properly complete a subcontractor list (WSDOT Form 271-015),
if applicable, as required in Section 1-02.6;
j. The Bidder fails to submit or properly complete a Disadvantaged Business Enterprise
Certification (WSDOT Form 272-056), if applicable, as required in Section 1-02.6;
k. The Bidder fails to submit Written Confirmations (WSDOT Form 422-031) from each DBE firm
listed on the Bidder’s completed DBE Utilization Certification that they are in agreement with
the bidder’s DBE participation commitment, if applicable, as required in Section 1-02.6, or if
the written confirmation that is submitted fails to meet the requirements of the Special
Provisions;
l. The Bidder fails to submit DBE Good Faith Effort documentation, if applicable, as required in
Section 1-02.6, or if the documentation that is submitted fails to demonstrate that a Good
Faith Effort to meet the Condition of Award was made;
m. The Bidder fails to submit a DBE Bid Item Breakdown (WSDOT Form 272-054), if applicable,
as required in Section 1-02.6, or if the documentation that is submitted fails to meet the
requirements of the Special Provisions;
n. The Bidder fails to submit DBE Trucking Credit Forms (WSDOT Form 272-058), if applicable, as
required in Section 1-02.6, or if the documentation that is submitted fails to meet the
requirements of the Special Provisions;
o. The Bidder fails to submit or properly execute the Contractor Certification, Wage Law
Compliance – Responsibility Criteria, Washington State Public Works Contractors document,
as required in Section 1-02.6(1).
p. The Bid Proposal does not constitute a definite and unqualified offer to meet the material
terms of the Bid invitation; or
q. More than one Proposal is submitted for the same project from a Bidder under the same or
different names.
2. A Proposal may be considered irregular and may be rejected if:
a. The Proposal does not include a unit price for every Bid item;
b. Any of the unit prices are excessively unbalanced (either above or below the amount of a
reasonable Bid) to the potential detriment of the Contracting Agency;
c. Receipt of Addenda is not acknowledged;
d. A member of a joint venture or partnership and the joint venture or partnership submit
Proposals for the same project (in such an instance, both Bids may be rejected); or
e. If Proposal form entries are not made in ink.
12
3. A Proposal will be considered irregular and may be rejected if:
a. The Bidder fails to submit with their Bid Proposal, evidence of signatory’s authority to sign the
Bid Proposal on behalf of the business entity, as required in Section 1-02.6.
1-02.14 Disqualification of Bidders
Delete this Section and replace it with the following:
(******)
A Bidder will be deemed not responsible if the Bidder does not meet the mandatory bidder
responsibility criteria in RCW 39.04.350(1), as amended.
A bidder may be deemed not responsible and the proposal rejected if:
a. More than one Proposal is submitted for the same project from a Bidder under the same or
different names;
b. Evidence of collusion exists with any other Bidder or potential Bidder. Participants in collusion
will be restricted from submitting further Bids;
c. The Bidder, in the opinion of the Contracting Agency, is not qualified for the Work or to the
full extent of the bid, or to the extent that the bid exceeds the authorized prequalification
amount as may have been determined by a prequalification of the Bidder;
d. An unsatisfactory performance record exists based on past or current Contracting Agency
Work or for Work done for others, as judged from the standpoint of conduct of the Work;
workmanship; progress; affirmative action; equal employment opportunity practices; or
Disadvantaged Enterprise, Minority Enterprise, or Women’s Business Enterprise utilization.
e. There is uncompleted Work (Contracting Agency or otherwise) which might hinder or prevent
the prompt completion of the Work bid upon;
f. The Bidder failed to settle bills for labor or materials on past or current Contracts;
g. The Bidder has failed to complete a written public contract or has been convicted of a crime
arising from a previous public contract;
h. The Bidder is unable, financially or otherwise, to perform the Work;
i. A Bidder is not authorized to do business in the State of Washington (not registered in
accordance with RCW 18.27).
j. The Bidder owes delinquent taxes to the Washington State Department of Revenue without
a payment plan approved by the Department of Revenue;
k. The Bidder is currently debarred or suspended by the Federal government;
l. There are any other reasons deemed proper by the Contracting Agency.
The Contracting Agency will verify that the Bidder meets the mandatory bidder responsibility criteria
in RCW 39.04.350(1). To assess bidder responsibility, the Contracting Agency reserves the right to
request further documentation as needed from the low bidder and documentation from other
Bidders as well to assess Bidder responsibility and compliance with all bidder responsibility criteria.
The Contracting Agency also reserves the right to obtain information from third-parties and
independent sources of information concerning a Bidder’s compliance with the mandatory and
supplemental criteria, and to use that information in their evaluation. The Contracting Agency may
13
consider mitigating factors in determining whether the Bidder complies with the requirements of the
Supplemental Criteria.
The basis for evaluation shall include any documents or facts obtained by Contracting Agency
(whether from the Bidder or third parties) including but not limited to: (i) financial, historical, or
operational data from the Bidder; (ii) information obtained directly by the Contracting Agency from
others for whom the Bidder has worked, or other public agencies or private enterprises; and (iii) any
additional information obtained by the Contracting Agency which is believed to be relevant to the
matter.
If the Contracting Agency determines the Bidder does not meet the bidder responsibility criteria
above and is therefore not a responsible Bidder, the Contracting Agency shall notify the Bidder in
writing, with the reasons for its determination. If the Bidder disagrees with this determination, it may
appeal the determination within two (2) business days of the Contracting Agency’s determination by
presenting its appeal and any additional information to the Contracting Agency. The Contracting
Agency will consider the appeal and any additional information before issuing its final determination.
If the final determination affirms that the Bidder is not responsible, the Contracting Agency will not
execute a contract with any other Bidder until at least two business days after the Bidder determined
to be not responsible has received the Contracting Agency’s final determination.
1-02.15 Pre Award Information
Revise this section to read:
(******)
Before awarding any contract, the Contracting Agency may require one or more of these items or
actions of the bidder:
A complete statement of the origin, composition, and manufacture of any or all materials to
be used;
Samples of these materials for quality and fitness tests;
A progress schedule (in a form the Contracting Agency requires) showing the order of and
time required for the various phases of the work;
A breakdown of costs assigned to any bid item;
Attendance at a conference with the Engineer or representatives of the Engineer;
Obtain, and furnish a copy of, a business license to do business in the city or county where
the Work is located;
A copy of State of Washington Contractor’s Registration; or
Any other information or action taken that is deemed necessary to ensure that the bidder is
the lowest responsible bidder.
14
1-03 AWARD AND EXECUTION OF CONTRACT
1-03.1 Consideration of Bids
Section 1-03.1 is revised and supplemented as follows:
Revise the first paragraph to read:
(******)
After opening and reading proposals, the Contracting Agency will check them for correctness of
extensions of the prices per unit and the total price. If a discrepancy exists between the price per unit
and the extended amount of any bid item, the price per unit will control. If a minimum bid amount
has been established for any item and the bidder’s unit or lump sum price is less than the minimum
specified amount, the Contracting Agency will unilaterally revise the unit or lump sum price, to the
minimum specified amount and recalculate the extension. The total of extensions, corrected where
necessary, including sales taxes where applicable and such additives and/or alternates as selected by
the Contracting Agency, will be used by the Contracting Agency for award purposes and to fix the
Awarded Contract Price amount and the amount of the contract bond.
Revise the first sentence of the third paragraph to read:
(******)
A Bidder who wishes to claim error after the Bids have been publicly opened and read as required by
Section 1-02.12, shall promptly notify the Contracting Agency that an error has occurred.
Revise the last sentence of the fourth paragraph to read:
(******)
If the Contracting Agency does not concur in the error or determines that the error is not the kind for
which the law allows relieve, the Contracting Agency may Award the Contract and if the Bidder refuses
to execute the Contract, the Bidder’s Bid deposit shall be forfeited as required by RCW 35.23.352. Per
RCW 39.04.107, a low bidder on a public works project who claims error and fails to enter into a
contract is prohibited from bidding on the same project if a second or subsequent call for bids is made
for the project.
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
All bids will be based on total sum of all schedules of prices. No partial bids will be accepted unless so
stated in the call for bids or special provisions. The City reserves the right to award all or any schedule
of a bid to the lowest bidder at its discretion.
1-03.2 Award of Contract
Section 1-03.2 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contract, bond form, and all other forms requiring execution, together with a list of all other
forms or documents required to be submitted by the successful bidder, will be forwarded to the
successful bidder within 10 days of the award. The number of copies to be executed by the Contractor
shall be determined by the Contracting Agency.
15
1-03.3 Execution of Contract
Section 1-03.3 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
Within 10 calendar days after receipt from the City of the forms and documents required to be
completed by the Contractor, the successful bidder shall return the signed Contracting Agency-
prepared contract, an insurance certification as required by Section 1-07.18, and a satisfactory bond
as required by law and Section 1-03.4. Before execution of the Contract by the Contracting Agency,
the successful bidder shall provide any pre-award information the Contracting Agency may require
under Section 1-02.15.
Until the Contracting Agency executes a contract, no proposal shall bind the Contracting Agency nor
shall any Work begin within the project limits or within Contracting Agency-furnished sites. The
Contractor shall bear all risks for any Work begun outside such areas and for any materials ordered
before the Contract is executed by the Contracting Agency.
If the bidder experiences circumstances beyond their control that prevents return of the Contract
documents within 10 calendar days after the award date, the Contracting Agency may grant up to a
maximum of 10 additional calendar days for return of the documents, provided the Contracting
Agency deems the circumstances warrant it.
The Contracting Agency is prohibited by RCW 39.06.010 from executing a contract with a Contractor
who is not registered or licensed as required by the laws of the state. In addition, the Contracting
Agency requires persons doing business with the Contracting Agency to possess a valid City of Renton
business license prior to award.
When the Bid Form provides spaces for a business license number, a Washington State Contractors
registration number, or both the Bidder shall insert such information in the spaces provided. The
Contracting Agency requires legible copies of the Contractor's Registration and business license be
submitted to the Engineer as part of the Contracting Agency's post-award information and evaluation
activities.
It is anticipated that this project will be funded in part by the Washington State Department of
Ecology. Neither the State of Washington nor any of its departments or employees are, or shall be, a
party to this contract or any subcontract.
1-03.4 Contract Bond
Revise the first paragraph to read:
(******)
The successful bidder shall provide an executed contract bond for the full contract amount. This
contract bond shall:
1. Be on the Contracting Agency-furnished form;
2. Be signed by an approved surety (or sureties) that:
a. Is registered with the Washington State Insurance Commissioner, and
b. Appears on the current Authorized Insurance List in the State of Washington published
by the Office of the Insurance Commissioner;
16
3. Be conditioned upon the faithful performance of the Contract by the Contractor within the
prescribed time;
4. Guarantee that the surety shall indemnify, defend, and protect the Contracting Agency
against any claim of direct or indirect loss resulting from the failure:
a. Of the Contractor (or any of the employees, subcontractors, or lower tier subcontractors
of the Contractor) to faithfully perform the Contract, or
b. Of the Contractor (subcontractors, or lower tier subcontractors of the Contractor) to pay
all laborers, mechanics, subcontractors, lower tie subcontractors, material person, or any
other person who provides supplies or provisions for carrying out Work;
5. Be accompanied by a power of attorney for the Surety’s officer empowered to sign the bond;
and
6. Be signed by an officer of the Contractor empowered to sign official statements (sole
proprietor or partner). If the Contractor is a corporation, the bond must be signed by the
president or vice-president, unless accompanied by a written proof of the authority of the
individual signing the bond to bind the corporation (i.e., corporate resolution, power of
attorney or a letter to such effect by the president or vice-president).
1-03.7 Judicial Review
Revise this section to read:
(******)
All decisions made by the Contracting Agency regarding the Award and execution of the Contract or
Bid rejection shall be conclusive subject to the scope of judicial review permitted under Washington
Law. Such review, if any, shall be timely filed in the Superior Court of the county where the Contracting
Agency headquarters is located, provided that where an action is asserted against a county, RCW
36.01.050 shall control venue and jurisdiction.
1-04 SCOPE OF WORK
1-04.2 Coordination of Contract Documents, Plans, Special Provisions Specifications, and Addenda
Revise the second paragraph to read:
(******)
Any inconsistency in the parts of the contract shall be resolved by following this order of precedence
(e.g., 1 presiding over 2, 2 over 3, 3 over 4, and so forth):
1. Addenda,
2. Proposal Form,
3. Special Provisions,
4. Contract Plans,
5. Standard Specifications,
6. Contracting Agency’s Standard Plans (if any), and
7. WSDOT/APWA Standard Plans for Road, Bridge and Municipal Construction.
17
1-04.2(1) Contractor-Discovered Discrepancies
Section 1-04.2(1) is a new section:
(******)
Upon receipt of award of contract, the Contractor shall carefully study and compare all the
components of the Contract Documents and other instructions, and check and verify all field
measurements. The Contractor shall, prior to ordering material or performing Work, report in writing
to the Engineer any error, inconsistency, or omission in respect to design or mode of construction,
which is discovered. If the Contractor, in the course of this study or in the accomplishment of the
Work, finds any discrepancy between the Plans and the physical condition of the locality as
represented in the Plans, or any such errors or omissions in respect to design or mode of construction
in the Plans or in the layout as given by points and instructions, it shall be the Contractor’s duty to
inform the Engineer immediately in writing, and the Engineer will promptly check the same. Any Work
done after such discovery, until correction of Plans or authorization of extra Work is given, if the
Engineer finds that extra Work is involved, will be done at the Contractor's risk. If extra Work is
involved, the procedure shall be as provided in Section 1-04.4 of the Standard Specifications.
1-04.4 Changes
The first two sentences of the last paragraph of Section 1-04.4 are deleted.
1-04.4(1) Minor Changes
Section 1-04.4(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Payments and credits will be determined in accordance with Section 1-09.4 of the Standard
Specifications. For the purpose of providing a common proposal for all bidders, the Contracting
Agency may have entered an amount for “Minor Change” in the Proposal to become a part of the
total bid by the Contractor.
1-04.6 Variation in Estimated Quantities
Section 1-04.6 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The quantities for the following items have been entered into the Proposal only to provide a common
proposal for bidders. Actual quantities will be determined in the field as the work progresses, and will
be paid at the original bid price, regardless of final quantity. These bid items shall not be subject to
the provisions of 1-04.6 of the Standard Specifications:
• “Controlled Density Fill”
• “Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation Material”
• “Side Sewer Replacement”
18
1-04.8 Progress Estimates and Payments
Section 1-04.8 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor is encouraged to provide to the Engineer prior to progress payments an estimate of
lump sum work accomplished to date. The Engineer's calculations and decisions shall be final in regard
to the actual percentage of any lump sum pay item accomplished and eligible for payment unless
another specific method of calculating lump sum payments is provided elsewhere in the
Specifications.
1-04.11 Final Cleanup
Revise this section to read:
(******)
The Contractor shall perform final cleanup as provided in this section to the Engineer’s satisfaction.
The Engineer will not establish the Physical Completion Date until this is done. The Right of Way,
material sites, and all ground the Contractor occupied to do the Work shall be left neat and
presentable. The Contractor shall:
Remove all rubbish, surplus materials, discarded materials, falsework, camp buildings,
temporary structures, equipment, and debris; and
Remove from the project, all unneeded, oversized rock left from grading, surfacing, or paving,
unless otherwise directed or approved by the City.
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
All salvage material as noted on the Plans and taken from any of the discarded facilities shall, at the
Engineer's discretion, be carefully salvaged and delivered to the City shops. Any cost incurred in
salvaging and delivering such items shall be considered incidental to the project and no compensation
will be made.
The Contract price for "Finish and Cleanup, Lump Sum," shall be full compensation for all Work,
equipment and materials required to perform final cleanup. If this pay item does not appear in the
Contract Documents then final cleanup shall be considered incidental to the Contract and to other
pay item and no further compensation shall be made.
1-05 CONTROL OF WORK
1-05.4 Conformity With and Deviation from Plans and Stakes
Section 1-05.4 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
If the project calls for the Contractor supplied surveying, the Contractor shall provide all required
survey Work, including such Work as mentioned in Sections 1-05, 1-11 and elsewhere in these
Specifications as being provided by the Engineer. All costs for this survey Work shall be included in
"Construction Surveying, Staking, and As-Built Drawings," per lump sum.
The Engineer or the Contractor supplied surveyor will provide construction stakes and marks
establishing lines, slopes, and grades as stipulated in Sections 1-05.4 and will perform such Work per
19
Section 1-11. The Contractor shall assume full responsibility for detailed dimensions, elevations, and
excavation slopes measured from the Engineer or the Contractor supplied surveyor furnished stakes
and marks.
The Contractor shall provide a work site, which has been prepared to permit construction staking to
proceed in a safe and orderly manner. The Contractor shall keep the Engineer or the Contractor
supplied surveyor informed of staking requirements and provide at least 48 hour notice to allow the
Engineer or the Contractor supplied surveyor adequate time for setting stakes.
The Contractor shall carefully preserve stakes, marks, and other reference points, including existing
monumentation, set by Contracting Agency forces. The Contractor will be charged for the costs of
replacing stakes, markers and monumentation that were not to be disturbed but were destroyed or
damaged by the Contractor's operations. This charge will be deducted from monies due or to become
due to the Contractor.
Any claim by the Contractor for extra compensation by reason of alterations or reconstruction Work
allegedly due to error in the Engineer's line and grade, will not be allowed unless the original control
points set by the Engineer still exist, or unless other satisfactory substantiating evidence to prove the
error was furnished by the Engineer. Three consecutive points set on line or grade shall be the
minimum points used to determine any variation from a straight line or grade. Any such variation
shall, upon discovery, be reported to the Engineer. In the absence of such report the Contractor shall
be liable for any error in alignment or grade.
The Contractor shall provide all surveys required other than those to be performed by the Engineer.
All survey Work shall be done in accordance with Section 1-11 SURVEYING STANDARDS of these
Specifications.
The Contractor shall keep updated survey field notes in a standard field book and in a format set by
the Engineer, per Section 1-11.1(4). These field notes shall include all survey Work performed by the
Contractor's surveyor in establishing line, grade and slopes for the construction Work. Copies of these
field notes shall be provided the Engineer upon request and upon completion of the Contract Work
the field book or books shall be submitted to the Engineer and become the property of the Contracting
Agency.
If the survey Work provided by the Contractor does not meet the standards of the Engineer, then the
Contractor shall, upon the Engineer's written request, remove the individual or individuals doing the
survey Work and the survey Work will be completed by the Engineer at the Contractor's expense.
Costs for completing the survey Work required by the Engineer will be deducted from monies due or
to become due the Contractor.
1-05.4(3) Contractor Supplied Surveying
Section 1-05.4(3) is a new section:
(******)
When the Contract provides for Contractor Supplied Surveying, the Contractor shall supply the survey
Work required for the project. The Contractor shall retain as a part of the Contractor Organization an
experienced team of surveyors under the direct supervision of a professional land surveyor licensed
by the State of Washington. All survey Work shall be done in accordance with Sections 1-05.4 and
1-11.
The Contractor and/or the Surveyor shall inform the Engineer in writing of any errors, discrepancies,
and omissions to the Plans that prevent the Contractor and/or the Surveyor from constructing the
20
project in a manner satisfactory to the Engineer. All errors, discrepancies, and omissions must be
corrected to the satisfaction of the Engineer before the survey Work may be continued.
The Contractor shall coordinate his Work with the Surveyor and perform his operations in a manner
to protect all survey stakes from harm. The Contractor shall inform the Surveyor of the Contractor's
intent to remove any survey stakes and/or points before physically removing them.
The Surveyor shall be responsible for maintaining As-Built records for the project. The Contractor shall
coordinate his operations and assist the Surveyor in maintaining accurate As-Built records for the
project.
If the Contractor and the Surveyor fail to provide, as directed by the Engineer and/or these Plans and
Specifications, accurate As-Built records and other Work the Engineer deems necessary, the Engineer
may elect to provide at Contractor expense, a surveyor to provide all As-Built records and other Work
as directed by the Engineer. The Engineer shall deduct expenses incurred by the Engineer-supplied
surveying from monies owed to the Contractor.
Payment per Section 1-04.1 for all Work and materials required for the full and complete survey Work
required to complete the project and As-Built drawings shall be included in the lump sum price for
"Construction Surveying, Staking, and As-Built Drawings."
1-05.4(4) Contractor Provided As-Built Information
Section 1-05.4(4) is a new section:
(******)
It shall be the Contractors responsibility to record the location prior to the backfilling of the trenches,
by centerline station, offset, and depth below pavement, of all existing utilities uncovered or crossed
during his Work as covered under this project.
It shall be the Contractor’s responsibility to have his Surveyor locate by centerline station, offset and
elevation each major item of Work done under this contract per the survey standard of Section 1-11.
Major items of Work shall include but not be limited to: Manholes, Catch Basins and Inlets, Valves,
Vertical and Horizontal Bends, Junction Boxes, Cleanouts, Side Sewers, Street Lights & Standards,
Hydrants, Major Changes in Design Grade, Vaults, Culverts, Signal Poles, and Electrical Cabinets.
After the completion of the Work covered by this contract, the Contractor’s Surveyor shall provide to
the City the hard covered field book(s) containing the as-built notes and one set of white prints of the
project drawings upon which he has plotted the notes of the Contractor locating existing utilities, and
one set of white prints of the project drawings upon which he has plotted the as-built location of the
new Work as he recorded in the field book(s). This drawing shall bear the Surveyor’s seal and signature
certifying its accuracy.
All costs for as-built Work shall be included in the Contract item "Construction Surveying, Staking, and
As-Built Drawings", lump sum.
1-05.7 Removal of Defective and/or Unauthorized Work
Section 1-05.7 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Upon written notice from the Engineer, the Contractor shall promptly replace and re-execute Work
by Contractor forces, in accordance with the intent of the Contract and without expense to the Owner,
21
and shall bear the expense of making good all Work of other contractors destroyed or damaged by
such removal or replacement.
If the Contractor does not remove such condemned Work and materials and commence re-execution
of the Work within 7 calendar days of written notice from the Engineer, or fails to perform any part
of the Work required by the Contract Documents, the Owner may correct and remedy such Work as
may be identified in the written notice, with Contracting Agency forces or by such other means as the
Contracting Agency may deem necessary. In that case, the Owner may store removed material.
Direct or indirect costs incurred by the Contracting Agency attributable to correcting and remedying
defective or unauthorized Work, or Work the Contractor failed or refused to perform, shall be paid by
the Contractor. Payment will be deducted by the Engineer from monies due, or to become due, the
Contractor. Such direct and indirect costs shall include in particular, but without limitation,
compensation for additional professional services required, and costs for repair and replacement of
Work of others destroyed or damaged by correction, removal, or replacement of the Contractor’s
unauthorized Work.
If sufficient funds do not remain in the Contract and the Contractor does not pay the cost of such
removal and storage within 10 calendar days from the date of the notice to the Contractor of the fact
of such removal, the Owner may, upon an additional 10 calendar days written notice, sell such
materials at public or private sale, and deduct all costs and expenses incurred from monies due to the
Contractor, including costs of sale, and accounting to Contractor for the net proceeds remaining. The
Owner may bid at any such sale. The Contractor shall be liable to the Owner for the amount of any
deficiency from any funds otherwise due the Contractor.
If the Contractor fails to comply with a written order to remedy what the Engineer determines to be
an emergency situation, the Engineer may have the defective and unauthorized Work corrected
immediately, have the rejected Work removed and replaced, or have Work the Contractor refuses to
perform completed by using Contracting Agency or other forces. An emergency situation is any
situation when, in the opinion of the Engineer, a delay in its remedy could be potentially unsafe, or
might cause serious risk of loss or damage to the public, the Property Owner and the Property Owner’s
property.
No adjustment in contract time or compensation will be allowed because of the delay in the
performance of the Work attributable to the exercise of the Contracting Agency’s rights provided by
this section.
The rights exercised under the provisions of this section shall not diminish the Contracting Agency’s
right to pursue any other avenue for additional remedy or damages with respect to the Contractor’s
failure to perform the Work as required.
1-05.10 Guarantees
Section 1-05.10 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
If within one year after the Acceptance Date of the Work by the Contracting Agency, defective and/or
unauthorized Work is discovered, the Contractor shall promptly, upon written order by the
Contracting Agency, return and in accordance with the Engineer’s instructions, either correct such
Work, or if such Work has been rejected by the Engineer, remove it from the project site and replace
it with non-defective and authorized Work, all without cost to the Contracting Agency. If the
Contractor does not promptly comply with the written order to correct defective and/or unauthorized
22
Work, or if an emergency exists, the Contracting Agency reserves the right to have defective and/or
unauthorized Work corrected or removed and replaced pursuant to Section 1-05.7 “Removal of
Defective and/or Unauthorized Work.”
The Contractor agrees the above one year limitation shall not exclude or diminish the Contracting
Agency’s rights under any law to obtain damages and recover costs resulting from defective and/or
unauthorized Work discovered after one year but prior to the expiration of the legal time period set
forth in RCW 4.16.040 limiting actions upon a contract in writing, or liability expressed of implied
arising out of a written agreement.
The Contractor shall warrant good title to all materials, supplies, and equipment purchased for, or
incorporated in the Work. Nothing contained in this paragraph, however, shall defeat or impair the
right of persons furnishing materials or labor, to recover under any bond given by the Contractor for
their protection, or any rights under any law permitting such persons to look to funds due the
Contractor in the hands of the Contracting Agency.
The provisions of this paragraph shall be inserted in all subcontracts and material contracts, and notice
of its provisions shall be given to all persons furnishing materials for the Work when no formal contract
is entered into for such materials.
1-05.11 Final Inspection
1-05.11(1) Substantial Completion Date
Section 1-05.11(1) is a new section:
(******)
When the Contractor considers the Work to be substantially complete, the Contractor shall so notify
the Engineer and request the Engineer establish the Substantial Completion Date. The Engineer will
schedule an inspection of the Work with the Contractor to determine the status of completion.
To be considered substantially complete the following conditions must be met:
1. The Contracting Agency must have full and unrestricted use and benefit of the facilities both
from the operational and safety standpoint.
2. Only minor incidental Work, replacement of temporary substitute facilities, or correction of
repair Work remains to reach physical completion of the Work.
The Contractor’s request shall list the specific items of Work in subparagraph two above that remains
to be completed in order to reach physical completion. The Engineer may also establish the
Substantial Completion Date unilaterally.
If after this inspection, the Engineer concurs with the Contractor that the Work is substantially
complete and ready for its intended use, the Engineer, by written notice to the Contractor, will set
the Substantial Completion Date. If, after this inspection the Engineer does not consider the Work
substantially complete and ready for its intended use, the Engineer will, by written notice, so notify
the Contractor giving the reasons therefore.
Upon receipt of written notice concurring in or denying substantial completion, whichever is
applicable, the Contractor shall pursue vigorously, diligently and without unauthorized interruption,
the Work necessary to reach Substantial and Physical Completion. The Contractor shall provide the
Engineer with a revised schedule indicating when the Contractor expects to reach substantial and
physical completion of the Work.
23
The above process shall be repeated until the Engineer establishes the Substantial Completion Date
and the Contractor considers the Work physically complete and ready for Final Inspection.
1-05.11(2) Final Inspection and Physical Completion Date
Section 1-05.11(2) is a new Section:
(******)
When the Contractor considers the Work physically complete and ready for Final Inspection, the
Contractor, by Written Notice, shall request the Engineer to schedule a final inspection. The Engineer
will set a date for Final Inspection. The Engineer and the Contractor will then make a final inspection
and the Engineer will notify the Contractor in writing of all particulars in which the Final Inspection
reveals the Work incomplete or unacceptable. The Contractor shall immediately take such corrective
measures as are necessary to remedy the listed deficiencies. Corrective Work shall be pursued
vigorously, diligently, and without interruption until physical completion of the listed deficiencies. This
process will continue until the Engineer is satisfied the listed deficiencies have been corrected.
If action to correct the listed deficiencies is not initiated within 7 days after receipt of the Written
Notice listing the deficiencies, the Engineer may, upon Written Notice to the Contractor, take
whatever steps are necessary to correct those deficiencies pursuant to Section 1-05.8. The Contractor
will not be allowed an extension of contract time because of a delay in the performance of the Work
attributable to the exercise of the Engineer’s right hereunder.
Upon correction of all deficiencies, the Engineer will notify the Contractor and the Contracting Agency,
in writing, of the date upon which the Work was considered physically complete, that date shall
constitute the Physical Completion Date of the Contract, but shall not imply all the obligations of the
Contractor under the Contract have been fulfilled.
1-05.11(3) Operational Testing
Section 1-05.11(3) is a new section:
(******)
Unless otherwise noted in the Contract Documents, the Contractor shall give the Engineer a minimum
of 3 working days’ notice of the time for each test and inspection. If the inspection is by another
authority than the Engineer, the Contractor shall give the Engineer a minimum of 3 working days’
notice of the date fixed for such inspection. Required certificates of inspection by other authority than
the Engineer shall be secured by the Contractor.
It is the intent of the Contracting Agency to have at the Physical Completion Date a complete and
operable system. Therefore, when the Work involves the installation of machinery or other
mechanical equipment; street lighting, electrical distribution or signal systems; irrigation systems;
buildings; or other similar Work, it may be desirable for the Engineer to have the Contractor operate
and test the Work for a period of time, after final inspection but prior to the physical completion date.
Whenever items of Work are listed in the Contract Provisions for operational testing they shall be fully
tested under operating conditions for the time period specified to ensure their acceptability prior to
the Physical Completion Date. During and following the test period, the Contractor shall correct any
items of workmanship, materials, or equipment which prove faulty, or that are not in first class
operating condition. Equipment, electrical controls, meters, or other devices and equipment to be
tested during this period shall be tested under the observation of the Engineer, so that the Engineer
may determine their suitability for the purpose for which they were installed. The Physical Completion
24
Date cannot be established until testing and corrections have been completed to the satisfaction of
the Engineer.
The costs for power, gas, labor, material, supplies, and everything else needed to successfully
complete operational testing, shall be included in the unit contract prices related to the system being
tested, unless specifically set forth otherwise in the proposal.
Operational and test periods, when required by the Engineer, shall not affect a manufacturer’s
guaranties or warranties furnished under the terms of the Contract.
1-05.12 Final Acceptance
The third and fourth sentences in paragraph 1 are deleted and replaced with:
(******)
The Final Acceptance date shall be that date in which the Renton City Council formally approves
acceptance of the Contract.
1-05.13 Superintendents, Labor and Equipment of Contractor
Revise the seventh paragraph to read:
(******)
Whenever the Contracting Agency evaluates the Contractor’s qualifications pursuant to Section
1-02.1, the Contracting Agency will take these performance reports into account.
1-05.14 Cooperation with Other Contractors
Section 1-05.14 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall afford the Owner and other contractors working in the area reasonable
opportunity for the introduction and storage of their materials and the execution of their respective
Work, and shall properly connect and coordinate the Contractor’s Work with theirs.
Other utilities, districts, agencies, and contractors who may have facilities within the project area are:
1. Puget Sound Energy (gas and electric)
2. Lumen
3. City of Renton (water, storm, sewer, transportation)
4. Comcast
5. Private contractors employed by adjacent property owners
The Contractor shall be responsible to coordinate in advance with PSE and provide for the temporary
support and stabilization of any power poles or gas lines potentially affected by underground utility
facility removal or installation.
Prior to starting the Work, the Contractor shall provide the agencies and entities listed below of the
name(s) and telephone numbers of the construction superintendent in responsible charge, or other
individuals having full authority to execute the orders or direction of the Engineer in the event of an
emergency:
25
Comcast
Andrew Parker
Email: andrew_parker2@comcast.com
Puget Sound Energy
Sandy Leek
Email: sandy.leek@pse.com
Lumen
Austin Sweeny
Email: Austin.Sweeney@lumen.com
1-05.15 Method of Serving Notices
Revise the second paragraph to read:
(******)
All correspondence from the Contractor shall be directed to the Engineer. All correspondence from
the Contractor constituting any notification, notice of protest, notice of dispute, or other
correspondence constituting notification required to be furnished under the Contract, must be in
paper format, hand delivered or sent via mail delivery service to the Engineer's office. Electronic
copies such as e-mails or electronically delivered copies of correspondence will not constitute such
notice and will not comply with the requirements of the Contract.
1-05.16 Water and Power
Section 1-05.16 is a new Section:
(******)
The Contractor shall make necessary arrangements, and shall bear the costs for power and water
necessary for the performance of the Work, unless the Contract includes power and water as a pay
item.
1-05.17 Oral Agreements
Section 1-05.17 is a new section:
(******)
No oral agreement or conversation with any officer, agent, or employee of the Contracting Agency,
either before or after execution of the Contract, shall affect or modify any of the terms or obligations
contained in any of the documents comprising the Contract. Such oral agreement or conversation
shall be considered as unofficial information and in no way binding upon the Contracting Agency,
unless subsequently put in writing and signed by the Contracting Agency.
1-05.18 Contractor's Daily Diary
Section 1-05.18 is a new section:
(******)
The Contractor and subcontractors shall maintain and provide to the Engineer a Daily Diary Record of
this Work. This diary will be created by pen entries in a hardbound diary book of the type that is
commonly available through commercial outlets. The diary must contain the Project and Number; if
the diary is in loose-leaf form, this information must appear on every page. The diary must be kept
and maintained by the Contractor's designated project superintendent(s). Entries must be made on a
daily basis and must accurately represent all of the project activities on each day.
26
At a minimum, the diary shall show on a daily basis:
1. The day and date.
2. The weather conditions, including changes throughout the day.
3. A complete description of Work accomplished during the day with adequate references to
the Plans and Contract Provisions, so that the reader can easily and accurately identify said
Work in the Plans. Identify location/description of photographs or videos taken that day.
4. An entry for each and every changed condition, dispute or potential dispute, incident,
accident, or occurrence of any nature whatsoever which might affect the Contractor, the
Owner, or any third party in any manner.
5. Listing of any materials received and stored on- or off-site by the Contractor for future
installation, to include the manner of storage and protection of the same.
6. Listing of materials installed during each day.
7. List of all subcontractors working on-site during each day.
8. Listing of the number of the Contractor's employees working during each day by category of
employment.
9. Listing of the Contractor's equipment working on the site during each day. Idle equipment
on the site shall be listed and designated as idle.
10. Notations to explain inspections, testing, stake-out, and all other services furnished by the
Owner or other party during each day.
11. Entries to verify the daily (including non-Work days) inspection and maintenance of traffic
control devices and condition of the traveled roadway surfaces. The Contractor shall not
allow any conditions to develop that would be hazardous to the public.
12. Any other information that serves to give an accurate and complete record of the nature,
quantity, and quality of Contractor's progress on each day.
13. Plan markups showing locations and dimensions of constructed features to be used by the
Engineer to produce record drawings.
14. All pages of the diary must be numbered consecutively with no omissions in page numbers.
15. Each page must be signed and dated by the Contractor's official representative on the
project.
The Contractor may use additional sheets separate from the diary book if necessary to provide a
complete diary record, but they must be signed, dated, and labeled with project name and number.
It is expressly agreed between the Contractor and the Owner that the Daily Diary maintained by the
Contractor shall be the “Contractor's Book of Original Entry” for the documentation of any potential
claims or disputes that might arise during this contract. Failure of the Contractor to maintain this diary
in the manner described above will constitute a waiver of any such claims or disputes by the
Contractor.
The Engineer or other Owner’s representative on the job site will also complete a Daily Construction
Report.
27
Payment
All costs to comply with this special provision are incidental to the contract and are the responsibility
of the Contractor. The Contractor shall include all related costs in the associated bid prices of the
contract.
1-06 CONTROL OF MATERIAL
1-06.1 Approval of Materials Prior to Use
Section 1-06.1 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The materials and equipment lists submitted to the Engineer at the Preconstruction Conference shall
include the quantity, manufacturer, and model number, if applicable, of materials and equipment to
be installed under the Contract. This list will be checked by the Engineer as to conformity with the
Contract Documents. The Engineer will review the lists within 10 working days, noting required
corrections. The Contractor shall make required corrections and file 2 corrected copies with the
Engineer within one week after receipt of required corrections. The Engineer's review and acceptance
of the lists shall not relieve the Contractor from responsibility for suitability for the intended purpose,
nor for deviations from the Contract Documents. Neither the review of the Contractor’s submittal nor
the corrections or comments provided, shall create any duty owed to or a cause of action in favor of
the Contractor or any Subcontractor.
1-06.1(2) Request for Approval of Materials (RAM)
Section 1-06.1(2) is supplemented a follows:
(******)
The Engineer will require up to 7 calendar days from the date each RAM is submitted until it is
returned to the Contractor. The Contractor shall not proceed with the Work to incorporate the
materials included in each RAM until each RAM is approved by the Engineer. As applicable, comments
from the Engineer regarding a submitted RAM shall be addressed and resubmitted to the Engineer.
Each resubmitted RAM will require up to 7 calendar days from the date of submission until it is
returned to the Contractor.
1-06.2(1) Samples and Tests for Acceptance
Section 1-06.2(1) is supplemented a follows:
(******)
The finished Work shall be in accordance with approved samples. Approval of samples by the Engineer
does not relieve the Contractor of responsibility for performance of the Work in accordance with the
Contract Documents.
1-06.2(2) Statistical Evaluation of Materials for Acceptance
Section 1-06.02(2) is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Unless stated otherwise in the special provisions, statistical evaluation will not be used by the City of
Renton.
28
1-06.6 Recycled Materials
The first paragraph of Section 1-06.6 is deleted and replaced with the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall make an effort to utilize recycled materials in the construction of the project,
however, the use of recycled materials is not a requirement of the Contract. Recycled aggregates shall
not be installed as pipe zone bedding but may be allowed in the backfill zone if approved by the
1-07 LEGAL RELATIONS AND RESPONSIBILITIES TO THE PUBLIC
1-07.1 Laws to be Observed
Section 1-07.1 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall erect and properly maintain, at all times, as required by the conditions and
progress of the Work, all necessary safeguards for protection of workers and the public; shall post
danger signs warning against known or unusual hazards; and shall designate as Safety Supervisor, a
responsible employee on the construction site whose duty shall be the enforcement of safety. The
name and position of such person so designated shall be reported in writing to the Engineer by the
Contractor.
The Contractor shall, at all times, enforce strict discipline and good order among all employees and
shall not employ any person unfit or not skilled in the Work assigned to him/her.
Necessary sanitation conveniences for the use of the workers on the job, properly secluded from
public observation, shall be provided and maintained by the Contractor.
In cases of conflict between different safety regulations, the more stringent regulation shall apply.
The Washington State Department of Labor and Industries shall be the sole and paramount
administrative agency responsible for the administration of the provisions of the Washington
Industrial Safety and Health Act of 1973 (WISHA).
The Contractor shall maintain at the project site office, or other well-known place at the project site,
all articles necessary for providing first aid to the injured. The Contractor shall establish, publish, and
make known to all employees, procedures for ensuring immediate removal to a hospital or doctor’s
care, and persons, including employees, who may have been injured on the project site. Employees
should not be permitted to Work on the project site before the Contractor has established and made
known procedures for removal of injured persons to a hospital or a doctor’s care.
The Contractor shall have sole responsibility for the safety, efficiency, and adequacy of the
Contractor’s plant, appliances, and methods, and for any damage or injury resulting from their failure,
or improper maintenance, use, or operation. The Contractor shall be solely and completely
responsible for the conditions of the project site, including safety for all persons and property in the
performance of the Work. This requirement shall apply continuously, and not be limited to normal
working hours. The required or implied duty of the Engineer to conduct construction review of the
Contractor’s performance does not, and shall not, be intended to include review and adequacy of the
Contractor’s safety measures, in, on, or near the project site.
In the event of public health emergencies of a similar nature to the COVID-19 pandemic, the
Contractor shall prepare a project specific comprehensive exposure control, mitigation, and recovery
plan (EMCP) in conformance with Section 1-07.4 of the Standard Specifications and the Washington
29
State Governor’s Job Site Requirements, as well as any statutes that may be enacted related to job
site protocols during a public health emergency.
1-07.2 State Tax
Delete this Section, including its sub-sections, in its entirety and replace it with the following:
(******)
1-07.2 State Sales Tax
The Washington State Department of Revenue has issued special rules on the state sales tax. Sections
1-07.2(1) through 1-07.2(4) are meant to clarify those rules. The Contractor should contact the
Washington State Department of Revenue for answers to questions in this area. The Contracting
Agency will not adjust its payment if the Contractor bases a bid on a misunderstood tax liability.
The Contractor shall include all Contractor-paid taxes in the unit bid prices or other contract amounts.
In some cases, however, state retail sales tax will not be included. Section 1-07.2(3) describes this
exception.
The Contracting Agency will pay the retained percentage only if the Contractor has obtained from the
Washington State Department of Revenue a certificate showing that all contract-related taxes have
been paid (RCW 60.28.050). The Contracting Agency may deduct from its payments to the Contractor
any amount the Contractor may owe the Washington State Department of Revenue, whether the
amount owed relates to this contract or not. Any amount so deducted will be paid into the proper
state fund.
1-07.2(1) State Sales Tax – Rule 171
WAC 458-20-171, and its related rules, apply to building, repairing, or improving streets, roads, etc.,
which are owned by a municipal corporation, or political subdivision of the state, or by the United
States, and which are used primarily for foot or vehicular traffic. This includes storm or combined
sewer systems within and included as part of the street or road drainage system, and power lines
when such are part of the roadway lighting system. For Work performed in such cases, the Contractor
shall include Washington State Retail Sales Taxes in the various unit bid item prices, or other contract
amounts, including those that the Contractor pays on the purchase of the materials, equipment, or
supplies used or consumed in doing the Work.
1-07.2(2) State Sales Tax – Rule 170
WAC 458-20-170, and its related rules, applies to the constructing and repairing of new or existing
buildings, or other structures, upon real property. This includes, but is not limited to; the construction
of streets, roads, highways, etc., owned by the state of Washington; water mains and their
appurtenances; sanitary sewers and sewage disposal systems unless such sewers and disposal
systems are within, and a part of, a street or road drainage system; telephone, telegraph, electrical
power distribution lines, or other conduits or lines in or above streets or roads, unless such power
lines become a part of a street or road lighting system; and installing or attaching of any article of
tangible personal property in or to real property, whether or not such personal property becomes a
part of the realty by virtue of installation.
30
For Work performed in such cases, the Contractor shall collect from the Contracting Agency, retail
sales tax on the full contract price. The Contracting Agency will automatically add this sales tax to each
payment to the Contractor. For this reason, the Contractor shall not include the retail sales tax in the
unit bid item prices, or in any other contract amount subject to Rule 170, with the following exception.
Exception: The Contracting Agency will not add in sales tax for a payment the Contractor or a
subcontractor makes on the purchase or rental of tools, machinery, equipment, or consumable
supplies not integrated into the project. Such sales taxes shall be included in the unit bid item prices
or in any other contract amount.
1-07.2(3) Services
The Contractor shall not collect retail sales tax from the Contracting Agency on any contract wholly
for professional or other services (as defined in Washington State Department of Revenue Rules 138
and 244).
1-07.5 Environmental Regulations
1-07.5(1) General
Section 1-07.5(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Protection of the Environment: No construction related activity shall contribute to the degradation
of the environment, allow material to enter surface or ground waters, or allow particulate emissions
to the atmosphere, which exceed state or federal standards. Any actions that potentially allow a
discharge to state waters must have prior approval of the Washington State.
1-07.6 Permits and Licenses
Section 1-07.6 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall ensure that all necessary permits are obtained, and is responsible for reviewing
all permits to become familiar with the requirements.
The Contractor and all subcontractors of any tier must obtain a City of Renton Business License
(Contractor).
The permits, easements, and right of entry documents that have been acquired are available for
inspection and review.
The Contractor shall be required to comply with all conditions of the permits, easements, and rights
of entry, at no additional cost to the Owner. The Contractor is required to indemnify the Owner from
claims on all easements and rights of entry.
All other permits, licenses, etc., shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. The Contractor shall
comply with the special provisions and requirements of each.
Permits, permission under franchises, licenses and bonds of a temporary nature necessary for and
during the prosecution of the Work, and inspection fees in connection therewith shall be secured and
paid for by the Contractor. If the Owner is required to secure such permits, permission under
franchises, licenses and bonds, and pay the fees, the costs incurred by the Owner thereby shall be
charged against the Contractor and deducted from any funds otherwise due the Contractor.
31
The Contractor is cautioned to review all permits and other Contract Documents and schedule the
work activities appropriately to complete the work within the number of days stated in the Contract
Document. No additional compensation or extensions to time will be granted to the Contractor due
to the time constraints imposed by such documents. The Contractor shall assume all responsibility for
meeting all requirements of all permits.
Any fines or penalties incurred by Contracting Agency for not meeting state water quality standards
and/or lack of stormwater pollution prevention on this Project shall be deducted from monies
otherwise due to Contractor. Any fines assessed directly to Contractor shall be paid directly to the
fining authority, at the Contractor’s own cost.
1-07.7 Load Limits
Section 1-07.7 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
If the sources of materials provided by the Contractor necessitates hauling over roads other than State
Highways, the Contractor shall, at the Contractor’s expense, make all arrangements for the use of the
haul routes.
1-07.9 Wages
1-07.9(5)C Certified Payroll
Delete the first paragraph, and replace it with the following:
(******)
The Contractor must submit weekly-certified payrolls for the Contractor and all subcontractors and
lower tier subcontractors, regardless of project’s funding source.
1-07.11 Requirements for Non-Discrimination
1-07.11(11) City of Renton Affidavit of Compliance
Section 1-07.11(11) is new:
(******)
Each Contractor, Subcontractor, Consultant, and or Supplier shall complete and submit a copy of the
“City of Renton Fair Practices Policy Affidavit of Compliance”. A copy of this document will be bound
in the bid documents.
1-07.13 Contractor’s Responsibility for Work
1-07.13(1) General
Section 1-07.13(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
See 8-01 for additional construction requirements regarding implementation of the SWPPP and TESC
Plan.
During unfavorable weather and other conditions, the Contractor shall pursue only such portions of
the Work as shall not be damaged thereby.
32
No portion of the Work whose satisfactory quality or efficiency will be affected by unfavorable
conditions shall be constructed while these conditions exist, unless the Contractor shall be able to
overcome said unfavorable conditions by special means or precautions acceptable to the Engineer.
1-07.15 Temporary Water Pollution/Erosion Control
Section 1-07.15 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall perform all Work in strict accordance with all Federal, State, and local laws and
regulations governing waters of the State, as well as permits acquired for the project.
The Contractor shall prepare a Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control Plan (TESCP) and a
Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP).
The TESCP and SWPPP shall be developed in accordance with the erosion control standards contained
in the Current City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual. The plan shall include any assumptions,
detailed calculations, sketches and sequencing. The plan shall be signed and stamped by a Washington
State Professional Engineer. A TESC supervisor shall be designated by the Contractor, whose name
and phone number shall be given to the Engineer at the Preconstruction Conference. The TESC
supervisor must be CESCL certified in accordance with NPDES permit requirements.
The plan shall be submitted for approval to the City at minimum 3 days prior to the pre-construction
meeting. The TESCP shall include the various configurations that may be necessary to adequately
control erosion and sediment at the site during the various stages of construction.
Design of dewatering, water control, bypass systems, and temporary erosion and sediment control
during construction shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
At a minimum, the plan shall contain:
1. Manufacturer’s data and detailed plans for the erosion control products specified in the plan.
2. Plan for temporary pipe system diversions. This shall include a description of when the piping
will be used, pipe material, locations, elevations, plan and profile views, inlet and outlet
protection, hydraulic capacity, and details of important design features.
3. Plan for collecting, pumping and pipe surface stormwater runoff, dewatering discharge, and
seepage from the source to the Baker Tank or acceptable discharge. The plan shall be shown
in phases to coincide with the phases of construction. The plan shall include:
a. Layout and details of system.
b. Diversion systems manufacturer’s data and material submittals.
c. Pump and pipe types, sizes, manufacturer’s data, and design criteria for pump sizing.
d. Flow calculations for stormwater, seepage, and dewatering pump discharge. Schedule
and sketch of location for dewatering systems. Pumps shall be sized to pump stormwater
runoff for the tributary area plus an allowance for groundwater and surface seepage. Each
pump area location shall be equipped with two pumps meeting the capacity requirement,
in case one is non-operational.
e. Source of power for pumps, description of schedule and fueling requirements, storage
location, and methods.
33
4. Manufacturer’s literature and test results (certificates) on the temporary silt fence, erosion
control matting, riprap gradations, and any other necessary erosion control materials.
5. Planned installation and maintenance schedule for temporary erosion and sedimentation
control facilities. Indicate locations and outlets of dewatering systems.
6. The boundaries of the clearing limits, sensitive areas and their buffers, and areas of vegetation
preservation and tree retention.
The Contractor shall also prepare a SWPPP. The SWPPP must meet the requirements of the
Department of Ecology’s NPDES and State Waste Discharge General Permit for Stormwater Discharges
Associated with Construction Activity (General Permit). The SWPPP shall include and modify as
necessary the Site Preparation and Erosion Control Plan drawings provided as part of the Contract
Plans. The Contractor shall prepare, review, and modify the SWPPP as necessary to be consistent with
the actual work schedule, sequencing, and construction methods that will be used on the project. The
Contractor’s SWPPP shall meet the requirements of the general permit.
The Contractor shall:
• Furnish, install, operate, and maintain necessary machinery, appurtenances, and equipment
to keep excavations free of water during construction;
• Dewater and dispose of water in a manner that will not cause injury to public and private
property, as well as keep sediment-laden water from entering the City surface water system
or violate applicable water standards;
• Keep sufficient pumping equipment and machinery on hand at all times for emergencies,
including electric power failures;
• Keep experienced personnel available at all times to operate pumping equipment, machinery
and appliances;
• Not shut down dewatering systems between shifts, on holidays and weekends, nor during
work stoppages without prior authorization by the Engineer;
• Control groundwater to prevent softening of bottoms of excavations, or formation of “quick”
conditions or “boils”;
• Design and operate dewatering system that will not remove natural soils;
• Keep excavations free of water during excavation, construction of structures, installation of
pipelines, placing of structures, backfill, and placing and curing of concrete; and
• Control surface water runoff to prevent entry and collection in excavations.
As construction progresses and unexpected or seasonal conditions dictate, the Contractor shall
anticipate that more water pollution/erosion control measures will be necessary. It shall be the
obligation and responsibility of the Contractor to revise or supplement the pollution/erosion control
measures as may be needed to protect the work, adjacent properties, storm drains, streams, and
other water bodies.
In addition, the SWPPP shall outline the procedures to be used to prevent high pH stormwater or
dewatering water from entering surface waters. The plan shall include how the pH of the water will
be maintained between pH 6.5 and pH 8.5 prior to being discharged from the project or entering
surface waters. Prior to beginning any concrete or grinding work, the Contractor shall submit the plan,
for the Engineer’s review and approval.
34
An Ecology template is available to the Contractor for producing the SWPPP, using project- specific
information added by the Contractor. The template and instructions are available at:
http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/construction.
The Engineer’s review and any resulting approval of the Contractor’s SWPPP and TESCP will be only
regarding conformance with the specification requirement that the Contractor have the plans
prepared by a CPESC or professional Civil Engineer who has expertise in the type of facilities and that
the SWPPP and TESCP include the items specified for such plans. The Contractor shall be solely
responsible for the adequacy of the SWPPP and TESCP and if erosion sediment, and other pollutant
control measures in deviation or addition to those described in the SWPPP become necessary to
minimize erosion and prevent storm water contamination from sediment and other pollutants, the
Contractor shall prepare and submit a revised SWPPP to the Engineer for review as specified for the
original plan.
The Owner will not be liable to the Contractor for failure to accept all or any portion of an originally
submitted or revised SWPPP, nor for any delays to the Work due to the Contractor’s failure to submit
and implement an acceptable SWPPP.
1-07.16 Protection and Restoration of Property
1-07.16(1) Private/Public Property
Section 1-07.16(1) is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
The Contracting Agency will obtain all easements and franchises required for the project. The
Contractor shall limit his operation to the areas obtained and shall not trespass on private property.
The Contracting Agency may provide certain lands, as indicated in connection with the Work under
the Contract together with the right of access to such lands. The Contractor shall not unreasonably
encumber the premises with his equipment or materials.
The Contractor shall provide, with no liability to the Contracting Agency, any additional land and
access thereto not shown or described that may be required for temporary construction facilities or
storage of materials. He shall construct all access roads, detour roads, or other temporary Work as
required by his operations. The Contractor shall confine his equipment, storage of material, and
operation of his workers to those areas shown and described and such additional areas as he may
provide.
A. General. All construction Work under this contract on easements, right-of-way, over private
property or franchise, shall be confined to the limits of such easements, right-of-way or
franchise. All Work shall be accomplished so as to cause the least amount of disturbance and
a minimum amount of damage. The Contractor shall schedule his Work so that trenches
across easements shall not be left open during weekends or holidays and trenches shall not
be open for more than 48 hours.
B. Structures. The Contractor shall remove such existing structures as may be necessary for the
performance of the Work and, if required, shall rebuild the structures thus removed in as
good a condition as found. He shall also repair all existing structures that may be damaged as
a result of the Work under this contract.
C. Easements, cultivated areas and other surface improvements. All cultivated areas, either
agricultural or lawns, and other surface improvements which are damaged by actions of the
35
Contractor shall be restored as nearly as possible to their original condition.
Prior to excavation on an easement or private right-of-way, the Contractor shall strip topsoil
from the trench or construction area and stockpile it in such a manner that it may be replaced
by him, upon completion of construction. Ornamental trees and shrubbery shall be carefully
removed with the earth surrounding their roots wrapped in burlap and replanted in their
original positions within 48 hours.
All shrubbery or trees destroyed or damaged, shall be replaced by the Contractor with
material of equal quality at no additional cost to the Contracting Agency. In the event that it
is necessary to trench through any lawn area, the sod shall be carefully cut and rolled and
replaced after the trenches have been backfilled. The lawn area shall be cleaned by sweeping
or other means, of all earth and debris.
The Contractor shall use rubber wheel equipment similar to the small tractor-type backhoes
used by side sewer contractors for all Work, including excavation and backfill, on easements
or rights-of-way, which have lawn areas. All fences, markers, mailboxes, or other temporary
obstacles shall be removed by the Contractor and immediately replace, after the trench is
backfilled, in their original position. The Contractor shall notify the Contracting Agency and
Property Owner at least 24 hours in advance of any Work done on easements or rights-of-
way.
Damage to existing structures outside of easement areas that may result from dewatering
and/or other construction activity under this contract shall be restored to their original
condition or better. The original condition shall be established by photographs taken and/or
inspection made prior to construction. All such Work shall be done to the satisfaction of the
Property Owners and the Contracting Agency at the expense of the Contractor.
D. Streets. The Contractor will assume all responsibility of restoration of the surface of all streets
(traveled ways) used by him if damaged.
In the event the Contractor does not have labor or material immediately available to make
necessary repairs, the Contractor shall so inform the Contracting Agency. The Contracting
Agency will make the necessary repairs and the cost of such repairs shall be paid by the
Contractor.
The Contractor is responsible for identifying and documenting any damage that is pre-existing
or caused by others. Restoration of excavation in City streets shall be done in accordance with
the City of Renton Trench Restoration Requirements, which is available at the Public Works
Department Customer Services counter on the 6th floor, Renton City Hall, 1055 South Grady
Way.
1-07.17 Utilities and Similar Facilities
Section 1-07.17 is supplemented by adding:
(******)
Existing utilities indicated in the Plans have been plotted from the best information available to the
Engineer. Information and data shown or indicated in the Contract Documents with respect to existing
underground utilities or services at or contiguous to the project site are based on information and
data furnished to the Owner and the Engineer by owners of such underground facilities or others, and
the Owner and the Engineer do not assume responsibility for the accuracy or completeness thereof.
36
It is to be understood that other aboveground or underground facilities not shown in the Plans may
be encountered during the course of the Work.
All utility valves, manholes, vaults, or pull boxes which are buried shall be conspicuously marked in a
fashion acceptable to the Owner and the Engineer by the Contractor to allow their location to be
determined by the Engineer or utility personnel under adverse conditions, (inclement weather or
darkness).
Where underground main distribution conduits, such as water, gas, sewer, electric power, or
telephone, are shown on the Plans, the Contractor, for the purpose of preparing his bid, shall assume
that every property parcel will be served by a service connection for each type of utility.
The Contractor shall conduct a utility coordination meeting with the utility companies concerning any
possible conflict prior to commencing excavation in any area and submit documentation of said
meeting to the Engineer. The Contractor shall resolve all crossing and clearance problems with the
utility company concerned. No excavation shall begin until all known facilities, in the vicinity of the
excavation area, have been located and marked. All costs for utility coordination, discussions, and
meetings shall be considered incidental to the Contract and no additional compensation will be made.
In addition to the Contractor having all utilities field marked before starting Work, the Contractor shall
have all utilities field marked after they are relocated in conjunction with this project.
Call Before You Dig
The 48-Hour Locators
1-800-424-5555
At least 2 and not more than 10 working days prior to commencing any excavations for utility
potholing or for any other purpose under this Contract, the Contractor shall notify the Underground
Utilities Location Center by telephone of the planned excavation and progress schedule. The
Contractor is also warned that there may be utilities on the project that are not part of the One Call
system. They must be contacted directly by the Contractor for locations.
The Contractor shall make arrangements 48 hours in advance with respective utility owners to have
a representative present when their utility is exposed or modified, if the utility chooses to do so.
Utility Adjustments and Conflicts
Existing utilities for telephone, power, gas, water, and television cable facilities shall be adjusted or
relocated by the appropriate utility company unless otherwise noted in the Plans. These adjustments
may be completed before the Contractor begins Work, or may be performed in conjunction with the
Contract Work. The Contractor shall be entirely responsible for coordination with the utility
companies and arranging for the movement or adjustment, either temporary or permanent, of their
facilities within the project limits. See also Section 1-05.14 of these Special Provisions.
If or when utility conflicts occur, the Contractor shall continue the construction process on other
aspects of the project whenever possible. No additional compensation will be made to the Contractor
for reason of delay caused by the actions of any utility company, and the Contractor shall consider
such costs to be incidental to the other items of the Contract.
Utility Potholing
Potholing may be included as a bid item for use in determining the location of existing utilities in
advance of the Contractor's operations. If potholing is not included as a bid item then it shall be
considered incidental to other Work. The Contractor shall submit all potholing requests to the
37
Engineer for approval, at least 2 working days before potholing is scheduled. Additionally, the
Contractor shall provide potholing at the Engineer's request.
In no way shall the Work described under Utility Potholing relieve the Contractor of any of the
responsibilities described in Section 1-07.17 of the Standard Specifications and Special Provisions, and
elsewhere in the Contract Documents.
Potholing shall include excavation and backfilling of the existing utility, identification of the pipe or
line size, material type and condition and the survey work to locate the facility horizontally and
vertically. Survey information to be obtained shall include station and offset to center of utility and
elevation at top of utility. Stations, offsets and elevations shall be to the nearest 0.1 foot unless
greater accuracy is required. Potholes shall be backfilled with CSBC compacted to 95%, or with
controlled density fill (CDF), as directed by the Engineer. In areas subject to public traffic, potholes
shall be paved with hot mix asphalt (HMA) patch matching the depth of the surrounding pavement.
1-07.17(4) Interruption of Services
Section 1-07.17(4) is a new section:
(******)
Whenever in the course of the construction operation it becomes necessary to cause an outage of
utilities, it shall be the Contractor's responsibility to notify the affected users and the Engineer not
less than 48 hours in advance of such outage. The Contractor shall make reasonable effort to minimize
the duration of outages, and shall estimate the length of time service will be interrupted and so notify
the users. In the case of any utility outage that has exceeded or will exceed four hours, user contact
shall again be made. Temporary service, if needed, will be arranged by the Contractor at no cost to
the Owner.
Overhead lighting outages shall not exceed 24 hours. All cost to the Contractor for providing
temporary overhead lighting to meet above requirements shall be incidental to the various unit and
Lump sum items of the Contract; no separate payment will be made.
1-07.17(5) Resolution of Utility Conflicts
Section 1-07.17(5) is a new section:
(******)
In no way shall the work described under Resolution of Utility Conflicts relieve Contractor of any of
the responsibilities described in Section 1-07.17 of the Standard Specifications and Special Provisions,
and elsewhere in the Contract Documents. If or when utility conflicts occur, Contractor shall continue
the construction process on other aspects of the project whenever possible.
In the event that a conflict arises between the proposed improvements and an existing utility, the
Resolution of Utility Conflicts item will compensate the Contractor for standby time and additional
work in the following manner:
1. Standby time resulting from existing utility conflicts
a) Standby time is defined as time the Contractor is unable to proceed with progression of a
specific work item (i.e. storm drainage, underground utility installation etc.) due to conflicts
with existing facilities. However, payment for standby time shall be limited to:
(1) For each agreed upon conflict, a maximum of four (4) hours of standby time will be paid
for actual delay of labor and equipment due to a utility conflict. The Contractor shall be
38
responsible to adjust his work schedule and/or reassign his work forces and equipment
to other areas of work to minimize standby time.
(2) If the conflict is resolved within one (1) hour of notification to the Engineer, no standby
time will be paid.
2. Additional work required to resolve utility conflicts will be paid for at the bid unit prices for the
associated work. Work that can be measured and paid for at the unit contract prices shall not be
identified as force account work. This work includes but is not limited to:
(1) Storm drainage manhole, pipe, vault, and conduit realignments of line and/or grade for the
storm drain, undergrounding of overhead utilities, illumination, and signal, to avoid existing
utility conflicts.
(2) Additional storm drainage manholes, pipe, vaults, and conduit required by a change in
alignment, and/or grade, not exceeding the limits set in Section 1-04.4 of the Standard
Specifications.
If “Resolution of Utility Conflicts” is included as a Bid Item in Section 1-09.14, it shall be used to resolve
new identified utility conflicts not otherwise shown on the Contract Drawings or Specifications that
are identified during the course of construction.
1-07.18 Public Liability and Property Damage Insurance
Delete this Section in its entirety, and replace it with the following:
(******)
1-07.18 Insurance
1-07.18(1) General Requirements
A. The Contractor shall procure and maintain the insurance described in all subsections of Section
1-07.18 of these Special Provisions, from insurers with a current A. M. Best rating of not less than
A-: VII and licensed to do business in the State of Washington. The Contracting Agency reserves
the right to approve or reject the insurance provided, based on the insurer’s financial condition.
B. The Contractor shall keep this insurance in force without interruption from the commencement
of the Contractor’s Work through the term of the Contract and for thirty (30) days after the
Physical Completion date, unless otherwise indicated below.
C. If any insurance policy is written on a claims-made form, its retroactive date, and that of all
subsequent renewals, shall be no later than the effective date of this Contract. The policy shall
state that coverage is claims made and state the retroactive date. Claims-made form coverage
shall be maintained by the Contractor for a minimum of 36 months following the Completion Date
or earlier termination of this Contract, and the Contractor shall annually provide the Contracting
Agency with proof of renewal. If renewal of the claims made form of coverage becomes
unavailable, or economically prohibitive, the Contractor shall purchase an extended reporting
period (“tail”) or execute another form of guarantee acceptable to the Contracting Agency to
assure financial responsibility for liability for services performed.
D. The Contractor’s Automobile Liability, Commercial General Liability and Excess or Umbrella
Liability insurance policies shall be primary and non-contributory insurance as respects the
Contracting Agency’s insurance, self-insurance, or self-insured pool coverage. Any insurance, self-
39
insurance, or self-insured pool coverage maintained by the Contracting Agency shall be excess of
the Contractor’s insurance and shall not contribute with it.
E. The Contractor shall provide the Contracting Agency and all additional insureds with written
notice of any policy cancellation, within two business days of their receipt of such notice.
F. The Contractor shall not begin work under the Contract until the required insurance has been
obtained and approved by the Contracting Agency.
G. Failure on the part of the Contractor to maintain the insurance as required shall constitute a
material breach of contract, upon which the Contracting Agency may, after giving five business
days’ notice to the Contractor to correct the breach, immediately terminate the Contract or, at its
discretion, procure or renew such insurance and pay any and all premiums in connection
therewith, with any sums so expended to be repaid to the Contracting Agency on demand, or at
the sole discretion of the Contracting Agency, offset against funds due the Contractor from the
Contracting Agency.
H. All costs for insurance shall be incidental to and included in the unit or lump sum prices of the
Contract and no additional payment will be made.
1-07.18(2) Additional Insured
All insurance policies, with the exception of Workers Compensation, and of Professional Liability and
Builder’s Risk (if required by this Contract) shall name the following listed entities as additional
insured(s) using the forms or endorsements required herein:
• the Contracting Agency and its officers, elected officials, employees, agents, and volunteers;
• Consultants hired by the Contracting Agency to provide engineering support during
construction of this project;
• Consultants hired by the Contracting Agency to provide environmental support during
construction of this project;
• Consultants hired by the Contracting Agency to provide construction management, inspection
and materials testing services for this project.
The above-listed entities shall be additional insured(s) for the full available limits of liability
maintained by the Contractor, irrespective of whether such limits maintained by the Contractor are
greater than those required by this Contract, and irrespective of whether the Certificate of Insurance
provided by the Contractor pursuant to 1-07.18(4) describes limits lower than those maintained by
the Contractor.
For Commercial General Liability insurance coverage, the required additional insured endorsements
shall be at least as broad as Insurance Services Office (ISO) forms CG 20 10 10 01 for ongoing
operations and CG 20 37 10 01 for completed operations.
1-07.18(3) Subcontractors
The Contractor shall cause each subcontractor of every tier to provide insurance coverage that
complies with all applicable requirements of the Contractor-provided insurance as set forth herein,
except the Contractor shall have sole responsibility for determining the limits of coverage required to
be obtained by subcontractors.
40
The Contractor shall ensure that all subcontractors of every tier add all entities listed in 1-07.18(2) as
additional insureds, and provide proof of such on the policies as required by that section as detailed
in 1-07.18(2) using an endorsement as least as broad as ISO CG 20 10 10 01 for ongoing operations
and CG 20 37 10 01 for completed operations.
Upon request by the Contracting Agency, the Contractor shall forward to the Contracting Agency
evidence of insurance and copies of the additional insured endorsements of each subcontractor of
every tier as required in 1-07.18(4) Verification of Coverage.
1-07.18(4) Verification of Coverage
The Contractor shall deliver to the Contracting Agency a Certificate(s) of Insurance and endorsements
for each policy of insurance meeting the requirements set forth herein when the Contractor delivers
the signed Contract for the work. Failure of Contracting Agency to demand such verification of
coverage with these insurance requirements or failure of Contracting Agency to identify a deficiency
from the insurance documentation provided shall not be construed as a waiver of Contractor’s
obligation to maintain such insurance.
Verification of coverage shall include:
1. An ACORD certificate or a form determined by the Contracting Agency to be equivalent.
2. Copies of all endorsements naming Contracting Agency and all other entities listed in
1-07.18(2) as additional insured(s), showing the policy number. The Contractor may submit a
copy of any blanket additional insured clause from its policies instead of a separate
endorsement.
3. Any other amendatory endorsements to show the coverage required herein.
4. A notation of coverage enhancements on the Certificate of Insurance shall not satisfy these
requirements – actual endorsements must be submitted.
Upon request by the Contracting Agency, the Contractor shall forward to the Contracting Agency a
full and certified copy of the insurance policy(s). If Builders Risk insurance is required on this Project,
a full and certified copy of that policy is required when the Contractor delivers the signed Contract for
the work.
1-07.18(5) Coverage and Limits
The insurance shall provide the minimum coverages and limits set forth below. Contractor’s
maintenance of insurance, its scope of coverage, and limits as required herein shall not be construed
to limit the liability of the Contractor to the coverage provided by such insurance, or otherwise limit
the Contracting Agency’s recourse to any remedy available at law or in equity.
All deductibles and self-insured retentions must be disclosed and are subject to approval by the
Contracting Agency. The cost of any claim payments falling within the deductible or self-insured
retention shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. In the event an additional insured incurs a
liability subject to any policy’s deductibles or self-insured retention, said deductibles or self-insured
retention shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
1-07.18(5)A Commercial General Liability
Commercial General Liability insurance shall be written on coverage forms at least as broad as ISO
occurrence form CG 00 01, including but not limited to liability arising from premises, operations, stop
gap liability, independent contractors, products-completed operations, personal and advertising
41
injury, and liability assumed under an insured contract. There shall be no exclusion for liability arising
from explosion, collapse or underground property damage.
The Commercial General Liability insurance shall be endorsed to provide a per project general
aggregate limit, using ISO form CG 25 03 05 09 or an equivalent endorsement.
Contractor shall maintain Commercial General Liability Insurance arising out of the Contractor’s
completed operations for at least three years following Substantial Completion of the Work.
Such policy must provide the following minimum limits:
$1,000,000 Each Occurrence
$2,000,000 General Aggregate
$2,000,000 Products & Completed Operations Aggregate
$1,000,000 Personal & Advertising Injury each offence
$1,000,000 Stop Gap / Employers’ Liability each accident
1-07.18(5)B Automobile Liability
Automobile Liability shall cover owned, non-owned, hired, and leased vehicles; and shall be written
on a coverage form at least as broad as ISO form CA 00 01. If the work involves the transport of
pollutants, the automobile liability policy shall include MCS 90 and CA 99 48 endorsements.
Such policy must provide the following minimum limit:
$1,000,000 Combined single limit each accident
1-07.18(5)C Worker’s Compensation
The Contractor shall comply with Workers’ Compensation coverage as required by the Industrial
Insurance laws of the State of Washington.
1-07.18(5)D Excess or Umbrella Liability
The Contractor shall provide Excess or Umbrella Liability insurance with limits of not less than
described herein. This excess or umbrella liability coverage shall be excess over and as least as broad
in coverage as the Contractor’s Commercial General and Auto Liability insurance.
All entities listed under 1-07.18(2) of these Special Provisions shall be named as additional insureds
on the Contractor’s Excess or Umbrella Liability insurance policy.
This requirement may be satisfied instead through the Contractor’s primary Commercial General and
Automobile Liability coverages, or any combination thereof that achieves the overall required limits
of insurance.
Such policy must provide the following minimum limit:
Each Occurrence Limit $1,000,000
General Aggregate Limit $1,000,000
Products/Completed Operations Aggregate $1,000,000
42
1-07.18(5)J Pollution Liability
The Contractor shall provide a Contractors Pollution Liability policy, providing coverage for claims
involving bodily injury, property damage (including loss of use of tangible property that has not been
physically injured), cleanup costs, remediation, disposal or other handling of pollutants, including
costs and expenses incurred in the investigation, defense, or settlement of claims, arising out of any
one or more of the following:
1. Contractor’s operations related to this project.
2. Remediation, abatement, repair, maintenance or other work with lead-based paint or
materials containing asbestos.
3. Transportation of hazardous materials away from any site related to this project.
All entities listed under 1-07.18(2) of these Special Provisions shall be named by endorsement as
additional insureds on the Contractors Pollution Liability insurance policy.
Such Pollution Liability policy shall provide the following minimum limits:
$1,000,000 each loss and annual aggregate
1-07.18(5)K Professional Liability
The Contractor and/or its subcontractor(s) and/or its design consultant providing construction
management, value engineering, or any other design-related non-construction professional services
shall provide evidence of Professional Liability insurance covering professional errors and omissions.
Such policy shall provide the following minimum limits:
$1,000,000 per claim and annual aggregate
If the scope of such design-related professional services includes work related to pollution conditions,
the Professional Liability insurance shall include coverage for Environmental Professional Liability.
If insurance is on a claims-made form, its retroactive date, and that of all subsequent renewals, shall
be no later than the effective date of this Contract.
1-07.22 Use of Explosives
Section 1-07.22 is supplemented by the following:
(******)
Explosives shall not be used without specific authority of the Engineer, and then only under such
restrictions as may be required by the proper authorities. Explosives shall be handled and used in
strict compliance with WAC 296-52 and such local laws, rules and regulations that may apply. The
individual in charge of the blasting shall have a current Washington State Blaster Users License.
The Contractor shall obtain, comply with, and pay for such permits and costs as are necessary in
conjunction with blasting operations.
43
1-07.23 Public Convenience and Safety
1-07.23(1) Construction Under Traffic
Revise the second paragraph to read:
(******)
To disrupt public traffic as little as possible, the Contractor shall permit traffic to pass through the
Work with the least possible inconvenience or delay. The Contractor shall maintain existing roads,
streets, sidewalks, driveways, and paths within the project limits, keeping them open, and in good,
clean, safe condition at all times. Deficiencies caused by the Contractor’s operations shall be repaired
at the Contractor’s expense. Deficiencies not caused by the Contractor’s operations shall be repaired
by the Contractor when directed by the Engineer, at the Contracting Agency’s expense. The
Contractor shall also maintain roads, streets, sidewalks, driveways, and paths adjacent to the project
limits when affected by the Contractor’s operations. Snow and ice control will be performed by the
Contracting Agency on all projects. Cleanup of snow and ice control debris will be at the Contracting
Agency’s expense. The Contractor shall perform the following:
1. Remove or repair any condition resulting from the Work that might impede traffic or create
a hazard.
2. Keep existing traffic signal and highway lighting systems in operation as the Work proceeds.
(The Contracting Agency will continue the route maintenance on such system.)
3. Maintain the striping on the roadway at the Contracting Agency’s expense. The Contractor
shall be responsible for scheduling when to renew striping, subject to the approval of the
Engineer. When the scope of the project does not require Work on the roadway, the
Contracting Agency will be responsible for maintaining the striping.
4. Maintain existing permanent signing. Repair of signs will be at the Contracting Agency’s
expense, except those damaged due to the Contractor’s operations.
5. Keep drainage structures clean to allow for free flow of water. Cleaning of existing drainage
structures will be at the Contracting Agency’s expense when approved by the Engineer, except
when flow is impaired due to the Contractor’s operations.
Section 1-07.23(1) is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall be responsible for controlling dust and mud within the project limits and on any
street, which is utilized by his equipment for the duration of the project. The Contractor shall be
prepared to use watering trucks, power sweepers, and other pieces of equipment as deemed
necessary by the Engineer, to avoid creating a nuisance.
Dust and mud control shall be considered as incidental to the project and no compensation will be
made for this section.
Complaints of dust, mud, or unsafe practices and/or property damage to private ownership will be
transmitted to the Contractor and prompt action in correcting them will be required by the
Contractor.
The Contractor shall maintain the roads during construction in a suitable condition to minimize affects
to vehicular and pedestrian traffic. All cost to maintain the roads shall be borne by the Contractor.
44
At least one-way traffic shall be maintained on all cross-streets within the project limits during
working hours. One lane shall be provided in each direction for all streets during non-working hours.
The Contractor shall provide one drivable roadway lane and maintain convenient access for local and
commuter traffic to driveways, businesses, and buildings along the line of Work throughout the course
of the project. Such access shall be maintained as near as possible to that which existed prior to the
commencement of construction. This restriction shall not apply to the paving portion of the
construction process.
The Contractor shall notify and coordinate with all property owners and tenants of street closures, or
other restrictions which may interfere with their access at least 24 hours in advance for single-family
residential property, and at least 48 hours in advance for apartments, offices, and commercial
property. The Contractor shall give a copy of all notices to the Engineer.
When the abutting owners’ access across the right-of-way line is to be eliminated and replaced under
the Contract by other access, the existing access shall not be closed until the replacement access
facility is available.
All unattended excavations shall be properly barricaded and covered at all times. The Contractor shall
not open any trenches that cannot be completed and refilled that same day. Trenches shall be patched
or covered by a temporary steel plate, at the Contractor’s expense, except in areas where the roadway
remains closed to public traffic. Steel plates must be anchored.
1-07.23(2) Construction and Maintenance of Detours
Revise the first paragraph to read:
(******)
Unless otherwise approved, the Contractor shall maintain two-way traffic during construction. The
Contractor shall build, maintain in a safe condition, keep open to traffic, and remove when no longer
needed:
1. Detours and detour bridges that will accommodate traffic diverted from the roadway, bridge,
sidewalk, driveway, or path during construction,
2. Detour crossings of intersecting highway, and
3. Temporary approaches.
1-07.24 Rights-of-Way
Delete this Section in its entirety, and replace it with the following:
(******)
Street right-of-way lines, limits of easements, and limits of construction permits are indicated on the
Drawings. The Contractor’s construction activities shall be confined within these limits unless
arrangements for use of private property are made.
Generally, the Contracting Agency will have obtained, prior to bid opening, all rights-of-way and
easements, both permanent and temporary, necessary for carrying out the completion of the Work.
Exceptions to this are noted in the Contract Documents or brought to the Contractor’s attention by a
duly issued addendum.
Whenever any of the Work is accomplished on or through property other than public right-of-way,
the Contractor shall meet and fulfill all covenants and stipulations of any easement agreement
45
obtained by the Contracting Agency from the owner of the private property. Copies of the easement
agreements are included in the Contract Provisions or made available to the Contractor as soon as
practical after they have been obtained by the Engineer.
Whenever easements or rights-of-entry have not been acquired prior to advertising, these areas are
so noted on the Drawings. The Contractor shall not proceed with any portion of the Work in areas
where right-of-way, easements, or rights-of-entry have not been acquired until the Engineer certifies
to the Contractor that the right-of-way or easement is available or that the right-of-entry had been
received. If the Contractor is delayed due to acts of omission on the part of the Contracting Agency in
obtaining easements, rights of entry of right-of-way, the Contractor will be entitled to an extension of
time. The Contractor agrees that such delay shall not be a breach of contract.
Each property owner shall be given 48 hours notice prior to entry by the Contactor. This includes entry
onto easements and private property where private improvements must be adjusted.
The Contractor shall be responsible for providing, without expense or liability of the Contracting
Agency, any additional land and access thereto that the Contractor may desire for temporary
construction facilities, storage of materials, or other Contractor needs. However, before using any
private property, whether adjoining the Work or not, the Contractor shall file with the Engineer a
written permission of the private property owner, and, upon vacating the premises, a written release
from the property owner of each property disturbed or otherwise interfered with by reasons of
construction pursued under this Contract. The statement shall be signed by the private property
owner, or proper authority acting for the owner of the private property affected, stating that
permission has been granted to use the property and all necessary permits have been obtained or, in
the case of a release, that the restoration of the property has been satisfactorily accomplished. The
statement shall include the parcel number, address and date of signature. Written releases must be
filed with the Engineer before the Completion Date will be established.
1-07.28 Confined Space Entry
Section 1-07.28 is new:
The Contractor shall:
1. Review and be familiar with the City’s Public Works Confined Space Entry Program.
2. Review documented information about the City confined spaces in which entry is intended as
listed and described in the City’s Attribute and Map Book. This information includes identified
hazards for each permit-required confined space.
3. Each contractor shall have their own confined space entry program. Upon request of the City
they will provide a statement confirming they are in compliance with their confined space
entry program including requirements for confined space training for employees associated
with the project in Renton.
4. Be responsible for following all confined space requirements established by the provisions in
WAC 296-809 and its chapters.
5. Coordinate entry operations with the City of Renton when employees from the contractor will
be working in or near City confined spaces.
6. Discuss entry operations with the City of Renton including the program followed during
confined space entry.
46
7. Debrief the City on any hazards confronted or created at the completion of entry operations.
8. Place signs stating, “Danger, Follow Confined Space Entry Procedure before Entering” at each
confined space to be entered. Never leave the confined space open and unattended.
The contractor’s or consultant’s point of contact with the City in regard to confined space entry will
be the City’s assigned construction inspector.
1-08 PROSECUTION AND PROGRESS
1-08.0 Preliminary Matters
Section 1-08.0 is a new section with subsections as follows:
(******)
1-08.0(1) Preconstruction Conference
Section 1-08.0(1) is a new subsection:
(******)
The Engineer will furnish the Contractor with copies of the Contract Documents per Section 1-02.2
“Plans and Specifications”. Additional documents may be furnished upon request at the cost of
reproduction. Prior to undertaking each part of the Work the Contractor shall carefully study and
compare the Contract Documents, and check and verify pertinent figures shown therein and all
applicable field measurements. The Contractor shall promptly report in writing to the Engineer any
conflict, error or discrepancy, which the Contractor may discover.
After the Contract has been executed, but prior to the Contractor beginning the Work, a
preconstruction conference will be held between the Contractor, the Engineer and such other
interested parties as may be invited.
The Contractor shall prepare and submit at minimum 3 days prior to the preconstruction meeting:
Contractor's plan of operation and progress schedule (3+ copies)
Contractor's Phasing Plan
Approval of qualified subcontractors (bring list of subcontractors if different from list
submitted with bid)
List of materials fabricated or manufactured off the project
Material sources on the project
Names of principal suppliers
Detailed equipment list, including “Rental Rate Blue Book” hourly costs (both working and
standby rates)
Weighted wage rates for all employee classifications anticipated to be used on Project
Cost percentage breakdown for lump sum bid item(s)
Shop Drawings (bring preliminary list)
Traffic Control Plans (3+ copies)
47
Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control (TESC) Plan, Stormwater Pollution Prevention
(SWPP) Plan, and Spill Prevention, Control, and Countermeasure (SPCC) Plan
In addition, the Contractor shall be prepared to address:
• Bonds and insurance
• Project meetings – schedule and responsibilities
• Provision for inspection for materials from outside sources
• Responsibility for locating utilities
• Responsibility for damage
• Time schedule for relocations, if by other than the Contractor
• Laydown and staging
• Compliance with Contract Documents
• Acceptance and approval of Work
• Labor compliance, payrolls, and certifications
• Safety regulations for the Contractors’ and the Owner's employees and representatives
• Suspension of Work, time extensions
• Change order procedures
• Progress estimates, procedures for payment
• Special requirements of funding agencies
• Construction engineering, advance notice of special Work
• Any interpretation of the Contract Documents requested by the Contractor
• Any conflicts or omissions in Contract Documents
• Any other problems or questions concerning the Work
• Processing and administration of public complaints
• Easements and rights-of-entry
• Other contracts
The franchise utilities may be present at the preconstruction conference, and the Contractor should be
prepared for their review and discussion of progress schedule and coordination.
1-08.0(2) Hours of Work
Section 1-08.0(2) is a new subsection:
(******)
Except in the case of emergency or unless otherwise approved by the Contracting Agency, the normal
straight time working hours for the Contract shall be any consecutive 8-hour period between 7:00
a.m. and 5:00 p.m. of a working day with a maximum 1-hour lunch break and a 5-day Work week. The
48
normal straight time 8-hour working period for the Contract shall be established at the
preconstruction conference or prior to the Contractor commencing the Work.
If a Contractor desires to perform Work on holidays, Saturdays, Sundays, or before 7:00 a.m. or after
5:00 p.m. on any day, the Contractor shall apply in writing to the Engineer for permission to Work
such times. Permission to Work longer than an 8-hour period between 7:00 a.m. and 5:00 p.m. is
required. Such requests shall be submitted to the Engineer no later than noon on the working day
prior to the day for which the Contractor is requesting permission to Work.
Permission to Work between the hours of 10:00 p.m. and 7:00 a.m. during weekdays and between
the hours of 10:00 p.m. and 7:00 a.m. on weekends or holidays may also be subject to noise control
requirements. Approval to continue Work during these hours may be revoked at any time the
Contractor exceeds the Contracting Agency’s noise control regulations or complaints are received
from the public or adjoining property owners regarding the noise from the Contractor’s operations.
The Contractor shall have no claim for damages or delays should such permission be revoked for these
reasons.
Permission to Work Saturdays, Sundays, holidays or other than the agreed upon normal straight time
working hours Monday through Friday may be given subject to certain other conditions set forth by
the Contracting Agency or the Engineer. These conditions may include but are not limited to: requiring
the Engineer or such assistants as the Engineer may deem necessary to be present during the Work;
requiring the Contractor to reimburse the Contracting Agency for the cost of engineering salaries paid
Contracting Agency employees who worked during such times; considering the Work performed on
Saturdays, Sundays, and holidays as working days with regards to the Contract Time; and considering
multiple Work shifts as multiple working days with respect to Contract Time even though the multiple
shifts occur in a single 24-hour period. Assistants may include, but are not limited to, survey crews;
personnel from the material testing labs; inspectors; and other Contracting Agency employees when
in the opinion of the Engineer such Work necessitates their presence.
1-08.0(3) Reimbursement for Overtime Work of Contracting Agency Employees
Section 1-08.0(3) is a new subsection:
(******)
Where the Contractor elects to Work on a Saturday, Sunday, holiday, or longer than an 8-hour Work
shift on a regular working day, as defined in the Standard Specifications, such Work shall be
considered as overtime Work. On all such overtime Work an inspector will be present, and a survey
crew may be required at the discretion of the Engineer. The Contractor shall reimburse the
Contracting Agency for the full amount of the straight time plus overtime costs for employees and
representative(s) of the Contracting Agency required to work overtime hours.
The Contractor by these Specifications does hereby authorize the Engineer to deduct such costs from
the amount due or to become due the Contractor.
1-08.1 Subcontracting
Section 1-08.1 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Written requests for change in subcontractors shall be submitted by the Contractor to the Engineer
at least seven (7) calendar days prior to start of a subcontractor's Work.
49
The Contractor agrees that he/she/they is(are) fully responsible to the Owner for the acts and
omissions of all subcontractors and lower-tier subcontractors and persons either directly or indirectly
employed by the subcontractors, as well as for the acts and omissions of persons directly employed
by the Contractor. The Contractor shall be required to give personal attention to the Work that is
sublet. Nothing contained in the Contract Documents shall create any contractual relation between
any subcontractor and the Owner.
The Contractor shall be responsible for making sure all subcontractors submit all required
documentation, forms, etc. prior to the commencement of subcontractor work.
1-08.1(7)A Payment Certification
Revise this section to read “Vacant”.
1-08.2 Assignment
The second paragraph of Section 1-08.2 is modified as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall not assign any moneys due or to become due to the Contractor hereunder
without the prior written consent of the Owner. The assignment, if approved, shall be subject to all
setoffs, withholdings, and deductions required by law and the Contract.
1-08.3 Progress Schedule
Section 1-08.3 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The progress schedule for the entire project shall be submitted in electronic format to the Engineer
three (3) days prior to the Preconstruction Conference. The schedule shall be prepared using the
critical path method (CPM), preferably using Microsoft Project or equivalent software. The schedule
shall contain this information, at a minimum:
1. Construction activities, in sufficient detail that all activities necessary to construct a complete
and functional project are considered. Any activity that has a scheduled duration exceeding
30 calendar days shall be subdivided until no sub-element has a duration exceeding 30
calendar days.
2. The schedule shall clearly indicate the activities that comprise the critical path. For each
activity not on the critical path, the schedule shall show the float, or slack, time.
3. Procurement of material and equipment.
4. Submittals requiring review by the Engineer. Submittal by the Contractor and review by the
Engineer shall be shown as separate activities.
5. Work to be performed by a subcontractor, agent, or any third party.
6. Allowances for delays that could result from normal inclement weather (time extensions due
to inclement weather will not be allowed).
7. Allowances for the time required by utilities (Owner’s and others) to locate, monitor, and
adjust their facilities as required.
50
The Engineer may request the Contractor to alter the progress schedule when deemed necessary in
the opinion of the Engineer, in the interest of public safety and welfare of the Owner, or for
coordination with any other activity of other contractors, the availability of all or portions of the job
site, or special provisions of this Contract, or to reasonably meet the completion date of the project.
The Contractor shall provide such revised schedule within 10 days of request.
If, at any time, in the opinion of the Engineer, the progress of construction falls significantly behind
schedule, the Contractor may be required to submit a plan for regaining progress and a revised
schedule indicating how the remaining Work items will be completed within the authorized contract
time.
The Contractor shall promptly report to the Engineer any conditions that the Contractor feels will
require revision of the schedule and shall promptly submit proposed revisions in the progress
schedule for acceptance by the Engineer. When such changes are accepted by the Engineer, the
revised schedule shall be followed by the Contractor.
Weekly Schedule. The Contractor shall submit a weekly progress schedule to the Engineer which sets
forth specific Work to be performed the following week, and a tentative schedule for the second
week.
Failure to Maintain Progress Schedule. The Engineer will check actual progress of the Work against
the progress schedule a minimum of two (2) times per month. Failure, without just cause, to maintain
progress in accordance with the approved schedule shall constitute a breach of Contract. If, through
no fault of the Contractor, the proposed construction schedule cannot be met, the Engineer will
require the Contractor to submit a revised schedule to the Engineer for acceptance. The approved
revisions will thereafter, in all respects, apply in lieu of the original schedule.
Failure of the Contractor to follow the progress schedule submitted and accepted, including revisions
thereof, shall relieve the Owner of any and all responsibility for furnishing and making available all or
any portion of the job site, and will relieve the Owner of any responsibility for delays to the Contractor
in the performance of the Work.
The cost of preparing the progress schedule, any supplementary progress schedules, and weekly
schedules shall be considered incidental to the Contract and no other compensation shall be made.
1-08.4 Prosecution of the Work
Section 1-08.4 is replaced with the following:
(******)
1-08.4 Notice to Proceed and Prosecution of the Work
Notice to Proceed will be given after the contract has been executed and the contract bond and
evidence of insurance have been approved and filed by the Contracting Agency. The Contractor shall
not commence with the work until the Notice to Proceed has been given by the Engineer. The
Contractor shall commence construction activities on the project site within ten (10) days of the
Notice to Proceed Date, unless otherwise approved in writing. The Work thereafter shall be
prosecuted diligently, vigorously, and without unauthorized interruption until physical completion of
the Work. There shall be no voluntary shutdowns or slowing of operations by the Contractor without
prior approval of the Engineer. Such approval shall not relieve the Contractor from the contractual
obligations to complete the work within the prescribed contract Time.
51
When shown in the Plans, the first order of work shall be the installation of high visibility fencing to
delineate all areas for protection or restoration, as described in the Contract. Installation of high
visibility fencing adjacent to the roadway shall occur after the placement of all necessary signs and
traffic control devices in accordance with 1-10.1(2). Upon construction of the fencing, the Contractor
shall request the Engineer to inspect the fence. No other work shall be performed on the site until the
Contracting Agency has accepted the installation of high visibility fencing, as described in the Contract.
Following acceptance of high visibility fencing Contractor shall install fencing to limit access.
1-08.5 Time For Completion
Revise the first paragraph in this section as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall complete all physical Contract Work within the number of “working days” stated
in the Contract Provisions or as extended by the Engineer in accordance with Section 1-08.8. Every
day will be counted as a “working day” unless it is a nonworking day or an Engineer determined
unworkable day. A nonworking day is defined as a Saturday, a Sunday, a whole or half day on which
the Contract specifically prohibits Work on the critical path of the Contractor’s approved progress
schedule, or one of these holidays: January 1, the third Monday of January, the third Monday of
February, Memorial Day, Juneteenth, July 4, Labor Day, Veteran’s Day, Thanksgiving Day, the day after
Thanksgiving, and Christmas Day. The day before Christmas shall be a holiday when Christmas Day
occurs on a Tuesday or Friday. The day after Christmas shall be a holiday when Christmas Day occurs
on a Monday, Wednesday, or Thursday. When Christmas Day occurs on a Saturday, the two preceding
working days shall be observed as holidays. When Christmas day occurs on a Sunday, the two working
days following shall be observed as holidays. When holidays other than Christmas fall on a Saturday,
the preceding Friday will be counted as a non-working day and when they fall on a Sunday the
following Monday will be counted as a non-working day.
Revise the third and fourth paragraphs to read:
(******)
Contract time shall begin on the first working day following the Notice to Proceed Date.
Each working day shall be charged to the contract as it occurs, until the contract work is physically
complete. If substantial completion has been granted and all the authorized working days have been
used, charging of working days will cease. Each week the Engineer will provide the Contractor a
statement that shows the number of working days: (1) charged to the contract the week before; (2)
specified for the physical completion of the contract; and (3) remaining for the physical completion of
the contract. The statement will also show the nonworking days and all partial or whole days the
Engineer declares as unworkable The statement will be identified as a Written Determination by the
Engineer. If the Contractor does not agree with the Written Determination of working days, the
Contractor shall pursue the protest procedures in accordance with Section 1-04.5. By failing to follow
the procedures of Section 1-04.5, the Contractor shall be deemed as having accepted the statement
as correct. If the Contractor is approved to work 10 hours a day and 4 days a week (a 4-10 schedule)
and the fifth day of the week in which a 4-10 shift is worked would ordinarily be charged as a working
day then the fifth day of that week will be charged as a working day whether or not the Contractor
works on that day.
52
Revise the sixth paragraph to read:
(******)
The Engineer will give the Contractor written notice of the completion date of the contract after all
the Contractor’s obligations under the contract have been performed by the Contractor. The following
events must occur before the Completion Date can be established:
1. The physical work on the project must be complete; and
2. The Contractor must furnish all documentation required by the contract and required by law,
to allow the Contracting Agency to process final acceptance of the contract. The following
documents must be received by the Engineer prior to establishing a completion date:
a. Certified Payrolls (per Section 1-07.9(5)).
b. Material Acceptance Certification Documents.
c. Monthly Reports of Amounts Credited as DBE Participation, as required by the Contract
Provisions.
d. Final Contract Voucher Certification.
e. Copies of the approved “Affidavit of Prevailing Wages Paid” for the Contractor and all
Subcontractors.
f. A copy of the Notice of Termination sent to the Washington State Department of Ecology
(Ecology); the elapse of 30 calendar days from the date of receipt of the Notice of
Termination by Ecology; and no rejection of the Notice of Termination by Ecology. This
requirement will not apply if the Construction Stormwater General Permit is transferred
back to the Contracting Agency in accordance with Section 8-01.3(16).
g. Property owner releases per Section 1-07.24.
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
The requirements for scheduling the Final Inspection and establishing the Substantial Completion,
Physical Completion, and Completion Dates are specified in Sections 1-05.11 and 1-05.12.
Within 10 calendar days after execution of the Contract by the Contracting Agency, the Contractor
shall provide the Contracting Agency with copies of purchase orders for all equipment items deemed
critical by the Contracting Agency, including but not limited to signal controller materials, lighting
standards, and signal standards required for the physical completion of the Contract. Such purchase
orders shall disclose the estimated delivery dates for the equipment.
All items of Work that can be performed without delivery of the critical items shall start and be
completed as soon as possible. At that time, the Engineer may suspend the Work upon request of the
Contractor until the critical items are delivered to the Contractor, if the Contracting Agency received
a purchase order within 10 calendar days after execution of the Contract by the Contracting Agency.
The Contractor will be entitled to only one such suspension of time during the performance of the
Work and during such suspension shall not perform any additional Work on the project. Upon delivery
of the critical items, contract time will resume and continue to be charged in accordance with Section
1-08.
53
1-08.6 Suspension of Work
Section 1-08.6 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Owner may at any time suspend the Work, or any part thereof, by giving notice to the Contractor in
writing. The Work shall be resumed by the Contractor within 14 calendar days after the date fixed in
the written notice from the Owner to the Contractor to do so.
The Contractor shall not suspend Work under the Contract without the written order of the Owner.
If it has been determined that the Contractor is entitled to an extension of time, the amount of such
extension shall be only to compensate for direct delays, and shall be based upon the Contractor's
diligently pursuing the Work at a rate not less than that which would have been necessary to complete
the original Contract Work on time.
1-08.7 Maintenance During Suspension
Revise the second paragraph to read:
(******)
At no expense to the Contracting Agency, the Contractor shall provide through the construction area
a safe, smooth, and unobstructed roadway, sidewalk, driveway, and path for public use during
suspension (as required in Section 1-07.23 or the Special Provisions). This may include a temporary
road or detour.
1-08.9 Liquidated Damages
Revise the second and third paragraphs to read:
(******)
Accordingly, the Contractor agrees:
1. To pay (according to the following formula) liquidated damages for each working day beyond
the number of working days established for Physical Completion, and
2. To authorize the Engineer to deduct these liquidated damages from any money due or coming
due to the Contractor.
Liquidated Damages Formula
LD = 0.15 C / T
Where:
LD = liquidated damages per working day (rounded to the nearest dollar)
C = original Contract amount
T = original time for Physical Completion
When the Contract Work has progressed to Substantial Completion as defined in the Contract, the
Engineer may determine the Contract Work is Substantially Complete. The Engineer will notify the
Contractor in writing of the Substantial Completion Date. For overruns in Contract time occurring after
the date so established, the formula for liquidated damages shown above will not apply. For overruns
in Contract time occurring after the Substantial Completion Date, liquidated damages shall be
assessed on the basis of direct engineering and related costs assignable to the project until the actual
54
Physical Completion Date of all the Contract Work. The Contractor shall complete the remaining Work
as promptly as possible. Upon request by the Engineer, the Contractor shall furnish a written schedule
for completing the physical Work on the Contract.
Section 1-08.9 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
In addition, the Contractor shall compensate the Owner for actual engineering inspection and
supervision costs and any other expenses and legal fees incurred by the Owner as a result of such
delay. Such labor costs will be billed to the Contractor at actual costs, including administrative
overhead costs.
In the event that the Owner is required to commence any lawsuit in order to enforce any provision of
this Contract or to seek redress for any breach thereof, the Owner shall be entitled to recover its costs,
including reasonable attorney’s fees, from the Contractor.
1-08.11 Contractor's Plant and Equipment
Section 1-08.11 is a new Section:
(******)
The Contractor alone shall at all times be responsible for the adequacy, efficiency, and sufficiency of
his and his subcontractor's plant and equipment. The Owner shall have the right to make use of the
Contractor's plant and equipment in the performance of any Work on the site of the Work.
The use by the Owner of such plant and equipment shall be considered as extra Work and paid for
accordingly.
Neither the Owner nor the Engineer assumes any responsibility, at any time, for the security of the
site from the time the Contractor's operations have commenced until final acceptance of the Work
by the Engineer and the Owner. The Contractor shall employ such measures as additional fencing,
barricades, and watchmen service, as he deems necessary for the public safety and for the protection
of the site and his plant and equipment. The Owner will be provided keys for all fenced, secured areas.
1-08.12 Attention to Work
Section 1-08.12 is a new section:
(******)
The Contractor shall give his personal attention to and shall supervise the Work to the end that it shall
be prosecuted faithfully, and when he is not personally present on the Work site, he shall at all times
be represented by a competent superintendent who shall have full authority to execute the same,
and to supply materials, tools, and labor without delay, and who shall be the legal representative of
the Contractor. The Contractor shall be liable for the faithful observance of any instructions delivered
to him or to his authorized representative.
55
1-09 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
1-09.1 Measurement of Quantities
Section 1-09.1 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Lump Sum. The percentage of lump sum Work completed, and payment will be based on the cost
percentage breakdown of the lump sum bid price(s) submitted at the preconstruction conference.
The Contractor shall submit a breakdown of costs for each lump sum bid item. The breakdown shall
list the items included in the lump sum together with a unit price of labor, materials, and equipment
for each item. The summation of the detailed unit prices for each item shall add up to the lump sum
bid. The unit price values may be used as a guideline for determining progress payments or deductions
or additions in payment for ordered Work changes.
Cubic Yard Quantities. The Contractor shall provide truck trip tickets for progress payments only in
the following manner. Where items are specified to be paid by the cubic yard, the following tally
system shall be used.
All trucks to be employed on this Work will be measured to determine the volume of each truck. Each
truck shall be clearly numbered, to the satisfaction of the Engineer, and there shall be no duplication
of numbers.
Duplicate tally tickets shall be prepared to accompany each truckload of material delivered on the
project. All tickets received that do not contain the following information will not be processed for
payment:
1. Truck number
2. Quantity and type of material delivered in cubic yards
3. Drivers name, date and time of delivery
4. Location of delivery, by street and stationing on each street
5. Place for the Engineer to acknowledge receipt
6. Pay item number
7. Contract number and/or name
It will be the Contractor's responsibility to see that a ticket is given to the Engineer on the project for
each truckload of material delivered. Pay quantities will be prepared on the basis of said tally tickets.
Loads will be checked by the Engineer to verify quantity shown on ticket.
Quantities by Ton. It will be the Contractor's responsibility to see that a certified weight ticket is given
to the Inspector on the project at the time of delivery of materials for each truckload delivered. Pay
quantities will be prepared on the basis of said tally tickets, delivered to Inspector at time of delivery
of materials. Tickets not receipted by Inspector will not be honored for payment.
Each truck shall be clearly numbered to the satisfaction of the Engineer and there shall be no
duplication of numbers.
56
Duplicate tickets shall be prepared to accompany each truckload of material delivered to the project.
All tickets received that do not contain the following information will not be processed for payment:
1. Truck number
2. Truck tare weight (stamped at source)
3. Gross truckload weight in tons (stamped at source)
4. Net load weight (stamped at source)
5. Driver's name, date, and time of delivery
6. Location for delivery by street and stationing on each street
7. Place for the Engineer to acknowledge receipt
8. Pay item number
9. Contract number and/or name
1-09.2 Weighing Equipment
1-09.2(1) General Requirements for Weighing Equipment
Revise item 4 of the fifth paragraph in this section as follows:
(******)
Test results and scale weight records for each day’s hauling operations are provided to the Engineer
daily. Reporting shall utilize WSDOT form 422-027, Scaleman’s Daily Report, unless the printed ticket
contains the same information that is on the Scaleman’s Daily Report Form. The scale operator must
provide AM and/or PM tare weights for each truck on the printed ticket.
1-09.2(5) Measurement
Revise the first paragraph to read:
(******)
Scale Verification Checks – At the Engineer’s discretion, the Engineer may perform verification checks
on the accuracy of each batch, hopper, or platform scale used in weighing contract items of Work.
1-09.3 Scope of Payment
Section 1-09.3 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
The bid items listed in Section 1-09.14 will be the only items for which compensation will be made for
the Work described in each section of the Standard Specifications when the Contractor performs the
specified Work. Should a bid item be listed in a “Payment” clause but not in the Proposal Form, and
Work for that item is performed by the Contractor and the Work is not stated as included in or
incidental to a pay item in the Contract and is not Work that would be required to complete the intent
of the Contract per Section 1-04.1, then payment for that Work will be made as for Extra Work
pursuant to a Change Order.
The words “Bid Item,” “Contract Item,” and “Pay Item,” and similar terms used throughout the
Contract Documents are synonymous.
57
If the “payment” clause in the Specifications relating to any unit bid item price in the Proposal Form
requires that said unit bid item price cover and be considered compensation for certain Work or
material essential to the item, then the Work or material will not be measured or paid for under any
other unit bid item which may appear elsewhere in the Proposal Form or Specifications.
Pluralized unit bid items appearing in these Specifications are changed to singular form.
Payment for bid items listed or referenced in the “Payment” clause of any particular section of the
Specifications shall be considered as including all of the Work required, specified, or described in that
particular section. Payment items will generally be listed generically in the Specifications, and
specifically in the bid form. When items are to be “furnished” under one payment item and “installed”
under another payment item, such items shall be furnished FOB project site, or, if specified in the
Special Provisions, delivered to a designated site. Materials to be “furnished,” or “furnished and
installed” under these conditions, shall be the responsibility of the Contractor with regard to storage
until such items are incorporated into the Work or, if such items are not to be incorporated into the
Work, delivered to the applicable Contracting Agency storage site when provided for in the
Specifications. Payment for material “furnished,” but not yet incorporated into the Work, may be
made on monthly estimates to the extent allowed.
1-09.6 Force Account
Section 1-09.6 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contracting Agency has estimated and included in the Proposal, dollar amounts for all items to
be paid per force account, only to provide a common proposal for Bidders. All such dollar amounts
are to become a part of Contractor's total bid. However, the Contracting Agency does not warrant
expressly or by implication, that the actual amount of work will correspond with those estimates.
Payment will be made on the basis of the amount of work actually authorized by Engineer.
1-09.7 Mobilization
Section 1-09.7 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Mobilization shall also include, but not be limited to, the following items: the movement of
Contractor's personnel, equipment, supplies, and incidentals to and from the project site; the
establishment of an office, buildings, and other facilities necessary for Work on the project; providing
sanitary facilities for the Contractor's personnel; and obtaining permits or licenses required to
complete the project not furnished by the Owner.
Payment will be made for the following bid item(s):
“Mobilization & Demobilization,” Lump Sum.
1-09.9 Payments
Section 1-09.9 is revised as follows:
(******)
The basis of payment will be the actual quantities of Work performed according to the Contract and
as specified for payment.
58
The Contractor shall submit a breakdown of the cost of lump sum bid items at the Preconstruction
Conference, to enable the Engineer to determine the Work performed on a monthly basis. A
breakdown is not required for lump sum items that include a basis for incremental payments as part
of the respective Specification. Absent a lump sum breakdown, the Engineer will make a
determination based on information available. The Engineer’s determination of the cost of work shall
be final.
Progress payments for completed work and material on hand will be based upon progress estimates
prepared by the Engineer. A progress estimate cutoff date will be established at the preconstruction
conference.
The initial progress estimate will be made not later than 30 days after the Contractor commences the
work, and successive progress estimates will be made every month thereafter until the Completion
Date. Progress estimates made during progress of the work are tentative, and made only for the
purpose of determining progress payments. The progress estimates are subject to change at any time
prior to the calculation of the final payment.
The value of the progress estimate will be the sum of the following:
1. Unit Price Items in the Bid Form — the approximate quantity of acceptable units of work
completed multiplied by the unit price.
2. Lump Sum Items in the Bid Form — based on the approved Contractor’s lump sum breakdown
for that item, or absent such a breakdown, based on the Engineer’s determination.
3. Materials on Hand — 100 percent of invoiced cost of material delivered to Job site or other
storage area approved by the Engineer.
4. Change Orders — entitlement for approved extra cost or completed extra work as determined
by the Engineer.
Progress payments will be made in accordance with the progress estimate less:
1. Retainage per Section 1-09.9(1), on non FHWA-funded projects;
2. The amount of progress payments previously made; and
3. Funds withheld by the Contracting Agency for disbursement in accordance with the Contract
Documents.
Progress payments for work performed shall not be evidence of acceptable performance or an
admission by the Contracting Agency that any work has been satisfactorily completed. The
determination of payments under the contract will be final in accordance with Section 1-05.1.
Failure to perform obligations under the Contract by the Contractor may be decreed by the
Contracting Agency to be adequate reason for withholding any payments until compliance is achieved.
Upon completion of all Work and after final inspection (Section 1-05.11), the amount due the
Contractor under the Contract will be paid based upon the final estimate made by the Engineer and
presentation of a Final Contract Voucher Certification to be signed by the Contractor. The Contractor's
signature on such voucher shall be deemed a release of all claims of the Contractor unless a Certified
Claim is filed in accordance with the requirements of Section 1-09.11 and is expressly excepted from
the Contractor’s certification on the Final Contract Voucher Certification. The date the Contracting
Agency signs the Final Contract Voucher Certification constitutes the final acceptance date (Section
1-05.12).
59
If the Contractor fails, refuses, or is unable to sign and return the Final Contract Voucher Certification
or any other documentation required for completion and final acceptance of the Contract, the
Contracting Agency reserves the right to establish a Completion Date (for the purpose of meeting the
requirements of RCW 60.28) and unilaterally accept the Contract. Unilateral final acceptance will
occur only after the Contractor has been provided the opportunity, by written request from the
Engineer, to voluntarily submit such documents. If voluntary compliance is not achieved, formal
notification of the impending establishment of a Completion Date and unilateral final acceptance will
be provided by email with delivery confirmation from the Contracting Agency to the Contractor, which
will provide 30 calendar days for the Contractor to submit the necessary documents. The 30 calendar
day period will begin on the date the email with delivery confirmation is received by the Contractor.
The date the Contracting Agency unilaterally signs the Final Contract Voucher Certification shall
constitute the Completion Date and the final acceptance date (Section 1-05.12). The reservation by
the Contracting Agency to unilaterally accept the Contract will apply to Contracts that are Physically
Completed in accordance with Section 1-08.5, or for Contracts that are terminated in accordance with
Section 1-08.10. Unilateral final acceptance of the Contract by the Contracting Agency does not in any
way relieve the Contractor of their responsibility to comply with all Federal, State, tribal, or local laws,
ordinances, and regulations that affect the Work under the Contract.
Payment to the Contractor of partial estimates, final estimates, and retained percentages shall be
subject to controlling laws.
Section 1-09.9 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Applications for payment shall be itemized and supported to the extent required by the Engineer by
receipts or other vouchers showing payment for materials and labor, payments to subcontractors,
and other such evidence of the Contractor's right to payment as the Engineer may direct, including
“red line” as-built drawings showing work installed by the contractor during the progress payment
period.
The Contractor shall submit a progress report with each monthly request for a progress payment. The
progress report shall indicate the estimated percent complete for each activity listed on the progress
schedule (see Section 1-08.3) and a revised and updated schedule to reflect the most current project
completion date.
1-09.9(1) Retainage
Section 1-09.9(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The retained amount shall be released as stated in the Standard Specifications if no claims have been
filed against such funds as provided by law, and if the Owner has no unsatisfied claims against the
Contractor. In the event claims are filed, the Owner shall withhold, until such claims are satisfied, a
sum sufficient to satisfy all claims and to pay attorney's fees. In addition, the Owner shall withhold
such amount as is required to satisfy any claims by the Owner against the Contractor, until such claims
have been finally settled.
Neither the final payment nor any part of the retained percentage shall become due until the
Contractor, if requested, delivers to the Owner a complete release of all liens arising out of this
Contract, or receipts in full in lieu thereof, and, if required in either case, an affidavit that so far as the
Contractor has knowledge or information, the release and receipts include all labor and materials for
60
which a lien could be filed: but the Contractor may, if any subcontractor refuses to furnish a release
or receipt in full, furnish a bond satisfactorily to the Engineer to indemnify the Owner against the lien.
If any lien remains unsatisfied after all payments are made, the Contractor shall reimburse to the
Owner all monies that the latter may be compelled to pay in discharging such lien, including all costs
and reasonable engineer's and attorney's fees.
1-09.9(2) Contracting Agency’s Right to Withhold and Disburse Certain Amounts
Section 1-09.9(2) is a new section:
(******)
In addition to monies retained pursuant to RCW 60.28 and subject to RCW 39.04.250, RCW 39.12 and
RCW 39.76, the Contractor authorizes the Engineer to withhold progress payments due or deduct an
amount from any payment or payments due the Contractor which, in the Engineer’s opinion, may be
necessary to cover the Contracting Agency’s costs for or to remedy the following situations:
1. Damage to another contractor when there is evidence thereof and a claim has been filed.
2. Where the Contractor has not paid fees or charges to public authorities of municipalities,
which the Contractor is obligated to pay.
3. Utilizing material tested and inspected by the Engineer, for purposes not connected with the
Work (Section 1-05.6).
4. Landscape damage assessments per Section 1-07.16.
5. For overtime Work performed by City personnel per Section 1-08.0(3).
6. Anticipated or actual failure of the Contractor to complete the Work on time:
a. Per Section 1-08.9 Liquidated Damages; or
b. Lack of construction progress based upon the Engineer’s review of the Contractor’s
approved progress schedule, which indicates the Work will not be complete within the
contract time. When calculating an anticipated time overrun, the Engineer will make
allowances for weather delays, approved unavoidable delays, and suspensions of the
Work. The amount withheld under this subparagraph will be based upon the liquidated
damages amount per day set forth in Contract Documents multiplied by the number of
days the Contractor’s approved progress schedule, in the opinion of the Engineer,
indicates the Contract may exceed the Contract Time.
7. Failure of the Contractor to perform any of the Contractor’s other obligations under the
Contract, including but not limited to:
a. Failure of the Contractor to provide the Engineer with a field office when required by the
Contract Provisions.
b. Failure of the Contractor to protect survey stakes, markers, etc., or to provide adequate
survey Work as required by Section 1-05.4.
c. Failure of the Contractor to correct defective or unauthorized Work (Section 1-05.7).
d. Failure of the Contractor to furnish a Manufacture’s Certificate of Compliance in lieu of
material testing and inspection as required by Section 1-06.3.
61
e. Failure to submit weekly payrolls, Intent to Pay Prevailing Wage forms, or correct
underpayment to employees of the Contractor or subcontractor of any tier as required
by Section 1-07.9.
f. Failure of the Contractor to pay worker’s benefits (Title 50 and Title 51 RCW) as required
by Section 1-07.10.
g. Failure of the Contractor to submit and obtain approval of a progress schedule per Section
1-08.3.
The Contractor authorizes the Engineer to act as agent for the Contractor disbursing such funds as
have been withheld pursuant to this Section to a party or parties who are entitled to payment.
Disbursement of such funds, if the Engineer elects to do so will be made only after giving the
Contractor 15 calendar days prior written notice of the Contracting Agency’s intent to do so, and if
prior to the expiration of the 15-calendar day period,
1. No legal action has commenced to resolve the validity of the claims, and
2. The Contractor has not protested such disbursement.
A proper accounting of all funds disbursed on behalf of the Contractor in accordance with this Section
will be made. A payment made pursuant to this section shall be considered as payment made under
the terms and conditions of the Contract. The Contracting Agency shall not be liable to the Contractor
for such payment made in good faith.
1-09.9(3) Final Payment
Section 1-09.9(3) is a new section:
(******)
Upon Acceptance of the Work by the Contracting Agency, the final amount to be paid the Contactor
will be calculated based upon a Final Progress Estimate made by the Engineer. Acceptance by the
Contractor of the final payment shall be and shall operate as a release:
1. To the Contracting Agency of all claims and all liabilities of the Contractor, other than claims
in stated amounts as may be specifically excepted in writing by the Contractor;
2. For all things done or furnished in connection with the Work;
3. For every act and neglect by the Contracting Agency; and
4. For all other claims and liability relating to or arising out of the Work.
A payment (monthly, final, retainage, or otherwise) shall not release the Contractor or the
Contractor’s Surety from any obligation required under the terms of the Contract Documents or the
Contract Bond; nor shall such payment constitute a waiver of the Contracting Agency’s ability to
investigate and act upon findings of non-compliance with the WMBE requirements of the Contract;
nor shall such payment preclude the Contracting Agency from recovering damages, setting penalties,
or obtaining such other remedies as may be permitted by law.
Before the Work will be accepted by the Contracting Agency, the Contractor shall submit an affidavit,
on the form provided by the Engineer, of amounts paid to certified disadvantaged (DB), minority
(MBE) or women business enterprises (WBE) participating in the Work. Such affidavit shall certify the
amounts paid to the DB, MBE or WBE subcontractors regardless of tier.
62
On federally funded projects the Contractor may also be required to execute and furnish the
Contracting Agency an affidavit certifying that the Contractor has not extended any loans, gratuity or
gift and money pursuant to Section 1-07.19 of these Specifications.
If the Contractor fails, refuses, or is unable to sign and return the Final Progress Estimate or any other
documents required for the final acceptance of the Contract, the Contracting Agency reserves the
right to establish a completion date and unilaterally accept the Contract. Unilateral acceptance will
occur only after the Contractor has been provided the opportunity, by written request from the
Engineer, to voluntarily submit such documents. If voluntary compliance is not achieved, formal
notification of the impending unilateral acceptance will be provided by certified letter from the
Engineer to the Contractor that will provide 30 calendar days for the Contractor to submit the
necessary documents. The 30-calendar day deadline shall begin on the date of the postmark of the
certified letter from the Engineer requesting the necessary documents. This reservation by the
Contracting Agency to unilaterally accept the Contract will apply to contracts that are completed in
accordance with Section 1-08.5 for contracts that are terminated in accordance with Section 1-08.10.
Unilateral acceptance of the Contract by the Contracting Agency does not in any way relieve the
Contractor of the provisions under contract or of the responsibility to comply with all laws,
ordinances, and federal, state, and local regulations that affect the Contract. The date the Contracting
Agency unilaterally signs the Final Progress Estimate constitutes the final acceptance date (Section
1-05.12).
1-09.11 Disputes and Claims
1-09.11(2) Claims
Paragraph 5 is revised as follows:
(******)
Failure to submit with the Final Application for Payment such information and details as described in
this section for any claim shall operate as a waiver of the claims by the Contractor as provided in
Section 1-09.9.
1-09.11(3) Time Limitations and Jurisdiction
Revised this section as read:
(******)
For the convenience of the parties to the Contract it is mutually agreed by the parties that all claims
or causes of action which the Contractor has against the Contracting Agency arising from the Contract
shall be brought within 180 calendar days from the date of final acceptance (Section 1-05.12) of the
Contract by the Contracting Agency; and it is further agreed that all such claims or causes of action
shall be brought only in the Superior Court of the county where the Contracting Agency headquarters
is located, provided that where an action is asserted against a county, RCW 36.01.050 shall control
venue and jurisdiction. The parties understand and agree that the Contractor’s failure to bring suit
within the time period provided, shall be a complete bar to all such claims or causes of action. It is
further mutually agreed by the parties that when claims or causes of action which the Contractor
asserts against the Contracting Agency arising from the Contract are filed with the Contracting Agency
or initiated in court, the Contractor shall permit the Contracting Agency to have timely access to all
records deemed necessary by the Contracting Agency to assist in evaluating the claims or action.
63
1-09.13 Claims Resolutions
1-09.13(1)A General
Revise this section to read:
(******)
Prior to seeking claims resolution through arbitration or litigation, the Contractor shall proceed in
accordance with Sections 1-04.5 and 1-09.11. The provisions of Sections 1-04.5 and 1-09.11 must be
complied with in full as a condition precedent to the Contractor’s right to seek claim resolution
through binding arbitration or litigation.
Any claims or causes of action which the Contractor has against the Contracting Agency arising from
the Contract shall be resolved, as prescribed herein, through binding arbitration or litigation.
The Contractor and the Contracting Agency mutually agree that those claims or causes of action which
total $1,000,000 or less, which are not resolved by mediation, shall be resolved through litigation
unless the parties mutually agree in writing to resolve the claim through binding arbitration.
The Contractor and the Contracting Agency mutually agree that those claims or causes of action in
excess of $1,000,000, which are not resolved by mediation, shall be resolved through litigation unless
the parties mutually agree in writing to resolve the claim through binding arbitration.
1-09.13(3)A Arbitration General
Revise the third paragraph to read:
(******)
The Contracting Agency and the Contractor mutually agree to be bound by the decision of the
arbitrator, and judgment upon the award rendered by the arbitrator may be entered in the Superior
Court of the county in which the Contracting Agency’s headquarters is located, provided that where
claims subject to arbitration are asserted against a county, RCW 36.01.050 shall control venue and
jurisdiction of the Superior Court. The decision of the arbitrator and the specific basis for the decision
shall be in writing. The arbitrator shall use the Contract as a basis for decisions.
1-09.13(3)B Procedures to Initiate Arbitration
Section 1-09.13(3)B is supplemented by adding:
(******)
The findings and decision of the board of arbitrators shall be final and binding on the parties, unless
the aggrieved party, within 10 days, challenges the findings and decision by serving and filing a petition
for review by the superior court of King County, Washington. The grounds for the petition for review
are limited to showing that the findings and decision:
1. Are not responsive to the questions submitted;
2. Is contrary to the terms of the contract or any component thereof;
3. Is arbitrary and/or is not based upon the applicable facts and the law controlling the issues
submitted to arbitration. The board of arbitrators shall support its decision by setting forth
in writing their findings and conclusions based on the evidence adduced at any such hearing.
The arbitration shall be conducted in accordance with the statutes of the State of Washington and
court decisions governing such procedure.
64
The costs of such arbitration shall be borne equally by the City and the Contractor unless it is the
board's majority opinion that the Contractor's filing of the protest or action is capricious or without
reasonable foundation. In the latter case, all costs shall be borne by the Contractor.
1-09.13(4) Venue for Litigation
Revise this section to read:
(******)
Litigation shall be brought in the Superior Court of the county in which the Contracting Agency’s
headquarters is located, provided that where claims are asserted against a county, RCW 36.01.050
shall control venue and jurisdiction of the Superior Court. It is mutually agreed by the parties that
when litigation occurs, the Contractor shall permit the Contracting Agency to have timely access to all
records deemed necessary by the Contracting Agency to assist in evaluating the claims or action.
1-09.14 Payment Schedule
Measurement and Payment Schedule for Bid Items in this Project Proposal.
Section 1-09.14 is a new section:
(******)
GENERAL
1-09.14(1) Scope
Section 1-09.14(1) is a new section:
(******)
A. Payment for the various items of the bid sheets, as further specified herein, shall include all
compensation to be received by the Contractor for furnishing all tools, equipment, supplies,
and manufactured articles, and for all labor, operations, and incidentals appurtenant to the
items of Work being described, as necessary to complete the various items of the Work all in
accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents, including all appurtenances
thereto, and including all costs of compliance with the regulations of public agencies having
jurisdiction, including Safety and Health Administration of the U.S. Department of Labor
(OSHA). No separate payment will be made for any item that is not specifically set forth in the
Bid Schedules, and all costs therefore shall be included in the prices named in the Bid
Schedules for the various appurtenant items of Work.
B. The Owner shall not pay for material quantities, which exceed the actual measured amount
used and approved by the Engineer.
C. It is the intention of these Specifications that the performance of all Work under the bid for
each item shall result in the complete construction, in an accepted operating condition, of
each item.
D. Work and material not specifically listed in the proposal but required in the Plans,
Specifications, and general construction practice, shall be included in the bid price. No
separate payment will be made for these incidental items.
65
1-09.14(2) Bid Items
Section 1-09.14(2) is a new section:
(******)
This section describes the bid items. Measurement and Payment, where described in a bid item,
shall supersede Measurement and Payment listed in other sections of the Special Provisions
and Standard Specifications.
All bid items under “Schedule A – General”, “Schedule C – Sanitary Sewer” & “Schedule D – Water”
shall follow State Sales Tax – Rule 170 per Section 1-07.2(3). All bid items under “Schedule B –
Stormwater” shall follow State Sales Tax – Rule 171 per Section 1-07.2(2).
1-09.14(2)A Bid Items Specific to Schedule A – General
1-09.14(2)A1 Mobilization & Demobilization (Maximum Bid 10% of Schedule Total) (Bid Item A01) – Lump Sum
Measurement for "Mobilization & Demobilization” will be lump sum. The lump sum price shown
will cover the complete cost of furnishing and installing, complete and in-place all Work and
materials necessary to move and organize equipment and personnel onto the job site, provide
and maintain all necessary support facilities and utilities, obtain all necessary permits and licenses,
prepare the site for construction operations, and maintain the site and surrounding areas during
construction, provide protection of existing utilities, provide component and system testing, and
move all personnel and equipment off the site after contract completion. Also included shall be a
Type B Progress Schedule and weekly look ahead schedules.
The Contractor shall prepare a Mobilization Plan showing the proposed location for storage of all
equipment and material proposed to be located at the site. Storage shall not interfere with use
of the City ROW and commercial and residential access.
For any proposed storage on private property outside the easement or work area, the Contractor
shall obtain a Temporary Use Permit for storage areas on private property. The Contractor shall
be responsible for all fees, applications, and work needed to obtain the permit.
The Contractor shall prepare a Work Plan that shall include the following:
A. Proposed Construction Sequence and Schedule including a Type B Progress Schedule for
all major items of work.
B. Mobilization Plan showing the proposed location for storage of all equipment and
materials.
C. Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control Plan for all stages of the project
D. Provisions for cleaning and sweeping of any impacted roadways.
E. Trench Excavation Safety Systems plan/provisions.
F. Identify Disposal Sites for various waste materials and provide copies of the site’s permits,
licenses, and approvals.
The Work Plan shall be submitted to the City for review and approval at minimum 3 days prior to
the pre-construction meeting.
66
Payment for “Mobilization & Demobilization” will be made at the lump sum amount bid (NOT to
exceed 80% of bid price prior to completion of construction) based on the percent of completed
Work as defined in the 2023 Standard Specifications for Road, Bridge, and Municipal Construction
(WSDOT) for mobilization. Payment for the remaining 20% will be made upon completion and
final clean-up of the construction site. Such payment will be complete compensation for all
mobilization of employees, equipment and materials, Mobilization Plan, Work Plan, preparation
of all necessary submittals, bonds, insurance, site improvements, permits, clean-up, safety plan,
and other plans/submittals not specifically covered in bid items, etc. all in conformance with the
Contract Documents.
This bid item may not be more than:
• For Bid Schedule B: ten percent (10%) of the total amount of Bid for the schedule.
• For Bid Schedules A, C, & D: ten percent (10%) of the total amount of Bid for the schedule
excluding sales tax.
1-09.14(2)A2 Construction Surveying, Staking, and As-Built Drawings (Bid Item A02) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Construction Surveying, Staking and As-Built Drawings” will be per the lump
sum bid price and based on the percentage of total Work complete, by dollar value, at the time
of measurement in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment may be prorated over the construction period based on the amount of work completed
for construction surveying, staking and as-built drawings.
Survey will be per Special Provision Section 1-05.4 and City of Renton Surveying Standards in
Special Provision Section 1-11. The as-built survey will be per Special Provisions Section 1-11. The
contractor shall provide the City with a set of redline drawings with the as-built locations and
elevations of all new utilities and construction work.
Payment for “Construction Surveying, Staking and As-Built Drawings” will be complete
compensation for all labor, materials, equipment, tools, all incidental work needed to provide
construction surveying and of the improvements (including providing a Washington State licensed
surveyor for said work), staking in advance of pipe laying, fittings and structure installation,
surveying the horizontal and vertical locations of all potholed existing utilities within the work
area, verification and recording of the elevations of existing roadway centerline, crown, and edge
of pavement to ensure that all roadways can be reconstructed to existing grade, and preparation
of cut-sheets. Said payment will be complete compensation for all labor, materials, equipment,
tools, all incidental work needed to provide as-built surveying, preparing “red line” as-built
drawings for pay estimate submittal with fittings and dimensions of existing and proposed
facilities installed or encountered during the pay period, furnishing an electronic file with
construction drawings stamped and signed by a licensed land surveyor that contains the as-built
information and copies of field notes, and furnishing and resetting property corners when
disturbed by the contractor’s activities. No more than 50% of the bid amount for this item shall
be paid prior to the review and acceptance of the as-constructed information by the Engineer.
1-09.14(2)A3 Project Temporary Traffic Control (Bid Item A03) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Project Temporary Traffic Control” will be per the lump sum bid price and
based on the percentage of total work complete, by dollar value, at the time of measurement in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
67
Payment for “Project Temporary Traffic Control” will be made at the measured percentage
amount for the pay period times the lump sum bid amount. Payment will be complete
compensation for preparing and submitting a traffic control plan and pedestrian handling plan as
well as all labor, tools, materials, equipment used in accordance with the approved Traffic Control
Plan and pedestrian handling plan that is not included in other bid items. The Lump Sum contract
price shall be full pay for all costs for performing the work described in Section 1-10, and in the
Traffic Control Information. Payment shall include but not be limited to providing for public
convenience and safety, flaggers, traffic control supervisor, construction signs, detours,
barricades, sequential arrow boards, a minimum of two Portable Changeable Message Signs,
traffic control devices, temporary striping, cleanup, etc. required to complete this item of Work
in conformance with the Contract Documents and the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices
(MUTCD) and as directed by the Engineer and by the City’s Transportation Department. Also,
included in the contract price is the cost to furnish traffic control services and equipment for
construction surveying, staking, and as-built plans.
All adjustments to the Traffic Control Plan are considered incidental, and no additional payment
will be made for adjustments.
1-09.14(2)A4 Erosion Control and Water Pollution Control (Bid Item A04) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Erosion Control and Water Pollution Control” will be based on the lump sum
bid price in conformance with the Contract Documents.
The lump sum price for “Erosion Control and Water Pollution Control” shall be full pay for all labor,
material, tools, equipment, and other incidental costs required to prepare the Stormwater
Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) and Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control (TESC) Plan as
described in Section 1-07.15 and implement the temporary erosion and sediment control BMPs
described in Section 8-01 including but not limited to installation, monitoring, and maintenance
of catch basin inserts, filter fabric fencing, stake and wire fencing, sediment ponds, straw wattles,
pumping of construction water, temporary storm drain diversions including temporary piping,
check dams, cover measures including plastic covering, street sweeping, collection and disposal
of wastewater from asphalt and concrete cutting operations and other work necessary to meet
the contract and permit requirements, not otherwise shown as a separate payment item.
Payment shall also include the Contractor’s use of Baker Tanks, as needed during construction
and associated labor, tools, equipment and incidental costs including Baker Tank mobilization, set
up, maintenance, and relocation as work progresses, and incidentals required to use Baker Tanks,
when needed to meet regulatory discharge requirements. Payment shall also include the
following:
• Applying for the Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP) or transferring
ownership of the CSWGP from the City of Renton to the Contractor
• Closing out the CSWGP and obtaining approval from the Department of Ecology on permit
closure
• All monitoring and reporting required for compliance with the CSWGP
Work shall include coordination, permitting, fees, approval and treatment required by the City of
Renton as required in 1-07.15 if discharging to the sanitary sewer.
68
1-09.14(2)A5 Spill Prevention, Control, and Countermeasure (SPCC) Plan and Implementation (Bid Item A05) – Lump Sum
Measurement and payment for “Spill Prevention, Control, and Countermeasure (SPCC) Plan and
Implementation” shall be per WSDOT Standard Specification 1-07.15.
1-09.14(2)A6 Landscape and Private Property Restoration (Bid Item A06) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Landscape and Private Property Restoration” work will be per the lump sum
bid price, and based on the percentage of total Work complete, by dollar value, at the time of
measurement in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Landscape and Private Property Restoration” shall be full compensation for all labor,
equipment, materials, hauling, excavation, sod, grass seed, hydroseed, mulch, trees, shrubs,
topsoil, landscape bark, gravel, concrete, planting, preparation, compaction, watering,
restoration, etc. required to restore landscaped, grass, trees, shrubs, and planted areas including
road medians, planter strips, and other unpaved areas within the ROW and Private Property to an
equal or better condition in conformance with the Contract Documents. It shall include but not
be limited to the following:
• Installation of tree protection fencing and all costs for the protection of trees in
accordance with the Plans and Specification
• Hauling and disposing unsuitable, surplus and/or waste materials
• Replacing and restoring any landscaping, grass, rockeries, walls, tree removal and
replacement, trees, shrubs, bark, and other improvements disturbed by construction
activities, whether identified on the Contract Documents or not, as directed by the
Engineer
• Preparation, placement, and maintenance of 12” depth topsoil and hydroseed per City
specifications as supplemented in the Special Provisions. All lawn areas shall be replaced
with topsoil and hydroseeded. Bare areas shall be replaced at a minimum with mulch and
seed.
• Site cleanup of all areas disturbed by contractor’s activities to match the conditions as
closely as existed prior to the contractor’s beginning of work or as directed by the
Engineer.
1-09.14(2)A7 Remove and Replace Pavement Markings (Bid Item A07) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Remove and Replace Pavement Markings” will be per the lump sum bid price,
and based on the percentage of total Work complete, by dollar value, at the time of measurement
in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Remove and Replace Pavement Markings” shall be full compensation for all labor,
equipment, tools, materials, and all else necessary for and incidental to remove and re-establish
existing pavement markings and channelization devices including but not limited to delineator
posts in accordance with the plans and specifications.
All Stop Bars, Traffic Arrows, and Crosswalks shall be thermoplastic. Pavement letters and
longitudinal pavement markings shall consist of profiled and embossed methyl methacrylate
(MMA).
69
1-09.14(2)B Bid Items Specific to Schedule B – Stormwater
1-09.14(2)B1 Trench Safety Systems (Bid Item B01) – Lump Sum
Measurement for “Trench Safety Systems” will be per the lump sum bid price and based on a
percentage defined as the amount of storm/sewer/water pipelines installed divided by the total
length of storm/sewer/water pipe shown to be installed in conformance with the Contract
Documents.
Payment for “Trench Safety Systems” will be made at the measured percentage amount for the
pay period times the lump sum amount bid, said payment will be complete compensation for all
equipment, labor, materials, hauling, planning, design, engineering, submittals, furnishing and
constructing and removal and disposal of such temporary sheeting, shoring, and bracing complete
as required under the provisions of any permits and in the requirements of OSHA and RCW
Chapter 49.17, etc., required to complete this item of Work in conformance with the Contract
Documents.
The work includes, but not limited to, preparing and submitting a shoring plan stamped by a
professional engineer registered in the State of Washington to the City prior to the
preconstruction conference.
1-09.14(2)B2 Crushed Surfacing Top Course (Bid Item B02) – Ton
Measurement for “Crushed Surfacing Top Course” shall be measured in tons based on the weight
of material installed into the Work in conformance with the Contract Documents. Certified weight
tickets will accompany each load, a copy of tickets will be given to the Engineer daily. Wasted
materials will not be included in the measurement or payment. Only materials placed and
compacted within the limits of the final pavement patch, sidewalk, driveway, curb ramps, curb,
gutter and water service line trench backfill will be considered for payment. Material placed
outside of the limits shown in the standard details and Contract Documents, within the trench
backfill zone, around structures, or as approved by the Engineer will be paid for under other bid
items.
Recycled material and recycled concrete aggregate as defined by WSDOT Section 9-03.21 shall
not be allowed as crushed surfacing top course or base course.
Payment for “Crushed Surfacing Top Course” shall be full compensation for all labor, materials,
tools, equipment, incidentals necessary to furnish and install crushed surfacing top course,
hauling, placement, compaction, removal, haul and disposal of unsuitable excavated materials,
waste and surplus materials, etc., required to install the crushed surfacing top course in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
Crushed Surfacing Base Course used for pipe bedding and for pipe zone backfill materials for
ductile iron pipe and fittings will not be paid under this bid item, and shall be considered incidental
to the bid items for pipe installation and no further compensation will be made.
1-09.14(2)B3 Gravel Borrow for Trench Backfill (Bid Item B03) – Ton
Measurement for “Gravel Borrow for Trench Backfill” will be measured in tons based on the
weight of material installed into the Work in conformance with the Contract Documents. Certified
weight tickets will accompany each load, a copy of tickets will be given to the Engineer daily.
Wasted materials will not be included in the measurement or payment. Only materials placed
within the pay limits shown will be considered for payment. Material placed outside of the pay
70
limits shown on the Plans or as approved by the Engineer will be deducted from the certified
tickets.
Recycled material and recycled concrete aggregate as defined by WSDOT Section 9-03.21 shall
not be allowed as trench backfill for pipe installation.
Payment for “Gravel Borrow for Trench Backfill” will be made at the amount bid per ton, which
payment will be complete compensation for all labor, materials, tools, equipment, incidentals
necessary to furnish and install select import backfill, hauling, placement, compaction, performing
backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer, removal, haul and disposal
of unsuitable excavated materials, waste and surplus materials, etc., required to complete this
item of Work in conformance with the Contract Documents.
1-09.14(2)B4 HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch (Bid Item B04) – Ton
Measurement for “HMA Cl. ½-inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch” shall be measured in tons
based on the weight of material installed for final trench patch and curb ramp pavement patch in
conformance with the Contract Documents, unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Wasted
materials and temporary patch materials will not be included in the measurement or payment.
Only materials placed within the limits shown on the plans will be considered for payment.
Material placed outside of the limits shown on the plans or as approved by the Engineer will be
deducted from the certified tickets.
Payment for “HMA Cl. ½-inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch” shall be full compensation for all
labor, materials, tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Removal and disposal of existing pavement
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting hot mix asphalt materials for the final pavement
patch
• Sealing all cold joints
• Tack coat
• Joint seal
• Asphalt Sidewalk Transitions
• Hauling
• Aggregate
• Sweeping
• Adjustment of utilities to grade
• Adjustment of survey monument cases to grade. Adjustments of survey monuments will
be completed by the Owner, if required.
• Temporary pavement markings
• Cleanup
• All other incidentals necessary to complete paving and restore the roadway grade to
existing elevations.
71
“HMA Cl. ½-inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch” is exempt from Section 1-04.6 and no price
adjustment will be made for variation in actual quantity used.
1-09.14(2)B5 HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay (Bid Item B05) – Ton
Measurement for “HMA Cl. ½-inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay” shall be measured in Tons based on
the weight of material installed for final overlay in conformance with the Contract Documents,
unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Wasted materials will not be included in the
measurement or payment. Only materials placed within the limits shown on the plans will be
considered for payment. Material placed outside of the limits shown on the plans or as approved
by the Engineer will be deducted from the certified tickets.
Payment for “HMA Cl. ½-inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay” shall be full compensation for all labor,
materials, equipment, and tools required to complete the work specified in the Contract
Documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Removal and disposal of existing pavement
• Milling, grinding, planing, chipping, jackhammering and/or sawcutting 2-inch in depth to
prepare the asphalt surface for overlay
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting HMA Cl. ½” PG 58H-22 for final overlay
• Sealing all cold joints
• Tack coat
• Joint seal
• Asphalt Sidewalk Transitions
• Hauling
• Aggregate
• Sweeping
• Adjustment of existing and new utilities to grade, including but not limited to manholes,
valve boxes, and drainage inlets
• Adjustment of survey monument cases to grade. Adjustments of survey monuments will
be completed by the Owner, if required.
• Temporary pavement markings
• Cleanup
• All other incidentals necessary to complete paving and restore the roadway grade to
existing elevations.
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay” is exempt from Section 1-04.6 and no price adjustment
will be made for variation in actual quantity used.
1-09.14(2)B6 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Sidewalk (Bid Item B06) – Square Yard
Measurement for “Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Sidewalk” shall be based on square
yard of concrete sidewalk, to match existing or to ADA standards as shown on the Plans, restored
to a saw-line line cut in conformance with the Contract Documents.
72
Payment for “Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Sidewalk” shall be full compensation for all
labor, equipment, materials, tools and incidentals to remove and replace cement concrete
sidewalk and driveway in conformance with the contract documents and plans, and shall include
but not be limited to the following:
• Sawcutting, removal and disposal of existing driveway, and existing pavement
• Removal and disposal of surplus, unsuitable and/or waste materials
• Placing and compacting CSTC for subgrade
• Temporary hot mix asphalt patching
• Furnishing and installing formwork
• Furnishing and placing joint filler
• Furnishing, placing, compacting, and finishing concrete for new sidewalk surface
• Adjustment of utilities to grade
• Removal and reinstallation of existing signs affected by work related to this bid item
• Cleanup
CSTC for sidewalk subgrade will be paid under the CSTC bid item.
1-09.14(2)B7 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Driveway (Bid Item B07) – Square Yard
Measurement for “Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Driveway” shall be based on square
yard of driveway, to match existing or to ADA standards as shown on the Plans, restored to a saw-
line line cut in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Driveway” shall be full compensation for all
labor, equipment, materials, tools and incidentals to remove and replace cement concrete
driveway in conformance with the contract documents and plans, and shall include but not be
limited to the following:
• Sawcutting, removal and disposal of existing driveway and existing pavement
• Removal and disposal of surplus, unsuitable and/or waste materials
• Placing and compacting CSTC for subgrade
• Temporary hot mix asphalt patching
• Furnishing and installing formwork
• Furnishing and placing joint filler
• Furnishing, placing, compacting, and finishing concrete for new driveway
• Adjustment of utilities to grade
• Removal and reinstallation of existing signs affected by work related to this bid item
• Cleanup
Gravel driveway and gravel parking areas, if existing, shall be restored under landscape
restoration.
73
CSTC for driveway subgrade will be paid under the CSTC bid item.
1-09.14(2)B8 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Curb Ramp, Type Parallel A (Bid Item B08) – Each
Measurement for “Remove and Replace Concrete Curb Ramp, Type Parallel A” shall be each for
all of the complete curb ramps, restored to a saw-line cut in conformance with the contract
documents.
Payment for “Remove and Replace Concrete Curb Ramp, Type Parallel A” shall be full
compensation for all labor, equipment, materials, tools, haul, and incidentals to remove and
replace nine concrete curb ramps in conformance with the contract documents and plans, and
shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Sawcutting, removal and disposal existing sidewalk and curb ramp within curb ramp pay
limits
• Removal and disposal of surplus, unsuitable and/or waste materials
• Removal and reinstallation of existing signs, including replacement of existing signposts
with metal sign posts per Standard Plan 129
• Furnishing and installing and removing temporary formwork
• Furnishing and placing joint filler
• Placing and compacting CSTC for subgrade
• Furnishing, placing, and finishing concrete for new curb ramp surfaces
• Furnishing and installing detectable warning surfaces
• Adjustment of utilities to grade
• Furnishing and installing temporary hot mix asphalt patching
• Concrete curing and cleanup
CSTC for subgrade will be paid under the CSTC bid item.
1-09.14(2)B9 Remove and Replace Concrete Curb and Gutter (Bid Item B09) – Linear Foot
Measurement for “Remove and Replace Concrete Curb and Gutter” shall be per linear foot of curb
repair required for installation of utilities in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Remove and Replace Concrete Curb and Gutter” shall be full compensation for all
labor, materials, tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Sawcutting, removal and disposal of existing pavement, curb, and gutter
• Removal and disposal of surplus, unsuitable and /or waste materials
• Placing and compacting CSTC for subgrade
• Temporary hot mix asphalt patching,
• Furnishing, installing, and removing temporary formwork
• Furnishing, placing, and finishing concrete and joint filler for new curb and gutter and
concrete extruded and vertical curb
74
• Concrete curing and cleanup
CSTC for subgrade will be paid under the CSTC bid item.
1-09.14(2)B10 Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation Material (Bid Item B10) – Ton
Measurement for “Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation Material” will be
measured in Tons based on the placed weight of material installed in conformance with the
Contract Documents. Placement of foundation material will be measured only for the area(s)
authorized by the Engineer. Certified tickets will accompany each load, a copy of tickets will be
given to the Engineer daily. Wasted materials will not be included in the measurement or
payment.
Payment for “Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation Material” will be made at the
unit bid price, which will be complete compensation for all labor, materials, tools, equipment,
excavation, foundation materials, haul, placement, water, compaction, removal haul and disposal
of waste material, etc., required to complete this item of Work in conformance with the Contract
Documents.
Payment for this item will be only for the removal and replacement of unsuitable material
requested by the City.
Removal and replacement of unsuitable foundation material is exempt from Section 1-04.6 and
no price adjustment will be made for variation in actual quantity used.
1-09.14(2)B11 Controlled Density Fill (Bid Item B11) – Cubic Yard
Measurement for “Control Density Fill” (CDF) will be per cubic yard in conformance with the
Contract Documents and neat line per the details on the plans. All use of CDF for trench dams–as
shown on the plans, is approved for use. Use of CDF for encasement of pipes and utility crossings
shall be pre-approved by the Engineer. CDF used beyond the agreed amount or CDF used without
prior Engineer approval will not be paid. CDF shall meet the requirements of WSDOT Standard
Specification Section 2-09.3(1)E.
Payment will be made at contract unit price and will constitute full compensation for all material,
equipment, tools, formwork, labor, and all necessary for and incidental to the installation of
“Control Density Fill” for trench dams—as shown on the plans, and encasement of pipes and utility
crossings—pre-approval required, in accordance with the Contract Documents, plan details and
as directed by the Engineer.
Payment for this item will be only for the control density fill used for trench dams—as shown on
the plans and where pre-approved by the City. No price adjustment will be made for variation in
actual quantity used for controlled density fill, see special provision 1-04.6.
1-09.14(2)B12 Minor Changes (Bid Item B12) – Estimate
For the purpose of providing a common proposal for all bidders, the Contracting Agency has
entered an amount for “Minor Changes” in the Proposal to become a part of the total bid by the
Contractor. At the discretion of the Contracting Agency, all or part of this estimated amount may
be used in lieu of the more formal procedure as outlined in Section 1-04.4 of the Standard
Specifications. The unit contract price for “Minor Changes” is given in the Schedule of Prices and
shall not be changed by the bidder.
75
All work and payment under this item will be authorized in writing by the City Project Manager or
Supervisor. Payment will be determined in accordance with Section 1-09.4 of the Standard
Specifications.
Payment for this item will be only for the changes and amounts approved by the City.
If no changes are authorized under this bid item, final payment for this item will be $0 (zero).
1-09.14(2)B13 CCTV Inspection (Bid Item B13) – Linear Foot
Measurement for “CCTV Inspection” will be per linear foot of storm pipe inspected in
conformance with section 7-08.3(5) and the Contract Documents.
Payment for “CCTV Inspection” will be made at the amount bid per linear foot, which payment
will be complete compensation for all labor, materials, equipment required to complete the work
specified in the Contract Documents and plans, and shall include, but not be limited to the
following:
• Bypass stormwater pumping (if needed)
• CCTV Inspection of all new open-cut installed storm pipe
• Delivery of the CCTV inspections entirely in a PACP compatible format data base on an
External HDD to the Engineer
Costs for additional Television inspection required to verify corrections or replacement of pipe, or
done solely for the Contractor’s convenience, shall be at the Contractor’s sole expense.
1-09.14(2)B14 ____-Inch ____Storm Drain Pipe (Bid Items B14 to B18) – Linear Foot
Measurement for “____-Inch ____Storm Drain Pipe” will be based on linear foot measured
horizontally over the centerline of the installed pipe from the center of structures in conformance
with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “____-Inch ____Storm Drain Pipe” will be made at the amount bid per linear foot,
which payment will be complete compensation for:
• All labor, materials, equipment and hauling
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, protecting and providing temporary support of existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Dewatering, temporary bypass pumping and control of water
• Structure Excavation, Class B
• Removal and disposal of waste material in the excavation necessary to construct the
improvements including but not limited to: existing pipes; catch basins; manholes;
structures; and abandoned utilities
• Pipe of the size and material type required, gaskets, fittings and adaptors
• Installation, laying, and jointing pipe and fittings
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting pipe zone bedding material
• Placing and compacting imported trench backfill
76
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Appurtenances, ethafoam pads, water, grading, cleaning, and testing, etc. required to
complete the work in accordance with the Contract Documents
• Removal of pipe and catch basins beyond the excavation where shown on the Drawings
or where directed by the Engineer as well as plugging existing pipes to be abandoned and
plugging existing pipes where sections have been removed for the storm installation, and
providing end caps were shown on the plans. These items shall not be limited to those
mentioned on the Plans or specified herein.
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)B15 Quarry Spalls (Bid Item B19) – Ton
Measurement for “Quarry Spalls” will be measured be measured in tons based on the weight of
material installed into the Work in conformance with the Contract Documents. Certified weight
tickets will accompany each load, a copy of tickets will be given to the Engineer daily. Wasted
materials will not be included in the measurement or payment. Only materials placed within the
pay limits shown will be considered for payment. Material placed outside of the pay limits shown
on the Plans or as approved by the Engineer will be deducted from the certified tickets.
Payment for “Quarry Spalls” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials, tools,
equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans, and
shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, protecting, and providing temporary support of existing utilities
• Dewatering, temporary bypass pumping, and control of water
• Removal and disposal of waste material in the excavation necessary to construct the
improvements including but not limited to: existing vegetation and pipes; catch basins;
manholes; structures; and abandoned utilities
• Excavation and grading of the ditch to the slope, lines, and cross-section of the
appropriate size and matching Details as specified in the Construction Plans
• Compaction of subgrade
• Offsite disposal of excavated materials
• Furnishing and installing quarry spalls of the appropriate size and matching Details as
specified in the Construction Plans
• Appurtenances, water, grading, cleaning, and testing, etc. required to complete the work
in accordance with the Contract Documents
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Restoration of public and private properties
77
1-09.14(2)B16 Yard Drain (Bid Item B20) – Each
Measurement for “Yard Drain” will be per each for each yard drain structure installed in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Yard Drain” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials, tools, and
equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans, and
shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, protecting, and providing temporary support of existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Sawcutting existing asphalt, sidewalk, curb, and gutter
• Dewatering, temporary bypass pumping, and control of water
• Removal and disposal of waste material in the excavation necessary to construct the
improvements including but not limited to: pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks; existing
pipes; catch basins; manholes; structures; and abandoned utilities
• Structure Excavation, Class B
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting foundation material
• Precast concrete yard drain structure – Old Castle Infrastructure Model 2424 YD or
approved alternate, gaskets, frame and grates, installation, adjustment of frames to
grade, appurtenances, Kor-N-Seal boots (or approved alternate), connections to new
pipes, reconnections to existing pipes including pipe and couplings, placement of
subsequent backfill materials, compaction, water, cleaning, and testing, etc. required in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
• Appurtenances, ethafoam pads, water, grading, cleaning, etc. required to complete the
work in accordance with the Contract Documents
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)B17 Catch Basin Type __ (Bid Items B21 & B22) – Each
Measurement for “Catch Basin Type __” will be per each for each catch basin installed in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Catch Basin Type __” will be made at the unit bid price per each, which will be
complete compensation for:
• All labor, equipment, materials, and hauling
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, protecting and providing temporary support of existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
78
• Excavation and shoring
• Dewatering, temporary bypass pumping and control of water
• Removal and disposal of waste material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and any abandoned utilities
• Structure Excavation, Class B
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting of foundation material
• Precast concrete catch basin, gaskets, catch basin frame and grate or lid, installation,
adjustment of frames to grade, appurtenances, Kor-N-Seal boots (or approved alternate),
connections to new pipes, reconnections to existing pipes including pipe and couplings,
placement of subsequent backfill materials, compaction, water, cleaning, and testing, etc.
required in conformance with the Contract Documents.
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)B18 Bird Cage Overflow Structure (Bid Item B23) – Each
Measurement for “Bird Cage Overflow Structure” will be per each for each overflow structure
installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Bird Cage Overflow Structure” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor,
materials, tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract documents
and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, protecting, and providing temporary support of existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Dewatering, temporary bypass pumping, and control of water
• Removal and disposal of waste material in the excavation necessary to construct the
improvements including but not limited to: existing pipes; catch basins; manholes;
structures; and abandoned utilities
• Structure Excavation, Class B
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting foundation material with geotextile fabric
• Precast concrete catch basin with (4) 1-inch diameter weep holes, gaskets, birdcage frame
and grates, hook clamps, installation, adjustment of frames to grade, appurtenances, Kor-
N-Seal boots (or approved alternate), connections to new pipes, reconnections to existing
pipes including pipe and couplings, placement of subsequent backfill materials,
compaction, water, cleaning, and testing, etc. required in conformance with the Contract
Documents.
• Furnishing and placing quarry spalls per WSDOT Section 8-15.3(6) and matching Details
as specified in the Construction Plans
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Restoration of public and private properties
79
1-09.14(2)B19 Connect New Storm Pipe to Existing Catch Basin (Bid Item B24) – Each
Measurement for “Connect New Storm Pipe to Existing Catch Basin” will be per each in
conformance with Contract Documents.
Payment for “Connect New Storm Pipe to Existing Catch Basin” will be made at the unit price per
each, which will be complete compensation for all labor, equipment, materials, excavation around
and protection of existing structure, temporary bypass pumping (if needed), core drilling, cleaning
the existing catch basin and other materials required to connect to the existing catch basin in
accordance with the Contract Documents.
1-09.14(2)B20 Side Sewer Replacement (Bid Item B25) – Linear Foot
Measurement for “Side Sewer Replacement” will be per linear foot of replaced side sewer
installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
The length of side sewer replacement shall be the number of linear feet of completed side sewer
pipe installation measured along the invert.
The unit price bid per linear foot of “Side Sewer Replacement” shall be full compensation for all
labor, material, related work, tools and equipment necessary to satisfactorily complete the Work
as defined in Section 7-18 Standard Specifications, these Special Provisions and as shown on the
Plans.
The unit price per linear foot of “Side Sewer Replacement” shall also include, but not be limited
to, furnishing, hauling, and assembling in place the completed installation including all wyes, tees,
special fittings, cleanouts, and joint materials for the completion of the installation to the required
lines and grades.
The unit price per linear foot of “Side Sewer Replacement” shall also include all costs for reviewing
pothole information, design submittals, trench excavation, dewatering, furnishing, stockpiling,
hauling, placing and compacting imported pipe zone bedding and suitable native backfill above
the pipe zone, cleaning and flushing pipes and existing structures, inspecting pipe, connecting new
pipe to existing structures, replacing, protecting and maintaining utilities, CCTV and providing as-
built sketches of all replaced side sewers.
1-09.14(2)B21 Resolution of Utility Conflicts (Bid Item B26) – Estimate
Payment will be made in accordance with Section 1-07.17(5) for the following bid items when
included in the proposal:
"Resolution of Utility Conflicts" will be paid by force account as provided in Section 1-09.6.
Costs for resolving utility conflicts will be paid for by force account in accordance with Section
1-09.6. To provide a common proposal for all bidders, the Contracting Agency has estimated the
amount for “Resolution of Utility Conflicts” and entered the amounts in the proposal to become
a part of the total bid by the Contractor. Utility conflicts due to the Contractor’s actions or
operations shall be resolved by the Contractor at no expense to the Contracting Agency.
1-09.14(2)B22 Survey Monument Restoration (Bid Item B27) – Each
Measurement for "Survey Monument Restoration" will be per each monument case and cover
furnished and set.
Payment for each “Survey Monument Restoration” shall be full compensation for all labor,
materials, tools, and equipment necessary to satisfactorily furnish and install new monument
cases and covers, as defined in the Plans, the Standard Specifications, and these Special
80
Provisions, including all required coordination the Owner’s surveyor, who will reestablish
disturbed monuments.
1-09.14(2)C Bid Items Specific to Schedule C – Sanitary Sewer
1-09.14(2)C1 Trench Safety Systems (Bid Item C01) – Lump Sum
See B1 above.
1-09.14(2)C2 Crushed Surfacing Top Course (Bid Item C02) – Ton
See B2 above.
1-09.14(2)C3 Gravel Borrow for Trench Backfill (Bid Item C03) – Ton
See B3 above.
1-09.14(2)C4 HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch (Bid Item C04) – Ton
See B4 above.
1-09.14(2)C5 Controlled Density Fill (Bid Item C05) – Cubic Yard
See B11 above.
1-09.14(2)C6 Minor Changes (Bid Item C06) – Estimate
See B12 above.
1-09.14(2)C7 CCTV Inspection (Bid Item C07) – Linear Foot
See B13 above.
1-09.14(2)C8 6-Inch SDR 35 PVC Sewer Pipe (Bid Item C08) – Linear Foot
Measurement for “6-Inch SDR 35 PVC Sewer Pipe” will be based on linear foot measured
horizontally over the centerline of the installed pipe from the center of structures in conformance
with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “6-Inch SDR 35 PVC Sewer Pipe” will be made at the amount bid per linear foot, which
payment will be complete compensation for:
• All labor, materials, equipment, and hauling
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, television inspection of existing sanitary sewer to determine location of
side sewer branches if necessary, and protecting and providing temporary support of
existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Sawcutting existing asphalt, sidewalk, curb, and gutter
• Dewatering, temporary bypass sewer pumping (if needed)
• Excavation, removal, haul, and disposal of waste materials including but not limited to:
pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, existing pipes; manholes; structures; and abandoned
utilities
• Plugging abandoned pipes with concrete when cut to facilitate new pipe installation
• Pipe of the size and material type required, gaskets, fittings, and adaptors
• Reconnection to existing pipes including couplings
81
• Installation, laying, and sewer pipes and fittings
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting pipe zone bedding material
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Furnishing ethafoam pads (when needed)
• Air testing
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)C9 48-Inch Sanitary Sewer Manhole (Bid Item C09) – Each
Measurement for “48-Inch Sanitary Sewer Manhole” will be per each manhole installed in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “48-Inch Sanitary Sewer Manhole” will be made at the unit price per each, which
payment will be complete compensation for:
• All labor, materials, equipment, and hauling
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location, television inspection of existing sanitary sewer to determine location of
side sewer branches if necessary, and protecting and providing temporary support of
existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Preparation and submittal of structural design calculations stamped by a registered
Structural Engineer (if needed)
• Sawcutting existing asphalt, sidewalk, curb, and gutter
• Dewatering, temporary bypass sewer pumping (if needed)
• Excavation, removal, haul, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, existing
pipes; manholes; structures
• Plugging abandoned pipes with concrete when cut to facilitate new pipe installation
• Furnishing and installing precast or poured-in-place concrete base, concrete manhole
sections, gaskets, Kor-N-Seal boots (or approved alternate), ladder and rungs,
appurtenances, connections, channeling, reconnection to existing pipes including pipe
and couplings, coating system (sealer), and manhole frame and lid
• Furnishing and installing material as needed for the adjustment of frames to grade
including HMA
• Furnishing foundation and bedding materials, placing and compacting foundation and
bedding
• Placing and compacting backfill
82
• Replacing, protecting and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)C10 Resolution of Utility Conflicts (Bid Item C10) – Estimate
See B21 above.
1-09.14(2)D Bid Items Specific to Schedule D – Water
1-09.14(2)D1 Trench Safety Systems (Bid Item D01) – Lump Sum
See B1 above.
1-09.14(2)D2 Crushed Surfacing Top Course (Bid Item D02) – Ton
See B2 above.
1-09.14(2)D3 Gravel Borrow for Trench Backfill (Bid Item D03) – Ton
See B3 above.
1-09.14(2)D4 HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch (Bid Item D04) – Ton
See B4 above.
1-09.14(2)D5 HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay (Bid Item D05) – Ton
See B5 above.
1-09.14(2)D6 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Sidewalk (Bid Item D06) – Square Yard
See B6 above.
1-09.14(2)D7 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Driveway (Bid Item D07) – Square Yard
See B7 above.
1-09.14(2)D8 Remove and Replace Cement Concrete Curb Ramp, Type Parallel A (Bid Item D08) – Each
See B8 above.
1-09.14(2)D9 Remove and Replace Concrete Curb and Gutter (Bid Item D09) – Linear Foot
See B9 above.
1-09.14(2)D10 Removal and Replacement of Unsuitable Foundation Material (Bid Item D10) – Ton
See B10 above.
1-09.14(2)D11 Controlled Density Fill (Bid Item D11) – Cubic Yard
See B11 above.
1-09.14(2)D12 Minor Changes (Bid Item D12) – Estimate
See B12 above.
83
1-09.14(2)D13 Ductile Iron Class 52 ___ -Inch Diameter Restrained-Joint Water Pipe and Restrained-Joint Fittings with Polywrap (Bid Items D13, D14, D15, & D16) –– Linear Foot
Measurement for Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Water Pipes and Restrained-Joint Fittings with
Polywrap of the size, type and class specified will be based on the actual lineal footage measured
horizontally over the centerline of the installed pipe and fittings.
Payment for 6-inch ductile iron pipe for hydrant laterals up to 20 feet in length is included in the
bid item for fire hydrant assembly.
Payment for Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Water Pipes and Restrained-Joint Fittings with Polywrap
of the size, type, and class specified shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials,
tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans,
and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical locations
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, and
unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the excavation
and the like
• Structure Excavation Class B
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Hand digging as required to complete construction and protect existing improvements,
including rockeries, signs, mailboxes, decking, etc., and utilities
• Furnishing, installing, laying, and jointing restrained-joint water pipes and restrained-joint
fittings of the size, type, and class shown on the plans and as specified in Section 9-30.2(6)
of the contract special provisions, polyethylene encasement, special fittings including
wedge type restrained-joint follower glands at all fittings with mechanical-joint ends,
tees, crosses, reducers, spools, couplings, sleeves, horizontal and vertical bends, and all
incidentals
• Deflecting the pipes and/or installing vertical bends with concrete blocking as required to
cross over or under buried utilities based on results of potholing and as directed by the
Engineer
• Furnishing and installing polyethylene foam pad (Dow Plastics Ethafoam 200 or approved
alternate) where necessary at utility crossings
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings. Recycled
material and recycled concrete aggregate as defined by WSDOT Section 9-03.21 shall not
be allowed as bedding or pipe zone materials.
84
• Placing and compacting trench backfill. Recycled material and recycled concrete
aggregate as defined by WSDOT Section 9-03.21 shall not be allowed as trench backfill.
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Furnishing and installing all poly-pigging station materials, temporary blow-off
assemblies, and temporary thrust blocking for testing
• Poly-pigging, pressure-testing, disinfecting and flushing of new piping, purity testing in
accordance with contract specifications
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D14 ___-Inch x 8-inch Tapping Tee and Valve Assembly (Bid Items D17 & D18) –– Each
Measurement for Tapping Tee and Valve Assembly of the size specified will be per each for each
type of tapping tee with tapping gate valve assembly installed in conformance with the Contract
Documents.
Payment for Tapping Tee and Valve Assembly of the size specified shall cover the complete cost
of providing all labor, materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in
the contract documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location and alignment
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Excavation, removal, hauling and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, and
unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the excavation,
and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Hand digging as required to complete construction and protect existing improvements
• Wet tapping the existing water main by a city approved wet-tap contractor (Speer Taps,
Inc. or Legacy Tapping, Inc.)
• Furnishing and installing a stainless steel or epoxy-coated steel tapping tee with full circle
seal, tapping gate valve assembly, valve box and cover to grade, stem extension, valve
marker post, polyethylene encasement, concrete support blocks, and all incidentals
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings.
85
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D15 ___-Inch Gate Valve Assembly (Bid Items D19, D20, D21, & D22) –– Each
Measurement for Gate Valve Assembly of the size specified will be per each for each type of valve
installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Hydrant auxiliary 6-inch gate valve will be included in the measurement for hydrant assembly and
will not be included in this measurement item.
Tapping gate valve will be included in the measurement for tapping tee and valve and will not be
included in this measurement item.
Payment for Gate Valve Assembly of the size specified shall cover the complete cost of providing
all labor, materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk curb,
and gutter
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks,
surplus, and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Furnishing and installing valves, wedge type restrained-joint follower glands for valves
with mechanical joint end(s), polyethylene encasement, valve boxes and covers to grade,
stem extensions, valve marker posts, and all incidentals
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings.
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
86
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D16 1-inch Air and Vacuum Release Valve Assembly (Bid Item D23) –– Each
Measurement for “1-inch Air and Vacuum Release Valve Assembly” will be per each for each type
of valve installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “1-inch Air and Vacuum Release Valve Assembly“ shall cover the complete cost of
providing all labor, materials, tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the
contract documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk curb,
and gutter
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks,
surplus, and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Furnishing and installing new corporation stop, valves, valve box and cover to grade, stem
extension, valve marker post, pipe nipples, couplings, air and vacuum valve assembly,
meter box and lid, gravel, copper pipe, galvanized iron pipe, and all other associated
fittings and incidentals
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings.
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Testing, disinfecting and flushing of new valves
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D17 Fire Hydrant Assembly (Bid Item D24) –– Each
Measurement for “Fire Hydrant Assembly” will be per each for each fire hydrant assembly
installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
87
Payment for “Fire Hydrant Assembly” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor,
materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Removal and salvage of existing hydrant, if existing hydrant is being replaced
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Furnishing and installing new fire hydrant assembly, main line tee and 6-inch gate valve,
standpipe, shoe, and 6-inch DI piping up to 20 feet per hydrant run, Storz adapter, blue
pavement marker
• Furnishing and installing shut-off valve, valve box, and valve extension
• Furnishing and installing mechanical joint restraints, follower-glands (i.e. Mega-lugs),
and/or shackles, tie-rods, concrete blocking, drain rocks, and polyethylene encasement
• Adjust hydrant to finish grade
• Install concrete shear block and retaining wall as shown on the standard plans
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings.
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Testing, disinfecting, and flushing of new hydrants
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
• Painting the hydrants with two field coats of paint as specified in the Contract Documents
• Moving, transplanting, potting, trimming, and pruning shrubs and tree branches, and
grading to create a clear-zone around the hydrant as specified in the Contract Documents
88
1-09.14(2)D18 1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type A with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve (PRV) (Bid Item D25) –– Each
Measurement for “1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type A with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve
(PRV)” will be per each for each 1-Inch water connection installed in conformance with the
Contract Documents.
Payment for “1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type A with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve
(PRV)” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials, tools, and equipment
required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans, and shall include
but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Hole-hogging, boring, tunneling, mechanical, or hand trenching to install new water
service lines,
• Furnishing and installing new ball valve corporation stop, tapping the main, laying and
jointing the new copper water service line and fittings of the appropriate size and
matching Detail 1 – Type A on Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new meter setter and re-installing the existing water meter, new
copper water service line and fittings, washed gravel, adapters to accommodate
5/8”x3/4” as needed, and new meter box and lid of the appropriate size and matching
Detail 1 - Type A on Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new pressure reducing valve assembly, new copper water
service line and fittings, new brass nipples, new shutoff valve, washed gravel, and new
meter box and lid of the appropriate size and matching Detail 1 - Type A on Drawing W-
19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Testing, disinfecting, and flushing the new service lines in conjunction with the new water
mains
• Coordinating with property owner and working within private property
• Performing pre- and post-pressure tests of water service pressure at house external hose
bib or as directed by the Engineer and reporting the pre- and post-pressure results to the
Engineer
89
• Connecting the customer-side private service line to the new copper tailpiece behind the
new pressure reducing valve assembly and property lines, installing the required fittings
and materials, and matching Detail 1 Type – A on Drawing W-19 as specified in the
Construction Plans
• Abandoning existing water service lines from the existing main by cutting and crimping or
capping
• Remove and wastehaul existing water meter box and setter
• Placing and compacting CSTC for trench backfill. Furnishing CSTC for water service line
trench backfill will be included in the measurement for Crushed Surfacing Top Course.
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D19 1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type B with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve (PRV) (Bid Item D26) –– Each
Measurement for “1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type B with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve
(PRV)” will be per each for each 1-Inch water connection installed in conformance with the
Contract Documents.
Payment for “1-Inch Water Service Connection, Type B with 1-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve
(PRV)” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials, tools, and equipment
required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans, and shall include
but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Hole-hogging, boring, tunneling, mechanical, or hand trenching to install new water
service lines
90
• Furnishing and installing new ball valve corporation stop, tapping the main, laying and
jointing the new copper water service line and fittings of the appropriate size and
matching Detail 1 – Type B on Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new meter setter and re-installing the existing water meter, new
copper water service line and fittings, washed gravel, adapters to accommodate
5/8”x3/4” as needed, and new meter box and lid of the appropriate size and matching
Detail 1 – Type B on Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new pressure reducing valve assembly, new copper water
service line and fittings, new brass nipples, new shutoff valve, washed gravel, and new
meter box and lid of the appropriate size and matching Detail 1 - Type B on Drawing W-
19 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Testing, disinfecting, and flushing the new service lines in conjunction with the new water
mains
• Coordinating with property owner and working within private property
• Performing pre- and post-pressure tests of water service pressure at house external hose
bib or as directed by the Engineer and reporting the pre- and post-pressure results to the
Engineer
• Connecting the customer-side private service line to the new copper tailpiece behind the
new pressure reducing valve assembly and property lines, installing the required fittings
and materials, and matching Detail 1 – Type B on Drawing W-19 as specified in the
Construction Plans
• Abandoning existing water service lines from the existing main by cutting and crimping or
capping
• Remove and wastehaul existing water meter box and setter
• Placing and compacting CSTC for trench backfill. Furnishing CSTC for water service line
trench backfill will be included in the measurement for Crushed Surfacing Top Course
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D20 ___-Inch Water Service Connection, Type C with ___-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve (PRV) (Bid Items D27 & D28) –– Each
Measurement for “___-Inch Water Service Connection, Type C with ___-Inch Pressure Reducing
Valve (PRV)” of the size specified will be per each for each ___-Inch water service connection
installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
91
Payment for “___-Inch Water Service Connection, Type C with ___-Inch Pressure Reducing Valve
(PRV)” of the size specified shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor, materials, tools,
and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract documents and plans,
and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Hole-hogging, boring, tunneling, mechanical, or hand trenching to install new water
service lines
• For 1-inch services only, furnishing and installing new ball valve corporation stop, tapping
the main, laying and jointing the new copper water service line and fittings of the
appropriate size and matching Detail 1 – Type C on Drawing W-19 as specified in the
Construction Plans
• For 1.5-inch services only, furnishing and installing new main line tees with 2” tap, 2” gate
valves, laying and jointing the new copper water service line and fittings of the
appropriate size and matching Detail 1 - Type C on Drawings W-20 and W-21 as specified
in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new meter setter and re-installing the existing water meter, new
copper water service line and fittings, washed gravel, and new meter box and lid of the
appropriate size and matching Detail 1 - Type C on Drawing W-19 or Drawings W-20 and
W-21 as specified in the Construction Plans
• Furnishing and installing new pressure reducing valve assembly on the existing meter
setter, new copper water service line and fittings, washed gravel, and removing and re-
installing the existing meter box and lid of the appropriate size and matching Detail 1 -
Type C on Drawing W-19 or Drawings W-20 and W-21 as specified in the Construction
Plans
• Testing, disinfecting, and flushing the new service lines in conjunction with the new water
mains
• Coordinating with property owner and working within private property
• Performing pre- and post-pressure tests of water service pressure at house external hose
bib or as directed by the Engineer and reporting the pre- and post-pressure results to the
Engineer
92
• Connecting new copper water service line from the new meter setter to the existing
meter setter, installing the required fittings and materials matching Detail 1 – Type C on
Drawing W-19 or Drawings W-20 and W-21 as specified in the Construction Plans, and
protecting the existing customer-side private service line
• Abandoning existing water service lines from the existing main by cutting and crimping or
capping
• Placing and compacting CSTC for trench backfill. Furnishing CSTC for water service line
trench backfill will be included in the measurement for Crushed Surfacing Top Course.
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D21 2-Inch Water Service Connection (Bid Item D29) –– Each
Measurement for “2-Inch Water Service Connection” will be per each for each 2-inch water
service connection installed in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “2-Inch Water Service Connection” shall cover the complete cost of providing all
labor, materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Hole-hogging, boring, tunneling, mechanical, or hand trenching to install new water
service lines
• Furnishing and installing new main line tees with 2” tap, 2” gate valves, laying and jointing
the new 2" copper water service line and fittings and matching the Standard Detail 320.2
as specified in the Construction Documents
93
• Furnishing and installing new meter setter and re-installing the existing water meter, new
copper water service line and fittings, washed gravel, and new meter box and lid of the
appropriate size and matching the Standard Detail 320.2 as specified in the Construction
Documents
• Testing, disinfecting, and flushing the new service lines in conjunction with the new water
mains
• Protecting the existing customer-side private service line
• Abandoning existing water service lines from the existing main by cutting and crimping or
capping
• Placing and compacting CSTC for trench backfill. Furnishing CSTC for water service line
trench backfill will be included in the measurement for Crushed Surfacing Top Course
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Restoration of public and private properties
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D22 Connection to Existing Water Main (Bid Item D30) –– Each
Measurement for “Connection to Existing Water Main” will be per each connection for
completion in conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Connection to Existing Water Main” shall cover the complete cost of providing all
labor, materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Furnishing all required pipes, fittings, adapters, couplings, and incidentals as required for
City’s water department’s personnel to perform the initial cut-in installation of valves,
and fittings on the existing water main(s)
94
• Furnishing all required pipes, fittings, adapters, couplings and incidentals as required for
City’s water department’s personnel to perform the second and final connection of the
new water line to the existing water system and to the valves installed during the initial
cut-in as described above. Ductile iron spools, fittings, adapters, couplings, sleeves, and
reducers of various diameter sizes including 6-, 8-, 10-, 12-, and 16-inch shall be
considered as incidentals to this bid item and no further compensation shall be made
• Furnishing all required pipes, fittings, adapters, couplings and incidentals as required for
City's water department's personnel to perform the final connection of the new water
line to the new tapping valve installed by wet tap on the existing water system. 8-inch
ductile iron sleeves and spools shall be considered as incidentals to this bid item and no
further compensation shall be made
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D23 Concrete for Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Anchors (Bid Item D31) –– Cubic Yard
Measurement for “Concrete for Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Anchors” will be per cubic yard
for all concrete installed for thrust blocking and dead-man anchor blocks in conformance with the
Contract Documents.
Payment for “Concrete for Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Anchors” shall cover the complete cost
of providing all labor, materials, tools, equipment required to complete the work specified in the
contract documents and plans, and shall include but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities and potholing in advance to determine their horizontal and
vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt concrete pavement up to 12" in depth, trench excavation,
shoring, and dewatering (if needed)
• Removal, hauling and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus and
unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the excavation
and the like
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Furnishing and placing concrete for vertical and horizontal blocks, dead-man anchor
blocks, reinforcing steel, shackle rods, clamp assembly, anchor bolts, turnbuckles,
concrete form work
95
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, restoring, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D24 Abandon Existing Water Main (Bid Item D32) –– Lump Sum
Measurement for “Abandon Existing Water Main” will be based on the lump sum bid price in
conformance with the Contract Documents.
Payment for “Abandon Existing Water Main” shall cover the complete cost of providing all labor,
materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in the contract
documents and plans, and shall include, but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus and
unsuitable excavated material, blow-off assemblies, excluding any asbestos cement pipe
or fittings
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Plugging and capping water lines and fire hydrant runs, removal of valves, valve boxes,
tees, services, and appurtenances as shown on the Plans or as required to complete the
Work
• Furnishing all required pipes, fittings, ductile iron end caps, plugs, blind flanges, adapters,
couplings, and incidentals as required for City’s water department’s personnel to perform
each cut and cap of existing water mains during the final connections of the new mains
to the existing water mains
• Backfilling voids left by removed items with suitable native material or gravel borrow as
approved by the Engineer
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
• Replacing, protecting, and/or maintaining existing utilities
• Protecting existing survey monument cases
96
• Furnishing and placing temporary hot mix asphalt patching. Temporary hot mix asphalt
includes all hot mix asphalt and/or temporary asphalt that is not part of the final trench
patch and overlay.
1-09.14(2)D25 Additional Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Fittings (Bid Item D33) –– Pound
Measurement for “Additional Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Fittings” shall be per pound (LB).
Payment for “Additional Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Fittings” shall be for the full compensation
to the Contractor for providing and installing any and all extra ductile iron fittings used but not
shown or implied on the plans.
Payment for “Additional Restrained-Joint Ductile Iron Fittings” shall cover the complete cost of
providing all labor, materials, tools, and equipment required to complete the work specified in
the contract documents and plans, and shall include, but not be limited to the following:
• Locating all existing utilities, water main and services and potholing in advance to
determine their horizontal and vertical location
• Saw cutting existing asphalt and concrete pavement up to 12” in depth, sidewalk, curb,
and gutter
• Excavation, removal, hauling, and disposal of pavement, curbs, gutters, sidewalks, surplus
and unsuitable excavated material including existing pipes and structures in the
excavation and the like
• Additional excavation up to 8 feet in depth from roadway surface for installation of
vertical bends and fittings to clear conflict with existing utilities
• Stockpiling suitable excavated material for use as pipe bedding and trench backfill as
directed by the Engineer
• Trench dewatering (if needed), including but not limited to sump pumps and hoses and
sedimentation tank mobilization, assembly, maintenance, relocation, and removal
• Furnishing and installing additional ductile iron fittings, wedge type restrained joint
follower glands at all fittings with mechanical joint ends, polyethylene encasement
• Installing horizontal and vertical concrete thrust blocking. Furnishing of concrete for
thrust blocking will be paid under the bid item for concrete thrust blocks
• Furnishing, placing, and compacting crushed surfacing base course for pipe bedding
materials and for pipe zone backfill materials for ductile iron pipes and fittings
• Placing and compacting trench backfill
• Performing backfill compaction tests and furnishing test reports to the Engineer
1-09.14(2)D26 Side Sewer Replacement (Bid Item D34) – Linear Foot
See B20 above.
1-09.14(2)D27 Resolution of Utility Conflicts (Bid Item D35) – Estimate
See B21 above.
1-09.14(2)D28 Survey Monument Restoration (Bid Item D36) – Each
See B22 above.
97
1-10 TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL
1-10.1 General
Revise the first paragraph to read:
(******)
Temporary traffic control refers to the control of all types of traffic, including vehicles, bicyclists, and
pedestrians (including pedestrians with disabilities). The Contractor shall provide flaggers, signs, and
other traffic control devices not otherwise specified as being furnished by the Contracting Agency.
The Contractor shall erect and maintain all construction signs, warning signs, detour signs, and other
traffic control devices necessary to warn and protect the public at all times from injury or damage as
a result of the Contractor’s operations which may occur on highways, roads, streets, sidewalks, or
paths. No Work shall be done on or adjacent to any traveled way until all necessary signs and traffic
control devices are in place.
Section 1-10.1 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
When the bid proposal includes an item for “Project Temporary Traffic Control,” the Work required
for this item shall be all items described in Section 1-10, including, but not limited to:
1. Furnishing and maintaining barricades, flashers, construction signing, and other
channelization devices, unless a pay item is in the bid proposal for any specific device and the
Special Provisions specify furnishing, maintaining, and payment in a different manner for that
device;
2. Furnishing traffic control labor, equipment, and supervisory personnel for all traffic control
labor;
3. Furnishing any necessary vehicle(s) to set up and remove the Class B construction signs and
other traffic control devices;
4. Furnishing labor and vehicles for patrolling and maintaining in position all of the construction
signs and the traffic control devices, unless a pay item is in the bid proposal to specifically pay
for this Work; and
5. Furnishing labor, material, and equipment necessary for cleaning up, removing, and replacing
of the construction signs and the traffic control devices destroyed or damaged during the life
of the project.
6. Removing existing signs as specified or as directed by the Engineer and delivering to the City
Shops, or storing and reinstalling as directed by the Engineer.
7. Preparing a traffic control plan for the project and designating the person responsible for
traffic control at the Work site. The traffic control plan shall include descriptions of the traffic
control methods and devices to be used by the prime Contractor, and subcontractors, shall
be submitted at or before the preconstruction conference, and shall be subject to review and
approval of the Engineer.
8. Contacting police, fire, 911, and ambulance services to notify them in advance of any Work
that will affect and traveled portion of a roadway.
98
9. Assuring that all traveled portions of roadways are open to traffic during peak traffic periods,
6:30 a.m. to 8:30 a.m., and 3:00 p.m. to 6:00 p.m., or as specified in the special provisions, or
as directed by the Engineer.
10. Promptly removing or covering all non-applicable signs during periods when they are not
needed.
If no bid item “Project Temporary Traffic Control” appears in the proposal, then all Work required by
these sections will be considered incidental and their cost shall be included in the other items of Work.
If the Engineer requires the Contractor to furnish additional channelizing devices, pieces of
equipment, or services, which could not be usually anticipated, by a prudent Contractor for the
maintenance and protection of traffic, then a new item or items may be established to pay for such
items. Further limitations for consideration of payment for these items are that they are not covered
by other pay items in the bid proposal, they are not specified in the Special Provisions as incidental,
and the accumulative cost for the use of each individual channelizing device, piece of equipment, or
service must exceed $200 in total cost for the duration of their need. In the event of disputes, the
Engineer will determine what is usually anticipated by a prudent Contractor. The cost for these items
will be by agreed price, price established by the Engineer, or by force account. Additional items
required as a result of the Contractor’s modification to the traffic control plan(s) appearing in the
Contract shall not be covered by the provisions in this paragraph.
If the total cost of all the Work under the Contract increases or decreases by more than 25 percent,
an equitable adjustment will be considered for the item “Project Temporary Traffic Control” to
address the increase or decrease.
Traffic control and maintenance for the safety of the traveling public on this project shall be the sole
responsibility of the Contractor and all methods and equipment used will be subject to the approval
of the Owner.
Traffic control devices and their use shall conform to City of Renton standards and the Manual on
Uniform Traffic Control Devices( MUTCD).
The Contractor shall not proceed with any construction until proper traffic control has been provided
to the satisfaction of the Engineer. Any days lost due to improper traffic control will be charged against
the Contractor’s allowable contract time, and shall not be the cause for a claim for extra days to
complete the Work.
1-10.2(1)B Traffic Control Supervisor
Paragraphs 1 and 2 are revised as follows:
(******)
A Traffic Control Supervisor (TCS) shall be on the project whenever traffic control labor is required or
as authorized by the Engineer.
The TCS shall assure that all the duties of the TCS are performed during the duration of the Contract.
During non-Work periods, the TCS shall be able to be on the job site within a 45-minute time period
after notification by the Engineer.
99
1-10.2(2) Traffic Control Plans
Section 1-10.2(2) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall be responsible for assuring that traffic control is installed and maintained in
conformance to established standards. The Contractor shall continuously evaluate the operation of
the traffic control plan and take prompt action to correct any problems that become evident during
operation.
Special Conditions
• The Contractor shall maintain at least one continuous ADA accessible pedestrian walkway
through the project area at all times.
• The Contractor shall coordinate with local garbage and recycling collection and school bus
routes that may be affected.
1-10.3 Traffic Control Labor, Procedures, and Devices
Section 1-10.3 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
At the end of each working day, provisions shall be made for the safe passage of traffic and
pedestrians during non-working hours.
Barricades shall be reflectorized as specified in Part VI of the MUTCD and shall be 3M-diamond grade
or equivalent approved by the Engineer. Barricades shall also be equipped with flashers during hours
of darkness.
Drivers of motor vehicles used in connection with the construction shall obey traffic rules posted for
such location in the same manner and under the same restrictions as provided for the drivers of
private vehicles.
The Contractor shall conduct the work in such a manner as will obstruct and inconvenience vehicular
and pedestrian traffic as little as possible. The streets, sidewalks and private driveways shall be kept
open by the Contractor except for the brief periods when actual work is being done. The Contractor
shall so conduct his operations so as to have under construction no greater length or amount of work
than Contractor can prosecute vigorously and Contractor shall not open up sections of the work and
leave them in an unfinished condition. See Section 1-07.23(1) for additional driveway closure
requirements.
The Contractor shall provide traffic cones, barricades, and drums, with warning lights in sufficient
number and in good condition as required to protect the work and the public throughout the length
of the job. Traffic Safety Drums with flashers in addition to temporary striping will be used to
channelize traffic through construction zones. Opposing lanes of traffic will be separated by pylons
when clearance for drums is not adequate. All signing and channelization shall be per current MUTCD
standards.
Temporary paint striping, reflective marking tape, and/or retroreflective tubular markers shall be
required for each shift of traffic control. The Contractor shall provide temporary striping, reflective
marking tape, and/or retroreflective tubular markers as required at the direction of the Engineer.
Paint, reflective marking tape, and/or retroreflective tubular markers used for temporary striping shall
meet the requirement of Section 8-23 of the Specifications.
100
1-10.3(3)A Construction Signs
Section 1-10.3(3)A is supplemented as follows:
(******)
No separate pay item will be provided in the bid proposal for Class A or Class B construction signs. All
costs for the Work to provide Class A or Class B construction signs shall be included in the unit contract
price for the various other items of the Work in the bid proposal.
1-10.3(3)C Portable Changeable Message Sign
Section 1-10.3(3)C is supplemented as follows:
(******)
When feasible, position PCMS or mPCMSs to provide at least 2 feet of lateral clearance from the
nearest open lane and transversely delineate with at least 3 channelization devices. For truck-
mounted PCMSs, provide 2 feet of lateral clearance when feasible but transverse delineation is not
required.
The Contractor shall remove these devices from the work zone clear zone when not in use unless
protected by barrier or guardrail.
1-11 RENTON SURVEYING STANDARDS
The following is a new section with new subsections:
(******)
1-11.1(1) Responsibility for Surveys
All surveys and survey reports shall be prepared under the direct supervision of a person registered
to practice land surveying under the provisions of Chapter 18.43 RCW.
All surveys and survey reports shall be prepared in accordance with the requirements established by
the Board of Registration for Professional Engineers and Land Surveyors under the provisions of
Chapter 18.43 RCW.
1-11.1(2) Survey Datum and Precision
The horizontal component of all surveys shall have as its coordinate base: The North American Datum
of 1983/91.
All horizontal control for projects must be referenced to or in conjunction with a minimum of two of
the City of Renton's Survey Control Network monuments. The source of the coordinate values used
will be shown on the survey drawing per RCW 58.09.070.
The horizontal component of all surveys shall meet or exceed the closure requirements of WAC 332-
130-060. The control base lines for all surveys shall meet or exceed the requirements for a Class A
survey revealed in Table 2 of the Minimum Standard Detail Requirements for ALTA/ACSM Land Title
Surveys jointly established and adopted by ALTA and ACSM in 1992 or comparable classification in
future editions of said document. The angular and linear closure and precision ratio of traverses used
for survey control shall be revealed on the face of the survey drawing, as shall the method of
adjustment.
101
The horizontal component of the control system for surveys using global positioning system
methodology shall exhibit at least 1 part in 50,000 precision in line length dependent error analysis at
a 95 percent confidence level and performed pursuant to Federal Geodetic Control Subcommittee
Standards for GPS control surveys as defined in Geometric Geodetic Accuracy Standards &
Specifications for Using GPS Relative Positioning Techniques dated August 1, 1989, or comparable
classification in future editions of said document.
The vertical component of all surveys shall be based on NAVD 1988, the North American Vertical
Datum of 1988, and tied to at least one of the City of Renton Survey Control Network benchmarks. If
there are two such benchmarks within 3000 feet of the project site a tie to both shall be made. The
benchmark(s) used will be shown on the drawing. If a City of Renton benchmark does not exist within
3000 feet of a project, one must be set on or near the project in a permanent manner that will remain
intact throughout the duration of the project. Source of elevations (benchmark) will be shown on the
drawing, as well as a description of any benchmarks established.
1-11.1(3) Subdivision Information
Those surveys dependent on section subdivision shall reveal the controlling monuments used and the
subdivision of the applicable quarter section.
Those surveys dependent on retracement of a plat or short plat shall reveal the controlling
monuments, measurements, and methodology used in that retracement.
1-11.1(4) Field Notes
Field notes shall be kept in conventional format in a standard bound field book with waterproof pages.
In cases where an electronic data collector is used field notes must also be kept with a sketch and a
record of control and base line traverses describing station occupations and what measurements were
made at each point.
Every point located or set shall be identified by a number and a description. Point numbers shall be
unique within a complete job. The preferred method of point numbering is field notebook, page and
point set on that page. Example: The first point set or found on page 16 of field book 348 would be
identified as Point No. 348.16.01, the second point would be 348.16.02, etc.
Upon completion of a City of Renton project, either the field notebook(s) provided by the City or the
original field notebook(s) used by the Surveyor will be given to the City. For all other Work, Surveyors
will provide a copy of the notes to the City upon request. In those cases where an electronic data
collector is used, a hard copy print out in ASCII text format will accompany the field notes.
1-11.1(5) Corners and Monuments
Corner: A point on a land boundary, at the juncture of two or more boundary lines. A monument is
usually set at such points to physically reference a corner's location on the ground.
Monument: Any physical object or structure of record, which marks or accurately references:
• A corner or other survey point established by or under the supervision of an individual per
Section 1-11.1(1) and any corner or monument established by the General Land Office and its
successor the Bureau of Land Management including section subdivision corners down to and
including one-sixteenth corners; and
102
• Any permanently monumented boundary, right-of-way alignment, or horizontal and vertical
control points established by any governmental agency or private surveyor including street
intersections but excluding dependent interior lot corners.
1-11.1(6) Control or Base Line Survey
Control or Base Line Surveys shall be established for all construction projects that will create
permanent structures such as roads, sidewalks, bridges, utility lines or appurtenances, signal or light
poles, or any non-single family building. Control or Base Line Surveys shall consist of such number of
permanent monuments as are required such that every structure may be observed for staking or "as-
builting" while occupying one such monument and sighting another such monument. A minimum of
two of these permanent monuments shall be existing monuments, recognized and on record with the
City of Renton. The Control or Base Line Survey shall occupy each monument in turn, and shall satisfy
all applicable requirements of Section 1-11.1 herein.
The drawing depicting the survey shall be neat, legible, and drawn to an appropriate scale. North
orientation should be clearly presented and the scale shown graphically as well as noted. The drawing
must be of such quality that a reduction thereof to one-half original scale remains legible.
If recording of the survey with the King County Recorder is required, it will be prepared on 18 inch by
24 inch mylar and will comply with all provisions of Chapter 58.09 RCW. A photographic mylar of the
drawing will be submitted to the City of Renton and, upon their review and acceptance per the specific
requirements of the project, the original will be recorded with the King County Recorder.
If recording is not required, the survey drawing shall be prepared on 22 inch by 34 inch mylar, and the
original or a photographic mylar thereof will be submitted to the City of Renton.
The survey drawings shall meet or exceed the requirements of WAC 332-130-050 and shall conform
to the City of Renton's Drafting Standards. American Public Works Association symbols shall be used
whenever possible, and a legend shall identify all symbols used if each point marked by a symbol is
not described at each use.
An electronic listing of all principal points shown on the drawing shall be submitted with each drawing.
The listing should include the point number designation (corresponding with that in the field notes),
a brief description of the point, and northing, easting, and elevation (if applicable) values, all in ASCII
format, on IBM PC compatible media.
1-11.1(7) Precision Levels
Vertical Surveys for the establishment of benchmarks shall satisfy all applicable requirements of
Sections 1-05 and 1-11.1.
Vertical surveys for the establishment of benchmarks shall meet or exceed the standards,
Specifications and procedures of third order elevation accuracy established by the Federal Geodetic
Control Committee.
Benchmarks must possess both permanence and vertical stability. Descriptions of benchmarks must
be complete to insure both recoverability and positive identification on recovery.
1-11.1(8) Radial and Station -- Offset Topography
Topographic surveys shall satisfy all applicable requirements of Section 1-11.1 herein.
All points occupied or back sighted in developing radial topography or establishing baselines for
station-offset topography shall meet the requirements of Section 1-11.1 herein.
103
The drawing and electronic listing requirements set forth in Section 1-11.1 herein shall be observed
for all topographic surveys.
1-11.1(9) Radial Topography
Elevations for the points occupied or back sighted in a radial topographic survey shall be determined
either by, 1) spirit leveling with misclosure not to exceed 0.1 feet or Federal Geodetic Control
Committee third order elevation accuracy Specifications, OR 2) trigonometric leveling with elevation
differences determined in at least two directions for each point and with misclosure of the circuit not
to exceed 0.1 feet.
1-11.1(10) Station--Offset Topography
Elevations of the baseline and topographic points shall be determined by spirit leveling and shall
satisfy Federal Geodetic Control Committee Specifications as to the turn points and shall not exceed
0.1 foot's error as to side shots.
1-11.1(11) As-Built Survey
All improvements required to be "as-built" (post construction survey) per City of Renton Codes, TITLE
4 Building Regulations and TITLE 9 Public Ways and Property, must be located both horizontally and
vertically by a Radial survey or by a Station offset survey. The "as-built" survey must be based on the
same base line or control survey used for the construction staking survey for the improvements being
"as-built". The "as-built" survey for all subsurface improvements should occur prior to backfilling.
Close cooperation between the installing Contractor and the "as-builting" surveyor is therefore
required.
All "as-built" surveys shall satisfy the requirements of Section 1-11.1(1) herein, and shall be based
upon control or base line surveys made in conformance with these Specifications.
The field notes for "as-built" shall meet the requirements of Section 1-11.1(4) herein, and submitted
with stamped and signed "as-built" drawings which includes a statement certifying the accuracy of
the "as-built".
The drawing and electronic listing requirements set forth in Section 1-11.1(6) herein shall be observed
for all "as-built" surveys.
1-11.1(12) Monument Setting and Referencing
All property or lot corners, as defined in 1-11.1(5), established or reestablished on a plat or other
recorded survey shall be referenced by a permanent marker at the corner point per 1-11.2(1). In
situations where such markers are impractical or in danger of being destroyed, e.g., the front corners
of lots, a witness marker shall be set. In most cases, this will be the extension of the lot line to a tack
in lead in the curb. The relationship between the witness monuments and their respective corners
shall be shown or described on the face of the plat or survey of record, e.g., “Tacks in lead on the
extension of the lot side lines have been set in the curbs on the extension of said line with the curb."
In all other cases the corner shall meet the requirements of Section 1-11.2(1) herein.
All non-corner monuments, as defined in 1-11.1(5), shall meet the requirements of Section 1-11.2(2)
herein. If the monument falls within a paved portion of a right-of-way or other area, the monument
shall be set below the ground surface and contained within a lidded case kept separate from the
monument and flush with the pavement surface, per Section 1-11.2(3).
104
In the case of right-of-way centerline monuments all points of curvature (PC), points of tangency (PT),
street intersections, center points of cul-de-sacs shall be set. If the point of intersection (PI) for the
tangents of a curve fall within the paved portion of the right-of-way, a monument can be set at the PI
instead of the PC and PT of the curve.
For all non corner monuments set while under contract to the City of Renton or as part of a City of
Renton approved subdivision of property, a City of Renton Monument Card (furnished by the city)
identifying the monument; point of intersection (PI), point of tangency (PT), point of curvature (PC),
one-sixteenth corner, Plat monument, street intersection, etc., complete with a description of the
monument, a minimum of two reference points and NAD 83/91 coordinates, and NAVD 88 elevation
shall be filled out and filed with the city.
1-11.2 Materials
1-11.2(1) Property/Lot Corners
Corners per 1-11.1(5) shall be marked in a permanent manner such as 1/2 inch diameter rebar 24
inches in length, durable metal plugs or caps, tack in lead, etc., and permanently marked or tagged
with the surveyor's identification number. The specific nature of the marker used can be determined
by the surveyor at the time of installation.
1-11.2(2) Monuments
Monuments per 1-11.1(5) shall meet the requirements as set forth in City of Renton Standard Plans
page H031 and permanently marked or tagged with the surveyor's identification number.
1-11.2(3) Monument Case and Cover
Materials shall meet the requirements of Section 9-22 and City of Renton Standard Plans page H031.
105
DIVISION 2 EARTHWORK
2-01 CLEARING, GRUBBING, AND ROADSIDE CLEANUP
2-01.1 Description
Section 2-01.1 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The limits of clearing and grubbing (construction limits) shall be defined as being the construction
limit lines as shown in the Plans. Where, in the opinion of the Engineer, any trees abutting or adjacent
to the limits of clearing and grubbing are damaged and require removal, the Contractor shall remove
such trees. Any trees flagged by the Engineer to remain within the clearing and grubbing limits shall
be left undamaged by the Contractor’s operations. Any flagged trees, which are damaged, shall be
replaced in kind at the Contractor’s expense.
Existing landscaping outside the construction limits, including but not limited to, sod, rockeries,
beauty bark, decorative gravel or rock, bushes, and shrubbery shall be protected from damage.
The property owners shall be responsible for removing and/or relocating irrigation equipment, trees,
shrubs, curbing, ornamental plants, and any other decorative landscaping materials within the
construction limits that they wish to save. The Contractor shall give property owners 10 days’ written
notice prior to removing landscaping materials. All landscaping materials that remain in the
construction limits after that time period shall be removed and disposed of, by the Contractor, in
accordance with Section 2-01 of the Standard Specifications, these Special Provisions, and the Plans.
The Contractor shall receive approval from the Engineer prior to removal.
2-01.2 Disposal of Usable Material and Debris
Section 2-01.2 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall dispose of all debris by Disposal Method No. 2 – Waste Site.
2-01.3(1) Clearing
Section 2-01.3(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
8. Remove shrubs, hedges, and/or bushes and associated stumps where noted in the plans.
9. Trim all shrubs, hedges, and/or bushes to be left standing to the height specified by the Engineer,
neatly cutting all limbs close to the hunk.
2-02 REMOVAL OF STRUCTURES AND OBSTRUCTIONS
2-02.3(3) Removal of Pavement, Sidewalks, Curbs, and Gutters
Section 2-02.3(3) is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
Item “1” is revised as follows:
106
In removing pavement, sidewalks, driveways, and curbs, the Contractor shall haul broken-up
pieces to an approved off-project site.
The section is supplemented as follows:
When an area where pavement, sidewalk, or driveway has been removed is to be opened to traffic
before pavement patching has been completed, temporary mix asphalt concrete patch shall be
required. Temporary patching shall be placed to a minimum depth of 2 inches immediately after
backfilling and compaction are complete, and before the road is opened to traffic. Medium curing
(MC) cold mix or MC hot mix shall be used at the discretion of the Engineer.
2-03 ROADWAY EXCAVATION AND EMBANKMENT
2-03.3 Construction Requirements
Section 2-03.3 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Roadway excavation shall include the removal of all materials excavated from within the limits shown
on the Plans. Suitable excavated material shall be used for embankments, while surplus excavated
material or unsuitable material shall be disposed of by the Contractor.
Earthwork quantities and changes will be computed, either manually or by means of electronic data
processing equipment, by use of the average end area method. Any changes to the proposed Work
as directed by the Engineer that would alter these quantities shall be calculated by the Engineer and
submitted to the Contractor for his review and verification.
Any excavation or embankment beyond the limits indicated in the Plans, unless ordered by the
Engineer, shall not be paid for. All Work and material required to return these areas to their original
conditions, as directed by the Engineer, shall be provided by the Contractor at his sole expense.
All areas shall be excavated, filled, and/or backfilled as necessary to comply with the grades shown
on the Plans. In filled and backfilled areas, fine grading shall begin during the placement and the
compaction of the final layer. In cut sections, fine grading shall begin within the final six (6) inches of
cut. Final grading shall produce a surface, which is smooth and even, without abrupt changes in grade.
Excavation for curbs and gutters shall be accomplished by cutting accurately to the cross sections,
grades and elevations shown. Care shall be taken not to excavate below the specified grades. The
Contractor shall maintain all excavations free from detrimental quantities of leaves, brush, sticks,
trash, and other debris until final acceptance of the Work.
Following removal of topsoil or excavation to grade, and before placement of fills or base course, the
subgrade under the roadway shall be proof-rolled to identify any soft or loose areas which may
warrant additional compaction or excavation and replacement.
The Contractor shall provide temporary drainage or protection to keep the subgrade free from
standing water.
Acceptable excavated native soils shall be used for fill in the area requiring fills. Care shall be taken to
place excavated material at the optimum moisture content to achieve the specified compaction. Any
native material used for fill shall be free of organics and debris, and have a maximum particle size of
6 inches.
It shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to prevent the native materials from becoming
saturated with water. The measures may include sloping to drain, compacting the native materials,
107
and diverting runoff away from the materials. If the Contractor fails to take such preventative
measures, any costs or delay related to drying the materials shall be at his own expense.
If the native materials become saturated, it shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to dry the
materials, to the optimum moisture content. If sufficient acceptable native soils are not available to
complete construction of the roadway embankment, Gravel Borrow shall be used.
If subgrade trimmer is not required on the project, all portions of Section 2-03 shall apply as though a
subgrade trimmer were specified.
If sufficient acceptable native soils, as determined by the Engineer, are not available to complete
construction of the roadway embankment, Gravel Borrow meeting the requirements of Section
9-03.14 of the Standard Specifications, shall be used.
2-04 HAUL
2-04.5 Payment
Section 2-04.5 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
All costs for the hauling of material to, from, or on the job site shall be considered incidental to and
included in the unit price of other units of Work.
2-06 SUBGRADE PREPARATION
2-06.5 Measurement and Payment
Section 2-06.5 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Subgrade preparation and maintenance including watering shall be considered as incidental to the
construction and all costs thereof shall be included in the appropriate unit or lump sum contract bid
prices.
2-09 STRUCTURE EXCAVATION
2-09.1 Description
Section 2-09.1 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
This Work also includes the excavation, haul, and disposal of all unsuitable materials such as peat,
muck, swampy or unsuitable materials, including buried logs and stumps.
2-09.3(1)D Disposal of Excavated Material
Section 2-09.3(1)D is revised as follows:
(******)
The second paragraph is replaced with:
All costs for disposing of excavated material within or external to the project limits shall be
included in the unit contract price for structure excavation, Class A or B.
108
The third paragraph is replaced with:
If the Contract includes structure excavation, Class A or B, including haul, the unit contract price
shall include all costs for loading and hauling the material the full required distance, otherwise all
such disposal costs shall be considered incidental to the Work.
2-09.4 Measurement
Section 2-09.4 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
“Structure Excavation Class ___ Incl Haul,” shall not be measured.
2-09.5 Payment
Section 2-09.5 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
Payment will not be considered for “Structure Excavation Class __ Incl. Haul,” and shall be considered
incidental to unit bid price of other items of work.
When gravel backfill is paid by the ton, the Contractor shall take care to assure to the satisfaction of
the Engineer that such per ton backfill is only being used for the specified purpose and not for
purposes where backfill is incidental or being paid by cubic yard. Evidence that per ton gravel backfill
is not being used for its designated purpose shall be grounds for the Engineer to deny payment for
such load tickets.
109
DIVISION 5 SURFACE TREATMENTS AND PAVEMENTS
5-04 HOT MIX ASPHALT
Delete Section 5-04, Hot Mix Asphalt and replace it with the following:
(******)
5-04 Hot Mix Asphalt (Non-Statistical, Commercial)
5-04.1 Description
This Work shall consist of providing and placing one or more layers of plant-mixed hot mix asphalt
(HMA) on a prepared foundation or base in accordance with these Specifications. and the lines,
grades, thicknesses, and typical cross-sections shown in the Plans. The Contractor shall maintain the
existing street surface contours (e.g. street profile and cross section, etc.), unless otherwise directed
by the Engineer. The manufacture of HMA may include warm mix asphalt (WMA) processes in
accordance with these Specifications. WMA processes include organic additives, chemical additives,
and foaming.
HMA shall be composed of asphalt binder and mineral materials as may be required, mixed in the
proportions specified to provide a homogeneous, stable, and workable mixture.
All HMA to be placed in this contract shall be HMA CL. ½” PG 58H-22.
5-04.2 Materials
Materials shall meet the requirements of the following sections:
Asphalt Binder 9-02.1(4)
Cationic Emulsified Asphalt 9-02.1(6)
Anti-Stripping Additive 9-02.4
HMA Additive 9-02.5
Aggregates 9-03.8
Recycled Asphalt Pavement 9-03.8(3)B
Mineral Filler 9-03.8(5)
Recycled Material 9-03.21
Portland Cement 9-01
Sand 9-03.1(2)
(As noted in 5-04.3(5)C for crack sealing)
Joint Sealant 9-04.2
Foam Backer Rod 9-04.2(3)A
The Contract documents may establish that the various mineral materials required for the
manufacture of HMA will be furnished in whole or in part by the Contracting Agency. If the documents
do not establish the furnishing of any of these mineral materials by the Contracting Agency, the
110
Contractor shall be required to furnish such materials in the amounts required for the designated mix.
Mineral materials include coarse and fine aggregates, and mineral filler.
The Contractor may choose to utilize recycled asphalt pavement (RAP) in the production of HMA. The
RAP may be from pavements removed under the Contract, if any, or pavement material from an
existing stockpile.
The Contractor may use up to 20 percent RAP by total weight of HMA with no additional sampling or
testing of the RAP. The RAP shall be sampled and tested at a frequency of one sample for every 1,000
tons produced and not less than ten samples per project. The asphalt content and gradation test data
shall be reported to the Contracting Agency when submitting the mix design for approval on the QPL.
The Contractor shall include the RAP as part of the mix design as defined in these Specifications.
The grade of asphalt binder shall be as required by the Contract. Blending of asphalt binder from
different sources is not permitted.
The Contractor may only use warm mix asphalt (WMA) processes in the production of HMA with 20
percent or less RAP by total weight of HMA. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer for approval
the process that is proposed and how it will be used in the manufacture of HMA.
Production of aggregates shall comply with the requirements of Section 3-01.
Preparation of stockpile site, the stockpiling of aggregates, and the removal of aggregates from
stockpiles shall comply with the requirements of Section 3-02.
5-04.2(1) How to Get an HMA Mix Design on the QPL
If the contractor wishes to submit a mix design for inclusion in the Qualified Products List (QPL), please
follow the WSDOT process as follows:
Comply with each of the following:
• Develop the mix design in accordance with WSDOT SOP 732.
• Develop a mix design that complies with Sections 9-03.8(2) and 9-03.8(6).
• Develop a mix design no more than 6 months prior to submitting it for QPL evaluation.
• Submit mix designs to the WSDOT State Materials Laboratory in Tumwater, including WSDOT
Form 350-042.
• Include representative samples of the materials that are to be used in the HMA production as
part of the mix design submittal.
• Identify the brand, type, and percentage of anti-stripping additive in the mix design submittal.
• Include with the mix design submittal a certification from the asphalt binder supplier that the
anti-stripping additive is compatible with the crude source and the formulation of asphalt
binder proposed for use in the mix design.
• Do not include warm mix asphalt (WMA) additives when developing a mix design or
submitting a mix design for QPL evaluation. The use of warm mix asphalt (WMA) additives is
not part of the process for obtaining approval for listing a mix design on the QPL. Refer to
Section 5-04.2(2)B.
111
5-04.2(1)A Vacant
5-04.2(2) Mix Design – Obtaining Project Approval
No paving shall begin prior to the approval of the mix design by the Engineer.
Nonstatistical evaluation will be used for all HMA not designated as Commercial HMA in the contract
documents.
Commercial evaluation will be used for Commercial HMA and for other classes of HMA in the
following applications: sidewalks, road approaches, ditches, slopes, paths, trails, gores, prelevel, and
pavement repair. Other nonstructural applications of HMA accepted by commercial evaluation shall
be as approved by the Engineer. Sampling and testing of HMA accepted by commercial evaluation will
be at the option of the Engineer. The Proposal quantity of HMA that is accepted by commercial
evaluation will be excluded from the quantities used in the determination of nonstatistical evaluation.
Nonstatistical Mix Design. Fifteen days prior to the first day of paving the contractor shall provide
one of the following mix design verification certifications for Contracting Agency review;
• The WSDOT Mix Design Evaluation Report from the current WSDOT QPL, or one of the mix
design verification certifications listed below.
• The proposed HMA mix design on WSDOT Form 350-042 with the seal and certification (stamp
& sig-nature) of a valid licensed Washington State Professional Engineer.
• The Mix Design Report for the proposed HMA mix design developed by a qualified City or
County laboratory that is within one year of the approval date.**
**The mix design shall be performed by a lab accredited by a national authority such as
Laboratory Accreditation Bureau, L-A-B for Construction Materials Testing, The Construction
Materials Engineering Council (CMEC’s) ISO 17025 or AASHTO Accreditation Program (AAP)
and shall supply evidence of participation in the AASHTO: resource proficiency sample
program.
Mix designs for HMA accepted by Nonstatistical evaluation shall;
• Have the aggregate structure and asphalt binder content determined in accordance with
WSDOT Standard Operating Procedure 732 and meet the requirements of Sections 9-03.8(2),
except that Hamburg testing for ruts and stripping are at the discretion of the Engineer, and
9-03.8(6).
• Have anti-strip requirements, if any, for the proposed mix design determined in accordance
with AASHTO T 283 or T 324, or based on historic anti-strip and aggregate source compatibility
from previous WSDOT lab testing.
At the discretion of the Engineer, agencies may accept verified mix designs older than 12
months from the original verification date with a certification from the Contractor that the
materials and sources are the same as those shown on the original mix design.
Commercial Evaluation. Approval of a mix design for “Commercial Evaluation” will be based on a
review of the Contractor’s submittal of WSDOT Form 350-042 (For commercial mixes, AASHTO T 324
evaluation is not required) or a Mix Design from the current WSDOT QPL or from one of the processes
allowed by this section. Testing of the HMA by the Contracting Agency for mix design approval is not
required.
112
For the Bid Item Commercial HMA, the Contractor shall select a class of HMA and design level of
Equivalent Single Axle Loads (ESAL’s) appropriate for the required use.
ESAL's
The number of ESAL's for the design and acceptance of the HMA shall be 4 million.
5-04.2(2)B Using Warm Mix Asphalt Processes
The Contractor may elect to use additives that reduce the optimum mixing temperature or serve as a
compaction aid for producing HMA. Additives include organic additives, chemical additives and
foaming processes. The use of Additives is subject to the following:
• Do not use additives that reduce the mixing temperature more than allowed in Section
5-04.3(6) in the production of mixtures.
• Before using additives, obtain the Engineer’s approval using WSDOT Form 350-076 to describe
the proposed additive and process.
5-04.3 Construction Requirements
5-04.3(1) Weather Limitations
Do not place HMA for wearing course on any Traveled Way beginning October 1st through March 31st
of the following year without written concurrence from the Engineer.
Do not place HMA on any wet surface, or when the average surface temperatures are less than those
specified below, or when weather conditions otherwise prevent the proper handling or finishing of
the HMA.
Minimum Surface Temperature for Paving
Compacted Thickness (Feet) Wearing Course Other Courses
Less than 0.10 55°F 45°F
0.10 to .20 45°F 35°F
More than 0.20 35°F 35°F
5-04.3(2) Paving Under Traffic
When the Roadway being paved is open to traffic, the requirements of this Section shall apply.
The Contractor shall keep intersections open to traffic at all times except when paving the intersection
or paving across the intersection. During such time, and provided that there has been an advance
warning to the public, the intersection may be closed for the minimum time required to place and
compact the mixture. In hot weather, the Engineer may require the application of water to the
pavement to accelerate the finish rolling of the pavement and to shorten the time required before
reopening to traffic.
Before closing an intersection, advance warning signs shall be placed and signs shall also be placed
marking the detour or alternate route.
During paving operations, temporary pavement markings shall be maintained throughout the project.
Temporary pavement markings shall be installed on the Roadway prior to opening to traffic.
Temporary pavement markings shall be in accordance with Section 8-23.
113
All costs in connection with performing the Work in accordance with these requirements, except the
cost of temporary pavement markings, shall be included in the unit Contract prices for the various Bid
items involved in the Contract.
5-04.3(3) Equipment
5-04.3(3)A Mixing Plant
Plants used for the preparation of HMA shall conform to the following requirements:
1. Equipment for Preparation of Asphalt Binder – Tanks for the storage of asphalt binder shall
be equipped to heat and hold the material at the required temperatures. The heating shall be
accomplished by steam coils, electricity, or other approved means so that no flame shall be
in contact with the storage tank. The circulating system for the asphalt binder shall be
designed to ensure proper and continuous circulation during the operating period. A valve for
the purpose of sampling the asphalt binder shall be placed in either the storage tank or in the
supply line to the mixer.
2. Thermometric Equipment – An armored thermometer, capable of detecting temperature
ranges expected in the HMA mix, shall be fixed in the asphalt binder feed line at a location
near the charging valve at the mixer unit. The thermometer location shall be convenient and
safe for access by Inspectors. The plant shall also be equipped with an approved dial-scale
thermometer, a mercury actuated thermometer, an electric pyrometer, or another approved
thermometric instrument placed at the discharge chute of the drier to automatically register
or indicate the temperature of the heated aggregates. This device shall be in full view of the
plant operator.
3. Heating of Asphalt Binder – The temperature of the asphalt binder shall not exceed the
maximum recommended by the asphalt binder manufacturer nor shall it be below the
minimum temperature required to maintain the asphalt binder in a homogeneous state. The
asphalt binder shall be heated in a manner that will avoid local variations in heating. The
heating method shall provide a continuous supply of asphalt binder to the mixer at a uniform
average temperature with no individual variations exceeding 25°F. Also, when a WMA
additive is included in the asphalt binder, the temperature of the asphalt binder shall not
exceed the maximum recommended by the manufacturer of the WMA additive.
4. Sampling and Testing of Mineral Materials – The HMA plant shall be equipped with a
mechanical sampler for the sampling of the mineral materials. The mechanical sampler shall
meet the requirements of Section 1-05.6 for the crushing and screening operation. The
Contractor shall provide for the setup and operation of the field testing facilities of the
Contracting Agency as provided for in Section 3-01.2(2).
5. Sampling HMA – The HMA plant shall provide for sampling HMA by one of the following
methods:
a. A mechanical sampling device attached to the HMA plant.
b. Platforms or devices to enable sampling from the hauling vehicle without entering the
hauling vehicle.
5-04.3(3)B Hauling Equipment
Trucks used for hauling HMA shall have tight, clean, smooth metal beds and shall have a cover of
canvas or other suitable material of sufficient size to protect the mixture from adverse weather.
114
Whenever the weather conditions during the work shift include, or are forecast to include,
precipitation or an air temperature less than 45°F or when time from loading to unloading exceeds 30
minutes, the cover shall be securely attached to protect the HMA.
The contractor shall provide an environmentally benign means to prevent the HMA mixture from
adhering to the hauling equipment. Excess release agent shall be drained prior to filling hauling
equipment with HMA. Petroleum derivatives or other coating material that contaminate or alter the
characteristics of the HMA shall not be used. For live bed trucks, the conveyer shall be in operation
during the process of applying the release agent.
5-04.3(3)C Pavers
HMA pavers shall be self-contained, power-propelled units, provided with an internally heated
vibratory screed and shall be capable of spreading and finishing courses of HMA plant mix material in
lane widths required by the paving section shown in the Plans.
The HMA paver shall be in good condition and shall have the most current equipment available from
the manufacturer for the prevention of segregation of the HMA mixture installed, in good condition,
and in working order. The equipment certification shall list the make, model, and year of the paver
and any equipment that has been retrofitted.
The screed shall be operated in accordance with the manufacturer’s recommendations and shall
effectively produce a finished surface of the required evenness and texture without tearing, shoving,
segregating, or gouging the mixture. A copy of the manufacturer’s recommendations shall be
provided upon request by the Contracting Agency. Extensions will be allowed provided they produce
the same results, including ride, density, and surface texture as obtained by the primary screed.
Extensions without augers and an internally heated vibratory screed shall not be used in the
Traveled Way.
When specified in the Contract, reference lines for vertical control will be required. Lines shall be
placed on both outer edges of the Traveled Way of each Roadway. Horizontal control utilizing the
reference line will be permitted. The grade and slope for intermediate lanes shall be controlled
automatically from reference lines or by means of a mat referencing device and a slope control device.
When the finish of the grade prepared for paving is superior to the established tolerances and when,
in the opinion of the Engineer, further improvement to the line, grade, cross-section, and smoothness
can best be achieved without the use of the reference line, a mat referencing device may be
substituted for the reference line. Substitution of the device will be subject to the continued approval
of the Engineer. A joint matcher may be used subject to the approval of the Engineer. The reference
line may be removed after the completion of the first course of HMA when approved by the Engineer.
Whenever the Engineer determines that any of these methods are failing to provide the necessary
vertical control, the reference lines will be reinstalled by the Contractor.
The Contractor shall furnish and install all pins, brackets, tensioning devices, wire, and accessories
necessary for satisfactory operation of the automatic control equipment.
If the paving machine in use is not providing the required finish, the Engineer may suspend Work as
allowed by Section 1-08.6. Any cleaning or solvent type liquids spilled on the pavement shall be
thoroughly removed before paving proceeds.
5-04.3(3)D Material Transfer Device or Material Transfer Vehicle
A Material Transfer Device/Vehicle (MTD/V) shall only be used with the Engineer’s approval, unless
other-wise required by the contract.
115
Where an MTD/V is required by the contract, the Engineer may approve paving without an MTD/V,
at the request of the Contractor. The Engineer will determine if an equitable adjustment in cost or
time is due.
When used, the MTD/V shall mix the HMA after delivery by the hauling equipment and prior to
laydown by the paving machine. Mixing of the HMA shall be sufficient to obtain a uniform
temperature throughout the mixture. If a windrow elevator is used, the length of the windrow may
be limited in urban areas or through intersections, at the discretion of the Engineer.
To be approved for use, an MTV:
1. Shall be self-propelled vehicle, separate from the hauling vehicle or paver.
2. Shall not be connected to the hauling vehicle or paver.
3. May accept HMA directly from the haul vehicle or pick up HMA from a windrow.
4. Shall mix the HMA after delivery by the hauling equipment and prior to placement into the
paving machine.
5. Shall mix the HMA sufficiently to obtain a uniform temperature throughout the mixture.
To be approved for use, an MTD:
1. Shall be positively connected to the paver.
2. May accept HMA directly from the haul vehicle or pick up HMA from a windrow.
3. Shall mix the HMA after delivery by the hauling equipment and prior to placement into the
paving machine.
4. Shall mix the HMA sufficiently to obtain a uniform temperature throughout the mixture.
5-04.3(3)E Rollers
Rollers shall be of the steel wheel, vibratory, oscillatory, or pneumatic tire type, in good condition and
capable of reversing without backlash. Operation of the roller shall be in accordance with the
manufacturer’s recommendations. When ordered by the Engineer for any roller planned for use on
the project, the Contractor shall provide a copy of the manufacturer’s recommendation for the use of
that roller for compaction of HMA. The number and weight of rollers shall be sufficient to compact
the mixture in compliance with the requirements of Section 5-04.3(10). The use of equipment that
results in crushing of the aggregate will not be permitted. Rollers producing pickup, washboard,
uneven compaction of the surface, displacement of the mixture or other undesirable results shall not
be used.
5-04.3(4) Preparation of Existing Paved Surfaces
When the surface of the existing pavement or old base is irregular, the Contractor shall bring it to a
uniform grade and cross-section as shown on the Plans or approved by the Engineer.
Preleveling of uneven or broken surfaces over which HMA is to be placed may be accomplished by
using an asphalt paver, a motor patrol grader, or by hand raking, as approved by the Engineer.
Compaction of preleveling HMA shall be to the satisfaction of the Engineer and may require the use
of small steel wheel rollers, plate compactors, or pneumatic rollers to avoid bridging across preleveled
areas by the compaction equipment. Equipment used for the compaction of preleveling HMA shall be
approved by the Engineer.
116
Before construction of HMA on an existing paved surface, the entire surface of the pavement shall be
clean. All fatty asphalt patches, grease drippings, and other objectionable matter shall be entirely
removed from the existing pavement. All pavements or bituminous surfaces shall be thoroughly
cleaned of dust, soil, pavement grindings, and other foreign matter. All holes and small depressions
shall be filled with an appropriate class of HMA. The surface of the patched area shall be leveled and
compacted thoroughly. Prior to the application of tack coat, or paving, the condition of the surface
shall be approved by the Engineer.
A tack coat of asphalt shall be applied to all paved surfaces on which any course of HMA is to be placed
or abutted; except that tack coat may be omitted from clean, newly paved surfaces at the discretion
of the Engineer. Tack coat shall be uniformly applied to cover the existing pavement with a thin film
of residual asphalt free of streaks and bare spots at a rate between 0.02 and 0.10 gallons per square
yard of retained asphalt. The rate of application shall be approved by the Engineer. A heavy
application of tack coat shall be applied to all joints. For Roadways open to traffic, the application of
tack coat shall be limited to surfaces that will be paved during the same working shift. The spreading
equipment shall be equipped with a thermometer to indicate the temperature of the tack coat
material.
Equipment shall not operate on tacked surfaces until the tack has broken and cured. If the
Contractor’s operation damages the tack coat it shall be repaired prior to placement of the HMA.
The tack coat shall be CSS-1, or CSS-1h emulsified asphalt. The CSS-1 and CSS-1h emulsified asphalt
may be diluted once with water at a rate not to exceed one part water to one part emulsified asphalt.
The tack coat shall have sufficient temperature such that it may be applied uniformly at the specified
rate of application and shall not exceed the maximum temperature recommended by the emulsified
asphalt manufacturer.
All utility appurtenances (e.g. manhole covers, valve covers, etc.) located within the paving limits shall
be coated with a biodegradable soap to prevent the tack coat and HMA from sticking to them. Diesel
shall not be used for this purpose. After application of the biodegradable soap, all catch basins shall
be covered to prevent tack and HMA from entering into them.
5-04.3(4)A Crack Sealing
5-04.3(4)A1 General
When the Proposal includes a pay item for crack sealing, seal all cracks ¼ inch in width and greater.
Cleaning: Ensure that cracks are thoroughly clean, dry and free of all loose and foreign material when
filling with crack sealant material. Use a hot compressed air lance to dry and warm the pavement
surfaces within the crack immediately prior to filling a crack with the sealant material. Do not overheat
pavement. Do not use direct flame dryers. Routing cracks is not required.
Sand Slurry: For cracks that are to be filled with sand slurry, thoroughly mix the components and pour
the mixture into the cracks until full. Add additional CSS-1 cationic emulsified asphalt to the sand
slurry as needed for workability to ensure the mixture will completely fill the cracks. Strike off the
sand slurry flush with the existing pavement surface and allow the mixture to cure. Top off cracks that
were not completely filled with additional sand slurry. Do not place the HMA overlay until the slurry
has fully cured.
The sand slurry shall consist of approximately 20 percent CSS-1 emulsified asphalt, approximately 2
percent portland cement, water (if required), and the remainder clean Class 1 or 2 fine aggregate per
section 9-03.1(2). The components shall be thoroughly mixed and then poured into the cracks and
117
joints until full. The following day, any cracks or joints that are not completely filled shall be topped
off with additional sand slurry. After the sand slurry is placed, the filler shall be struck off flush with
the existing pavement surface and allowed to cure. The HMA overlay shall not be placed until the
slurry has fully cured. The requirements of Section 1-06 will not apply to the portland cement and
sand used in the sand slurry.
In areas where HMA will be placed, use sand slurry to fill the cracks.
In areas where HMA will not be placed, fill the cracks as follows:
1. Cracks ¼ inch to 1 inch in width - fill with hot poured sealant.
2. Cracks greater than 1 inch in width – fill with sand slurry.
Hot Poured Sealant: For cracks that are to be filled with hot poured sealant, apply the material in
accordance with these requirements and the manufacturer’s recommendations. Furnish a Type 1
Working Drawing of the manufacturer’s product information and recommendations to the Engineer
prior to the start of work, including the manufacturer’s recommended heating time and
temperatures, allowable storage time and temperatures after initial heating, allowable reheating
criteria, and application temperature range. Confine hot poured sealant material within the crack.
Clean any overflow of sealant from the pavement surface. If, in the opinion of the Engineer, the
Contractor’s method of sealing the cracks with hot poured sealant results in an excessive amount of
material on the pavement surface, stop and correct the operation to eliminate the excess material.
5-04.3(4)A2 Crack Sealing Areas Prior to Paving
In areas where HMA will be placed, use sand slurry to fill the cracks.
5-04.3(4)A3 Crack Sealing Areas Not to be Paved
In areas where HMA will not be placed, fill the cracks as follows:
A. Cracks ¼ inch to 1 inch in width - fill with hot poured sealant.
B. Cracks greater than 1 inch in width – fill with sand slurry.
5-04.3(4)B Vacant
5-04.3(4)C Pavement Repair
The Contractor shall excavate pavement repair areas and shall backfill these with HMA in accordance
with the details shown in the Plans and as marked in the field. The Contractor shall conduct the
excavation operations in a manner that will protect the pavement that is to remain. Pavement not
designated to be removed that is damaged as a result of the Contractor’s operations shall be repaired
by the Contractor to the satisfaction of the Engineer at no cost to the Contracting Agency. The
Contractor shall excavate only within one lane at a time unless approved otherwise by the Engineer.
The Contractor shall not excavate more area than can be completely finished during the same shift,
unless approved by the Engineer.
Unless otherwise shown in the Plans or determined by the Engineer, excavate to a depth of 1.0 feet.
The Engineer will make the final determination of the excavation depth required. The minimum width
of any pavement repair area shall be 40 inches unless shown otherwise in the Plans. Before any
excavation, the existing pavement shall be sawcut or shall be removed by a pavement grinder.
Excavated materials will become the property of the Contractor and shall be disposed of in a
Contractor-provided site off the Right of Way or used in accordance with Sections 2-02.3(3) or 9-03.21.
118
Asphalt for tack coat shall be required as specified in Section 5-04.3(4). A heavy application of tack
coat shall be applied to all surfaces of existing pavement in the pavement repair area.
Placement of the HMA backfill shall be accomplished in lifts not to exceed 0.35-foot compacted depth.
Lifts that exceed 0.35-foot of compacted depth may be accomplished with the approval of the
Engineer. Each lift shall be thoroughly compacted by a mechanical tamper or a roller.
5-04.3(5) Producing/Stockpiling Aggregates and RAP
Aggregates and RAP shall be stockpiled according to the requirements of Section 3-02. Sufficient
storage space shall be provided for each size of aggregate and RAP. Materials shall be removed from
stockpile(s) in a manner to ensure minimal segregation when being moved to the HMA plant for
processing into the final mixture. Different aggregate sizes shall be kept separated until they have
been delivered to the HMA plant.
5-04.3(5)A Vacant
5-04.3(6) Mixing
After the required amount of mineral materials, asphalt binder, recycling agent and anti-stripping
additives have been introduced into the mixer the HMA shall be mixed until complete and uniform
coating of the particles and thorough distribution of the asphalt binder throughout the mineral
materials is ensured.
When discharged, the temperature of the HMA shall not exceed the optimum mixing temperature by
more than 25°F as shown on the reference mix design report or as approved by the Engineer. Also,
when a WMA additive is included in the manufacture of HMA, the discharge temperature of the HMA
shall not exceed the maximum recommended by the manufacturer of the WMA additive. A maximum
water content of 2 percent in the mix, at discharge, will be allowed providing the water causes no
problems with handling, stripping, or flushing. If the water in the HMA causes any of these problems,
the moisture content shall be reduced as directed by the Engineer.
Storing or holding of the HMA in approved storage facilities will be permitted with approval of the
Engineer, but in no event shall the HMA be held for more than 24 hours. HMA held for more than 24
hours after mixing shall be rejected. Rejected HMA shall be disposed of by the Contractor at no
expense to the Contracting Agency. The storage facility shall have an accessible device located at the
top of the cone or about the third point. The device shall indicate the amount of material in storage.
No HMA shall be accepted from the storage facility when the HMA in storage is below the top of the
cone of the storage facility, except as the storage facility is being emptied at the end of the
working shift.
Recycled asphalt pavement (RAP) utilized in the production of HMA shall be sized prior to entering
the mixer so that a uniform and thoroughly mixed HMA is produced. If there is evidence of the
recycled asphalt pavement not breaking down during the heating and mixing of the HMA, the
Contractor shall immediately suspend the use of the RAP until changes have been approved by the
Engineer. After the required amount of mineral materials, RAP, new asphalt binder and asphalt
rejuvenator have been introduced into the mixer the HMA shall be mixed until complete and uniform
coating of the particles and thorough distribution of the asphalt binder throughout the mineral
materials, and RAP is ensured.
119
5-04.3(7) Spreading and Finishing
The mixture shall be laid upon an approved surface, spread, and struck off to the grade and elevation
established. HMA pavers complying with Section 5-04.3(3) shall be used to distribute the mixture.
Unless otherwise directed by the Engineer, the nominal compacted depth of any layer of any course
shall not exceed the following:
HMA Class 1” 0.35 feet
HMA Class ¾” and HMA Class ½”
wearing course 0.30 feet
other courses 0.35 feet
HMA Class ⅜” 0.15 feet
On areas where irregularities or unavoidable obstacles make the use of mechanical spreading and
finishing equipment impractical, the paving may be done with other equipment or by hand.
When more than one JMF is being utilized to produce HMA, the material produced for each JMF shall
be placed by separate spreading and compacting equipment. The intermingling of HMA produced
from more than one JMF is prohibited. Each strip of HMA placed during a work shift shall conform to
a single JMF established for the class of HMA specified unless there is a need to make an adjustment
in the JMF.
All cast off rock from raking shall be removed prior to compaction of final HMA lift.
5-04.3(8) Aggregate Acceptance Prior to Incorporation in HMA
For HMA accepted by nonstatistical evaluation the aggregate properties of sand equivalent,
uncompacted void content and fracture will be evaluated in accordance with Section 3-04. Sampling
and testing of aggregates for HMA accepted by commercial evaluation will be at the option of the
Engineer.
5-04.3(9) HMA Mixture Acceptance
Acceptance of HMA shall be as provided under nonstatistical, or commercial evaluation.
Nonstatistical evaluation will be used for the acceptance of HMA unless Commercial Evaluation is
specified.
Commercial evaluation will be used for Commercial HMA and for other classes of HMA in the following
applications: sidewalks, road approaches, ditches, slopes, paths, trails, gores, prelevel, temporary
pavement, and pavement repair. Other nonstructural applications of HMA accepted by commercial
evaluation shall be as approved by the Engineer. Sampling and testing of HMA accepted by
commercial evaluation will be at the option of the Engineer.
The mix design will be the initial JMF for the class of HMA. The Contractor may request a change in
the JMF. Any adjustments to the JMF will require the approval of the Engineer and may be made in
accordance with this section.
HMA Tolerances and Adjustments
1. Job Mix Formula Tolerances – The constituents of the mixture at the time of acceptance shall
be within tolerance. The tolerance limits will be established as follows:
120
For Asphalt Binder and Air Voids (Va), the acceptance limits are determined by adding the
tolerances below to the approved JMF values. These values will also be the Upper
Specification Limit (USL) and Lower Specification Limit (LSL) required in Section 1-06.2(2)D2.
Property Non-Statistical Evaluation Commercial Evaluation
Asphalt Binder +/- 0.5% +/- 0.7%
Air Voids, Va 2.5% min. and 5.5% max N/A
For Aggregates in the mixture:
a. First, determine preliminary upper and lower acceptance limits by applying the
following tolerances to the approved JMF.
Aggregate Percent
Passing
Non-Statistical
Evaluation
Commercial
Evaluation
1”, ¾”, ½”, and 3/8” sieves +/- 6% +/- 8%
No. 4 sieve +/-6% +/- 8%
No. 8 Sieve +/- 6% +/-8%
No. 200 sieve +/- 2.0% +/- 3.0%
b. Second, adjust the preliminary upper and lower acceptance limits determined from
step (a) the minimum amount necessary so that none of the aggregate properties are
outside the control points in Section 9-03.8(6). The resulting values will be the upper
and lower acceptance limits for aggregates, as well as the USL and LSL required in
Section 1-06.2(2)D2.
2. Job Mix Formula Adjustments – An adjustment to the aggregate gradation or asphalt
binder content of the JMF requires approval of the Engineer. Adjustments to the JMF will
only be considered if the change produces material of equal or better quality and may
require the development of a new mix design if the adjustment exceeds the amounts
listed below.
a. Aggregates –2 percent for the aggregate passing the 1½″, 1″, ¾″, ½″, ⅜″, and the No.
4 sieves, 1 percent for aggregate passing the No. 8 sieve, and 0.5 percent for the
aggregate passing the No. 200 sieve. The adjusted JMF shall be within the range of
the control points in Section 9-03.8(6).
b. Asphalt Binder Content – The Engineer may order or approve changes to asphalt
binder content. The maximum adjustment from the approved mix design for the
asphalt binder content shall be 0.3 percent.
5-04.3(9)A Vacant
5-04.3(9)B Vacant
5-04.3(9)C Mixture Acceptance – Nonstatistical Evaluation
HMA mixture which is accepted by Nonstatistical Evaluation will be evaluated by the Contracting
Agency by dividing the HMA tonnage into lots.
121
5-04.3(9)C1 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation – Lots and Sublots
A lot is represented by randomly selected samples of the same mix design that will be tested for
acceptance. A lot is defined as the total quantity of material or work produced for each Job Mix
Formula placed. Only one lot per JMF is expected. A sublot shall be equal to one day’s production or
800 tons, whichever is less except that the final sublot will be a minimum of 400 tons and may be
increased to 1200 tons.
All of the test results obtained from the acceptance samples from a given lot shall be evaluated
collectively. If the Contractor requests a change to the JMF that is approved, the material produced
after the change will be evaluated on the basis of the new JMF for the remaining sublots in the current
lot and for acceptance of subsequent lots. For a lot in progress with a CPF less than 0.75, a new lot
will begin at the Contractor’s request after the Engineer is satisfied that material conforming to the
Specifications can be produced.
Sampling and testing for evaluation shall be performed on the frequency of one sample per sublot.
5-04.3(9)C2 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation Sampling
Samples for acceptance testing shall be obtained by the Contractor when ordered by the Engineer.
The Contractor shall sample the HMA mixture in the presence of the Engineer and in accordance with
AASH-TO T 168. A minimum of three samples should be taken for each class of HMA placed on a
project. If used in a structural application, at least one of the three samples shall to be tested.
Sampling and testing HMA in a Structural application where quantities are less than 400 tons is at the
discretion of the Engineer.
For HMA used in a structural application and with a total project quantity less than 800 tons but more
than 400 tons, a minimum of one acceptance test shall be performed. In all cases, a minimum of 3
samples will be obtained at the point of acceptance, a minimum of one of the three samples will be
tested for conformance to the JMF:
• If the test results are found to be within specification requirements, additional testing will be
at the Engineer’s discretion.
• If test results are found not to be within specification requirements, additional testing of the
remaining samples to determine a Composite Pay Factor (CPF) shall be performed.
5-04.3(9)C3 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation – Acceptance Testing
Testing of HMA for compliance of Va will at the option of the Contracting Agency. If tested, compliance
of Va will use WSDOT SOP 731. Testing of HMA for compliance of Va will not be performed by the
Contracting Agency for this contract.
Testing for compliance of asphalt binder content will be by WSDOT FOP for AASHTO T 308.
Testing for compliance of gradation will be by FOP for WAQTC T 27/T 11.
5-04.3(9)C4 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation – Pay Factors
For each lot of material falling outside the tolerance limits in 5-04.3(9), the Contracting Agency will
determine a Composite Pay Factor (CPF) using the following price adjustment factors:
122
Table of Price Adjustment Factors
Constituent Factor “f”
All aggregate passing: 1½″, 1″, ¾″, ½″, ⅜″ and No.4 sieves 2
All aggregate passing No. 8 sieve 15
All aggregate passing No. 200 sieve 20
Asphalt binder 40
Air Voids (Va) (where applicable) 20
Each lot of HMA produced under Nonstatistical Evaluation and having all constituents falling within
the tolerance limits of the job mix formula shall be accepted at the unit Contract price with no further
evaluation. When one or more constituents fall outside the nonstatistical tolerance limits in the Job
Mix Formula shown in Table of Price Adjustment Factors, the lot shall be evaluated in accordance with
Section 1-06.2 to determine the appropriate CPF. The nonstatistical tolerance limits will be used in
the calculation of the CPF and the maximum CPF shall be 1.00. When less than three sublots exist,
backup samples of the existing sublots or samples from the Roadway shall be tested to provide a
minimum of three sets of results for evaluation.
5-04.3(9)C5 Vacant
5-04.3(9)C6 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation – Price Adjustments
For each lot of HMA mix produced under Nonstatistical Evaluation when the calculated CPF is less
than 1.00, a Nonconforming Mix Factor (NCMF) will be determined. The NCMF equals the algebraic
difference of CPF minus 1.00 multiplied by 60 percent. The total job mix compliance price adjustment
will be calculated as the product of the NCMF, the quantity of HMA in the lot in tons, and the unit
Contract price per ton of mix.
If a constituent is not measured in accordance with these Specifications, its individual pay factor will
be considered 1.00 in calculating the Composite Pay Factor (CPF).
5-04.3(9)C7 Mixture Nonstatistical Evaluation - Retests
The Contractor may request a sublot be retested. To request a retest, the Contractor shall submit a
written request within 7 calendar days after the specific test results have been received. A split of the
original acceptance sample will be retested. The split of the sample will not be tested with the same
tester that ran the original acceptance test. The sample will be tested for a complete gradation
analysis, asphalt binder content, and, at the option of the agency, Va. The results of the retest will be
used for the acceptance of the HMA in place of the original sublot sample test results. The cost of
testing will be deducted from any monies due or that may come due the Contractor under the
Contract at the rate of $500 per sample.
5-04.3(9)D Mixture Acceptance – Commercial Evaluation
If sampled and tested, HMA produced under Commercial Evaluation and having all constituents falling
within the tolerance limits of the job mix formula shall be accepted at the unit Contract price with no
further evaluation. When one or more constituents fall outside the commercial tolerance limits in the
Job Mix Formula shown in 5-04.3(9), the lot shall be evaluated in accordance with Section 1-06.2 to
determine the appropriate CPF. The commercial tolerance limits will be used in the calculation of the
CPF and the maximum CPF shall be 1.00. When less than three sublots exist, backup samples of the
123
existing sublots or samples from the street shall be tested to provide a minimum of three sets of
results for evaluation.
For each lot of HMA mix produced and tested under Commercial Evaluation when the calculated CPF
is less than 1.00, a Nonconforming Mix Factor (NCMF) will be determined. The NCMF equals the
algebraic difference of CPF minus 1.00 multiplied by 60 percent. The Job Mix Compliance Price
Adjustment will be calculated as the product of the NCMF, the quantity of HMA in the lot in tons, and
the unit Contract price per ton of mix.
If a constituent is not measured in accordance with these Specifications, its individual pay factor will
be considered 1.00 in calculating the Composite Pay Factor (CPF).
5-04.3(10) HMA Compaction Acceptance
HMA mixture accepted by nonstatistical evaluation that is used in traffic lanes, including lanes for
intersections, ramps, truck climbing, weaving, and speed change, and having a specified compacted
course thickness greater than 0.10-foot, shall be compacted to a specified level of relative density.
The specified level of relative density shall be a Composite Pay Factor (CPF) of not less than 0.75 when
evaluated in accordance with Section 1-06.2, using a LSL of 92.0 (minimum of 92 percent of the
maximum density). The maximum density shall be determined by WSDOT FOP for AASHTO T 729. The
specified level of density attained will be determined by the evaluation of the density of the
pavement. The density of the pavement shall be determined in accordance with WSDOT FOP for
WAQTC TM 8, except that gauge correlation will be at the discretion of the Engineer, when using the
nuclear density gauge and WSDOT SOP 736 when using cores to determine density.
Tests for the determination of the pavement density will be taken in accordance with the required
procedures for measurement by a nuclear density gauge or roadway cores after completion of the
finish rolling.
If the Contracting Agency uses a nuclear density gauge to determine density the test procedures FOP
for WAQTC TM 8 and WSDOT SOP T 729 will be used on the day the mix is placed and prior to opening
to traffic.
Roadway cores for density may be obtained by either the Contracting Agency or the Contractor in
accordance with WSDOT SOP 734. The core diameter shall be 4-inches minimum, unless otherwise
approved by the Engineer. Roadway cores will be tested by the Contracting Agency in accordance with
WSDOT FOP for AASHTO T 166.
If the Contract includes the Bid item “Roadway Core” the cores shall be obtained by the Contractor in
the presence of the Engineer on the same day the mix is placed and at locations designated by the
Engineer. If the Contract does not include the Bid item “Roadway Core” the Contracting Agency will
obtain the cores.
For a lot in progress with a CPF less than 0.75, a new lot will begin at the Contractor’s request after
the Engineer is satisfied that material conforming to the Specifications can be produced.
HMA mixture accepted by commercial evaluation and HMA constructed under conditions other than
those listed above shall be compacted on the basis of a test point evaluation of the compaction train.
The test point evaluation shall be performed in accordance with instructions from the Engineer. The
number of passes with an approved compaction train, required to attain the maximum test point
density, shall be used on all subsequent paving.
HMA for preleveling shall be thoroughly compacted. HMA that is used for preleveling wheel rutting
shall be compacted with a pneumatic tire roller unless otherwise approved by the Engineer.
124
Test Results
For a sublot that has been tested with a nuclear density gauge that did not meet the minimum of 92
percent of the reference maximum density in a compaction lot with a CPF below 1.00 and thus subject
to a price reduction or rejection, the Contractor may request that a core be used for determination of
the relative density of the sublot. The relative density of the core will replace the relative density
determined by the nuclear density gauge for the sublot and will be used for calculation of the CPF and
acceptance of HMA compaction lot.
When cores are taken by the Contracting Agency at the request of the Contractor, they shall be
requested by noon of the next workday after the test results for the sublot have been provided or
made available to the Contractor. Core locations shall be outside of wheel paths and as determined
by the Engineer. Traffic control shall be provided by the Contractor as requested by the Engineer.
Failure by the Contractor to provide the requested traffic control will result in forfeiture of the request
for cores. When the CPF for the lot based on the results of the HMA cores is less than 1.00, the cost
for the coring will be deducted from any monies due or that may become due the Contractor under
the Contract at the rate of $200 per core and the Contractor shall pay for the cost of the traffic control.
5-04.3(10)A HMA Compaction – General Compaction Requirements
Compaction shall take place when the mixture is in the proper condition so that no undue
displacement, cracking, or shoving occurs. Areas inaccessible to large compaction equipment shall be
compacted by other mechanical means. Any HMA that becomes loose, broken, contaminated, shows
an excess or deficiency of asphalt, or is in any way defective, shall be removed and replaced with new
hot mix that shall be immediately compacted to conform to the surrounding area.
The type of rollers to be used and their relative position in the compaction sequence shall generally
be the Contractor’s option, provided the specified densities are attained. Unless the Engineer has
approved otherwise, rollers shall only be operated in the static mode when the internal temperature
of the mix is less than 175°F. Regardless of mix temperature, a roller shall not be operated in a mode
that results in checking or cracking of the mat. Rollers shall only be operated in static mode on bridge
decks.
5-04.3(10)B HMA Compaction – Cyclic Density
Low cyclic density areas are defined as spots or streaks in the pavement that are less than 90 percent
of the theoretical maximum density. At the Engineer’s discretion, the Engineer may evaluate the HMA
pavement for low cyclic density, and when doing so will follow WSDOT SOP 733. A $500 Cyclic Density
Price Adjustment will be assessed for any 500-foot section with two or more density readings below
90 percent of the theoretical maximum density.
5-04.3(10)C Vacant
5-04.3(10)D HMA Nonstatistical Compaction
5-04.3(10)D1 HMA Nonstatistical Compaction – Lots and Sublots
HMA compaction which is accepted by nonstatistical evaluation will be based on acceptance testing
performed by the Contracting Agency dividing the project into compaction lots.
A lot is represented by randomly selected samples of the same mix design that will be tested for
acceptance. A lot is defined as the total quantity of material or work produced for each Job Mix
Formula placed. Only one lot per JMF is expected. A sublot shall be equal to one day’s production or
400 tons, whichever is less except that the final sublot will be a minimum of 200 tons and may be
125
increased to 800 tons. Testing for compaction will be at the rate of 5 tests per sublot per WSDOT T
738.
The sublot locations within each density lot will be determined by the Engineer. For a lot in progress
with a CPF less than 0.75, a new lot will begin at the Contractor’s request after the Engineer is satisfied
that material conforming to the Specifications can be produced.
HMA mixture accepted by commercial evaluation and HMA constructed under conditions other than
those listed above shall be compacted on the basis of a test point evaluation of the compaction train.
The test point evaluation shall be performed in accordance with instructions from the Engineer. The
number of passes with an approved compaction train, required to attain the maximum test point
density, shall be used on all subsequent paving.
HMA for preleveling shall be thoroughly compacted. HMA that is used to prelevel wheel ruts shall be
compacted with a pneumatic tire roller unless otherwise approved by the Engineer.
5-04.3(10)D2 HMA Compaction Nonstatistical Evaluation – Acceptance Testing
The location of the HMA compaction acceptance tests will be randomly selected by the Engineer from
within each sublot, with one test per sublot.
5-04.3(10)D3 HMA Nonstatistical Compaction – Price Adjustments
For each compaction lot with one or two sublots, having all sublots attain a relative density that is 92
percent of the reference maximum density the HMA shall be accepted at the unit Contract price with
no further evaluation. When a sublot does not attain a relative density that is 92 percent of the
reference maximum density, the lot shall be evaluated in accordance with Section 1-06.2 to determine
the appropriate CPF. The maximum CPF shall be 1.00, however, lots with a calculated CPF in excess of
1.00 will be used to offset lots with CPF values below 1.00 but greater than 0.90. Lots with CPF lower
than 0.90 will be evaluated for compliance per 5-04.3(11). Additional testing by either a nuclear
moisture-density gauge or cores will be completed as required to provide a minimum of three tests
for evaluation.
For compaction below the required 92% a Non-Conforming Compaction Factor (NCCF) will be
determined. The NCCF equals the algebraic difference of CPF minus 1.00 multiplied by 40 percent.
The Compaction Price Adjustment will be calculated as the product of CPF, the quantity of HMA in the
compaction control lot in tons, and the unit Contract price per ton of mix.
5-04.3(11) Reject Work
5-04.3(11)A Reject Work General
Work that is defective or does not conform to Contract requirements shall be rejected. The Contractor
may propose, in writing, alternatives to removal and replacement of rejected material. Acceptability
of such alternative proposals will be determined at the sole discretion of the Engineer. HMA that has
been rejected is subject to the requirements in Section 1-06.2(2) and this specification, and the
Contractor shall submit a corrective action proposal to the Engineer for approval.
5-04.3(11)B Rejection by Contractor
The Contractor may, prior to sampling, elect to remove any defective material and replace it with new
material. Any such new material will be sampled, tested, and evaluated for acceptance.
126
5-04.3(11)C Rejection Without Testing (Mixture or Compaction)
The Engineer may, without sampling, reject any batch, load, or section of Roadway that appears
defective. Material rejected before placement shall not be incorporated into the pavement. Any
rejected section of Roadway shall be removed.
No payment will be made for the rejected materials or the removal of the materials unless the
Contractor requests that the rejected material be tested. If the Contractor elects to have the rejected
material tested, a minimum of three representative samples will be obtained and tested. Acceptance
of rejected material will be based on conformance with the nonstatistical acceptance Specification. If
the CPF for the rejected material is less than 0.75, no payment will be made for the rejected material;
in addition, the cost of sampling and testing shall be borne by the Contractor. If the CPF is greater
than or equal to 0.75, the cost of sampling and testing will be borne by the Contracting Agency. If the
material is rejected before placement and the CPF is greater than or equal to 0.75, compensation for
the rejected material will be at a CPF of 0.75. If rejection occurs after placement and the CPF is greater
than or equal to 0.75, compensation for the rejected material will be at the calculated CPF with an
addition of 25 percent of the unit Contract price added for the cost of removal and disposal.
5-04.3(11)D Rejection - A Partial Sublot
In addition to the random acceptance sampling and testing, the Engineer may also isolate from a
normal sublot any material that is suspected of being defective in relative density, gradation or asphalt
binder content. Such isolated material will not include an original sample location. A minimum of
three random samples of the suspect material will be obtained and tested. The material will then be
statistically evaluated as an independent lot in accordance with Section 1-06.2(2).
5-04.3(11)E Rejection - An Entire Sublot
An entire sublot that is suspected of being defective may be rejected. When a sublot is rejected a
minimum of two additional random samples from this sublot will be obtained. These additional
samples and the original sublot will be evaluated as an independent lot in accordance with Section
1-06.2(2).
5-04.3(11)F Rejection - A Lot in Progress
The Contractor shall shut down operations and shall not resume HMA placement until such time as
the Engineer is satisfied that material conforming to the Specifications can be produced:
1. When the Composite Pay Factor (CPF) of a lot in progress drops below 1.00 and the Contractor
is taking no corrective action, or
2. When the Pay Factor (PF) for any constituent of a lot in progress drops below 0.95 and the
Contractor is taking no corrective action, or
3. When either the PFi for any constituent or the CPF of a lot in progress is less than 0.75.
5-04.3(11)G Rejection - An Entire Lot (Mixture or Compaction)
An entire lot with a CPF of less than 0.75 will be rejected.
127
5-04.3(12) Joints
5-04.3(12)A HMA Joints
5-04.3(12)A1 Transverse Joints
The Contractor shall conduct operations such that the placing of the top or wearing course is a
continuous operation or as close to continuous as possible. Unscheduled transverse joints will be
allowed and the roller may pass over the unprotected end of the freshly laid mixture only when the
placement of the course must be discontinued for such a length of time that the mixture will cool
below compaction temperature. When the Work is resumed, the previously compacted mixture shall
be cut back to produce a slightly beveled edge for the full thickness of the course.
A temporary wedge of HMA constructed on a 20H:1V shall be constructed where a transverse joint as
a result of paving or planing is open to traffic. The HMA in the temporary wedge shall be separated
from the permanent HMA by strips of heavy wrapping paper or other methods approved by the
Engineer. The wrapping paper shall be removed and the joint trimmed to a slightly beveled edge for
the full thickness of the course prior to resumption of paving.
The material that is cut away shall be wasted and new mix shall be laid against the cut. Rollers or
tamping irons shall be used to seal the joint.
All transverse (butt) joints between new and existing asphalt shall be milled to the full overlay depth.
All transverse (butt) joints shall be sealed after paving. See Section 5-04.3(17) for requirements.
5-04.3(12)A2 Longitudinal Joints
The longitudinal joint in any one course shall be offset from the course immediately below by not
more than 6 inches nor less than 2 inches. All longitudinal joints constructed in the wearing course
shall be located at a lane line or an edge line of the Traveled Way. A notched wedge joint shall be
constructed along all longitudinal joints in the wearing surface of new HMA unless otherwise
approved by the Engineer. The notched wedge joint shall have a vertical edge of not less than the
maximum aggregate size or more than ½ of the compacted lift thickness and then taper down on a
slope not steeper than 4H:1V. The sloped portion of the HMA notched wedge joint shall be uniformly
compacted.
5-04.3(12)B Bridge Paving Joint Seals
5-04.3(12)B1 HMA Sawcut and Seal
Prior to placing HMA on the bridge deck, establish sawcut alignment points at both ends of the bridge
paving joint seals to be placed at the bridge ends, and at interior joints within the bridge deck when
and where shown in the Plans. Establish the sawcut alignment points in a manner that they remain
functional for use in aligning the sawcut after placing the overlay.
Submit a Type 1 Working Drawing consisting of the sealant manufacturer’s application procedure.
Construct the bridge paving joint seal as specified ion the Plans and in accordance with the detail
shown in the Standard Plans. Construct the sawcut in accordance with the detail shown in the
Standard Plan. Construct the sawcut in accordance with Section 5-05.3(8)B and the manufacturer’s
application procedure.
5-04.3(12)B2 Paved Panel Joint Seal
Construct the paved panel joint seal in accordance with the requirements specified in section
5-04.3(12)B1 and the following requirement:
128
1. Clean and seal the existing joint between concrete panels in accordance with Section
5-01.3(8) and the details shown in the Standard Plans.
5-04.3(13) Surface Smoothness
The completed surface of all courses shall be of uniform texture, smooth, uniform as to crown and
grade, and free from defects of all kinds. The completed surface of the wearing course shall not vary
more than ⅛ inch from the lower edge of a 10-foot straightedge placed on the surface parallel to the
centerline. The transverse slope of the completed surface of the wearing course shall vary not more
than ¼ inch in 10 feet from the rate of transverse slope shown in the Plans.
When deviations in excess of the above tolerances are found that result from a high place in the HMA,
the pavement surface shall be corrected by one of the following methods:
1. Removal of material from high places by grinding with an approved grinding machine, or
2. Removal and replacement of the wearing course of HMA, or
3. By other method approved by the Engineer.
Correction of defects shall be carried out until there are no deviations anywhere greater than the
allowable tolerances.
Deviations in excess of the above tolerances that result from a low place in the HMA and deviations
resulting from a high place where corrective action, in the opinion of the Engineer, will not produce
satisfactory results will be accepted with a price adjustment. The Engineer shall deduct from monies
due or that may become due to the Contractor the sum of $500.00 for each and every section of single
traffic lane 100 feet in length in which any excessive deviations described above are found.
When utility appurtenances such as manhole covers and valve boxes are located in the traveled way,
the utility appurtenances shall be adjusted to the finished grade prior to paving. This requirement
may be waived when requested by the Contractor, at the discretion of the Engineer or when the
adjustment details provided in the project plan or specifications call for utility appurtenance
adjustments after the completion of paving.
Utility appurtenance adjustment discussions will be included in the Pre-Paving planning
(5-04.3(14)B3). Submit a written request to waive this requirement to the Engineer prior to the start
of paving.
5-04.3(14) Planing (Milling) Bituminous Pavement
The planning plan must be approved by the Engineer and a pre planning meeting must be held prior
to the start of any planing. See Section 5-04.3(14)B2 for information on planning submittals.
Locations of existing surfacing to be planed are as shown in the Drawings.
Where planing an existing pavement is specified in the Contract, the Contractor must remove existing
surfacing material and to reshape the surface to remove irregularities. The finished product must be
a prepared surface acceptable for receiving an HMA overlay.
Use the cold milling method for planing unless otherwise specified in the Contract. Do not use the
planer on the final wearing course of new HMA.
Conduct planing operations in a manner that does not tear, break, burn, or otherwise damage the
surface which is to remain. The finished planed surface must be slightly grooved or roughened and
must be free from gouges, deep grooves, ridges, or other imperfections. The Contractor must repair
129
any damage to the surface by the Contractor’s planing equipment, using an Engineer approved
method.
Repair or replace any metal castings and other surface improvements damaged by planing, as
determined by the Engineer.
After planing is complete, planed surfaces must be swept, cleaned, and if required by the Contract or
directed by the Engineer, patched and preleveled.
The Engineer may direct additional depth planing. Before performing this additional depth planing,
the Contractor must conduct a hidden metal in pavement detection survey as specified in Section
5-04.3(14)A.
5-04.3(14)A Pre-Planing Metal Detection Check
Before starting planing of pavements, and before any additional depth planing required by the
Engineer, the Contractor must conduct a physical survey of existing pavement to be planed with
equipment that can identify hidden metal objects.
Should such metal be identified, promptly notify the Engineer.
See Section 1-07.16(1) regarding the protection of survey monumentation that may be hidden in
pavement.
The Contractor is solely responsible for any damage to equipment resulting from the Contractor’s
failure to conduct a pre-planing metal detection survey, or from the Contractor’s failure to notify the
Engineer of any hidden metal that is detected.
5-04.3(14)B Paving and Planing Under Traffic
5-04.3(14)B1 General
In addition the requirements of Section 1-07.23 and the traffic controls required in Section 1-10, and
unless the Contract specifies otherwise or the Engineer approves, the Contractor must comply with
the following:
1. Intersections:
a. Keep intersections open to traffic at all times, except when paving or planing operations
through an intersection requires closure. Such closure must be kept to the minimum time
required to place and compact the HMA mixture, or plane as appropriate. For paving,
schedule such closure to individual lanes or portions thereof that allows the traffic
volumes and schedule of traffic volumes required in the approved traffic control plan.
Schedule work so that adjacent intersections are not impacted at the same time and
comply with the traffic control restrictions required by the Traffic Engineer. Each
individual intersection closure or partial closure, must be addressed in the traffic control
plan, which must be submitted to and accepted by the Engineer, see Section 1-10.2(2).
b. When planing or paving and related construction must occur in an intersection, consider
scheduling and sequencing such work into quarters of the intersection, or half or more of
an intersection with side street detours. Be prepared to sequence the work to individual
lanes or portions thereof.
c. Should closure of the intersection in its entirety be necessary, and no trolley service is
impacted, keep such closure to the minimum time required to place and compact the
HMA mixture, plane, remove asphalt, tack coat, and as needed.
130
d. Any work in an intersection requires advance warning in both signage and a number of
Working Days advance notice as determined by the Engineer, to alert traffic and
emergency services of the intersection closure or partial closure.
e. Allow new compacted HMA asphalt to cool to ambient temperature before any traffic is
allowed on it. Traffic is not allowed on newly placed asphalt until approval has been
obtained from the Engineer.
2. Temporary centerline marking, post-paving temporary marking, temporary stop bars, and
maintaining temporary pavement marking must comply with Section 8-23.
3. Permanent pavement marking must comply with Section 8-22.
5-04.3(14)B2 Submittals – Planing Plan and HMA Paving Plan
The Contractor must submit a separate planing plan and a separate paving plan to the Engineer at
least 5 Working Days in advance of each operation’s activity start date. These plans must show how
the moving operation and traffic control are coordinated, as they will be discussed at the pre-planing
briefing and pre-paving briefing. When requested by the Engineer, the Contractor must provide each
operation’s traffic control plan on 24 x 36 inch or larger size Shop Drawings with a scale showing both
the area of operation and sufficient detail of traffic beyond the area of operation where detour traffic
may be required. The scale on the Shop Drawings is 1 inch = 20 feet, which may be changed if the
Engineer agrees sufficient detail is shown.
The planing operation and the paving operation include, but are not limited to, metal detection,
removal of asphalt and temporary asphalt of any kind, tack coat and drying, staging of supply trucks,
paving trains, rolling, scheduling, and as may be discussed at the briefing.
When intersections will be partially or totally blocked, provide adequately sized and noticeable
signage alerting traffic of closures to come, a minimum 2 Working Days in advance. The traffic control
plan must show where police officers will be stationed when signalization is or may be,
countermanded, and show areas where flaggers are proposed.
At a minimum, the planing and the paving plan must include:
1. A copy of the accepted traffic control plan, see Section 1-10.2(2), detailing each day’s traffic
control as it relates to the specific requirements of that day’s planing and paving. Briefly
describe the sequencing of traffic control consistent with the proposed planing and paving
sequence, and scheduling of placement of temporary pavement markings and channelizing
devices after each day’s planing, and paving.
2. A copy of each intersection’s traffic control plan.
3. Haul routes from Supplier facilities, and locations of temporary parking and staging areas,
including return routes. Describe the complete round trip as it relates to the sequencing of
paving operations.
4. Names and locations of HMA Supplier facilities to be used.
5. List of all equipment to be used for paving.
6. List of personnel and associated job classification assigned to each piece of paving equipment.
7. Description (geometric or narrative) of the scheduled sequence of planing and of paving, and
intended area of planing and of paving for each day’s work, must include the directions of
proposed planing and of proposed paving, sequence of adjacent lane paving, sequence of
131
skipped lane paving, intersection planing and paving scheduling and sequencing, and
proposed notifications and coordinations to be timely made. The plan must show HMA joints
relative to the final pavement marking lane lines.
8. Names, job titles, and contact information for field, office, and plant supervisory personnel.
9. A copy of the approved Mix Designs.
10. Tonnage of HMA to be placed each day.
11. Approximate times and days for starting and ending daily operations.
5-04.3(14)B3 Pre-Paving and Pre-Planing Briefing
At least 2 Working Days before the first paving operation and the first planing operation, or as
scheduled by the Engineer for future paving and planing operations to ensure the Contractor has
adequately prepared for notifying and coordinating as required in the Contract, the Contractor must
be prepared to discuss that day’s operations as they relate to other entities and to public safety and
convenience, including driveway and business access, garbage truck operations, Metro transit
operations and working around energized overhead wires, school and nursing home and hospital and
other accesses, other contractors who may be operating in the area, pedestrian and bicycle traffic,
and emergency services. The Contractor, and Subcontractors that may be part of that day’s
operations, must meet with the Engineer and discuss the proposed operation as it relates to the
submitted planing plan and paving plan, approved traffic control plan, and public convenience and
safety. Such discussion includes, but is not limited to:
1. General for both Paving Plan and for Planing Plan:
a. The actual times of starting and ending daily operations.
b. In intersections, how to break up the intersection, and address traffic control and
signalization for that operation, including use of peace officers.
c. The sequencing and scheduling of paving operations and of planing operations, as
applicable, as it relates to traffic control, to public convenience and safety, and to other
con-tractors who may operate in the Project Site.
d. Notifications required of Contractor activities, and coordinating with other entities and
the public as necessary.
e. Description of the sequencing of installation and types of temporary pavement markings
as it relates to planning and to paving.
f. Description of the sequencing of installation of, and the removal of, temporary pavement
patch material around exposed castings and as may be needed.
g. Description of procedures and equipment to identify hidden metal in the pavement, such
as survey monumentation, monitoring wells, street car rail, and castings, before planning,
see Section 5-04.3(14)B2.
h. Description of how flaggers will be coordinated with the planing, paving, and related
operations.
i. Description of sequencing of traffic controls for the process of rigid pavement base
repairs.
j. Other items the Engineer deems necessary to address.
132
2. Paving – additional topics:
a. When to start applying tack and coordinating with paving.
b. Types of equipment and numbers of each type equipment to be used. If more pieces of
equipment than personnel are proposed, describe the sequencing of the personnel
operating the types of equipment. Discuss the continuance of operator personnel for
each type equipment as it relates to meeting Specification requirements.
c. Number of JMFs to be placed, and if more than one JMF how the Contractor will ensure
different JMFs are distinguished, how pavers and MTVs are distinguished if more than
one JMF is being placed at the time, and how pavers and MTVs are cleaned so that one
JMF does not adversely influence the other JMF.
d. Description of contingency plans for that day’s operations such as equipment breakdown,
rain out, and Supplier shutdown of operations.
e. Number of sublots to be placed, sequencing of density testing, and other sampling and
testing.
5-04.3(15) Sealing Pavement Surfaces
Apply a fog seal where shown in the plans. Construct the fog seal in accordance with Section 5-02.3.
Unless otherwise approved by the Engineer, apply the fog seal prior to opening to traffic.
5-04.3(16) HMA Road Approaches
HMA approaches shall be constructed at the locations shown in the Plans or where staked by the
Engineer. The Work shall be performed in accordance with Section 5-04.
5-04.3(17) Construction Joint Sealing
Transverse Joints - Joints between new and existing asphalt shall be sealed within five (5) calendar
days after final rolling of the final lift of HMA. The seal shall be CSS-1 emulsified asphalt. The emulsified
asphalt shall be placed in a way to be smooth and flush with roadway surface with minimal
overbanding. This work is considered incidental to the bid item “HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for
Overlay”.
5-04.3(18) Incidental Uses for HMA
Incidental uses for HMA shall consist of restoration and adjustment to paved areas and other such
uses as directed by the Engineer. Incidental uses for HMA shall be measured and paid under the “HMA
Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay” bid item for the overlay related HMA.
5-04.3(19) Vacant
5-04.3(20) Vacant
5-04.3(21) Temporary Pavement Marking
The furnishing and installing of temporary pavement marking shall be as described in Section 8-23.
Should the Engineer direct the Contractor to provide temporary pavement marking, it shall be short
duration. This work is considered incidental to the bid item “Project Temporary Traffic Control”.
133
5-04.4 Measurement
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch” and “HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay” will
be measured by the ton in accordance with Section 1-09.2, with no deduction being made for the
weight of asphalt binder, mineral filler, or any other component of the mixture. If the Contractor
elects to remove and replace mix as allowed by Section 5-04.3(11), the material removed will not be
measured.
5-04.5 Payment
Payment will be made for each of the following Bid items that are included in the Proposal:
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch”, per ton.
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay”, per ton.
Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment
The Contracting Agency will make an Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment, either a credit or a payment, for
qualifying changes in the reference cost of asphalt binder. The adjustment will be applied to partial
payments made according to Section 1-09.9 for the following bid items when they are included in the
proposal:
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Final Trench Patch”
“HMA Cl. ½-Inch PG 58H-22 for Overlay”
“HMA for Approach Cl. ___ PG ___”
“HMA for Preleveling Cl. ___ PG ___”
“HMA for Pavement Repair Cl. ___ PG ___”
“Commercial HMA”
The adjustment is not a guarantee of full compensation for changes in the cost of asphalt binder. The
Contracting Agency does not guarantee that asphalt binder will be available at the reference cost.
The Contracting Agency will establish asphalt binder reference costs twice each month and post the
information on the Agency website at: https://wsdot.wa.gov/business-wsdot/how-do-business-
us/public-works-contracts/payments-reporting/asphalt-binder-reference-cost. The reference cost
will be determined using posted prices furnished by Poten & Partners, Inc. If the selected price source
ceases to be available for any reason, then the Contracting Agency will select a substitute price source
to establish the reference cost.
Price adjustments will be calculated one time per month. No price adjustment will be made if the
Current Reference Cost is within +/-5% of the Base Cost. Reference costs for projects located in
Eastern versus Western Washington shall be selected from the column in the WSDOT website table
labeled “Eastern”, or “Western”, accordingly. The adjustment will be calculated as follows:
If the reference cost is greater than or equal to 105% of the base cost, then
Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment = (Current Reference Cost – (1.05 x Base Cost)) x (Q x 0.056).
If the reference cost is less than or equal to 95% of the base cost, then
Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment = (Current Reference Cost – (0.95 x Base Cost)) x (Q x 0.056).
134
Where:
Current Reference Cost is selected from the website table based on the “Date Effective” that
immediately precedes the current month’s progress estimate end date. For work completed after
all authorized working days are used, the adjustment will be based on the posted reference cost
during which contract time was exhausted.
Base Cost is selected from the website table based on the “Date Effective” that immediately
precedes the contract bid opening date, and shall be a constant for all monthly adjustments.
Q = total tons of all classes of HMA paid in the current month’s progress payment.
“Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment”, by calculation.
“Asphalt Cost Price Adjustment” will be calculated and paid for as described in this section. For
the purpose of providing a common proposal for all bidders, the Contracting Agency has entered
an amount in the proposal to become a part of the total bid by the Contractor.
5-07 TEMPORARY RESTORATION IN PAVEMENT AREA
Section 5-07 is new Section with subsections:
(******)
5-07.1 Description
Pavement areas that have been removed by construction activities must be restored by the
Contractor prior to the end of each working period, prior to use by vehicular traffic. Within paved
streets, the Contractor may use temporary pavement to allow vehicular traffic to travel over the
construction areas. Temporary pavement shall be placed around trench plates or others devices used
to cover construction activities in a manner that provides a smooth and safe transition between
surfaces.
5-07.2 Materials
The asphalt pavement for temporary patches shall be 2” of a hot mix or cold mix asphalt composition
determined by the Contractor to provide a product suitable for the intended application. The
Contractor shall not use materials that are a safety or health hazard.
Temporary pavement material that does not form a consolidated surface after compaction shall be
considered unsuitable and shall be removed from the site. Unsuitable temporary pavement shall be
disposed of offsite.
5-07.3 Construction Requirements
The Contractor shall maintain temporary hot mix asphalt patches daily during to the satisfaction of
the governing road agency and the Engineer until said patch is replaced with permanent hot patch.
The completed pavement shall be free from ridges, ruts, bumps, depressions, objectionable marks, or
other irregularities. The permanent hot mix asphalt patch shall be placed and sealed with a paving
asphalt within 30 calendar days.
The Contractor shall immediately repair, patch, or remove any temporary pavement that does not
provide a flat transition between existing pavement areas.
All temporary asphalt pavement shall be removed from the site by the end of the project and shall
not be used as permanent asphalt pavement or subgrade material.
135
DIVISION 7 DRAINAGE STRUCTURES, STORM SEWERS, WATER MAINS, AND CONDUITS
7-01 DRAINS
7-01.2 Materials
The second paragraph of Section 7-01.2 is revised as follows:
(******)
Drain pipes may be concrete, zinc coated (galvanized) corrugated iron with Asphalt Treatment I,
aluminum coated (aluminized) corrugated iron with Asphalt Treatment I, zinc coated (galvanized)
steel with Asphalt Treatment I, corrugated aluminum alloy, polyvinyl chloride (PVC), or corrugated
polyethylene (PE) at the option of the Contractor unless the Plans specify the type to be used.
7-01.3 Construction Requirements
Section 7-01.3 is revised as follows:
(******)
The second paragraph is revised as follows:
PVC drain pipe shall be jointed with a bell and spigot joint using a flexible elastomeric seal as
described in Section 9-04.8. The bell shall be laid upstream. PE or ABS drainpipe shall be jointed
with snap-on, screw-on, or wraparound coupling bands as recommended by the manufacturer of
the tubing.
The sixth paragraph is revised as follows:
PVC under drain pipe shall be jointed using either the flexible elastomeric seal as described in
Section 9-04.8 or solvent cement as described in Section 9-04.9, at the option of the Contractor
unless otherwise specified in the Plans. The bell shall be laid upstream. PE or ABS drainage tubing
under drain pipe shall be jointed with snap-on, screw-on, or wraparound coupling bands, as
recommended by the manufacturer of the tubing.
7-02 CULVERTS
7-02.2 Materials
The second paragraph of Section 7-02.2 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
Where steel or aluminum are referred to in this section in regard to a kind of culvert pipe, pipe arch,
or end sections, it shall be understood that steel is zinc coated (galvanized) with Asphalt Treatment I
or aluminum coated (aluminized) corrugated iron or steel, and aluminum is corrugated aluminum
alloy as specified in Sections 9-05.4 and 9-05.5. Where plain or reinforced concrete, steel, or
aluminum are referred to in Section 7-02 it shall be understood that reference is also made to PVC.
136
7-04 STORM SEWERS
7-04.2 Materials
The first paragraph of Section 7-04.2 is revised as follows:
(******)
Trench backfill for storm trench shall be Gravel Borrow per 9-03.14(1).
Unless a pipe material is specifically called out on the Plans, materials shall meet the following
requirements.
Size and Pipe Material Allowed Specification
15” or smaller Solid Wall PVC Sanitary Sewer Pipe
10” or smaller Corrugated Polyethylene Storm Sewer Pipe
12” or larger Polypropylene Storm Sewer Pipe
8” or larger Ductile Iron Sewer Pipe
4” or larger C900 PVC Storm Sewer Pipe
9-05.12(1)
9-05.20
9-05.24
9-05.13
9-30.1(5)A
Where bends are shown on the plans, they shall be of the same material and manufacturer as the
main pipe and meet the manufacturer’s recommendations.
The second paragraph of Section 7-04.2 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall require pipe suppliers to furnish certificates signed by their authorized
representative, stating the specifications to which the materials or products were manufactured. The
Contractor shall provide 2 copies of these certifications to the Engineer for approval. Certificates
showing nonconformance with the Contract shall be sufficient evidence for rejection. Approval of
certificates shall be considered only as tentative acceptance of the materials and products, and such
action by Engineer will not relieve Contractor of his/her responsibility to perform field tests and to
replace or repair faulty materials, equipment, and/or workmanship and Contractor’s own expense.
Section 7-04.2 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Dense foam shall meet 9-05.52 of these Special Provisions.
Direct Pipe Tee Connections:
Direct pipe tee connections for use in gravity-flow sewer and storm drainage direct connections to
pipe shall be Inserta Tee service connections, as manufactured by Inserta Tee and shall meet ASTM
F2946 and consist of a PVC hub, rubber sleeve, and stainless steel band. Connection shall be a
compression fit into the cored wall of a mainline pipe. Hub shall be made from heavy-duty PVC
material. Stainless steel clamping assembly shall be of SS #301 for the band and housing and SS #305
for screws. Rubber sleeve and gasket, when applicable, shall meet the requirements of ASTM F477.
Gaskets shall be installed by the manufacturer. A water-based solution provided by the manufacturer
shall be used during assembly. Inserta Tee product shall provide a water connection according to the
requirements of ASTM D3212.
137
7-04.2(2) Temporary Stormwater Diversion
Section 7-04.2(2) is an added new section
(******)
It shall be the Contractor’s responsibility to maintain operation of the existing storm sewer system
throughout the duration of the project without any disruption of service until the new storm drain
has been accepted by the City to receive stormwater flows, and connections are made between the
existing and new storm based on scheduling approved by the Engineer.
A temporary stormwater diversion shall be capable of bypassing at least the 2-year peak flow during
construction.
The Contractor shall submit proposed methods for providing the diversions to the Engineer for
approval prior to construction. The diversions shall have the least impact on property owners and
traffic flow through the site. The diversions shall be installed, operated, and maintained only when
needed where the existing storm drain system must be demolished to allow construction of the new
system. Where shown on the Plans, Contractor shall time work of bypasses during period of
anticipated no or little rain.
If bypass pumping is provided, it shall be scheduled for continuous operation with backup equipment
available at all times for periods of maintenance and refueling or failure of the primary bypass pump(s)
or diversion system.
The Contractor’s bypass operation shall be sized to handle, at a minimum, the 2-year peak flow rate
or can be reduced to a size determined by the Contractor if the temporary bypass can be timed to
coincide with a period of little to no rain. The Contractor shall submit a Temporary Stormwater
Diversion Plan in accordance with Section 1-05. The Contractor’s plan shall be reviewed by the City
before the plan is implemented. The review of the flow diversion plan shall, as well as the Contractor’s
proposed size of the bypass, in no way relieve the Contractor of his responsibility to provide a bypass
system that conveys encountered flows without property damage or damage to the project or
construction area. As risk associated with sizing the bypass and impacts to construction is born by the
Contractor.
7-04.3(1) Cleaning and Testing
Section 7-04.3(1) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Before testing begins and in adequate time to obtain approval through submittal process, prepare
and submit test plan for approval by Engineer. Include testing procedures, methods, equipment, and
tentative schedule. Obtain advance written approval for any deviations from Drawings and
Specifications.
Repair, correct, and retest sections of pipe which fail to meet specified requirements when tested.
Perform testing as work progresses. Schedule testing so that no more than 1000 linear feet of installed
pipeline remains untested at one time.
Perform testing under observation of Engineer or Inspector.
Schedule testing during no rain. Plug the lower end of the pipe if needed to test pipe.
138
All pipe larger than 30-inch diameter shall have joints individually tested for Joint Tightness. Prior to
final backfill, all joints shall be individually tested using low-pressure air per ASTM C1103. For the
installation of any flexible pipe larger than 30-inches in diameter, the Contractor shall retain the
services of a pipe manufacturer representative, knowledgeable in the installation methods and
practices for the specific pipe product used on this project, as well as on the installation practices for
flexible pipelines in general. The manufacturer’s representative shall be present full time on site
during the construction of the first 300 feet of pipe installation, and part-time, as required, thereafter
until the entire pipeline installation is complete. The manufacturer’s representative shall observe pipe
foundation, pipe installation, placement and compaction of pipe zone bedding and backfill, and
testing procedures. The manufacturer’s representative shall notify Engineer and Contractor of any
non-conforming installation, identifying the manufacturer recommended corrective action(s), within
24 hours of such occurrence. All flexible pipe shall be tested for maximum pipe deflection by pulling
a rigid mandrel through the entire (i.e., 100%) flexible pipe length installed. Maximum deflection shall
not exceed 5%. Mandrel testing shall conform to ASTM D3034, and be performed no sooner than 30
days after backfilling and prior to final acceptance testing of the segment. Submit test results to the
Engineer.
1. Rigid mandrel shall have outside diameter (O.D.) equal to 95 percent of inside diameter (I.D.)
of pipe. Inside diameter of pipe, for purpose of determining outside diameter of mandrel, shall
be average outside diameter minus two minimum wall thicknesses for O.D. controlled pipe and
average inside diameter for I.D. controlled pipe, dimensions shall be per appropriate standard.
Statistical or other "tolerance packages" shall not be considered in mandrel sizing.
2. Rigid mandrel shall be constructed of metal or rigid plastic material that can withstand 200 psi
without being deformed. Mandrel shall have nine or more "runners" or "legs" as long as total
number of legs is odd number. Barrel section of mandrel shall have length of at least 75 percent
of inside diameter of pipe. Rigid mandrel shall not have adjustable or collapsible legs which
would allow reduction in mandrel diameter during testing. Provide and use proving ring for
modifying each size mandrel.
3. Furnish "proving ring" with each mandrel. Fabricate ring of 1/2-inch-thick, 3-inch-wide bar steel
to diameter 0.02 inches larger than approved mandrel diameter.
4. If a rigid mandrel is not available, the Contractor may substitute a round steel bar meeting #3
above.
“Testing Storm Sewer Pipe”, per linear foot shall be incidental to and included in storm sewer pipe bid
items.
7-04.3(2) CCTV Inspection
Section 7-04.3(2)is a new added section:
(******)
All storm drain and sewer main lines constructed as part of this project shall be inspected using closed-
circuit television (CCTV) before substantial completion. The costs incurred in “CCTV Inspection” per
linear foot shall be paid for under “CCTV Inspection.”
All CCTV inspections for storm drain lines shall conform to Section 7-17.3(2)H.
The Contractor shall bear all cost incurred in correcting any deficiencies found during television
inspection including the cost of any additional television inspection that may be required by the
Engineer to verify the correction of said deficiency.
139
The Contractor shall be responsible for all costs incurred in any television inspection performed solely
for the benefit of the Contractor.
7-04.3(3) Direct Pipe Connections
Section 7-04.3(4) is a new added section as follows:
(******)
Field Pipe and Joint Performance: To assure water tightness, field performance verification may be
accomplished by testing in accordance with ASTM F2487, ASTM F1417 or ASTM C1103. Appropriate
safety precautions must be used when field-testing any pipe material. Contact the manufacturer for
recommended leakage rates.
Installation: Installation shall be accordance with the manufacturer’s recommended installation
guidelines. Backfill around the Inserta Tee service connection shall be, at a minimum, of the same
material type and compaction level as specified for the mainline pipe installation.
7-05 MANHOLES, INLETS, AND CATCH BASINS
7-05.3 Construction Requirements
Section 7-05.3 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
All manholes shall have eccentric cones and shall have ladders.
Connection to manholes or catch basins for storm sewer pipe less than 24-inch shall be “Kor-n-Seal”
boot or approved alternate.
Sanitary sewer pipe to sanitary sewer manhole connections shall be “Kor-n-Seal” boot or approved
alternate.
7-05.3(1) Adjusting Manholes and Catch Basins to Grade
Section 7-05.3(1) is replaced with:
(******)
Where shown in the Plans or where directed by the Engineer, the existing manholes, catch basins, or
inlets shall be adjusted to the grade as staked or otherwise designated by the Engineer.
The existing cast iron ring and cover on manholes and the catch basin frame and grate shall first be
removed and thoroughly cleaned for reinstalling at the new elevation. From that point, the existing
structure shall be raised or lowered to the required elevation.
The Contractor shall construct manholes so as to provide adjustment space for setting cover and
casting to a finished grade as shown on the Construction Plans. Manhole ring and covers shall be
adjusted to the finished elevations per standard detail 106 prior to final acceptance of the Work.
Manholes in unimproved areas shall be adjusted to 6” above grade.
In unpaved streets: manholes, catch basins, and similar structures in areas to be surfaced with crushed
rock or gravel shall be constructed to a point approximately eight inches below the subgrade and
covered with a temporary wood cover. Existing manholes shall be cut off and covered in a similar
manner. The Contractor shall carefully reference each manhole so that they may be easily found upon
completion of the street Work. After placing the gravel or crushed stone surfacing, the manholes and
140
manhole castings shall be constructed to the finished grade of the roadway surface. Excavation
necessary for bringing manholes to grade shall center about the manhole and be held to the minimum
area necessary. At the completion of the manhole adjustment, the void around the manhole shall be
backfilled with materials which result in the section required on the typical roadway section, and be
thoroughly compacted.
In cement concrete pavement: manholes, catch basins, and similar structures shall be constructed
and adjusted in the same manner as outlined above except that the final adjustment shall be made
and cast iron frame be set after forms have been placed and checked. In placing the concrete
pavement, extreme care shall be taken not to alter the position of the casting in any way.
In asphalt concrete pavement: manholes shall not be adjusted until the pavement is completed, at
which time the center of each manhole shall be carefully relocated from references previously
established by the Contractor. The manhole shall then be brought to proper grade utilizing the same
methods of construction as for the manhole itself. The cast iron frame shall be placed on the concrete
grade rings and mortar. The complete patch shall match the existing paved surface for texture,
density, and uniformity of grade. The joint between the patch and the existing pavement shall then
be carefully painted with hot asphalt cement or asphalt emulsion and shall be immediately covered
with dry paving sand before the asphalt cement solidifies.
Adjustment of inlets: The final alignment and grade of cast iron frames for new and old inlets to be
adjusted to grade will be established from the forms or adjacent pavement surfaces. The final
adjustment of the top of the inlet will be performed in similar manner to the above for manholes. On
asphalt concrete paving projects using curb and gutter section, that portion of the cast iron frame not
embedded in the gutter section shall be solidly embedded in asphalt also. The concrete shall extend
a minimum of six inches beyond the edge of the casting and shall be left 2 inches below the top of the
frame so that the wearing course of asphalt concrete pavement will butt the cast iron frame. The
existing concrete pavement and edge of the casting shall be painted with hot asphalt cement.
Adjustments in the inlet structure shall be constructed in the same manner and of the same material
as that required for new inlets. The inside of the inlets shall be mortared.
Monuments and cast iron frame and cover: monuments and monument castings shall be adjusted to
grade in the same manner as for manholes.
Valve box castings: adjustments of valve box castings shall be made in the same manner as for
manholes.
7-05.3(2) Abandon Existing Manholes
Section 7-05.3(2) is revised as follows:
(******)
Where it is required that an existing manhole be abandoned, the structure shall be broken down to a
depth of at least 4 feet below the revised surface elevation, all connections plugged, the manhole
base shall be fractured to prevent standing water, and the manhole filled with sand and compacted
to 90 percent density as specified in Section 2-03.3(14)C. Debris resulting from breaking the upper
part of the manhole may be mixed with the sand subject to the approval of the Engineer. The ring and
cover shall be salvaged and all other surplus material disposed of.
141
7-05.3(3) Connections to Existing Structures
Section 7-05.3(3) is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Where shown on the Plans, new drain pipes shall be connected to existing line, catch basin, curb inlets
and/or manholes. The Contractor shall be required to core drill into the structure, shape the new pipe
to fit and re-grout the opening in a workmanlike manner. Where directed by the Engineer or where
shown on the Plans, additional structure channeling will be required.
Connections to existing sanitary sewer pipes shall be made with ductile iron sleeve-style coupling,
ROMAC or approved alternate, conforming to ASTM C219 and sized specifically for the pipe size and
materials being connected.
Connections to existing sanitary sewer manholes shall be core drilled. Couplings shall be equal to “Kor-
n-Seal” boots. Existing sanitary sewer manholes shall be cleaned, repaired, and re-channeled as
necessary to match the new pipe configuration and as shown on the Construction Plans.
A "connection to existing" item will be allowed at any connection of a new line to an existing structure.
No "connection to existing" will be accepted at the location of new installation, relocation and
adjustment of line manholes, catch basins, or curb inlets.
Any damage to existing pipe or structure that is to remain in place resulting from the Contractor's
operations shall be repaired or replaced at her/his own expense.
The unit bid price per each shall be full compensation for all labor, materials and equipment required.
7-05.3(5) Manhole Coatings
Section 7-05.3(5) is an added new section:
(******)
All new sanitary sewer manholes shall be coated as specified below. The following coating system
Specifications shall be used for coating (sealing) all interior concrete surfaces of sanitary sewer
manholes.
Coating Material: High Solids Urethane
Surfaces: Concrete
Surface Preparation: In accordance with SSPC SP-7
(Sweep of brush off blast)
Application: Shop/Field
The drying time between coats shall not exceed 24 hours in any case
System Thickness: 6.0 mils dry film
Coatings: Primer: One coat of Wasser MC-Aroshield (2.0 mils DFT)
Finish: Two or more coats of Wasser MC-Aroshield (min. 4.0 mils DFT)
Color: White
142
7-08 GENERAL PIPE INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
7-08.3 Construction Requirements
7-08.3(1)A Trenches
Section 7-08.3(1)A is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Trench Excavation and backfill for storm sewer and sanitary sewer construction shall be in accordance
with the trench limits outlined in the table below. Existing soil conditions are variable, and areas of
soil instability may exist. The Contractor is responsible for protecting and maintaining the trench
integrity and shall be held accountable for liability of trench construction, maintenance, and incidental
trench deficiencies or accidents. Incidents that result in loss of trench integrity will not be eligible for
a change order. All trench excavated materials shall be disposed of off-site at an approved Contractor-
provided disposal site, unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Excavation outside the excavation
limits shown on the plan drawings shall be at no additional expense to the City.
Pipe Type Sewer and Storm
Drain
Sewer and Storm
Drain
Sewer and Storm
Drain
Trench Depth <8-feet 8 through 16-feet >16-feet
Trench Pay
Width (ft) 4 6 8
7-08.3(1)C Bedding the Pipe
Section 7-08.3(1)C is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Pipe bedding for PVC sewer pipe shall meet the requirements of Section 9-03.12(3). It shall be placed
to a depth of 6" over and 6" under the exterior walls of the pipe.
For all pipe bedding, hand compaction of the bedding materials under the pipe haunches will be
required. Pipe bedding should provide a firm uniform cradle for support of the pipes. Prior to
installation of the pipe, the pipe bedding should be shaped to fit the lower part of the pipe exterior
with reasonable closeness to provide uniform support along the pipe. Hand compaction shall be
accomplished by using a suitable tamping tool to firmly tamp bedding material under the haunches
of the pipe. Care shall be taken to avoid displacement of the pipe during the compaction effort.
Pipe bedding material should be used as pipe zone backfill and placed in layers and tamped around
the pipes to obtain complete contact.
Bedding material shall meet the requirements of Gravel backfill for Pipe Zone Bedding in accordance
with Standard Specification Section 9-03.12(3), unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Pipe
bedding shall be considered incidental to the pipe and no further compensation shall be made.
In areas where the subgrade soils in the trench excavation consist of fine-grained soils, such as
silt/clay, or organic rich soils, the Engineer may direct the Contractor to use a geotextile separator
fabric be placed over the native soils prior to placement of the pipe bedding. The geotextile shall meet
the requirements of Section 9-33.2(1) Table 3 for Separation. Geotextile shall be paid for by other
items.
143
7-08.3(1)D Pipe Foundation
Section 7-08.3(1)D is a new section:
(******)
Pipe foundation in poor soil: When soft or unstable material is encountered at the subgrade which, in
the opinion of the Engineer, will not uniformly support the pipe, such material shall be excavated to
an additional depth as required by the Engineer and backfilled with foundation gravel material placed
in maximum 12-inch lifts. Foundation gravel shall be CSBC or Gravel Backfill for Walls, as directed by
the Engineer, and conform to the requirements of Section 9-03.9(3) or Section 9-03.12(2) of the
Standard Specifications.
Corrections faulty grade: Excess excavation below grade shall be backfilled with foundation gravel as
specified above and thoroughly compacted to the required grade line.
7-08.3(2)A Survey Line and Grade
Section 7-08.3(2)A is replaced with:
(******)
Survey line and grade control shall be provided in accordance with Sections 1-05.4, 1-05.5 and 1-11 in
a manner consistent with accepted practices.
The Contractor shall transfer line and grade into the trench where they shall be carried by means of a
laser beam. Any other procedure shall have the written approval of the Engineer.
7-08.3(2)B Pipe Laying – General
Section 7-08.3(2)B is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
Checking of the invert elevation of the pipe may be made by calculations from measurements on the
top of the pipe, or by looking for ponding of 1/2" or less, which indicates a satisfactory condition. At
manholes, when the downstream pipe(s) is of a larger size, pipe(s) shall be laid by matching the (eight-
tenths) flow elevation, unless otherwise shown on the plans and/or approved by the Engineer.
All pipe, fittings, etc. shall be carefully handled and protected against damage, impact shocks, and
free fall. All pipe handling equipment shall be acceptable to the Engineer. Pipe shall not be placed
directly on rough ground but shall be supported in a manner, which will protect the pipe against injury
whenever stored at the trench site or elsewhere. No pipe shall be installed where the lining or coating
show defects that may be harmful as determined by the Engineer. Such damaged lining or coating
shall be repaired, or a new undamaged pipe shall be furnished and installed.
The Contractor shall inspect each pipe and fitting prior to installation to insure that there are not
damaged portions of the pipe. Any defective, damaged, or unsound pipe shall be repaired or replaced.
All foreign matter or dirt shall be removed from the interior of the pipe before lowering into position
in the trench. Pipe shall be kept clean during and after laying. All openings in the pipeline shall be
closed with watertight expandable type sewer plugs at the end of each day's operation, or whenever
the pipe openings are left unattended. The use of burlap, wood, or other similar temporary plugs will
not be permitted.
Where necessary to raise or lower the pipe due to unforeseen obstructions or other causes, the
Engineer may change the alignment and/or the grades. Except for short runs, which may be permitted
by the Engineer, pipes shall be laid uphill on grades that exceed 10 percent. Pipe, which is laid on a
144
downhill grade, shall be blocked and held in place until sufficient support is furnished by the following
pipe to prevent movement.
Unless otherwise required, all pipe shall be laid straight between the changes in alignment, and at
uniform grade between changes in grade. For concrete pipes with elliptical reinforcement, the pipe
shall be placed with the minor axis of the reinforcement in a vertical position.
Immediately after the pipe joints have been made, proper gasket placement shall be checked with a
feeler gage as approved by the pipe manufacturer to verify proper gasket placement.
7-08.3(2)E Rubber Gasketed Joints
Section 7-08.3(2)E is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Care shall be taken by the Contractor to avoid over pushing the pipe and damaging the pipe or joint
system. Any damaged pipe shall be replaced by the Contractor at his expense.
7-08.3(2)H Sewer Line Connections
Section 7-08.3(2)H is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
All connections not occurring at a manhole or catch basin shall be done utilizing pre-manufactured
tee connectors or pipe sections approved by the Engineer. Any other method or materials proposed
for use in making connections shall be subject to approval by the Engineer.
Unless otherwise approved by the Engineer, all connections of lateral sewers to existing mains shall
be as follows:
A. Vitrified Clay MainCut in new PVC “Tee” using “Strong-Back” Flexible Couplings (Fernco or
approved alternate).
B. Concrete MainCut in new PVC “Tee” using “Strong-Back” Flexible Couplings (Fernco or
approved alternate).
C. PVC & C900 PVC MainCore-drilled with Romac Saddle (or approved alternate) or cut in new
“Tee” using “Strong-Back” Flexible Couplings (Fernco or approved alternate).
D. Ductile Iron Main Core-drilled with Romac Saddle (or approved alternate).
Connections (unless booted connections have been provided for) to existing concrete manholes shall
be per Section 7-05.3(3).
7-08.3(2)J Placing PVC Pipe
Section 7-08.3(2)J is an added new section:
(******)
In the trench, prepared as specified in Section 7-02.3(1) PVC pipe shall be laid beginning at the lower
end, with the bell end upgrade. Gravel Backfill for Pipe Zone Bedding or Pea Gravel will be used as the
bedding material and extend from 6" below the bottom of the pipe to 6" above the top of the pipe.
When it is necessary to connect to a structure with a mudded joint a rubber gasketed concrete
adapter-collar will be used at the point of connection.
145
7-08.3(3)A Backfilling Pipe Trenches
Section 7-08.3(3)A is a new section supplementing 7-08.3(3)
(******)
To the maximum extent available, suitable material obtained from trench or pond excavation shall be
used for trench backfill. All material placed as trench backfill shall be free from rocks or stones larger
than 6 inches in their greatest dimension, brush, stumps, logs, roots, debris, and organic or other
deleterious materials. No stones or rock shall be placed in the upper three feet of trench backfill. Rock
or stones within the allowable size limit incorporated in the remainder of fills shall be distributed so
that they do not congregate or interfere with proper compaction.
The existing soils shall not be reused as trench backfill unless otherwise required by the Engineer.
Structural fill shall consist of Gravel Borrow, meeting the requirements of Section 9-03.14(1) of the
Standard Specifications. It should be free of gravel, organics and other debris. The structural trench
backfill should be moisture conditioned to within approximately 3 percent of optimum moisture
content, placed in loose horizontal lifts less than 6 inches in thickness, and compacted to at least 95
percent of the maximum dry density (MDD) as determined by the Modified Proctor compaction test
method ASTM D 1557.
Trench backfill shall be densely compacted in a systematic manner using methods that consistently
produce adequate compaction levels. During placement of the initial lifts, the trench backfill material
shall not be bulldozed into the trench or dropped directly on the pipe. Heavy vibratory equipment
shall not permitted to operate directly over the pipe until a minimum of 2 feet of backfill has been
placed over the pipe bedding.
Contactor shall take special care to obtain good compaction up to the edges of the excavation as the
shoring is removed in accordance with the Shoring Plan.
The Contractor shall be responsible for performing compaction testing and furnishing testing reports
to the Engineer. Areas of the trench which fail to meet the compaction requirements shall be removed
and replaced and re-compacted at the Contractor’s expense.
The Contractor shall be responsible for any settlement of backfill, sub-base, and pavement that may
occur during the period stipulated in the Contract conditions. All repairs necessary due to settlement
shall be made by the Contractor at his expense.
Backfill in unimproved areas shall be compacted to at least 90 percent of maximum dry density as
determined by the modified proctor compaction test, ASTM D1557.
The Contractor shall be responsible for the disposal of any excess excavated material. Special care
must be taken to obtain good compaction up to the edges of the excavation as the shoring is removed.
Moreover, attention must be paid to ensuring good compaction around manholes.
7-09 WATER MAINS
7-09.1(1)A Trench Widths
Section 7-09.1.1(A) is revised as follows:
(******)
Trench excavation and backfill for the water main construction shall be in accordance with the trench
limits outlined in the table below. Existing soil conditions are variable, and areas of soil instability may
146
exist. The Contractor is responsible for protecting and maintaining the trench integrity and shall be
held accountable for liability of trench construction, maintenance, and incidental trench deficiencies
or accidents. All trench excavated materials shall be disposed of off-site at an approved Contractor-
provided disposal site, unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Excavation outside the excavation
limits shown on the plan drawings shall be at no additional expense to the City.
Pipe Type Water Main Pipe Water Service Pipe
Trench Depth All All
Trench Pay Width (ft) 3 2
7-09.3(15) Laying of Pipe on Curves
7-09.3(15)A Ductile Iron Pipe
Section 7-09.3(15)A is revised as follows:
(******)
Long radius curves with radius of 400 feet or more, either horizontal or vertical, pipe may be laid with
standard pipe lengths by deflecting the joints. If the pipe is shown curved on the Plans and no special
fittings are shown, the Contractor can assume that the curves can be made by deflecting the joints
with standard lengths of pipe. If shorter lengths are required, the Plans will indicate maximum lengths
that can be used. The amount of deflection at each pipe joint when pipe is laid on a horizontal or
vertical curve shall not exceed one half (50%) of the manufacturer’s printed recommended
deflections.
The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer the pipe manufacturer's joint deflection
recommendations prior to pipe installation indicating deflections are within allowable AWWA
specification tolerances.
Where field conditions require deflection or curves not anticipated by the Plans, the Engineer will
determine the methods to be used. No additional payment will be made for laying pipe on curves as
shown on the Plans, or for field changes involving standard lengths of pipe deflected at the joints.
When special fittings not shown on the Plans are required to meet field conditions, additional
payment will be made for special fittings as provided in Section 1-09.6.
When rubber gasketed pipe is laid on a curve, the pipe shall be jointed in a straight alignment and
then deflected to the curved alignment. Trenches shall be made wider on curves for this purpose.
Where pipe installation on curves requires the use of special fittings, concrete blocking shall be used
per Section 7-09.3(21).
Where restrained joint pipe is installed on a curve, the Contractor shall submit the pipe
manufacturer’s recommendations to the Engineer for approval.
7-09.3(15)B Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Pipe (4 inches and Over)
Section 7-09.3(15)B is revised as follows:
(******)
Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Pipe shall not be used for water mains and appurtenances.
147
7-09.3(17) Laying Ductile Iron Pipe and Fittings with Polyethylene Encasement
Section 7-09.3(17), with title change, is revised as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall lay ductile iron pipe with a polyethylene encasement. Pipe and polyethylene
encasement shall be installed in accordance with AWWA C105. The polyethylene encasement shall
also be installed on all appurtenances, such as pipe laterals, couplings, and fittings with 8-mil
polyethylene plastic in accordance with Section 4-5 of ANSI 21.5 or AWWA C105.
The polyethylene wrap shall be tube type and black color. Any damage that occurs to the wrap shall
be repaired in accordance with ANSI/AWWA C105/A21.5-93.
Installation of the polyethylene encasement shall be considered incidental to the installation of the
pipe and fittings and no additional payment shall be allowed.
7-09.3(19)A Connections to Existing Mains
Section 7-09.3(19)A is revised as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall not operate any valve on existing Water Main.
The City of Renton Water Operations and Maintenance staff will make all connections to charged
water mains and will operate all valves to accomplish shutdowns and subsequent reactivation. The
draining of existing water mains will be done by City water maintenance staff. The Contractor shall
provide pumping and disposal of the water from the draining of the existing water mains including
de-chlorination of the water prior to disposal.
Connections to the existing water main shall not be made without first making the necessary
scheduling arrangements with the Engineer in advance. The Contractor shall request water main shut-
offs for connections of new water mains to existing water mains at least ten (10) working days in
advance for each connection. Approval of connections to existing water main is contingent on the
Water Main and appurtenances being completely installed, tested, cleaned with polypig, disinfected
and flushed per Contract requirements.
City’s water operations and maintenance staff will notify in writing all water customers affected by
the shut-offs of the water mains at least 48 hours in advance (not including weekends and holidays)
of any water shut-offs. The Contractor may be required to perform the connection during times other
than normal working hours. Water main shut-offs shall occur during non-holiday weekdays unless
otherwise specified in the contract documents. Water main shut-offs shall not occur in the five (5)
weekdays preceding or the day after the major holidays listed below:
New Year’s Day, Martin Luther King Jr. Day, Memorial Day, Juneteenth, Independence Day, Labor Day,
Veterans Day, Thanksgiving Day, Christmas Day.
Due to the needs of various water customers in the project vicinity, water shut-off periods are limited
to the times set forth below:
Days Hours
Monday to Thursday 9:00 AM TO 3:00 PM
Friday to Sunday DO NOT SCHEDULE
148
The City of Renton’s Water Maintenance Manager, at his/her sole discretion, may adjust the above
shut-off periods in order to address specific project circumstances and customer needs. No water
main shutoffs affecting public schools will be allowed during scheduled school hours. The City reserves
the right to re-schedule the connection if the work area is not ready at the scheduled time for the
connection.
Points of connection to existing water mains shall be exposed by hydro excavation or potholing prior
to trenching of the new water mains. Before the installation of the new water mains, the Contractor
shall field verify, in the presence of the Engineer, the actual location and depth of the existing water
mains where new connections will be made to assure proper fit. Care shall be taken not to disturb
existing thrust blocks and soil bearing areas. After excavation, the Contractor shall verify the
dimensions, type, condition, and roundness of the exposed water main. The Contractor shall
immediately notify the Engineer if the connection cannot be made as specified by the Contract Plans
in order that the connection detail may be revised. When necessary, the profile shall be adjusted as
directed by the Engineer to prevent abrupt changes in grade and alignment of the water main and
connection.
The Contractor shall provide all saw-cutting, removal and disposal of existing surface improvements,
excavation, haul and disposal of unsuitable materials, shoring, de-watering, foundation material, at
the connection areas before the scheduled time for the connection by the City. The Contractor shall
provide all materials necessary for the City Water Maintenance personnel to install all connections to
existing water mains as indicated on the Contract Plans, including fittings, couplings, pipe spools,
shackle materials to complete the connections.
The City Water Operations and Maintenance staff will:
a) Deactivate and dewater the existing and new water main to perform the connections. The
Contractor shall provide pumping and disposal of the water from the draining of the water
mains including de-chlorination.
b) Cut, remove and dispose pipe sections as necessary to install the new Materials with
Contractor’s assistance
c) Swab all connecting pipe and fittings with 5-6% chlorine solution
d) Perform the connection work
e) Reactivate and flush the Water Main
The Contractor shall install the polywrap on all pipes and fittings at the connection points and shall
install concrete thrust blocks per Contract standard plans and specifications.
In addition to those connections shown on the Plans, segments of a new Water Main may be placed
in service prior to completion of the new Water Main. All connection between the charged and
uncharged segments of the new Water Main, including connection to a new Tapping Tee and Valve
will be done by the City of Renton Water Operations and Maintenance staff.
Connections to existing water mains which include wet tapping the existing water main or the cutting
of the existing water main for the installation of new in-line tee and valves shall be done in two steps:
Step 1: Cut-in of existing water main for installation of in-line tee and valves:
The Contractor shall provide all materials necessary for the City Water Maintenance personnel to cut
the existing water main as indicated on the Contract Plans for the installation of the in-line tee and
valves, including but not limited to the required fittings, couplings, pipe spools, shackle materials to
149
complete the cut-in. After the cut-in of the in-line tee and valves by City personnel, the Contractor
shall provide and install concrete blocking and polyethylene encasement behind the in-line tee and
other fittings. A minimum 3-day curing period is required before a connection can be made to the
new water mains.
Wet tapping of existing water main for installation of tapping tee and valve:
Wet tapping of existing water mains shall be performed by a City approved wet tap contractor (Speer
Taps, Inc. or Legacy Tapping, Inc.). The Contractor shall provide all materials necessary for the wet
tapping of the existing water main as indicated on the Contract Plans for the installation of the tapping
tee and valve. After the wet tap, the Contractor shall provide and install concrete blocking behind the
tapping tee. A minimum 3-day curing period is required before a connection can be made to the new
tapping valve.
Step 2: Connection of new water main to the new cut-in tee and valves, or to a new tapping valve on
existing water mains by City’s Water Maintenance personnel.
7-09.3(21) Concrete Thrust Blocking and Dead-Man Block
Section 7-09.3(21), with title change, is revised as follows:
(******)
Concrete thrust blocking shall be placed at bends, tees, dead ends, crosses and on other fittings in
conformance to the City of Renton Standards Plans, latest revisions and Contract Plans.
Concrete thrust collar and blocking and dead-man thrust blocking shall be installed at locations shown
on the Plans and shall be in conformance with the Standard Plans and Contract Plans. Reinforcement
steel shall be Grade 40 or better.
Blocking shall be poured in place Ready-Mix Concrete Class 3000 with a minimum compressive
strength at 28 days of 3,000 psi. Job site mixing, hand-mixed concrete and mobile concrete mixers are
not allowed.
All fittings to be blocked shall be wrapped with 8-mil polyethylene plastic. Concrete blocking shall bear
against solid undisturbed earth at the sides and bottom of the trench excavation and shall be shaped
and properly formed with plywood or other acceptable forming materials so as not to obstruct access
to the joints of the pipe, bolts or fittings. The forms shall be removed prior to backfilling. Unacceptable
concrete blocking shall be replaced at the Contractor’s expense.
The Contractor shall provide the Engineer at least 1 Working Day advance notice before pouring
concrete thrust blocking and 1 Working Day advance notice for inspection and approval of all concrete
blocking prior to backfilling.
7-09.3(23) Hydrostatic Pressure Test
Section 7-09.3(23) is revised as follows:
(******)
Water main and appurtenances including service connections to the meter setter shall be tested in
sections of convenient length under a hydrostatic pressure equal to 150 psi in excess of that under
which they will operate or in no case shall the test pressure be less than 225 psi at the highest point
on the water main. Pumps, gauges, plugs, saddles, corporation stops, miscellaneous hose and piping,
and measuring equipment necessary for performing the test shall be furnished and operated by the
Contractor.
150
The Contractor shall obtain a hydrant meter permit from the City by completing a permit application
and making the required security deposits. The Contractor shall use the City’s issued hydrant meter
with an attached backflow prevention assembly to draw water from the City’ water system to fill the
water mains for poly-pigging, testing, cleaning, disinfection and for subsequent flushing purposes.
There will be a charge for the water used for filling, testing, cleaning and disinfection of the water
mains.
Sections to be tested shall normally be limited to 1,500 feet or less, unless otherwise indicated on the
plans or approved by the Engineer. The Engineer may require that the first section of pipe, not less
than 1,000 feet in length, installed by each of the Contractor’s crews, be tested in order to qualify the
crew and the materials. Pipe laying shall not be continued more than an additional 1,000 feet until
the first section has been tested successfully.
The pipeline shall be backfilled sufficiently to prevent movement of the pipe under pressure. Thrust
blocks shall be in place and time allowed for the concrete to cure before testing. Where permanent
blocking is not required, the Contractor shall furnish and install temporary blocking and remove it
after testing.
Before applying the specified test pressure, the water main shall be slowly filled and air shall be
expelled completely from the pipe, valves and hydrants. If permanent air vents are not located at all
high points, the contractor shall install corporation cocks at such points so that the air can be expelled
as the line is filled with water. After all the air has been expelled, the corporation cocks shall be closed
and the test pressure applied. At the conclusion of the pressure test, the corporation cocks shall be
removed and plugged.
The Contractor shall perform a leakage test concurrently with the pressure test. The pressure test
shall be conducted for a 2-hour period.
The test shall be accomplished by pumping the main up to the required pressure, stopping the pump
for 2 hours, and then pumping the main up to the test pressure again. During the test, the section
being tested shall be observed to detect any visible leakage.
A clean container shall be used for holding water for pumping up pressure on the main being tested.
This makeup water shall be sterilized by the addition of chlorine to a concentration of 50 mg/l.
The acceptability of the pressure test and leakage test will be determined by two factors as follows:
1. The loss in pressure shall not exceed 5 psi during the 2-hour test period.
2. The quantity of water lost from the main and appurtenances shall not exceed the number of
gallons during the 2-hour test period as listed in the following table.
Allowable leakage in gallons per 1000 ft. of pipeline* for a 2-hour test period
Nominal Pipe Diameter (inches)
PSI 6" 8" 10" 12" 16" 20" 24"
450 0.95 1.27 1.59 1.91 2.55 3.18 3.82
400 0.90 1.20 1.50 1.80 2.40 3.00 3.60
350 0.84 1.12 1.40 1.69 2.25 2.81 3.37
275 0.75 1.00 1.24 1.49 1.99 2.49 2.99
250 0.71 0.95 1.19 1.42 1.90 2.37 2.85
225 0.68 0.90 1.13 1.35 1.80 2.25 2.70
200 0.64 0.85 1.06 1.28 1.70 2.12 2.55
151
*If the pipeline under test contains sections of various diameters, the allowable leakage will be the
sum of the computed leakage for each size. For those diameters or pressures not listed, the formula
below shall be used:
The quantity of water lost from the main shall not exceed the number of gallons per hour as
determined by the formula: 𝐿𝐿=𝑆𝑆𝑆𝑆√𝑃𝑃266,400
where:
L = Allowable leakage in gallons/hour
S = Gross length of pipe tested, feet
D = Nominal diameter of the pipe in inches
P = Test pressure during the leakage test in psi
The quantity of water required to restore the pressure shall be accurately determined by either 1)
pumping from an open container of suitable size such that accurate volume measurements can be
made by the Engineer or, 2) by pumping through a positive displacement water meter with a sweep
unit hand registering one (1) gallon per revolution. The meter shall be approved by the Engineer.
Pressure gauges used in the test shall be accompanied with certifications of accuracy from a testing
Laboratory approved by the Engineer.
Any visible leakage detected shall be corrected by the Contractor regardless of the allowable leakage
specified above. Should the tested section fail to meet the pressure test successfully as specified, the
Contractor shall, at no additional expense to the Contracting Agency, locate and repair the defects
and then retest the pipeline. The use of leak detection dye or other substances to detect any visible
leakage is strictly prohibited.
All tests shall be made with the hydrant auxiliary gate valves open and pressure against the hydrant
inlet valve. After the test is completed, each valve shall be tested by closing each in turn and relieving
the pressure beyond. This test of the valve will be acceptable if there is no immediate loss of pressure
on the gauge when the pressure comes against the valve being checked. The Contractor shall verify
that the pressure differential across the valve does not exceed the rated working pressure of the valve.
Prior to calling out the Engineer or Inspector to witness the pressure test, the Contractor shall have
all equipment set up completely ready for operation and shall have successfully performed the test
to ensure that the pipe is in satisfactory condition.
Defective materials or workmanship, discovered as a result of hydrostatic field test, shall be replaced
by the Contractor at no additional expense to the Contracting Agency. Whenever it is necessary to
replace defective material or correct the workmanship, the hydrostatic test shall be re-run at the
Contractor’s expense until a satisfactory test is obtained.
152
7-09.3(24) Disinfection of Water Mains
7-09.3(24)A Flushing and "Poly-pigging"
Section 7-09.3(24)A, with title change, is revised as follows:
(******)
Prior to pressure testing, disinfection, and final flushing of the Water Mains for bacteriological
sampling and testing, all Water Mains shall first be poly-pigged to remove any solids or contaminated
materials that may have entered or become lodged in the pipes during installation.
The "Poly-pig" shall be light density foam (1-2 pcf) with 90A durometer urethane rubber coating on
the rear of the "Poly-pig" only. The "Poly-pig" shall be cylinder shaped with bullet nose or squared
end. The “Poly-pigs” shall be inserted in the pipes and retrieved form the pipes through launching
stations with vertical crosses and blow-off assemblies as shown and on the Contract Plans and
Standard Plans.
If the main cannot be poly-pigged, then a tap shall be provided large enough to develop a flow velocity
of at least 2.5 fps in the water main.
Taps required by the Contractor for temporary or permanent release of air, chlorination or flushing
purposes shall be provided by the Contractor as part of the construction of water mains.
The Contractor shall be responsible for disposal of treated water flushed from mains and shall
neutralize the wastewater for protection of aquatic life in the receiving water before disposal into any
natural drainage channel, i.e., receiving water, waters of the State, including wetlands. The Contractor
shall be responsible for disposing of disinfecting solution to the satisfaction of the Contracting Agency
and local authorities. At a minimum, chlorinated water shall be dechlorinated to a concentration of
0.1 parts per million (ppm) or less, and pH adjustment to within 6.5 – 8.5 standard units before
discharging to surface waters of the State or to a storm sewer system that drains to surface waters of
the State.
If approved by the Engineer and by the local authority responsible for the sanitary sewer system,
disposal of treated water from mains may be made to an available sanitary sewer, provided the rate
of disposal will not overload the sewer.
7-09.3(24)D Dry Calcium Hypochlorite
Section 7-09.3(24)D is revised as follows:
(******)
Dry calcium hypochlorite shall not be placed in the pipe as laid.
7-09.3(24)K Retention Period
Section 7-09.3(24)K is revised as follows:
(******)
Treated water shall be retained in the pipe at least 24 hours but no longer than 48 hours. After the
retention period, the chlorine residual shall be tested at all pipe extremities and at other
representative points and shall measure at least 25 mg/L. If a measurement of less than 25 mg/L is
obtained repeat disinfection is required.
153
7-09.3(24)N Final Flushing and Testing
Section 7-09.3(24)N is revised as follows:
(******)
Following chlorination, treated water shall be flushed from the newly-laid pipe until the replacement
water throughout its length shows, upon test, the absence of chlorine. In the event chlorine is
normally used in the source of supply, then the tests shall show a residual not in excess of that carried
in the water supply system. After flushing the treated water from the pipes, a 16-hour rest period is
required before any water quality sampling can be taken from the new pipes.
A sample tap shall be located ahead of the flushing hose for convenience and for sanitary sampling.
Before placing the lines into service, and after a 16-hour rest period, two sets of satisfactory reports
shall be received from the local or State Health Department or an approved testing lab on samples
collected from representative points in the new system. Samples will be collected and bacteriological
tests obtained by the Engineer or City Inspector. Following the retention period, the installation of
new mains requires that two sets of samples for coliform analysis are collected using the following
method:
AWWA C651-14 Option B
1. Provide rest period of at least 16 hours.
2. Collect first set of samples from representative points.
3. Provide wait period of at least 15 minutes.
4. Collect second set of samples from representative points.
At a minimum, chlorinated water shall be dechlorinated to a concentration of 0.1 parts per million
(ppm) or less, and pH adjustment to within 6.5 to 8.5 standard units, if necessary, before discharging
to surface waters of the State or to a storm sewer system that drains to surface waters of the State.
Following successful bacteriological testing on an individual segment, the City will complete the final
tie-in of that segment within 10 working days.
7-09.3(26) Abandonment of Existing Water Pipe
Section 7-09.3(26) is a new section:
(******)
Where shown in the Plans or at other locations as determined by the Engineer, the Contractor shall
abandon existing water lines with installation of DI mechanical joint end caps or plugs. Where the
remaining portion of the existing water main is to remain in service following removal of the
designated water main, hydrant assembly, or water service connection, the Contractor shall install a
permanent cast iron or ductile iron cap or plug with associated fittings, and thrust block.
154
7-12 VALVES FOR WATER MAINS
7-12.3(1) Installation of Valve Marker Post
Section 7-12.3(1) has been revised as follows:
(******)
Where required, a valve marker post shall be furnished and installed with each valve. Valve marker
posts shall be placed at the edge of the right-of-way opposite the valve and be set with 18 inches of
the post exposed above grade.
The rest of this section is deleted.
7-12.3(2) Adjust Existing Valve Box to Grade
Section 7-12.3(2) is a new section:
(******)
Existing valve boxes shall be adjusted to grade in the same manner as for manholes, as detailed in
Section 7-05.3(1) of the City of Renton Standard Provisions. Valve box adjustments shall include, but
not be limited to, the locations shown on the Plans.
Existing roadway valve boxes shall be adjusted to conform to final finished grades. The final
installation shall be made in accordance with the applicable portions of Section 7-12.
In the event that the existing valve box is plugged or blocked with debris, the Contractor shall use
whatever means necessary to remove such debris, leaving the valve installation in a fully operable
condition.
The valve box shall be set to an elevation tolerance of one-fourth inch (1/4") to one-half inch (1/2")
below finished grade.
7-14 HYDRANTS
7-14.3(1) Setting Hydrants
Section 7-14.3(1) has been revised as follows:
(******)
Where shown on the Plans, hydrants shall be installed in accordance with the Standard Plans and
Contract specifications. A minimum 3-foot radius unobstructed working area shall be provided around
all hydrants. The bottom surface of the breakaway flange shall be set 2-inches minimum and 7-inches
maximum above the concrete shear block finished grade.
For each hydrant requiring vertical adjustment, see Section 7-14.3(6).
Fire hydrants shall be of such length as to be suitable for installation with connections to 6", 8" and
10" piping in trenches 3-1/2 feet deep unless otherwise specified. The hydrant shall be designed for a
4-1/2 foot burial where 12" and larger pipe is shown unless otherwise noted in the Plans.
After installation hydrants shall be subjected to a hydrostatic test as specified in Section 7-09.3(23).
The hydrant excavation shall be backfilled and compacted when installation and testing are complete
and accepted by the Engineer.
155
A concrete shear block as shown by the hydrant details on the Standard Plans shall be constructed for
all hydrants. Construction, Materials, and finishing of the concrete shear block shall conform to
Section 8-14, Cement Concrete Sidewalk. The shear block shall be set flush with the immediately
surrounding finish grade.
The Contractor shall flush, test and disinfect furnished hydrants and hydrant barrel extensions
according to Section 7-14.3(6).
Upon completion of the project, all fire hydrants shall be painted with two field coats of Kelly-
Moore/Preservative paint No. 5780-563 DTM Acrylic Gloss Safety Yellow or approved alternate.
Any hydrants not in service shall be identified by covering with a burlap or plastic bag properly
secured.
Fire hydrant assembly shall include: main line cast-iron or ductile iron tee (MJ x FL), 6" gate valve (FL
x MJ), 6" DI spool (PE x PE) up to 20 feet in length, 5-1/4" MVO fire hydrant (MJ connection), 4" x 5"
Storz adapter with stainless steel cable, cast iron valve box, cover, valve operating nut extension,
1-1/4" washed drain rock, blue reflective pavement marker, 16"x8"x4" (minimum) concrete blocks
under hydrant and gate valve, 4'x4'x6" concrete shear block around hydrant, and mechanical joint
restraint (wedge-type restrained retainer glands) with poured-in-place concrete thrust block behind
the hydrant shoe or two 3/4-inch diameter Cor-Ten steel tie rods.
7-14.3(3) Resetting Existing Hydrants
Section 7-14.3(3) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
All existing hydrants to be reset shall be rebuilt to the approval of the Engineer. All rubber gaskets
shall be replaced with new gaskets of the type required for a new installation of the same type.
Unless a specific bid item has been included in the Proposal/Contract Document, resetting existing
hydrants shall be incidental to and included in the various bid items.
7-14.3(7) Remove and Salvage Hydrant
Section 7-14.3(7) is a new section:
(******)
Existing hydrants shall be removed where shown in the Plans. Removed hydrants shall be delivered
to the City of Renton shops by the Contractor. The existing hydrant lateral tee shall be removed from
the main.
Unless a specific bid item has been included in the Proposal/Contract Document, removing and
salvaging hydrants shall be incidental to and included in the various bid items.
7-14.3(8) Abandoned Valves
Section 7-14.3(8) is added as follows:
(******)
All valves to be abandoned shall be abandoned in the closed position, unless shown otherwise, by
removing a minimum of the top twenty-four inches of the valve box and then filling the bottom of the
box with a minimum of 8-inches of sand. The remaining portion of the valve box shall be filled with
concrete having an f’c of at least 2000 psi.
156
Unless a specific bid item has been included in the Proposal/Contract Document, Abandoned Valves
shall be incidental to and included in the various bid items.
7-15 SERVICE CONNECTIONS
7-15.3 Construction Requirements
Section 7-15.3 is revised as follows:
(******)
All pipe materials for new water service lines and for extension or replacement of existing water
service lines shall be copper and lead free in accordance with the Federal Reduction of Lead in Drinking
Water Act. Pipe materials for water service line installation for size 2-inch or less and connection to
ductile iron water main shall be copper type “K” annealed tubing and seamless (ANSI H33.1).
Ductile iron pipe Class 52 or stronger shall be direct-tapped with 1-inch corporation stops for 1-inch
service lines.
All meter setters for residential domestic use shall be 1-inch by 1-inch setters unless otherwise
specified on the Contract Plans. For existing 3/4-inch meters, the Contractor shall furnish and install
reducing couplings to adapt the 1-inch setter to the standard 3/4-inch domestic meter.
All installations shall be considered open cut and the contractor shall locate and avoid other
underground utilities during installation. The Contractor may install service lines utilizing a trenchless
percussion and impact method (hoe-hogging) method but must obtain written approval from the
Engineer.
Where shown in the Plans, the Contractor shall:
• Furnish and install new water service lines from the new water main to the new meter setters
and new meter boxes near the existing meters.
• Furnish and install adaptors for the relocation of the existing water meters to the new meter
setters and re-install the existing meters in the new meter setters.
• For Types A and B service connections, furnish and install new pressure reducing valve (PRV)
assemblies and new PRV boxes behind the new meter boxes.
• For Type C service connections, furnish new PRV assemblies with adapters and install into the
existing meter setters and re-install existing boxes on top of existing setters.
• Connect the customer-side private service line to the new copper tailpiece behind the new
PRV assembly.
• Restore disturbed areas to their approximate original condition as directed by the Engineer.
157
7-17 SANITARY SEWERS
7-17.2 Materials
Section 7-18.2 is replaced with the following:
(******)
Pipe
Gravity sewer pipe shall be as specified herein and as shown on the Plans. The Contractor shall provide
two copies of the pipe manufacturer’s technical literature and tables of dimensional tolerances to the
Engineer. Any pipe found to have dimensional tolerances in excess of those prescribed or having
defects, which prevent adequate joint seal or any other damage, shall be rejected. If requested by the
Engineer, not less than three nor more than five lengths of pipe for each size, selected from stock by
the Engineer, shall be tested as specified for maximum dimensional tolerance of the respective pipe.
Materials shall be the requirements of the following sections:
SDR 35 Sewer Pipe (ASTM D3034 & ASTM F679) Section 9-05.12(1).
All pipe shall be clearly marked with type, class, and thickness. Lettering shall be legible and
permanent under normal conditions of handling and storage.
7-17.3 Construction Requirements
7-17.3(1) Protection of Existing Sewerage Facilities
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
When extending an existing sewer, the downstream system shall be protected from construction
debris by placing a screen or trap in the first existing manhole downstream of the connection. It shall
be the Contractor's responsibility to maintain this screen or trap until the new system is placed in
service and then to remove it. Any construction debris, which enters the existing downstream system,
shall be removed by the Contractor at his expense, and to the satisfaction of the Engineer. When the
first manhole is set, its outlet shall be plugged until acceptance by the Engineer.
7-17.3(1)A Temporary Sewer Bypass Systems
It shall be the Contractor's responsibility to maintain operation of the existing sewer systems throughout
the duration of the project without any interruption of sewer service. The Contractor shall divert all flows
around each segment of the pipe designated for replacement. This diversion shall consist of redirecting
flow from an upstream manhole and discharging it to a manhole downstream of the rehabilitation
operation. This can be accomplished via a combination of pumping and/or gravity flow. After the work is
completed, flow shall be returned to the sewer system. The area affected by the bypass operation shall
be fully restored.
Bypass pumping shall be scheduled for continuous operation. Back-up equipment shall be on-site and
available for periods of maintenance, refueling or failure of the primary bypass pump(s) or diversion
system. Bypass pumping shall be done in such a manner as not to damage private or public property or
create a nuisance or public menace. The bypass-pumping pipe shall not block any driveways or
intersections unless approved by the Engineer. The sewage shall be pumped through a watertight hose or
pipe that is adequately protected from traffic. The discharge of raw sewage to private property, city
streets, sidewalks, storm sewer, or any location other than an approved sanitary sewer is prohibited. The
158
Contractor shall be liable for all cleanup, damages, and resultant fines should the Contractor's operation
cause any backups or overflows.
The Contractor's bypass operation shall be sized to handle, at a minimum, the full pipe capacity in each
subject line removed from service. If flow conditions are greater than full pipe, the Contractor may elect
to wait for flow conditions to subside prior to removing the subject line from service. Working days will
not be charged for the period of time during which the flow is greater than full pipe. No additional
payment will be made for periods of high flows during which the Contractor elects to wait for lower flows.
Once the Contractor removes a section of line from service he/she is responsible to bypass any and all
flow in the system during construction, even in the event the system surcharges and exceeds the full pipe
capacity, until the line is returned to service.
All bypassing systems shall be approved by the Engineer. A plan for bypassing the existing sewer system
shall be submitted by the Contractor for review. The Contractor's plan for bypass pumping shall be
satisfactory to the Owner before the Contractor will be allowed to commence bypass pumping. The
sewage bypass pumping plan shall include an emergency response plan to be followed in the event of a
failure of the bypass pumping and a security plan for continued operation and protection of the bypass
system. The review of the bypassing system and equipment by the Engineer shall in no way relieve the
Contractor of his responsibility and public liability.
The Contractor shall coordinate activities with impacted property owners. Property Owners shall be
notified that their side sewer will be out of service for a specified period of time, as approved by the
Engineer. Where there exist a situation where impacted properties cannot be disconnected, plugged, or
subjected to any other service interruption, i.e. hospitals, care facilities, restaurants, etc., bypass pumping
of the side sewer to the downstream sanitary sewer system shall be required. The contractor shall verify
whether a property is able to be interrupted prior to bypassing operations.
7-17.3(2)H Television Inspection
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
CCTV Inspection:
1. All newly installed and newly-rehabilitated (public and private) Sanitary Sewer and Storm
Drain main lines shall be inspected by means of remote CCTV. CCTV inspections and reports
shall be submitted to the City of Renton inspector assigned to the project prior to receiving
approval to install project curbs, gutters and/or pavement.
2. The Contractor shall perform all CCTV inspections in accordance with the National Association
of Sewer Service Companies (NASSCO) Pipeline Assessment Certification Program (PACP).
3. All CCTV operators shall have current NASSCO PACP certification.
4. CCTV inspections shall be recorded in a GraniteNet compatible format database using the
latest software version and submitted with electronic links between the data and the video
on an External HDD, DVD or Flash Drive.
5. All CCTV inspection reports shall be within +/- two (2) feet of the measured linear footage
between manholes along the existing pipeline centerline from the start of pipe to end of pipe.
6. All Owner and PACP required header information must be fully and accurately entered on all
CCTV reports. Work not following these specifications will be rejected and the Contractor shall
be required to re-CCTV the work.
159
7. The documentation of the work shall consist of PACP CCTV Reports, PACP database which will
have a .MDB or .MDF file extension, logs, electronic reports, etc. noting important features
encountered during the inspection. The speed of travel shall be slow enough to inspect each
pipe joint, tee connection, structural deterioration, infiltration and inflow sources, and
deposits, but should not, at any time, be faster than 30 feet per minute, except as noted
otherwise in this document.
8. The camera must be centered in the pipe to provide accurate distance measurements to
provide locations of features in the sewer and these footage measurements shall be displayed
and documented on the video. All PACP Observations shall be identified by audio and on a
PACP log. All video must be continuously metered from manhole to manhole. All video
recording shall be continuous from structure to structure with no “pausing” of the video
recording during each pipeline inspection. The pipe shall be cleaned prior to the CCTV
inspection to ensure all defects, features and observations are seen and logged.
9. Just prior to beginning the CCTV inspection, while the CCTV camera is in place and recording,
water (containing dye) shall be introduced into the upstream manhole of each pipe segment
until it is observed and recorded flowing past the camera’s field of vision in its entirety.
10. The CCTV camera shall have a water-level measuring device (ball, cylinder, etc.) attached that
has ¼” markings to show the depth of water in the pipe during the CCTV inspection.
11. All manholes shall be channeled and coated prior to CCTV inspection.
12. Per City of Renton specification 7-08.3(2)B, sewer and storm drain pipeline shall have no more
than ½” of ponding to be considered acceptable.
7-18 SIDE SEWERS
7-18.1 Description
Section 7-18.1 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Further, this work shall consist of identifying potential vertical conflicts between existing sanitary side
sewers and new water mains and/or storm sewer pipes and resolving the conflicts to obtain 18-inch
minimum vertical separation between existing side sewer and new utility.
7-18.2 Materials
Section 7-18.2 is replaced with the following:
(******)
Sanitary sewer pipe shall be polyvinyl chloride (PVC) rubber gasketed ASTM D 3034, SDR 35, or ductile
iron class 50, unless otherwise approved by the City. Fittings and connections shall be per City of
Renton Standard plan 406.1.
160
7-18.3 Construction Requirements
7-18.3(6) Side Sewer Replacement
Section 7-18.3(6) is an added new section:
(******)
Potholing
Side sewers shown on the plans are based upon best available record information and the Contractor
shall pothole all side sewers per the plans prior to preparing side sewer submittals. Potholing shall be
completed per 1-07. Compare pothole data against the new watermain or storm sewer profile to
determine if and where side sewer replacement is required.
Contractor Submittals
Submit all procedures or material descriptions requiring the Engineer’s approval not less than 15
calendar days prior to commencing side sewer replacement activities at the Site. Include shop
drawings for side sewer pipe, fittings, cleanouts, adapters, castings, couplings, method of connection
to the main, information on the CCTV and locating equipment, sample CCTV inspection report and
sample public notice with Submittal.
Following side sewer connection and inspection work submit videotapes, inspection reports, and
record drawing sketches of the side sewer replacement and inspection. Submit inspection information
on a color, digital DVD with on-screen footage counter and site address of each side sewer together
with a written CCTV inspection report. Re-inspect the side sewer, at no expense to the Owner, if video
quality is not acceptable as determined by the Engineer. Reset the on-screen footage counter to zero
at the beginning of each side sewer inspection.
Construction
Existing side sewers identified for removal shall be cleanly cut or removed at the nearest joint and the
pipe removed for disposal. Construct side sewer per City of Renton standard details 406 & 407. The
final location of replaced side sewer shall clear the new water main by at least 18 inches. If the side
sewer replacement limits cause removal of the existing cleanout, then the Contractor must remove
and reinstall a cleanout per City standards.
CCTV
Identify location of the side sewer pipe by using a suitable sonde transmitter attached to the camera.
Provide temporary markers positioned on the ground surface and to measure accurately from to
create a record drawing sketch and a photograph.
Provide CCTV equipment approved by the Engineer before inspection begins. Provide CCTV
equipment with the following minimum criteria:
a. Self-contained color television cameras with footage counter, color monitor, three-wire
coaxial cable, power sources, and other equipment.
b. Waterproof camera having a minimum 650 line resolution capable of inspecting side sewers
3-inches to 6-inches in diameter and up to 200 feet in length.
c. Operate in 100% humidity.
d. Camera lighting that minimizes relative glare.
161
e. Picture quality providing a clear, in-focus color picture of the entire pipeline periphery for all
work conditions.
f. Equipped with a centering device to ensure view of full pipe diameter.
g. Capable of traveling upstream or downstream at a steady uniform rate, stopping where
necessary to ensure a proper assessment of pipe defects, blockages, direction changes,
material changes, and branch connections.
If the camera fails to pass through the side sewer within City right-of-way, temporarily suspend
inspection and notify the Engineer of the obstruction. The Engineer may direct the Contractor on
further actions.
Record Drawing Sketch
Prepare record drawing sketch for each side sewer connection and inspection using a City-furnished
aerial photograph as a base plan, indicating the location, extent, depth and materials associated with
the side sewer connection and the alignment, connections and defects encountered during CCTV
inspection of the existing side sewer. Where necessary for clarity, take photographs of ground surface
of the site, prepare an 8-1/2 inch x 11-inch print of the photo and mark locations of pipe, bends,
fittings and defects.
In addition, inspect and document field observations associated with each side sewer pipe including,
but not limited to, existing pipe material, pipe diameter, joint type, joint integrity, extent of pipe
deterioration, grade and alignment, bedding and backfill, root intrusion, and debris accumulation.
162
DIVISION 8 MISCELLANEOUS CONSTRUCTION
8-01 EROSION CONTROL AND WATER POLLUTION CONTROL
8-01.1 Description
Section 8-01.1 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
This Work shall consist of the Contractor implementing the Contracting Agency-provided Stormwater
Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) to complete the project’s National Pollutant Discharge Elimination
System (NPDES) permit. The Contractor shall be required to follow and implement the SWPPP.
The Work includes, but is not limited to weekly reporting to Department of Ecology on behalf of the
Contracting Agency.
8-01.3 Construction Requirements
8-01.3(1) General
Section 8-01.3(1) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall be responsible for all Work required for compliance with the Construction
Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP) including applying for coverage, transfer of coverage, closing of
coverage and/or annual permit fees.
8-01.3(1)F Stormwater Sampling
Section 8-01 .3(1)F is a new section as follows:
(******)
Stormwater sampling shall be performed by the Contractor or authorized representative at the
frequencies required in the Construction Stormwater General Permit (weekly at minimum). Samples
shall be analyzed for turbidity and pH in accordance with the Construction Stormwater General
Permit.
Sampling shall be conducted in accordance with the EPA 180.1 analytical method and the Washington
State Department of Ecology's How to do Stormwater Monitoring: A guide for construction sites,
available online at http://www.ecy.wa.gov/pubs/0610020.pdf. Samples shall be taken at the point of
discharge from the site. Reports of the sampling results shall be recorded in the project SWPPP and
shall be submitted monthly to the Contracting Agency and the Washington State Department of
Ecology. The DMR forms are mailed to permittees when permit coverage is granted for the project. If
there are no discharges during the month, the Contractor is still required to submit a form stating "no
discharge". The sampling results shall be submitted via mail to:
Department of Ecology
Water Quality Program - Construction Stormwater
PO Box 47696
Olympia, Washington 98504-7696
163
Ecology must receive DMR's within 15 days after the end of each month. If the permittee monitors
more frequently than required by the permit, these results also need to be submitted in the DMR.
Corrective measures shall be taken if benchmark values are exceeded.
The key benchmark turbidity value is 25 nephelometric turbidity units (NTU) for the downstream
receiving water body. If the 25 NTU benchmark is exceeded in any sample collected from the discharge
point, the following steps will be conducted:
a. Ensure all BMPs specified in this SWPPP are installed and functioning as intended.
b. Assess whether additional BMPs should be implemented, and document modified BMPs in
the SWPPP as necessary.
c. Sample discharge daily until the discharge is 25 NTU or lower.
If the turbidity exceeds 250 NTU at any time, the following steps will be conducted:
a. Notify Ecology by phone within 24 hours of analysis.
b. Continue sampling daily until the discharge is 25 NTU or lower Initiate additional treatment
BMPs such as off-site treatment, infiltration, filtration and chemical treatment within 24
hours, and implement those additional treatment BMPs as soon as possible, but within a
minimum of 7 days.
1. Describe inspection results and remedial actions taken in the site log book and in monthly
discharge monitoring reports.
Sampling and monitoring for pH will occur during the phase of construction when concrete pouring
will be conducted until fully cured (3 weeks from pour). Samples will be collected weekly at all
discharge points prior to discharge to surface water. Samples will be analyzed for pH using a calibrated
pH meter and recorded in the site log book.
The key benchmark pH value for stormwater is a maximum of 8.0. If a pH greater than 8.0 is measured
at a discharge point that has the potential to discharge to surface water, the following steps will be
conducted:
a. Assess whether additional BMPs should be implemented and whether associated revisions to
the SWPPP are necessary.
b. Stop (detain) all discharges from leaving the site and entering surface waters or storm drains
if the pH is greater than 8.5.
c. Sample sedimentation pond the following day, and if the pH exceeds 8.0 for the second
consecutive day, implement C02 sparging treatment.
d. Sample and measure pH daily until there are 3 consecutive pH measurements less than 8.0.
e. If there are 3 consecutive pH measurements greater than 8.0, notify the Washington
Department of Ecology by phone within 24 hours of the 3rd measurement exceeding a pH of
8.0 and initiate discussions with Ecology regarding additional treatment BMPs.
f. Describe inspection results and remedial actions that are taken in the site log book and in
monthly Discharge Monitoring Reports.
164
8-01.3(8) Street Cleaning
Section 8-01.3(8) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall be responsible for controlling dust and mud within the project. The Contractor
shall be prepared to use watering trucks equipped with high-velocity water jets and low-head
sprinkling devices, power sweepers, and any other pieces of equipment necessary to avoid creating a
nuisance. All streets used by the Contractor during the execution of the work under this contract shall
be maintained in a clean condition. Any damage caused by dust and/or mud shall be the sole
responsibility of the Contractor. In no case shall sediment-laden water be allowed to enter drainage
facilities without prior filtration or sedimentation.
The roadways shall be swept daily and as needed, and kept in a clean condition.
All costs associated with Street Cleaning and Sweeping shall be incidental to the various bid items.
8-01.3(9)D Inlet Protection
Section 8-01.3(9)D is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Inlet protection can be in the form of internal devices and shall be installed prior to clearing, grubbing,
or earthwork activities. Catch Basin Inserts shall be installed on all new Catch Basins that are
constructed as part of this contract.
When the depth of accumulated sediment and debris reaches approximately one-half the height of
an internal device or one-third the height of the external device (or less if so specified by the
manufacturers), the deposits shall be removed and stabilized on site.
Catch basin inserts shall be installed at all catch basins within project limits and those immediately
downstream of the project site that could possibly receive sediment laden runoff from the site. They
shall be installed and meet the requirement of the detail in the Plans. Simply placing a piece of
geotextile under the catch basin grate is not acceptable.
Catch basin inserts shall be installed, maintained, inspected, and removed by the Contractor per the
Standard Specifications and as recommended by the manufacturer.
Inlet protection devices shall be regularly cleaned at the discretion of the Engineer. The cost of this
cleaning is incidental to other items of Work.
8-01.3(16) Removal
The first paragraph of Section 8-01.3(16) is revised to read:
(******)
The Contractor shall remove all temporary BMP’s and all associated hardware from the project limits
prior to Physical Completion unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Physical Completion is at the
sole discretion of the Engineer and will require the following:
1. All other Work required for Contract Completion has been completed.
2. All Work required for compliance with the CSWGP has been completed to the maximum
extent possible. This includes removal of BMPs that are no longer needed and the site has
165
undergone all stabilization identified for meeting the requirements of Final Stabilization in the
CSWGP.
3. An Equitable Adjustment change order for the cost of Work that has not been completed by
the Contractor.
8-01.3(17) Protection of Existing Trees and Shrubs
Add New Section 8-01.3(17) as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall carefully protect existing trees and shrubs not specifically protected with high
visibility fence during the course of construction against cutting, breaking or skinning of roots, skinning
or bruising of bark. The Contractor shall plan all operations so as to avoid creating situations in which
trees and shrubs may be damaged. Notify the Engineer if construction may damage trees and shrubs.
The Contractor shall not proceed with Work until directed by the Engineer.
Root Protection
Cut exposed roots clearly and keep moist with straw mulch and burlap or equivalent during the time
trenches are open. Hand dig trenches in areas with extensive roots. Roots larger than 3" in diameter
shall be left intact and the Engineer notified for instructions on how to proceed.
Damages for Loss or Injury to Existing Trees and Shrubs to Remain
The Contractor shall be liable for damage to trees and shrubs. In the event of injuries to the crown,
trunk or root system of existing trees and shrubs resulting from the Contractor's failure to protect
them (the just value of which is determined by the Valuation of Landscape Trees, Shrubs, and Other
Plants, (Current Edition) damages shall be deducted from the total amount due the Contractor.
8-02 ROADSIDE RESTORATION
8-02.2 Materials
Section 8-02.2 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Topsoil Type A 9-14.2(1)
Seed 9-14.3
8-02.3(1) Responsibility During Construction
Section 8-02.3(1) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Dumping or stockpiling of topsoil shall not be allowed on roadway surfaces.
The Contractor shall locate all underground utilities (both new and existing) prior to starting work and
shall not disturb or damage them. Promptly notify the Engineer of any conflict between the proposed
work and any obstructions. The Contractor shall be responsible for making any and all repairs for
damage caused by his or her activities.
166
8-02.3(2)A Roadside Work Plan
Section 8-02.3(2)A is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall submit to the Contracting Agency a Roadside Work Plan meeting the
requirements of the Standard Specifications a minimum of 30 calendar days prior to commencing the
installation of topsoil and / or landscape materials.
8-02.3(4)A Topsoil Type A
Section 8-02.3(4)A is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The contractor shall provide a material submittal for topsoil prior to use.
Topsoil Type A shall conform to Section 9-14.2(1) of these Special Provisions and shall be supplied by
a Contractor's supplied source, and as approved by the Engineer.
8-02.3(10) Lawn Installation
8-02.3(10)C Lawn Establishment
Section 8-02.3(10)C has been deleted and superseded with the following:
(******)
8-02.3(10)C1 Lawn Establishment and Final Acceptance
The Contractor shall maintain all new lawn areas in this project; shall be responsible for the survival
of turf in acceptable condition and shall maintain all new lawn areas in a neat and orderly fashion until
Final Acceptance of the project by the City. The period for Final Acceptance shall be no sooner than
the second mowing. The Contractor will be held responsible for all damage or loss caused by his
inattention or carelessness. The Contractor shall repair damage caused by traffic, vandalism, weather
or other outside causes.
8-02.3(10)C2 Establishment Period
The Establishment Period will commence on the date of Preliminary Acceptance and will extend to
Substantial Completion or Final Acceptance by the City of landscape work, whichever is later.
Maintenance during this period will include:
1. Watering: Water areas of new turf so they receive adequate water for survival of the plant in
a healthy position.
2. Lawns shall be fertilized every six weeks from March through September per Grower’s written
recommendations. Lawns shall be maintained weed-free.
3. Lawns are to be mowed weekly or as needed to maintain a neat appearance. All grass
clippings shall be removed from the site. Maximum height of lawn shall not exceed three
inches.
4. Protect all lawn areas against damage, including erosion and trespassing, by providing and
maintaining proper safeguards.
5. Debris Control: Debris control shall be accomplished in all landscaped lawn areas on a regular
basis, at least weekly or more often where necessary. This will include leaf fall control in Fall
167
period. Policing for paper and litter in all areas shall be conducted at least weekly. During the
Fall period leaves, windblown into gutters and catch basins, are considered as litter and shall
be removed as debris.
8-02.3(10)C3 Guarantee
All new turf areas shall be guaranteed by the Contractor to be in a healthy condition for a period of
one year from the date of Final Acceptance.
8-02.3(10)C4 Final Acceptance
Acceptance of lawn planting as specified shall be based on a uniform stand of grass and a uniform
grade at the time of final inspection.
Final inspection of the work of the Section will be made at the time of the Final Inspection of the entire
project or earlier, if approved by the Engineer. A final punch list will be issued. Final Acceptance of the
new turf areas which are the responsibility of the Contractor will be contingent upon Final Acceptance
of the entire project or at the determination of the City if earlier than Final Acceptance of the entire
project.
8-02.3(17) Protection of Private Property and Property Restoration
Add the following new section:
(******)
Property restoration shall consist of placement of additional plant materials, sod, seed and bark
mulch, and other work not currently identified on the plans, as directed by the Engineer.
All materials shall conform to Sections 9-14 Erosion Control and Roadside Planting and 9-15 Irrigation
System of the Standard Specifications.
The Contractor is specifically reminded that any unnecessary damage caused by construction activities
will be repaired at the Contractor’s expense.
Restore all disturbed areas to original condition or better. Grass areas shall be restored with
hydroseed where directed.
Topsoil shall be Type A and Bark Mulch shall be medium grade fir or hemlock.
The lump sum bid item provided for property restoration also includes any adjustments and/or
replacements of existing irrigation systems. This work shall also consist of modifying existing
landscape lighting systems as may become necessary by these improvements.
The Contractor is advised that protecting existing private irrigation and lighting systems from damage
does not constitute a basis for claim or extra work.
8-04 CURBS, GUTTERS, AND SPILLWAYS
8-04.1 Description
Section 8-04.1 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
This work shall also consist of constructing cement concrete curbs with the sidewalk in accordance
with these Specifications and in conformity with the dimensions and cross-sections shown in the Plans
and to the lines and grades as staked.
168
8-04.3 Construction Requirements
Section 8-04.3 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The sub-base for curb and gutter sections shall be compacted to 95 percent density at or below
optimum moisture content, as per Section 2-03.3(14)D revised, before placing the curb and gutter.
White-pigmented curing compounds will not be allowed.
The top of the finished concrete shall not deviate more than one-eighth (1/8”) in ten feet (10’) or the
alignment one-fourth (1/4”) in ten feet (10’).
Where shown on the plans, the Contractor shall paint the curbs with 2-coats of yellow paint. Paint
and application shall conform to the Standard Specifications for traffic paint striping.
8-04.3(3) Painting of Curbs
Section 8-04.3(3), with title change, is supplemented with the following:
(******)
When shown on the plans, concrete curbing shall be painted with two full coats of Paint formula No.
H-2-83 or H-3-83 as shown on the plans or directed by the Engineer. The paint can be applied by brush
or spray.
8-06 CEMENT CONCRETE DRIVEWAY ENTRANCES
8-06.1 Description
Section 8-06.1 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Concrete approaches for driveways as well as curb within and adjacent to driveway approaches shall
be constructed with 3-day portland cement concrete per Sections 8-06.3 and 9-01.2(1) Portland
Cement of the Standard Specifications. Approaches shall be constructed per the details on the Plans.
Approach locations and width are shown on the Plans. This includes all concrete for cement concrete
driveways as shown on the Plans.
If curb sections are poured monolithic with driveway approaches, these sections of curb shall be paid
per square yard under the unit contract price for “Cement Concrete Driveway Entrance”. Otherwise
they shall be paid for by the linear foot of Cement Concrete Curb & Gutter. See also Section 8-04
Curbs, Gutters, Spillways and Inlets herein.
Concrete approaches, driveways and adjoining sections of curb, gutter and sidewalk shall be
constructed in two or more segments to allow continued driveway access unless alternate access can
be provided and clearly delineate.
8-06.2 Materials
Section 8-06.2 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Commercial concrete for driveways & driveway entrances gutter will not be allowed.
169
8-06.3 Construction Requirements
Section 8-06.3 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Section 1-07 of these Special Provisions describes the restrictions to driveway closures and
construction that will be in place for this contract. To meet these requirements, the Contractor may
use a quick setting concrete. The Engineer shall approve the quick-setting mix prior to use.
8-13 MONUMENT CASES
8-13.1 Description
Section 8-13.1 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
This Work shall consist of adjusting and/or furnishing and placing monument cases and covers, in
accordance with the Standard Plans and these Specifications, in conformity with the lines and
locations shown in the Plans or as staked by the Engineer or by the Contractor supplied Surveyor.
8-13.3 Construction Requirements
Paragraph 4 of Section 8-13.3 is revised and supplemented as follows:
(******)
The monument will be furnished and set by the Contractor supplied Surveyor.
When existing monuments will be impacted by a project, the Contractor shall be responsible for
assuring that a registered surveyor references the existing monuments prior to construction. After
construction is complete, the monuments shall be re-established by the Surveyor in accordance with
RCW58.09.130. All surveying shall be in accordance with Section 1-11 of these Special Provisions.
Section 8-13.3 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Where shown in the Plans or where directed by the Engineer, the existing monument case and cover
shall be adjusted to the grade as staked or otherwise designated by the Engineer. The existing
monument shall be carefully protected so as not to disturb its location in any way. The Contractor
shall have a licensed professional land surveyor locate the monument in accordance with Section
1-11.1 prior to the case and cover adjustment if any disturbance of the existing monument is probable.
The existing cast iron ring and cover shall first be removed and thoroughly cleaned for reinstalling at
the new elevation. From that point, the existing structure shall be raised or lowered to the required
elevation. The materials and method of construction shall conform to the requirements of the
Standard Plan as approved by the Engineer.
Reestablishment of Disturbed Monument
The Professional Land Surveyor who has been engaged by the Contractor for the purposes of roadway
surveying shall be responsible for perpetuating and documenting existing monuments in compliance
with the Application for Permit to Destroy a Survey Monument (WAC 332-120). Upon completion of
the roadway surface, the destroyed and new proposed monuments positions shall be set and
referenced by the Contractor. The Contractor shall then drill and core out the monument position,
install the poured monument, and place a blank brass monument centered in the cored position. The
170
Contractor will then mark the referenced position and file a completion report for Monument
Removal or Destruction with DNR, as applicable for pre-existing monuments. Following approval by
the Public Land Survey Offices, copies of the Application for Permit shall be forwarded to the
Contracting Agency.
All surveying shall be in accordance with Section 1-11 of these Special Provisions.
8-14 CEMENT CONCRETE SIDEWALKS
8-14.2 Materials
Section 8-14.2 is supplemented by adding the following:
(******)
The Contractor shall use one of the detectable warning surface products listed in the WSDOT Qualified
Products. The detectable warning surface shall have the truncated dome shape shown in WSDOT
Standard Plan F-45.10. The detectable warning shall be dark red/colonial red and shall match SAE AMS
Standard 595, color number 20109.
8-14.3 Construction Requirements
Supplement this Section as follows:
(******)
The Contractor shall request a pre-meeting with the Engineer to be held 2 to 5 working days before
any work can start on cement concrete sidewalks, curb ramps or other pedestrian access routes to
discuss construction requirements. Those attending shall include:
1. The Prime Contractor and Subcontractor in charge of constructing forms, and placing, and
finishing the cement concrete.
2. Engineer (or representative) and Project Inspectors for the cement concrete sidewalk, curb
ramp or pedestrian access route Work.
Items to be discussed in this meeting shall include, at a minimum, the following:
1. Slopes shown on the Plans.
3. Inspection.
4. Traffic control.
5. Pedestrian control, access routes and delineation.
6. Accommodating utilities.
7. Form work.
8. Installation of detectable warning surfaces.
171
8-14.3(4) Curing
Section 8-14.3(4) is replaced with:
(******)
The curing materials and procedures outlined in Section 5-05.3(13) of the Standard Specifications shall
prevail, except that white pigmented curing compound shall not be used on sidewalks. The curing
agent shall be applied immediately after brushing and be maintained for a period of 5 days.
The Contractor shall have readily available sufficient protective covering, such as waterproof paper or
plastic membrane, to cover the pour of an entire day in the event of rain or other unsuitable weather.
During the curing period, all traffic, both pedestrian and vehicular, shall be excluded. Vehicular traffic
shall be excluded for such additional time as the Engineer may specify.
The Contractor shall be responsible for barricading, patrolling, or otherwise protecting the newly
placed concrete to prevent damage. Damaged, vandalized, discolored, stained, or unsightly concrete
shall be removed and replaced at the expense of the Contractor.
8-14.3(6) Curb Ramps
Section 8-14.3(6) is a new sub-section:
(******)
Some of the curb ramps on this project have been modified from the standard details to fit the project
conditions while meeting current ADA requirements. Contractor shall take special care to assure that
the ramps are constructed in conformance with ADA requirements. The following requirements shall
apply to all curb ramps:
1. Detectable Warning Surface shall be placed on the bottom two feet of the ramp.
2. The landing length shall be a minimum of 48-inches.
3. The cross slope of the landing or ramp shall not be steeper than 2%.
4. The longitudinal slope (up or down the ramp) of the ramp shall not exceed 8%.
5. The Flare Side Slopes shall not exceed 10%.
Compliance with ADA Standards is required and minor modifications to the dimensions shown on the
Plans may be necessary to meet current standards. Therefore, prior to pouring concrete at the curb
ramp locations, the Contractor shall have each ramp inspected and receive written approval from the
on-site inspector that the forms are set in compliance with ADA Standards. Ramps poured without
written approval that do not meet current ADA standards shall be removed and replaced at the
Contractors expense, regardless of whether or not they conform to the dimensions shown on the
Plans.
Per the Standard Specifications, detectable warning surfaces shall be furnished and installed on each
curb ramp.
Pedestrian curbs shall be placed where shown on the Plans and necessary to transition from lowered
grade at depressed concrete ramps to the adjacent finished grade.
Contractor shall set all concrete forms, check for ADA Compliance and then obtain written approval
from the Engineer for each curb ramp prior to placement of concrete.
172
8-14.3(7) Cold Weather Work
Section 8-14.3(6) is a new sub-section:
(******)
The following additional requirements for placing concrete shall be in effect from November 1 to April
1:
• The Engineer shall be notified at least 24 hours prior to placement of concrete.
• All concrete placement shall be completed no later than 2:00 p.m. each day.
Where forms have been placed and the subgrade has been subjected to frost, no concrete shall be
placed until the ground is completely thawed. At the time, the forms shall be adjusted and subgrade
repaired as determined by the Engineer.
8-18 MAILBOX SUPPORT
8-18.3 Construction Requirements
Supplement this Section with the following:
(******)
Permanently reinstalled mailboxes shall be installed with new hardware and posts in conformance
with City of Renton standard details H027, H028, and H029.
All relocated mailbox supports shall be installed with the new wood posts. Post foundations shall be
commercial concrete.
Mailbox assemblies damaged during construction activities shall be replaced in kind by the Contractor.
All costs associated with damaged mailbox replacement shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
8-19 ADJUST UTILITY APPURTENANCES
Section 8-19 is a new section with new sub-sections:
(******)
8-19.1 Description
This work shall consist of adjusting gas valves and utility vaults to grade.
8-19.3 Construction Requirements
8-19.3(1) Valve Boxes
Gas valve boxes shall be adjusted to final grade after final grading has been established or the asphalt
concrete paving operations are complete. The Contractor shall adjust the valve boxes with cast iron
extensions as required.
The asphalt concrete pavement shall be removed to a neat circular shape. The edge of the cut shall
be 1 foot from the outside edge of the valve box frame. The base materials and crushed rock shall be
removed. The valve box frame shall be reset to the final grade, plumb to the roadway, and remain
operational and accessible. Commercial class concrete shall be placed in the entire void up to within,
but not to exceed, 2 inches of the finished pavement surface.
173
Twenty-four hours after placement of the concrete, or as directed by the Engineer, the edges of the
removed asphalt pavement, the concrete surface, and the outer edge of the reset frame shall be
painted with asphalt for tack coat. Hot mix asphalt shall then be placed and properly compacted to
finished grade. The hot mix asphalt shall meet the requirements of Section 5-04 of the Standard
Specifications. The joint between the patch and existing pavement shall then be painted with asphalt
for tack coat and immediately covered with dry paving sand before the asphalt for tack coat solidifies.
8-22 PAVEMENT MARKING
8-22.1 Description
This Section is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Pavement markings shall conform to Section 8-22 of the Standard Specifications, the latest edition
and amendments thereto of the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (MUTCD) as adopted by
the State of Washington, and City of Renton Standard Plans 109 and 128, and shall be constructed as
shown in the Plans except as modified herein.
The Contractor shall be responsible for all traffic control required to place and protect pavement
marking material, as outlined in Sections 1-07.23 and 1-10 of the Standard Specifications and these
Special Provisions.
8-22.2 Materials
This Section is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Plastic pavement marking materials shall be Type A – liquid hot applied thermoplastic unless indicated
otherwise in the Contract Documents.
Patents
The Contractor shall assume all costs arising from the use of patented materials, equipment, devices,
or processes used on or incorporated in the work, and agrees to indemnify and save harmless the
Contracting Agency and its duly authorized representatives from all suits of law or action of every
nature for, or on account of, the use of any patented materials, equipment, device, or processes.
Acceptance
The Contractor shall be responsible for supplying material that meets aforestated material and testing
requirements. The Contractor shall supply certification that the pavement marking material meets
the above specifications.
8-22.3 Construction Requirements
This Section is supplemented with the following:
(******)
In addition to the requirements of Sections 8-22.3(2) and 8-22.3(3), the application and surface
preparation shall conform to the manufacturer's recommendations.
174
In all cases, the product manufacturer’s recommended application procedures shall be adhered to.
When no such procedures have been published, workmanship shall be governed by these Special
Provisions and the Standard Specifications.
After cleaning of areas to receive pavement markings, the areas shall pass inspection of the Engineer
prior to application of the material or the primer coat.
Reflectorized beading as stated in Section 8-22.3(3) of the Standard Specifications shall be provided
with all pavement markings.
8-22.3(6) Removing Pavement Markings
Section 8-22.3(6) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Existing pavement markings within the construction limits, including stop bars, traffic arrows, lane
markers, and raised pavement markers shall be removed prior to overlaying the roadway surface.
All conflicting channelization shall be removed as necessary by sand blasting to install temporary
pavement markings or after the final channelization has been installed.
Removal of existing pavement markings shall be conducted using such methods to prevent damage
to the remaining pavement. The use of chemicals that may be harmful to the pavement will not be
allowed. Damaged pavement shall be replaced at the Contractor's expense.
8-23 TEMPORARY PAVEMENT MARKINGS
8-23.5 Payment
Section 8-23.5 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
If no pay item is included in the Contract for installation, or for removal of temporary pavement
markings, then all costs associated with these items are considered incidental to other items in the
Contract or included under "Project Temporary Traffic Control," if that item is included as a bid item.
175
DIVISION 9 MATERIALS
9-03 AGGREGATES
9-03.8(7) HMA Tolerances and Adjustments
Item 1 is deleted and replaced with:
(******)
1. Job Mix Formula Tolerances. After the JMF is determined as required in 5-04.3(7)A, the
constituents of the mixture at the time of acceptance shall conform to the following tolerances:
Nonstatistical Commercial
Evaluation Evaluation
Aggregate, percent passing
1”, ¾”, ½”, and 3/8” sieves ±6% ±8%
U.S. No. 4 sieve ±6% ±8%
U.S. No. 8 sieve ±6% ±8%
U.S. No. 16 sieve ±4% ±6%
U.S. No. 30 sieve ±4% ±6%
U.S. No. 50 sieve ±4% ±6%
U.S. No. 100 sieve ±3% ±5%
U.S. No. 200 sieve ±2.0% ±3.0%
Asphalt Binder ±0.5% ±0.7%
VMA 1.5% below minimum value in 9-03.8(2)
VFA minimum and maximum as listed in 9-03.8(2)
Va 2.5% minimum and 5.5% maximum
These tolerance limits constitute the allowable limits as described in Section 1-06.2. The tolerance
limit for aggregate shall not exceed the limits of the control point’s section, except the tolerance limits
for sieves designated as 100% passing will be 99-100.
9-03.12 Gravel Backfill
Section 9-03.12(6) is a new additional section:
(******)
9-03.12(6) Underdrain Aggregate
Underdrain Aggregate shall conform to the following grading:
Sieve Size Percent Passing
¾-inch 100
¼-inch 30-60
No. 8 20-50
No. 50 3-12
No. 200 0-1
176
Underdrain aggregate shall consist of screened sand, gravel or other inert materials, or combinations
thereof, from sources approved by the engineer, having hard, durable particles free from adherent
coatings. The materials must be washed thoroughly to remove clay, loam, alkali, organic matter or
other deleterious substances. Particles having a specific gravity less than 1.95 must not exceed 1.0
percent of the total weight. Organic matter, by calorimetric test, must not be darker than the
reference standard color (Organic Plate No. 3) AASHTO T21 unless other tests prove a darker color to
be harmless.
9-05 DRAINAGE STRUCTURES, CULVERTS, AND CONDUITS
9-05.2 Underdrain Pipe
9-05.2(9) Slotted PVC Underdrain Pipe
Section 9-05.2(9) is a new additional section:
(******)
Slotted PVC underdrain pipe shall be per ASTM D1785 Sch. 40. Slots shall be cut perpendicular to the
long axis of the pipe and be 0.04 to 0.069 inches wide by 1 inch long and be spaced 0.25 inches apart
(spaced longitudinally). Slots should be arranged in four rows spaced on 45-degree centers and cover
one-half of the circumference of the pipe.
9-05.4 Steel Culvert Pipe and Pipe Arch (RC)
Section 9-05.4 is revised as follows:
(******)
Steel culvert pipe and pipe arch shall meet the requirements of AASHTO M 36, Type I and Type II.
Welded seam aluminum coated (aluminized) corrugated steel pipe and pipe arch with metallized
coating applied inside and out following welding is acceptable and shall be asphalt treatment coated.
9-05.7(2) Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe
9-05.7(2) Reinforced Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe (RC)
Section 9-05.7(2) is replaced by the following:
(******)
Reinforced Concrete Storm Sewer pipe shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C-76 and shall be
Class IV. Cement used in the manufacture of reinforced concrete pipe shall be Type II in conformance
with ASTM C150. No admixture shall be used unless otherwise specified.
9-05.7(2)A Basis for Acceptance (RC)
Section 9-05.7(2)A is supplemented by the following:
(******)
All pipe shall be subject to (1) a three-edge-bearing strength (D-load) test in accordance with ASTM
C76; and (2) a hydrostatic test of rubber gasket joints in accordance with ASTM C361 or AWWA C302
except test pressure shall be 5 psi.
177
9-05.7(3) Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe Joints (RC)
Section 9-05.7(3) is replaced by the following:
(******)
Joint assembly design shall be reinforced concrete bell and spigot type incorporating a fully retained
single rubber gasket in accordance with ASTM C361 or AWWA C302. Rubber gasket material shall be
neoprene.
9-05.7(4) Testing Concrete Storm Sewer Pipe Joints (RC)
Section 9-05.7(4) is supplemented by the following:
(******)
Hydrostatic testing of rubber gasket joints shall be performed in accordance with ASTM C361 or
AWWA C302 except test pressure shall be 5 psi.
9-05.9 Steel Spiral Rib Storm Sewer Pipe (RC)
Section 9-05.9 is replaced with:
(******)
The manufacturer of spiral rib storm sewer pipe shall furnish the Engineer a Manufacturer's Certificate
of Compliance stating that the materials furnished comply in all respects with these Specifications.
The Engineer may require additional information or tests to be performed by the Contractor at no
expense to the City.
Unless otherwise specified, spiral rib storm sewer pipe shall be furnished with pipe ends cut
perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of the pipe. Pipe ends shall be cut evenly. Spiral rib pipe shall
be fabricated either by using a continuous helical lock seam or a continuous helical welded seam
paralleling the rib.
Steel spiral rib storm sewer pipe shall be manufactured of metallic coated (aluminized or galvanized)
corrugated steel and inspected in conformance with Section 9-05.4. The size, coating, and metal shall
be as shown in the Plans or in the Specifications.
For spiral rib storm sewer pipe, helical ribs shall project outwardly from the smooth pipe wall and shall
be fabricated from a single thickness of material. The ribs shall be essentially rectangular and shall be
3/4 inch plus two times the wall thickness (2t) plus or minus 1/8 inch (measured outside to outside)
and a minimum of 0.95 inch high (measured as the minimum vertical distance from the outside of
pipe wall immediately adjacent to the lockseam or stiffener to the top surface of rib). The maximum
spacing of the ribs shall be 11.75 inches center to center (measured normal to the direction of the
ribs). The radius of bend of the metal at the corners of the ribs shall be a minimum of 0.10 inch and a
maximum of 0.17 inch. If the sheet between adjacent ribs does not contain a lockseam, a stiffener
shall be included midway between ribs, having a nominal radius of 0.25 inch and a minimum height
of 0.20 inch toward the outside of the pipe. Pipe shall be fabricated with ends that can be effectively
jointed with coupling bands.
When required, spiral rib or narrow pitch spiral rib pipe shall be bituminous treated or paved. The
bituminous treatment for spiral rib pipe shall conform to the requirements of Sections 9-05.4(3) and
9-05.4(4).
178
For narrow pitch spiral rib sewer pipe, the helical ribs shall project outwardly from the smooth pipe
wall and shall be fabricated from a single thickness of material. The ribs shall be .375 inch + 1/8 inch
wide (measured outside to outside) and a minimum of .4375 inch high (measured as the minimum
vertical distance of ribs shall be 4.80 inches center to center (measured normal to the direction of the
ribs). The radius of bend of the metal at the corners of the ribs shall be 0.0625 inch with an allowable
tolerance of + 10 percent.
9-05.12(3) CPEP Sewer Pipe
Section 9-05.12(3) is a new additional section:
(******)
CPEP - Smooth interior pipe and fittings shall be manufactured from high density polyethylene
resin which shall meet or exceed the requirements of Type 111, Category 4 or 5, Grade P33 or
P34, Class C per ASTM D1248. In addition, the pipe shall comply with all material and stiffness
requirements of AASHTO M294.
9-05.14 ABS Composite Sewer Pipe
Section 9-05.14 is deleted.
(******)
9-05.17 Aluminum Spiral Rib Storm Sewer Pipe
Section 9-05.17 is replaced with:
(******)
Unless otherwise specified, spiral rib storm sewer pipe shall be furnished with pipe ends cut
perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of the pipe. Pipe ends shall be cut evenly. Spiral rib pipe shall
be fabricated by using a continuous helical lock seam with a seam gasket.
For spiral rib storm sewer pipe, helical ribs shall project outwardly from the smooth pipe wall and shall
be fabricated from a single thickness of material. The ribs shall be 3/4 inch wide by 3/4 inch deep with
a nominal spacing of 7-1/2 inches center to center. Pipe shall be fabricated with ends that can be
effectively jointed with coupling bands.
For narrow pitch spiral rib storm sewer pipe, helical ribs shall project outwardly from the smooth pipe
wall and shall be fabricated from a single thickness of material. The ribs shall be 0.375 inch + 1/8 inch
wide (measured outside to outside) and a minimum spacing of ribs shall be 4.80 inches center to
center (measured normal to the direction of the ribs). The radius of bend of the metal at the corners
of the ribs shall be 0.0625 inch with an allowable tolerance of + 10 percent.
For wide pitch spiral rib storm sewer pipe, helical ribs shall project outwardly from the smooth pipe
wall and shall be fabricated from a single thickness of material. The ribs shall be 3/4 inch + 1/8 inch
wide (measured outside to outside) and a minimum of 0.95 inch high (measured as the minimum
vertical distance from the outside of pipe wall to top surface of the rib). The maximum spacing of ribs
shall be 11.75 inches center to center (measured normal to the direction of the ribs). The radius of
bend of the metal at the corners of the ribs shall be 0.0625 inch with an allowable tolerance of + 10
percent.
179
9-05.20 Corrugated Polyethylene Storm Sewer Pipe (CPEP)
Section 9-05.20 is replaced with the following:
(******)
9-05.20(1) Description
Corrugated Polyethylene Pipe (CPEP) shall be corrugated high-density polyethylene pipe with smooth
internal wall manufactured by Advanced Drainage Systems (ADS), or approved equivalent.
9-05.20(2) Pipe Material and Fabrication
CPEP shall be in conformance with the latest version of ASTM F 667 or AASHTO M 294, Type S.
9-05.20(3) Fittings and Gaskets
Fittings shall be gasketed PVC fittings. Gaskets shall conform to ASTM F 477. Fittings shall conform to
ASTM F 1536 or ASTM D 3212. Fittings shall be manufactured by Nyloplast USA, Inc., or approved
equivalent.
9-05.20(4) Installation
Pipe and fittings shall be installed per the manufacturer's recommendations. Lubricate gasket and
fitting socket with manufacturer-approved lubricant prior to pushing pipe into fitting.
9-05.23 High Density Polyethylene Piping
Section 9-05.23 is replaced with the following:
(******)
DRISCOPLEX 4100 High-density Polyethylene Piping
1 General Terms and Conditions
1.1 Scope - This Specification covers requirements for DriscoPlex 4100 PE 3408 high-density
polyethylene piping. All Work shall be performed in accordance with these Specifications.
1.2 Engineered and Approved Plans - Construction shall be performed in accordance with Engineered
Construction Plans for the Work prepared under the direction of a Professional Engineer.
1.3 Referenced Standards - Where all or part of a federal, ASTM, ANSI, AWWA, etc., Standard
Specification is incorporated by reference in these Specifications, the reference standard shall be the
latest edition and revision.
1.4 Licenses and Permits – The Contractor shall be licensed and bonded.
1.5 Inspections - All Work shall be inspected by an Authorized Representative of the City who shall
have the authority to halt construction if, in his opinion, these Specifications or standard construction
practices are not being followed. Whenever any portion of these Specifications is violated, the
Engineer shall, by written notice, order further construction to cease until all deficiencies are
corrected.
2 Polyethylene Pipe and Fittings
2.1 Qualifications of Manufacturers - The manufacturer shall have manufacturing and quality
assurance facilities capable of producing and assuring the quality of the pipe and fittings required by
180
these Specifications. The manufacturer’s production facilities shall be open for inspection by the City
or his Authorized Representative. The Engineer shall approve qualified manufacturers.
2.2 Materials - Black PE materials used for the manufacture of polyethylene pipe and fittings shall be
PE 3408 high density polyethylene, meeting ASTM D 3350 cell classification 345464C and shall be
listed in the name of the pipe and fitting manufacturer in PPI (Plastics Pipe Institute) TR-4, with a
standard grade HDB rating of 1600 psi at 73°F. Color material, when used, shall be the same except
for meeting ASTM D 3350 cell classification 345464E. The material shall be listed and approved for
potable water in accordance with NSF Standard 61. When requested on the order, the manufacturer
shall certify that the materials used to manufacture pipe and fittings meet these requirements.
2.3 Interchangeability of Pipe and Fittings - The same qualified and approved manufacturer shall
produce polyethylene pipe and fittings. Products such as fittings or flange adapters made by sub-
contractors or distributors are prohibited.
2.4 Polyethylene Fittings & Custom Fabrications - Polyethylene fittings and custom fabrications shall
be molded or fabricated by the approved pipe manufacturer. All fittings and custom fabrications shall
be pressure rated for the same internal pressure rating as the mating pipe.
2.5 Molded Fittings - Molded fittings shall be manufactured and tested in accordance with ASTM D
3261 and shall be so marked. Molded fittings shall be tested in accordance with AWWA C906.
2.6 Fabricated Fittings - Fabricated fittings shall be made by heat fusion joining specially machined
shapes cut from pipe, polyethylene sheet stock or molded fittings. Fabricated fittings shall be rated
for internal pressure service at least equal to the full service pressure rating of the mating pipe.
Fabricated fittings shall be tested in accordance with AWWA C906.
2.7 Polyethylene Flange Adapters - Flange adapters shall be made with sufficient through-bore length
to be clamped in a butt fusion-joining machine without the use of a stub-end holder. The sealing
surface of the flange adapter shall be machined with a series of small v-shaped grooves (serrations)
to promote gasketless sealing, or restrain the gasket against blowout.
2.8 Back-up Rings & Flange Bolts - Flange adapters shall be fitted with back-up rings that are pressure
rated equal to or greater than the mating pipe. The back-up ring bore shall be chamfered or radiused
to provide clearance to the flange adapter radius. Flange bolts and nuts shall be Grade 3 or higher.
9-05.24 Polypropylene Culvert Pipe, Polypropylene Storm Sewer Pipe, and Polypropylene Sanitary Sewer Pipe
This Sections content is deleted and replaced with the following:
(******)
All joints for polypropylene pipe shall be made with a bell/bell or bell and spigot coupling and shall
conform to ASTM D 3212 using elastomeric gaskets conforming to ASTM F 477. All gaskets shall be
factory installed on the pipe in accordance with the producer’s recommendations.
Qualification for each producer of polypropylene storm sewer pipe requires joint system conformance
to ASTM D 3212 using elastomeric gaskets conforming to ASTM F 477 and a formal quality control
plan for each plant proposed for consideration.
A Manufacturer’s Certificate of Compliance shall be required and shall accompany the materials
delivered to the project. The certificate shall clearly identify production lots for all materials
represented. The Contracting Agency may conduct verification tests of pipe stiffness or other
properties it deems appropriate.
181
This Section is supplemented with the following new sub-sections:
9-05.24(1) Polypropylene Culvert Pipe and Storm Sewer Pipe
Polypropylene culvert and storm sewer pipe shall conform to the following requirements:
1. For dual wall pipe sizes up to 30 inches: ASTM F2736.
2. For triple wall pipe sizes from 30 to 60 inches: ASTM F2764.
3. For dual wall profile pipe sizes 36 to 60 inches: AASHTO MP 21, Type S or Type D.
4. Fittings shall be factory welded, injection molded or PVC.
9-05.24(2) Polypropylene Sanitary Sewer Pipe
1. Polypropylene sanitary sewer pipe shall conform to the following requirements:
2. For pipe sizes up to 30 inches: ASTM F2736.
3. For pipe sizes from 30 to 60 inches: ASTM F2764.
4. Fittings shall conform to ASTM F2764. Bell & spigot connections shall utilize a spun-0n,
welded or integral bell and spigot with gaskets meeting ASTM F477. Fitting joints shall be
watertight joint performance requirements of ASTM D3212.
9-05.52 Dense Foam
Section 9-05.52 is a New Section as follows:
(******)
Dense foam shall be Ethafoam HS 600 high density, polyethylene foam, as manufactured by Dow
Chemical Company, or approved equivalent.
9-08 PAINTS
9-08.9 Manhole Coating System Products
Section 9-08.8 is a new section and subsections:
(******)
9-08.9(1) Coating Systems Specification
A. High Solids Urethane
Coating System: C1
Coating Material: High Solids Urethane
Surfaces: Concrete
Surface Preparation: In accordance with SSPC SP-7 (Sweep or brush off blast)
Application: Shop/Field: The drying time between coats shall not exceed 24 hours in any case System Thickness: 6.0 mils dry film
Coatings: Primer: One coat of Wasser MC-Aroshield high solids urethane (2.0 DFT) Finish: Two or more coats of Wasser MC-Aroshield (min. 4.0 DFT) Color: White
182
9-14 EROSION CONTROL AND ROADSIDE PLANTING
9-14.2 Topsoil
9-14.2(1) Topsoil Type A
Section 9-14.2(1) is supplemented with the following:
(******)
Topsoil Type A shall consist of loose, moderately well-drained, friable soil of sandy loam texture, free
of ice, snow and rubbish with no admixture of refuse or material toxic to plant growth. Soil shall be
reasonably free of stones, lumps, roots, and weeds or similar objects. Topsoil should be fertile and
free-flowing (pulverized). Topsoil shall be Mycorrhizae inoculated.
Topsoil shall meet the following parameters:
Parameter Range
pH 6.7-7.5
Moisture Content 25%-55%
Soluble Salts 2.5 mmhos/(dS)
Coarse Sand 50% max (by weight)
Clay 25% max (by weight)
Silt 15% max (by weight)
Organic matter 10% max (by weight)
9-14.3 Seed
Section 9-14.3 is supplemented with the following:
(******)
The grass seed dealer shall mix the grass seed only. The Contractor shall furnish the Owner’s
Representative with a dealer’s guaranteed statement of the composition, mixture, and the
percentage of purity and germination of each variety.
All seed mixes shall be certified as 99% weed-free and 90% viable seeds by germination tests and by
age specifications by species. Apply hydroseed mulch, tackifier, seed and fertilizer per supplier’s
recommendations.
Seeded Lawn Mix
Seeded Lawn Mix shall be composed of the following varieties mixed in the proportions indicated:
Botanical Name / Common Name % by Weight % Purity % Germination
Lolium perenne var. Dasher 3 /
Dasher 3 Perennial Rye Grass
35% 98% 90%
Lolium perenne var. Cutter II /
Cutter II Perennial Rye Grass
35% 98% 90%
Festuca rubra var. Garnet /
Garnet Creeping Red Fescue
15% 98% 90%
183
Botanical Name / Common Name % by Weight % Purity % Germination
Festuca rubra ssp. Fallax var. Windward /
Windward Chewings Fescue
15% 98% 90%
9-23 CONCRETE CURING MATERIALS AND ADMIXTURES
9-23.9 Fly Ash (RC)
Section 9-23.9 is revised as follows:
(******)
Fly ash shall not be used around water lines.
9-30 WATER DISTRIBUTION MATERIALS
9-30.1 Pipe
Section 9-30.1 is revised as follows:
(******)
All materials for water distribution and transmission shall be new and undamaged. Prior to ordering
any pipe and fittings to be used in a potable water supply, the Contractor shall submit the material
source as required by Section 1-06.1 of the Standard Specifications. All direct and indirect drinking
water system components which come in contact with potable water shall have National Sanitation
Foundation (NSF) certification. All pipe and fittings shall be clearly marked with the manufacturer’s
name, type, class, and thickness as applicable and shall be marked on the component at the place of
manufacture. Marking shall be legible and permanent under normal conditions of handling and
storage.
9-30.1(1) Ductile Iron Pipe
Section 9-30.1(1) is revised to read as follows:
(******)
1. Ductile iron pipe shall be centrifugally cast in 18 or 20 foot nominal lengths and meet the
requirements of AWWA C151. Ductile iron pipe shall have a double thick cement mortar lining
and a 1-mil thick seal coat meeting the requirements of AWWA C104. Ductile iron pipe shall be
minimum Standard Thickness Class 52 or the thickness class as shown in the Plans. Flanged ductile
iron pipe shall be Class 53 per AWWA C115.
2. Non-restrained joint shall be rubber gasket, push-on type joint (Tyton) or mechanical joint (M.J.)
conforming to AWWA C111, unless otherwise specified.
3. Restrained joints shall be as specified in Section 9-30.2(6).
4. Flanged joints shall conform to ANSI B16.1, class 125 drilling pattern, rated for 250 psi working
pressure. Flanged ductile iron pipe shall be Class 53 per AWWA C 115. Thicker Classes are
acceptable.
The Contractor shall furnish certification from the manufacturer of the pipe and gasket being supplied
that the inspection and all of the specified tests have been made and the results thereof comply with
the requirements of the above referenced standards.
184
9-30.1(2) Polyethylene Encasement
Section 9-30.1(2) is revised as follows:
(******)
Polyethylene encasement (plastic film wrap) shall be eight mil polyethylene, tube type conforming to
AWWA C105. All ductile iron pipes, fittings, and valves shall be installed with a polyethylene
encasement, tube-type and in black color.
9-30.2 Fittings
9-30.2(1) Ductile Iron Pipe
Section 9-30.2(1) is revised as follows:
(******)
Fittings for ductile iron pipe shall be ductile iron conforming to AWWA C110, and AWWA C111 or
AWWA C153 and shall be cement-lined conforming to AWWA C104. All water main fittings shall be
ductile iron, short body, cement lined and for pressure rating of 350 psi for mechanical joint fittings
and 250 psi for flange joint fittings, unless otherwise specified. Metal thickness and manufacturing
process shall conform to applicable portions of ANSI/AWWA C110/A21.10. Mechanical joint, ductile
iron, compact fittings 24 inches and less shall conform to ANSI A21.53 (AWWA C153). Flanged fittings,
cast or ductile iron, shall conform to ANSI B16.1, class 125 drilling pattern.
Ductile iron fittings include: tees, crosses, wyes, bends, adapters, sleeves, plugs, caps, offsets,
reducers, and ells.
Rubber gaskets for push-on joints (Tyton) or mechanical joint (M.J.) shall conform to ANSI A21.11 /
AWWA C111. Gasket materials for flange joints shall be SBR, neoprene, Buna N, chlorinated butyl, or
cloth-inserted rubber suitable for pressurized water service purposes. Type of connections shall be
specified as push-on joint (Tyton), mechanical joint (M.J.), plain end (P.E.), flanged (FL), restrained
joint (RJ) and threaded.
Sleeves less than or equal to 12 inches in diameter shall be 12 inches minimum length and shall be
mechanical joint. Sleeves greater than 12 inches in diameter shall be of the long body type and shall
be 15 inches minimum length and shall be mechanical joint.
Where ductile iron pipe is to be joined to existing cast iron pipe of the same nominal size and the
outside diameter of the existing cast iron pipe is 0.05 inches or less from the outside diameter of the
ductile iron pipe being joined, the pipe shall be joined with a mechanical joint sleeve.
Where ductile iron pipe is to be joined to existing cast iron pipe of the same nominal size and the
outside diameter of the existing cast iron pipe conforms to AWWA 1908 classifications A, B, C, D, or
F, the pipe shall be joined with a transition coupling having a single-piece casting. Threaded pipe and
flanges combinations shall not be used.
Bolts and nuts for all fittings and valves with mechanical-joint end(s) shall be Cor-ten (low alloy steel)
conforming to ANSI/AWWA C110/A21.10 or stainless steel. Bolts and nuts for all pipe, fittings, and
valves with flanged end(s) shall be stainless steel and shall conform in size and length with
ANSI/AWWA C111/A21.11. Stainless steel bolts shall meet the requirements of ASTM F593, Group 2.
Shackle rods shall be Cor-ten or stainless steel all thread 316SS. Stainless steel nuts and bolts shall be
type 316SS.
185
Contractor shall provide Manufacturer’s Certificate of Compliance in accordance with Section 1-06.3
Manufacturer’s Certificate of Compliance of the Standards Specifications for all fittings and bolts to
be used.
9-30.2(2) Galvanized Iron Pipe
Section 9-30.2(2) is a new section:
(******)
Where galvanized iron pipe is specified, the pipe shall be standard weight, Schedule 40, steel pipe per
Standard Specifications for black and hot-dipped, zinc coated (galvanized) welded and seamless steel
pipe for ordinary uses (ASTM A-120). Fittings shall be screwed malleable iron galvanized per ANSI
B16.3.
9-30.2(3) Steel Casing Pipe
Section 9-30.2(3) is a new section:
(******)
Steel casing shall be black steel pipe conforming to ASTM A 53. Before installation, coat casing exterior
with shop-applied anticorrosive coating conforming to AWWA C210. Minimum coating thickness shall
be 16 mils dry film thickness (DFT); however, thickness shall not exceed manufacturer’s recommended
thickness. Coating type shall be a polyamide epoxy-coal tar equal to Tnemec Hi-Build Theme-Tar,
Series 46H-413.
Casing wall thickness shall be 0.250 inch for casings 24 inches or less in diameter and 0.375 inch for
casings over 24 inches in diameter.
Carrier pipe for water main shall be Restrained Joint Ductile Iron, Class 52.
9-30.2(4)C Spacers and Seals for Steel Casing Pipe
Section 9-30.2(4)C is a new section:
(******)
Casing spacers shall be “centered positioning” type bands at least 12 inch in width, and shall be either
stainless steel or heavy duty fusion bonded epoxy coated steel. Runners shall be 2-inch wide glass
reinforced plastic securely bonded to the spacer, and shall be aligned on the spacer along the axis of
insertion of the water main into the casing pipe. Runner length shall approximate the width of the
spacer. Securing the spacer to the water main shall be in accordance with the manufacturer’s
instruction. The height of the risers and runners combined shall be sufficient to keep the carrier pipe
bell, couplings or fittings at least 0.75 inch from the casing pipe wall at all times and provide at least
1-inch clearance between the runners and the top of the casing wall, to prevent jamming during
installation.
Acceptable spacers and end seals manufacturers are Pipeline Seal and Insulator model S12G-2 for
stainless steel and model C12G-2, C8G-2 for fusion-bonded and coated steel, Cascade Waterworks
Mfg. Co., Advance Products & Systems, Inc. or approved alternate.
186
9-30.2(6) Restrained-Joint Pipe and Restrained-Joint Fittings
Section 9-30.2(6), with title change, is revised as follows:
(******)
Restrained joints (RJ) for ductile iron pipe, fittings, and valves, where required on the plans, shall be
flexible after assembly and be able to be disassembled. Restrained joints shall meet the following
criteria:
1. The restrained joint shall have a positive metal to metal contact locking system without the
use of gripping teeth. Gaskets for push-on joint pipe with integrally molded steel or metal
teeth or locking segments shall not be allowed as substitutes for restrained-joint pipes.
2. The joint restraint system for the pipe shall be the same as the joint restraint system for the
pipe fittings, except as provided in item 3 below.
3. Where restrained joint fittings required on the plans cannot be furnished or where restrained
jointed fittings are required in areas that are known to be subject to location adjustments,
the Contractor may submit a lay plan showing mechanically jointed fittings with wedge
restraint glands for approval. Mechanically jointed pipe with wedge restraint glands shall not
be substituted for restrained joint pipe.
Wedge Restraint Glands:
Wedge restraint glands shall conform to AWWA C111, ASTM A 536-80 Grade 65-42-12. All bolts and
wedges shall be ductile iron. Wedge shall be heat-treated to a minimum 370 BHN. Wedge restraint
glands shall be rated for 350 psi for pipe 12 inch in diameter and smaller.
9-30.2(7) Bolted, Sleeve-Type Couplings for Plain End Pipe
Section 9-30.2(7) is revised as follows:
(******)
Transition couplings, reducing couplings, transition reducing couplings, sleeves, flexible couplings for
water main shall be compression type by pipe manufacturer: Romac or Ford or approved alternate.
Bolts and nuts shall be high strength, low alloy steel, corrosion resistant per AWWA C111. Stainless
steel bolts require anti-seize compound. Heavy hex nuts shall be used.
The long body pattern with a minimum center ring or center sleeve length of 12-inches for pipe less
than 12 inches in diameter and equal to or greater than the pipe diameter for pipe greater than 12
inches in diameter. Solid sleeves (greater than 12 inch diameter) shall be a 15 inch minimum length.
9-30.3 Valves
Section 9-30.3 is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Valves shall be a standard pattern of a manufacturer whose products are approved by the Engineer
and shall have the name or mark of the manufacturer, year valve casting was made, size and working
pressure plainly cast in raided and legible letters on the valve body. All valves shall be NSF approved
and valve bodies shall be ductile iron. All valves shall be stamped with “NSF APPROVED” and “DI”.
Where a valve is required to operate in a higher pressure environment than the Class of valve specified
in Section 9-30.3, the class of valve shall be as specified in the Contract.
187
All bolts on the body of valves shall be stainless steel.
9-30.3(1) Gate Valves (3 to 16 inches)
Section 9-30.3(1) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
All valve material shall be new and undamaged. Unless otherwise approved by the Engineer, the same
manufacturer of each item shall be used throughout the work.
All gate valves shall be ductile iron body, bronze mounted, resilient seat, non-rising stem, and shall be
equipped with a standard two (2) inch square operating nut and O-ring stem seals. Valves shall open
counterclockwise when viewed from above. Valves shall be designed for a minimum water operating
pressure of 200 psi.
Resilient seated gate valves shall be manufactured to meet or exceed the requirements of AWWA
C509 and C515 latest revisions. All exterior valve body bolting shall be Type 304 stainless steel and
shall be provided with hexagonal heads with dimensions to conform with ANSI B18.2.1.
Valve ends shall be mechanical joints, flanged joints or mechanical by flanged joints as shown on the
project plans. Where restrained joints are called out, valve ends shall be flanged with appropriate
flange by restrained joint adapters.
All gate valves shall include an 8" x 24" cast iron gate valve box and extensions, as required. A valve
stem extension is required where the valve operating nut is more than 3 feet below finished grade.
Valve stem extensions are to be a minimum of 1 foot with only one extension per valve in shall be
installed in accordance to the City of Renton standard plans.
Acceptable gate valves are Clow, M & H/Kennedy, American Flow Control (ACIPCo), Pratt/Mueller, US
Metroseal or approved alternate in sizes 16 inches and less.
Approval of valves other than models specified shall be obtained prior to bid opening.
9-30.3(3) Butterfly Valves
Section 9-30.3(3) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
The valve shall be short-body type and shall have flanged ends. Flanged ends shall be sized and drilled
in conformance with ANSI B16.1 Class 125. Valve shall be suitable for direct bury and shall have a stem
extension with AWWA 2-inch square operating nut and suitable valve box. All butterfly valves bodies
and discs shall be ductile iron.
The butterfly valves shall be manufactured by Henry Pratt Company, Mueller, DeZurick, Mosser Valve
Division of Olsen Technologies, Dresser 450, Pratt Groundhog or approved alternate.
9-30.3(4) Valve Boxes
Section 9-30.3(4) is revised as follows:
(******)
Valve boxes shall be installed on all buried valves. The box and lid shall be cast iron, 2-piece slip type
with cast iron extension as necessary, conforming to the City of Renton latest standard plans. The
cover shall have the word “WATER” cast in it and shall have cast-iron “ears” installed in the direction
188
of the main. Valve box extension pieces shall be provided for valves with groundcover in excess of the
depth of the standard valve box.
Acceptable manufacturers of valves boxes and covers are Olympic Foundry, Inc., EJCO, Rich (Varnish
Casting Corp.)
The Contractor shall provide an affidavit of compliance stating that the valve furnished fully complies
with AWWA C504.
9-30.3(5) Valve Marker Posts
Section 9-30.3(5) is revised as follows:
(******)
Valve markers shall be Carsonite composite utility marker 0.375"x 6'-0", or approved alternate, with
blue label "water”. The valve markers shall be installed in conformance with the City of Renton
Standard Plans.
9-30.3(6) Valve Stem Extensions
Section 9-30.3(6) is revised as follows:
(******)
Valve stem extensions shall have a 2-inch square operating nut and self-centering rockplate. A valve
stem extension is required where the valve operating nut is more than 3 feet below finished grade.
Valve stem extensions are to be a minimum of 1 foot with only one extension per valve in shall be
installed in accordance to the City of Renton standard plans.
9-30.3(7) Combination Air Release/Air Vacuum Valves
Section 9-30.3(7) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Combination air release/air vacuum valves shall comply with the requirements of ANSI/AWWA C512.
Air and vacuum release valves shall be APCO No. 143C- Valve and Primer Corp, "Heavy-Duty,"
combination air release valve, Val-Matic No. 201C, Crispin UL10 or approved alternate. Installation
shall be per the City of Renton Standard Plans, latest revision. Piping and fitting shall be copper or
brass. Location of the air release valve as show on the plans is approximate. The installation shall be
set at the actual high point of the line.
9-30.3(8) Tapping Sleeve and Valve Assembly
Section 9-30.3(8) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Tapping tees shall be stainless steel or epoxy coated steel with full circle seal. Bolt and nuts shall be
Cor-Ten or stainless steel.
9-30.3(9) Blow-Off Assembly
Section 9-30.3(9) is a new section:
Installation of blow-off assembly shall be per City of Renton Standard Details, latest revision. Pipe and
fittings shall be galvanized. Blow-off assembly shall be installed at location(s) shown on the plans.
189
Temporary blow-off assembly on new dead-end water main shall be installed at location shown on
the plans.
Temporary blow-off assemblies for testing and flushing of the new water mains will not be included
under this item and shall be considered incidental to the contract and no additional payment shall be
made.
9-30.5 Hydrants
Section 9-30.5 is revised as follows:
(******)
Fire hydrants shall conform to AWWA C502 and shall be of standard manufacture and of a pattern
approved by the City of Renton. The name or mark of the manufacturer, size of the valve opening and
year made shall be plainly cast in raised letters on the hydrant barrel to be visible after the hydrant is
installed.
Hydrants of the following manufacture and pattern have been approved by the City of Renton.
Clow Medallion, M&H 929, Mueller Centurion Model A-423, Waterous Pacer, American Darling Model
B-62B, Kennedy K81D Guardian, East Jordan WaterMaster 5CD250.
9-30.5(1) End Connections
Section 9-30.5(1) is revised as follows:
(******)
Hydrant end connections shall be mechanical joint connection unless otherwise specified in the
description of the bid of proposal.
9-30.5(2) Hydrant Dimensions
Section 9-30.5(2) is revised as follows:
(******)
Fire hydrants shall have a main valve opening with minimum diameter of 5-1/4 inches, “O” ring stem
seal, two 2-1/2-inch National Standard Thread (N.S.T.) hose nozzle connections, one 4-inch pumper
port connection with City of Seattle standard threads and with a 4.875” Seattle thread x 5” Storz
adapter attached with a 1/8” stainless steel cable. The shoe connection and hydrant connection inside
pipe size and auxiliary gate valve shall be 6 inches, mechanical joint with lugs. The operating nut and
port cap nuts are 1-1/4-inch pentagonal.
The hydrant curb stand section of the hydrant that is above ground including all exposed surfaces of
the breakaway flange shall be painted with 2 field coats of paint Kelly-Moore Luxlite or approved
alternate in Safety Yellow color.
Fire hydrants shall be installed per City of Renton Standard Details for fire hydrants, latest revisions.
9-30.5(4) Hydrant Restraints
Section 9-30.5(5) is revised as follows:
(******)
Hydrant restraint system shall be mechanical joint restraint with poured-in-place concrete thrust
190
block behind the hydrant shoe or two 3/4-inch diameter Cor-Ten steel tie rods. Hydrants shall be
provided with a breakaway flange assembly and be equipped with breaking devices at the sidewalk.
If a restrained-joint pipe system is used, it shall meet the requirements of Section 9-30.2(6).
9-30.6 Water Service Connections (2 inches and Smaller)
9-30.6(3) Service Pipes
9-30.6(3)B Polyethylene Pipe
Section 9-30.6(3)B is revised as follows:
(******)
Polyethylene pipe shall not be used.
9-30.6(3)C PEX-a Tubing
Section 9-30.6(3)C is revised as follows:
(******)
PEX-a tubing shall not be used.
9-30.6(4) Service Fittings
Section 9-30.6(4) is revised as follows:
(******)
Fittings used for copper tubing shall be compression type with gripper ring.
9-30.6(5) Meter Setters
Section 9-30.6(5) is supplemented as follows:
(******)
Meter setters for 1-inch water services shall be Ford VBH74-15W-44-44-Q-NL, A.Y. McDonald 721-
415WCQQ 44, Mueller B-24701-6AN, or approved alternate, and shall be installed per Detail 1 on
Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans.
Meter setters for 1.5-inch water services shall be Ford VBH86-12B-11-66-Q-NL, A.Y. McDonald 73-B-
612WDFF665, Mueller B-2427N (1 ½”), or approved alternate, and shall be installed per Detail 1 on
Drawing W-20 and W-21 as specified in the Construction Plans.
Meter setters for 2-inch water services shall be Ford VBH87-12B-11-77-Q-NL, A.Y. McDonald 730B-
612WDFF665, Mueller B-2427N (2”), or approved alternate and shall be installed per City of Renton
Standard Plan 320.2, latest edition.
9-30.6(7) Meter Boxes
Section 9-30.6(7) has been supplemented as follows:
(******)
Meter boxes for 1-inch water services shall be Armorcast A6001946PCX18 or approved alternate and
shall be installed per Detail 1 on Drawing W-19 as specified in the Construction Plans.
191
Meter boxes for 1.5-inch water services shall be Armorcast A6001640PCX18 or approved alternate
and shall be installed per Detail 1 on Drawing W-20 and W-21 as specified in the Construction Plans.
Meter boxes for 2-inch water services shall be Armorcast A6001640PCX18 or approved alternate and
shall be installed per City of Renton Standard Plan 320.2, latest edition.
22 City of Renton Standard Plans\
CITY OF RENTON
STANDARD PLANS
Std. Plan 101 – Cement Concrete Curbs
Std. Plan 101.1 – Cement Concrete Curb Installation
at Catch Basins
Std. Plan 102 – Cement Concrete Sidewalk
Std. Plan 102.1 – Utility Placement in Cement
Concrete Sidewalk
Std. Plan 104.1 – Cement Concrete Driveway
Entrance – Type R1
Std. Plan 104.2 – Cement Concrete Driveway
Entrances – Notes & Details
Std. Plan 106 – Typical Construction and Adjustment
of Manhole Risers
Std. Plan 109 – Pavement Marking Notes
Std. Plan 110 – Typical Transverse Patch for Flexible
Pavement or Rigid Pavement with Overlay
Std. Plan 110.1 – Typical Longitudinal Patch for
Flexible Pavement or Rigid Pavement with Overlay
Std. Plan 110.2 – Required Sawcut, Grind and Overlay
for Longitudinal Trenches
Std. Plan 128 – Intersection Crosswalk and Stop Bar
Pavement Markings
Std. Plan 129 – Sign Mounting on Single Metal Post
Std. Plan 134 – Post Mounted Street Name Signs
Std. Plan H031 – Monument Case and Cover
WSDOT Standard Plans
WSDOT Std. Plan F-40.12-03 – Parallel Curb Ramp
WSDOT Std. Plan M-20.20-02 – Profiled and
Embossed Plastic Lines
WSDOT Std. Plan M-20.30-04 – Longitudinal Marking
Supplement with Raised Pavement Markers
22 City of Renton Standard Plans\
Surface Water Standard Plans
Std. Plan 200.00 – Catch Basin Type 1
Std. Plan 201.00 – Catch Basin Type 2
Std. Plan 202.00 – Catch Basin Installation
Std. Plan 204.00 – Rectangular Frame
Std. Plan 204.20 – Rectangular Vaned Grate
Std. Plan 204.30 – Rectangular Bi-Directional
Vaned Grate
Std. Plan 204.50 – Storm Round Frame and
Cover (Public)
Std. Plan 204.60 – Miscellaneous Details for
Drainage Structures
Std. Plan 212.00 – Stake and Wire Fence
Std. Plan 213.40 – Straw Wattles
Std. Plan 214.00 – Silt Fence
Std. Plan 214.10 – Silt Fence Installation by Slicing
Std. Plan 216.30 – Catch Basin Insert
Std. Plan 216.50 – Curb and Gutter Barrier
Protection
Std. Plan 220.00 – Pipe Zone Bedding and
Compaction – Rigid Pipe
Std. Plan 220.10 – Pipe Zone Bedding and
Compaction – Flexible Pipe
Std. Plan 220.20 – Typical Trench and Backfill
Std. Plan 267.00 – Surface Water Standard Plan
Notes (1 of 2)
Std. Plan 267.10 – Surface Water Standard Plan
Notes (2 of 2)
Std. Plan 268.00 – Erosion and Sediment Control
Standard Plan Notes
Water Standard Plans
Std. Plan 300.6 – Tapping Tee
Std. Plan 300.7 – Polypigging New Water Mains
Std. Plan 300.9 – Pipe Zone Bedding and Trench
Backfill for Ductile Iron Water Main
Std. Plan 310.1 – Fire Hydrant Assembly
Std. Plan 310.2 – Fire Hydrant Assembly Shear Block
Std. Plan 310.3 – Fire Hydrant Assembly Pavement
Marker
Std. Plan 320.2 – 2” Water Service in Cement
Concrete Sidewalk
Std. Plan 330.1 – Concrete Blocking for Horizontal
Fittings
Std. Plan 330.3 – Concrete Blocking for Vertical
Fittings with Restrained Joints
Std. Plan 330.4 – Concrete Blocking Pipe Clamp and
Anchor Rods
Std. Plan 330.7 – Valve Box, Operating Nut Extension,
and Marker Post
Std. Plan 340.3 – 1" Air and Vacuum Release Valve
Assembly
Dead-Man Anchor Block
Wastewater Standard Plans
Std. Plan 400.1 – Standard Sanitary Manhole
Std. Plan 405 – Pipe Bedding for Sanitary Sewers
Side Sewer Relocation
FACE OF CURB
6 112' '
1/2" R. 1" R.
1:24
t
TOP OF
112" R. ROADWAY
I
V
ED
T
CEMENT CONCRETE
TRAFFIC CURB AND GUTTER
FACE OF ADJACENT CURB
6 1f2"--
FLUSH WITH GUTTER
PAN AT SIDEWALK
RAMP ENTRANCE
1:12 1:24
TOP OF
112" R. ROADWAY
1
DEPRESSED CURB SECTION
AT SIDEWALK RAMPS
w '
PREMOLDED
JOINT FILLER
E FULL -DEPTH
EXPANSION JOINT
6" CEMENT CONCRETE
112" R. 1"R. SIDEWALK RAMP
VARIES
OR LANDING
FROM !
6"TOO S
s"
T
318" PREMOLDED
JOINT FILLER
CEMENT CONCRETE
PEDESTRIAN CURB
AT SIDEWALK RAMPS AND LANDINGS
6 112" '
FACE OF ADJACENT CURB
SEE DEPRESSED CURB DETAIL THIS SHEET
114
TOP OF
1/2" R. ROADWAY
2"
i
T
DEPRESSED CURB SECTION
AT RESIDENTIAL DRIVEWAYS ONLY.
FOR COMMERCIAL DRIVEWAYS SEE STD PLAN 104.2
1 P2' R.
FACE OF ADJACENT CURB I
GUTTER SURFACE
u
6 112" 1"
1' R.
FACE OF CURB
1" R.
8 114"
1" R.
CEMENT CONCRETE
i TRAFFIC CURB
DEPRESSED CURB DETAIL
AT RESIDENTIAL OR COMMERCIAL DRIVEWAYS, AND ALLEYS
GENERAL NOTES:
1. See standard plans 102 and 101.1 for curb expansion and contraction joint spacing.
2. Expansion joint shall be full depth, 3/8" (in.) premolded joint filler.
3. For Depressed Monolithic Driveway Curb & Gutter Section, see Standard Plan 104.2
TOP OF
ROADWAY
STD. PLAN — 101
a PUBLIC WORKS
CEMENT CONCRETE CURBSDEPARTMENT
NOfE2 X3/8 -R X 5/8"D DUMMY JOINT
I I
I I
3/8- PREMOLDED JOINT FILLER (TYP) I
F V— 5 _
PLAN VIEW
FACEOF
FRAME
A GRATECURBI_S FRANE60RATE
6 1/2"
IL•
13"
51 2" 1• (
I.OB')
FRAMEANDGRATE-NOTndwosa
1/2" R. 1' jR MATCHROADWAY Iry DDRB AND DUTIERSID rlEh1
SLOPE
TOP OFI
1R2EOE69
ROADWAY
D'
D D D
D.. D.'.' ADJUSTMENT SECTION -NOTINCLUDED
D' e' INCURSANDOUTIERSIDIIEM
CATCH RUN -NOTDICL DED
D •'••' - INCURSANDOUTTERSIDREM
SECTION O
GENERAL NOTES:
1. The Intent of this design Is to facilitate the removal'
of a catch basin with minimal disturbance
of the curb
x .i-
2. The expansion joints of the - i .
I. adjacentsidawalkshall
be adjusted to be In
line with these curb
expansion joints. j I sI
SEE NOTE2
CEMENTCONCREIE
CURS AND ODTTER
I
ISO 2IC VIEW
CEMENT CONCRETE CURB
SM. PLAN — IMA
PUBLIC WORKS PRO D: INSTALLATION AT
DEPARTMENT
CATCH BASINS ADA
s RAISED EDGE DETAIL 1 a sI DEWALK
LEVEL 1r2' F•J7 O $IOEWAL3(TRANSVERSE 1'-0" 1' - 0"
11r R J01NTS TO INCLUDE RASED EDGE
318• (IN) PREMOLDED JOINT FILLER
TYPICAL WHERE APPLICABLEON
RDUt DING 2.0%1 tr2" (IN) R. (TYP.]
FOR CURB pETA[LS
r , SEE STD PLAN 101
er ' y r. STING ROADWAY
CRUSHED ROCK BrLS
SEE RAISED EDGE I
SIDEWALK DETAIL - THIS SHE LTYPICALUNDER CRUSHEOSURFACING TOP COURSE (CSTC) ALL
CUT SIDEWALK
OMPACT TO 957, MODIFILU PROCTOR MIN.
O
SLOPESWITH RAISED EDGE UNLESS REOUTREMENT WAIVED BY ENGINEER)
TYPICAL. UNDER ALL CURB, V2" (
tN) R. (TYP.) GUTTER S SIDEWALK, CSTC UNDER 2' '
v
FOR
CURB DETAILS CURB S GUTTER TO BE S THICKNESS CR LS%
SEE STD PLAN 101 MATCH EXISTING ROADWAY CRUSHED ROCK dH " ,•
i!' BASE,
WHICHEVER IS GREATER (1YP. FOR ALL
CURB b GUTTER). FINISHED
GRADE 1"(IN)BELOW 1fn2' 0• SIDEWALK TOPOF
CONCRETE SURFACE ADJACENT
TO CURB MIN 1,
m 1 0• ROU
DING R. (
TYR) FOR
CURB DETAILS 1,
5% SEE STD PLAN 101 o
a
t
s
Fr• • BRI
DGE OR PEDESTRIAN RAILING
ADJACENT
TO CURB FOR
CURB CURSDETAILS WRIER -
SEE SIDEWALK SEE $TD PLAN 101. STEEP
FILL SLOPES) CONTRACT
PLANS WALL OR BARRIER I
772' (IN) R. (TYP.) J
I
SIDEWALK FLUSH'
1.
5% t
1rz• M R. VERTICAL
WALL - -- ' -. . - -- \Vr
ti..f . •. SEE
DETAIL 318• (
IN) PREMOLDED JOINT
FILLER ADJACENT
TO CURB AND RAILING OR WALL a (IN) PREMOLDED
JOINT
FILLER FOR
SIDE BUFFER
STR1P TREATMENTSIDEWALKSIDEWALK ADJACENT TO WALL DETAIL SEE
HER (SEE NOTE 10) SIDEWALK/
12• (
IN) R. SECTIONS1 (
TYP ) FOR
v
1.5% SEE STD PLAN 10.S
1.
SX MIN. SEE STD PLAN 101 r 4`\\
f
GROOMED FINISH OR
MATCH E)(iST1NG e
4' M/IDE, SMOOTH Go
TROWELED PERIMETER FINISHED
GRADE t• (IN) BELOW TOP OF CONCRETE SURFACE
FOR PLANTING -FLUSH IF PAVED T
CONCRETE CEMENTCONCRETECURB CURB ADJACENT
TO BUFFER STRIP 0 CURB FOR
CURB DETAILS D•
SEE STD PLAN 101 r
5, z
1r8'TD 114' NOTES
1.
Four feet of the sidewalk width shall be
the minimum pedestrian CONTRACTION
JOINT • . Al
yam.
aocessibTe
route (aut) free of vertical IN
RAG .'
andhorizontalobstructions. Gratings, FULL -
DEPTH EXPANSION JO NT IN BOTH h1' AccessCovers, Junction Boxes, CURB
AND SIDEWALK (SEE STD PLAN mi.1) CableVaults, Pull Boxes and other appurtenances
within the sidewalk ` s'F 3W C CONTRACTION JOINT must
be flush with surface, and match grade
of the sidewalk. JOINT AND FINISH DETAIL
2.
Monolithic Cement Concrete Curb and + Sidewalk
is not permitted in new For other referenced NOTES see , construction.
When replacement work STD PLAN 104.2, R ••
necessitates
a Monolithic Cement PREMOLAE
ConcreteCurbbuildperWSDOTJOINTFILLERStandardPlanF-30.10-03. Paved surfaces must comply With STD
PLAN 102.1 as applicable. E FULL -DEPTH 3.
Concrete to 6e 4,000 PSI. EXPANSION
JOINT fthk
SM PLAN - 109 PUBLIC
WORKS CEMENT CONCRETE PPRQ •
ED: DEPARTMENT
SIDEWALK T ljZ_It]ra#'YA 104/ +7
NOTES'
1. Not used.
2. All ramp and landing edges shall be separately formed.
Utilities structures that must remain are to be made non -slip or non-skid.
4. Utilities structures such as vaults and junction boxes shall not be located in the Pedestrian Access Route (PAR) of the
Pedestrian Circulation Route,
5. Drainage appurtenances, such as manholes, catch basins, eic. shall not be located in the PAR. These should be located
in the street or the buffer strip.
6. Accessible pedestrian access shall be provided for during construction.
PUBLIC IVORKr I UTILITY PLACEMENT IN
AN ) DEPAR?6!E\! CEMENT CONCRETE SIDEWALK
STD. PLAN — L02.1
Gregg Lmmerman, PuGlk Warts Adminbvator
FOIfEV r'IgU{F64C6WALR iIh'ifr
F'YN vYFE55EEntaren
WWROWIRCIFFIAW
wFNt11E4
oMCYMY K4YPE0
v 1!F et0 FUN lapVa"
FOFfYfUt
SEE M9iE f
I
CWKTIIYGIEM-0MI
r
W.IWINfMry
F(E M(IIEI - RYENIfAOIfE
TOFFItVFI
S
IFFEF
Np1F i
ascaxfNaEacNaorrtrtvF.; f
lf1EE np FUN np
PIAN Mw
N!s
N
1 EM1O 1 `a]f Nfl lE[Na1E{;1'rY,.
11 /
Y E F'Mw
CYI YYIItIlax 1ElE
6'lil RMSYDCUN{WTFII
YMf`, aFEYMNFFXr AMI(M1V.) IQ.Icff4
9ECTIONOryFESN F4N loa VIIIIM1EJ _fIWYY{IM]M_ _
M M'11YW RMFSbET WF YtJYfvELtA[MlEal _ Ih
n
CWVEYNY r-ai
I OOPn'Ef1YY YY gtgrh .
N __—
CLr wCtYOltEcwFEwmfl
s N]fEJI
YES.. SLD PIAN IN }
STD. PLAN - 104.1
PUBLIC WORKS CEMENT CONCRETE DRIVEWAY,.
4
DEPARTMENT ENTRANCE - TYPE R1
Gregg Zimmerman. PUM¢ W orlu Administrator
CEMENT
SEE NOTE 31
CEMENT- DEPRESSED MONOLITHIC
CONCRETE - CURB 8 CUTTER
SIX -WALK j j (SEE DETAIL MS SHEET)
TYPE C213 - ISOMETRIC VIEW
COMMERCIAL, WITH BUFFER)
NOTES
1. When a driveway width exceeds 15 feet, consbud a full depth
expanslon joint with 3f8' Joint filler along the driveway lane lines
see std. plan 102). Construct expansion joints parallel with the
centerline as required at 15 maximum sparing when driveway
Widths exceed 30'.
2. See std. plan 102 for sidewalk details.
3. Curb and gutter shown, other curb designs may be specified.
See std. plan 101 for curb details.
4. Not used.
5. The engineer will design all driveways to Include elevations at all
points marked with symbol "X'. All elevations are at the back of
Curb top on uphill side.
6. Not used.
7. For Driveway Widths see DRIVEWAY STANDARDS
See NOTE 10). The expansion joints (see end. plan 102) shall be
spaced as shown In the corresponding leamViic New.
8. Slopes shall comply with sections 8303.21 or R303.2.2 or
R303-2.3 of the Revised Draft Guidelines for Accessible Public
Rigbtsaf=Way of Nove uba 23, 2005 (PROWAO).
9. Curb returns for any Type C -MAX Driveway maybe approved on
a case-by-case basis,
10. STREET STANDARDS= Renton Municipal Code (RMC)
Tide IV Development Regulators
CHAPTER 6 STREET AND UTILITY STANDARDS
Section 4.6-060 STREET STANDARDS
DRIVEWAY STANDARDS = Renton Municipal Cade (RMC)
Tice IV Development Regulations
CHAPTER 4
CITY-WIDE PROPERTY DEVELOPMENT STANDARDS
Section 4 -4 -ON PARKING, LOADING AND DRIVEWAY
REGULATIONS
aEE.C.
coNTwtcnCN X}
aro N.w tae
b
SEE DEFREMECC Dr1M
on r z ew-
Wit TOPOF1110MY
NOTE, ORNE NYtalC.naEULmMB1IX1
ADM
NOLtFMALO
CURBDEPRESSEDMDNOLTTNIDpJRB 6 DUTfEfiOETAL
FACE OF ADJACENT WF®
DEPRESSED CURB DETAIL
AT RESIDEMW. ORCORBBK.YAL DRIVEWAYS, AND ALIEN'S
DdvelNay Example: TYPE C11 B
R=Rlisd, d, C.CwwnwdAl 1NurtofLAIW. _----
MA)(x lwne Comm q
a=b,(Pia tNSw;l 3an1F41e Buffer -
PUBLIC WORE' CEMENT CONCRETE DRIVEWAY
STD. PLAN - 104.2
DEPARTMENT ENTRANCES - NOTES AND DETAILS A11f'— //
PATCHED AREA
i
A q
COVER
COVER PER STD PLAN 401
SEE NOTE 9)
SEAL WITH AR 4000 OR APPROVED
EQUAL AND DRY SAND AFTER P L A N
PATCHING
NTS
OUTSIDE DIAMETER OF
SEE NOTE 9) ADJUSTMENT RING AND x SEE NOTE 2
X
gOTTOM OF FRAME
t----
MORTAR JOINT(S) (3/8" MIN.-2" MAX.) ADJUSTMENT RING (1" MIN.). SEE
SEE NOTE 3 AND SPECIAL PROVISION NOTE 6.
7-05.3(1).
SECTION A-A
NOTES
1. REMOVE PAVEMENT AND BASE MATERIALS FOR A DISTANCE 5. CONSTRUCTION AND ADJUSTMENT SHALL BE PERFORMED
WHICH IS EQUAL TO THE DIAMETER OF THE FRAME PLUS ONE ONLY BY A JOURNEYMAN MASON.
FOOT(MIN.). ADJUST CASTING FRAME TO PAVEMENT
SURFACE USING RISER RINGS AND MORTAR. 6. ADJUSTMENT OF THE FRAME TO GRADE SHALL BE
ACCOMPLISHED WITH ADJUSTMENT RINGS AND MORTAR ONLY.
2. REPLACE EXCAVATED MATERIAL WITH A MINIMUM OF 8"OF THE USE OF SHIMS IS PROHIBITED.
HMA CLASS"PG 64-22(OR TO A DEPTH THAT S 2"BELOW
THE BOTTOM OF THE UPPER ADJUSTMENT RING WHICHEVER 7• FRAME SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO PAVEMENT GRADE BY
IS GREATER)OR AS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. TAPPING UNTIL FRAME IS FLUSH WITH PAVEMENT AS
DETERMINED WITH A STRAIGHT EDGE OF SUFFICIENT LENGTH.
3. ADJUSTMENT RINGS AND FRAME SHALL BE FULLY BEDDED IN
MORTAR.MORTAR SHALL BE ASTM C270 FOR TYPE S. 8. ALL MORTAR JOINTS SHALL BE TRIMMED FLUSH AND REMAIN
VISIBLE UPON COMPLETION.
4. MORTAR SHALL BE MIXED AND APPLIED PER
MANUFACTURERS DIRECTIONS. 9. X=1'-0"MIN.TO 2'-6"MAX.-PER ENGINEER'S INSTRUCTION
STD. PLAN - 106
j PUBLIC WORKS
TY'CAL CONSTRUCTION A ROVED:
al' DEPARTMENT AND ADJUSTMENT OF
flMANNOLERISER3
e o r>tor DA E
1 1 VARIES 1 1
MIN MIN MIN I MIN
SPECIAL NOTE: T < }
x , 4
IN THE EVENT TRANSVERSE PATCHES EXIST I ;
WITHIN THE AFFECTEO STREET, THE LENGTH I I
IOFTHEPATCHSHALLBEEXTENDEDTO
INCLUDE ANY EXISTING PATCH WITHIN 10 j
FEET OF THE EDGE OF THE PATCH REQUIRED iFORTHENEWCROSSINGANDANYf . .
SUBSEQUENT PATCH EDGE WITHIN 70 FEE7
OF THE EDGE OF THE SECOND PATCH AND
SO ON UP TO A TOTAL OF 300 FEET. I FACE OF GUTTER OR
i I EDGE OF PAVEMENT
k -=f--
a ;
TRAFFIC FLOW
2" HMA I r a d` i
i
CENTER LINE ORILANELWE
2" TO 8" HMA i
I
6.5' MIN.
2" DEPTH OF
PLANING OR SAWCUT AND REMOVE
VARIES: 6.5' MIN.
DEPTH OF EXISTING PAVEMENT
MIN I MIN
VARIES {
MIN I MINI
2" SAWCUT AND REMOVE
OR PLANE, SEAL WITH 2" - 6" MIN. HMA (SEE NOTE 2)
AR-4000W
EACH SIDE)
6" CRUSHED SURFACWG TOP COURSE (CSTC)
2" HMA 9-03.9(3)) PER WSDOT STANDARO
SPECIFICATIONS, COMPACTED TO 95% MODIFIED
PROCTOR.
SAWCUT AFTER BACKFILL
EACH SIDE)
CSTC, BANK RUN GRAVEL FOR TRENCH BACKFILL
9-03.19), GRAVEL BORROW (9-03.14(1)) PER
WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS OR NATIVE
MATERIAL IF APPROVED IN WRITING BY ENGINEER
BASED ON GEOTECH REPORT, COMPACTED TO 95%
MODIFIED PROCTOR.
WIDTH OF TRENCH AS RE UIRED BY SIZE OF PROPOSED
IMPROVEMENT (SEE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATION 2-09.4)
PLUS AN ALLOWANCE FOR ANY SHORING. SHORING, IF PIPE ZONE BEDDING. MATERIAL- SEE STANDARDNEEDED, SHALL MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF WSDOT PLAN 110.1.
STANDARD SPECIFICATION 7-08.3(1)B
TRENCH WIDTH
FOR NOTES, SEE STANDARD PLAN 110.1
TYPICAL TRANSVERSE PATCH FOR
p - 110
PUBLIC WORKS
FLEXIBLE PAVEMENT OR RIGID F'}'R 'E;D
DEPARTMENT u j,.,,
PAVEMENT WITN OVERLAY
r
T
RECYCLED CONCRETE AGGREGATE SHALL
NOT BE USED AS TRENCH BACKFILL
o
LANE ] LAt E LANE i
f
t ii
1 :
f I
f
l
j 4
INITIAL 2" DEEP SAWCUT OR GRIND, AND
LIMIT OF FINAL OVERLAY. GRIND AND PAVE
r FULL STREET WIDTH OVERLAY REQUIRED.
J 'r
t
1 J
f/
t
I ce:
t(. p_.
2:
t -, / . -I / t'
If
r .. }t ,
1
i f 1` I
t f
EDGE OF EXISTING PAVEMENT
11
EDGE OF TRAVELED LANE (EDGE STRIPE)
t
VARIES: 4.5' MIN. (SEE STD PLAN 110.1)
f
I
CENTER OF ANY MARKED LANE LINE,
PROVIDE NEW CHANNELIZATION AFTER OVERLAY
F
t1
i r SECONDARY FULL DEPTH SAWCUT FOR
4 PROPOSED TRENCH
t
f
I
INITIAL 2" DEEP SAWCUT OR GRIND, AND
f LIMIT OF FINAL OVERLAY. GRIND AND PAVE
FULL STREET WIDTH OVERLAY REQUIRED
CANE LAtV LANE
r ___ _0
i __
FOR TYPICAL SECTION AND NOTES SEE STANDARD PLAN 110.1
3TD. PLAN - 110.2
PUBLIC WORKS REQUIRED SAWCUT, GRIND AND ppR' 'I,D:
DEPARTMENT OVERLAY FOR LONGITUDINAL TRENCHES Q -
DocuSign Envelope ID: 9D9B0DA8-0385-4664-AE66-57BFF1561D7F
7/27/2022 | 5:44 PM PDT
BAND -
OR
MOUNTING ON EXISTING
METAL POLE OR LUMINAIRE
MIN.
NOTES
1. DIMENSIONS FOR THE PARTS USED TO ASSEMBLE THE BASE
CONNECTIONS ARE INTENTIONALLY NOT SHOWN. BASE
CONNECTIONS ARE PATENTED, MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS
THAT ARE IN COMPLIANCE WITH NCHRP 350 CRASH TEST
CRITERIA. THE BASE CONNECTION DETAILS ARE SHOWN ON
THIS PLAN ONLY TO ILLUSTRATE HOW THE PARTS ARE
ASSEMBLED.
2. A 2- (IN) POST WITH A 2 1/4" (IN) PSST ANCHOR OR A 2
1/4" (IN) POST WITH A 2 1/2" (IN) PSST ANCHOR MAY BE
SUBSTITUTED. SEE CONTRACT PLANS.
3. PERFORATED SQUARE STEEL POST SHALL MEET THE
REQUIREMENTS OF WSOOT STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-06.
4. USE ONLY BASE CONNECTION MANUFACTURER SUPPLIED
HARDWARE THAT MEETS THE REQUIREMENTS OF WSDOT
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 9-06 AND 9-28.
EDGE OF TRAVELED
ROADWAY
90-F,3C
FOR REFLECTORIZED SIGNS: MOUNT
FACING 3'(degree) OUTWARD IF SIGN
IS WITHIN 30 FEET OF ROADWAY
SIGN FACE ORIENTATION
BOLT STOPGN POST
TYPE ST -4 SIGN SUPPORT
OST SUPPORT — 2.25"
HOT—DIP GALV.,
ANCHOR
ON CRE 1E
MOUNTING ON METAL POST
SIGN MOUNTING ON SINGLE STD. PLAN- 129isPUBLICWORKSMETALPOSTAPPROVED: tiZ + DEPARTMENT (
ADOPTED ( /V
nerc
SIGN POST
s
LOWER SIGN
e
5/16" (IN) CORNER BOLT
IN) POST SUPPORT OR 3/6' FLANGED
SHOULDER BOLT NTH
NUT AND WASHERS
2 REQUIRED (TYP.)
BOLT STOPGN POST
TYPE ST -4 SIGN SUPPORT
OST SUPPORT — 2.25"
HOT—DIP GALV.,
ANCHOR
ON CRE 1E
MOUNTING ON METAL POST
SIGN MOUNTING ON SINGLE STD. PLAN- 129isPUBLICWORKSMETALPOSTAPPROVED: tiZ + DEPARTMENT (
ADOPTED ( /V
nerc
DocuSign Envelope ID: B16CE03A-ED99-4F11-B559-FEB382C92BFB
7/30/2018 | 4:09 PM PDT
SHEET 1 OF 1 SHEET
APPROVED FOR PUBLICATION
STATE DESIGN ENGINEER
Washington State Department of Transportation
‘
LANDING
A
CURB RAMP
FACE OF CURB
A
‘
C
B
SECTION A
CURB RAMP
CURB RAMP
LEGEND
CURB RAMP
B
LANDING
LANDING
(T
Y
P
.)
4
"
FACE OF CURB
SIDEWALK
SIDEWALK
SIDEWALK
SIDEWALK
CURB AND GUTTER
SECTION
SECTION
CROSSWALKCROSSWALK
GRADE BREAK
GRADE BREAK
GRADE BREAK
3" R.
LANDING
PLAN VIEW PLAN VIEW
TYPE PARALLEL A TYPE PARALLEL B
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
1.
2.
3.
NOTES
LANDINGCURB RAMP
(
T
Y
P
.
)
4
"
ISOMETRIC VIEWISOMETRIC VIEW
TYPE PARALLEL A PAY LIMIT TYPE PARALLEL B PAY LIMIT
SLOPE IN EITHER DIRECTION
STANDARD PLAN F-40.12-03
ROADWAY
TOP OF
5.0% MAX.COUNTER SLOPE
V
A
R
IE
S
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
GRADE BREAK
GRADE BREAK
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
4’ - 0" MIN. ~
SEE
DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE ~
STANDARD PLAN F-45.10
SEE
DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE ~
STANDARD PLAN F-45.10
PEDESTRIAN CURB ~
SEE NOTE 9
SEE
DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE ~
STANDARD PLAN F-45.10
PEDESTRIAN CURB ~
SEE NOTE 9
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
4’ - 0" MIN. ~
PEDESTRIAN CURB ~
SEE NOTE 9
CURB ~
CEMENT CONCRETE PEDESTRIAN
SEE NOTE 9
4’ - 0" MIN.
4’ - 0" MIN.
4’ - 0" MIN.
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
SEE
3/8" EXPANSION JOINT (TYP.) ~
STANDARD PLAN F-30.10
PARALLEL B" PAY LIMIT ~
"CEMENT CONCRETE CURB RAMP TYPE
SEE NOTE 6
PARALLEL A" PAY LIMIT ~
"CEMENT CONCRETE CURB RAMP TYPE
SEE NOTE 6
PARALLEL CURB RAMP
D
R
A
W
N
B
Y
:
F
E
R
N
L
ID
D
E
L
L
(
T
Y
P
.
)
4
"
*
**FORMWORK (8.3% MAX.) ~ SEE NOTE 7
7.5% OR FLATTER RECOMMENDED FOR DESIGN/***
(ALONG INSIDE RADIUS AT BACK OF WALKWAY)
(ALONG INSIDE RADIUS AT BACK OF WALKWAY)
SEE NOTE 7
15’ - 0" MAX. (TYP.)
*
**
SEE NOTE 7
15’ - 0" MAX. (TYP.)
SEE NOTE 7
15’ - 0" MAX. (TYP.)
C
*
**
*
DEPRESSED CURB AND GUTTER
DEPRESSED CURB AND GUTTER
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
4’ - 0" MIN. ~
SEE CONTRACT PLANS
4’ - 0" MIN. ~
DESIGN/FORMWORK (2% MAX.)
1.5% OR FLATTER RECOMMENDED FOR
CURB AND GUTTER
SEE
DEPRESSED CURB AND GUTTER ~
STANDARD PLAN F-10.12
AND NOTE 6
**
1
1
CONTRACTION JOINT EQUALLY SPACED 4’ - 0" MIN. OC.
FOR CURB RAMP LENGTHS GREATER THAN 8’ - 0"PROVIDE
STANDARD PLAN F-30.1 CONTRACTION JOINT (TYP.) ~ SEE
1
CURB RAMP
SEE
3/8" (IN) EXPANSION JOINT (TYP.) ~
STANDARD PLAN F-30.10
JOINT (TYP.) ~ SEE
3/8" (IN) EXPANSION
STANDARD PLAN F-30.10
JOINT (TYP.) ~ SEE
3/8" EXPANSION
STANDARD PLAN F-30.10
Specifications 8-14.
Standard
Standard Plan F-30.10
F-10.12
Standard Plan
Ramp or Landing and there will be no material to retain.
Curb Ramp and/or Landing will be at the same elevation as the Curb
Pedestrian Curb may be omitted if the ground surface at the back of the
Curb Ramps and Landings shall receive a broom finish. See
walkway.
15-foot max. length is measured on the inside radius along the back of the
the15-foot max. measurement. When a ramp is constructed on a radius, the
over a horizontal distance of 15 feet. Do not include abutting landing(s) in
constant slope from bottom of ramp to top of ramp to match into the sidewalk
the running slope of the curb ramp is allowed to exceed 8.3%. Use a single
shown in the Contract Plans). When applying the 15-foot max. length,
The Curb Ramp length is not required to exceed 15 feet (unless otherwise
Pedestrian Curb, or Sidewalks.
the adjacent Curb, Curb and Gutter, Depressed Curb and Gutter,
The Bid Item "Cement Concrete Curb Ramp Type __" does not include
See Contract Plans for width and placement of sidewalk.
for Cement Concrete Sidewalk Details.See
Pedestrian Curb details.
for Curb, Curb and Gutter, Depressed Curb and Gutter, and
See Contract Plans for the curb design specified. See
Curb and Gutter where the Landing connects to the roadway.
nances on any part of the Curb Ramp or Landing, or in the Depressed
Do not place Gratings, Junction Boxes, Access Covers, or other appurte-
break between the two adjacent surface planes shall be flush.
Where "GRADE BREAK" is called out, the entire length of the grade
roadway must be contained within the width of the crosswalk markings.
At marked crosswalks, the connection between the landing and the
ST A TEOFWASHI
NGT
O
N
R
EGISTEREDP
R
OFE
S
SIONAL ENGINEER
R
ELLE
Z TTOCS .R
28680
PRECAST BASE SECTION
SEE NOTE 1
NOTES:
1.AS ACCEPTABLE ALTERNATIVES TO THE REBAR SHOWN
IN THE PRECAST BASE SECTION, FIBERS (PLACED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD SPECIFICATION
9-05.50(9)), OR WIRE MESH HAVING A MINIMUM AREA OF
0.12 SQUARE INCHES PER FOOT SHALL BE USED WITH
THE MINIMUM REQUIRED REBAR SHOWN IN THE
ALTERNATIVE PRECAST BASE SECTION. WIRE MESH
SHALL NOT BE PLACED IN THE KNOCKOUTS. AS AN
ACCEPTABLE ALTERNATIVE TO THE REBAR SHOWN IN
THE RECTANGULAR ADJUSTMENT SECTION, WIRE MESH
HAVING A MINIMUM AREA OF 0.12 SQUARE INCHES PER
FOOT MAY BE USED.
2.THE KNOCKOUT DIAMETER SHALL NOT BE GREATER
THAN 20". KNOCKOUTS SHALL HAVE A WALL THICKNESS
OF 2" MINIMUM TO 2.5" MAXIMUM. PROVIDE A 1.5"
MINIMUM GAP BETWEEN THE KNOCKOUT WALL AND THE
OUTSIDE OF THE PIPE. AFTER THE PIPE IS INSTALLED,
FILL THE GAP WITH JOINT MORTAR IN ACCORDANCE WITH
STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-04.3.
3.THE MAXIMUM DEPTH FROM THE FINISHED GRADE TO
THE LOWEST PIPE INVERT SHALL BE 5 FEET.
4.THE FRAME AND GRATE MUST BE INSTALLED WITH THE
FLANGE DOWN.
5.THE PRECAST BASE SECTION MAY HAVE A ROUNDED
FLOOR, AND THE WALLS MAY BE SLOPED AT A RATE OF
1H:24V OR STEEPER.
6.THE OPENING SHALL BE MEASURED AT THE TOP OF THE
PRECAST BASE SECTION.
7.ALL PICKUP HOLES SHALL BE GROUTED FULL AFTER THE
INLET HAS BEEN PLACED. USE GROUT TYPE 2 FOR
NON-SHRINK APPLICATIONS IN ACCORDANCE WITH
STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-20.3(2).
8.ALL GRADE RINGS AND CASTINGS SHALL BE SET IN
MORTAR IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD
SPECIFICATION 9-04.3. THEN APPLY MORTAR TO INSIDE
AND OUTSIDE OF ALL JOINTS, RINGS, RISERS, AND
FRAMES.
9.MORTAR SHALL BE MIXED AND APPLIED PER
MANUFACTURER'S DIRECTIONS.
10.FRAME SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO PAVEMENT GRADE BY
TAPPING UNTIL FRAME IS FLUSH WITH PAVEMENT AS
DETERMINED WITH A STRAIGHT EDGE OF SUFFICIENT
LENGTH.
11.ALL MORTAR JOINTS SHALL BE TRIMMED FLUSH AND
REMAIN VISIBLE UPON COMPLETION.
FRAME AND VANED GRATE
RECTANGULAR ADJUSTMENT SECTION
34"
24"
30
20
5"
5"
1", 2", 4", 6", 12", OR 24"
ONE #3 BAR HOOP FOR 6" HEIGHT
INCREMENT (SPACED EQUALLY),
SEE NOTE 1
PIPE ALLOWANCES
PIPE MATERIAL
MAXIMUM
INSIDE
DIAMETER
REINFORCED OR PLAIN
CONCRETE
12"
ALL METAL PIPE 15"
CPSSP*,
STD. SPEC. 9-05.20
12"
SOLID WALL PVC,
STD. SPEC. 9-05.12(1)15"
PROFILE WALL PVC,
STD. SPEC. 9-05.12(2)
15"
CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE STORM
SEWER PIPE
26",
S E E N O T E 6
22SE
E
N
O
T
E
6
3"4"44"
21" MIN.4"
MI N. (T Y
P.)3 BAR EACH
SIDE 3 BAR EACH
WAY 3 BAR
EACH CORNER 3
BAR EACH CORNER
18" MIN.3 BAR
HOOP ALTERNATIVE PRECAST BASE
SECTION CATCH BASIN TYPE
1 STD.
PLAN -
200.
00PUBLIC
WORKS DEPARTMENT APPROVED:
DATEGregg Zimmerman Public Works Administrator UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING
IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)DocuSign Envelope ID:
6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878 9/28/
NOTES:
1.NO STEPS ARE REQUIRED WHEN HEIGHT IS 4' OR LESS.
2.THE BOTTOM OF THE PRECAST CATCH BASIN MAY BE
SLOPED TO FACILITATE CLEANING.
3.THE RECTANGULAR FRAME AND GRATE MUST BE
INSTALLED WITH THE FLANGE DOWN. THE FRAME MAY BE
CAST INTO THE ADJUSTMENT SECTION.
4.KNOCKOUTS SHALL HAVE A WALL THICKNESS OF 2"
MINIMUM TO 2.5" MAXIMUM. PROVIDE A 1.5" MINIMUM GAP
BETWEEN THE KNOCKOUT WALL AND THE OUTSIDE OF THE
PIPE. AFTER THE PIPE IS INSTALLED, FILL THE GAP WITH
JOINT MORTAR IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD
SPECIFICATION 9-04.3.
5.ALL GRADE RINGS, RISERS, AND CASTINGS SHALL BE SET
IN MORTAR IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD
SPECIFICATION 9-04.3.
6.WHEN CONNECTING TO A NEW PIPE, USE A FLEXIBLE
CONNECTOR (KOR-N-SEAL BOOT WITH CORRUGATED PIPE
ADAPTER OR APPROVED EQUAL). WHEN CONNECTING TO
AN EXISTING PIPE, USE A FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF
THE SAME MATERIAL AS THE CONNECTING PIPE.
7.MORTAR SHALL BE MIXED AND APPLIED PER
MANUFACTURER'S DIRECTIONS.
8.FRAME SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO PAVEMENT GRADE BY
TAPPING UNTIL FRAME IS FLUSH WITH PAVEMENT AS
DETERMINED WITH A STRAIGHT EDGE OF SUFFICIENT
LENGTH.
9.ALL MORTAR JOINTS SHALL BE TRIMMED FLUSH AND
REMAIN VISIBLE UPON COMPLETION.
CATCH BASIN FRAME AND VANED
GRATE PER STD. PLAN 204.00
RECTANGULAR OR CIRCULAR ADJUSTMENT
SECTION (TWO SECTIONS MAX.)
MORTAR, (TYP.), SEE NOTE 5
FLAT SLAB TOP
SEE NOTE 6, TYP.
REINFORCING STEEL, (TYP.)
GRAVEL BACKFILL FOR PIPE ZONE
BEDDING PER WSDOT STD.
SPECIFICATION SECTION 9-03.12(3)
INTEGRAL BASE
PRECAST WITH RISER
STEPS OR
LADDER
4" MIN.
16" MAX.28" MAX.
48", 54", 60", 72", 84",
96", 120" OR 144"
12" (TYP.)
24"
MIN.
12" MAX.
1" MIN.
2.5" MAX.
12"
6"
15' MAX. FOR
MAINTENANCE
SEPARATE BASE
PRECAST
O" RING
12"
6"
CATCH BASIN DIMENSIONS
CATCH BASIN
DIAMETER
MIN. WALL
THICKNESS
MIN. BASE
THICKNESS
MAXIMUM
KNOCKOUT SIZE
MINIMUM
DISTANCE
BETWEEN
KNOCKOUTS
48"4"6"36"8"
54"4.5"8"42"8"
60"5"8"48"8"
72"6"8"60"12"
84"8"12"72"12"
96"8"12"84"12"
120"10"12"96"12"
144"12"12"108"12"
PIPE ALLOWANCES
CATCH BASIN
DIAMETER
PIPE MATERIAL WITH MAXIMUM INSIDE DIAMETER
CONCRETE ALL METAL CPSSP 1 SOLID WALL
PVC 2
PROFILE WALL
PVC 3
48"24"30"24"30"30"
54"30"36"30"36"36"
60"36"42"36"42"42"
72"42"54"42"48"48"
84"54"60"54"48"48"
96"60"72"60"48"48"
120"66"84"60"48"48"
144"78"96"60"48"48"
1 CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE STORM SEWER PIPE (STD. SPEC. 9-05.20)
2 STD. SPEC. 9-05.12(1)
3 STD. SPEC. 9-05.12(2)
CATCH BASIN TYPE 2
STD. PLAN - 201.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
FRAME AND VANED GRATE
ADJUSTMENT SECTION
NOTES:
1.THE COVER OR GRATING OF A CATCH BASIN SHALL NOT BE ADJUSTED TO FINAL GRADE UNTIL THE FINAL ELEVATION OF THE PAVEMENT, GUTTER,
DITCH, OR SIDEWALK IN WHICH IT IS TO BE PLACED HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, AND UNTIL PERMISSION THEREAFTER IS GIVEN BY THE ENGINEER TO
MORTAR IN PLACE IN ACCORDANCE WITH WSDOT/APWA STANDARD SPECIFICATION 7-05.3.
2.SHIMS SHALL NOT BE USED TO SET FRAME TO GRADE. THE USE OF SHIMS IS PROHIBITED.
3.A CONTINUOUS LAYER OF MORTAR SHALL BE PLACED BETWEEN ADJUSTMENT RINGS AND BRICKS PRIOR TO PLACEMENT.
4.ONLY BY APPROVAL OF THE CITY, THE USE OF BRICKS IS PERMITTED WHERE THE BRICKS ARE STAGGERED TO CREATE A RUNNING BOND OR 12 BOND.
5.BASE SECTION SHALL BE SEALED TO THE BOTTOM AREA OF THE ADJUSTMENT SECTION WITH MORTAR.
6.MORTAR SHALL MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF WSDOT/APWA STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-04.3.
7.PICK / LIFTING HOLES ARE TO BE GROUTED WATER TIGHT. USE GROUT TYPE 2 FOR NON-SHRINK APPLICATIONS IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD
SPECIFICATION 9-20.3(2).
8.MORTAR SHALL BE MIXED AND APPLIED PER MANUFACTURER'S DIRECTIONS.
9.FRAME SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO PAVEMENT GRADE BY TAPPING UNTIL FRAME IS FLUSH WITH PAVEMENT AS DETERMINED WITH A STRAIGHT EDGE OF
SUFFICIENT LENGTH.
10.ALL MORTAR JOINTS SHALL BE TRIMMED FLUSH AND REMAIN VISIBLE UPON COMPLETION.
BASE SECTION
SEE NOTE 4
CLEAN SURFACE AND BOTTOM AREA.
PROVIDE UNIFORM CONTACT. THE SURFACE
AREA OF THE BASE SECTION MUST BE
MORTARED TO THE BOTTOM AREA OF THE
ADJUSTMENT SECTION
CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION
STD. PLAN - 202.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
NOTES:
1.THIS FRAME IS DESIGNED TO ACCOMMODATE 20" × 24" GRATES OR COVERS,SEE
STANDARD PLANS 204.10, 204.20, AND 204.30.2.
BOLT-DOWN CAPABILITY IS REQUIRED ON ALL FRAMES, GRATES, AND COVERS,
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. PROVIDE TWO HOLES IN THE FRAME
THAT ARE VERTICALLY ALIGNED WITH THE GRATE OR COVER SLOTS.THE
FRAME SHALL ACCEPT THE 5/8"-11 NC x 2" ALLEN HEAD CAP SCREW BY BEING
TAPPED, OR OTHER APPROVED MECHANISM. LOCATION OF BOLT-
DOWN HOLES VARIES BY MANUFACTURER.3.
REFER TO STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-05.15(2) FOR ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS.
GRATE
FRAME
SEE
NOTE 2 RECESSED
ALLEN HEAD
CAP SCREW 5/
8" - 11 NC x 2"SECTION
A DETAIL
TOP
ISOMETRIC
VIEW BOLT-
DOWN HOLE (TYP.) ~ 5/8",11
NC, SEE DETAIL AND NOTE 2 29
1/4"25
1/4"SECTION
BOLT-DOWN DETAIL 24
1/4"SEE
DETAIL 3/
4"4
1/2"1
5/8"2
1/2"1
5/8"1
1/4"3/
4"7/
8"1/
8"ARECTANGULAR
FRAME STD.
PLAN - 204.00 PUBLIC
WORKS DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin
PastuchaPublic
Works Administrator UNLESS
OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)DocuSign
Envelope ID: E212B987-C626-4330-A5D4-D055A0107AF9 10/
19/2022 | 2:52 PM PDT
NOTES:
ISOMETRIC
SECTION B
TOPFOUNDRY
NAMEDIFLOW
SECTION A
1.BOLT-DOWN CAPABILITY IS REQUIRED ON ALL FRAMES, GRATES, AND
COVERS, UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. PROVIDE TWO HOLES IN
THE FRAME THAT ARE VERTICALLY ALIGNED WITH THE GRATE OR
COVER SLOTS. THE FRAME SHALL ACCEPT THE 5/8"-11 NC x 2" ALLEN
HEAD CAP SCREW BY BEING TAPPED, OR OTHER APPROVED
MECHANISM. LOCATION OF BOLT-DOWN HOLES VARIES BY
MANUFACTURER.
2.REFER TO STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-05.15(2) FOR ADDITIONAL
REQUIREMENTS.
3.FOR FRAME DETAILS, SEE STANDARD PLAN 204.00.
FLOWFLOWBOLT-DOWN SLOT DETAIL
SEE NOTE 1
1/2"
3/4"
1 1/4"
5/8"
BOLT-DOWN SLOT,
SEE DETAIL AND
NOTE 1
20"
5"
5"
5"
3"
1"
3"
5"
5"
5"
DIRECTION OF FLOW
24"
7 OR 8 EQUAL SPACES
1 5/8" MAX.
A
BOUTFALL TO STREAM DUMP NO POLLUTANTS
3/8" RECESSED LETTERING
RECTANGULAR VANED GRATE
STD. PLAN - 204.20
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
ISOMETRIC
NOTES:
SECTION B
TOPFOUNDRY
NAMEDIFLOW
SECTION A
1.BOLT-DOWN CAPABILITY IS REQUIRED ON ALL FRAMES, GRATES, AND
COVERS, UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. PROVIDE TWO HOLES IN
THE FRAME THAT ARE VERTICALLY ALIGNED WITH THE GRATE OR
COVER SLOTS. THE FRAME SHALL ACCEPT THE 5/8"-11 NC x 2" ALLEN
HEAD CAP SCREW BY BEING TAPPED, OR OTHER APPROVED
MECHANISM. LOCATION OF BOLT-DOWN HOLES VARIES BY
MANUFACTURER.
2.REFER TO STANDARD SPECIFICATION 9-05.15(2) FOR ADDITIONAL
REQUIREMENTS.
3.USE ONLY IN SAGS ON VERTICAL CURVES.
4.FOR FRAME DETAILS, SEE STANDARD PLAN 204.00.
FLOWFLOWBOLT-DOWN SLOT DETAIL
SEE NOTE 1
1/2"
3/4"
1 1/4"
5/8"
BOLT-DOWN SLOT,
SEE DETAIL AND
NOTE 1
20"
5"
5"
5"
3"
1"
3"
5"
5"
5"
24"
1 5/8" MAX.
4 EQUAL SPACES 4 EQUAL SPACES
A
BOUTFALL TO STREAM DUMP NO POLLUTANTS
3/8" RECESSED LETTERING
RECTANGULAR BI-DIRECTIONAL
VANED GRATE
STD. PLAN - 204.30
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
COVER SECTION VIEW ASTM A48 CL35B00371780MO/
DA/YR X3717C1PTEON
BOLTING DETAIL GASKET
GROOVE DETAIL FRAME
SECTION VIEW
COVER
BOTTOM
VIEW
PLAN VIEW DRAINIFCOMADEINUSA EJIW DUMPNO P OL LU T
A
N
T
S -
DRAINS T O S T REAMR
E
N T O N NOTES:1.ALL COVERS SHALL BE LOCKING
LID PER EJ
No. 3717C1 OR
APPROVED EQUAL.1/2"
LETTERING BOLT HOLES - 3 PLACES
EQUALLY SPACED 120° APART ON 23
1/16" DIA. B.
C.1 1/4"
LETTERING 1)
1" DIA.
PICKHOLE
25" DIA.3/
4"1"2
1/
2"8 3/4"TYP.)
3) BLT SOC. (ALLEN HEAD)5/8"-11
x
1.5
SS RUBBER WASHER 5/
8"25 1/4"
DIA.26 1/2" DIA.23
3/8" DIA. CL
OPEN 27 5/16"
DIA.34 1/
8" DIA.1
1/16"6"1/8"
1/4"
1 1/16"R1/8"
1/4" DIA. NEOPRENE GASKET
STORM
ROUND FRAME AND COVER
PUBLIC)STD.
PLAN -
204.
50PUBLIC
WORKS DEPARTMENT APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha Public Works Administrator UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING
IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)DocuSign Envelope ID:
3B1B34D3-7E0A-476C-ADB3-4329FFE0C108 8/13/
5"
ECCENTRIC CONE SECTION
72" FLAT SLAB TOP
RECTANGULAR ADJUSTMENT SECTION
CIRCULAR ADJUSTMENT SECTION
PREFABRICATED LADDER
STEP
84" or 96" FLAT SLAB TOP
NOTES:
1.AS AN ACCEPTABLE ALTERNATIVE TO REBAR, WIRE MESH HAVING A MINIMUM AREA OF
0.12 SQUARE INCHES PER FOOT MAY BE USED FOR ADJUSTMENT SECTIONS.
48", 54", or 60" FLAT SLAB TOP
20"x24", 24" DIA.,
48" DIA., OR 54"
DIA. HOLE
6 BARS @ 7" SPACING
12"
2" (TYP.)
1" MIN.
2 1/2" MAX.
12" (TYP.)
12"
9"
6"
48"
MAX.
24"
MIN.
5 BARS @ 6" SPACING
20"x24", 24" DIA.,
48" DIA., OR 54"
DIA. HOLE
8"
2" (TYP.)
1" MIN.
2 1/2" MAX.
TYPICAL ORIENTATION
FOR ACCESS AND STEPS
6"
9 1/2" MAX.
12"
MIN.
48" MIN.
24"
MIN.
18" MIN.
42" MAX.
4 BARS @ 6" SPACING
20"x24" OR
24" DIA. HOLE
8"
2" (TYP.)
1" MIN.
2 1/2" MAX.
34"
ONE #3 BAR HOOP FOR 6"
HEIGHT INCREMENT (SPACED
EQUALLY), SEE NOTE 1
34"
24"
30
20
5"
5"
1", 2", 4", 6", 12", OR 24"
ONE #3 BAR HOOP FOR 6" HEIGHT
INCREMENT (SPACED EQUALLY),
SEE NOTE 1
1", 2", 4", 6",
12", OR 24"
MISCELLANEOUS DETAILS FOR
DRAINAGE STRUCTURES
STD. PLAN - 204.60
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
1.CONDITIONS OF USE
1.1.TO ESTABLISH CLEARING LIMITS, STAKE AND WIRE FENCE MAY BE USED:
1.1.1.AT THE BOUNDARY OF CRITICAL AREAS, THEIR BUFFERS AND OTHER AREAS REQUIRED TO BE LEFT UNCLEARED.
1.1.2.AS NECESSARY TO CONTROL VEHICLE ACCESS TO AND ON THE SITE.
2.MAINTENANCE AND REQUIREMENTS
2.1.IF THE FENCE IS DAMAGED OR VISIBILITY REDUCED, IT SHALL BE REPAIRED OR REPLACED IMMEDIATELY AND VISIBILITY RESTORED.
2.2.DISTURBANCE OF A CRITICAL AREA, CRITICAL BUFFER AREA, NATIVE GROWTH RETENTION AREA, OR OTHER AREA REQUIRED TO BE
LEFT UNDISTURBED SHALL BE REPORTED TO THE CITY OF RENTON FOR RESOLUTION.
2.3.THE CITY MAY REQUIRE MORE SUBSTANTIAL FENCING IF THE FENCE DOES NOT PREVENT ENCROACHMENT INTO THOSE AREAS THAT
ARE NOT TO BE DISTURBED.
NOTES
SURVEYFLAGGINGBAILINGWIRE
DO NOT NAIL OR STAPLE WIRE
TO TREES
METAL FENCE POST (TYP.)3' MIN.
10' - 20'
12" MIN.
STAKE AND WIRE FENCE
STD. PLAN - 212.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
WOODEN STAKE
LIVE STAKE
ROLL SPACING
DEPENDS ON SOIL
TYPE AND SLOPE
STEEPNESS
STRAW ROLLS MUST BE
PLACED ALONG SLOPE
CONTOURS
4'
3'-30', SEE NOTE 2.3
SEDIMENT, ORGANIC MATTER,
AND NATIVE SEEDS ARE
CAPTURED BEHIND THE ROLLS
ADJACENT ROLLS SHALL
TIGHTLY ABUT
8"-10" DIA.
3"-5", SEE NOTE 2.2
NOTES:
1.CONDITIONS OF USE
1.1.INSTALL ON DISTURBED AREAS THAT REQUIRE IMMEDIATE EROSION PROTECTION.
1.2.USE ON SLOPES REQUIRING STABILIZATION UNTIL PERMANENT VEGETATION CAN BE ESTABLISHED.
1.3.CAN BE USED ALONG THE PERIMETER OF A PROJECT, AS A CHECK DAM IN UNLINED DITCHES AND AROUND TEMPORARY STOCKPILES.
1.4.WATTLES CAN BE STAKED TO THE GROUND USING WILLOW CUTTINGS FOR ADDED REVEGETATION.
1.5.RILLING CAN OCCUR BENEATH AND BETWEEN WATTLES IF NOT PROPERLY ENTRENCHED, ALLOWING WATER TO PASS BELOW AND BETWEEN WATTLES.
2.DESIGN AND INSTALLATION SPECIFICATIONS
2.1.IT IS CRITICAL THAT WATTLES ARE INSTALLED PERPENDICULAR TO THE FLOW DIRECTION AND PARALLEL TO THE SLOPE CONTOUR.
2.2.NARROW TRENCHES SHOULD BE DUG ACROSS THE SLOPE, ON CONTOUR, TO A DEPTH OF 3 TO 5 INCHES ON CLAY SOILS AND SOILS WITH GRADUAL SLOPES.
ON LOOSE SOILS, STEEP SLOPES, AND DURING HIGH RAINFALL EVENTS, THE TRENCHES SHOULD BE DUG TO A DEPTH OF 5 TO 7 INCHES, OR 1/2 TO 2/3 OF THE
THICKNESS OF THE WATTLE.
2.3.START CONSTRUCTION OF TRENCHES AND INSTALLING WATTLES FROM THE BASE OF THE SLOPE AND WORK UPHILL. EXCAVATED MATERIAL SHOULD BE
SPREAD EVENLY ALONG THE UPHILL SLOPE AND COMPACTED USING HAND TAMPING OR OTHER METHOD. CONSTRUCT TRENCHES AT CONTOUR INTERVALS
OF 3 TO 30 FEET APART DEPENDING ON THE STEEPNESS OF THE SLOPE, SOIL TYPE, AND RAINFALL. THE STEEPER THE SLOPE THE CLOSER TOGETHER THE
TRENCHES SHOULD BE CONSTRUCTED. VERTICAL DISTANCE BETWEEN WATTLES IS NOT TO EXCEED 10 FEET.
2.4.INSTALL THE WATTLES SNUGLY INTO THE TRENCHES AND ABUT TIGHTLY END TO END. DO NOT OVERLAP THE ENDS.
2.5.INSTALL STAKES AT EACH END OF THE WATTLE, AND AT 4 FOOT CENTERS ALONG THE ENTIRE LENGTH OF THE WATTLE.
2.6.IF REQUIRED, INSTALL PILOT HOLES FOR THE STAKES USING A STRAIGHT BAR TO DRIVE HOLES THROUGH THE WATTLE AND INTO THE SOIL.
2.7.AT A MINIMUM, WOODEN STAKES SHOULD BE APPROXIMATELY 3/4 X 3/4 X 24 INCHES. WILLOW CUTTINGS OR 3/8-INCH REBAR CAN ALSO BE USED FOR STAKES.
2.8.STAKES SHOULD BE DRIVEN THROUGH THE MIDDLE OF THE WATTLE, LEAVING 2 TO 3 INCHES OF THE STAKE PROTRUDING ABOVE THE WATTLE.
3.MAINTENANCE STANDARDS
3.1.INSPECT WATTLES PRIOR TO FORECASTED RAIN, DAILY DURING EXTENDED RAIN EVENTS, AFTER RAIN EVENTS, WEEKLY DURING THE WET SEASON, AND AT
TWO WEEK INTERVALS AT ALL OTHER TIMES OF THE YEAR.
3.2.REPAIR OR REPLACE SPLIT, TORN, RAVELING, OR SLUMPING WATTLES
3.3.REMOVE SEDIMENT ACCUMULATIONS WHEN EXCEEDING 1/2 THE HEIGHT BETWEEN THE TOP OF THE WATTLE AND THE GROUND SURFACE.
STRAW WATTLES
STD. PLAN - 213.40
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
1.CONDITIONS OF USE
1.1.SILT FENCE MAY BE USED DOWNSLOPE OF ALL DISTURBED AREAS.
1.2.SILT FENCE IS NOT INTENDED TO TREAT CONCENTRATED FLOWS, NOR IS IT INTENDED TO TREAT SUBSTANTIAL AMOUNTS OF OVERLAND FLOW. ANY CONCENTRATED
FLOW MUST BE CONVEYED THROUGH THE DRAINAGE SYSTEM TO A SEDIMENT TRAP OR POND.
2.DESIGN AND INSTALLATION SPECIFICATIONS
2.1.THE GEOTEXTILE USED MUST MEET THE STANDARD LISTED BELLOW. A COPY OF THE MANUFACTURER'S FABRIC SPECIFICATIONS MUST BE AVAILABLE ON SITE.
2.2.STANDARD STRENGTH FABRIC REQUIRES WIRE BACKING TO INCREASE THE STRENGTH OF THE FENCE. WIRE BACKING OR CLOSER POST SPACING MAY BE REQUIRED
FOR EXTRA STRENGTH FABRIC IF FIELD PERFORMANCE WARRANTS A STRONGER FENCE.
2.3.WHERE THE FENCE IS INSTALLED, THE SLOPE SHALL NOT BE STEEPER THAN 2H:1V
2.4.IF A TYPICAL SILT FENCE IS USED, THE STANDARD 4"X4" TRENCH MAY BE REDUCED AS LONG AS THE BOTTOM 8 INCHES OF THE SILT FENCE FABRIC IS WELL BURIED AND
SECURE IN A TRENCH THAT STABILIZES THE FENCE AND DOES NOT ALLOW WATER TO BYPASS OR UNDERMINE THE SILT FENCE.
2.5.FILTER FABRIC FENCES SHALL BE INSTALLED ALONG CONTOURS WHENEVER POSSIBLE.
3.MAINTENANCE STANDARDS
3.1.ANY DAMAGE SHALL BE REPAIRED IMMEDIATELY.
3.2.IF CONCENTRATED FLOWS ARE EVIDENT UPHILL OF THE FENCE, THEY MUST BE INTERCEPTED AND CONVEYED TO A SEDIMENT TRAP OR POND.
3.3.IT IS IMPORTANT TO CHECK THE UPHILL SIDE OF THE FENCE FOR SIGNS OF THE FENCE CLOGGING AND ACTING AS A BARRIER TO FLOW AND THEN CAUSING
CHANNELIZATION OF FLOWS PARALLEL TO THE FENCE. IF THIS OCCURS, REPLACE THE FENCE OR REMOVE THE TRAPPED SEDIMENT.
3.4.SEDIMENT MUST BE REMOVED WHEN SEDIMENT IS 6 INCHES HIGH.
3.5.IF THE FILTER FABRIC (GEOTEXTILE) HAS DETERIORATED DUE TO ULTRAVIOLET BREAKDOWN, IT SHALL BE REPLACED.
NOTES:
JOINTS IN FILTER FABRIC SHALL BE SPLICED AT
POSTS. USE STAPLES, WIRE RINGS, OR
EQUIVALENT TO ATTACH FABRIC TO POSTS
2"x2" 14 GAUGE WIRE, OR
EQUIVALENT, IF STANDARD
STRENGTH FABRIC USED
FILTER FABRIC
2' MIN.
12" MIN.
4"x4" MIN. TRENCH
BACKFILL TRENCH WITH NATIVE SOIL
OR 3/4" TO 1-1/2" WASHED GRAVEL
2"x4" WOOD POSTS, STEEL FENCE POSTS, OR EQUIVALENT (TYP.)
6' MAX.
POST SPACING MAY BE INCREASED
TO 8' IF WIRE BACKING IS USED
AOS (ASTM D4751)
30-100 SIEVE SIZE (0.60-0.15mm) FOR SILT FILM
50-100 SIEVE SIZE (0.30-0.15mm) FOR OTHER FABRICS
WATER PERMITTIVITY (ASTM D4491)0.02 SEC-1 MINIMUM
GRAB TENSILE STRENGTH (ASTM D4632)
180 LBS. MIN. FOR EXTRA STRENGTH FABRIC
100 LBS. MIN. FOR STANDARD STRENGTH FABRIC
GRAB TENSILE ELONGATION (ASTM D4632)30% MAX. (WOVEN)
ULTRAVIOLET RESISTANCE (ASTM D4355)70% MIN.
SILT FENCE
STD. PLAN - 214.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
ATTACHMENT DETAILS:
1.GATHER FABRIC AT POSTS, IF NEEDED.
2.UTILIZE THREE TIES PER POST, ALL WITHIN TOP 8" OF
FABRIC.
3.POSITION EACH TIE DIAGONALLY, PUNCTURING HOLES
VERTICALLY A MINIMUM OF 1" APART.
4.HANG EACH TIE ON A POST NIPPLE AND TIGHTEN
SECURELY. USE CABLE TIES (50 LBS) OR SOFT WIRE.
TOP OF FABRIC
BELT
DIAGONAL ATTACHMENT
DOUBLES STRENGTH
FLOW
STEEL
SUPPORT POSTNOTES:1.POST SPACING: 7' MAX. ON OPEN RUNS 4' MAX. ON
POOLING AREAS.2.POST DEPTH: AS MUCH BELOW GROUND AS FABRIC
ABOVE GROUND.3.PONDING HEIGHT 24" MAX. ATTACH FABRIC TO UPSTREAM SIDE
OF POST.4.DRIVE OVER EACH SIDE OF SILT FENCE 2 TO 4 TIMES WITH DEVICE EXERTING 60 P.S.I.
OR GREATER.5.NO MORE THAN 24" OF A 36" FABRIC ROLL IS ALLOWED
ABOVE GROUND.6.VIBRATORY PLOW IS NOT ACCEPTABLE BECAUSE OF
HORIZONTAL COMPACTION.
100% COMPACTION
EACH
SIDE OPERATION
SILT FENCE
TOP 8"
200-300mm
8"-12")ROLL OF
SILT
FENCE PLOW FABRIC
ABOVE GROUND SLICING BLADE (18mm (11/
16") WIDTH)HORIZONTAL CHISEL POINT (76mm (
3") WIDTH)SILT FENCE INSTALLATION
BY SLICING STD. PLAN -
214.10
PUBLIC
WORKS
DEPARTMENTAPPROVED:
DATEGregg Zimmerman Public
Works Administrator UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO
SCALE (NTS)DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-
B436-A317AA638878 9/28/2018 | 9:45
NOTES:
SECTION VIEW
ISOMETRIC VIEW
DRAINAGE GRATE TRIM
GRATE FRAME
FILTERED
WATER
SEDIMENT AND DEBRIS
OVERFLOW BYPASS
BELOW INLET GRATE DEVICE
DRAINAGE GRATE
RECTANGULAR GRATE SHOWN)RETRIEVAL SYSTEM (TYP.)
OVERFLOW BYPASS (TYP.)
BELOW INLET GRATE DEVICE
1.PROTECTION SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR ALL STORM DRAIN INLETS DOWNSLOPE AND WITHIN 500 FEET OF A DISTURBED OR
CONSTRUCTION AREA, UNLESS THE RUNOFF THAT ENTERS THE CATCH BASIN WILL BE CONVEYED TO A SEDIMENT POND OR TRAP.
2.INLET PROTECTION SHALL BE USED TO PROTECT THE DRAINAGE SYSTEM.
3.THE CONTRIBUTING DRAINAGE AREA MUST NOT BE LARGER THAN ONE ACRE.
4.SIZE THE BELOW INLET GRATE DEVICE (BIGD) FOR THE STORMWATER STRUCTURE IT WILL SERVICE.
5.THE BIGD SHALL HAVE A BUILT-IN HIGH-FLOW RELIEF SYSTEM (OVERFLOW BYPASS).
6.THE RETRIEVAL SYSTEM MUST ALLOW REMOVAL OF THE BIGD WITHOUT SPILLING THE COLLECTED MATERIAL.
7.PERFORM MAINTENANCE IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD SPECIFICATION 8-01.3(15).
8.ANY SEDIMENT IN THE CATCH BASIN INSERT SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN THE SEDIMENT HAS FILLED ONE-THIRD OF THE AVAILABLE
STORAGE. THE FILTER MEDIA FOR THE INSERT SHALL BE CLEANED OR REPLACED AT LEAST MONTHLY.
5" MAX.
CATCH BASIN INSERT
STD. PLAN - 216.30
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
RUNOFF
RUNOFF
SPILLWAY
NOTES:
1.PROTECTION SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR ALL STORM DRAIN INLETS DOWNSLOPE AND WITHIN 500 FEET OF A
DISTURBED OR CONSTRUCTION AREA, UNLESS THE RUNOFF THAT ENTERS THE CATCH BASIN WILL BE
CONVEYED TO A SEDIMENT POND OR TRAP.
2.INLET PROTECTION SHALL BE USED TO PROTECT THE DRAINAGE SYSTEM.
3.THE CONTRIBUTING DRAINAGE AREA MUST NOT BE LARGER THAN ONE ACRE.
4.PLACE CURB TYPE SEDIMENT BARRIERS ON GENTLY SLOPING STREET SEGMENTS, WHERE WATER CAN POND
AND ALLOW SEDIMENT TO SEPARATE FROM RUNOFF.
5.SANDBAGS OF EITHER BURLAP OR WOVEN GEOTEXTILE FABRIC, SHALL BE FILLED WITH GRAVEL, LAYERED
AND PACKED TIGHTLY.
6.LEAVE A ONE SANDBAG GAP IN THE TOP ROW TO PROVIDE A SPILLWAY FOR OVERFLOW.
7.INSPECT BARRIERS AND REMOVE SEDIMENT AFTER EACH STORM EVENT. SEDIMENT AND GRAVEL MUST BE
REMOVED FROM THE TRAVELED WAY IMMEDIATELY.
8.CURB AND GUTTER BARRIER PROTECTION MAY ONLY BE USED IN LANES NOT OPEN TO TRAFFIC.
BACK OF SIDEWALK
CURB INLET
CURB FACE
GUTTER
DRAIN GRATE
SANDBAGS TO OVERLAP ONTO CURB
GRAVEL FILLED SANDBAGS STACKED TIGHTLY
CURB AND GUTTER BARRIER
PROTECTION
STD. PLAN - 216.50
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
RIGID PIPE NOTES:
1.PIPE COMPACTION LIMITS SHOWN ON THIS PLAN ARE FOR PIPE
CONSTRUCTION IN AN EMBANKMENT. FOR PIPE CONSTRUCTION IN
A TRENCH, THE HORIZONTAL LIMITS OF THE PIPE COMPACTION
ZONE SHALL BE THE WALLS OF THE TRENCH.
2.O.D. IS EQUAL TO THE OUTSIDE DIAMETER OF A PIPE OR THE
OUTSIDE SPAN OF PIPE-ARCH.
3.SEE STANDARD WSDOT/APWA SPECIFICATIONS SECTION 2-09.4 FOR
TRENCH WIDTH.
4.PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND BACKFILL MATERIAL SHALL BE PLACED IN
6" LOOSE LAYERS AND COMPACTED TO 95% MAXIMUM DENSITY.
5.EXCAVATE UNSTABLE MATERIAL DOWN TO FIRM SOIL AND REPLACE
WITH FOUNDATION MATERIAL CLASS A OR B PER STANDARD
WSDOT/APWA SPECIFICATIONS SECTION 9-03.17.
GRAVEL BACKFILL FOR PIPE ZONE BEDDING (WSDOT 9-03.12(3))
OR MAINTENANCE ROCK (WSDOT 9-03.9(4))
CIRCULAR PIPE
FOUNDATION MATERIAL,
IF REQUIRED, SEE NOTE 5
SPAN
6"
PIPE - ARCH
6"
PIPE TYPE
MINIMUM
COVER (FT)PUBLIC?PRIVATE?
ALLOWED IN ZONE 1
OF THE APA?
CORRUGATED
STEEL PIPE
2.0 YES YES YES
SPIRAL RIB STEEL
PIPE
2.0 YES YES YES
PLAIN CONCRETE
PIPE (PCP)
2.0 NO YES NO
REINFORCED
CONCRETE PIPE
RCP)
1.0 YES YES NO
DUCTILE IRON PIPE 1.0 YES YES YES
FOUNDATION
LEVEL
RISE
TRENCH WIDTH,
SEE NOTE 3
CIRCULAR PIPE
DIAMETER
MINIMUM DISTANCE
BETWEEN BARRELS
12" TO 24"12"
30" TO 96"DIAMETER / 3
102" TO 180"48"
PIPE-ARCH
SPAN
MINIMUM DISTANCE
BETWEEN BARRELS
18" TO 36"12"
43" TO 142"SPAN / 3
148" TO 199"48"
TRENCH WIDTH,
SEE NOTE 3
6"
O.D.
6"
FOUNDATION
LEVEL
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND
BACKFILL, SEE NOTE 4
FOUNDATION MATERIAL,
IF REQUIRED, SEE NOTE 5
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND
BACKFILL, SEE NOTE 4
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND
COMPACTION - RIGID PIPE
STD. PLAN - 220.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartinPastucha
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: E212B987-C626-4330-A5D4-D055A0107AF9
10/19/2022 | 2:52 PM PDT
FLEXIBLE PIPE NOTES:
1.PROVIDE UNIFORM SUPPORT UNDER BARRELS.
2.HAND TAMP UNDER HAUNCHES.
3.DIRECTLY OVER PIPE, HAND TAMP ONLY.
4.SEE STANDARD WSDOT/APWA SPECIFICATIONS SECTION 2-09.4 FOR
TRENCH WIDTH.
5.PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND BACKFILL MATERIAL SHALL BE PLACED IN 6"
LOOSE LAYERS AND COMPACTED TO 95% MAXIMUM DENSITY.
6.EXCAVATE UNSTABLE MATERIAL DOWN TO FIRM SOIL AND REPLACE WITH
FOUNDATION MATERIAL CLASS A OR B PER STANDARD WSDOT/APWA
SPECIFICATIONS SECTION 9-03.17.
SEE NOTE 4,
LIMIT OF PIPE ZONE
6"
O.D.
6"
FOUNDATION
LEVEL
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND
BACKFILL, SEE NOTE 5
FLEXIBLE PIPE
PIPE TYPE
MINIMUM
COVER (FT)
PUBLIC?PRIVATE?
ALLOWED IN ZONE 1
OF THE APA?
LINE CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE PIPE (LCPE)2.0 YES YES YES
CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE PIPE (CPE) - TRIPLE WALL 2.0 YES YES YES
POLYVINYL CHLORIDE PIPE (PVC)3.0 YES YES YES
SOLID WALL HIGH DENSITY POLYETHYLENE PIPE (HDPE)2.0 YES YES YES
POLYPROPYLENE PIPE (PP) - DUAL WALL 2.0 YES YES YES
DIAMETER
MINIMUM DISTANCE
BETWEEN BARRELS
12" TO 24"12"
30" TO 96"DIAMETER / 3
102" TO 180"48"
GRAVEL BACKFILL FOR PIPE ZONE BEDDING (WSDOT 9-03.12(3))
OR MAINTENANCE ROCK (WSDOT 9-03.9(4))
FOUNDATION MATERIAL,
IF REQUIRED, SEE NOTE 6
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND
COMPACTION - FLEXIBLE PIPE
STD. PLAN - 220.10
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartinPastucha
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 3B1B34D3-7E0A-476C-ADB3-4329FFE0C108
8/13/2020 | 8:48 AM PDT
12" MIN.
6" MIN. , SEE NOTE 4
EXISTING PAVEMENT SURFACE
SURFACE RESTORATION AS
SPECIFIED IN CONTRACT DOCUMENTS
CRUSHED SURFACING TOP COURSE" PER
WSDOT STD. SPEC 9-03.9(3), "BANK RUN
GRAVEL FOR TRENCH BACKFILL" PER
WSDOT STD. SPEC 9-03.19, OR "GRAVEL
BORROW" PER WSDOT STD. SPEC 9-03.14(1),
COMPACTED TO 95% OF MAXIMUM DENSITY
BENCH AS NEEDED FOR
SHORING SYSTEM WHEN
DEPTH IS 4' OR GREATER
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND BACKFILL
PER STD. PLANS 220.00 AND 220.10
PIPE
NEAT LINE TRENCH
UNPAVED AREAS PAVED AREAS
SEE NOTE 1
NOTES:
1.SEE WSDOT/APWA STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS SECTION 2-09.4 FOR
MEASUREMENT OF TRENCH WIDTH.
2.EXCAVATIONS OVER 4' DEEP SHALL COMPLY WITH THE SAFETY STANDARD
DESCRIBED IN CHAPTER 295-155 PART N OF THE WAC.
3.MAXIMUM BACKFILL DEPTH ABOVE PIPE SHALL NOT BE EXCEEDED, AS
DETERMINED BY PIPE MANUFACTURER.
4.IN PAVED AREAS, IF PIPE HAS LESS THAN 3' OF COVER, USE "CRUSHED
SURFACING TOP COURSE" FOR THE ENTIRE BACKFILL DEPTH ABOVE PIPE ZONE.
5.SEE CONSTRUCTION PLANS FOR SPECIFIC PROJECT REQUIREMENTS.
SEE STANDARD PLANS 110, 110.1, 110.2, AND 111 FOR PAVEMENT
RESTORATION REQUIREMENTS
CRUSHED SURFACING TOP COURSE" PER
WSDOT STD. SPEC 9-03.9(3), COMPACTED
TO 95% OF MAXIMUM DENSITY
TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL
STD. PLAN - 220.20
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
RECYCLED CONCRETE AGGREGATE
SHALL NOT BE USED AS BEDDING
OR BACKFILL IN THE PIPE ZONE OR
AS TRENCH BACKFILL
FOR STORM PIPE
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN
NOTES (1 OF 2)
STD. PLAN - 267.00
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartinPastucha
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN NOTES:
THE FOLLOWING IS A LISTING OF GENERAL NOTES THAT SHALL BE INCORPORATED IN THE DRAINAGE PLAN SET. ALL THE NOTES ON THE LIST MAY NOT PERTAIN TO EVERY
PROJECT. THE APPLICANT OR OWNER, HEREBY REFERRED TO AS APPLICANT, MAY STRIKE OUT IRRELEVANT NOTES IF NOT APPLICABLE TO THE PROJECT. HOWEVER, THE
APPLICANT SHALL NOT RENUMBER NOR EDIT THE REMAINING NOTES. IF ADDITIONAL NOTES ARE NEEDED FOR SPECIFIC ASPECTS, THEY SHALL BE ADDED AFTER THE
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN NOTES.
1.BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION OR DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITY OCCURS, A PRE-CONSTRUCTION MEETING SHALL BE HELD AMONG THE CITY OF RENTON, HEREBY
REFERRED TO AS THE CITY, THE APPLICANT, AND THE APPLICANT'S CONTRACTOR.
2.THE APPLICANT SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR SECURING ALL NECESSARY CITY, STATE, AND FEDERAL PERMITS PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
3.ALL STORM DRAINAGE IMPROVEMENTS SHALL BE DESIGNED AND CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LATEST EDITION OF THE CITY OF RENTON SURFACE
WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM), RENTON MUNICIPAL CODE (RMC), AND THE STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS FOR ROAD, BRIDGE AND MUNICIPAL
CONSTRUCTION PREPARED BY WSDOT AND THE AMERICAN PUBLIC WORKS ASSOCIATION (APWA). IT SHALL BE THE SOLE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT TO
CORRECT ANY ERROR, OMISSION OR VARIATION FROM THE ABOVE REQUIREMENTS FOUND IN THE PLANS. ALL CORRECTIONS SHALL BE AT NO ADDITIONAL COST TO
THE CITY.
4.APPROVAL OF THE ROAD, GRADING, PARKING, BUILDING, AND DRAINAGE PLAN DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AS APPROVAL OF ANY OTHER CONSTRUCTION (E.G. WATER,
SEWER, GAS, ELECTRICAL. ETC.). PLANS FOR STRUCTURES SUCH AS BRIDGES, VAULTS, AND RETAINING WALLS REQUIRE A SEPARATE REVIEW AND APPROVAL BY
THE CITY PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION. THE SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE SYSTEM SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED ACCORDING TO THE APPROVED PLANS. ANY DEVIATION
FROM THE APPROVED PLANS WILL REQUIRE COORDINATION FOLLOWED BY WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM THE CITY.
5.A COPY OF THE APPROVED PLANS SHALL BE ON THE JOB SITE WHENEVER CONSTRUCTION IS IN PROGRESS.
6.THE LOCATIONS OF ALL EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN HEREON HAVE BEEN ESTABLISHED BY FIELD SURVEY OR OBTAINED FROM AVAILABLE RECORDS AND SHALL
THEREFORE BE CONSIDERED APPROXIMATE ONLY AND NOT NECESSARILY COMPLETE. IT IS THE SOLE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT AND THE APPLICANT'S
CONTRACTOR TO INDEPENDENTLY VERIFY THE ACCURACY OF ALL UTILITY LOCATIONS SHOWN, AND TO FURTHER DISCOVER AND AVOID ANY OTHER UTILITIES NOT
SHOWN HEREON THAT MAY BE AFFECTED BY THE IMPLEMENTATION OF THIS PLAN. THE APPLICANT SHALL RECORD ON THE AS-BUILT DRAWINGS ALL
UNDOCUMENTED UTILITIES DISCOVERED AND ANY CHANGES TO THE APPROVED PLANS. THE APPLICANT SHALL IMMEDIATELY NOTIFY THE ENGINEER OF RECORD IF A
CONFLICT EXISTS.
7.VERTICAL DATUM SHALL BE NAVD 88 AND HORIZONTAL DATUM SHALL BE NAD 83 (WA STATE PLANE, NORTH), UNLESS OTHERWISE APPROVED BY THE CITY.
REFERENCE BENCHMARK, DATUM, AND ELEVATIONS SHALL BE NOTED ON THE PLANS.
8.ALL UTILITY TRENCH BACKFILL AND ROADWAY SUBGRADE SHALL BE COMPACTED TO 95% MAXIMUM DRY DENSITY PER SECTION 2-03.3(14)D - COMPACTION AND
MOISTURE CONTROL TESTS OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS. IN PERMEABLE PAVEMENT AND OTHER INFILTRATION AREAS, ALL TRENCH BACKFILL SHALL
BE FIRM AND UNYIELDING BUT IN NO CASE SHALL BE COMPACTED TO MORE THAN 92% OF MAXIMUM DRY DENSITY.
9.OPEN CUTTING OF EXISTING ROADWAYS FOR STORM DRAINAGE WORK IS NOT ALLOWED UNLESS SPECIFICALLY APPROVED BY THE CITY AND NOTED ON THESE
APPROVED PLANS. ANY OPEN CUT SHALL BE RESTORED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CITY TRENCH RESTORATION STANDARDS.
10.ALL PIPE AND STRUCTURES SHALL BE STAKED FOR SURVEY LINE AND GRADE PRIOR TO THE START OF CONSTRUCTION. WHERE SHOWN ON THE PLANS OR WHERE
DIRECTED BY THE CITY, THE EXISTING MANHOLES, CATCH BASINS, OR INLETS SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO THE GRADE AS STAKED.
11.ALL FLOW CONTROL FACILITIES SHALL BE INSTALLED AND IN OPERATION PRIOR TO, OR IN CONJUNCTION WITH, ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY UNLESS OTHERWISE
APPROVED BY THE CITY.
12.ALL PIPE AND APPURTENANCES SHALL BE LAID ON A PROPERLY PREPARED FOUNDATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CURRENT STATE OF WASHINGTON STANDARD
SPECIFICATION FOR ROAD AND BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION. THIS SHALL INCLUDE NECESSARY LEVELING OF THE TRENCH BOTTOM OR THE TOP OF THE FOUNDATION
MATERIAL, AS WELL AS PLACEMENT AND COMPACTION OF REQUIRED BEDDING MATERIAL TO UNIFORM GRADE SO THAT THE ENTIRE LENGTH OF THE PIPE WILL BE
SUPPORTED ON A UNIFORMLY DENSE, UNYIELDING BASE. ALL PIPE BEDDING AND BACKFILL SHALL BE AS SHOWN ON THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 220.00, 220.10, AND
220.20.
13.STEEL PIPE SHALL BE ALUMINIZED, OR GALVANIZED WITH ASPHALT TREATMENT 1, 2, OR 5 INSIDE AND OUTSIDE.
14.ALL DRAINAGE STRUCTURES SUCH AS CATCH BASINS AND MANHOLES SHALL BE FITTED WITH DUCTILE IRON, BOLT-LOCKING LIDS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN
204.10, 204.20, 204.30, 204.40, AND 204.50. STRUCTURES SHALL HAVE:
RECTANGULAR OR ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND OUTSIDE OF THE ROADWAY.
ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND LOCATED WITHIN THE ROADWAY, BUT OUTSIDE OF THE CURB/GUTTER LINE.
ROUND, SOLID LIDS DISPLAYING THE CITY LOGO WHEN WITHIN THE PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY OR IN AN EASEMENT TO THE CITY. PRIVATE STRUCTURE LIDS OUTSIDE
PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY AND EASEMENTS TO THE CITY SHALL NOT DISPLAY THE CITY LOGO.
15.BUILDINGS AND OTHER STRUCTURES SHALL BE PLACED IN ACCORDANCE WITH TABLE 4.1 EASEMENT WIDTHS AND BUILDING SETBACKS LINES OF THE RENTON SWDM.
16.LIDS OF MANHOLES/CATCH BASINS WITHIN PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY SHALL NOT BE ADJUSTED TO FINAL GRADE UNTIL AFTER PAVING. ALL MANHOLE/CATCH BASIN RIMS
SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO BE FLUSH WITH FINAL FINISHED GRADES, UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN.
17.ALL DRIVEWAY CULVERTS LOCATED WITHIN CITY RIGHT-OF-WAY SHALL BE OF SUFFICIENT LENGTH TO PROVIDE A MINIMUM 3:1 SLOPE FROM THE EDGE OF THE
DRIVEWAY TO THE BOTTOM OF THE DITCH.
DocuSign Envelope ID: 3B1B34D3-7E0A-476C-ADB3-4329FFE0C108
8/13/2020 | 8:48 AM PDT
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN
NOTES (2 OF 2)
STD. PLAN - 267.10
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartinPastucha
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
THE FOLLOWING IS A LISTING OF GENERAL NOTES THAT SHALL BE INCORPORATED IN THE DRAINAGE PLAN SET. ALL THE NOTES ON THE LIST MAY NOT PERTAIN TO EVERY
PROJECT. THE APPLICANT OR OWNER, HEREBY REFERRED TO AS APPLICANT, MAY STRIKE OUT IRRELEVANT NOTES IF NOT APPLICABLE TO THE PROJECT. HOWEVER, THE
APPLICANT SHALL NOT RENUMBER NOR EDIT THE REMAINING NOTES. IF ADDITIONAL NOTES ARE NEEDED FOR SPECIFIC ASPECTS, THEY SHALL BE ADDED AFTER THE
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN NOTES.
18.ROCK FOR EROSION PROTECTION OF ROADSIDE DITCHES, WHERE REQUIRED, SHALL BE OF SOUND QUARRY ROCK PLACED TO A MINIMUM DEPTH OF ONE (1) FOOT
AND SHALL MEET THE FOLLOWING SPECIFICATIONS:
4 - 8 INCH ROCK / 40 - 70% PASSING;
2 - 4 INCH ROCK / 30 - 40% PASSING; AND
LESS THAN 2 INCH ROCK / 10 - 20% PASSING.
19.FOOTING DRAINAGE SYSTEMS AND ROOF DOWNSPOUT SYSTEMS SHALL NOT BE INTERCONNECTED AND SHALL SEPARATELY CONVEY COLLECTED FLOWS TO THE
CONVEYANCE SYSTEM OR FLOW CONTROL FACILITY ON THE SITE, UNLESS APPROVED BY THE CITY. FOOTING DRAINS SHALL NOT BE CONNECTED TO ON-SITE BMPS.
20.THE END OF EACH STORM DRAIN STUB SHALL BE CAPPED. A CLEANOUT TOPPED WITH A BOLT-LOCKING LID MARKED "STORM” OR "DRAIN" SHALL BE LOCATED AT THE
PROPERTY LINE OR AT THE POINT OF CONNECTION OF A PRIVATE STORM DRAINAGE CONVEYANCE SYSTEM PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 227.00.
21.ALL STORM SYSTEM EXTENSIONS SHALL BE STAKED FOR LINE AND GRADE BY A SURVEYOR LICENSED IN WASHINGTON STATE, AND CUT SHEETS SHALL BE PROVIDED
TO THE CITY PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
22.ALL NEWLY-INSTALLED AND NEWLY-REHABILITATED (PUBLIC AND PRIVATE) STORM CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS SHALL BE INSPECTED BY MEANS OF REMOTE CCTV
ACCORDING TO THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 266.00. CCTV INSPECTIONS AND REPORTS SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY PRIOR TO RECEIVING APPROVAL TO INSTALL
PROJECT CURBS, GUTTERS AND/OR PAVEMENT.
23.ALL STORM SYSTEMS AND CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING MAINS SHALL BE TESTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 7-04.3(1) OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
AND IN THE PRESENCE OF A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE CITY. STORM DRAIN STUBS SHALL BE TESTED FOR ACCEPTANCE AT THE SAME TIME THE MAIN STORM IS
TESTED.
24.FOR ALL DISTURBED PERVIOUS AREAS (COMPACTED, GRADED, LANDSCAPED, ETC.) OF THE DEVELOPMENT SITE, TO MAINTAIN THE MOISTURE CAPACITY OF THE SOIL
EITHER STOCKPILE AND REDISTRIBUTE THE EXISTING DUFF LAYER AND NATIVE TOPSOIL OR AMEND THE SOIL WITH COMPOST IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD PLAN
264.00.
25.ISSUANCE OF THE BUILDING OR CONSTRUCTION PERMITS BY THE CITY DOES NOT RELIEVE THE APPLICANT OF THE CONTINUING LEGAL OBLIGATION AND/OR LIABILITY
CONNECTED WITH STORMWATER DISPOSAL. THE CITY DOES NOT ACCEPT ANY OBLIGATION FOR THE PROPER FUNCTIONING AND MAINTENANCE OF THE STORM
SYSTEM PROVIDED DURING CONSTRUCTION.
26.ADEQUATE SAFEGUARDS, SAFETY DEVICES, PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, FLAGGERS, AND ANY OTHER ACTIONS NEEDED TO PROTECT THE LIFE, HEALTH, AND SAFETY OF
THE PUBLIC, AND TO PROTECT PROPERTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE PERFORMANCE OF WORK SHALL BE PROVIDED. ANY WORK WITHIN THE TRAVELED
RIGHT-OF-WAY THAT MAY INTERRUPT NORMAL TRAFFIC FLOW SHALL REQUIRE A TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN APPROVED BY THE CITY. ALL SECTIONS OF THE WSDOT
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 1-10 TEMPORARY TRAFFIC CONTROL SHALL APPLY.
27.PROJECTS LOCATED WITHIN THE CITY'S AQUIFER PROTECTION AREA (APA) SHALL COMPLY WITH SPECIAL REQUIREMENT #6 OF THE RENTON SWDM AND AQUIFER
PROTECTION REGULATIONS (RMC 4-3-050).
28.PLACEMENT OF SURFACE APPURTENANCES (CATCH BASIN/MANHOLE LIDS, CLEANOUTS, INLETS, ETC.) IN THE STREET TRAVEL LANE WHEEL PATH, INTERSECTIONS OF
STREET TRAVEL LANES, BIKE LANES, SIDEWALKS, AND CROSSWALKS SHALL BE AVOIDED WHENEVER POSSIBLE. ANY SURFACE APPURTENANCE PLACED IN A
SIDEWALK OR CROSSWALK SHALL BE FITTED WITH A NON-SLIP OR NON-SKID LID PER ADA REQUIREMENTS.
29.CLEARLY LABEL PUBLIC AND PRIVATE SYSTEMS ON THE PLANS. PRIVATE SYSTEMS SHALL BE MAINTAINED BY THE APPLICANT.
30.MINIMUM COVER OVER STORM DRAINAGE PIPE SHALL CONFORM TO TABLE 4.2.1.A2 OF THE RENTON SWDM.
31.CONSTRUCTED PERMEABLE PAVEMENT SHALL BE PERMEABLE ENOUGH TO ABSORB WATER AT A MINIMUM RATE OF 20 INCHES PER HOUR IMMEDIATELY AFTER THE
PAVEMENT SURFACE HAS BEEN WETTED CONTINUOUSLY FOR AT LEAST 10 MINUTES. COMPLIANCE WITH THIS MINIMUM RATE SHALL BE CHECKED PRIOR TO
CONSTRUCTION APPROVAL OF THE PAVEMENT. COMPLIANCE MAY BE CHECKED USING A SIMPLE BUCKET TEST IN WHICH 5 GALLONS OF WATER IS POURED ONTO THE
PAVEMENT SURFACE ALL AT ONCE. IF ONLY A MINOR AMOUNT OF WATER PONDS OR RUNS OFF THE SURFACE, THEN THE PAVEMENT IS CONSIDERED TO MEET THE
MINIMUM RATE OF ABSORPTION. AT LEAST ONE TEST SHALL BE CONDUCTED PER 1,000 SQUARE FEET OF PERMEABLE PAVEMENT. IF THIS TEST IS NOT CONCLUSIVE,
THEN ANOTHER TEST PER ASTM C1701 SHALL BE CONDUCTED. FOR LARGE AREAS (E.G., PARKING AREAS), TESTING OBSERVATION MAY BE ACCOMPLISHED WHILE
WALKING BEHIND A SLOWLY MOVING WATER TRUCK DISCHARGING WATER AT A RATE SIMILAR TO THE BUCKET TEST. PERMEABLE PAVERS SHALL BE TESTED USING
ASTM C1781.
SURFACE WATER STANDARD PLAN NOTES:
DocuSign Envelope ID: 3B1B34D3-7E0A-476C-ADB3-4329FFE0C108
8/13/2020 | 8:48 AM PDT
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL
STANDARD PLAN NOTES
STD. PLAN - 268.00
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) STANDARD PLAN NOTES:
THE FOLLOWING IS A LISTING OF GENERAL NOTES THAT SHALL BE INCORPORATED IN THE EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) PLAN SET. ALL THE NOTES ON THE
LIST MAY NOT PERTAIN TO EVERY PROJECT. THE APPLICANT OR OWNER, HEREBY REFERRED TO AS APPLICANT, MAY STRIKE OUT IRRELEVANT NOTES IF NOT
APPLICABLE TO THE PROJECT. HOWEVER, THE APPLICANT SHALL NOT RENUMBER NOR EDIT THE REMAINING NOTES. IF ADDITIONAL NOTES ARE NEEDED FOR SPECIFIC
ASPECTS, THEY SHALL BE ADDED AFTER THE ESC STANDARD PLAN NOTES.
1.BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION OR DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITY OCCURS, A PRE-CONSTRUCTION MEETING SHALL BE HELD AMONG THE CITY OF RENTON, HEREBY
REFERRED TO AS THE CITY, THE APPLICANT, AND THE APPLICANT'S CONTRACTOR.
2.THE APPLICANT IS RESPONSIBLE FOR OBTAINING THE WASHINGTON STATE DEPARTMENT OF ECOLOGY (ECOLOGY) CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER GENERAL
PERMIT, IF IT IS REQUIRED FOR THE PROJECT. THE APPLICANT SHALL PROVIDE THE CITY COPIES OF ALL MONITORING REPORTS PROVIDED TO ECOLOGY
ASSOCIATED WITH THE CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER GENERAL PERMIT.
3.THE ESC PLAN SET SHALL INCLUDE AN ESC CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE DETAILING THE ORDERED STEPS THAT SHALL BE FOLLOWED FROM CONSTRUCTION
COMMENCEMENT TO POST-PROJECT CLEANUP IN ORDER TO FULFILL PROJECT ESC REQUIREMENTS.
4.THE BOUNDARIES OF THE CLEARING LIMITS, SENSITIVE AREAS AND THEIR BUFFERS, AND AREAS OF VEGETATION PRESERVATION AND TREE RETENTION AS
PRESCRIBED ON THE PLAN(S) SHALL BE CLEARLY DELINEATED BY FENCING AND PROTECTED IN THE FIELD IN ACCORDANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF THE CITY OF
RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM) PRIOR TO THE START OF CONSTRUCTION. DURING THE CONSTRUCTION PERIOD, NO DISTURBANCE
BEYOND THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE PERMITTED. THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE MAINTAINED BY THE APPLICANT/ESC SUPERVISOR FOR THE DURATION OF
CONSTRUCTION.
5.STABILIZED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCES SHALL BE INSTALLED AT THE BEGINNING OF CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTAINED FOR THE DURATION OF THE PROJECT.
ADDITIONAL MEASURES, SUCH AS CONSTRUCTED WHEEL WASH SYSTEMS OR WASH PADS, MAY BE REQUIRED TO ENSURE THAT ALL PAVED AREAS ARE KEPT
CLEAN AND TRACK-OUT TO ROAD RIGHT OF WAY DOES NOT OCCUR FOR THE DURATION OF THE PROJECT. IF SEDIMENT IS TRACKED OFFSITE, PUBLIC ROADS SHALL
BE CLEANED THOROUGHLY AT THE END OF EACH DAY, OR MORE FREQUENTLY DURING WET WEATHER, AS NECESSARY TO PREVENT SEDIMENT FROM ENTERING
WATERS OF THE STATE.
6.WASHOUT FROM CONCRETE TRUCKS SHALL BE PERFORMED OFF-SITE OR IN DESIGNATED CONCRETE WASHOUT AREAS ONLY. DO NOT WASH OUT CONCRETE
TRUCKS ONTO THE GROUND, OR TO STORM DRAINS OR OPEN DITCHES. ON-SITE DUMPING OF EXCESS CONCRETE SHALL ONLY OCCUR IN DESIGNATED CONCRETE
WASHOUT AREAS.
7.ALL REQUIRED ESC BMPS SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED AND IN OPERATION PRIOR TO LAND CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION TO PREVENT TRANSPORTATION OF
SEDIMENT TO SURFACE WATER, DRAINAGE SYSTEMS AND ADJACENT PROPERTIES. ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE MAINTAINED IN A SATISFACTORY CONDITION UNTIL
SUCH TIME THAT CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE AND POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE EROSION HAS PASSED. ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED AFTER
CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETED AND THE SITE HAS BEEN STABILIZED TO ENSURE POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE EROSION DOES NOT EXIST. THE IMPLEMENTATION,
MAINTENANCE, REPLACEMENT, ENHANCEMENT, AND REMOVAL OF ESC BMPS SHALL BE THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT.
8.ANY HAZARDOUS MATERIALS OR LIQUID PRODUCTS THAT HAVE THE POTENTIAL TO POLLUTE RUNOFF SHALL BE DISPOSED OF PROPERLY.
9.THE ESC BMPS DEPICTED ON THIS DRAWING ARE INTENDED TO BE MINIMUM REQUIREMENTS TO MEET ANTICIPATED SITE CONDITIONS. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES AND UNEXPECTED OR SEASONAL CONDITIONS DICTATE, THE APPLICANT SHALL ANTICIPATE THAT MORE ESC BMPS WILL BE NECESSARY TO ENSURE
COMPLETE SILTATION CONTROL ON THE PROPOSED SITE. DURING THE COURSE OF CONSTRUCTION, IT SHALL BE THE OBLIGATION AND RESPONSIBILITY OF THE
APPLICANT TO ADDRESS ANY NEW CONDITIONS THAT MAY BE CREATED BY THE ACTIVITIES AND TO PROVIDE ADDITIONAL ESC BMPS, OVER AND ABOVE MINIMUM
REQUIREMENTS, AS MAY BE NEEDED, TO PROTECT ADJACENT PROPERTIES AND WATER QUALITY OF THE RECEIVING DRAINAGE SYSTEM.
10.APPROVAL OF THIS PLAN IS FOR ESC ONLY. IT DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN APPROVAL OF STORM DRAINAGE DESIGN, SIZE NOR LOCATION OF PIPES, RESTRICTORS,
CHANNELS, OR STORMWATER FACILITIES.
11.ANY DEWATERING SYSTEM NECESSARY FOR THE CONSTRUCTION OF STORMWATER FACILITIES SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY FOR REVIEW AND APPROVAL.
12.ANY AREAS OF EXPOSED SOILS, INCLUDING ROADWAY EMBANKMENTS, THAT WILL NOT BE DISTURBED FOR TWO DAYS DURING THE WET SEASON (OCTOBER 1ST
THROUGH APRIL 30TH) OR SEVEN DAYS DURING THE DRY SEASON (MAY 1ST THROUGH SEPTEMBER 30TH) SHALL BE IMMEDIATELY STABILIZED WITH THE APPROVED
ESC COVER METHODS (E.G., SEEDING, MULCHING, PLASTIC COVERING, ETC.) IN CONFORMANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF THE RENTON SWDM.
13.WET SEASON ESC REQUIREMENTS APPLY TO ALL CONSTRUCTION SITES BETWEEN OCTOBER 1ST AND APRIL 30TH, UNLESS OTHERWISE APPROVED BY THE CITY.
14.ANY AREA NEEDING ADDITIONAL ESC MEASURES, NOT REQUIRING IMMEDIATE ATTENTION, SHALL BE ADDRESSED WITHIN SEVEN (7) DAYS.
15.THE ESC BMPS ON INACTIVE SITES SHALL BE INSPECTED AND MAINTAINED AT A MINIMUM OF ONCE A MONTH OR WITHIN 24 HOURS FOLLOWING A STORM EVENT.
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE SHALL OCCUR MORE FREQUENTLY AS REQUIRED BY THE CITY.
16.BEFORE COMMENCEMENT OF ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY, CATCH BASIN INSERTS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 216.30 SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR ALL STORM
DRAIN INLETS DOWNSLOPE AND WITHIN 500 FEET OF A DISTURBED OR CONSTRUCTION AREA, UNLESS THE RUNOFF THAT ENTERS THE INLET WILL BE CONVEYED
TO A SEDIMENT POND OR TRAP. ALL CATCH BASIN INSERTS SHALL BE PERIODICALLY INSPECTED AND REPLACED AS NECESSARY TO ENSURE FULLY FUNCTIONING
CONDITION.
17.AT NO TIME SHALL SEDIMENT ACCUMULATION EXCEED 2/3 OF THE CAPACITY OF THE CATCH BASIN SUMP. ALL CATCH BASINS AND CONVEYANCE LINES SHALL BE
CLEANED PRIOR TO PAVING. THE CLEANING OPERATION SHALL NOT FLUSH SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER INTO THE DOWNSTREAM SYSTEM.
18.ANY PERMANENT STORMWATER FACILITY LOCATION USED AS A TEMPORARY SETTLING BASIN SHALL BE MODIFIED WITH THE NECESSARY ESC BMPS AND SHALL
PROVIDE ADEQUATE STORAGE CAPACITY. IF THE TEMPORARY FACILITY IS TO ULTIMATELY FUNCTION AS AN INFILTRATION SYSTEM IN ITS PERMANENT STATE, THE
TEMPORARY FACILITY SHALL BE ROUGH GRADED SO THAT THE BOTTOM AND SIDES ARE AT LEAST THREE FEET ABOVE THE FINAL GRADE OF THE PERMANENT
FACILITY.
19.AREAS DESIGNATED ON THE PLAN(S) CONTAINING EXISTING STORMWATER FACILITIES OR ON-SITE BMPS (AMENDED SOILS, BIORETENTION, PERMEABLE PAVEMENT,
ETC.) SHALL BE CLEARLY FENCED AND PROTECTED USING ESC BMPS TO AVOID SEDIMENTATION AND COMPACTION DURING CONSTRUCTION.
20.PRIOR TO THE BEGINNING OF THE WET SEASON (OCTOBER 1ST), ALL DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE INSPECTED TO IDENTIFY WHICH ONES SHALL BE SODDED OR
SEEDED IN PREPARATION FOR THE WINTER RAINS. DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED WITHIN ONE WEEK OF THE BEGINNING OF THE WET SEASON.
AN EXHIBIT OF THOSE AREAS TO BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND THOSE AREAS TO REMAIN UNCOVERED SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY FOR REVIEW.
21.PRIOR TO FINAL CONSTRUCTION ACCEPTANCE, THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE STABILIZED TO PREVENT SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER FROM LEAVING THE PROJECT SITE,
ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED, AND STORMWATER CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS, FACILITIES, AND ON-SITE BMPS SHALL BE RESTORED TO THEIR FULLY
FUNCTIONING CONDITION. ALL DISTURBED AREAS OF THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE VEGETATED OR OTHERWISE PERMANENTLY STABILIZED. AT A MINIMUM,
DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND MULCHED TO ENSURE THAT SUFFICIENT COVER WILL DEVELOP SHORTLY AFTER FINAL APPROVAL. MULCH
WITHOUT SEEDING IS ADEQUATE FOR AREAS TO BE LANDSCAPED BEFORE OCTOBER 1ST.
22.ROCKERIES ARE CONSIDERED TO BE A METHOD OF BANK STABILIZATION AND EROSION CONTROL. ROCKERIES SHALL NOT BE CONSTRUCTED TO SERVE AS
RETAINING WALLS. ALL ROCKERIES IN CITY ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH CITY STANDARDS. ROCKERIES OUTSIDE OF
ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE INTERNATIONAL BUILDING CODE.
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEGreggZimmerman
Public Works Administrator
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING IS NOT TO SCALE (NTS)
DocuSign Envelope ID: 6EECF5B6-602A-4E4A-B436-A317AA638878
9/28/2018 | 9:45 AM PDT
NOTES:
1.WET TAPPING OF EXISTING WATER MAINS SHALL BE PERFORMED BY A CITY APPROVED WET TAP CONTRACTOR (SPEER TAPS, INC.,
LEGACY TAPPING, INC. OR OTHER FIRM APPROVED BY CITY ENGINEER).
2.CONTRACTOR SHALL POTHOLE AND VERIFY THE HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL ALIGNMENT OF EXISTING WATER MAIN AND SHALL LAY THE
NEW WATER MAIN TO MATCH.
3.TAPPING TEE SHALL BE STAINLESS STEEL OR STEEL WITH FULL CIRCLE SEAL WITH CORTEN OR STAINLESS STEEL NUTS AND BOLTS.
4.ALL TEES AND VALVES SHALL BE WATER TESTED BEFORE TAPPING OR ASSEMBLY SEALS SHALL BE TESTED VIA AIR PRESSURE AFTER THE
TAPPING SLEEVE IS INSTALLED TO THE MAIN AND THE TAPPING VALVE IS INSTALLED.
5.TAPPING TEES MAY BE SIZE-ON-SIZE, PROVIDED THE SHELL CUTTER DIAMETER IS AT LEAST 2" SMALLER THAN THE EXISTING MAIN
DIAMETER.
6.TAPPING TEES SHALL NOT BE INSTALLED ON STEEL OR ASBESTOS CEMENT WATER MAINS.
COMPACTED BEDDING GRAVEL
PER SECTION 9-03.12(3) OF THE
WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CONCRETE
SUPPORT
BLOCKS
CONCRETE BLOCKING
PER STD PLAN 330.1
MAIN
NEW
WATER MAIN
ELEVATION
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
TAPPING TEE
STD. PLAN - 300.6
6/28/2023
NOTES:
1.THE BACKFLOW PREVENTION ASSEMBLY AND SUPPLY HOSE MUST BE DISCONNECTED DURING HYDROSTATIC PRESSURE TESTING OF THE
NEW WATER MAIN.
2.POLYPIG AND ALL DEBRIS SHALL BE REMOVED FROM SUMP OF VERTICAL CROSS VIA SANITARY METHOD PRIOR TO DISINFECTION OF NEW
WATER MAIN.
3.UPON REMOVAL OF POLYPIG, REMOVE TEMPORARY BLOW-OFF ASSEMBLY AND INSTALL 2" PLUG.
4.THE NEW WATER MAIN SHALL BE CONNECTED TO THE EXISTING SYSTEM ONLY AFTER NEW WATER MAIN IS POLYPIGGED, DISINFECTED
AND SATISFACTORY BACTERIOLOGICAL SAMPLE RESULTS ARE OBTAINED.
5.THE INTERIORS OF ALL PIPES AND FITTINGS TO BE USED IN FINAL CONNECTION MUST BE SWABBED OR SPRAYED WITH A 5-6% AVAILABLE
CHLORINE SOLUTION.
NEW DI WATER MAIN
NSF 61 SUPPLY HOSE
METERED BACKFLOW ASSEMBLY
(TO BE OBTAINED FROM CITY)
(1) 2 1 2" CONTROL VALVE
(1) CONSTRUCTION METER
(1) RPBA
METER SUPPORT (BY CONTRACTOR)
HYDRANT ON EXISTING WATER MAIN
POLYPIG
TEMPORARY BLOW-OFF ASSEMBLY
(1) 2" GALVANIZED PIPE
(1) 2" 90° BEND
(1) 2" GATE VALVE
POLYPIG STATION
(1)VERTICAL CROSS (MJxFL), SIZE TO MATCH WATER MAIN
(1)BLIND FLANGE WITH 2" TAP ON TOP OF CROSS
(1)TEMPORARY BLOW-OFF ASSEMBLY
(1)BLIND FLANGE ON BOTTOM OF CROSS
(1) PLUG (MJ) ON END OF CROSS WITH TEMPORARY THRUST BLOCKING
TEMPORARY BLOCKING
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
POLYPIGGING NEW WATER MAINS
STD. PLAN - 300.7
6/28/2023
SEE STANDARD PLANS 110, 110.1, 110.2, AND 111
FOR PAVEMENT RESTORATION REQUIREMENTS
TRENCH BACKFILL - CRUSHED
SURFACING TOP COURSE (CSTC)
PER WSDOT STD. SPEC.
9-03.9(3), BANK RUN GRAVEL
FOR TRENCH BACKFILL PER
WSDOT STD. SPEC. 9-03.19,
GRAVEL BORROW PER WSDOT
STD. SPEC. 9-03.14(1), OR
SUITABLE EXCAVATED MATERIAL
IF APPROVED BY ENGINEER,
COMPACTED TO 95% OF
MAXIMUM DENSITY
NOTES:
1.RECYCLED CONCRETE AGGREGATE SHALL NOT BE USED AS BEDDING OR BACKFILL IN THE PIPE ZONE OR AS TRENCH BACKFILL
2.EXCAVATIONS OVER 4' DEEP SHALL COMPLY WITH THE SAFETY STANDARD DESCRIBED IN CHAPTER 296-155 - PART N OF THE WAC
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND PIPE ZONE
BACKFILL - CRUSHED SURFACING BASE
COURSE (CSBC) PER WSDOT STD. SPEC.
9-03.9(3)
DUCTILE IRON PIPE
WITH POLYWRAP
NEAT LINE TRENCH
6" CRUSHED SURFACING TOP
COURSE (CSTC) UNDER
PAVEMENT PER WSDOT STD.
SPEC. 9-03.9(3), COMPACTED TO
95% OF MAXIMUM DENSITY
LOWER LIMIT PIPE ZONE
UPPER LIMIT PIPE ZONE
EXISTING PAVEMENT
SURFACE
36"
12" MIN.12" MIN.
6"
O.D.
12"
EXISTING PAVEMENT
SURFACE
SAWCUTSAWCUT
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED, DRAWING NOT TO SCALE
PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND TRENCH
BACKFILL FOR DUCTILE IRON WATER MAIN
STD. PLAN - 300.9
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS
WTR-27-4186
CL
A HYDRANT
COMPRESSION TYPE HYDRANT (SEE APPROVED MATERIALS LIST) WITH 6" MJ INLET WITH LUGS, 5 1 4" MVO,
1 1 4" PENTAGON OPERATING NUT, TWO (2) 2 1 2" NST HOSE NOZZLES, AND 4.875" SST PUMPER NOZZLE
EQUIPPED WITH 5" STORZ ADAPTER AND 1/8" STAINLESS STEEL CABLE, WITH EXTENSION IF NECESSARY.
TEE MAIN LINE TEE WITH 6" FLANGE SIDE OUTLET
VALVE 6" GATE VALVE (FLxMJ)
VALVE BOX VALVE BOX AND LID PER STD PLAN 330.7
PIPE CLASS 52 DI, LENGTH TO FIT
JOINT RESTRAINT MECHANICAL JOINT RESTRAINT WITH CONCRETE BLOCKING OR (2) 3/4" CORTEN STEEL TIE RODS
GRAVEL 1 1 4" WASHED DRAIN ROCK, MINIMUM 1' ABOVE BOOT FLANGE WITH 8-MIL POLYETHYLENE SHEETING
AROUND TOP AND SIDES OF GRAVEL
CONCRETE BLOCK MINIMUM 16"x8"x4" CONCRETE BLOCKS UNDER FIRE HYDRANT AND GATE VALVE
BLOCKING CONCRETE BLOCKING PER STD PLAN 330.1
SHEAR BLOCK 4'x4'x6" CONCRETE SHEAR BLOCK AROUND FIRE HYDRANT, SEE STANDARD DETAIL 310.2
PAVEMENT MARKER BLUE REFLECTIVE PAVEMENT MARKER PER STD PLAN 310.3
BE
K
MAIN
RO
A
D
W
A
Y
O
R
N
E
A
R
E
S
T
L
A
N
E
C
H
A
N
N
E
L
I
Z
A
T
I
O
N
1'
MIN
A1' MIN
4"4" MINIMUM
F
MATERIALS
NOTES:
1.FIRE HYDRANT TO BE PAINTED WITH TWO COATS OF SAFETY YELLOW DTM ACRYLIC GLOSS OR ENAMEL PAINT.
2.PUMPER NOZZLE TO FACE ROADWAY OR AS DIRECTED BY RRFA.
3.A MINIMUM 3' RADIUS UNOBSTRUCTED WORKING AREA SHALL BE PROVIDED AROUND THE OUTSIDE OF THE HYDRANT.
H
H
J
G
D
C I
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
F
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
FIRE HYDRANT ASSEMBLY
STD. PLAN - 310.1
6/28/2023
4'x4'x6" CONCRETE SHEAR BLOCK
4'x4'x6" CONCRETE SHEAR BLOCK
ONE MAN ROCK
1
1
1
6
1
6
3' MIN RADIUS
UNOBSTRUCTED WORKING AREA
AROUND OUTSIDE OF FIRE HYDRANT
3' MIN RADIUS
UNOBSTRUCTED WORKING AREA
AROUND OUTSIDE OF FIRE HYDRANT
CUT
FILL
NOTE:
4'x4'x6" CONCRETE SHEAR BLOCK AROUND FIRE HYDRANT WITH EXPANSION JOINT AT BACK OF SIDEWALK, FINISH TO MATCH SIDEWALK, ALL
CONCRETE SHALL BE MINIMUM 3,000 PSI AND SHALL BE MECHANICALLY MIXED - JOB SITE MIXING, HAND-MIXED CONCRETE, AND MOBILE
CONCRETE MIXERS ARE NOT ALLOWED.
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
FIRE HYDRANT ASSEMBLY
SHEAR BLOCK
STD. PLAN - 310.2
6/28/2023
BLUE REFLECTIVE PAVEMENT MARKER,
STIMSONITE MODEL C88 OR EQUAL,
PLACED 4" FROM ROADWAY
CENTERLINE AS INDICATED BELOW
TWO LANE ROAD OFFSET MARKER ON SIDE STREETS WHERE THE HYDRANT IS
WITHIN 20' OF A MAJOR STREET, THE MARKER
SHALL BE INSTALLED ON THAT MAJOR STREET
FOUR LANE ROAD OFFSET MARKER FIVE LANE ROAD OFFSET MARKER
4"0.7"
MARKERMARKER
MARKER MARKER
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
FIRE HYDRANT ASSEMBLY
PAVEMENT MARKER
STD. PLAN - 310.3
6/28/2023
A TEE 2" TAPPED REDUCING TEE (MJxFIPT)
PIPE 2" BRASS NIPPLE (MIPT), 4" LENGTH
VALVE 2" GATE VALVE (FIPT) WITH SQUARE OPERATING
NUT AND EXTENSION PER STD PLAN 330.8
VALVE BOX VALVE BOX AND LID PER STD PLAN 330.8
COUPLING 2" BRASS COUPLING (MIPT x PACK JOINT), FORD
C84-77-Q-NL OR EQUAL
TUBING 2" TYPE "K" SOFT COPPER TUBING
BEND
2" 90° BRASS BEND (PACK JOINT x PACK JOINT OR
PACK JOINT x FIPT), FORD L44-77-Q-NL OR
L41-77-Q-NL OR EQUAL
METER SETTER
2" VERTICAL METER SETTER WITH BYPASS, FLANGED
ANGLE BALL VALVE AND PADLOCK WINGS ON INLET,
ANGLE CHECK VALVE ON OUTLET, AND BALL VALVE
ON BYPASS WITH PADLOCK WINGS,
FORD VBH87-12B-11-77-Q-NL, A.Y. MCDONALD
730B-612WDFF665, OR MUELLER B-2427N (2"),
BYPASS NOT PERMITTED ON IRRIGATION METERS
METER SPREADER 17 3 16" RIGID METER SPREADER (TEMPORARY)
WATER METER AMI WATER METER WITH RADIO AND BATTERY UNIT,
TO BE SUPPLIED AND INSTALLED BY CITY FORCES
METER BOX
17"X30" METER BOX, ARMORCAST A6001640PCX18,
WITH METER BOX LID, ARMORCAST
A6001947RCI-H7, TO READ "RENTON WATER"
COUPLER
2" COUPLER (PACK JOINT x PACK JOINT), FORD
C4#-7#-Q-NL OR EQUAL, WITH GALVANIZED PLUG IF
PRIVATE SERVICE LINE IS NOT YET INSTALLED
GRAVEL CSTC TO SUPPORT METER BOX, METER BYPASS TO BE
EXPOSED
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
PR
O
P
E
R
T
Y
L
I
N
E
FINISHED GRADE
SIDEWALK
21" TO 30"
24
"
T
O
3
0
"
12"
CITY
PIPING PIPING
PRIVATE
A B C
D
G
H
I
JK
E
L
M
MAIN
MATERIALS 2" SERVICE
9" TO 12"
F
E
M
BA
C
K
O
F
SI
D
E
W
A
L
K
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
2" WATER SERVICE
IN CEMENT CONCRETE SIDEWALK
STD. PLAN - 320.2
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS
WTR-27-4186
NOTES:
1.MINIMUM BEARING AREA MUST BE ADJUSTED FOR PIPE SIZE, PRESSURE, AND SOIL CONDITIONS.
2.FITTINGS SHALL BE POLYWRAPPED PRIOR TO POURING CONCRETE BLOCKING.
3.CONCRETE BLOCKING SHALL BE CAST IN PLACE AND SHALL HAVE A MINIMUM OF 0.25 SF BEARING AREA AGAINST THE FITTING.
4.CONCRETE BLOCKING SHALL BEAR AGAINST FITTINGS ONLY AND SHALL BE CLEAR OF JOINTS TO PERMIT TAKING UP OR DISMANTLING
JOINT.
5.CONTRACTOR SHALL INSTALL BLOCKING ADEQUATE TO WITHSTAND FULL HYDROSTATIC TEST PRESSURE AS WELL AS TO CONTINUOUSLY
WITHSTAND OPERATING PRESSURE UNDER ALL CONDITIONS OF SERVICE.
6.ALL CONCRETE SHALL BE MECHANICALLY MIXED. JOB SITE MIXING, HAND-MIXED CONCRETE, AND MOBILE CONCRETE MIXERS ARE NOT
ALLOWED.
7.IN MUCK OR PEAT, ALL THRUSTS SHALL BE RESTRAINED BY PILES OR TIE RODS TO SOLID FOUNDATION OR MUCK OR PEAT SHALL BE
REMOVED AND REPLACED WITH BALLAST OF SUFFICIENT STABILITY TO RESIST THRUST.
8.CONCRETE BLOCKING SHALL BE LEFT OPEN OR SHEETED FOR MINIMUM 24 HOURS.
MINIMUM BEARING AREA
AGAINST UNDISTURBED SOIL (SF) *
PIPE
SIZE
PRESSURE
(PSI)
4"200
300
2/(1)
3/(2)
1/(NONE )
2/(2)
1/(NONE )
2/(1)
NONE
1/(1)
NONE
NONE
6"200
300
4/(3)
6/(4)
3/(2)
4/(3)
3/(1)
3/(2)
1/(1)
2/(1)
1/(NONE )
1/(NONE )
8"200
300
7/(5)
11/(8)
5/(3)
8/(5)
4/(3)
6/(4)
2/(2)
3/(2)
1/(1)
2/(1)
10"200
275
11/(8)
16/(11)
8/(6)
11/(7)
6/(4)
9/(6)
3/(2)
5/(3)
2/(1)
3/(2)
12"200
250
16/(11)
24/(16)
11/(8)
17/(11)
9/(6)
13/(9)
5/(3)
7/(5)
3/(2)
4/(3)
14"200
250
22/(13)
33/(22)
16/(11)
23/(16)
12/(8)
18/(12)
6/(4)
9/(6)
3/(2)
5/(3)
16"200
225
29/(19)
32/(21)
21/(14)
23/(16)
16/(11)
17/(12)
8/(6)
9/(6)
5/(3)
5/(3)
18"200 36/(24)26/(17)20/(13)10/(7)5/(4)
20"200 45/(29)32/(21)24/(16)13/(8)7/(4)
24"200 64/(43)46/(30)35/(23)18/(12)9/(6)
* VALUES BASED ON SAFE BEARING LOAD OF 2,000/(3,000) PSF
SOIL TYPE SAFE BEARING LOAD (PSF)
MUCK OR PEAT 0
SOFT CLAY 1,000
SAND 2,000
SAND AND GRAVEL 3,000
CEMENTED WITH CLAY 4,000
HARD SHALE 10,000
E
B
D
A C
B
A B C D E
11 1 4° BEND
22 1 2° BEND
45° BEND90° BEND
CAP / PLUG
TEE
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
CONCRETE BLOCKING
FOR HORIZONTAL FITTINGS
STD. PLAN - 330.1
6/28/2023
NOTES:
1.NO CHANGE IN PIPE DIRECTION OR DIAMETER SHALL OCCUR WITHIN 36' OF THE VERTICAL BEND. BENDS, TEES, REDUCERS, ETC. BEYOND
THE 36' LIMIT MAY BE RESTRAINED BY STANDARD CONCRETE BLOCKING PER STD PLANS 330.1 AND 330.2.
2.FITTINGS SHALL BE POLYWRAPPED AFTER INSTALLATION OF PIPE CLAMPS AND ANCHOR RODS PRIOR TO POURING CONCRETE BLOCKING.
3.PIPE CLAMPS AND ANCHOR RODS SHALL BE INSTALLED PER STD PLAN 330.4.
4.JOINT RESTRAINT SHALL BE MEGALUG SERIES 1100 OR EQUAL.
5.WATER MAIN SHALL NOT BE PRESSURIZED UNTIL ALL TRENCHING WITHIN 100' OF VERTICAL BEND IS BACKFILLED AND COMPACTED TO
MINIMUM 3' COVER.
6.90° VERTICAL BENDS SHALL ONLY BE INSTALLED WHERE GIVEN PRIOR APPROVAL BY THE CITY.
7.ALL CONCRETE SHALL BE MECHANICALLY MIXED. JOB SITE MIXING, HAND-MIXED CONCRETE, AND MOBILE CONCRETE MIXERS ARE NOT
ALLOWED.
8.BACKFILL TRENCH BEYOND 90° VERTICAL BLOCK WITH CRUSHED SURFACING TOP COURSE MATERIAL COMPACTED TO 95% MDD. CRUSHED
BACKFILL SHALL EXTEND 20' BEYOND BLOCK OR TO FIRM BEARING TRENCH WALL, WHICHEVER IS LESS.
9.CONCRETE BLOCKING SHALL BE LEFT OPEN OR SHEETED FOR MINIMUM 24 HOURS.
MINIMUM DIMENSIONS
PIPE
SIZE BEND VOLUME
(CF)A D *L
4"
11 1 4°
BLOCKING NOT REQUIRED22 1 2°
45°
90°16 2.5'3 4"2.0'
6"
11 1 4°
BLOCKING NOT REQUIRED
22 1 2°
45°13 2.3'3 4"2.0'
90°43 3.5'3 4"2.0'
8"
11 1 4°
BLOCKING NOT REQUIRED
22 1 2°
45°33 3.2'3 4"2.0'
90°86 4.4'3 4"2.0'
10"
11 1 4°BLOCKING NOT REQUIRED
22 1 2°13 2.3'3 4"2.0'
45°64 4.0'3 4"2.0'
90°141 5.2'1"3.5'
12"
11 1 4°BLOCKING NOT REQUIRED
22 1 2°20 2.7'3 4"2.0'
45°111 4.8'3 4"2.0'
90°206 5.9'1 1 8"4.0'
* D = ANCHOR ROD DIAMETER
MINIMUM DIMENSIONS BASED ON FOLLOWING CONDITIONS:
• PIPE RESTRAINED MINIMUM 36' ON EACH SIDE OF BEND
• SAFE BEARING LOAD = 1,000 SF
• CONCRETE STRENGTH = 3,000 PSI
• CONCRETE WEIGHT = 150 PCF
• HYDROSTATIC PRESSURE = 200 PSI
• TRENCH = TYPE 2 FLAT BOTTOM TRENCH WITH LIGHTLY
CONSOLIDATED BACKFILL PER ANSI/AWWA C150/A21.50
• FACTOR OF SAFETY = 1.5
• SOIL FRICTIONAL RESISTANCE BASED ON COHESIVE
GRANULAR SOIL (GC+SC), SAND, GRAVEL, CLAY MIXTURE
CONCRETE BLOCKING DESIGN MUST BE ADJUSTED FOR
VARIANCES IN ANY OF THESE CONDITIONS.
45° BEND
L
L
A
A
A
A
L
L
11 1 4° AND 22 1 2 ° BENDS
PIPE CLAMP AND
ANCHOR ROD
PIPE CLAMP AND
ANCHOR ROD
A
A
L
L
90° BEND
PIPE CLAMP AND
ANCHOR ROD
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
CONCRETE BLOCKING
FOR VERTICAL FITTINGS
WITH RESTRAINED JOINTS
STD. PLAN - 330.3
6/28/2023
WATER
MAIN
PIPE CLAMP HEAVY DUTY HOT-DIPPED GALVANIZED PIPE CLAMP, COOPER B-LINE B3132 OR EQUAL, WITH OPENINGS TO
ACCOMMODATE ANCHOR ROD DIAMETER
ANCHOR ROD ALL-THREAD ROD, ASTM A242 CORTEN OR STAINLESS STEEL, SIZE PER STD PLAN 330.2 AND STD PLAN 330.3
NUT HEAVY HEX NUT, ASTM A563 GRADE C3 OR STAINLESS STEEL 316SS, SIZE TO MATCH ANCHOR ROD
DIAMETER, TIGHTEN TOP NUTS TO TENSION BOLTS AND LOWER NUTS TO COMPRESS CLAMP SNUG
WASHER ROUND FLAT STRUCTURAL WASHER, CORTEN OR STAINLESS STEEL 316SS, SIZE TO MATCH ANCHOR ROD
DIAMETER
A
MATERIALS
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
CONCRETE BLOCKING
PIPE CLAMP AND ANCHOR RODS
STD. PLAN - 330.4
6/28/2023
VALVE OPERATING NUT EXTENSION
VALVE MARKER POST
SECTION A-A
AA
VALVE BOX AND LID
NOTES:
1.EXTENSIONS ARE REQUIRED WHEN VALVE NUT IS MORE THAN 3'
BELOW FINISHED GRADE. EXTENSIONS ARE TO BE A MINIMUM
OF 1' LONG. ONLY ONE EXTENSION TO BE USED PER VALVE.
2.ALL EXTENSIONS ARE TO BE MADE OF STEEL, SIZED AS NOTED,
WITH ANTICORROSION COATING CONFORMING TO AWWA C210
NOTES:
1.VALVE MARKER POST TO BE USED FOR ALL MAIN LINE VALVES
OUTSIDE PAVED AREAS.
2.DISTANCE TO VALVE SHALL BE NEATLY STENCILED ON THE POST
WITH 2" NUMERALS.
MAIN
3"
MIN
VALVE BOX
TWO-PIECE VALVE BOX WITH REGULAR
BASE SECTION TO FIT AND STANDARD 8"
TOP SECTION, OLYMPIC FOUNDRY INC
940 OR RICH #045 (NON-LOCKING)
VALVE BOX LID
COVER TO MATCH VALVE BOX
MANUFACTURER, TO READ "WATER",
WITH EARS IN DIRECTION OF WATER
MAIN
HMA COLLAR
8" THICK HMA FOR VALVE IN PAVED
AREA OR 3'x3'x6" CONCRETE PAD IN
UNPAVED AREA
OPERATING
NUT EXTENSION SEE DETAIL, THIS SHEET
MARKER POST
WHITE MARKER POST WITH ANCHOR
BARB AND BLUE LABEL TO READ
"WATER", CARSONITE UTILITY MARKER
CRM3-066-08 OR EQUAL
A
B
C
D
E
MATERIALS 3 3 4"
62"
34"
24"
12"
8" TO 12"
2" SQUARE
OPERATING NUT
4 1 4" DIAMETER
1 8" MIN THICKNESS
1" DIAMETER STEEL,
LENGTH AS REQUIRED
1 8" MIN THICKNESS
2 1 4" INSIDE MEASUREMENT
2 1 4" DEPTH
D
A
C
B
E
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
VALVE BOX,
OPERATING NUT EXTENSION,
AND MARKER POST
STD. PLAN - 330.7
6/28/2023
CORPORATION STOP 1" BALLCORP WITH AWWA TAPERED (CC) INLET AND COPPER THREAD OUTLET, FORD FB600-4-NL OR EQUAL
SWING JOINT 1" BRASS SWING JOINT
PIPE 1" TYPE "K" SOFT COPPER TUBING
COUPLING 1" STRAIGHT COUPLING (MIPT x PACK JOINT), FORD C84-44, MUELLER H15428, OR EQUAL
GATE VALVE 1" BRONZE GATE VALVE, THREADED, RED-WHITE VALVE NO. 280, OHIO BRASS NO. 2500, OR EQUAL
UNION 1" BRASS UNION
PIPE 1" BRASS NIPPLE
AIR & VACUUM
RELEASE VALVE
ASSEMBLY
1" AIR AND VACUUM RELEASE VALVE ASSEMBLY, APCO NO. 143-C, VAL-MATIC NO. 201-C, OR CRISPIN UL10,
OR EQUAL
PIPE 1" GALVANIZED IRON NIPPLE
BEND 1" 90° GALVANIZED IRON BEND
UNION 1" GALVANIZED IRON UNION
PIPE 1" GALVANIZED IRON PIPE, LENGTH TO FIT
SWING JOINT (1) 2"X1" BELL REDUCER
(2) 2" 90° STREET ELLS
PIPE 2" GALVANIZED IRON PIPE, LENGTH TO FIT, FIELD LOCATE
BEND 2" 180° RETURN BEND, OPEN PATTERN
STRAINER 2" BEEHIVE STRAINER
METER BOX AND LID METER BOX, ARMORCAST A6001946PCX18, WITH METER BOX LID, ARMORCAST A6001969RCI-H7, TO READ
"RENTON WATER"
GRAVEL 1 1 4" WASHED GRAVEL
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
12"
MIN
A
B C
D
E
F
G B
G
H
I J K
L M
N
O
P
Q
6" MIN
5" TO 18"
NOTES:
1.AIR AND VACUUM RELEASE VALVE ASSEMBLY MUST BE INSTALLED AT THE HIGHEST POINT IN THE WATER MAIN. IF THE HIGH POINT FALLS
IN A LOCATION WHERE THE ASSEMBLY CANNOT BE INSTALLED, PROVIDE ADDITIONAL DEPTH OF MAIN TO CREATE THE HIGH POINT AT A
LOCATION WHERE THE ASSEMBLY CAN BE INSTALLED.
2.LOCATE METER BOX OUTSIDE OF TRAFFIC AREAS, BEHIND THE CURB.
MAIN
R
MATERIALS
FINISHED GRADE
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
APPROVED:
DATEMartin Pastucha
Public Works Administrator
1" AIR AND VACUUM RELEASE
VALVE ASSEMBLY
STD. PLAN - 340.3
6/28/2023
#4 REBAR AT 8" ON CENTER
WITH 180° STANDARD
HOOKS @ BOTH ENDS
3/4" CORTEN CONTINUOUS THREAD RODS
INSTALLED SYMMETRICALLY AROUND PIPE
TO MATCH BOLT HOLES
18"
6"
1'
-
6
"
MI
N
3"
C
.
L
.
18"
3"
C
.
L
.
3"
M
I
N
1'-6"
MIN
1"-6"
MIN
2-6"
MAXIMUM
1'
-
6
"
MI
N
1-
6
"
MI
N
1-
6
"
MI
N
5"9"
TOP SECTION VIEW
NOT TO SCALE
SIDE SECTION VIEW
NOT TO SCALE
ELEVATION VIEW
NOT TO SCALE
NOTES:
1.CONCRETE SHALL BE 3000 P.S.I. READY MIX
POURED IN PLACE
2.REINFORCED BARS SHALL BE DEFORMED BARS
AND TIED TOGETHER.
3.FORMWORK AT FACE OF ANCHOR WALLS MUST
BE REMOVED. BACKFILL AT FACE OF ANCHOR
WALL MUST BE COMPACTED TO 95% MAX DRY
DENSITY BASED ASTM D1557 PRIOR TO
REINSTATING SERVICE OF THE WATER MAIN.
UNDISTURBED EARTH
CONCRETE DEADMAN
BLOCK
PUBLIC WORKS
DEPARTMENT
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS
WTR-27-4186
DocuSign Envelope ID:3458681D-914F-4F2D-AB59-7C192D3B78A3
MANHOLE FRAME AND COVER
6" l SEE STD. PLAN 401
12" MAX. ADJUSTMENT RINGS AND MORTAR JOINTS
10440.1
SEE NOTE 3
D,
FIRST STEP SHALL BE A MAXIMUM OF 18"
1
BELOW THE COVER.
CONE (ECCENTRIC)
STEPS — POLYPROPYLENE STEPS
6-1/2"~I —•' SHALL BE INCLUDED
r
5' MIN.
RUBBER GASKETED JOINTS SEE NOTE 5
c
12" (TYP) •.
IF REQUIRED, LADDER—POLYPROPYLENE
SHALL BE ATTACHED TO MANHOLE
MAX. PIPE SIZE — 'E'
s
SHELF AND CHANNEL SHALL BE
3000 PSI CONCRETE
1%
o . a'PRECAST BASE SECTION
OR CAST IN SHELF.
i••r!••'•hetishir!•e•r•tr!• %•s:!•" COMPACTED SUBGRADE WITH 6"
CRUSHED ROCK OR ADDITIONAL
NOT TO SCALE MATERIAL SUITABLE TO
SUPPORT STRUCTURE.
A' B' C' D' E'
48" MH 48" 6" MIN. 5"MIN 24" MIN. 21" I.D.
54" MH 54" 8" MIN. 5.5" MIN. 24" MIN. 24" I.D.
60" MH 60" 8" MIN. 6" MIN. 42" MIN. 30" I.D.
NOTES:
1. STEPS ARE TO BE IN PLACE BEFORE MANHOLE SECTIONS ARE INSTALLED.
2. MANHOLE SECTIONS TO BE OF REINFORCED PRECAST CONCRETE IN CONFORMANCE WITH ASTM C-478.
3. ADJUSTMENT OF THE CASTING TO GRADE SHALL BE PER STD PLAN 106. THE USE OF SHIMS IS PROHIBITED.
4. SANITARY SEWER MANHOLES SHALL HAVE ALL INTERIOR SURFACES, INCLUDING CHANNELING,
FACTORY—COATED (SEALED) WITH A HIGH SOLIDS URETHANE COATING; WASSER MC—SHIELDCOAT 100 OR
APPROVED EQUAL; COLOR OF COATING SHALL BE WHITE.
5. RUBBER GASKETED JOINTS SHALL BE IN CONFORMANCE WITH ASTM C-443.
6. CHANNEL WIDTH AND HEIGHT SHALL EQUAL THE INSIDE DIAMETER OF THE LARGEST PIPE.
7. CONNECTIONS TO MANHOLE SHALL BE MADE USING KOR—N—SEAL BOOTS OR APPROVED EQUAL.
8. IN UNIMPROVED AREAS, MANHOLES SHALL EXTEND A MINIMUM OF 6" AND A MAXIMUM OF 12"
ABOVE FINISHED GRADE OR MUST HAVE AN AT—GRADE, MINIMUM 2'—WIDE CONCRETE RING POURED AROUND
THE COVER. IN PAVED AREAS, COVER MUST SLOPE TO MATCH PAVING.
9. MANHOLES OVER 20' DEEP SHALL BE A MINIMUM OF 60" IN DIAMETER.
STD.PLAN-400.1
PUBLIC WORKS gnedby:
DEPARTMENT STANDARD SANITARY MANHOLE Martin Pastucli'26/202C I 12:
F N T O M°tertf , 449D... DATE
DocuSign Envelope ID:345B681 D-914F-4F2D-AB59-7C192D3B78A3
rW (SEE NOTE 7) LIMITS OF PIPE ZONE
6"
BEDDING MATERIAL FORa
SANITARY SEWER PIPE
O.D.
SEE NOTE 5)
of
PIPE
FOUNDATION LEVEL
6"
BEDDING FOR SANITARY SEWER PIPE
NOTES:
1. PROVIDE UNIFORM SUPPORT UNDER BARREL.
2. HAND TAMP UNDER HAUNCHES.
3. COMPACT BEDDING MATERIAL TO 95% MAX. DENSITY EXCEPT DIRECTLY
OVER PIPE. HAND TAMP ONLY.
4. PIPE INSTALLATION SHALL BE PER SECTION 7-08 OF THE
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS.
5. PIPE ZONE MATERIAL SHALL BE PER SECTION 9-03.12(3)
OF THE STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS.
6. PIPE MUST BE ANCHORED IN SUCH A MANNER AS TO ENSURE FLOW
LINE IS MAINTAINED.
7. TRENCH WIDTH SHALL BE PER SECTION 2-09.4 OF THE
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS.
STD. PLAN—405
PUBLIC WORKS PIPE BEDDING APP ---
41'
1 DEPARTMENT FOR SANITARY SEWERS Martin Pastucfa/26/2o2o I 12:
4 i
f H 1° 8B®467 FD98B449D...
vueuc won nomim.v.w DATE
23 Drainage Report\
DRAINAGE REPORT
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
April 2024
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, WA 98101
(206) 505-3400
www.bhcconsultants.com
This report has been prepared for the use of the client for the specific purposes identified in the report. The conclusions,
observations, and recommendations contained herein attributed to BHC Consultants constitute the opinions of BHC
Consultants. To the extent that statements, information, and opinions provided by the client or others have been used in the
preparation of this report, BHC Consultants has relied upon the same to be accurate, and for which no assurances are intended
and no representations or warranties are made. BHC Consultants makes no certification and gives no assurances except as
explicitly set forth in this report
Copyright 2023, BHC Consultants, LLC
All rights reserved.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
This document was prepared under the direct supervision of:
Rebecca Loveday Ochiltree, P.E.
BHC Consultants, LLC
04/02/2024
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
i
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. Project Overview .................................................................................................................................. 1
1.1 Existing Site .............................................................................................................................. 1
1.2 Proposed Project ....................................................................................................................... 2
2. Conditions and Requirements Summary ............................................................................................. 2
3. Offsite Analysis .................................................................................................................................... 5
4. Flow Control, Low Impact Development (LID), and Water Quality Facility Analysis and Design .......... 5
5. Special Reports and Studies ................................................................................................................ 5
6. Other Permits ....................................................................................................................................... 5
7. CSWPP Analysis and Design .............................................................................................................. 6
7.1 Part A: Erosion and Sediment Control Plan Analysis and Design ............................................. 6
7.2 Part B: Stormwater Pollution Prevention and Spill Control Plan Design .................................... 6
8. Operations and Maintenance Manual .................................................................................................. 7
9. References .......................................................................................................................................... 7
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1 Requirements for Targeted Drainage Review Categories #1 and #2 ............................................... 3
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1: Vicinity Map
Figure 2: Existing Conditions
Select Issued for Bid Drawings
APPENDICES
Appendix A – Operations and Maintenance Manual
Appendix B – Geotechnical Engineering Report
Appendix C – Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (under separate cover)
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
ii
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
iii
ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS LIST
APA Aquifer Protection Area
BMP Best Management Practices
BP Basin Plan
City City of Renton
COR City of Renton
CSWPP Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention
DHA Duane Hartman and Associates
ELW East Lake Washington
ESC Erosion and Sediment Control
FEMA Federal Emergency Management Agency
HMP Hazard Mitigation Plan
LF Linear Feet
LID Low Impact Development
LMP Lake Management Plan
MDP Master Drainage Plan
NFHL National Flood Hazard Layer
PSE Puget Sound Energy
RMC Renton Municipal Code
ROW Right-of-Way
SCP Salmon Conservation Plan
SFDP Shared Facility Drainage Plan
SWCP Stormwater Compliance Plan
SWPP Stormwater Pollution Prevention
SWDM Surface Water Design Manual
TDR Targeted Drainage Report
WSDOT Washington State Department of Transportation
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
iv
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY BLANK.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
1
1. Project Overview
The City of Renton (City) Windsor Hills Utility Improvement Project involves the installation of new water
mains, service lines to customers, and fire hydrants, along with stormwater improvements consisting of new
storm drain piping, catch basins, and manholes. Overall, this project is intended to increase fire flow
capacity and improve water quality as part of the City’s Water System Plan Update dated May 2021.
This Drainage Report is in accordance with Renton’s 2022 Surface Water Design Manual (SWDM). The
SWDM is adopted from the 2021 King County Surface Water Design Manual with amendments. It was
determined a Targeted Drainage Report (TDR) Project Category #1 and #2 are needed for this project. A
Category #1 TDR is required due to the critical areas within the project area including regulated slopes,
high landslide potential, and high erosion hazard. A Category #2 is also required due to the proposed
drainage pipe size of 12 inches (Reference: Renton SWDM).
The location of the Windsor Hills Project is the Windsor Hills neighborhood of Renton, east of I-405, west of
Edmonds Ave NE, and north of NE 4th Street. Windsor Hills is an established residential neighborhood
consisting of single-family residences. See Figure 1: Vicinity Map for further detail. Project work is
anticipated to be largely completed within the existing City right of way, on City property, or in existing City
easements. The proposed quantity of replaced utilities in this project includes approximately 7,000 linear
feet (LF) of new 8-inch ductile iron water mains, new 1-inch water service lines to 136 existing customers,
and new fire hydrants installed within 300 feet of existing residential dwellings. Stormwater improvements
will include approximately 4,200 LF of 12-inch storm drain with catch basins and manholes.
An existing ditch (Ditch 1) lined with stones and concrete debris runs between 514 and 550 Grandey Way
NE and drains into a culvert beneath Grandey Way NE. The ditch is 2.5 to 5 feet wide, 2 to 4 feet deep, 80
feet long, and has a roughly 5 percent slope. An existing 4- to 6-foot-high retaining wall runs along the
eastern property boundaries.
A second existing concrete lined ditch (Ditch 2) runs between 472 and 476 Bronson Way NE and drains
into a culvert underneath Bronson Way NE. The ditch is approximately 6-to12-inches deep, 2 feet wide,
120 feet long, and has roughly a 2 percent slope.
A 1- to 3-foot-deep ditch with a 10 percent inclination (Ditch 3) is located on the Puget Sound Energy (PSE)
parcel south of 456 Bronson Way NE. The ditch flows from southeast to northwest, connecting stormwater
drainage pipes from neighboring properties to an existing catch basin adjacent to Bronson Way NE (BHC,
2023). The eastern side of the ditch is grassed, and the western side of the ditch is covered in thick
blackberry bushes.
The existing site conditions are presented in Figure 2: Existing Conditions.
1.1 Existing Site
The Windsor Hills Utility Improvement Project consists of improvements in an area of approximately 35
acres within the Windsor Hills residential neighborhood in Renton. This area is located in the Cedar River-
Lake Washington Watershed in the East Lake Washington (ELW) Basin. The ELW Basin is broken into five
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
2
sections along the east side of Lake Washington. This project is located in the furthest south section of this
basin at the bottom of Lake Washington.
The existing site conditions are typical of those in a residential neighborhood, with the following additional
features:
Areas mapped within regulated, sensitive, and protected slopes (Reference: City of Renton, 2022)
Areas mapped in high erosion potential areas (Reference: City of Renton, 2022)
Two concrete lined ditches running between properties.
1.2 Proposed Project
Proposed project improvements include below ground piping, catch basins, manholes, new water meter
connections, and improvements to three open channels: Ditch 1, Ditch 2, and Ditch 3. Ditch 1
improvements include a proposed bird cage overflow structure that will convey stormwater from an existing
storm drain above the existing wall to a proposed storm drain that will replace the existing ditch. The
proposed bird cage and storm drain will be connected by an 18-inch diameter polypropylene buried
stormwater pipe. The existing wall will be protected during installation of the overflow structure by carefully
excavating the area and providing bracing as needed. Ditch 2 improvements include replacement of the
surface water ditch with hard-piped18-inch diameter polypropylene stormwater pipe that flows from a
proposed bird cage inlet structure at the southeast property boundaries. Ditch 3 will be improved by
expanding its width and depth and lining it with quarry spalls.
The proposed land use is described as follows:
Residential – 8
Residential – Multi-Family
Commercial Office
2. Conditions and Requirements Summary
Per Figure 1.1.2.A Flow Chart for Determining Type of Drainage Review Required in the SWDM, a targeted
drainage review is required for this project. Targeted drainage reviews are broken into three categories and
this project pertains to two of the three:
Category #1: Projects containing or adjacent to a flood, erosion, or steep slope hazard area; or
projects within a Landslide Hazard Drainage Area or Aquifer Protection Area.
Category #2: Projects that construct or modify a drainage pipe/ditch that is 12-inch or larger or
receive runoff from a 12-inch of larger drainage pipe/ditch.
Per the SWDM, if the proposed project has the characteristics of more than one project category, the
requirements of each applicable category shall apply.
Table 1 below contains the necessary Core Requirements and Special Requirements applicable for a
Category #1 and #2 TDR.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
3
Table 1
Requirements for Targeted Drainage Review Categories #1 and #2
Requirement Targeted Drainage Review
Category #1 Category #2
Core Requirement #1: Discharge at Natural Location √
Core Requirement #2: Offsite Analysis √1
Core Requirement #3: Flow Control Facilities
Core Requirement #4: Conveyance System √
Core Requirement #5: Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention √ √
Core Requirement #6: Maintenance and Operations √
Core Requirement #7: Financial Guarantees and Liability √1
Core Requirement #8: Water Quality Facilities
Core Requirement #9: On-Site BMPs
Special Requirement #1: Other Adopted Area-Specific
Requirements √1
Special Requirement #2: Flood Hazard Area Delineation √1
Special Requirement #3: Flood Protection Facilities √1
Special Requirement #4: Source Control √1 √1
Special Requirement #5: Oil Control
Special Requirement #6: Aquifer Protection Areas √1 √1
Notes:
1) These requirements have exemptions or thresholds that may preclude or limit their application to
a specific project.
Each requirement and its applicability to this specific project is described below.
Core Requirement #1: Discharge at the Natural Location
Stormwater runoff from the project area presently is and will continue to be routed to an existing WSDOT
pond area, eventually discharging to the Cedar River.
Core Requirement #2: Offsite Analysis
The project falls under exemption #1 from Core Requirement #2: “The City of Renton determines there is
sufficient information for them to conclude that the project will not have a significant adverse impact on the
downstream and/or upstream drainage system.” The project serves to upgrade the existing stormwater
system in-kind and will not have a significant adverse impact on the existing downstream and/or upstream
systems.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
4
Core Requirement #4: Conveyance System
According to SWDM Section 1.2.4.2 Conveyance Requirements for Existing Systems, conveyance systems
that will not experience a change in flow characteristics as a result of the proposed project need not be
analyzed for conveyance capacity. For this project, all existing pipes are being upsized to 12-inch minimum
per City standard. No flooding issues have been observed with the current system containing 8-inch pipes,
it is assumed that upsizing the pipes will not cause flooding issues.
Core Requirement #5: Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention
Required Erosion and Sediment Control (ESC) measures and Stormwater Pollution Prevention (SWPP)
and spill control measures as detailed in SWDM Section 1.2.5, are incorporated into the project design, and
will be implemented and maintained during the construction phase. Temporary and permanent ESC plans
are shown on the Drawing Sheets included with this report. The contractor will be required to implement a
Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention (CSWPP) Plan per this core requirement, which is discussed
further in Section 7 of this report and included under separate cover as Appendix C.
Core Requirement #6: Maintenance and Operations
The proposed stormwater improvements for this project are located in City right-of-way (ROW) with the
exception of three ditches that are located on private property. The improvements located in the ROW will
be maintained by the City of Renton in accordance with Appendix A of the SWDM (Maintenance
Requirements for Stormwater Facilities and On-Site BMPs) and Appendix A of this Drainage Report
(Operations and Maintenance Manual).
The three ditches that are part of this project will also be maintained by the City per the SWDM.
Core Requirement #7: Financial Guarantees and Liability
The Windsor Hills Utility Improvement Project design and construction is funded and managed by the City
of Renton. The bonds and insurances described in Core Requirement #7 do not apply to this project.
Special Requirement #1: Other Adopted Area-Specific Requirements
The proposed work is not related to the drainage requirements listed in SWDM Section 1.3.1.
Master Drainage Plans (MDPs): Not applicable.
Basin Plans (BPs): Not applicable.
Salmon Conservation Plans (SCPs): Not applicable.
Stormwater Compliance Plans (SWCPs): Not applicable.
Lake Management Plans (LMPs): Not applicable. There are no LMPs for this area.
Hazard Mitigation Plan (HMP): Not Applicable.
Shared Facility Drainage Plans (SFDPs): Not applicable. Drainage facilities are not being shared.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
5
Special Requirement #2: Flood Hazard Area Delineation
According to Federal Emergency Management Agency’s (FEMA) National Flood Hazard Layer (NFHL)
Viewer, the project is not located within a flood hazard area.
Special Requirement #3: Flood Protection Facilities
The project does not rely on existing flood protection facilities and does not modify or construct a new flood
protection facility; therefore, no flood protection measures are required.
Special Requirement #4: Source Control
The proposed project does not require a commercial building or commercial site development permit.
Special Requirement #6: Aquifer Protection Areas
Portions of the proposed project are located in Wellhead Protection Areas per the City’s online COR maps.
The specific areas to consider for this Special Requirement within the project are the three open channel
ditches. Of the three proposed ditches, only Ditch 1 is located in a Zone 2 Aquifer Protection Area (APA)
along Grandey Way NE.
3. Offsite Analysis
A downstream analysis is not required since the project is exempt as described under Core Requirement
#2, above.
4. Flow Control, Low Impact Development (LID), and
Water Quality Facility Analysis and Design
Flow control, LID, and water quality facility analysis and design are not required for a Category #1 or #2
Targeted Drainage Review and are excluded from this report.
5. Special Reports and Studies
The following reports are relevant to this project:
Site Survey – Duane Hartman and Associates, Inc (DHA), July 2022.
Geotechnical Engineering Report – Aspect Consulting, September 2022.
6. Other Permits
Permits required with this project will be the following standard permits associated with grading and
drainage review:
Critical Areas Exception Memo, City of Renton
Right of Way Permit, City of Renton.
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
6
7. CSWPP Analysis and Design
Since the construction site has the potential to pollute stormwater by sediment erosion and by ineffective
management of onsite construction-related activities and material storage, contractors are required to
implement a Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention (CSWPP) Plan to effectively manage onsite
construction activities and materials in relation to stormwater pollution. The CSWPP is a comprehensive
document comprised of an Erosion and Sediment Control (ESC) Plan and a Stormwater Pollution
Prevention and Spill Control (SWPPS) Plan. The following sections describe the respective components of
the CSWPP, which propose the implementation of various Best Management Practices (BMPs) to prevent
stormwater pollution onsite and in nearby areas from construction activities. The completed CSWPP can be
found in Appendix C.
7.1 Part A: Erosion and Sediment Control Plan Analysis and Design
The ESC Plan aims to prevent the transport of sediment to bodies of water, drainage systems, and
adjacent properties during and following project construction. A variety of strategies can be employed to
minimize erosion and transport of sediment to the maximum extent practicable. The specific strategies and
Best Management Practices (BMPs) that will be implemented as part of the ESC portion of the CSWPP are
listed below. Further detail about design, implementation, and management of these BMPs can be found in
the Construction SWPPP included under separate cover as Appendix C.
Clearing limits
Cover measures
Perimeter protection
Traffic area stabilization
Sediment retention
Surface water collection
Dewatering control
Dust control.
7.2 Part B: Stormwater Pollution Prevention and Spill Control Plan
Design
The SWPP Plan aims to prevent, reduce, or eliminate the discharge of pollutants to onsite or adjacent
stormwater systems or bodies of water from construction related activities. Materials delivery and storage
and onsite equipment fueling, and maintenance are all construction related activities with the potential to
discharge pollutants onsite, or to nearby stormwater systems or bodies of water. The following pollutants
are anticipated to be present onsite:
Fuel and lubricants for construction equipment
Municipal raw sewage.
The specific strategies and BMPs that will be implemented as part of the SWPP portion of the CSWPP to
prevent onsite discharge of the above pollutants are listed below. Additional detail about design,
City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Replacement
Drainage Report
7
implementation, and management of these BMPs can be found in the Construction SWPPP included under
separate cover as Appendix C.
Sawcutting and surfacing pollution prevention
Material delivery, storage, and containment.
8. Operations and Maintenance Manual
Per requirements in the SWDM, an operations and maintenance manual is to be provided for all flow
control, conveyance, and water quality facilities. Appendix A contains the maintenance requirements for the
conveyance facilities included in the proposed project design. The maintenance requirements are taken
from Appendix A of the SWDM.
9. References
City of Renton, 2022, SWDM
City of Renton, 2022, Renton Municipal Code (RMC) Critical Areas Regulations, Chapter 4-03-050,
accessed June 1, 2023.
FIGURES AND SELECT DRAWINGS
GIS Data Source: King C ounty G IS
Data sources supplied may not reflect current or actual conditions. This m ap
is a geographic representation based on inform ation available. It does not
represent survey data. No warranty is made concerning the accuracy, currency,
or completeness of data depicted on this map.
BH C Consultants LLC., assum es no responsibility for the validity of any
information presented herein, nor any responsibility for the use or m isuse of the data.
P:\Mapping\Maps_Generated\Renton\22-10795.00\600\mxd\Fig 1 Vicinity Map - 11x17.mxd 6/2/2023 dknight
COPYRIGHT © 2023 BHC CO NSULTANTS LLC., ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Wind so r Hills Utility Improvements
City of R enton
FigureVicinity Map
1June 2023
Legend
Project Area
Renton City
Boundary
0 1,200 2,400600
Feet $April 2024
GIS Data Source: King C ounty G IS
Data sources supplied may not reflect current or actual conditions. This m ap
is a geographic representation based on inform ation available. It does not
represent survey data. No warranty is made concerning the accuracy, currency,
or completeness of data depicted on this map.
BH C Consultants LLC., assum es no responsibility for the validity of any
information presented herein, nor any responsibility for the use or m isuse of the data.
P:\Mapping\Maps_Generated\Renton\22-10795.00\600\mxd\Fig 2 Existing Conditions - 11x17.mxd 6/2/2023 dknight
COPYRIGHT © 2023 BHC CO NSULTANTS LLC., ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Wind so r Hills Utility Improvements
City of R enton
FigureExisting Conditions
2June 2023
Legend
Project Area
Public Existing
Storm
Conveyance
Private Existing
Storm
Conveyance
Public Culvert
Private Culvert
U!;Public Discharge
Point
Existing Sewer
Piping
Surface Water
Ditch
0 240 480120
Feet $April 2024
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
CITY PROJECT: 27-04186
MARCH 2024
COPYRIGHT © 2024 BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC. ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Pa
t
h
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
d
F
il
e
n
a
m
e
:
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
P
l
o
t
d
a
t
e
:
M
a
r
0
7
,
2
0
2
4
-
0
2
:
58
:
1
0
p
m
C
A
D
U
s
e
r
:
a
c
a
r
i
a
s
o
.
X
r
e
f
F
i
l
e
n
a
m
e
:
|
X
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
t
a
t
u
s
|
G-1
85of1
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.comKING COUNTY
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES INC. - SURVEY
ASPECT CONSULTING, LLC - GEOTECHNICAL
TENW - TRAFFIC CONTROL AND SURFACE RESTORATION
KING COUNTY
PROJECT LOCATION
405
5
Seattle
Redmond
2
522
90
202
18
169
167
Skykomish
Maple Valley
Bellevue
Renton PREPARED BY:
IN ASSOCIATION WITH:
LOCATION MAP VICINITY MAP
520
NTS NTS
PROJECT MANAGER
KATIE MEDINA, P.E. Kmedina@rentonwa.gov 425-430-7335
JARED McDONALD, P.E. Jmcdonald@rentonwa.gov 425-430-7293
CITY OF RENTON
NE 4TH ST
W I N D S O R W A Y N E
B R O N S O N W A Y N EGRANDEY W A Y
B R O N S O N
PL
NE
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
I-405
S U N S E T B L V D N E
BRONSON WAY NE
B R O N S O N
W A Y N E
PROJECT
LOCATION
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
2
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
INDEX OF DRAWINGS G-2
2 86
M. McCrosky, P.E.
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
INDEX OF DRAWINGS
SHEET
NO.DRAWING TITLEDWG
NO.
GENERAL
1 G-1 COVER SHEET AND VICINITY MAP
2 G-2 INDEX OF DRAWINGS
3 G-3 GENERAL AND SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES
4 G-4 WATER AND WASTEWATER NOTES
5 G-5 LEGENDS AND ABBREVIATIONS
6 G-6 SURVEY CONTROL AND NOTES
7 G-7 ALIGNMENT TABLES 1 OF 2
8 G-8 ALIGNMENT TABLES 2 OF 2
9 G-9 EROSION CONTROL KEY PLAN
10 G-10 WATER KEY PLAN
11 G-11 STORMWATER KEY PLAN
12 G-12 CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING, GENERAL REQUIREMENTS, AND POTHOLING DATA
13 G-13 TRENCH DAM DETAIL
EROSION CONTROL
14 EC-1 TESC NOTES
15 EC-2 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 1+00 TO 8+25
16 EC-3 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 8+25 TO 17+50
17 EC-4 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 17+50 TO 22+50 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 29+80 TO 34+00
18 EC-5 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLANS STA 34+00 TO 42+50
19 EC-6 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 42+50 TO 47+00 BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25
20 EC-7 BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 54+00 TO 57+50 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25
21 EC-8 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 83+25 TO 88+01 WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 60+00 TO 64+50
22 EC-9 WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 64+50 TO 73+50
23 EC-10 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 73+50 TO 75+76 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 800+00 TO 802+10
24 EC-11 DITCH TESC PLAN
WATER
25 W-1 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 0+80 TO 4+50
26 W-2 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 4+50 TO 8+25
27 W-3 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 8+25 TO 13+00
28 W-4 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 13+00 TO 17+50
29 W-5 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 17+50 TO 22+50
30 W-6 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 29+80 TO 34+00
31 W-7 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 34+00 TO 38+50
32 W-8 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 38+50 TO 42+50
33 W-9 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 42+50 TO 47+00
34 W-10 BRONSON PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 49+80 TO 54+00
35 W-11 BRONSON PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 54+00 TO 57+50
36 W-12 WINDSOR PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 79+80 TO 83+25
37 W-13 WINDSOR PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 83+25 TO 88+00
38 W-14 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 59+80 TO 64+50
39 W-15 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 64+50 TO 69+50
40 W-16 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 69+50 TO 73+50
41 W-17 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 73+50 TO 75+76
42 W-18 VUEMONT PL NE WATER MAIN STA 700+00 TO 702+00
43 W-19 1" WATER SERVICE CONNECTION DETAILS FOR 5/8" x 3/4" AND 1" METERS
44 W-20 WATER SERVICE CONNECTION DETAILS FOR 1 1/2" METER
45 W-21 1 1/2" METER MATERIAL LIST
46 W-22 WATER MAIN CONNECTIONS DETAILS
47 W-23 WATER MAIN POLYPIGGING PLAN
STORMWATER
48 SD-1 BRONSON WAY NE STORM DRAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 1+00 TO 4+50
49 SD-2 BRONSON WAY NE STA 4+50 TO 8+25
50 SD-3 BRONSON WAY NE STA 8+25 TO 13+00
51 SD-4 BRONSON WAY NE STA14+25 TO 18+50
52 SD-5 BRONSON WAY NE STA17+50 TO 22+50
53 SD-6 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 30+00 TO 34+00
54 SD-7 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 8+00 TO 13+00
55 SD-8 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 38+50 TO 42+50
56 SD-9 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 42+50 TO 47+00
57 SD-10 BRONSON PL NE STA 80+00 TO 83+25
58 SD-11 BRONSON PL NE STA 54+00 TO 57+50
59 SD-12 WINDSOR PL NE STA 80+00 TO 83+25
60 SD-13 WINDSOR PL NE STA 83+25 TO 88+00
61 SD-14 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 60+00 TO 64+50
62 SD-15 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 64+50 TO 69+50
63 SD-16 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 69+50 TO 73+50
64 SD-17 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 73+50 TO 75+76
65 SD-18 VUEMONT PL NE STA 700+00 TO 702+00 AND STORM STRUCTURE TABLE
66 SD-19 GRANDEY WAY DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
67 SD-20 BRONSON WAY NE DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
68 SD-21 BRONSON WAY NE DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
69 SD-22 STORMWATER DETAILS
RESTORATION
70 R-1 RESTORATION KEY PLAN
71 R-2 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 1+00 TO 7+00
72 R-3 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 7+00 TO 13+00
73 R-4 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 13+00 TO 19+50
74 R-5 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 19+50 TO 22+50
75 R-6 GRANDEY WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 38+00 TO 44+50
76 R-7 GRANDEY WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 31+50 TO 38+50
77 R-8 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 61+00 TO 67+00
78 R-9 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 67+00 TO 72+50
79 R-10 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 72+50 TO 76+00
80 R-11 WINDSOR PL NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 80+50 TO 84+00
81 R-12 BRONSON PL NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 51+00 TO 57+00
82 R-13 DRIVEWAY DETAILS
TRAFFIC CONTROL
83 TC-1 WINDSOR WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
84 TC-2 WINDSOR PL & BRONSON PL NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
85 TC-3 BRONSON WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
86 TC-4 GRANDEY WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
SHEET
NO.DRAWING TITLEDWG
NO.
GENERAL NOTES SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES (CONT.)
SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES
1. NOT USED
2. NOT USED
3. ALL STORM DRAINAGE IMPROVEMENTS SHALL BE DESIGNED AND CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LATEST
EDITION OF THE CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM), RENTON MUNICIPAL CODE
(RMC), AND THE STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS FOR ROAD, BRIDGE AND MUNICIPAL CONSTRUCTION PREPARED BY
WSDOT AND THE AMERICAN PUBLIC WORKS ASSOCIATION (APWA).
4. NOT USED
5. NOT USED
6. NOT USED
7. ALL UTILITY TRENCH BACKFILL AND ROADWAY SUBGRADE SHALL BE COMPACTED TO 95% MAXIMUM DRY DENSITY
PER SECTION 2-03.3(14)D - COMPACTION AND MOISTURE CONTROL TESTS OF THE WSDOT STANDARD
SPECIFICATIONS.
8. NOT USED.
9. ALL PIPE AND STRUCTURES SHALL BE STAKED FOR SURVEY LINE AND GRADE PRIOR TO THE START OF
CONSTRUCTION. WHERE SHOWN ON THE PLANS OR WHERE DIRECTED BY THE CITY, THE EXISTING MANHOLES,
CATCH BASINS, OR INLETS SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO THE GRADE AS STAKED.
10. NOT USED
11. ALL PIPE AND APPURTENANCES SHALL BE LAID ON A PROPERLY PREPARED FOUNDATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE
CURRENT STATE OF WASHINGTON STANDARD SPECIFICATION FOR ROAD AND BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION. THIS SHALL
INCLUDE NECESSARY LEVELING OF THE TRENCH BOTTOM OR THE TOP OF THE FOUNDATION MATERIAL, AS WELL AS
PLACEMENT AND COMPACTION OF REQUIRED BEDDING MATERIAL TO UNIFORM GRADE SO THAT THE ENTIRE LENGTH
OF THE PIPE WILL BE SUPPORTED ON A UNIFORMLY DENSE, UNYIELDING BASE. ALL PIPE BEDDING AND BACKFILL
SHALL BE AS SHOWN ON THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 220.00, 220.10, AND 220.20.
12. NOT USED.
13. ALL DRAINAGE STRUCTURES SUCH AS CATCH BASINS AND MANHOLES SHALL BE FITTED WITH DUCTILE IRON,
BOLT-LOOKING LIDS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 204.10, 204.20, 204.30, 204.40, AND 204.50. STRUCTURES SHALL
HAVE:
·RECTANGULAR OR ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND OUTSIDE OF THE ROADWAY.
·ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND LOCATED WITHIN THE ROADWAY, BUT OUTSIDE OF
THE CURB/GUTTER LINE.
·ROUND, SOLID LIDS DISPLAYING THE CITY LOGO WHEN WITHIN THE PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY OR IN AN EASEMENT
TO THE CITY. PRIVATE STRUCTURE LIDS OUTSIDE PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY AND EASEMENTS TO THE CITY SHALL
NOT DISPLAY THE CITY LOGO.
14. NOT USED
15. LIDS OF MANHOLES/CATCH BASINS WITHIN PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY SHALL NOT BE ADJUSTED TO FINAL GRADE UNTIL
AFTER PAVING. ALL MANHOLE/CATCH BASINS RIMS SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO BE FLUSH WITH FINAL FINISHED GRADES,
UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN.
16. NOT USED.
17. ROCK FOR EROSION PROTECTION OF ROADSIDE DITCHES, WHERE REQUIRED, SHALL BE OF SOUND QUARRY ROCK
PLACED TO A MINIMUM DEPTH OF ONE (1) FOOT AND SHALL MEET THE FOLLOWING SPECIFICATIONS:
·4 - 8 INCH ROCK / 40 - 70% PASSING.
·2 - 4 INCH ROCK / 30 - 40% PASSING; AND
·LESS THAN 2 INCH ROCK / 10 - 20% PASSING.
18. NOT USED
19. THE END OF EACH STORM DRAIN STUB SHALL BE CAPPED. A CLEANOUT TOPPED WITH A BOLT-LOCKING LID MARKED
"STORM" OR "DRAIN" SHALL BE LOCATED AT THE PROPERTY LINE OR AT THE POINT OF CONNECTION OF A PRIVATE
STORM DRAINAGE CONVEYANCE SYSTEM PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 227.00.
20. ALL STORM SYSTEM EXTENSIONS SHALL BE STAKED FOR LINE AND GRADE BY A SURVEYOR LICENSED IN
WASHINGTON STATE, AND CUT SHEETS SHALL BE PROVIDED TO THE CITY PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
21. ALL NEWLY-INSTALLED AND NEWLY-REHABILITATED (PUBLIC AND PRIVATE) STORM CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS SHALL
BE INSPECTED BY MEANS OF REMOTE CCTV ACCORDING TO THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 266.00. CCTV INSPECTIONS
AND REPORTS SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY PRIOR TO RECEIVING APPROVAL TO INSTALL PROJECT CURBS,
GUTTERS AND/OR PAVEMENT.
1. ALL WORK AND WORK MATERIAL SHALL BE IN CONFORMANCE WITH THE STANDARDS AND SPECIFICATIONS OF THE
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT AND THE 2023 EDITION OF THE WSDOT/APWA STANDARDS AND
SPECIFICATIONS, AS APPROVED AND MODIFIED BY THE CITY OF RENTON IN THE RENTON STANDARD PLANS &
SPECIFICATIONS. A SET OF APPROVED PLANS SHALL BE KEPT ON SITE AT ALL TIMES DURING CONSTRUCTION.
2. THE HOURS OF WORK IN THE STREET RIGHT OF WAY SHALL BE PER CITY SPECIFICATIONS ON WEEKDAYS UNLESS
OTHERWISE APPROVED IN WRITING BY THE PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT, REFER TO SP 1-08.0(2).
3. THE CITY OF RENTON AND BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR EXISTING UTILITY LOCATIONS
AND ELEVATIONS. ALL LOCATIONS OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN ARE APPROXIMATE AND IT SHALL BE THE
CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO VERIFY THE TRUE AND CORRECT LOCATION AND ELEVATION SO AS TO AVOID
DAMAGE OR DISTURBANCE PRIOR TO COMMENCEMENT OF ANY CONSTRUCTION. THE INFORMATION IS PROVIDED
FOR CONTRACTORS CONVENIENCE ONLY. THERE MAY BE DISCREPANCIES AND OMISSIONS.
4. BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY OCCURS, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MEET WITH THE CITY FOR A
PRE-CONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE. A MINIMUM OF FIVE (5) WORKING DAYS NOTICE IS REQUIRED FOR SCHEDULING.
TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS NOTICE WILL BE REQUIRED PRIOR TO STARTING CONSTRUCTION.
REFER TO SP 1-07.6 and 1-08.0(1).
5. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL FOLLOW CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12. THE
CONTRACTOR MAY PROPOSE ALTERNATIVES FOR THE CITY'S APPROVAL.
6. INSPECTION WILL BE ACCOMPLISHED BY A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE CITY OF RENTON. IT SHALL BE THE
CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO NOTIFY THE CITY IN ADVANCE OF BACKFILLING ANY CONSTRUCTION.
7. PLANS APPROVED BY THE CITY OF RENTON, PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT SHALL TAKE PRECEDENCE OVER ALL
OTHER PLANS.
8. NOT USED.
9. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE THE CITY OF RENTON WITH AN AS-BUILT DRAWING OF THE STORM, WATER, AND
SEWER IMPROVEMENTS, WHICH HAS BEEN STAMPED AND SIGNED BY A LICENSED PROFESSIONAL ENGINEER OR
LICENSED PROFESSIONAL SURVEYOR, REFER TO SP 1-05.4
10. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL UTILITY LOCATIONS PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION BY CALLING THE
UNDERGROUND LOCATE LINE AT 1-800-424-5555 A MINIMUM OF 48 HOURS PRIOR TO ANY EXCAVATION,
REFER TO SP 1-7.17
11. A PROJECT GEOTECHNICAL ENGINEERING REPORT IS AVAILABLE FOR CONTRACTOR REFERENCE AS NOTED IN THE
CONTRACT BIDDING DOCUMENTS.
12. OVERHEAD ELECTRICAL POWER, TELEPHONE, CABLE TV, AND OTHER OVERHEAD LINES ARE GENERALLY NOT
SHOWN. THE LINES THAT ARE SHOWN ARE LOCATED BY POINT-TO-POINT, POLE OR TOWER TO POLE OR TOWER.
DETERMINE THE EXTENT OF HAZARDS OR IMPACTS ON CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITIES CREATED BY OVERHEAD OR
UNDERGROUND ELECTRICAL POWER, TELEPHONE, CABLE TV, AND OTHER LINES IN ALL AREAS, AND FOLLOW
PROCEDURES DURING CONSTRUCTION AS REQUIRED BY LAW AND REGULATIONS. PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION, MEET
WITH UTILITY OWNERS TO DETERMINE THE EXTENT OF HAZARDS AND TAKE WHATEVER PRECAUTIONS AND
REMEDIAL MEASURES THAT MAY BE REQUIRED TO PROTECT PERSONS AND PROPERTY AND TO AVOID DISRUPTION
OF SERVICE.
13. MANHOLES, CATCH BASINS, AND OTHER STRUCTURES ARE GENERALLY SHOWN ON PLAN AND PROFILE DRAWINGS
SYMBOLICALLY. CONSTRUCT MANHOLES, CATCH BASINS, AND OTHER STRUCTURES AS SHOWN ON DETAIL
DRAWINGS AND AS SPECIFIED.
14. ALL UTILITIES SHALL BE SUPPORTED AND MAINTAINED DURING CONSTRUCTION (INCLUDING THOSE IDENTIFIED AS
ABANDONED OR TO BE ABANDONED).
15. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROTECT PUBLIC AND PRIVATE PROPERTY. PROPERTY DISTURBED DURING CONSTRUCTION
TO BE RESTORED TO EXISTING CONDITIONS UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED BY THE CITY. THE CONTRACTOR IS
RESPONSIBLE FOR IDENTIFYING AND DOCUMENTING ANY DAMAGE THAT IS PRE-EXISTING OR CAUSED BY OTHERS.
REFER TO SS 1-07.16 AND SP 1-07.16.
16. PROTECTION OF THE ENVIRONMENT: NO CONSTRUCTION RELATED ACTIVITY SHALL CONTRIBUTE TO THE
DEGRADATION OF THE ENVIRONMENT, ALLOW MATERIAL TO ENTER SURFACE OR GROUND WATERS, OR ALLOW
PARTICULATE EMISSIONS TO THE ATMOSPHERE, WHICH EXCEED STATE OR FEDERAL STANDARDS. ANY ACTIONS
THAT POTENTIALLY ALLOW A DISCHARGE TO STATE WATERS MUST HAVE PRIOR APPROVAL OF THE STATE OF
WASHINGTON, DEPARTMENT OF ECOLOGY.
17. ALL DISTANCES SHOWN ON THE DRAWINGS AND DESCRIBED IN THE SPECIFICATIONS SHALL BE INTERPRETED TO REFER TO
THE HORIZONTALLY AND VERTICALLY PROJECTED PLANES UNLESS OTHERWISE INDICATED. LINEAL FOOTAGE OF PIPING
SHOWN ON THE DRAWINGS REFERS TO HORIZONTAL LENGTH. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL DIMENSIONS BEFORE
STARTING WORK AND SHALL IMMEDIATELY NOTIFY THE ENGINEER OF ANY DISCREPANCIES.
18. SYSTEM OPERATION AND SERVICES SHALL BE MAINTAINED DURING CONSTRUCTION. SOME DWGS HAVE SPECIFIC
SEQUENCING REQUIREMENTS TO MAINTAIN SERVICE. SEE NOTE 12 ON DWG G-12.
19. ALL EXCAVATIONS ADJACENT TO POWER POLES OR OTHER RELATED FACILITIES (VAULTS, HANDHOLES, ETC.) SHALL COMPLY
WITH WAC 296-155, PART N, EXCAVATION, TRENCHING AND SHORING. POLE PROTECTION/ SUPPORTING SYSTEMS USED
WHILE EXCAVATING SHALL COMPLY WITH WAC 155-655 GENERAL PROTECTION REQUIREMENTS, ITEM (9) AND SHALL NOT
AFFECT THE STRUCTURAL INTEGRITY OF POLES WHILE THE SYSTEMS ARE IN PLACE OR AFTER THE SYSTEMS HAVE BEEN
REMOVED.
20. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR FULL RESTORATION OF ALL EXISTING FEATURES DISTURBED DURING
CONSTRUCTION TO THEIR ORIGINAL CONDITION UNLESS OTHERWISE INDICATED BY THE ENGINEER. ALL MATERIALS USED
FOR THE CONSTRUCTION SHALL BE NEW AND UNDAMAGED, AND CATALOG CUTS FOR ALL MATERIALS SHALL BE
APPROVED IN WRITING BY THE CITY PRIOR TO BRINGING ANY MATERIALS ON SITE.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
3
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
GENERAL AND SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE
NOTES G-3
3 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
22. ALL STORM SYSTEMS AND CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING MAINS SHALL BE TESTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION
7-04.3(1) OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS AND IN THE THE PRESENCE OF A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE
CITY. STORM DRAIN STUBS SHALL BE TESTED FOR ACCEPTANCE AT THE SAME TIME THE MAIN STORM IS TESTED.
23. FOR ALL DISTURBED PERVIOUS AREAS (COMPACTED, GRADED, LANDSCAPED, ETC.) OF THE DEVELOPMENT
SITE, TO MAINTAIN THE MOISTURE CAPACITY OF THE SOIL EITHER STOCKPILE AND REDISTRIBUTE THE
EXISTING DUFF LAYER AND NATIVE TOPSOIL OR AMEND THE SOIL WITH COMPOST IN ACCORDANCE WITH
STANDARD PLAN 264.00.
24. ISSUANCE OF THE BUILDING OR CONSTRUCTION PERMITS BY THE CITY DOES NOT RELIEVE THE
CONTRACTOR OF THE CONTINUING LEGAL OBLIGATION AND/OR LIABILITY CONNECTED WITH STORMWATER
DISPOSAL. THE CITY DOES NOT ACCEPT ANY OBLIGATION FOR THE PROPER FUNCTIONING AND
MAINTENANCE OF THE STORM SYSTEM PROVIDED DURING CONSTRUCTION.
25. ADEQUATE SAFEGUARDS, SAFETY DEVICES, PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, FLAGGERS, AND ANY OTHER
ACTIONS NEEDED TO PROTECT THE LIFE, HEALTH, AND SAFETY OF THE PUBLIC, AND TO PROTECT
PROPERTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE PERFORMANCE OF WORK SHALL BE PROVIDED. ANY WORK WITHIN
THE TRAVELED RIGHT-OF-WAY THAT MAY INTERRUPT NORMAL TRAFFIC FLOW SHALL REQUIRE A TRAFFIC
CONTROL PLAN APPROVED BY THE CITY. ALL SECTIONS OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 1-10
TEMPORARY CONTROL SHALL APPLY.
26. PROJECTS LOCATED WITHIN THE CITY'S AQUIFER PROTECTION AREA (APA) SHALL COMPLY WITH SPECIAL
REQUIREMENT #6 OF THE RENTON SWDM AND AQUIFER PROTECTION REGULATIONS (RMC 4-3-050).
27. PLACEMENT OF SURFACE APPURTENANCES (CATCH BASIN/MANHOLE LIDS, CLEANOUTS, INLETS, ETC.) IN
THE STREET TRAVEL LANE WHEEL PATH, INTERSECTIONS OF SIDEWALK OR CROSSWALK SHALL BE FITTED
WITH A NON-SLIP OR NON-SKID LID PER ADA REQUIREMENTS.
28. NOT USED.
29. MINIMUM COVER OVER STORM DRAINAGE PIPE SHALL CONFORM TO TABLE 4.2.1.A2 OF THE RENTON SWDM.
30. NOT USED
GENERAL NOTES (CONT.)
21. THESE DRAWINGS AND THE IDEAS AND DESIGNS INCORPORATED HEREIN SHALL NOT BE USED, IN WHOLE OR IN
PART, FOR ANY OTHER PROJECT WITHOUT WRITTEN AUTHORIZATION OF CITY OF RENTON AND BHC
CONSULTANTS, LLC.
22. CITY OF RENTON AND WSDOT STD PLANS REFERENCED ON THE DWGS ARE INCLUDED IN THE CONTRACT BIDDING
DOCUMENTS. SOME RENTON STANDARD PLANS HAVE BEEN MODIFIED FOR THE PROJECT. ANY OTHER STD
PLANS REQUIRED TO COMPLETE THE WORK IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS CAN BE
OBTAINED FROM THE CITY OF RENTON.
WATER NOTES WASTEWATER NOTES
1. EXISTING WATER MAINS, HYDRANTS AND SERVICES SHALL REMAIN OPERATIONAL THROUGHOUT THE COURSE OF
CONSTRUCTION. ABANDONMENT AND/OR REMOVAL OF EXISTING WATER MAINS SHALL TAKE PLACE ONLY AFTER
THE NEW MAIN HAS BEEN INSTALLED, TESTED, AND APPROVED BY THE CITY OF RENTON. REFER TO CONSTRUCTION
SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
2. MAIN SHUTDOWNS SHALL BE BY CITY MAINTENANCE STAFF ONLY. CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING MAINS SHALL ALSO
BE PERFORMED BY CITY FORCES, EXCEPT WET TAPS, WHICH MUST BE MADE BY CITY-APPROVED WET TAP
CONTRACTORS. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE TWO WEEK ADVANCED NOTICE TO CITY FOR SCHEDULING OF
CONNECTIONS AND SHUTDOWNS. ALL NECESSARY EXCAVATION AND MATERIALS ARE TO BE SUPPLIED BY THE
CONTRACTOR AND BE ON-SITE PRIOR TO CITY NOTIFICATIONS. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(19)A.
3. VERIFY LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING WATER MAINS AT ALL CONNECTION POINTS PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
THE CONTRACTOR SHALL FIELD VERIFY THE OUTSIDE DIAMETER (O.D.) OF ALL EXISTING CAST-IRON PIPES AND
PROVIDE THE PROPER LONG-BODY ADAPTERS AND TRANSITION COUPLINGS FOR THE FINAL CONNECTIONS BY CITY
FORCES. CONNECTIONS TO ALL DUCTILE IRON PIPES SHALL BE MADE WITH LONG-BODY SOLID SLEEVES (MJ).
REFER TO SP 7-09.3(19)A.
4. ALL CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING WATER MAINS SHALL BE MADE ONLY AFTER ALL THE NEW WATER MAINS AND
APPURTENANCES HAVE SUCCESSFULLY CLEANED WITH POLYPIGS, PASSED ALL PRESSURE TESTS, DISINFECTED
WITH CHLORINE SOLUTION, HAVE RECEIVED SATISFACTORY BACTERIOLOGICAL TEST LAB REPORTS, AND ARE
THOROUGHLY FLUSHED. A SUGGESTED POLYPIGGING PLAN IS INCLUDED ON W-23. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23) &
7-09.3(24)
5. NEW WATER MAIN PIPE MATERIALS SHALL BE DOUBLE THICK CEMENT-LINED DUCTILE IRON PIPE, THICKNESS CLASS
52. ALL DUCTILE IRON PIPES AND FITTINGS SHALL BE WRAPPED WITH 8-MIL BLACK, TUBE-TYPE, POLYETHYLENE
PLASTIC. REFER TO SP 9-30.1(1) & SP 9-30.1(2).
6. ALL WATER PIPES, FITTINGS, AND VALVES SHALL HAVE RESTRAINED JOINTS PER SPECIFICATIONS. ALL MECHANICAL
JOINT FITTINGS AND VALVES SHALL HAVE WEDGE-TYPE RETAINER GLANDS EQUAL TO MEGALUG SERIES 1100. ALL
FITTINGS AND VALVES SHALL ALSO HAVE CONCRETE THRUST BLOCKS PER COR STANDARD PLANS. REFER TO SP
9-30.2(6).
7. RESTRAINED-JOINT DUCTILE IRON PIPE SHALL HAVE A POSITIVE METAL TO METAL CONTACT LOCKING SYSTEM
WITHOUT THE USE OF GRIPPING TEETH. THE USE OF GASKETS FOR PUSH-ON PIPE WITH INTEGRALLY MOLDED
STEEL OR METAL TEETH (E.G. FIELD LOK GASKET, FAST GRIP GASKET, TALON RJ GASKET) SHALL NOT BE ALLOWED
AS SUBSTITUTE FOR RESTRAINED-JOINT PIPES. REFER TO SP 9-30.2(6).
8. ALL WATER MAINS 10 INCH DIAMETER AND SMALLER TO MAINTAIN A MINIMUM COVER OF 36 INCHES BELOW FINISH
GRADE AND ALL WATERMAIN 12 INCH DIAMETER AND LARGER SHALL BE AT A MINIMUM OF 48 INCHES BELOW FINISH
GRADE, UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS. WHERE UTILITY CONFLICTS OCCUR, WATER MAINS ARE TO BE
LOWERED OR RAISED BY PIPE JOINT DEFLECTION OR VERTICAL BENDS AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER TO CLEAR
CONFLICTS. PIPE DEFLECTION SHALL NOT EXCEED ONE-HALF OF PIPE MANUFACTURER’S SPECIFICATION FOR SIZE
OF PIPE USED. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(15).
9. AT UTILITY CROSSINGS MAINTAIN MINIMUM VERTICAL SEPARATION OF 18 INCHES FROM SANITARY SEWER OR
STORM DRAIN PIPE AND 12 INCHES FROM OTHER UTILITIES, MEAUSRED WALL TO WALL, UNLESS OTHERWISE
SHOWN ON THE PLANS. WHERE WATER MAIN CROSSES ABOVE OR BELOW SANITARY SEWER OR STORM DRAIN PIPE,
ONE FULL LENGTH OF WATER PIPE SHALL BE CENTERED FOR MAXIMUM JOINT SEPARATION.
10. ALL WATER MAIN VERTICAL BENDS SHALL INCLUDE VERTICAL THRUST BLOCKING PER COR STANDARD PLAN 330.3.
ALL WATER MAIN HORIZONTAL BENDS SHALL INCLUDE HORIZONTAL THRUST BLOCKING PER COR STANDARD PLAN
330.1.
11. CONTRACTOR TO PROVIDE END CAPS, PLUGS, TEMPORARY BLOW-OFF ASSEMBLIES AND TEMPORARY CONCRETE
THRUST BLOCKING, FOR TESTING AND PURITY ACCEPTANCE PRIOR TO FINAL TIE-INS TO EXISTING WATER SYSTEM.
REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23).
12. NEW WATER MAINS, HYDRANTS, AND SERVICE LATERALS SHALL BE PRESSURE TESTED AT A STATIC PRESSURE OF
150 PSI ABOVE WORKING PRESSURE WITH A MINIMUM OF 225 PSI TEST PRESSURE FOR 120 MINUTES WITH A
MAXIMUM OF 5 PSI PRESSURE DROP DURING THE ENTIRE TEST PERIOD. THE QUANTITY OF WATER LOST FROM THE
MAIN SHALL NOT EXCEED THE NUMBER OF GALLONS PER HOUR AS LISTED IN SP 7-09.3(23). ALL PRESSURE TESTING
SHALL BE DONE IN THE PRESENCE OF A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE CITY OF RENTON. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23).
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
WATER AND WASTEWATER
NOTES G-4
4 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
R. NICOLAS
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
1. PROVIDE AS-BUILT INFORMATION SHOWING ALL INVERT AND RIM ELEVATIONS OF MANHOLES AND SIDE SEWER
VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL LOCATIONS.
2. INSTALL SEWER MAINS AND SERVICES A MINIMUM 2 FEET FROM PARALLEL GAS LINES WHERE CONFLICT OCCURS.
3. AT UTILITY CROSSINGS MAINTAIN MINIMUM TYPICAL VERTICAL SEPARATION OF 18 INCHES FROM WATER AND 12
INCHES FROM OTHER UTILITIES, MEAUSRED WALL TO WALL, UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS. NOTIFY
ENGINEER IF TYPIAL VERTICAL SEPARATION CAN NOT BE MET. 6-INCH ETHAFOAM PAD MAY BE USED IF APPROVED
BY THE CITY OF RENTON.
4. ALL SIDE SEWER COUPLINGS SHALL BE “FERNCO STRONG-BACK” OR APPROVED EQUAL.
G GENERAL
EC EROSION CONTROL
W WATER
SD STORMWATER
R RESTORATION
TC TRAFFIC CONTROL
AASHTO AMERICAN ASSOCIATION OF STATE HIGHWAY
TRANSPORTATION OFFICIALS
AB ANCHOR BOLT
AC ASPHALT CONCRETE
ACP ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT
ADA AMERICANS WITH DISABILITIES ACT
ADS ADVANCED DRAINAGE SYSTEMS (PIPE)
ANSI AMERICAN NATIONAL STANDARDS INSTITUTE
APPROX APPROXIMATE
APWA AMERICAN PUBLIC WORKS ASSOCIATION
AVE AVENUE
BF BLIND FLANGE
BGS BELOW GROUND SURFACE
BO BLOW-OFF
BOT BOTTOM
BSM BIORETENTION SOIL MIX
CB CATCH BASIN
CDF CONTROLLED DENSITY FILL
CED CEDAR
CF CUBIC FEET
CFS CUBIC FEET PER SECOND
CHLK CHAIN LINK FENCE
CI CAST IRON
C/L, CL CENTERLINE
CLR CLEAR
CMP CORRUGATED METAL PIPE
CO CLEANOUT
CONC CONCRETE
CPE CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE PIPE
CPLG COUPLING
CRZ CRITICAL ROOT ZONE
CSBC CRUSHED SURFACING BASE COURSE
CSTC CRUSHED SURFACING TOP COURSE
CTR CENTER
CULV CULVERT
D DEPTH, DOUBLE, DRAIN
DI DUCTILE IRON
DHA DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES
DIA DIAMETER
DR DRIVE
DT DECIDUOUS TREE
DWG DRAWING
DWY DRIVEWAY
E EAST, EASTING, ELECTRICAL
EA EACH
EC EROSION CONTROL
EL, ELEV ELEVATION
EP EDGE OF PAVEMENT
EW EACH WAY
EX EXISTING
FCA FLANGED COUPLING ADAPTER
FF FINISHED FLOOR
FG FINISH GRADE
FH FIRE HYDRANT
FL FLANGE
FM FORCE MAIN
FT FEET, FOOT
G GAS
GALV GALVANIZED
GPM GALLONS PER MINUTE
GPS GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM
GRAV GRAVEL
H HORIZONTAL
HDPE HIGH DENSITY POLYETHYLENE
HMA HOT MIX ASPHALT
HP HORSEPOWER
HYD HYDRANT
ID INSIDE DIAMETER
IE INVERT ELEVATION
IPS IRON PIPE SIZE
JB JUNCTION BOX
L LENGTH
LF LINEAR FEET
LT LEFT
MAP MAPLE
MAX MAXIMUM
MB MAILBOX
MFR MANUFACTURER
MH MANHOLE
MIN MINIMUM
MJ MECHANICAL JOINT
MMA METHYL METHACRYLATE
MON MONUMENT
MPE MEDIUM DENSITY POLYETHYLENE
MUTCD MANUAL OF UNIFORM TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES
N NORTH, NORTHING
NAD NORTH AMERICAN DATUM
NAVD NORTH AMERICAN VERTICAL DATUM
NE NORTHEAST
NIC NOT IN CONTRACT
NO. NUMBER
NTS NOT TO SCALE
NW NORTHWEST
OC ON CENTER
OD OUTSIDE DIAMETER
OH OVERHEAD
OHWM ORDINARY HIGH WATER MARK
OP OVERHEAD POWER
OPG OPENING
P POWER
PE PLAIN END
PED XING PEDESTRIAN CROSSING
PKWY PARKWAY
P/L PROPERTY LINE
PLS PROFESSIONAL LAND SURVEYOR
PP POLYPROPYLENE PIPE
PRV PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE
PS PUMP STATION
PSE PUGET SOUND ENERGY
PSF POUNDS PER SQUARE FOOT
PSI POUNDS PER SQUARE INCH
PT POINT
PVC POLYVINYL CHLORIDE C-900 PIPE
PVMT PAVEMENT
PWR POWER
RCW REVISED CODE OF WASHINGTON
RD ROAD
REQ'D REQUIRED
RET RETAINING
RJ RESTRAINED JOINT
ROW RIGHT OF WAY
RPBA REDUCED PRESSURE BACKFLOW
ASSEMBLY
RPM REVOLUTIONS PER MINUTE,
RAISED PAVEMENT MARKER
RT RIGHT
S SOUTH, SLOPE, SOCKET, SINGLE
SCH SCHEDULE
SCO SEWER CLEANOUT
SD STORM DRAIN
SDMH STORM DRAIN MANHOLE
SDR STANDARD DIMENSION RATIO
SE SOUTHEAST
SERV SERVICE
SF SILT FENCE, SQUARE FEET
SMH SEWER MANHOLE
SS SANITARY SEWER
SSMH SANITARY SEWER MANHOLE
SST STAINLESS STEEL
ST STREET
STA STATION
STD STANDARD
STL STEEL
SW SOUTHWEST
SWPPP STORMWATER POLLUTION
PREVENTION PLAN
SYM SYMMETRICAL
T TELEPHONE
TBM TEMPORARY BENCHMARK
TDH TOTAL DYNAMIC HEAD
TELJB TELEPHONE JUNCTION BOX
TELR TELEPHONE RISER
TESC TEMPORARY EROSION AND
SEDIMENT CONTROL
THK THICK
TV TELEVISION (CABLE)
TVJB TELEVISION (CABLE)
JUNCTION BOX
TVR TELEVISION (CABLE) RISER
TYP TYPICAL
U/C UNDER CONSTRUCTION
UD UNDERDRAIN
UGP UNDERGROUND POWER
UGT UNDERGROUND TELEPHONE
UNO UNLESS NOTED OTHERWISE
V VENT, VERTICAL
W/ WITH
W WATER, WEST, WIDTH
WAC WASHINGTON ADMINISTRATIVE CODE
WM WATER METER
WS WATER SURFACE
WSDOT WASHINGTON STATE DEPARTMENT OF
TRANSPORTATION
WSRN WASHINGTON STATE REFERENCE
NETWORK
YRS YEARS
ABBREVIATIONS
X
LIMITS OF CONSTRUCTION WITHIN
PERMANENT EASEMENT
CENTERLINE STATIONING
TO BE REMOVED OR ABANDONED
PIPE
DIRECTION OF FLOW (PLAN)
CHAIN LINK FENCE
SILT FENCE
TEMPORARY CONSTRUCTION FENCE
STRAW WATTLE
CATCH BASIN INLET PROTECTION
CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
BIRD CAGE OVERFLOW STRUCTURE
STORM CULVERT END
VALVE
FIRE HYDRANT
WATER METER
PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE
COUPLING
FLANGE FITTING
MECHANICAL JOINT FITTING
RESTRAINED JOINT FITTING
CONCRETE THRUST BLOCK
SLOPE
DIRECTION OF FLOW
CAP
PLUG
POLYPIGGING STATION
AIR/VACUUM RELEASE ASSEMBLY
SEWER MANHOLE
o-o o-o o-o
LEGEND
EXISTING PROPOSED
WATER MANHOLE
FIRE HYDRANT
WATER VALVE
WATER METER
WATER VAULT
POST INDICATOR VALVE
POWER POLE W/ LIGHT
POWER POLE
POWER POLE ANCHOR
JUNCTION BOX
STREET LIGHT VAULT
CABLE TV VAULT
POWER VAULT
POWER/TELEPHONE JUNCTION BOX
STREET LIGHT VAULT
TELEPHONE VAULT
TELEPHONE MANHOLE
DHA SURVEY CONTROL
MONUMENT IN CASE
STORM/SANITARY SEWER MANHOLE
STORM DRAIN CATCH BASIN (TYPE I)I
STORM DRAIN CATCH BASIN (TYPE I)
YARD DRAIN
STORM CULVERT
WHEEL CHAIR RAMP
GAS METER
GAS VALVE
MAILBOX
SIGN
ROCKERY
POT HOLE
CONCRETE
PLAT LOT LINE
STREET R/W LINE
STREET R/W CENTERLINE
CONTOUR
FENCING
UNDERGROUND STORM LINE
UNDERGROUND SEWER LINE
CONIFER TREE
DECIDUOUS TREE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
LEGENDS AND
ABBREVEATIONS G-5
5 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
DESIGNATIONS
SECTION
TITLE
A
-SCALE: 1/2" = 1'-0"
TITLE
DETAIL
TITLE
1
M-1SCALE: 1/2" = 1'-0"
TITLE
4/M-1
DETAIL/SECTION CALLOUT
1
PHOTO
NUMBER
DIRECTION
OF PHOTO
PHOTO REFERENCE
1
M-1 DRAWING
REFERENCE
A
M-1
SECTION LETTER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE
SECTION IS DRAWN, DASH IF
SECTION APPEARS ON SAME
SHEET AS CUT
DASH IF SECTION IS TAKEN ON THE SAME
DRAWING, DRAWING NUMBER IF SECTION
IS TAKEN ON A DIFFERENT SHEET
SECTION, ELEVATION OR
PROFILE REFERENCE LETTER
DETAIL NUMBER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE DETAIL IS
REFERENCED, DASH IF DETAIL
APPEARS ON THE SAME SHEET AS
SHEET REFERENCED
ELEVATION
LETTER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE
ELEVATION IS DRAWN, DASH
IF ELEVATION APPEARS ON
SAME SHEET AS REFERENCED
A
M-1
PIPING DESIGNATIONS
PIPING IS IDENTIFIED BY ITS SIZE FOLLOWED BY PIPING SYSTEM AS FOLLOWS:
NEW PIPING:
EXISTING PIPING:
FOR NEW PIPING MATERIAL, FITTINGS, AND VALVES, SEE SPECIFICATIONS.
PIPING SYSTEM DESIGNATIONS FOR EXISTING PIPING INDICATE TYPE OF
SERVICE AND TYPE OF MATERIAL IF KNOWN. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL
EXISTING PIPE MATERIAL AND NOT RELY ON THIS DESIGNATION PRIOR TO
CONSTRUCTION.
PIPE SIZE
PIPING SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT DESIGNATIONS
EQUIPMENT IS IDENTIFIED AS FOLLOWS:
BOXED NUMBER DESIGNATES NEW EQUIPMENT TO BE SUPPLIED BY THE
CONTRACTOR:
UNBOXED NUMBER DESIGNATES EXISTING EQUIPMENT:
EQUIPMENT LIST IS INCLUDED FOR THE CONVENIENCE OF THE ENGINEER AND
CONTRACTOR, AND IS NOT INTENDED TO REPRESENT PRECISE LISTING OF ALL
EQUIPMENT AND DEVICES TO BE PROVIDED UNDER THIS CONTRACT.
XX-XXXX
8" W
XX-XXXX
8" W
DI GENERAL PIPE MATERIAL
DRAWING
REFERENCE
DETAIL NUMBER OR
SECTION LETTER
DRAWING REFERENCE
SEE R - DRAWINGS FOR RESTORATION SPECIFIC LEGEND.
NOTE
2+00
#
UNDERGROUND SEWER LATERAL LINE
(APROXIMATE LOCATION PER GIS)
UNDERGROUND WATER LINE
UNDERGROUND POWER LINE
UNDERGROUND NATURAL GAS LINE
UNDERGROUND TELEPHONE
UNDERGROUND CABLE TV LINE
UNDERGROUND FIBER OPTIC
OVERHEAD POWER LINE
LANE DELINEATIONS
DITCH
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
SURVEY CONTROL
AND NOTES G-6
6 85
M. McCrosky
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
SURVEY NOTES
SURVEY CONTROL
PT # SURVEY PT # DESCRIPTION NORTHING EASTING ELEVATION
1 1 MON IN CASE 181819.119 1305917.511 223.30
2 2 MON IN CASE 182293.286 1305907.472 247.20
3 3 REBAR/CONTROL CAP 181637.250 1305103.058 169.81
4 5 SCRIBED X 181637.301 1304474.387 122.28
5 6 SCRIBED X 181873.303 1304990.056 131.52
6 10 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181618.964 1306079.113 248.23
7 11 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181803.706 1306100.663 255.43
8 12 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181773.924 1305649.786 191.25
9 13 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181465.485 1305413.305 190.82
10 14 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181392.471 1305141.120 194.22
11 15 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181220.273 1304835.806 191.14
12 16 MAG NAIL/WASHER 180849.891 1304813.388 193.38
13 17 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181454.170 1304898.582 178.10
14 18 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182269.838 1305312.044 157.05
15 19 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182315.181 1305146.125 142.28
16 20 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182313.180 1304921.540 117.12
17 21 REBAR/CONTROL CAP 182130.996 1304970.591 114.24
18 22 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182069.184 1305115.024 131.51
19 23 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181472.124 1304413.897 125.08
20 24 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181314.536 1304477.880 144.41
21 25 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182065.805 1305567.432 171.64
22 26 MON IN CASE 182305.268 1305619.856 211.48
23 27 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182495.846 1305541.458 219.55
24 40 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181903.877 1305365.386 158.84
25 42 SCRIBED X 181322.086 1305018.983 192.93
26 43 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181723.615 1304690.202 125.73
27* 44 REBAR CONTROL CAP 180586.655 1304611.727 173.67
28 45 SCRIBED X 181814.454 1305383.172 160.57
29 46 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181734.055 1305460.777 169.50
30 47 TACK IN HUB 182059.632 1305159.048 137.35
31 48 TACK IN HUB 182038.776 1305208.637 138.48
32 80 REBAR CONTROL CAP 180717.094 1304783.081 190.95
33 81 MAG NAIL/PACE WASHER 182158.261 1305357.177 153.46
UTILITIES MAPPING:
ALL EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN HEREIN ARE TO BE VERIFIED HORIZONTALLY AND VERTICALLY PRIOR
TO ANY CONSTRUCTION. ALL EXISTING FEATURES INCLUDING BURIED UTILITIES ARE SHOWN AS
INDICATED BY RECORD LOCATION OR FIELD TIED AS A RESULT OF A UTILITY PAINT-OUT DURING THE
COURSE OF THE FIELD SURVEY. DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES, INC. (DHA) AND BHC
CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO LIABILITY FOR THE ACCURACY OF THE RECORD INFORMATION. FOR
THE FINAL LOCATION OF THE EXISTING UTILITIES IN AREAS CRITICAL TO CONSTRUCTION, CONTACT
THE UTILITY OWNER/AGENCY AND UTILITIES UNDERGROUND CENTER (800/424-5555)
TOPOGRAPHIC MAPPING:
THE MAP SHOWN HEREON IS THE RESULT OF A TOPOGRAPHIC SURVEY BY DUANE HARTMAN &
ASSOCIATES, INC. (DHA) COMPLETED IN APRIL 2022. DHA AND BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO
LIABILITY, BEYOND SAID DATE, FOR ANY FUTURE SURFACE FEATURE MODIFICATIONS OR
CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITIES THAT MAY OCCUR WITHIN OR ADJOINING THE PERIMETER OF THIS
SURVEY. CONTACT DHA (425) 483-5355 FOR SITE UPDATES AND VERIFICATIONS.
NOTE:
·PROPERTY LINES SHOWN HEREON GENERATED FROM KING COUNTY RECORDS, AND ARE
CONSIDERED APPROXIMATE IN LOCATION.
·SANITARY AND STORM SEWER MANHOLE LOCATION SHOWN HEREIN ARE FROM CENTER OF LID.
CENTER OF STRUCTURES ARE TO BE VERIFIED PRIOR TO ANY CONSTRUCTION.
HORIZONTAL DATUM:
WASHINGTON STATE COORDINATE SYSTEM, NORTH ZONE NAD83(91), US FEET UTILIZING RTK GPS
FIELD PROCEDURES EXTENDED FROM WSDOT LOCAL CONTROL POINTS.
CONTOUR INTERVAL: TWO (2) FOOT CONTOURS
VERTICAL DATUM:
NORTH AMERICAN VERTICAL DATUM 1988 (NAVD88), US FEET.
* POINT 27 LOCATED NORTH OF INTERSECTION
VUEMONT PL NE AND BRONSON WAY NE.
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
32
12
11
25
10
9
6 7
1
2
8
29
21
22
23
33
14
15
16
1718
5
24
28
3
13
26
4
19
20
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
27
30
31
VU E M O NT PL NE
S U N S E T B L V D N E
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
7
-
8
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
ALIGNMENT TABLES
1 OF 2 G-7
7 85
M. McCrosky
R. Nicolas
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
NOTES:
1. SEE DWG G-8 FOR ALIGNMENT TABLES.
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
VU E M O NT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E
4
T
H
S
T
S U N S E T B L V D N E
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+00 5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9
+
0
0
10+00
11+00
1
2
+
0
0
1
3
+
0
0
14+00
15+00 16+00 1 7 +0 0
1 8 +0 0
19+00
20+00
21+00
22+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
3 4 +0 0
35+00
36+00
3
7
+
0
0
3
8
+
0
0
3
9
+
0
0
4
0
+
0
0
4
1
+
0
0
4
2
+
0
0
4
3
+
0
0
44+00
45+00 46+00
47+00
50+00
5
1
+
0
0
5
2
+
0
0
53+00
54+00
55+00
5 6 +0 0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00
82+00
8 3 +0 0
8 4 +0 085+0086+00
87+00
8 8 +0 0
75+
76
59+50
60+00
6
1
+
0
0
62+00
6
3
+
0
0
6
4
+
0
0
6
5
+
0
0
6
6
+
0
0
6
7
+
0
0
6
8
+
0
0
69+00
7
0
+
0
0
7
1
+
0
0
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
20+00
21+00
21+75
43 +0 0
40+00
41+00
4 2 +0 043+00
9 0 +0 0
91+00
91+50
L73
C33
L74 L75
L
7
6
L77
C34
C 35
L78
L79
L80
L81
C 3 6
C37
C38
L82
L
8
3
C39
C40
L
8
4
L
8
5
L86
L87
L88
C41
C42
C43
C44
C45
L 8 9L90
L91
L92
L93
C46
C 4 7
C48
L94
L95
L96
L97
L98
L99
L100
L101
L102
L103
L104
L105
L 1 0 6
L107
L108
800+00
801+00
8
0
2
+
0
0
8
0
3
+
0
0 804+00
805+00
8
0
6
+
0
0
700+00
701+00
702+00
702+90
L118
L119
C61
C62
C63
L120
C64
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
7
-
8
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
ALIGNMENT TABLES
2 OF 2 G-8
8 85
M. McCrosky
R. Nicolas
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
NOTES:
1. SEE DWG G-7 FOR ALIGNMENT PLAN.
BRONSON - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L74
L75
C33
L76
C34
C35
L73
L77
BEGIN
STATION
0+80.00
4+97.23
5+56.64
10+25.12
10+53.95
18+04.01
19+51.85
20+26.03
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,740.51
181,157.70
181,217.11
181,586.64
181,598.22
182,227.27
182,301.85
182,299.78
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,796.94
1,304,802.36
1,304,803.13
1,305,048.05
1,305,074.45
1,305,320.03
1,305,202.33
1,305,128.18
END
STATION
4+97.23
5+56.64
10+25.12
10+53.95
18+04.01
19+51.85
20+26.03
22+22.29
END
NORTHING
181,157.70
181,217.11
181,586.64
181,598.22
182,227.27
182,301.85
182,299.78
182,294.30
END
EASTING
1,304,802.36
1,304,803.13
1,305,048.05
1,305,074.45
1,305,320.03
1,305,202.33
1,305,128.18
1,304,932.00
DISTANCE
417.23
59.41
28.83
74.18
196.26
BEARING
N0°44'42"E
N0°44'23"E
N66°19'32"E
S88°24'02"W
S88°24'02"W
RADIUS
409.30
477.50
124.77
TANGENT
263.68
477.50
83.98
CURVE
LENGTH
468.48
750.06
147.84
DELTA
65°34'50"
90°00'00"
67°53'19"
GRANDEY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L78
C36
L79
C37
L80
L81
C38
BEGIN
STATION
29+80.00
32+16.39
34+90.82
34+91.02
37+67.73
37+67.75
40+83.98
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,243.74
181,274.95
181,464.00
181,464.20
181,683.19
181,683.19
181,810.17
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,824.39
1,304,590.07
1,304,424.33
1,304,424.33
1,304,567.24
1,304,567.26
1,304,856.87
END
STATION
32+16.39
34+90.82
34+91.02
37+67.73
37+67.75
40+83.98
47+05.40
END
NORTHING
181,274.95
181,464.00
181,464.20
181,683.19
181,683.19
181,810.17
182,319.50
END
EASTING
1,304,590.07
1,304,424.33
1,304,424.33
1,304,567.24
1,304,567.26
1,304,856.87
1,305,124.85
DISTANCE
236.39
0.20
0.02
316.23
BEARING
N82°24'48"W
N0°04'01"W
N66°19'32"E
N66°19'32"E
RADIUS
190.95
238.80
461.50
TANGENT
167.01
156.24
368.08
CURVE
LENGTH
274.44
276.71
621.42
DELTA
82°20'47"
66°23'33"
77°09'00"
BRONSON PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L82
C39
C40
L83
BEGIN
STATION
49+80.00
50+88.92
56+32.68
57+06.43
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,927.24
181,970.97
182,427.97
182,494.90
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,331.25
1,305,431.00
1,305,553.16
1,305,559.69
END
STATION
50+88.92
56+32.68
57+06.43
57+54.57
END
NORTHING
181,970.97
182,427.97
182,494.90
182,527.22
END
EASTING
1,305,431.00
1,305,553.16
1,305,559.69
1,305,595.37
DISTANCE
108.92
48.14
BEARING
N66°19'32"E
N47°49'51"E
RADIUS
301.60
50.00
TANGENT
381.20
45.43
CURVE
LENGTH
543.76
73.75
DELTA
103°17'58"
84°30'54"
WINDSOR PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L92
L93
L91
C46
L89
C47
L90
C48
BEGIN
STATION
79+80.00
80+00.00
81+01.61
81+73.90
83+05.38
83+07.96
84+91.79
86+95.79
BEGIN
NORTHING
182,305.48
182,305.35
182,304.70
182,303.97
182,235.41
182,233.04
182,054.18
181,850.21
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,587.36
1,305,607.36
1,305,708.96
1,305,781.25
1,305,885.04
1,305,886.07
1,305,921.81
1,305,917.97
END
STATION
80+00.00
81+01.61
81+73.90
83+05.38
83+07.96
84+91.79
86+95.79
88+01.04
END
NORTHING
182,305.35
182,304.70
182,303.97
182,235.41
182,233.04
182,054.18
181,850.21
181,749.69
END
EASTING
1,305,607.36
1,305,708.96
1,305,781.25
1,305,885.04
1,305,886.07
1,305,921.81
1,305,917.97
1,305,944.36
DISTANCE
20.00
101.61
72.29
2.58
204.00
BEARING
S89°37'59"E
S89°37'59"E
S89°25'18"E
S23°40'48"E
S1°04'46"W
RADIUS
114.60
425.39
191.00
TANGENT
74.05
93.37
54.00
CURVE
LENGTH
131.48
183.82
105.25
DELTA
65°44'11"
24°45'34"
31°34'25"
WINDSOR WAY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L84
L85
C41
L86
C42
L87
C43
L88
C44
C45
BEGIN
STATION
59+50.00
61+43.27
61+57.14
62+52.38
64+11.19
68+99.76
69+14.11
72+12.45
72+14.32
73+61.37
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,227.06
181,302.52
181,308.94
181,344.14
181,379.06
181,665.13
181,677.75
181,820.63
181,820.60
181,749.69
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,757.97
1,304,935.90
1,304,948.20
1,305,036.26
1,305,191.18
1,305,569.00
1,305,575.83
1,305,820.93
1,305,822.80
1,305,944.36
END
STATION
61+43.27
61+57.14
62+52.38
64+11.19
68+99.76
69+14.11
72+12.45
72+14.32
73+61.37
75+76.14
END
NORTHING
181,302.52
181,308.94
181,344.14
181,379.06
181,665.13
181,677.75
181,820.63
181,820.60
181,749.69
181,656.32
END
EASTING
1,304,935.90
1,304,948.20
1,305,036.26
1,305,191.18
1,305,569.00
1,305,575.83
1,305,820.93
1,305,822.80
1,305,944.36
1,306,125.33
DISTANCE
193.27
13.87
158.81
14.35
1.87
BEARING
N67°01'14"E
N62°25'38"E
N77°17'42"E
N28°24'15"E
S88°54'14"E
RADIUS
299.25
573.00
272.90
143.85
191.00
TANGENT
48.03
260.24
166.05
80.67
120.35
CURVE
LENGTH
95.24
488.56
298.34
147.05
214.78
DELTA
18°14'06"
48°51'10"
62°38'14"
58°34'08"
64°25'43"
SD3 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L94
L95
L96
L97
BEGIN
STATION
20+00.00
20+12.90
20+44.12
21+40.50
BEGIN
NORTHING
182,105.43
182,098.73
182,082.53
182,051.94
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,085.77
1,305,096.79
1,305,123.47
1,305,214.87
END
STATION
20+12.90
20+44.12
21+40.50
21+74.56
END
NORTHING
182,098.73
182,082.53
182,051.94
182,042.49
END
EASTING
1,305,096.79
1,305,123.47
1,305,214.87
1,305,247.59
DISTANCE
12.90
31.22
96.38
34.06
BEARING
S58°43'34"E
S58°43'34"E
S71°29'40"E
S73°53'41"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
SD-06 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L103
L104
L105
L106
L107
L108
BEGIN
STATION
40+00.00
40+12.50
40+43.67
40+59.28
41+77.86
42+50.13
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,872.44
181,865.30
181,847.51
181,838.90
181,761.04
181,689.89
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,301.82
1,305,312.08
1,305,337.68
1,305,350.70
1,305,440.13
1,305,452.85
END
STATION
40+12.50
40+43.67
40+59.28
41+77.86
42+50.13
43+00.13
END
NORTHING
181,865.30
181,847.51
181,838.90
181,761.04
181,689.89
181,651.92
END
EASTING
1,305,312.08
1,305,337.68
1,305,350.70
1,305,440.13
1,305,452.85
1,305,485.39
DISTANCE
12.50
31.17
15.61
118.57
72.28
50.00
BEARING
S55°12'19"E
S55°12'19"E
S56°30'24"E
S48°57'09"E
S10°08'36"E
S40°35'34"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
SD-05 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L98
L99
L100
L101
L102
BEGIN
STATION
90+00.00
90+27.65
90+59.30
90+68.95
91+19.96
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,658.11
181,634.42
181,607.34
181,598.85
181,557.68
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,096.40
1,305,110.65
1,305,127.03
1,305,131.64
1,305,161.76
END
STATION
90+27.65
90+59.30
90+68.95
91+19.96
91+50.09
END
NORTHING
181,634.42
181,607.34
181,598.85
181,557.68
181,531.59
END
EASTING
1,305,110.65
1,305,127.03
1,305,131.64
1,305,161.76
1,305,176.82
DISTANCE
27.65
31.65
9.66
51.01
30.13
BEARING
S31°02'34"E
S31°09'53"E
S28°31'46"E
S36°11'10"E
S29°59'19"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
BRONSON WAY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L118
C61
C62
L119
C63
BEGIN
STATION
800+00.00
800+68.77
802+13.49
803+98.89
804+68.65
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,537.96
180,598.25
180,705.23
180,847.30
180,911.35
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,607.47
1,304,640.54
1,304,736.14
1,304,851.62
1,304,879.27
END
STATION
800+68.77
802+13.49
803+98.89
804+68.65
806+00.00
END
NORTHING
180,598.25
180,705.23
180,847.30
180,911.35
181,024.15
END
EASTING
1,304,640.54
1,304,736.14
1,304,851.62
1,304,879.27
1,304,945.89
DISTANCE
68.77
69.76
BEARING
N28°44'32"E
N23°20'42"E
RADIUS
317.84
337.74
520.87
TANGENT
73.64
95.10
66.02
CURVE
LENGTH
144.72
185.40
131.35
DELTA
26°05'18"
31°27'09"
14°26'53"
VUEMONT PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L120
C64
BEGIN
STATION
700+00.00
702+31.84
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,482.19
180,593.72
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,709.09
1,304,505.84
END
STATION
702+31.84
702+90.11
END
NORTHING
180,593.72
180,642.38
END
EASTING
1,304,505.84
1,304,480.13
DISTANCE
231.84
BEARING
N61°14'38"W
RADIUS
50.00
TANGENT
32.95
CURVE
LENGTH
58.27
DELTA
66°46'35"
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
EROSION CONTROL KEY PLAN G-9
9 85
M. McCrosky
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
G
R
A
N
D
EY
W
A
Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
BR
ONS
ON PLA
CE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
SUN SET BL VD NE
VUEMONT PL NE
B
R
O
N
S
O
N W
A
Y N
E
NE 4TH ST
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N W
A
Y N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
S U N S E T B L V D N E
VUE M O NT PL NE
E
C-10
EC-2
EC-4
E
C-5
E
C
-
3
E
C
-
5
EC-6 EC-4
E C -7
EC
-
7
EC-8
E
C
-
6
E
C
-
9
E C-10
E
C
-
9
EC-2
E
C
-
8
EC-3
EC-11
EC-11
EC-11
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
WATER KEY PLAN G-10
10 85
M. McCrosky
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
VUE M O NT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
S U N S E T B L V D N E
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W-18
W-1
W-6
W
-7
W
-
3
W
-
8
W-9 W-5
W -1 1
W-
1
2
W-13
W
-
1
0W
-
1
6
W-17
W
-
1
5
W-2
W
-
1
4
W-4
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
STORMWATER KEY PLAN G-11
11 85
M. McCrosky
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
G
R
A
N
D
EY
W
A
Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
BR
ONS
ON PLA
CE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
SUN SET BL VD NE
VUEMONT PL NE
B
R
O
N
S
O
N W
A
Y N
E
NE 4TH ST
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
S U N S E T B L V D N E
VU E M O NT PL NE
S
D-18
SD-1
SD-6
S
D-7
S
D
-
3
S
D
-
8
SD-9 SD-5
S D -1 1
SD
-
1
2
SD-13
S
D
-
1
0S
D
-
1
6
S D-17
S
D
-
1
5
SD-2
S
D
-
1
4
SD-4
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
1. WORK SHALL BE SEQUENCED AT THE CONTRACTOR’S DISCRETION. HOWEVER, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MINIMIZE
IMPACT TO THE NEIGHBORHOOD BY MAINTAINING INTERSECTIONS USED BY THE COMMUNITY FOR INGRESS AND
EGRESS AND BY LIMITING WORK TO A SINGLE STREET AS FEASIBLE.
2. DURING LANE OR STREET CLOSURE, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN LOCAL ACCESS TO ALL PROPERTIES IN
THE CLOSED AREA.
3. TOTAL ROAD CLOSURE LASTING MORE THAN TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS IS SUBJECT TO THE APPROVAL BY THE CITY
COUNCIL.
4. EMERGENCY SERVICES (253-852-2121) SHALL BE NOTIFIED TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS BEFORE ANY STREET OR LANE
CLOSURES.
5. RESIDENTS SHALL BE PROVIDED SEVENTY-TWO (72) HOURS OF NOTICE IF ACCESS TO PROPERTY IS IMPACTED OR IF
THE FRONTAGE ALONG THEIR PROPERTY IS IMPACTED.
6. CONTRACTOR SHALL NOT CLOSE NEIGHBORHOOD ENTRANCES FROM SUNSET BLVD NE, EDMONDS AVE NE AND NE
4TH ST SIMULTANEOUSLY. TO MAINTAIN NEIGHBORHOOD ACCESS, TWO OF THE ENTRANCES MUST BE OPEN DURING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. AT ALL LOCATIONS WHERE THERE IS CONFLICT BETWEEN NEW STORM AND EXISTING WATER, THE CONTRACTOR
SHALL SEQUENCE UTILITY INSTALLATION TO ENSURE WATER SERVICE IS PRESERVED FOR RESIDENTS.
INSTALLATION OF NEW STORM MAY NEED TO OCCUR AFTER NEW WATER MAIN IS OPERATIONAL, WATER SERVICES
HAVE BEEN TRANSFERRED FROM OLD TO NEW MAINS, AND EXISTING WATER MAINS HAVE BEEN ABANDONED.
THERE WILL BE NO ADDITIONAL ALLOWANCE FOR TEMPORARY WATER SERVICES IN THE CASE THAT EXISTING
WATER SERVICES ARE IN CONFLICT WITH THE NEW STORM UNDER THE CONTRACTOR'S SEQUENCING PLAN. THIS
SEQUENCING MAY ALLOW SECTIONS OF ABANDONED WATER MAIN TO BE CUT OUT OF THE WAY TO AVOID
CONFLICTS WITH NEW STORM PIPE ALIGNMENT AND TO MINIMIZE WATER SERVICE DISRUPTIONS FOR RESIDENTS.
THIS SUGGESTED SEQUENCING SHOULD BE FOLLOWED UNLESS THE CONTRACTOR PROVIDES IN WRITING AN
ALTERNATIVE APPROACH FOR MAINTAINING WATER SERVICE. THE ALTERNATIVE APPROACH MUST BE SUBMITTED
TO THE CITY PROJECT MANAGER 5 WORKING DAYS PRIOR TO THE ALTERNATIVE APPROACH WORK BEGINNING.
8. ALL NEW WATER MAIN PIPE AND FITTINGS SHALL BE FLUSHED AND CLEANED VIA FOAM POLYPIG PRIOR TO
DISINFECTION AND TESTING. SUGGESTED POLYPIGGING STATION LOCATIONS ARE SHOWN ON DWG W-23.
CONTRACTOR MAY PROPOSE ALTERNATIVE POLYPIGGING STATION LOCATIONS FOR THE CITY’S APPROVAL.
9. THE WINDSOR HILLS NEIGHBORHOOD HAS NARROW ROADWAYS AND LIMITED RESIDENTIAL PARKING. THEREFORE,
WITHIN THE EXISTING RIGHTS-OF-WAY, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL ONLY STAGE ENOUGH CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS
FOR THE CURRENT DAY’S WORK.
10. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL NOT LEAVE STOCKPILED MATERIAL ON CITY STREETS OUTSIDE OF WORK HOURS.
11. PRIOR TO EVERY WEEKEND, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL PATCH THE CONSTRUCTION SITE WITH HMA, STEEL PLATES,
ETC. AND LEAVE THE SITE IN A CLEAN AND ORDERLY CONDITION. ANY TRAFFIC DETOURS SHALL BE MAINTAINED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE APPROVED TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN.
12. SD-4, SD-5, SD-6, SD-7, SD-8, SD-9, SD-10, SD-15, SD-16, SD-17, SD-19, SD-20, AND SD-21, W-4, W-5,W-7, W-8, W-10, W-15,
AND W-16 HAVE SPECIFIC SEQUENCING REQUIREMENTS. SEE THOSE SHEETS FOR NOTES.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
2
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING, GENERAL REQUIREMENTS,
AND POTHOLING DATA G-12
12 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
POTHOLING TABLE
POTHOLE
NUMBER DRAWING
ASPHALT
OVERLAY
THICKNESS
(IN)
UTILITY
TYPE
UTILITY
SIZE (IN)
UTILITY
MATERIAL
PIPE
DIRECTION
TOP OF
UTILITY FROM
GRADE (IN)
1 SD-1 4 FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 36
2 SD-1 4 GAS 4 STEEL WRAP N & S 38
3A W-6 N/A SEWER 8 CONCRETE E & W 74
3B W-6 6 GAS 1 PE N & S 30
4 SD-6 6 GAS 1 PE N & S 32
5 SD-19 5 SEWER 24 CONCRETE SE & NW 24
6 W-11 5 GAS 2 PE E & W 48
7 W-11 3 FIBER OPTIC 1 PVC E & W 34
8 SD-12 8 GAS 0.5 PE E & W 22
9 SD-15 5 GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 32
10 SD-16 5 GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 38
11 W-1 8 FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 10
12 W-1 5 GAS 4 STEEL WRAP N & S 38
13 SD-5 8 POWER 2 PVC N & S 25
14 W-5 8 POWER 2 PVC N & S 23
15 W-5 8 GAS 2 STEEL N & S 44
16A W-17 6 POWER COULD NOT LOCATE AFTER DIGGING TO 8-FEET BELOW GRADE
16B W-17 4 POWER 2 CABLE N & S 61
17 W-18 N/A GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 38
18 W-18 N/A FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 30
POTHOLING TABLE NOTE:
UTILITY POTHOLE DATA IS PROVIDED FOR REFERENCE ONLY. CONTRACTOR TO VERIFY LOCATION, DEPTH AND SIZE OF EXISTING
UTILITIES. REPORT ANY DISCREPANCIES TO THE OWNER.
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE FOR WATER MAIN IMPROVEMENTS
1. THE CONTRACTOR MUST COMPLETE THE INSTALLATION OF EACH IDENTIFIED SEGMENT OF PIPES, INCLUDING
HYDRANTS, WATER SERVICE LINES, METER SETTERS AND RELATED APPURTENANCES AND PERFORM THE
POLYPIGGING, PRESSURE TESTING AND DISINFECTION OF THE INSTALLED SECTION OF PIPES AND HAVE IT
CONNECTED PER PLANS AND SPECIFICATIONS TO THE ACTIVE WATER SYSTEM BEFORE THE INSTALLATION OF THE
NEXT SEGMENT OF PIPES.
2. ALL WATER SERVICE TRANSFERS MUST BE COMPLETED FOR EACH SEGMENT OF THE NEW PIPES BEFORE THE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEXT SECTION OF PIPES
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
3
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
TRENCH DAM DETAIL G-13
13 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
R. NICOLAS
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
NOTES:
1. INSTALL TRENCH DAMS WHERE
EXISTING SLOPE IS GREATER THAN
OR EQUAL TO 10%. SPACE EVERY 25'
MINIMUM.
2. ADJUST SPACING AS REQUIRED TO
AVOID FITTINGS, VALVES AND
STRUCTURES.
SECTION A-A
A
A
ELEVATION
DETAIL
TRENCH DAM
1
TYPNTS
2'
12
"
VA
R
I
E
S
12
"
6"
6"
FINISH GRADE,
SURFACING VARIES,
SEE RESTORATION DWGS FINISH GRADE
TYP TRENCH
WALL
PIPE, DIA VARIES
TYP BOTTOM OF PIPE
TRENCH
CONTROLLED
DENSITY FILL
DUCTILE IRON PIPE TO BE
WRAPPED IN POLYWRAP
PRIOR TO PLACEMENT OF CDF
WEIGHTS
HEIGHT "H" WEIGHT
6" RISER 450 LBS
12" RISER 900 LBS
24" RISER 1,800 LBS
36" RISER 2,700 LBS
44" RISER 3,750 LBS
B
AA
6"2'6"
B
6"
2'
6"
3'
PLAN VIEW
4"
"H
"
6"
3'
-
8
"
M
A
X
SECTION A-A
OPENING CAST
AS REQUIRED
FRAME AND GRATE
PER COR STD PLAN
204.00 AND 204.30
SECTION B-B
SPECIFICATIONS:
1. CONCRETE MINIMUM
COMPRESSION STRENGTH:
F'c = 5,000 PSI @ 28 DAYS.
2. REINFORCING STEEL" ASTM A615,
Fy = 60,000 PSI
DETAIL
YARD DRAIN
2
NTS
NOTES:
1. INSTALL YARD DRAIN RIMS WITH
SLIGHT DEPRESSION TO COLLECT
STORMWATER ON SIDEWALKS.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO TESC NOTES EC-1
14 85
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) STANDARD PLAN NOTES:
THE FOLLOWING IS A LISTING OF GENERAL NOTES THAT SHALL BE INCORPORATED IN THE EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) PLAN SET. ALL THE NOTES
ON THE LIST MAY NOT PERTAIN TO EVERY PROJECT. THE APPLICANT OR OWNER, HEREBY REFERRED TO AS APPLICANT, MAY STRIKE OUT IRRELEVANT NOTES
IF NOT APPLICABLE TO THE PROJECT. HOWEVER, THE APPLICANT SHALL NOT RENUMBER NOR EDIT THE REMAINING NOTES. IF ADDITIONAL NOTES ARE
NEEDED FOR SPECIFIC ASPECTS, THEY SHALL BE ADDED AFTER THE ESC STANDARD PLAN NOTES.
1. BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION OR DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITY OCCURS, A PRE-CONSTRUCTION MEETING SHALL BE HELD AMONG THE CITY OF RENTON,
HEREBY REFERRED TO AS THE CITY, THE APPLICANT, AND THE APPLICANT'S CONTRACTOR.
2. THE APPLICANT IS RESPONSIBLE FOR OBTAINING THE WASHINGTON STATE DEPARTMENT OF ECOLOGY (ECOLOGY) CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER
GENERAL PERMIT, IF IT IS REQUIRED FOR THE PROJECT. THE APPLICANT SHALL PROVIDE THE CITY COPIES OF ALL MONITORING REPORTS PROVIDED TO
ECOLOGY ASSOCIATED WITH THE CONSTRUCTION STORM WATER GENERAL PERMIT.
3. THE ESC PLAN SET SHALL INCLUDE AN ESC CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE DETAILING THE ORDERED STEPS THAT SHALL BE FOLLOWED FROM
CONSTRUCTION COMMENCEMENT TO POST-PROJECT CLEANUP IN ORDER TO FULFILL PROJECT ESC REQUIREMENTS.
4. THE BOUNDARIES OF THE CLEARING LIMITS, SENSITIVE AREAS AND THEIR BUFFERS, AND AREAS OF VEGETATION PRESERVATION AND TREE RETENTION
AS PRESCRIBED ON THE PLAN(S) SHALL BE CLEARLY DELINEATED BY FENCING AND PROTECTED IN THE FIELD IN ACCORDANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF THE
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM) PRIOR TO THE START OF CONSTRUCTION. DURING THE CONSTRUCTION PERIOD, NO
DISTURBANCE BEYOND THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE PERMITTED. THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE MAINTAINED BY THE APPLICANT/ESC SUPERVISOR
FOR THE DURATION OF CONSTRUCTION.
5. STABILIZED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCES SHALL BE INSTALLED AT THE BEGINNING OF CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTAINED FOR THE DURATION OF THE
PROJECT. ADDITIONAL MEASURES, SUCH AS CONSTRUCTED WHEEL WASH SYSTEMS OR WASH PADS, MAY BE REQUIRED TO ENSURE THAT ALL PAVED
AREAS ARE KEPT CLEAN AND TRACK-OUT TO ROAD RIGHT OF WAY DOES NOT OCCUR FOR THE DURATION OF THE PROJECT. IF SEDIMENT IS TRACKED
OFFSITE, PUBLIC ROADS SHALL BE CLEANED THOROUGHLY AT THE END OF EACH DAY, OR MORE FREQUENTLY DURING WET WEATHER, AS NECESSARY TO
PREVENT SEDIMENT FROM ENTERING WATERS OF THE STATE.
6. WASHOUT FROM CONCRETE TRUCKS SHALL BE PERFORMED OFF-SITE OR IN DESIGNATED CONCRETE WASHOUT AREAS ONLY. DO NOT WASH OUT
CONCRETE TRUCKS ONTO THE GROUND, OR TO STORM DRAINS OR OPEN DITCHES. ON-SITE DUMPING OF EXCESS CONCRETE SHALL ONLY OCCUR IN
DESIGNATED CONCRETE WASHOUT AREAS.
7. ALL REQUIRED ESC BMPS SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED AND IN OPERATION PRIOR TO LAND CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION TO PREVENT
TRANSPORTATION OF SEDIMENT TO SURFACE WATER, DRAINAGE SYSTEMS AND ADJACENT PROPERTIES. ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE MAINTAINED IN A
SATISFACTORY CONDITION UNTIL SUCH TIME THAT CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE AND POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE EROSION HAS PASSED.
ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED AFTER CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETED AND THE SITE HAS BEEN STABILIZED TO ENSURE POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE
EROSION DOES NOT EXIST. THE IMPLEMENTATION, MAINTENANCE, REPLACEMENT, ENHANCEMENT, AND REMOVAL OF ESC BMPS SHALL BE THE
RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT.
8. ANY HAZARDOUS MATERIALS OR LIQUID PRODUCTS THAT HAVE THE POTENTIAL TO POLLUTE RUNOFF SHALL BE DISPOSED OF PROPERLY.
9. THE ESC BMPS DEPICTED ON THIS DRAWING ARE INTENDED TO BE MINIMUM REQUIREMENTS TO MEET ANTICIPATED SITE CONDITIONS. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES AND UNEXPECTED OR SEASONAL CONDITIONS DICTATE, THE APPLICANT SHALL ANTICIPATE THAT MORE ESC BMPS WILL BE
NECESSARY TO ENSURE COMPLETE SILTATION CONTROL ON THE PROPOSED SITE. DURING THE COURSE OF CONSTRUCTION, IT SHALL BE THE
OBLIGATION AND RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT TO ADDRESS ANY NEW CONDITIONS THAT MAY BE CREATED BY THE ACTIVITIES AND TO PROVIDE
ADDITIONAL ESC BMPS, OVER AND ABOVE MINIMUM REQUIREMENTS, AS MAY BE NEEDED, TO PROTECT ADJACENT PROPERTIES AND WATER QUALITY OF
THE RECEIVING DRAINAGE SYSTEM.
10. APPROVAL OF THIS PLAN IS FOR ESC ONLY. IT DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN APPROVAL OF STORM DRAINAGE DESIGN, SIZE NOR LOCATION OF PIPES,
RESTRICTORS, CHANNELS, OR STORMWATER FACILITIES.
11. ANY DEWATERING SYSTEM NECESSARY FOR THE CONSTRUCTION OF STORMWATER FACILITIES SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY FOR REVIEW AND
APPROVAL.
12. ANY AREAS OF EXPOSED SOILS, INCLUDING ROADWAY EMBANKMENTS, THAT WILL NOT BE DISTURBED FOR TWO DAYS DURING THE WET SEASON
(OCTOBER 1ST THROUGH APRIL 30TH) OR SEVEN DAYS DURING THE DRY SEASON (MAY 1ST THROUGH SEPTEMBER 30TH) SHALL BE IMMEDIATELY
STABILIZED WITH THE APPROVED ESC COVER METHODS (E.G., SEEDING, MULCHING, PLASTIC COVERING, ETC.) IN CONFORMANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF
THE RENTON SWDM.
13. WET SEASON ESC REQUIREMENTS APPLY TO ALL CONSTRUCTION SITES BETWEEN OCTOBER 1ST AND APRIL 30TH, UNLESS OTHERWISE APPROVED BY
THE CITY.
14. ANY AREA NEEDING ADDITIONAL ESC MEASURES, NOT REQUIRING IMMEDIATE ATTENTION, SHALL BE ADDRESSED WITHIN SEVEN (7) DAYS.
15. THE ESC BMPS ON INACTIVE SITES SHALL BE INSPECTED AND MAINTAINED AT A MINIMUM OF ONCE A MONTH OR WITHIN 24 HOURS FOLLOWING A STORM
EVENT. INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE SHALL OCCUR MORE FREQUENTLY AS REQUIRED BY THE CITY.
16. BEFORE COMMENCEMENT OF ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY, CATCH BASIN INSERTS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 216.30 SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR ALL
STORM DRAIN INLETS DOWNSLOPE AND WITHIN 500 FEET OF A DISTURBED OR CONSTRUCTION AREA, UNLESS THE RUNOFF THAT ENTERS THE INLET WILL
BE CONVEYED TO A SEDIMENT POND OR TRAP. ALL CATCH BASIN INSERTS SHALL BE PERIODICALLY INSPECTED AND REPLACED AS NECESSARY TO
ENSURE FULLY FUNCTIONING CONDITION.
17. AT NO TIME SHALL SEDIMENT ACCUMULATION EXCEED 2/3 OF THE CAPACITY OF THE CATCH BASIN SUMP. ALL CATCH BASINS AND CONVEYANCE LINES
SHALL BE CLEANED PRIOR TO PAVING. THE CLEANING OPERATION SHALL NOT FLUSH SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER INTO THE DOWNSTREAM SYSTEM.
18. ANY PERMANENT STORMWATER FACILITY LOCATION USED AS A TEMPORARY SETTLING BASIN SHALL BE MODIFIED WITH THE NECESSARY ESC BMPS AND
SHALL PROVIDE ADEQUATE STORAGE CAPACITY. IF THE TEMPORARY FACILITY IS TO ULTIMATELY FUNCTION AS AN INFILTRATION SYSTEM IN ITS
PERMANENT STATE, THE TEMPORARY FACILITY SHALL BE ROUGH GRADED SO THAT THE BOTTOM AND SIDES ARE AT LEAST THREE FEET ABOVE THE FINAL
GRADE OF THE PERMANENT FACILITY.
19. AREAS DESIGNATED ON THE PLAN(S) CONTAINING EXISTING STORMWATER FACILITIES OR ON-SITE BMPS (AMENDED SOILS, BIORETENTION, PERMEABLE
PAVEMENT, ETC.) SHALL BE CLEARLY FENCED AND PROTECTED USING ESC BMPS TO AVOID SEDIMENTATION AND COMPACTION DURING CONSTRUCTION.
20. PRIOR TO THE BEGINNING OF THE WET SEASON (OCTOBER 1ST), ALL DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE INSPECTED TO IDENTIFY WHICH ONES SHALL BE
SODDED OR SEEDED IN PREPARATION FOR THE WINTER RAINS. DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED WITHIN ONE WEEK OF THE BEGINNING
OF THE WET SEASON. AN EXHIBIT OF THOSE AREAS TO BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND THOSE AREAS TO REMAIN UNCOVERED SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE
CITY FOR REVIEW.
21. PRIOR TO FINAL CONSTRUCTION ACCEPTANCE, THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE STABILIZED TO PREVENT SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER FROM LEAVING THE
PROJECT SITE, ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED, AND STORMWATER CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS, FACILITIES, AND ON-SITE BMPS SHALL BE RESTORED TO
THEIR FULLY FUNCTIONING CONDITION. ALL DISTURBED AREAS OF THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE VEGETATED OR OTHERWISE PERMANENTLY STABILIZED.
AT A MINIMUM, DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND MULCHED TO ENSURE THAT SUFFICIENT COVER WILL DEVELOP SHORTLY AFTER
FINAL APPROVAL. MULCH WITHOUT SEEDING IS ADEQUATE FOR AREAS TO BE LANDSCAPED BEFORE OCTOBER 1ST.
22. ROCKERIES ARE CONSIDERED TO BE A METHOD OF BANK STABILIZATION AND EROSION CONTROL. ROCKERIES SHALL NOT BE CONSTRUCTED TO SERVE
AS RETAINING WALLS. ALL ROCKERIES IN CITY ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH CITY STANDARDS. ROCKERIES
OUTSIDE OF ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE INTERNATIONAL BUILDING CODE.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 1+00 TO 8+25 EC-2
15 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
8+25
EC-2
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
4
+
5
0
-
S
E
E
A
B
O
V
E
4+
5
0
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 0 2 +1 0
E C -1 0
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
1
2
11 12
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+008
0
3
+
0
0
804+00
805+00
BRONSON WAY NE
NE 4TH ST
o -o
o -o
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
5 +0 0
6 +0 0
7+00
8+00
30+00
5
9
+
5
0
60+00
6
1
+
0
03+00
4 +0 0
5
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
W
I
N
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y
N
E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 8+25 TO 17+50 EC-3
16 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
+
2
5
E
C
-
2
1
3
+
0
0
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
1
7
+
5
0
E
C
-
4
MAT
CH
LIN
E
STA
- SEE ABO
VE
13+00
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
1 3 +0 0
3
0
+
0
0
31+00
32+00
33+00
33+59
90+00
91+00
BRO NSON WAY NE
13+00
14+00
15+00
1 6 +0 0
1 7 +0 0
5
0
+
0
0
5
1
+
0
0
5
0
+
0
0
5 1 +0 0
52+00
40+00
41+00
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
P
L
A
C
E
N
E
BRONSON WAY NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 17+50 TO 22+50
GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 29+80 TO 34+00 EC-4
17 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
1 7 +5 0
E C -3
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
3 4 +0 0
E C -5
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
XX
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
13
14
15
1
8
+
0
0
19+00
2 0 +0 0
2 1 +0 0
2 2 +0 0
4
6
+
0
0
4
7
+
0
0
2
5
+
0
0
2 5 +7 5
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
3A
4
3B
5
+
0
0
6
+
0
0
30+00
3 1 +0 0
3 2 +0 0
33+00
3
4
+
0
0
5 9 +5 0
60+00
3+00
4
+
0
0
5 +0 0
6 +0 0
7+00
8
+
0
0
6 0 0 +0 0
6 0 0 +7 1
W I N D S O R W A Y N E
G R A N D E Y W A Y
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
5
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY TESC PLANS
STA 34+00 TO 42+50 EC-5
18 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M A T C H LIN E S T A
- S E E B E L O W
M
A
T
C
H
LIN
E S
T
A
- S
E
E D
W
G
34+00
W
-6
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
3 8 +5 0
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
38+50
SD-7
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
4
2
+
5
0
S
D
-
9
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
34+00
3 5 +0 0
36+00
37+00
3
8+
00
1 0 0 +0 0
1 0 0 +7 5
G R A N D E Y W A Y
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
39+00
40+00
41+00
4 2 +0 0
200+00
200+75
GRANDEY WAY
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
5
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 42+50 TO 47+00
BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25 EC-6
19 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
42+50
EC-5
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
5
4
+
0
0
E
C
-
7
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
5
19+00
2
0
+
0
0
43+00
44+00 4 5 +0 0
4 6 +0 0
4 7 +0 0
G R A N D E Y W A Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
1 5 +0 0
1 6 +0 0
50+00
51+00
52+00
5 3 +0 0
5 4 +0 0
52+00 53+00
54+00
5 5 +0 0
BRONSON PLACE NE
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 54+00 TO 57+50
WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25 EC-7
20 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
54+00
EC-6
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 3 +2 5
E C -8
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
67
54+00
55+00
5 6 +0 0
5
7
+
0
0
90+00
90+75
B R O N S O N P L A C E N E
WINDSOR PLACE NE
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
8
54+00
5
5
+
0
0
79+80 80+00 81+00
82+00
8
3
+
0
0
57+06
5
6
+
0
0
57+00
7 0 +0 0
71+00
7
2
+
0
0
90+00
90+75
WINDSOR PLACE NE
BRONSO
N PL
ACE
NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 83+25 TO 88+01
WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 60+00 TO 64+50 EC-8
21 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
3
+
2
5
E
C
-
7
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
64+50
EC-9
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
TREE PROTECTION
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
8 4 +0 0
85+00 86+00
87+00
8 8 +0 088+01
7 3 +0 0
7 2 +0 0
7 3 +0 0
74+00 75+00 75+75
8
5
+
0
0
8
6
+
0
0
4
0
0
+
0
0
4
0
1
+
0
0
5 0 0 +0 0
5 0 1 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
5+00
6+00
30+00
59+50
60+00
61+00
62+00
63+00
64+00
4+00
65+00
66+00
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
WINDSOR WAY NE
o
-
o
o-o
o-o
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 64+50 TO 73+50 EC-9
22 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
A
B
O
V
E
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
7 3 +5 0
E C -1 0
6
9
+
5
0
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DW G
64+50
EC-8 M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
6
9
+
5
0
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
10
87+00
7 0 +0 0
7 1 +0 0 72+00
7
3
+
0
0
75+00
75+75
8 2 +0 0
8
3
+
0
0
8 4 +0 0
8 5 +0 0
8 6 +0 0
4 0 0 +0 0
4 0 1 +0 0
5
0
0
+
0
0
5
0
1
+
0
0
WINDSOR WAY NE
9
65+00
66+00
67+00
6 8 +0 0
6 9 +0 0
8 0 +0 0
8 1 +0 0
43+00
3
0
0
+
0
0
3
0
0
+
7
5
WINDSOR WAY NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 73+50 TO 75+76
BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 800+00 TO 802+10 EC-10
23 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
73+50
EC-9
M ATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
802+10
EC-2
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
E
D
M
O
N
D
S
A
V
E
N
E
16A
16B
88+00
88+01 7 5 +7 6
74+00
7 5 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
17
18
800+00 801+00
802+00
00
70
1
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
VUEMONT PL NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
1
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO DITCH TESC PLANS EC-11
24 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
5
20+00
21+00
G R A N D E Y W A Y
o-o
o-o
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES TO BE
INSTALLED PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, ADDITIONAL TESC
MEASURES SHALL BE INSTALLED TO PROTECT BOTH
NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
SILT FENCE PER COR STD. PLAN 214.00
AND STAKE AND WIRE FENCE
PER COR STD PLAN 212.00
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
TREE PROTECTION
XX
1 0 +0 0
1 1 +0 0
3 2 +0 0
3 3 +0 0
3
3
+
5
9
9
1
+
5
0
9
0
+
0
0
9
1
+
0
0
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
o-o
o-o
o-o
o-o
1
4
+
0
0
1
5
+
0
0
50+00
4 0 +0 0
41+00
4
2
+
0
0
43+00
300+00B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
o-o o-o
o-oo-oo-o
o-o
o-o
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE STORM DRAIN PLAN AND PROFILES
STA 1+00 TO 4+50 SD-1
48 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
CONNECT TO EX CATCH BASIN WITH KOR-N-SEAL
CONNECTION.
1
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
4+
5
0
S
D
-
2
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 0 2 +1 0
S D -1 8
LEGEND:
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN
ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY
LOCATION OF EXISTING UTILITES PRIOR TO STARTING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. SEE DWG G-3 FOR STORM GENERAL NOTES. REFER TO
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
8. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
9. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
10. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
11. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
175
205
200
195
190
185
180
175
205
200
195
190
185
180
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
IE
1
9
0
.
7
4
-
8
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
70 LF - 8" SD HDPE
S=0.34%
EX
I
E
1
9
0
.
6
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
EX
I
E
1
9
0
.
5
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
N
E
)
IE
1
9
0
.
5
-
8
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
EX
1
4
"
D
x
2
3
"
W
F
O
IE
1
9
1
.
8
7
EX
1
0
"
W
,
I
E
1
9
2
.
5
3
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
E
,
I
E
1
9
2
.
7
2
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
C
B
N
O
.
1
3
4
5
6
5
RI
M
E
L
1
9
6
.
5
4
EX
W
S
CB
#
1
RI
M
E
L
1
9
4
.
8
9
EX
4
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
9
2
.
1
2
PROVIDE 6" MIN
CLEARANCE W/
ETHAFOAM PAD
1
1
2
11 12
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+008
0
3
+
0
0
804+00
805+00
BRONSON WAY NE
NE 4TH ST
8" SD
HDPE
CB #1
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 1+77
OFFSET 20.38' RT
1
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE
STA 4+50 TO 8+25 SD-2
49 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
8+25
SD-3
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
4
+
5
0
S
D
-
1
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
FOR CONTINUATION, SEE DWG SD-6
5 +0 0
6 +0 0
7+00
8+00
30+00
5
9
+
5
0
60+00
6
1
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
W
I
N
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y
N
E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
CB #31
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 5+04
OFFSET 14.8' LT
SEE DWG SD-6
CB #32
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 5+70
OFFSET 14.4' LT
SEE DWG SD-6
12" SD
PP
12" SD
PP
CB #30
TYPE 1
W/ GRATE
STA 4+74
OFFSET 27.1' RT
SEE DWG SD-6
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-6
12" SD
PP
SEE R DWGS FOR
RESTORATION
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN
ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY
LOCATION OF EXISTING UTILITES PRIOR TO STARTING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. SEE DWG G-3 FOR STORM GENERAL NOTES. REFER TO
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
8. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
9. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
10. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
11. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE
STA 8+25 TO 13+00 SD-3
50 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
1
3
+
0
0
S
D
-
4
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
+
2
5
S
D
-
2
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
1 3 +0 0
BRO NSON WAY NE
CB #2
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 8+36
OFFSET 14.9' RT
CB #3
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 8+35
OFFSET 15.2' LT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
DI
CB #5
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 11+04
OFFSET 15.5' RT
CB #6
TYPE 1 W/ BIRDCAGE INLET
PER COR STD PLAN 234.20
STA 11+04
OFFSET 25.6' RT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
PP
FOR DITCH IMPROVEMENTS
SEE DWG SD-20
12" SD
DI
OUTFALL
IE 166.3
CB #4
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 11+03
OFFSET 13.7' LT
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-20
185
180
175
170
165
160
155
185
180
175
170
165
160
155
CB
#
2
RI
M
E
L
1
7
7
.
2
0
IE
1
7
2
.
2
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
CB
#
3
RI
M
E
L
1
7
6
.
9
0
IE
1
7
1
.
6
2
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
1
7
1
.
6
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
E
)
CB
#
4
RI
M
E
L
1
6
9
.
4
7
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
W
)
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
CB
#
5
RI
M
E
L
1
6
9
.
9
4
IE
1
6
7
.
3
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
IE
1
6
7
.
3
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
CB
#
6
RI
M
E
L
1
7
0
.
0
6
IE
1
6
7
.
4
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
271 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.7%
30 LF - 12" SD PP
S=2.0%
29 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.0%
10 LF
12" SD DI
S=1.0%
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
9
.
5
8
8"
W
,
I
E
1
7
3
.
7
0
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
7
3
.
7
7
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
7
3
.
2
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
8
.
4
9
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
5
.
4
±
EX
O
H
P
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
4
.
7
8
EX
O
H
P
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
3
.
7
4
8"
W
,
I
E
1
6
5
.
5
7
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN
ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY
LOCATION OF EXISTING UTILITES PRIOR TO STARTING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. SEE DWG G-3 FOR STORM GENERAL NOTES. REFER TO
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
8. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
9. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
10. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
11. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE
STA 14+25 TO STA 18+50 SD-4
51 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
1
7
+
5
0
S
D
-
5
MAT
CH
LIN
E
STA
- SEE DW
G
13+00
SD-3
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
FOR PROFILE
CONTINUATION
SEE DWG SD-10
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE AND
PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL
BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS
PUMP EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
1
13+00
14+00
15+00
1 6 +0 0
1 7 +0 0
5
0
+
0
0
5
1
+
0
0
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
P
L
A
C
E
N
E
CB #56
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 16+25
OFFSET 17.1' LT
12" SD
DI
CB #58
TYPE 1W/ GRATE
STA 16+55
OFFSET 14.9' RT
CB #55
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 15+69
OFFSET 27.8' RT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
DI
12" SD
PP
BRONSON WAY NE
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-10
CB #54
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 50+80
OFFSET 15.5' RT
CB #8
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 14+20
OFFSET 14.8' RT
SEE DWG SD-21
CB #9
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 14+26
OFFSET 15.6' LT
SEE DWG SD-21
CB #7
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 14+17
OFFSET 30.1' RT
SEE DWG SD-21
FOR CHANNEL IMPROVMENTS
SEE DWG SD-21
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-21
CB #57
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 16+58
OFFSET 15.6' LT
1
170
165
160
155
150
145
140
EX GRADE AT C/L
OF PIPE ALIGNMENT
CB
#
5
8
RI
M
E
L
1
5
1
.
4
8
IE
1
4
9
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
170
165
160
155
150
145
140
CB
#
5
4
RI
M
E
L
1
6
0
.
9
0
CB
#
5
5
RI
M
E
L
1
5
6
.
2
6
IE
1
4
9
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
4
9
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
IE
1
4
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
1
5
0
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
EX
I
E
1
4
9
.
3
±
-
1
2
"
C
O
N
C
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
5
3
.
1
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
5
3
.
1
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
CB
#
5
7
RI
M
E
L
1
5
1
.
3
2
CB
#
5
6
RI
M
E
L
1
5
2
.
1
0
IE
1
5
7
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
5
7
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
7 3 L F - 1 2 " S D D I
31 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.3%
32 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.3%
6 0 L F - 1 2 " S D P P
S =7 .8 %
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
4
4
.
0
2
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
4
8
.
3
1
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
8"
W
,
I
E
1
4
7
.
9
0
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
4
9
.
5
0
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
4
9
.
6
0
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
4
4
.
4
4
6"
W
,
I
E
1
5
0
.
2
3
EX
6
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
5
1
.
0
9
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
6
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
5
3
.
1
7
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
4
8
.
7
2
8"
W
,
I
E
1
5
4
.
5
2
S =3 .6 %
1"
W
S
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN
ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY
LOCATION OF EXISTING UTILITES PRIOR TO STARTING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. SEE DWG G-3 FOR STORM GENERAL NOTES. REFER TO
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
8. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
9. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
10. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
11. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE
STA 17+50 TO 22+50 SD-5
52 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
1 7 +5 0
S D -4
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
PROFILE
VERT
SCALE: HORIZ
A
SD-61" = 20'-0"
1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"PROFILE
VERT
SCALE: HORIZ
B
SD-71" = 20'-0"
1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE AND
PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL
BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS
PUMP EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
CONNECT EXISTING PIPE TO NEW CATCH BASIN WITH
FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF SAME MATERIAL AS THE
CONNECTING PIPE.
1
2
LEGEND:
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
13
14
15
1
8
+
0
0
19+00
2 0 +0 0
2 1 +0 0
2 2 +0 0
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
12" SD
PVC
CB #20
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 21+59
OFFSET 16.8' LT
CB #21
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 21+71
OFFSET 15.0' RT
CB #22
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 21+90
OFFSET 15.8' RT
REMOVE EX CB AND
RESTORE CURB
AND GUTTER
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
2
1
130
125
120
115
110
105
100
130
125
120
115
110
105
100
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT CB
#
2
0
RI
M
E
L
1
1
9
.
1
2
IE
1
1
4
.
5
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
CB
#
2
1
RI
M
E
L
1
1
9
.
2
8
IE
1
1
4
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
W
)
IE
1
1
4
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
CB
#
2
2
RI
M
E
L
1
1
8
.
4
6
IE
1
1
4
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
EX
I
E
1
1
3
.
9
-
8
"
C
M
P
I
N
(
S
)
EX
I
E
1
1
3
.
9
-
8
"
C
M
P
O
U
T
(
N
)
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
1
2
.
1
4
8"
W
,
I
E
1
1
6
.
0
2
6"
W
,
I
E
1
1
6
.
1
0
EX
2
"
P
,
I
E
1
1
6
.
2
8
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
1
4
.
8
8
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
19 LF - 12" SD PVC
S=1.6%
34 LF -
12" SD
PVC
S=0.6%
EX
6
"
W
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
1
2
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN
ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY
LOCATION OF EXISTING UTILITES PRIOR TO STARTING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. SEE DWG G-3 FOR STORM GENERAL NOTES. REFER TO
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
8. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
9. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
10. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
11. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
135
130
125
120
115
110
135
130
125
120
115
110
CB
#
3
9
RI
M
E
L
1
2
1
.
7
3
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
IE
1
1
9
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
C
B
#
3
8
RI
M
E
L
1
2
1
.
6
8
S=0.75%
8"
W
,
I
E
1
1
7
.
1
1
EX
S
S
,
I
E
1
1
5
.
6
6
EX
1
"
W
S
6"
W
,
I
E
1
1
7
.
1
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
1
8
.
7
6
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
39 LF
12" SD DI
1
145
140
135
130
125
150
145
140
135
130
125
155155
150
IE
1
4
4
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
CB
#
3
4
RI
M
E
L
1
4
6
.
4
8
8"
W
,
I
E
1
4
3
.
0
9
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
4
3
.
2
6
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
3
9
.
9
4
CB
#
3
5
RI
M
E
L
1
4
5
.
7
5
IE
1
4
0
.
6
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
1
4
3
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
W
)
IE
1
4
0
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
30 LF -
12" SD DI
S=2.0%
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
4
2
.
8
2
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
PROVIDE 6" MIN
CLEARANCE W/
ETHAFOAM PAD
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
6
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY NE
STA 30+00 TO 34+00 SD-6
53 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
3 4 +0 0
S D -7
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
34
+
0
0
S
D
-
7
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
LEGEND:
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN
PLACE AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE
ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM
STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP
EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
1
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD
PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER
COR STD PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD
PLAN 220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED
WHEN LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW
STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED
WHERE SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND
ABANDONED IN PLACE PER WSDOT STD SPEC
7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER THAN 30
INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS
CALCULATED FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L
OF STRUCTURE.
3A
4
3B
5
+
0
0
6
+
0
0
30+00
3 1 +0 0
3 2 +0 0
33+00
3
4
+
0
0
5 9 +5 0
60+00
G R A N D E Y W A Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
WIN
D S O R W
A Y N
E
12" SD
PP
CB #32
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 30+13
OFFSET 17.3' LT
12" SD
PVC
12" SD
DI
CB #34
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 33+14
OFFSET 15.0' RT
CB #35
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 33+23
OFFSET 15.2' LT
12" SD
PP
CB #30
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 4+74
OFFSET 27.1' RT
CB #31
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 5+04
OFFSET 14.8' LT
CB #33
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 32+53
OFFSET 16.4' LT
12" SD
PVC
SEE PROFILE A/SD-5
1
1
1
195
190
185
180
175
170
200
195
190
185
180
175
170
200
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
3
1
RI
M
E
L
1
8
9
.
2
9
IE
1
8
5
.
2
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
1
8
5
.
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
CB
#
3
0
RI
M
E
L
1
9
0
.
4
8
IE
1
8
6
.
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
EX
I
E
1
8
9
.
6
-
4
"
I
N
(
N
)
CB
#
3
2
RI
M
E
L
1
8
8
.
0
0
IE
1
8
3
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
8
0
.
5
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
EX
8
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
8
5
.
4
4
,
TO
B
E
A
B
A
N
D
O
N
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
8
4
.
4
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
8
4
.
9
4
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
67 LF - 12" SD PP
S=1.5%
51 LF - 12" SD PP
S=1.9%
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
190
185
180
175
170
165
160
190
185
180
175
170
165
160
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
6
7
.
4
2
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
242 LF -
12" SD PVC
S=13.8%
TRENCH DAM, TYP
PER DETAIL 1/G-13
170
165
160
155
150
145
170
165
160
155
150
145
140 140
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
3
3
RI
M
E
L
1
5
4
.
4
0
IE
1
4
8
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
4
8
.
9
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
5
9
.
9
4
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
&
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
3
.
1
4
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
4
9
.
1
5
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
4
9
.
9
6
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
242 LF -
12" SD PVC
S=13.8%
11
155
150
145
140
135
130
155
150
145
140
135
130
125 125
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
3
5
RI
M
E
L
1
4
5
.
7
5
IE
1
4
0
.
6
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
4
3
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
1
4
0
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
4
3
.
3
4
1"
W
S
S=12.0%
139 LF
-12" SD PP
75 LF -
12" SD PVC
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
3
7
.
5
9
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
3
5
.
3
4
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
S=12.4%
1
1
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
6
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY NE
STA 8+00 TO 13+00 SD-7
54 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M A T C H LIN E S T A
- S E E D W G
3 8 +5 0
S D -8
M
A
T
C
H
LIN
E S
T
A
- S
E
E D
W
G
34+00
S
D-6
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
38
+
5
0
S
D
-
8
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
34
+
0
0
S
D
-
6
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
CONNECT EXISTING PIPE TO NEW CATCH BASIN WITH
FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF SAME MATERIAL AS
THE CONNECTING PIPE.
1
2
34+00
3 5 +0 0
36+00
37+00
3
8
+
0
0
12" SD
PP
12" SD
DI
CB #37
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE LID
STA 36+01
OFFSET 14.3' LT
12" SD
DI
CB #36
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 34+54
OFFSET 13.9' LT
CB #38
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 36+44
OFFSET 16.6' RT
12" SD
DI
CB #39
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE LID
STA 36+67
OFFSET 14.4' LT
G R A N D E Y W A Y
12" SD
DI
SEE PROFILE
B/SD-5
1
1
1
2
135
130
125
120
115
135
130
125
120
115
110 110
105 105
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
3
6
RI
M
E
L
1
2
8
.
1
9
IE
1
2
2
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
2
2
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
CB
#
3
7
RI
M
E
L
1
2
1
.
2
0
IE
1
1
9
.
2
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
1
7
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
EX
I
E
1
1
7
.
3
-
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
CB
#
3
9
RI
M
E
L
1
2
1
.
7
2
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
1
9
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
6"
W
,
I
E
1
1
7
.
1
EX
4
"
W
IE
1
2
8
.
1
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
6
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
2
0
.
0
±
EX
4
"
W
IE
1
2
2
.
5
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
IE
1
1
8
.
8
3
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
4
"
W
IE
1
1
8
.
9
6
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
8"
W
,
I
E
1
1
7
.
3
9
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
1
2
.
7
±
153 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.8%7 0 L F - 1 2 " S D D I
S =2 .9%
210 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.2%
1
1 1
TRENCH DAM, TYP
PER DETAIL 1/G-13
2
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD
PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER
COR STD PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD
PLAN 220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED
WHEN LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW
STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED
WHERE SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND
ABANDONED IN PLACE PER WSDOT STD SPEC
7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER THAN 30
INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS
CALCULATED FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L
OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
6
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY NE
STA 38+50 TO 42+50 SD-8
55 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
38+50
SD-7
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
4
2
+
5
0
S
D
-
9
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
38
+
5
0
S
D
-
7
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
1
39+00
40+00
41+00
4 2 +0 0
GRANDEY WAY
CB #41
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 38+74
OFFSET 13.5' LT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
PP
CB #42
TYPE 2 W/SOLID LID
STA 38+74
OFFSET 4.8' RT
CB #43
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 41+57
OFFSET 15.5' RT
CB #44
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 41+49
OFFSET 14.7' LT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
PP
CB #40
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 38+74
OFFSET 16.8' RT
1
140
135
130
125
120
115
110
140
135
130
125
120
115
110
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
4
2
RI
M
E
L
1
2
5
.
4
5
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
W
)
CB
#
4
3
RI
M
E
L
1
3
0
.
6
1
IE
1
2
5
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
2
5
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
W
)
IE
1
2
5
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
285 LF - 12" SD PP
S=1.2%
31 LF
12" SD PP
S=1.3%
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
1"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
8"
W
,
I
E
1
2
7
.
1
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
2
7
.
1
3
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
CB
#
4
4
RI
M
E
L
1
3
0
.
2
5
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD
PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER
COR STD PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD
PLAN 220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED
WHEN LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW
STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED
WHERE SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND
ABANDONED IN PLACE PER WSDOT STD SPEC
7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER THAN 30
INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS
CALCULATED FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L
OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
135
130
125
120
115
110
135
130
125
120
115
110
105105
CB
#
4
2
RI
M
E
L
1
2
5
.
4
5
IE
1
2
2
.
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
CB
#
4
1
RI
M
E
L
1
2
4
.
6
1
CB
#
4
0
RI
M
E
L
1
2
4
.
9
1
IE
1
2
2
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
12 LF - 12" SD DI
S=2.0%
18 LF - 12" SD DI
S=2.0%
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
1
8
.
9
8"
W
,
I
E
1
2
0
.
4
3
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
2
1
.
0
6
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
W
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
2
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
1
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
6
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY NE
STA 42+50 TO 47+00 SD-9
56 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
42+50
SD-8
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
1
5
19+00
2
0
+
0
0
43+00
44+00 45+00
4 6 +0 0
4 7 +0 0
G R A N D E Y W A Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
CB #46
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 44+77
OFFSET 15.6' LT
SEE DWG SD-19
18" SD
PP
CB #45
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 44+64
OFFSET 14.8' RT
SEE DWG SD-19
18" SD
PP
IE 127.0 - 18" OUT (W)
FOR CHANNEL
IMPROVMENTS
SEE DWG SD-19
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-19
1
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD
PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER
COR STD PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD
PLAN 220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED
WHEN LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW
STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED
WHERE SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND
ABANDONED IN PLACE PER WSDOT STD SPEC
7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER THAN 30
INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS
CALCULATED FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L
OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
0
-
1
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONA L E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON PL NE
STA 50+00 TO 54+00 SD-10
57 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
5
4
+
0
0
S
D
-
1
1
175
170
165
160
155
150
145
FOR PROFILE
CONTINUATION
SEE DWG SD-4
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
54
+
0
0
S
D
-
1
1
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
SEE WATER SHEETS FOR NEW SANITARY MANHOLE
DESIGN.
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
INSTALL YARD DRAIN RIMS WITH SLIGHT
DEPRESSION TO COLLECT STORMWATER ON
SIDEWALKS.
1
2
3
50+00
51+00
52+00
5 3 +0 0
5 4 +0 0
BRONSON PLACE NE
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
12" SD
PVC
CB #54
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 50+80
OFFSET 15.5' RT
CB #53
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 52+55
OFFSET 15.3' LT
CB #52
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 53+54
OFFSET 13.6' RT
YARD DRAIN,
PER DETAIL 2/G-13
12" SD
PP
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-4
CB #55
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
BRONSON WAY NE
STA 15+68.65
OFFSET 27.75' RT
1
8" SD
HDPE
10 LF
2 3
175
170
165
160
155
150
145
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
5
4
RI
M
E
L
1
6
0
.
9
0
IE
1
5
7
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
5
7
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
1 7 5 L F - 1 2 " S D P V C
S =5 .1 %
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
5
6
.
3
7
8"
W
,
I
E
1
5
5
.
5
4
1"
W
S
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
190
185
180
175
170
165
190
185
180
175
170
165
160160
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
5
2
RI
M
E
L
1
8
3
.
8
4
IE
1
7
8
.
7
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
7
8
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
1
7
8
.
7
-
8
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
CB
#
5
3
RI
M
E
L
1
7
1
.
0
7
IE
1
6
6
.
7
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
6
6
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
S =1 1 .7 %
8"
W
,
I
E
1
7
8
.
9
2
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
7
1
.
4
1
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
8
0
.
3
1
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
8
4
.
3
2
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
6
7
.
3
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
7
4
.
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
6
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
8
4
.
2
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
8
3
.
3
6
EX
6
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
6
9
.
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PADTRENCH DAM, TYP
PER DETAIL 1/G-13
EX
8
"
S
S
,
IE
1
7
2
.
1
7
2
1 0 3 L F -
1 2 " S D P P
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM PAD
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
0
-
1
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON PL NE
STA 54+00 TO 57+50 SD-11
58 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
54+00
SD-10
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
54
+
0
0
S
D
-
1
0
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
CONNECT TO EX CATCH BASIN WITH KOR-N-SEAL
CONNECTION.
INSTALL YARD DRAIN RIMS WITH SLIGHT DEPRESSION
TO COLLECT STORMWATER ON SIDEWALKS.
1
2
2
210
205
200
215
220
225
195
210
205
200
195
215
220
225
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
IE
2
1
1
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
C
B
#
9
0
RI
M
E
L
2
1
3
.
7
4
CB
#
9
1
RI
M
E
L
2
1
3
.
9
1
IE
2
1
1
.
2
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
2
1
1
.
2
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
CB
#
9
2
RI
M
E
L
2
1
4
.
3
6
IE
2
1
1
.
1
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
W
)
EX
I
E
2
1
1
.
1
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
21 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.50%
31 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.50%
8"
W
,
I
E
2
0
9
.
2
2
EX
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
7
.
6
7
EX
O
H
P
EX 12" SD
EX
2
"
G
,
I
E
2
1
0
.
5
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
1
0
.
4
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
67
54+00
55+00
5 6 +0 0
5
7
+
0
0
B R O N S O N P L A C E N E
WINDSOR PLACE NE
12" SD
DI
CB #92
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 56+56
OFFSET 14.2' RT
CB #90
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 56+36
OFFSET 15.6' LT
CB #91
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 56+52
OFFSET 16.4' LT
12" SD
DI
12" SD
PP
CB #51
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 54+96
OFFSET 7.5' LT
CB #50
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 55+00
OFFSET 58.3 RT12" SD
PP
YARD DRAIN,
PER DETAIL 2/G-13
8" SD
HDPE
1
2
210
205
200
195
190
215
220
210
205
200
195
190
215
220
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
5
1
RI
M
E
L
2
0
9
.
5
2
IE
2
0
2
.
5
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
E
)
IE
2
0
2
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
2
0
6
.
5
-
8
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
CB
#
5
0
RI
M
E
L
2
1
5
.
9
5
IE
2
1
1
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
2
1
3
.
8
-
8
"
I
N
(
N
)
YA
R
D
D
R
A
I
N
RI
M
E
L
2
1
6
.
6
7
IE
2
1
4
.
0
-
8
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
1 4 3 L F -
1 2 " S D P P
8"
W
,
I
E
2
0
8
.
4
7
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
0
8
.
7
8
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
2
"
S
D
,
I
E
1
9
2
.
2
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
2
0
4
.
4
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
8.4 LF
8" SD HDPE
S=2.0%
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
2
"
G
,
I
E
1
9
0
.
6
2
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
5
.
9
5
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
8
.
1
0
S =1 3 .4 %
TRENCH DAM, TYP
SEE DETAIL 1/G-13
S =1 6 .6 %
6 6 L F -
1 2 " S D P P
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
+00
210
205
200
215
220
210
205
200
215
220
195 195
190 190
IE
2
0
7
.
8
-
6
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
EX
I
E
2
1
0
.
7
-
6
"
I
N
(
E
)
EX
C
B
N
O
.
1
3
3
7
7
5
RI
M
2
1
2
.
1
9
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
4 4 L F - 8 " S D H DP E
S =3.0 %
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
0
8
.
9
0
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
2
0
9
.
2
2
CB
#
5
1
RI
M
E
L
2
0
9
.
5
2
IE
2
0
3
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
E
)
IE
2
0
3
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
2
0
6
.
5
-
6
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
EX 6" SD
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 3 +2 5
S D -1 3
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
2
-
1
3
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONA L E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PL NE
STA 80+00 TO 83+25 SD-12
59 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
INSTALL YARD DRAIN RIMS WITH SLIGHT DEPRESSION TO
COLLECT STORMWATER ON SIDEWALKS.
1
8
54+00
5
5
+
0
0
79+80 80+00 81+00
82+00
8
3
+
0
0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
BRONSO
N PL
ACE
NE
12" SD
PP
CB #81
TYPE 1
STA 83+01
OFFSET 15.8' RT
CB #82
TYPE 1
STA 83+13
OFFSET 23.6' LT
YARD DRAIN,
PER DETAIL 2/G-13
CB #83
TYPE 1
STA 82+80
OFFSET 229.2' LT
12" SD
PPFOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-11
CB #51
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 54+96
OFFSET 7.47' LT
CB #50
TYPE 1
STA 55+00
OFFSET 58.3' RT
1
255
250
245
240
235
230
225
245
240
235
255
250
230
225
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
8
3
RI
M
E
L
2
4
8
.
5
7
IE
2
4
6
.
6
-
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
2
4
4
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
CB
#
8
2
RI
M
E
L
2
4
3
.
9
8
IE
2
3
8
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
2
3
8
.
9
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
YA
R
D
D
R
A
I
N
RI
M
E
L
2
4
9
.
2
4
IE
2
4
6
.
7
-
8
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
CB
#
8
1
RI
M
E
L
2
4
1
.
7
8
IE
2
3
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
2
3
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
74 LF - 12" SD PP
S=7.3%
41 LF - 12" SD PP
S=4.6%
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
2
4
6
.
6
1
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
3
9
.
8
5
8"
W
,
I
E
2
4
0
.
3
7
EX
1
/
2
"
G
A
S
5.6 LF - 8" SD HDPE
S=1.8%
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
1
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
3
+
2
5
S
D
-
1
2
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
2
-
1
3
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PL NE
STA 83+25 TO 88+00 SD-13
60 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
FOR PROFILE CONTINUATION
SEE DWG SD-16
8 4 +0 0
85+00 86+00
87+00
8 8 +0 088+01
7 3 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
WINDSOR WAY NE
12" SD
PP
CB #80
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 85+23
OFFSET 14.8' LT
12" SD
PVC
CB #79
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 86+83
OFFSET 15.2' LT
SEE DWG SD-16
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-16
CB #78
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 86+67
OFFSET 24.0' RT
CB #76
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 72+48
OFFSET 21.8' LT
CB #77
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 72+93
OFFSET 14.6' RT
240
235
230
225
220
215
210
240
235
230
225
220
215
210
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
8
0
RI
M
E
L
2
2
9
.
2
1
IE
2
2
4
.
6
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
2
2
4
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
221 LF - 12" SD PVC
S=5.6%
160 LF - 12" SD PP
S=6.6%
CB
#
7
9
RI
M
E
L
2
2
2
.
5
5
IE 214.0 - 12" IN (N)
IE 214.0 - 12" OUT (SW)
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
2
2
3
.
5
±
8"
W
,
IE
2
3
3
.
0
8
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
G
A
S
IE
2
3
5
.
1
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
IE
2
3
6
.
0
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
G
A
S
IE
2
2
5
.
5
9
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
G
A
S
IE
2
2
1
.
9
0
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
G
A
S
IE
2
1
9
.
6
9
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
1"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX 4" W
IE 238.23
ESTIMATED
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
64+50
SD-15
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
4
-
1
7
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONA L E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE
STA 60+00 TO 64+50 SD-14
61 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
INSTALL QUARRY SPALL PAD AT OUTFALL, PER
WSDOT STD SPECIFICATION 8-01.3(11).
1
5+00
6+00
30+00
59+50
60+00
61+00
62+00
63+00
64+00
4+00
WINDSOR WAY NE
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
G
R
AN
DEY W
AY NE
12" SD
DI
CB #60
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 62+51
OFFSET 14.7' RT
CB #61
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 62+96
OFFSET 14.7' RT
12" SD
DI
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-6
CB #62
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 62+96
OFFSET 15.7' LT
12" SD
DI - OUTFALL
IE 190.5±
1
SEE R DWGS FOR
RESTORATION
INFORMATION
200
195
190
185
180
200
195
190
185
180
175175
205205
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
6
0
RI
M
E
L
1
9
2
.
5
6
EX
I
E
1
9
2
.
0
-
4
"
D
I
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
9
1
.
2
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
E
)
CB
#
6
1
RI
M
E
L
1
9
3
.
0
IE
1
9
1
.
1
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
E
)
IE
1
9
1
.
1
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
W
)
CB
#
6
2
RI
M
E
L
1
9
2
.
8
8
IE
1
9
0
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
1
9
0
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
30 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.7%
EX
2
"
G
A
S
IE
1
8
9
.
6
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
8
9
.
2
9
44 LF - 12" SD DI
S=0.05%
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
8
6
.
0
±
EX
O
H
P
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
9
0
.
2
1
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
15 LF -
12" SD DI
S=2.0%
12" SD DI
OUTFALL
IE 190.5±
1
8'
1'
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
4
-
1
7
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONA L E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE
STA 64+50 TO 69+50 SD-15
62 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DW G
64+50
SD-14 M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
6
9
+
5
0
S
D
-
1
6
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
69
+
5
0
S
D
-
1
6
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE AND
PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL
BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS
PUMP EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
CONNECT EXISTING PIPE TO NEW CATCH BASIN WITH
FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF SAME MATERIAL AS THE
CONNECTING PIPE.
1
2
LEGEND:
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
9
65+00
66+00
67+00
6 8 +0 0
6 9 +0 0
WINDSOR WAY NE
12" SD
PP
CB #70
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 68+28
OFFSET 15.9' LT
CB #71
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 68+58
OFFSET 15.0' LT
CB #72
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 68+52
OFFSET 15.4' RT
12" SD
PP
1
2
185
180
175
170
195
190
185
180
175
170
195
190
165 165
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
7
0
RI
M
E
L
1
7
8
.
9
8
EX
I
E
1
7
2
.
7
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
EX
I
E
1
7
2
.
6
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
7
2
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
CB
#
7
1
RI
M
E
L
1
7
8
.
2
4
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
1 5 6 L F - 1 2 " S D P P
S =6 .9 %29 LF - 12" SD PP
S=2.1%
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
9
.
8
9
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
4
"
W
I
E
1
7
5
.
2
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
1"
W
S
1
2
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D-
4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
185
180
175
170
165
185
180
175
170
165
165165
190190
CB
#
7
1
RI
M
E
L
1
7
8
.
2
4
31 LF - 12" SD PP
S=1.94%
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
7
2
RI
M
E
L
1
7
8
.
4
4
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
1
7
3
.
5
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
1
7
4
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
8"
W
,
I
E
1
7
2
.
2
9
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
7
5
.
7
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
4
"
W
I
N
S
I
D
E
CB
,
I
E
1
7
4
.
0
6
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
7
1
.
7
7
1
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
4
-
1
7
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE
STA 69+50 TO 73+50 SD-16
63 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
6
9
+
5
0
S
D
-
1
5
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
7 3 +5 0
S D -1 7
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
69
+
5
0
S
D
-
1
5
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
HORIZ: 1" = 20'-0"
VERT: 1" = 5'-0"
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
FOR PROFILE CONTINUATION
SEE DWG SD-13
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE AND
PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL
BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS
PUMP EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
1
185
180
175
195
190
205
200
185
180
175
195
190
200
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
CB
#
7
3
RI
M
E
L
1
8
8
.
9
0
IE
1
8
4
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
W
)
IE
1
8
4
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
E
)
CB
#
7
4
RI
M
E
L
1
9
4
.
8
9
IE
1
9
0
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
1
9
0
.
4
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
CB
#
7
5
RI
M
E
L
1
9
6
.
5
6
IE
1
9
2
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
W
)
IE
1
9
2
.
4
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
8 2 L F - 1 2 " S D P P
S =7 .4 %
3 6 L F -
1 2 " P P
EX
2
"
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
9
3
.
5
2
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
,
TO
B
E
R
E
L
O
C
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
8
9
.
0
0
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
9
1
.
7
5
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
9
0
.
9
7
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
8
4
.
0
±
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
8
6
.
3
1
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
1
9
1
.
2
2
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
1
7
8
.
1
3
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
1
8
2
.
5
7
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
EX 2" G,
TO BE
RELOCATED
11
S =5 .6 %
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
195
205
200
195
205
200
210 210
215 215
220 220
225 225
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT CB
#
7
6
RI
M
E
L
2
1
5
.
9
6
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
2
1
2
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
2
1
4
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
2
1
4
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
CB #79
RIM EL 222.55
1 4 3 L F -
1 2 " S D P V C
7 6 L F - 1 2 " S D P P
S =2.9 %
EX
1
"
W
S
1"
W
S
8"
W
IE
2
1
9
.
0
6
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
1
8
.
8
9
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
2
1
9
.
1
8
,
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
2
0
7
.
5
6
EX
6
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
3
.
2
±
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
1
1
.
7
5
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
1
"
W
S
8"
W
,
I
E
2
0
1
.
2
0
EX
G
A
S
,
I
E
2
0
4
.
6
9
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
1"
W
S
EX
1
"
W
S
EX
8
"
S
S
IE
2
1
5
.
1
2
EX 2" G,
TO BE
RELOCATED
S =1 3 .6 %
PROVIDE 6"
MIN CLR W/
ETHAFOAM
PAD
TRENCH DAM, TYP,
PER DETAIL 1/G-13
1
PROVIDE 6" MIN CLR
W/ ETHAFOAM PAD
10
7 0 +0 0
7 1+00 72+00
7
3
+
0
0
WINDSOR WAY NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
12" SD
PP
CB #74
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 70+91
OFFSET 15.3' LT
CB #75
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 71+11
OFFSET 15.0' RT
CB #78
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 86+67
OFFSET 24.0' RT
CB #79
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 86+83
OFFSET 15.2' LT
CB #77
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 72+93
OFFSET 14.6' RT
12" SD
PVC
12" SD
PP
12" SD
PP
12" SD
PP
CB #76
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 72+48
OFFSET 21.8' LT
CB #73
TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
STA 70+12
OFFSET 7.9' LT
FOR PLAN AND PROFILE
SEE DWG SD-13
SEE PROFILE
B/SD-17
SEE PROFILE
A/SD-17
1
1
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
4
-
1
7
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE
STA 73+50 TO 75+76 SD-17
64 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
73+50
SD-16
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
PROFILE
VERT
SCALE: HORIZ
A
SD-161" = 20'-0"
1" = 5'-0"
PROFILE
VERT
SCALE: HORIZ
B
SD-161" = 20'-0"
1" = 5'-0"
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE AND
PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND OPERATIONAL
BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS INSTALLED. BYPASS
PUMP EXISTING STORM AS REQUIRED.
1
16A
16B
7 5 +7 6
74+00
7 5 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
E
D
M
O
N
D
S
A
V
E
N
E
N O S T O R M I M P R O V E M E N T S O N T H I S P L A N
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN 202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE PER
WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED FARTHER
THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA RESTORED
AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
225
220
215
210
205
230
200
225
220
215
210
205
230
200
CB
#
7
6
RI
M
E
L
2
1
5
.
9
6
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
IE
2
1
6
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
)
C
B
#
7
8
RI
M
E
L
2
2
0
.
6
1
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
1
2
.
4
9
,
E
S
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
4
.
8
2
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
IE
2
1
2
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
5 4 L F - 1 2 " S D P P
S =6 .3 %
1
225
220
215
210
205
230
225
220
215
210
205
230
200200
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
IE
2
1
4
.
9
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
CB
#
7
7
RI
M
E
L
2
2
0
.
2
9
CB
#
7
6
RI
M
E
L
2
1
5
.
9
6
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
S
W
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
E
)
IE
2
1
2
.
9
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
N
)
IE
2
1
1
.
8
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
E
)
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
2
0
4
.
2
4
EX
4
"
W
,
I
E
2
1
2
.
8
1
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
2
1
4
.
7
8
EX
G
A
S
IE
2
1
5
.
6
8
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
5 8 L F
1 2 " S D P P
S =5 .3 %
1
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
802+10
SD-1
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
8
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO VUEMONT PL NE STA 700+00 TO 702+00 AND
STORM STRUCTURE TABLE SD-18
65 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
STORM STRUCTURE TABLE
STRUCTURE
ID DRAWING STATION CB TYPE
COVER/GRATE
COR STD
CB #1 SD-1 1+77 1 204.20
CB#2 SD-3 8+36 1 204.20
CB #3 SD-3 8+35 1 204.20
CB #4 SD-3 11+03 2 204.20
CB #5 SD-3 11+04 1 204.20
CB #6 SD-3 11+04 1 204.30
CB #7 SD-4 14+17 1 204.30
CB #8 SD-4 14+20 1 204.20
CB #9 SD-4 14+26 1 204.20
CB #20 SD-5 21+59 1 204.20
CB #21 SD-5 21+71 1 204.20
CB #22 SD-5 21+90 2 204.50
CB #30 SD-6 4+74 1 204.20
CB #31 SD-6 5+04 1 204.20
CB #32 SD-6 30+13 2 204.50
CB #33 SD-6 32+53 2 204.20
CB #34 SD-6 33+14 1 204.20
CB #35 SD-6 33+23 2 204.20
CB #36 SD-7 34+54 2 204.20
CB #37 SD-7 36+01 2 204.30
CB #38 SD-7 36+44 1 204.30
CB #39 SD-7 36+67 2 204.30
CB #40 SD-8 38+74 1 204.20
CB #41 SD-8 38+74 1 204.20
CB #42 SD-8 38+74 2 204.50
CB #43 SD-8 41+57 1 204.20
CB #44 SD-8 41+49 1 204.20
CB #45 SD-9 44+64 1 204.30
CB #46 SD-9 44+77 1 204.30
CB #50 SD-11 55+00 1 204.20
CB #51 SD-11 54+96 2 204.50
CB #52 SD-10 53+54 1 204.20
CB #53 SD-10 52+55 1 204.20
CB #54 SD-4 50+80 1 204.20
CB #55 SD-4 15+69 1 204.20
CB #56 SD-4 16+25 2 204.50
CB #57 SD-4 16+58 1 204.30
CB #58 SD-4 16+55 1 204.30
CB #60 SD-14 62+51 1 204.30
CB #61 SD-14 62+96 1 204.20
CB #62 SD-14 62+96 1 204.20
CB #70 SD-15 68+28 2 204.50
CB #71 SD-15 68+58 1 204.30
CB #72 SD-15 68+52 1 204.30
CB #73 SD-16 70+12 2 204.50
CB #74 SD-16 70+91 1 204.20
CB #75 SD-16 71+11 1 204.20
CB #76 SD-13 72+48 2 204.50
CB #77 SD-13 72+93 1 204.20
CB #78 SD-13 86+67 1 204.20
CB #79 SD-13 86+83 2 204.20
CB #80 SD-13 85+23 1 204.20
CB #81 SD-12 83+01 1 204.30
CB #82 SD-12 83+13 1 204.20
CB #83 SD-12 82+80 1 204.30
17
18
800+00 801+00
802+00
70
0
+
0
0
70
1
+
0
0
70
2
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
VUEMONT PL NE
N O S T O R M I M P R O V E M E N T S O N T H I S P L A N
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
S
D
-
1
1
SD
-
1
0
SD-1
SD-2
S D -3
S
D
-4
SD-5
SD-6
S D-7
S D -8
SD-9
SD-12
SD-13
S D -1 4
S D-1 5
S D -1 6
S
D-17
S D-18
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
1
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY DITCH
PLAN AND PROFILE SD-19
66 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
LEGEND:
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
5
20+00
21+00
CB #45
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 20+13
CB #46
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 20+46
18" SD
PP
18" SD
PP
REMOVE EX CB
G R A N D E Y W A Y
CB #47
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 21+42.4
2 3
LIMITS OF
CONSTRUCTION
1 4
6
8
8
7
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
PROTECT EXISTING BLOCK WALL IN-PLACE WITH
TEMPORARY SHORING AS NECESSARY.
REMOVE EXISTING BROKEN CONCRETE ROCKERY
AND LOOSE SOILS IN EXISTING DITCH TO PREPARE
TRENCH SUBGRADE AND SIDEWALLS.
WITHIN PRIVATE PROPERTY SURFACE
RESTORATION SHALL BE 12-INCHES OF TOPSOIL
AND HYDROSEED PER SECTION 8-02 ROADSIDE
RESTORATION.
REMOVE PORTIONS OF EX 24" CMP AND EX 12"
CONC SD SO THAT EX SD PIPES ARE FLUSH
WITHIN NEW CB #47. CONNECT USING
KOR-N-SEAL CONNECTIONS OR EQUAL.
CONNECT EX PIPE TO NEW CATCH BASIN WITH
FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF SAME MATERIAL
AS THE CONNECTING PIPE.
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
PROTECT EXISTING FENCES OR REMOVE, RETAIN,
AND REINSTALL AS NECESSARY.
PRESERVE AND PROTECT TREES.
1
2
3
4
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN
202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR
STD PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE
PER WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED
FARTHER THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS
CALCULATED FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF
STRUCTURE.
5
6
7
8
20+00 21+00
145
140
135
130
125
120
115
145
140
135
130
125
120
115
IE
1
2
4
.
6
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
CB
#
4
6
RI
M
E
L
1
3
1
.
0
6
IE
1
2
5
.
2
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
2
8
.
0
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
33 LF - 18" SD PP
S=1.9%
CB
#
4
7
RI
M
1
4
1
.
0
IE
1
3
6
.
0
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
EX
I
E
1
3
8
.
7
-
1
2
"
C
O
N
C
I
N
(
E
)
EX
I
E
1
3
7
.
3
-
2
4
"
C
M
P
I
N
(
S
)
9 7 L F - 1 8 " S D P P
S = 8 .3 %
EX
1
2
4
.
6
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
EX 18" OUTFALL
IE 122.7
8"
W
IE
1
2
7
.
6
1
EX
2
4
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
2
7
.
1
8
RI
G
H
T
O
F
W
A
Y
EX 12" SD
IE 138.7
(INSIDE EX 24" SD)
EX
2
4
"
S
D
I
E
1
3
7
.
3
P/
L
EX BLOCK WALL
FINAL
GRADE
PROVIDE 6" MIN
CLEARANCE W/
ETHAFOAM PAD
1
CB
#
4
5
RI
M
E
L
1
3
0
.
6
5
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
2
7
.
2
4
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
4
5
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
2
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE DITCH
PLAN AND PROFILE SD-20
67 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
INSTALL QUARRY SPALL PAD AT OUTFALL, PER
WSDOT STD SPECIFICATION 8-01.3(11).
PROVIDE MINIMUM 1-FOOT DITCH FREEBOARD
ABOVE BIRDCAGE INLET.
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
1
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN
202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE
PER WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED
FARTHER THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
2
3
9
1
+
5
0
9
0
+
0
0
9
1
+
0
0
REMOVE VEGETATION AND
INSTALL QUARRY SPALL DITCH,
MATCH EXISTING GRADES AND
SLOPE TO DRAIN TO CB #6
CB #4
TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
STA 90+30
CB #5
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 90+59
CB #6
TYPE 1 W/ BIRDCAGE INLET
PER COR STD PLAN 234.20
STA 90+69
12" SD
DI
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
LIMITS OF CONSTRUCTION
1
176
1
7
4
1
7
2
170
3
90+00 91+00
165
160
155
150
170
175
180
CB
#
4
RI
M
E
L
1
6
9
.
4
7
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
IE
1
6
7
.
0
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
W
)
29 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.0%
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT CB
#
5
RI
M
E
L
1
6
9
.
9
4
IE
1
6
7
.
3
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
IE
1
6
7
.
3
-
1
2
"
I
N
(
S
)
CB
#
6
RI
M
E
L
1
6
9
.
9
0
IE
1
6
7
.
4
-
1
2
"
O
U
T
(
N
)
10 LF - 12" SD DI
S=1.0%
QUARRY SPALL DITCH,
PER DETAIL 2/SD-22
8"
W
,
I
E
1
6
5
.
5
7
EX
8
"
S
S
,
I
E
1
6
3
.
7
4
OUTFALL
IE 166.3
18 LF - 12" SD DI
S=3.9%
FINAL
GRADE
1
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
6
6
.
0
6
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8'
1'
EX GRADE
RIGHT OF WAY
EX
GRADE
2
3
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
2
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE DITCH
PLAN AND PROFILE SD-21
68 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
CONSTRUCTION NOTES:
PROTECT EXISTING FENCES OR REMOVE, RETAIN,
AND REINSTALL AS NECESSARY.
REMOVE EXISTING BROKEN CONCRETE LINING,
LOOSE SOILS, AND VEGETATION IN EXISTING
DITCH TO PREPARE TRENCH SUBGRADE AND
SIDEWALLS.
WITHIN PRIVATE PROPERTY SURFACE
RESTORATION SHALL BE 8-INCHES OF CSBC.
REMOVE EXISTING ROCKERY TO PREPARE
TRENCH SUBGRADE AND SIDEWALLS.
CONTRACTOR SHALL ROUTE ANY SURFACE
WATER FROM EXISTING BUILDINGS TO CB #7.
EXISTING WATER SHALL BE ABANDONED IN PLACE
AND PROPOSED WATER SHALL BE ONLINE AND
OPERATIONAL BEFORE STORM STRUCTURE IS
INSTALLED. BYPASS PUMP EXISTING STORM AS
REQUIRED.
CONNECT EX PIPE TO NEW CATCH BASIN WITH
FABRICATED SAND COLLAR OF SAME MATERIAL
AS THE CONNECTING PIPE.
PROVIDE MINIMUM 1-FOOT DITCH FREEBOARD
ABOVE BIRDCAGE INLET.
PRESERVE AND PROTECT TREE.
1
2
3
4
5
6
NOTES:
1. CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 PER COR STD PLAN 200.00
2. CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 PER COR STD PLAN 201.00
3. CATCH BASIN INSTALLATION PER COR STD PLAN
202.00
4. PIPE ZONE BEDDING AND COMPACTION PER COR STD
PLAN 220.10
5. TYPICAL TRENCH AND BACKFILL PER COR STD PLAN
220.20
6. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE REMOVED WHEN
LOCATED WITHIN 30 INCHES OF NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
7. EXISTING STORM PIPES SHALL BE CAPPED WHERE
SHOWN AND PLUGGED AND ABANDONED IN PLACE
PER WSDOT STD SPEC 7-08.3(4) WHEN LOCATED
FARTHER THAN 30 INCHES FROM NEW STORM
FACILITIES.
8. EXISTING STORM STRUCTURES IDENTIFIED FOR
REMOVAL SHALL BE REMOVED AND THE AREA
RESTORED AS SHOWN ON THE RESTORATION
SHEETS.
9. PIPE SLOPE SHOWN IN PROFILE VIEW IS CALCULATED
FROM C/L OF STRUCTURE TO C/L OF STRUCTURE.
7
8
9
BIRD CAGE OVERFLOW STRUCTURE
PER COR STD PLAN 234.20
STA 41+78CB #7
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 40+59
18" SD
PP
REMOVE
EX CB
CB #9
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 40+12.5
REMOVE EX CB
18" SD
PP
18" SD
PP
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
CB #8
TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
STA 40+44
2
1
3
1
4
+
0
0
1
5
+
0
0
50+00
4 0 +0 0
41+00
4
2
+
0
0
43+00
300+00
5
LIMITS OF
CONSTRUCTION
4
6
9
EX GRADE AT
C/L OF PIPE
ALIGNMENT
BI
R
D
C
A
G
E
OV
E
R
F
L
O
W
ST
R
U
C
T
U
R
E
RI
M
1
6
3
.
0
16 LF - 18" SD PP
S=8.3%
CB
#
9
RI
M
E
L
1
5
7
.
4
5
IE
1
5
3
.
2
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
5
4
.
4
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
CB
#
8
RI
M
E
L
1
5
8
.
1
7
31 LF
18" SD PP
CB
#
7
RI
M
E
L
1
5
9
.
2
5
IE
1
5
5
.
7
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
IE
1
5
5
.
7
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
6
0
.
5
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
EX 18"
OUTFALL
IE 151.4
1 1 9 L F - 1 8 " S D PP
S =4 .0 %
EX
6
"
W
,
I
E
1
5
4
.
1
5
ES
T
I
M
A
T
E
D
8"
W
,
I
E
1
5
5
.
0
8
FINAL
GRADE
EX
I
E
1
5
2
.
7
-
1
8
"
O
U
T
(
W
)
IE
1
5
2
.
6
-
1
8
"
I
N
(
E
)
165
160
155
150
145
40+00 41+00 42+00
165
160
155
150
145
140 140
170
160
170
160EX
S
S
,
I
E
1
4
6
.
4
6
PROVIDE 6" MIN
CLEARANCE W/
ETHAFOAM PAD
1.9%
6
7
8
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
D
-
2
2
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO STORMWATER DETAILS SD-22
69 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
DEBRIS CAGE NOTES:
1. MAINTAIN 45 DEGREE ANGLE ON
VERTICAL BARS AND 7" OC MAX
SPACING OF BARS AROUND
LOWER STEEL BAND.
2. METAL PARTS MUST BE
CORROSION RESISTANT.
QUARRY SPALL DITCH
2
SD-20SCALE: 1" = 1'-0"
DETAIL
QUARRY SPALLS,
16-INCH DEPTH,
WSDOT 8-15.3(6)
1
2
1'
-
5
"
MIN WIDTH 5'-4"1
2.5 MAX
1
2
1
2.5 MAX
1
1
1
1
BIRD CAGE OVERFLOW STRUCTURE
1
SD-21NTS
DETAIL
PLAN
SECTION A-A
6" THICK GRAVEL BACKFILL
FOR PIPE ZONE BEDDING
DEBRIS CAGE, SEE DETAIL 3
4 - 1" DIA WEEP HOLES
48" DIA TYPE 2
CATCH BASIN BASE
3'-0"1'
-
6
"
TY
P
QUARRY SPALLS PER
WSDOT 8-15.3(6)
18" PP OUTLET PIPE
FLOW
FLOW
FLOW
AA
9'-0"
4 - 1" DIA WEEP HOLES
1'
-
0
"
M
I
N
FR
E
E
B
O
A
R
D
PROVIDE MAINTENANCE ACCESS BY
WELDING 4 CROSSBARS TO 4 VERTICAL
BARS AS SHOWN. HING UPPER ENDS
WITH FLANGES/BOLTS AND PROVIDE
LOCKING MECHANISM (PADLOCK) ON
LOWER END. LOCATE STEPS DIRECTLY
BELOW.
3/4" DIAMETER SMOOTH
BARS, EQUALLY SPACED
(4" OC MAX)
4 HOOK CLAMPS EVENLY
PLACED, SEE BELOW
UPPER STEEL BAND
3/4" X 4" WIDE
48" DIAMETER TYPE 2
CATCH BASIN
3/4" DIAMETER SMOOTH ROUND
BARS WELDED EQUALLY SPACED.
BARS SHALL BE WELDED TO UPPER
AND LOWER BANDS (22 BARS
EVENLY SPACED).
LOWER STEEL BAND 3/4" X 4" WIDE
FORMED TO FIT IN GROOVE OF CB
RISER
STANDARD GALVANIZED
STEPS OR LADDER
18"
16° TYP
PLAN
AA
SECTION A-A
DEBRIS CAGE DETAIL
3
SD-20SCALE: 1" = 1'-0"
DETAIL
SMOOTH
VERTICAL BARS
HOOK CLAMP
ANCHORED TO
CATCH BASIN RISER
CATCH BASIN
RISER
4 5 °
HOOK CLAMP
4
-SCALE: 1" = 1'-0"
DETAIL
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+00 5+00
6+
0
0
7+00
8+
0
0
9
+
0
0
1
0
+
0
0
11
+
0
0
1
2
+
0
0
13
+
0
0
14+00
15+00
16+00
17+00
18+00
19+
0
0
20
+
0
0
21
+
0
0
22
+
0
0
30
+
0
0
31
+
0
0
32
+
0
0
33+
0
0
34+00
35+00
36+
0
0
3
7
+
0
0
38
+
0
0
39
+
0
0
40
+
0
0
41
+
0
0
4
2
+
0
0
43
+
0
0
44+
0
0
45+00
46+00
47+00
50
+
0
0
5
1
+
0
0
52
+
0
0
53+
0
0
54+00
55
+
0
0
56+00
57
+
0
0
88
+
0
1
79
+
8
0
80
+
0
0
81
+
0
0
82
+
0
0
83+00
84+00
85+0086+00
87+00
88+00
75
+
7
6
59
+
5
0
60
+
0
0
61
+
0
0
63
+
0
0
64
+
0
0
65
+
0
0
6
6
+
0
0
6
7
+
0
0
68
+
0
0
69+
0
0
7
0
+
0
0
71
+
0
0
72
+
0
0
73+0
0
74+0
0
75
+
0
0
C39
C40
C46
C47
800
+
0
0
80
1
+
0
0
8
0
2
+
0
0
80
3
+
0
0
804+
0
0
805
+
0
0
80
6
+
0
0
700
+
0
0
701
+
0
0
702
+
0
0
702+90
62
+
0
0
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
RESTORATION KEY PLAN R-1
70
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+00 5+00
6+
0
0
7+0
0
30
+
0
0
31
+
0
0
59
+
5
0
60
+
0
0
6
1
+
0
0
8
0
3
+
0
0
804
+
0
0
80
5
+
0
0
80
0
+
0
0
70
1
+
0
0
70
2
+
0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
BRONSON WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 1+00 TO 7+00
71
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-2
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
BRONSON WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 7+00 TO 13+00 72
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-3
1
3
+
0
0
14+
0
0
15+00
16+00
17+00
18+00
19
+
0
0
50
+
0
0
5
1
+
0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
BRONSON WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 13+00 TO 19+50
73
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-4
20+00
21+00
22+00
45
+
0
0
46
+
0
0
47
+
0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+00
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+
0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+
0
0
35+0
0
36+00
37+00
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+00
47+00
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+00
54+00
55+00
56+
0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+
0
0
84+0
0
85+0
0
86+0
0
87+0
0
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C4
7
800+0
0
801+00
802+00
803+00
804+
0
0
805+00
806+0
0
700+00
701+00
702+00
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
BRONSON WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 19+50 TO 22+50
74
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-5
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
GRANDEY WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 38+00 TO 44+50
75
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-6
32
+
0
0
33
+
0
0
34+0
0
35+00
36
+
0
0
3
7
+
0
0
3
8
+
0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
GRANDEY WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 31+50 TO 38+50
76
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-7
61+00
63+0
0
64+0
0
65+00
66+00
67+00
62+00
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
WINDSOR WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 61+00 TO 67+00
77
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-8
67+00
68+00
69+0
0
70+00
71+00
72
+
0
0
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
WINDSOR WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 67+00 TO 72+50
78
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-9
88
+
0
1
84+00
85+0086+00
87+00
88+0
0
73+
0
0
74+
0
0
75
+
0
0
C47
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
WINDSOR WAY NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 72+50 TO 76+00
79
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-10
80+00
81+00
82+00
8
3
+
0
0
8
4
+
0
0
C46
C47
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
WINDSOR PL NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 80+50 TO 84+00
80
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-11
5
1
+
0
0
5
2
+
0
0
53
+
0
0
54+00
55
+
0
0
56+0
0
5
7
+
0
0
79
+
8
0
80
+
0
0
C39
C40
1+00
2+00
3+00
4+00
5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
13+00
14+00
15+0
0
16+0
0
17+0
0
18+0
0
19+0020+0021+0022+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
34+0
0
35+
0
0
36+0
0
37+0
0
38+00
39+00
40+00
41+00
42+00
43+00
44+00
45+0
0
46+0
0
47+0
0
50+00 51+00
52+00
53+0
0
54+0
0
55+00
56+0
0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00 82+00
83+0
0
84+
0
0
85+00
86+00
87+00
88+0
0
75+76
59+50
60+00
61+00
63+00
64+00
65+00
66+00
67+00
68+00
69+00
70+00
71+00
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
C39
C40
C46
C47
800+00
801+00
802+00
803+0
0
804+00
805+0
0
806+00
700+00
701+00
702+0
0
702+
9
0
62+00
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
BRONSON PL NE
RESTORATION PLAN STA 51+00 TO 57+00
81
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-12
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
T:
\
A
c
t
i
v
e
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
s
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
U
t
i
l
i
t
y
(
R
e
n
t
o
n
)
2
0
2
2
-
0
7
0
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
D
e
l
i
v
e
r
a
b
l
e
s
\
2
0
2
4
-
0
3
-
0
1
1
0
0
%
,
I
F
B
S
u
b
m
i
t
t
a
l
-
W
o
r
k
i
n
g
\
C
A
D
\
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
M
a
s
t
e
r
R
e
s
t
o
r
a
t
i
o
n
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR OF:
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
Transportation Planning | Design | Traffic Impact & Operations
11400 SE 8th Street, Suite 200, Bellevue, WA 98004 | Office (425) 889-6747
Transportation Engineering NorthWest
Project Contact: Brenda Velazquez Lopez
Phone: 206-773-5386
TENW
PROJECT #: 2022-070 86
1:20
ISSUED FOR BID 03-2024EMS EMS
03-08-2024
DRIVEWAY DETAILS
82
BVL/DVB
DVB
BVL
EMS
R-13
APPENDIX A
OPERATIONS AND MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-1
APPENDIX A
MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR
STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE
BMPS
This appendix contains the maintenance requirements for the following typical stormwater flow control
and water quality facilities and on-site BMPs (ctrl/click the title to follow the link):
No. 1 – Detention Ponds
No. 2 – Infiltration Facilities
No. 3 – Detention Tanks and Vaults
No. 4 – Control Structure/Flow Restrictor
No. 5 – Catch Basins and Manholes
No. 6 – Conveyance Pipes and Ditches
No. 7 – Debris Barriers (e.g., trash racks)
No. 8 – Energy Dissipaters
No. 9 – Fencing
No. 10 – Gates/Bollards/Access Barriers
No. 11 – Grounds (landscaping)
No. 12 – Access Roads
No. 13 – Basic Bioswale (grass)
No. 14 – Wet Bioswale
No. 15 – Filter Strip
No. 16 – Wetpond
No. 17 – Wetvault
No. 18 – Stormwater Wetland
No. 19 – Sand Filter Pond
No. 20 – Sand Filter Vault
No. 21 – Proprietary Facility Cartridge Filter Systems
No. 22 – Baffle Oil/Water Separator
No. 23 – Coalescing Plate Oil/Water Separator
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-2
No. 24 – Catch Basin Insert (not allowed in the city for oil control)
No. 25 – Drywell BMP
No. 26 – Gravel Filled Infiltration Trench BMP
No. 27 – Gravel Filled Dispersion Trench BMP
No. 28 – Native Vegetated Surface/Native Vegetated Landscape BMP
No. 29 – Perforated Pipe Connections BMP
No. 30 – Permeable Pavement BMP
No. 31 – Bioretention BMP
No. 32 – RainWater Harvesting BMP
No. 33 – Rock Pad BMP
No. 34 – Sheet Flow BMP
No. 35 – Splash Block BMP
No. 36 – Vegetated Roof BMP
No. 37 – Rain Garden BMP
No. 38 – Soil Amendment BMP
No. 39 – Retained Trees
No. 40 – Filterra System
No. 41 – Compost Amended Vegetated Filter Strip (CAVFS)
No. 42 – Media Filter Drain (MFD)
No. 43 – Compost-Amended Biofiltration Swale
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-10
NO. 5 – CATCH BASINS AND MANHOLES
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Structure Sediment
accumulation
Sediment exceeds 60% of the depth from
the bottom of the catch basin to the invert
of the lowest pipe into or out of the catch
basin or is within 6 inches of the invert of
the lowest pipe into or out of the catch
basin.
Sump of catch basin contains no sediment.
Trash and debris Trash or debris of more than ½ cubic foot
which is located immediately in front of the
catch basin opening or is blocking capacity
of the catch basin by more than 10%.
No Trash or debris blocking or potentially
blocking entrance to catch basin.
Trash or debris in the catch basin that
exceeds 1/3 the depth from the bottom of
basin to invert the lowest pipe into or out of
the basin.
No trash or debris in the catch basin.
Dead animals or vegetation that could
generate odors that could cause
complaints or dangerous gases (e.g.,
methane).
No dead animals or vegetation present
within catch basin.
Deposits of garbage exceeding 1 cubic
foot in volume.
No condition present which would attract or
support the breeding of insects or rodents.
Damage to frame
and/or top slab
Corner of frame extends more than ¾ inch
past curb face into the street (If
applicable).
Frame is even with curb.
Top slab has holes larger than 2 square
inches or cracks wider than ¼ inch.
Top slab is free of holes and cracks.
Frame not sitting flush on top slab, i.e.,
separation of more than ¾ inch of the
frame from the top slab.
Frame is sitting flush on top slab.
Cracks in walls or
bottom
Cracks wider than ½ inch and longer than
3 feet, any evidence of soil particles
entering catch basin through cracks, or
maintenance person judges that catch
basin is unsound.
Catch basin is sealed and is structurally
sound.
Cracks wider than ½ inch and longer than
1 foot at the joint of any inlet/outlet pipe or
any evidence of soil particles entering
catch basin through cracks.
No cracks more than 1/4 inch wide at the
joint of inlet/outlet pipe.
Settlement/
misalignment
Catch basin has settled more than 1 inch
or has rotated more than 2 inches out of
alignment.
Basin replaced or repaired to design
standards.
Damaged pipe joints Cracks wider than ½-inch at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes or any evidence of soil
entering the catch basin at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes.
No cracks more than ¼-inch wide at the
joint of inlet/outlet pipes.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Inlet/Outlet Pipe Sediment
accumulation
Sediment filling 20% or more of the pipe. Inlet/outlet pipes clear of sediment.
Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated in
inlet/outlet pipes (includes floatables and
non-floatables).
No trash or debris in pipes.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-11
NO. 5 – CATCH BASINS AND MANHOLES
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Inlet/Outlet Pipe
(cont.)
Damaged inlet/outlet
pipe
Cracks wider than ½-inch at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes or any evidence of soil
entering at the joints of the inlet/outlet
pipes.
No cracks more than ¼-inch wide at the
joint of the inlet/outlet pipe.
Metal Grates
(Catch Basins)
Unsafe grate opening Grate with opening wider than 7/8 inch. Grate opening meets design standards.
Trash and debris Trash and debris that is blocking more
than 20% of grate surface.
Grate free of trash and debris.
Damaged or missing
grate
Grate missing or broken member(s) of the
grate. Any open structure requires
urgent maintenance.
Grate is in place and meets design
standards.
Manhole Cover/Lid Cover/lid not in place Cover/lid is missing or only partially in
place. Any open structure requires
urgent maintenance.
Cover/lid protects opening to structure.
Locking mechanism
not working
Mechanism cannot be opened by one
maintenance person with proper tools.
Bolts cannot be seated. Self-locking
cover/lid does not work.
Mechanism opens with proper tools.
Cover/lid difficult to
remove
One maintenance person cannot remove
cover/lid after applying 80 lbs. of lift.
Cover/lid can be removed and reinstalled
by one maintenance person.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-12
NO. 6 – CONVEYANCE PIPES AND DITCHES
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Pipes Sediment & debris
accumulation
Accumulated sediment or debris that
exceeds 20% of the diameter of the pipe.
Water flows freely through pipes.
Vegetation/root
growth in pipe
Vegetation/roots that reduce free
movement of water through pipes.
Water flows freely through pipes.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Damage to protective
coating or corrosion
Protective coating is damaged; rust or
corrosion is weakening the structural
integrity of any part of pipe.
Pipe repaired or replaced.
Damaged pipes Any dent that decreases the cross section
area of pipe by more than 20% or is
determined to have weakened structural
integrity of the pipe.
Pipe repaired or replaced.
Ditches Trash and debris Trash and debris exceeds 1 cubic foot per
1,000 square feet of ditch and slopes.
Trash and debris cleared from ditches.
Sediment
accumulation
Accumulated sediment that exceeds 20%
of the design depth.
Ditch cleaned/flushed of all sediment and
debris so that it matches design.
Noxious weeds Any noxious or nuisance vegetation which
may constitute a hazard to City personnel
or the public.
Noxious and nuisance vegetation removed
according to applicable regulations. No
danger of noxious vegetation where City
personnel or the public might normally be.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Excessive vegetation
growth
Vegetation that reduces free movement of
water through ditches.
Water flows freely through ditches.
Erosion damage to
slopes
Any erosion observed on a ditch slope. Slopes are not eroding.
Rock lining out of
place or missing (If
applicable)
One layer or less of rock exists above
native soil area 5 square feet or more, any
exposed native soil.
Replace rocks to design standards.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-13
NO. 7 – DEBRIS BARRIERS (E.G., TRASH RACKS)
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED.
Site Trash and debris Trash or debris plugging more than 20% of
the area of the barrier.
Barrier clear to receive capacity flow.
Sediment
accumulation
Sediment accumulation of greater than
20% of the area of the barrier
Barrier clear to receive capacity flow.
Structure Cracked, broken, or
loose pipe or structure
Structure which bars attached to is
damaged – pipe is loose or cracked or
concrete structure is cracked, broken, or
loose.
Structure barrier attached to is sound.
Bars Incorrect bar spacing Bar spacing exceeds 6 inches. Bars have at most 6 inches spacing.
Damaged or missing
bars
Bars are bent out of shape more than 3
inches.
Bars in place with no bends more than ¾
inch.
Bars are missing or entire barrier missing. Bars in place according to design.
Bars are loose and rust is causing 50%
deterioration to any part of barrier.
Repair or replace barrier to design
standards.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-14
NO. 8 – ENERGY DISSIPATERS
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED.
Site Trash and debris Trash and/or debris accumulation. Dissipater clear of trash and/or debris.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Rock Pad Missing or moved
rock
Only one layer of rock exists above native
soil in area five square feet or larger or any
exposure of native soil.
Rock pad prevents erosion.
Dispersion Trench Pipe plugged with
sediment
Accumulated sediment that exceeds 20%
of the design depth.
Pipe cleaned/flushed so that it matches
design.
Not discharging water
properly
Visual evidence of water discharging at
concentrated points along trench (normal
condition is a “sheet flow” of water along
trench).
Water discharges from feature by sheet
flow.
Perforations plugged Over 1/4 of perforations in pipe are
plugged with debris or sediment.
Perforations freely discharge flow.
Water flows out top of
“distributor” catch
basin.
Water flows out of distributor catch basin
during any storm less than the design
storm.
No flow discharges from distributor catch
basin.
Receiving area over-
saturated
Water in receiving area is causing or has
potential of causing landslide problems.
No danger of landslides.
Gabions Damaged mesh Mesh of gabion broken, twisted or
deformed so structure is weakened or rock
may fall out.
Mesh is intact, no rock missing.
Corroded mesh Gabion mesh shows corrosion through
more than ¼ of its gage.
All gabion mesh capable of containing rock
and retaining designed form.
Collapsed or
deformed baskets
Gabion basket shape deformed due to any
cause.
All gabion baskets intact, structure stands
as designed.
Missing rock Any rock missing that could cause gabion
to loose structural integrity.
No rock missing.
Manhole/Chamber Worn or damaged
post, baffles or side of
chamber
Structure dissipating flow deteriorates to ½
or original size or any concentrated worn
spot exceeding one square foot which
would make structure unsound.
Structure is in no danger of failing.
Damage to wall,
frame, bottom, and/or
top slab
Cracks wider than ½-inch or any evidence
of soil entering the structure through
cracks, or maintenance inspection
personnel determines that the structure is
not structurally sound.
Manhole/chamber is sealed and
structurally sound.
Damaged pipe joints Cracks wider than ½-inch at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes or any evidence of soil
entering the structure at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes.
No soil or water enters and no water
discharges at the joint of inlet/outlet pipes.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-17
NO. 11 – GROUNDS (LANDSCAPING)
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Any trash and debris which exceed 1 cubic
foot per 1,000 square feet (this is about
equal to the amount of trash it would take
to fill up one standard size office garbage
can). In general, there should be no visual
evidence of dumping.
Trash and debris cleared from site.
Noxious weeds Any noxious or nuisance vegetation which
may constitute a hazard to City personnel
or the public.
Noxious and nuisance vegetation removed
according to applicable regulations. No
danger of noxious vegetation where City
personnel or the public might normally be.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Excessive growth of
grass/groundcover
Grass or groundcover exceeds 18 inches
in height.
Grass or groundcover mowed to a height
no greater than 6 inches.
Trees and Shrubs Hazard tree identified Any tree or limb of a tree identified as
having a potential to fall and cause
property damage or threaten human life. A
hazard tree identified by a qualified
arborist must be removed as soon as
possible.
No hazard trees in facility.
Damaged tree or
shrub identified
Limbs or parts of trees or shrubs that are
split or broken which affect more than 25%
of the total foliage of the tree or shrub.
Trees and shrubs with less than 5% of total
foliage with split or broken limbs.
Trees or shrubs that have been blown
down or knocked over.
No blown down vegetation or knocked over
vegetation. Trees or shrubs free of injury.
Trees or shrubs which are not adequately
supported or are leaning over, causing
exposure of the roots.
Tree or shrub in place and adequately
supported; dead or diseased trees
removed.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-19
NO. 13 – BASIC BIOSWALE (GRASS)
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Any trash and/or debris accumulated on
the bioswale site.
No trash or debris on the bioswale site.
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Swale Section Sediment
accumulation
Sediment depth exceeds 2 inches in 10%
of the swale treatment area.
No sediment deposits in grass treatment
area of the bioswale.
Sediment inhibits grass growth over 10%
of swale length.
Grass growth not inhibited by sediment.
Sediment inhibits even spreading of flow. Flow spreads evenly through swale
Erosion/scouring Eroded or scoured swale bottom due to
channelization or high flows.
No eroded or scoured areas in bioswale.
Cause of erosion or scour addressed.
Poor vegetation
coverage
Grass is sparse or bare or eroded patches
occur in more than 10% of the swale
bottom.
Swale has no bare spots and grass is thick
and healthy.
Excessive vegetation
growth
Grass excessively tall (greater than 10
inches), grass is thin or nuisance weeds
and other vegetation have taken over.
Grass is between 3 and 4 inches tall, thick
and healthy. No nuisance vegetation
present.
Excessive shade Grass growth is poor because sunlight
does not reach swale.
Healthy grass growth or swale converted
to a wet bioswale.
Constant baseflow Continuous flow through the swale, even
when it has been dry for weeks or an
eroded, muddy channel has formed in the
swale bottom.
Baseflow removed from swale by a low-
flow pea-gravel drain or bypassed around
the swale.
Standing water Water pools in the swale between storms
or does not drain freely.
Swale freely drains and there is no
standing water in swale between storms.
Channelization Flow concentrates and erodes channel
through swale.
No flow channels in swale.
Flow Spreader Concentrated flow Flow from spreader not uniformly
distributed across entire swale width.
Flows are spread evenly over entire swale
width.
Inlet/Outlet Pipe Sediment
accumulation
Sediment filling 20% or more of the pipe. Inlet/outlet pipes clear of sediment.
Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated in
inlet/outlet pipes (includes floatables and
non-floatables).
No trash or debris in pipes.
Damaged inlet/outlet
pipe
Cracks wider than ½-inch at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes or any evidence of soil
entering at the joints of the inlet/outlet
pipes.
No cracks more than ¼-inch wide at the
joint of the inlet/outlet pipe.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-21
NO. 15 – FILTER STRIP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Any trash and debris accumulated on the
filter strip site.
Filter strip site free of any trash or debris
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries or
paint.
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Grass Strip Sediment
accumulation
Sediment accumulation on grass exceeds
2 inches depth.
No sediment deposits in treatment area.
Erosion/scouring Eroded or scoured swale bottom due to
channelization or high flows.
No eroded or scoured areas in bioswale.
Cause of erosion or scour addressed.
Excessive vegetation
growth
Grass excessively tall (greater than 10
inches), grass is thin or nuisance weeds
and other vegetation have taken over.
Grass is between 3 and 4 inches tall, thick
and healthy. No nuisance vegetation
present.
Poor vegetation
coverage and/or
nuisance vegetation
present
Grass has died out, become excessively
tall (greater than 10 inches) or nuisance
vegetation is taking over.
Grass is healthy, less than 9 inches high
and no nuisance vegetation present.
Flow Spreader Concentrated flow Flow from spreader not uniformly
distributed across entire swale width.
Flows are spread evenly over entire swale
width.
Inlet/Outlet Pipe Sediment
accumulation
Sediment filling 20% or more of the pipe. Inlet/outlet pipes clear of sediment.
Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated in
inlet/outlet pipes (includes floatables and
non-floatables).
No trash or debris in pipes.
Damaged inlet/outlet
pipe
Cracks wider than ½-inch at the joint of the
inlet/outlet pipes or any evidence of soil
entering at the joints of the inlet/outlet
pipes.
No cracks more than ¼-inch wide at the
joint of the inlet/outlet pipe.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-37
NO. 24 – CATCH BASIN INSERT (NOT ALLOWED IN THE CITY FOR OIL CONTROL)
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-40
NO. 28 – NATIVE VEGETATED SURFACE/NATIVE VEGETATED LANDSCAPE BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated on the
native vegetated surface/native vegetated
landscape site.
Native vegetated surface site free of any
trash or debris.
Vegetation Insufficient vegetation Less than two species each of native
trees, shrubs, and groundcover occur in
the design area.
A minimum of two species each of native
trees, shrubs, and groundcover is
established and healthy.
Poor vegetation
coverage
Less than 90% if the required vegetated
area has healthy growth.
A minimum of 90% of the required
vegetated area has healthy growth.
Undesirable
vegetation present
Weeds, blackberry, and other undesirable
plants are invading more than 10% of
vegetated area.
Less than 10% undesirable vegetation
occurs in the required native vegetated
surface area.
Vegetated Area Soil compaction Soil in the native vegetation area
compacted.
Less than 8% of native vegetation area is
compacted.
Insufficient vegetation Less than 3.5 square feet of native
vegetation area for every 1 square foot of
impervious surface.
A minimum of 3.5 square feet of native
vegetation area for every 1 square foot of
impervious surface.
Excess slope Slope of native vegetation area greater
than 15%.
Slope of native growth area does not
exceed 15%.
NO. 29 – PERFORATED PIPE CONNECTIONS BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Preventive Blocking, obstructions Debris or trash limiting flow into perforated
pipe system or outfall of BMP is plugged or
otherwise nonfunctioning.
Outfall of BMP is receiving designed flows
from perforated pipe connection.
Inflow Inflow impeded Inflow into the perforated pipe is partially or
fully blocked or altered to prevent flow from
getting into the pipe.
Inflow to the perforated pipe is unimpeded.
Pipe Trench Area Surface compacted Ground surface over the perforated pipe
trench is compacted or covered with
impermeable material.
Ground surface over the perforated pipe is
not compacted and free of any impervious
cover.
Outflow Outflow impeded Outflow from the perforated pipe into the
public drainage system is blocked.
Outflow to the public drainage system is
unimpeded.
Outfall Area Erosion or landslides Existence of the perforated pipe is causing
or exasperating erosion or landslides.
Perforated pipe system is sealed off and
an alternative BMP is implemented.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-43
NO. 32 – RAINWATER HARVESTING BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Preventive Insufficient storage
volume
No rain water in storage unit at the
beginning of the rain season.
Maximum storage available at the
beginning of the rain season (Oct. 1).
Collection Area Trash and debris Trash of debris on collection area may plug
filter system
Collection area clear of trash and debris.
Filter Restricted or plugged
filter
Filter is partially or fully plugged preventing
water from getting in to the storage unit.
Filter is allowing collection water into
storage unit.
NO. 33 – ROCK PAD BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated on rock pad
site.
Rock pad site free of any trash or debris.
Rock Pad Area Insufficient rock pad
size
Rock pad is not 2 feet by 3 feet by 6 inches
thick or as designed.
Rock pad is 2 feet by 3 feet by 6 inches
thick or as designed.
Vegetation growth Vegetation is seen growing in or through
rock pad.
No vegetation within rock pad area.
Rock Exposed soil Soil can be seen through the rock pad. Full thickness of the rock pad is in place,
no soil visible through rock pad.
NO. 34 – SHEET FLOW BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated on the
sheet flow site.
Sheet flow site free of any trash or debris.
Sheet flow area Erosion Soil erosion occurring in sheet flow zone. Soil erosion is not occurring and rills and
channels have been repaired.
Concentrated flow Sheet flow is not occurring in the sheet
flow zone.
Sheet flow area is regraded to provide
sheet flow.
NO. 35 – SPLASH BLOCK BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Site Trash and debris Trash and debris accumulated on the
splash block.
Splash block site free of any trash or
debris.
Splash Block Dislodged splash
block
Splash block moved from outlet of
downspout.
Splash block correctly positioned to catch
discharge from downspout.
Channeling Water coming off the splash block causing
erosion.
No erosion occurs from the splash block.
Downspout water
misdirected
Water coming from the downspout is not
discharging to the dispersal area.
Water is discharging normally to the
dispersal area.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
A-47
NO. 38 – SOIL AMENDMENT BMP
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Soil Media Unhealthy vegetation Vegetation not fully covering ground
surface or vegetation health is poor.
Yellowing: possible Nitrogen (N)
deficiency. Poor growth: possible
Phosphorous (P) deficiency. Poor
flowering, spotting or curled leaves, or
weak roots or stems: possible Potassium
(K) deficiency.
Plants are healthy and appropriate for site
conditions
Inadequate soil
nutrients and
structure
In the fall, return leaf fall and shredded
woody materials from the landscape to the
site when possible
Soil providing plant nutrients and structure
Excessive vegetation
growth
Grass becomes excessively tall (greater
than 10 inches); nuisance weeds and other
vegetation start to take over.
Healthy turf- “grasscycle” (mulch-mow or
leave the clippings) to build turf health
Weeds Preventive maintenance Avoid use of pesticides (bug and weed
killers), like “weed & feed,” which damage
the soil
Fertilizer needed Where fertilization is needed (mainly turf
and annual flower beds), a moderate
fertilization program should be used which
relies on compost, natural fertilizers or
slow-release synthetic balanced fertilizers
Integrated Pest Management (IPM)
protocols for fertilization followed
Bare spots Bare spots on soil No bare spots, area covered with
vegetation or mulch mixed into the
underlying soil.
Compaction Poor infiltration due to soil compaction
To remediate compaction, aerate
soil, till to at least 8-inch depth, or
further amend soil with compost and
re-till
If areas are turf, aerate compacted
areas and top dress them with 1/4 to
1/2 inch of compost to renovate them
If drainage is still slow, consider
investigating alternative causes (e.g.,
high wet season groundwater levels,
low permeability soils)
Also consider site use and protection
from compacting activities
No soil compaction
Poor infiltration Soils become waterlogged, do not appear
to be infiltrating.
Facility infiltrating properly
Erosion/Scouring Erosion Areas of potential erosion are visible Causes of erosion (e.g., concentrate flow
entering area, channelization of runoff)
identified and damaged area stabilized
(regrade, rock, vegetation, erosion control
matting).For deep channels or cuts (over 3
inches in ponding depth), temporary
erosion control measures in place until
permanent repairs can be made
Grass/Vegetation Unhealthy vegetation Less than 75% of planted vegetation is
healthy with a generally good appearance.
Healthy vegetation. Unhealthy plants
removed/replaced. Appropriate vegetation
planted in terms of exposure, soil and soil
moisture.
Noxious Weeds Noxious weeds Listed noxious vegetation is present (refer
to current County noxious weed list).
No noxious weeds present.
APPENDIX A MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS FOR STORMWATER FACILITIES AND ON-SITE BMPS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
A-48
NO. 39 – RETAINED TREES
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITIONS WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
Tree Dead or declining Dead, damaged, or declining Tree replaced per planting plan or
acceptable substitute
NO. 40 – FILTERRA SYSTEM
MAINTENANCE
COMPONENT
DEFECT OR
PROBLEM
CONDITION WHEN MAINTENANCE
IS NEEDED
RESULTS EXPECTED WHEN
MAINTENANCE IS PERFORMED
In addition to the specific maintenance criteria provided below, all manufacturer’s requirements shall be followed.
Facility – General
Requirements
Life cycle Once per year, except mulch and trash
removal twice per year
Facility is re-inspected and any needed
maintenance performed
Contaminants and
pollution
Any evidence of contaminants or pollution
such as oil, gasoline, concrete slurries, or
paint
Materials removed and disposed of
according to applicable regulations. Source
control BMPs implemented if appropriate.
No contaminants present other than a
surface oil film.
Inlet Excessive sediment or
trash accumulation
Accumulated sediments or trash impair free
flow of water into system
Inlet should be free of obstructions allowing
free distributed flow of water into system
Mulch Cover Trash and floatable
debris accumulation
Excessive trash and/or debris accumulation Minimal trash or other debris on mulch
cover. Mulch cover raked level.
“Ponding” of water on
mulch cover
“Ponding” in unit could be indicative of
clogging due to excessive fine sediment
accumulation or spill of petroleum oils
Stormwater should drain freely and evenly
through mulch cover
Proprietary Filter
Media/
Vegetation Substrate
“Ponding” of water on
mulch cover after
mulch cover has been
maintained
Excessive fine sediment passes the mulch
cover and clogs the filter media/vegetative
substrate
Stormwater should drain freely and evenly
through mulch cover. Replace substrate and
vegetation when needed
Vegetation Plants not growing or in
poor condition
Soil/mulch too wet, evidence of spill,
incorrect plant selection, pest infestation,
and/or vandalism to plants
Plants should be healthy and pest free
Media/mulch too dry Irrigation is required
Plants absent Plants absent Appropriate plants are present
Excessive plant growth Excessive plant growth inhibits facility
function or becomes a hazard for pedestrian
and vehicular circulation and safety
Pruning and/or thinning vegetation maintains
proper plant density. Appropriate plants are
present.
Structure Structure has visible
cracks
Cracks wider than ½ inch
Evidence of soil particles entering the
structure through the cracks
Structure is sealed and structurally sound
APPENDIX B
GEOTECHNICAL ENGINEERING REPORT
GEOTECHNICAL ENGINEERING
REPORT
Windsor Hills Utilities Improvements Project
(WTR-27-4186)
Prepared for: BHC Consultants, LLC
Project No. 210614 March 17, 2023 FINAL
e
a
r
t
h
w
a
t
e
r
+
ppeecc tt
C O N S U L T I N G
earth +w ater Aspect Consulting, LLC 710 2nd Avenue Suite 550 Seattle, WA 98104 206.328.7443 www.aspectconsulting.com
GEOTECHNICAL ENGINEERING
REPORT
Windsor Hills Utilities Improvements Project
(WTR-27-4186)
Prepared for: BHC Consultants, LLC
Project No. 210614 March 17, 2023 FINAL
Aspect Consulting, LLC
Henry H. Haselton, PE, PMP
Principal Geotechnical Engineer
hhaselton@aspectconsulting.com
Rory Kilkenny, PE
Senior Geotechnical Engineer
rkilkenny @aspectconsulting.com
Jane Gregg, PE
Project Geotechnical Engineer
jgregg@aspectconsulting.com
V:\210614 Windsor Hill Geotech Study - Renton\Deliverables\Stormwater Replacement Geotech Report\GER_Windsor Hills
Stormwater Replacement.docx
March 17, 2023
ASPECT CONSULTING
1 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
Contents
1 Introduction ..................................................................................................1
1.1 Background ................................................................................................ 1
1.2 Scope of Work ........................................................................................... 1
2 Site Conditions ............................................................................................3
2.1 Surface Conditions ..................................................................................... 3
2.2 Subsurface Conditions ............................................................................... 5
3 Geologic Hazard Assessment ....................................................................7
3.1 Landslide Hazards ..................................................................................... 7
3.2 Regulated Slopes ....................................................................................... 8
3.3 Erosion Hazard .......................................................................................... 8
3.4 Seismic Hazards ........................................................................................ 8
4 Geotechnical Engineering Conclusions .................................................. 10
4.1 Geologically Hazardous Area Considerations .......................................... 10
4.2 Stormwater Infiltration Capacity ............................................................... 10
4.3 Maintenance Hole Design Recommendations.......................................... 10
4.3.1 Allowable Bearing Pressure and Settlement ....................................... 10
4.3.2 Lateral Earth Pressures ...................................................................... 11
4.3.3 Groundwater Effects ........................................................................... 11
5 Construction Recommendations ............................................................. 12
5.1 Temporary Slopes .................................................................................... 12
5.2 Temporary Shoring .................................................................................. 12
5.3 Check Dams ............................................................................................ 13
5.4 Pipe Bedding ............................................................................................ 13
5.5 Subgrade Preparation .............................................................................. 14
5.6 Structural Fill and Compaction ................................................................. 14
5.7 Wet Weather Earthwork ........................................................................... 15
5.8 Trench and Pavement Restoration ........................................................... 15
5.9 Temporary & Permanent Erosion and Sediment Control.......................... 16
6 Recommendations for Continuing Geotechnical Services .................... 17
7 References ................................................................................................. 18
8 Limitations .................................................................................................. 19
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL ii
List of Figures
1 Site Location Map
2 Geologic Map
3 Site and Exploration Map
List of Appendices
A Report Limitations and Guidelines for Use
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 1
1 Introduction
Aspect Consulting, LLC (Aspect) prepared this report for BHC Consultants, LLC (BHC)
to support the Critical Areas Exemption permitting process for the Windsor Hills Water
Quality Retrofit Project (Project) within the City of Renton (City). The purpose of this
Project is to replace aging stormwater and water lines within the Windsor Hills
neighborhood (Figure 1). This report includes our evaluation of potential impacts to the
critical areas and our geotechnical engineering recommendations for the Project.
1.1 Background
We understand the Project will consist of replacing below-grade stormwater and water
lines within streets of the Windsor Hills neighborhood. While the project is located
within several mapped critical areas including high erosion hazards, high landslide
hazards, and regulated slopes, the utility replacements will occur within the paved Rights-
of-Way (ROWs), apart from the following stormwater features (BHC, 2023):
• Bird cage structures and buried stormwater piping between 514 & 550 Grandey Way
NE and 472 & 476 Bronson Way NE. Excavation depths in these areas are expected
to be 6 feet below ground surface (bgs) or less.
• A shallow quarry spall ditch on a Puget Sound Energy (PSE) parcel near 456
Bronson Way NE.
Renton Municipal Code (RMC) 4-3-050 for critical areas applies to steep slopes,
landslide hazards, erosion hazards, and seismic hazards and/or on sites within fifty feet of
these hazards (City of Renton, 2022a). Because the Site is within 50 feet of these types of
critical areas, this report will address whether the proposed Project is consistent with the
RMC critical area regulations.
1.2 Scope of Work
Our scope of work included a critical area hazard screening evaluation, Site
reconnaissance, and development of this geotechnical engineering report. The screening
evaluation included a review of mapped geologic units and hazards, review of existing
LiDAR topographic data for indications of geologic hazards, and review of available
geotechnical data for the Project area. The Site reconnaissance included limited
subsurface investigations utilizing hand tools to verify the mapped geologic conditions.
Using data from the screening evaluation and reconnaissance we evaluated potential
impacts to critical areas at the Site. This geotechnical engineering report includes the
following:
• Description of the Site and our understanding of the Project
• Generalized characteristics of subsurface conditions based on our review of
existing data and reconnaissance
• Identification of relevant geologic hazards and critical areas
ASPECT CONSULTING
2 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
• Identification of appropriate methods to mitigate Project impacts to geologic
hazards
• Recommendations as to whether the Project complies with the criteria listed in
RMC Section 4-3-050.J.1 and whether the proposed Project is consistent with
critical area regulations listed in RMC 4-3-050.A (City of Renton, 2022a)
• Conclusions and recommendations relating to the feasibility of the Project
We performed a supplemental Site reconnaissance on March 3, 2023, to evaluate the
surface conditions outside of ROWs (between 514 & 550 Grandey Way NE, between 472
& 476 Bronson Way NE, adjacent 456 Bronson Way NE).
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 3
2 Site Conditions
This section presents the Site conditions, including surface conditions, critical area
mapping, geologic setting, and subsurface conditions encountered in our reconnaissance.
This information provides context for the discussion of types and distribution of geologic
soil units and a basis for our geotechnical engineering recommendations.
2.1 Surface Conditions
The Site is in a residential neighborhood in Renton between Interstate-405 to the west
and Windsor Hills Park to the east (Figure 1). The neighborhood includes five paved
residential City ROWs: Windsor Way NE, Windsor Place NE, Grandey Way NE,
Bronson Way NE, and Bronson Place NE. There are at least 140 residential parcels
within the neighborhood, one public park parcel, and four parcels owned by PSE. The
PSE parcels extend continuously from NE 4th St to Sunset Blvd NE except where
intersected by the residential ROWs (Figure 2). These PSE parcels are generally inclined
greater than 15 percent, contain overhead powerlines, and are vegetated with a
combination of grass, brush, and immature trees.
Elevations within the neighborhood range from 250 feet 1 at the eastern entrance of
Windsor Way NE to 110 feet at the western entrance of Bronson Way NE. The parcels
range in inclination from less than 15 percent to greater than 40 percent as mapped by the
City (City of Renton, 2022b). The PSE parcels are generally sloped greater than 15
percent with some areas inclined up to 40 percent. The neighbor ROWs are more
gradually sloped than the parcels, with typical inclinations of less than 15 percent. There
are five ROW sections with inclinations between 15 and 25 percent (BHC, 2023). We did
not observe evidence of slope instability, such as scarps or skin slides, during our Site
reconnaissance.
An existing ditch lined with stones and concrete debris runs between 514 & 550 Grandey
Way NE and drains into a culvert beneath Grandey Way NE. The ditch is 2.5 to 5 feet
wide, 2 to 4 feet deep, 80 feet long, and has a roughly 5 percent slope. An existing 4- to
6-foot-high retaining wall runs along the eastern property boundaries (Photograph 1). A
proposed bird cage overflow structure will convey stormwater from an existing storm
drain above the existing wall to a proposed storm drain that will replace the existing ditch
(BHC, 2023). The existing wall should be protected during installation of the overflow
structure installation by carefully excavating the area and providing bracing as needed.
An existing concrete lined ditch runs between 472 & 476 Bronson Way NE and drains
into a culvert underneath Bronson Way NE (Photograph 2). The ditch is approximately 6-
to 12-inches deep, 2 feet wide, 120 feet long, and has roughly a 2 percent slope. The ditch
will be replaced with a buried stormwater pipe that flows from a proposed birdcage
overflow structure at the southeast property boundaries (BHC, 2023).
1 All elevations cited in this report are reference to the North American Vertical Datum of 1988
(NAVD88).
ASPECT CONSULTING
4 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
Photograph 1. Existing retaining wall and ditch between 514 & 550 Grandey Way NE,
looking east.
Photograph 2. Concrete lined ditch between 472 and 476 Bronson Way NE, looking west.
A 1- to 3-foot-deep ditch with a 10 percent inclination is located on the PSE parcel south
of 456 Bronson Way NE. The ditch flows from southeast to northwest, connecting
stormwater drainage pipes from neighboring properties to an existing catch basin
adjacent to Bronson Way NE (BHC, 2023). The eastern side of the ditch is grassed and
the western side of the ditch is covered in thick blackberry bushes (Photograph 3). This
ditch will be improved by expanding its width and depth and lining it with quarry spalls.
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 5
Photograph 3. Existing ditch on a PSE parcel, looking southeast.
2.2 Subsurface Conditions
The Site is located at the western boundary of the Puget Lowland. The Puget Lowland is
a complex tectonic environment and an area of tectonic subsidence flanked by two
mountain ranges—the Cascades to the east, and the Olympics to the west. The sediments
within the Puget Lowland result from repeated cycles of glacial and non-glacial
deposition and erosion. During non-glacial cycles, the area was dominated by lowland
forests and broad river valleys. During glacial cycles, ice sheets up to 3,000 feet thick
occupied the Puget Lowland and surrounding areas and carved out the deep marine
waterways and river valleys and sculpted the uplands. Deposits from these glacial and
non-glacial cycles are present in the subsurface of the Project vicinity.
Geologic mapping (Schuster, J.E., et. al., 2015 and Mullineaux, D.R., 1965) indicates that
the Site is predominantly underlain by Vashon recessional outwash except in the northern
most section of Bronson Way NE, which is underlain by Vashon glacial till (Figure 3).
The recessional outwash is described as variably sorted, loose to compact sand and gravel
deposited by glacial meltwater. Vashon till is described as a highly compact, low-
permeability unsorted mixture of clay, silt, sand, gravel, cobbles, and boulders.
Aspect completed three shallow hand explorations at the Site on May 26, 2022 (AHA-01
to AHA-03), and an additional three hand explorations on March 1, 2023 (AHA-04 to
AHA-06). The locations of our explorations are shown on Figure 2. AHA-01 to AHA-03
extended 2 feet below ground surface and were used to verify that the Site is surficially
underlain by recessional outwash on the PSE Parcels. AHA-04, AHA-05 and AHA-06
were extended to 4.5 feet, 4.25 feet and 2 feet, respectively. The soil units encountered at
the Site are fill and recessional outwash deposits and are described below:
ASPECT CONSULTING
6 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
• Recessional outwash deposits were encountered underneath the topsoil at AHA-
04 and AHA-06 and mainly consisted of medium dense to dense, moist to wet,
brown silty sand with gravel (SM) and medium dense to dense, wet, brown silty
gravel with sand (GM).
• Up to 3 feet of fill was encountered in AHA-05 and mainly consisted of loose,
moist to wet, brown silty sand with variable amounts of gravel (SM), and soft,
wet, dark gray to black organic silt with sand deposits (OL). Recessional outwash
deposits were encountered beneath the fill and consisted of medium dense, wet,
brown silty sand with gravel.
• Although not encountered, the recessional outwash is likely underlain by Vashon
till at varying depths throughout the Site.
Groundwater seepage was not encountered in AHA-01 to AHA-03 and AHA-06;
however, it is possible that groundwater may develop locally within the recessional
outwash over the Vashon till. Groundwater was encountered at 2.5 feet and 1.25 feet bgs
in AHA-04 and AHA-05, respectively. Groundwater levels will vary by location, local
precipitation, local subsurface conditions, and other factors.
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 7
3 Geologic Hazard Assessment
The City of Renton Map Viewer (COR Maps) was reviewed for potential Critical Areas
at the Site that consider aquifer protection area zones, coal mines, erosion hazards, flood
zones, landslides, regulated slopes and shorelines, wetlands, and seismic hazards (City of
Renton, 2022b). Specific critical areas that are regulated by RMC Section 4-3-050
include flood hazard areas, geologic hazard areas, habitat conservation areas, streams and
lakes, wellhead protection areas, and wetlands (City of Renton, 2022a).
Based on the City’s data and Site survey (BHC, 2023), the Site is in two geologic hazard
areas:
• High landslide hazard potential
• High erosion hazard
• Portions of residential and public parcels outside of the work area are mapped
within City Regulated Slopes classified as sensitive slopes (> 25 to ≤ 40 percent)
and protected slopes (> 40 to ≤ 90 percent)
• Several small portions of the work area have slopes > 15 to ≤ 25 percent shown
on COR Maps (Figure 3). These areas are not considered geologically hazardous
areas by RMC Section 4-3-050
Work will be performed in areas mapped with high landside and erosion hazard potential,
but outside of sensitive and protected slopes. We understand that the critical areas listed
above do not have critical area buffers and do not require structure setbacks except for
protected slope areas. The structure setback from protected slopes is 15 feet (City of
Renton, 2022a).
The geologic hazards are discussed in greater detail in the following sections with respect
to the Project work.
3.1 Landslide Hazards
The Site is mapped with high landslide hazard potential by the City of Renton (City of
Renton, 2022a). The City defines high landslide hazards as areas with slopes greater than
40 percent. We reviewed aerial photographs of the Site area from 1936 through 2021
(Google, 2022 and NETR, 2022) and did not observe evidence of recent landslides.
Two types of landslides are common on interior steep slopes in the Puget Sound area:
deep-seated rotational landslides and surficial landslides (also known as shallow flows or
colluvial landslides; Varnes, 1978). Landslides may be triggered by natural events, such
as extended, heavy precipitation, freeze-thaw cycles, or an earthquake, or by human
factors, such as broken water pipes or improperly managed stormwater flow.
Evidence of large-scale rotational or surficial colluvial activity was not observed at the
Site or documented by the published landslide studies of the area. In our opinion, the Site
is currently stable, and the proposed earthwork for utilities improvements (BHC, 2023)
ASPECT CONSULTING
8 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
will not impact slope stability at the Site. Construction measures that should be
implemented to ensure excavation safety are described in the subsequent sections.
3.2 Regulated Slopes
As described above and shown in Figure 2, the Site has areas mapped within regulated,
sensitive and protected slopes (City of Renton, 2022a). Sensitive slopes are hillsides
characterized by an average slope of 25 percent to less than 40 percent as identified by
the City. Protected slopes are hillside characterized by an average slope of 40 percent or
greater and having a minimum vertical rise of 15 feet. Required structure setbacks from
sensitive and protected slopes are 0 feet and 15 feet, respectively.
No work is planned within the sensitive or protected slope areas; however, trenching will
be completed within 15 feet of the toe of the protected slope located along the western
bend of Grandey Way NE and the southern bend of Windsor Place NE (Figure 3). The
Preliminary 60% Review Set (BHC, 2023) indicates that the slopes near the proposed
utility work are no steeper than 40 percent and are supported by retaining walls along
some residential property boundaries. In our opinion, the limited utility trenching
performed within the ROWs will not impact the stability of this protected slope provided
the construction recommendations within this report are followed during the work.
3.3 Erosion Hazard
Most of the Site is mapped as an area with high erosion potential by the City of Renton
(City of Renton, 2022a). High erosion hazards are areas with soils characterized by the
Natural Resource Conservation Service (formerly U.S. Soil Conservation Service) as
having severe or very severe erosion potential, and a slope more than 15 percent.
Residential parcels are vegetated with grass and occasional young to mature trees. The
PSE parcels are vegetated with dense brush and some young to mature trees. Roadways
are paved and will be retrofitted with a stormwater collection system as part of the
Project. It is our opinion that the erosion risk at the Site will not increase during or after
the Project work; rather, the erosion risk may decrease because stormwater runoff will be
better managed.
3.4 Seismic Hazards
The Site is located within the Puget Lowland physiographic province, an area of active
seismicity that is subject to earthquakes on shallow crustal faults and deeper subduction
zone earthquakes. The Site is about 2 miles south of the Seattle Fault Zone, which
consists of shallow crustal tectonic structures (Gower et al., 1985). The Site is also within
the zone of strong ground shaking from earthquakes associated with the Cascadia
Subduction Zone (CSZ). Subduction-zone earthquakes occur due to rupture between the
subducting oceanic plate and the overlying continental plate. Deep intraslab earthquakes,
which occur from tensional rupture of the sinking oceanic plate, are associated with the
CSZ.
Due to the proximity of the Site to the mapped fault, the potential for surficial ground
rupture at the Site is considered low during the expected life of the Project.
Liquefaction occurs when loose, saturated, and relatively cohesionless soil deposits
temporarily lose strength from seismic shaking. The primary factors controlling the onset
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 9
of liquefaction include intensity and duration of strong ground motion, characteristics of
subsurface soil, in situ stress conditions, and the depth to groundwater. The Washington
Department of Natural Resources (DNR) maps the Site as having very low liquefaction
susceptibility (Palmer et al., 1992). Given the relative density and geologic origin of the
soils at the Site, we do not consider liquefaction to be a significant hazard for the Project.
ASPECT CONSULTING
10 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
4 Geotechnical Engineering Conclusions
Based on our geotechnical evaluation of the Site, the Project is feasible from a
geotechnical perspective—provided the recommendations contained here are properly
incorporated into the Project planning, concept development, design, and construction.
Design considerations and recommendations for infiltration capacity, slope stability, and
maintenance holes are presented in the following sections. Additional engineering
analyses and evaluations may be required to support final design of the Project.
4.1 Geologically Hazardous Area Considerations
Based on our geotechnical characterization of the Site and our understanding of the
Project, it is our opinion that the Project will not adversely affect the stability of the Site
and the nearby geologic hazard areas. The Site conditions meet the criteria for a Buffer
Reduction per RMC Section 4-3-050G. Furthermore, the Project can be built within the
15-foot-buffer from the base of the protected slope without adversely impacting the
slope.
Provided the Project implements standard erosion control best management practices
(BMPs) during and following construction, there is very little risk of increasing erosion
as a result of the Project.
4.2 Stormwater Infiltration Capacity
The City asked Aspect to consider stormwater infiltration capacity of the PSE parcels at
the Site. Infiltration is not recommended within slopes exceeding an inclination of 15
percent (City of Renton, 2022c), which applies to most of the areas on the PSE parcels.
Based on available mapping data (Figure 3) and our hand explorations (Figure 2), most of
the Site is underlain by recessional outwash. If slope inclinations are less than 15 percent,
recessional outwash is typically a suitable infiltration receptor. Infiltration is not likely to
be feasible within Vashon till, which may be present on the northernmost portions of the
Site (Figure 3) or below the recessional outwash. If necessary, best management practice
investigations, such as pilot infiltration testing, should be performed at Site-specific
locations to verify infiltration feasibility.
4.3 Maintenance Hole Design Recommendations
Our general recommendations for the design of the manholes are presented below.
4.3.1 Allowable Bearing Pressure and Settlement
The base of the maintenance holes should be founded in relatively undisturbed
recessional outwash or glacial till. We anticipate the dead load of the manholes will not
be significantly greater than the weight of the soil that is excavated; therefore, bearing
capacity will not be a significant design issue. For the purposes of evaluation and design,
an allowable bearing pressure of 1,500 psf may be used for maintenance holes founded
atop undisturbed recessional outwash, glacial till or properly compacted structural fill.
Assuming the foundation subgrade is properly prepared and accomplished as
recommended herein, we estimate total settlement of less than about 1 inch. We
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 11
anticipate that the majority of the estimated settlement will occur during construction as
the loads are applied. Maintenance holes may also exhibit some of the anticipated
settlement after construction as the structure is initially loaded with water and drained.
This cyclic loading may result in minor structure rebound and re-settlement.
4.3.2 Lateral Earth Pressures
Permanent lateral earth pressures on subsurface structure walls will be a function of the
shear strength of structural backfill and intact native soil. We recommend that subsurface
walls be designed to support an at-rest equivalent fluid pressure of 60 pounds per cubic
foot (pcf), plus a uniform rectangular horizontal live load surcharge of 100 psf. In our
opinion, the below-grade maintenance holes do not need to be designed for incremental
seismic loading. The buried structure will be restrained by the surrounding ground and
will not be subject to vibratory amplification like a bridge or building.
4.3.3 Groundwater Effects
It is likely that water will saturate the soils surrounding the proposed maintenance holes
during the structures’ design life. Below-grade structures are subjected to potential
upward buoyancy forces when the groundwater level around the structure is higher than
the base of the structure. Maintenance holes should be designed to resist upward buoyant
forces and to prevent possible heave and cracking of the structure base. Based on
standard maintenance hole sizes and the anticipated maintenance hole depths, we do not
anticipate that maintenance hole uplift will be an issue for this Project.
ASPECT CONSULTING
12 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
5 Construction Recommendations
We understand that the utility trenching for the proposed stormwater and water line
construction will be shallow and can be constructed using conventional open-trench
methods. Deeper excavations for piping or manhole installation may require temporary
sloping or shoring. General recommendations for design and implementation of trench
shoring systems are presented below.
The temporary excavation for the birdcage structure between 514 & 550 Grandey Way
NE is adjacent an existing concrete wall that will be protected during excavation. The
contractor should carefully excavate this area and be prepared to install temporary
bracing, such as ecology blocks, for additional support.
Detailed recommendations for open-trench pipeline construction and generalized
recommendations for Site earthwork, erosion control, and pavement restoration are
presented in this Section.
5.1 Temporary Slopes
Maintenance of safe working conditions, including temporary excavation stability, is the
responsibility of the contractor, and all excavations must comply with current federal,
state, and local requirements. Cuts greater than 4 feet in height should be sloped or
property shored in accordance with Part N of the Washington Administrative Code
(WAC) Chapter 296-155 (WSL, 2022).
The existing recessional outwash classifies as Type C Soil per WAC 296-155, and
temporary, unsupported, cut slopes in these materials should be inclined no steeper than
1.5H:1V (horizontal: vertical). Till soils may classify as Type B soils per WAC 296-155
and temporary, unsupported, cut slopes in these materials should be inclined no steeper
than 1.0H:1.0V, though the presence or absence of till should be verified by a
geotechnical engineer.
Temporary slopes should be protected from erosion, as necessary, by covering the cut
face with well-anchored plastic sheets. Heavy construction equipment, construction
materials, excavated soil, and vehicular traffic should not be allowed any nearer to the
slope crest than half the height of slope, measured from the top edge of the excavation,
unless there is a shoring system that has been designed for support of the additional
lateral pressure.
5.2 Temporary Shoring
Given the presence of other existing utilities in the roadway, it is anticipated that
temporary shoring will likely be utilized to facilitate construction up to 10 feet below
ground surface. General recommendations for design and implementation of trench
shoring systems are presented below.
• Shoring should be designed and constructed to support lateral soil loads, and any
surcharge loads from construction equipment, construction materials, excavated
soils, and vehicular traffic.
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 13
• Precautions should be taken during removal of the shoring or sheeting materials
to minimize disturbance of the pipe, underlying bedding materials, adjacent
structures/utilities, and surrounding soils.
• Trench boxes, if used, should be adequately reinforced to withstand the lateral
forces to which they will be subjected.
• Trench boxes should be of sufficient dimension, both vertically and laterally, to
support the excavation without excessive deformation of the natural soils
adjoining the open excavation. However, by their very nature, trench boxes
normally are incapable of positive support of the trench walls and some
deformation and possible spalling of the excavated slopes should be anticipated if
trench boxes are employed. The contractor should be responsible for repair of any
deformation or damages that occur to adjoining facilities where trench box
methods have been used.
• The open trench excavation should be backfilled immediately after the trench box
has been moved.
• Trenches must be shored when heavy construction equipment and excavated soils
are allowed within a lateral distance, measured from the edge of the excavation,
equal to half the depth of the excavation.
5.3 Check Dams
Experience has shown that surface and groundwater tend to collect in and seep along
pervious pipe bedding material. Where slopes exceed 15 percent, we recommend
installing check dams in the utility trenches every 50 feet to reduce the velocity of water
flowing through the pervious trench backfill. The check dams should extend the full
width of the utility trench and have heights three times greater than the diameter of the
pipe. The check dams could be constructed using controlled density fill (CDF) or
manufactured seepage collars.
5.4 Pipe Bedding
General recommendations relative to pipe bedding and trench backfill are presented
below:
• Pipe bedding material, placement, compaction, and shaping should be in
accordance with the project specifications and the pipe manufacturer’s
recommendations. As a minimum, the pipe bedding should meet the gradation
requirements for Gravel Backfill for Pipe Zone Bedding, Section 9-03.12(3) of
the WSDOT Standard Specifications (WSDOT, 2023).
• Pipe bedding materials should be placed on relatively undisturbed native soils, or
compacted fill soils. If the subgrade soils are disturbed, the disturbed material
should be compacted in place or removed and replaced with additional compacted
bedding material.
• In areas where the trench bottom encounters very soft or organic-rich subgrade
soils, it will be necessary to overexcavate the unsuitable material and backfill
ASPECT CONSULTING
14 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
with pipe bedding material. However, the depth of overexcavation should
generally be limited to a maximum of 2 feet, and should be confirmed by the
geotechnical engineer. If necessary, and as determined by the geotechnical
engineer, a soil separation-grade geotextile may be utilized to limit trench-base
overexcavation requirements.
• Pipe bedding should provide a firm, uniform cradle for the pipe. We recommend
a minimum of 4 inches of bedding material be placed beneath the pipe. The pipe
bedding should extend at least 6 inches above the pipe crown or such greater
thickness as may be required by the pipe manufacturer and/or the City of Renton.
• Pipe bedding material and/or backfill around the pipe should be placed in layers
and tamped to obtain complete contact with the pipe.
5.5 Subgrade Preparation
Subgrade preparation for areas receiving structural fill should include removal of all
topsoil, debris, loose fill soils, roots, and any other deleterious materials. These areas
include, but are not limited to, pavements, and below ground structures. All bearing
surfaces should be trimmed neat and carefully prepared. We recommend proof rolling all
pavement subgrade areas with heavy, pneumatic-tired construction equipment such as a
loaded dump truck or front-end loader to identify apparent loose, soft, or pumping areas
prior to placing pavement sections. Pavement sections should not be placed on frozen
subgrade. A separation geotextile should be placed between the prepared subgrade and
rip rap at relevant locations.
The on-Site soils may contain variable amounts of fine-grained particles, which makes
them moisture sensitive and subject to disturbance when wet. The Contractor must use
care during Site preparation and excavation operations so that any bearing surfaces are
not disturbed. If this occurs, the disturbed material should be removed to expose
undisturbed material. If bearing surfaces are exposed during the winter season or periods
of wet weather, it may be helpful to provide a layer of crushed rock or gravel to help
preserve the subgrade. If gravel is used to protect the bearing surfaces, it should meet the
gradation requirements for Class A Gravel Backfill for Foundations, as described in
Section 9-03.12(1)A of the WSDOT Standard Specifications (WSDOT, 2023).
We recommend that all bearing surfaces be observed by Aspect to verify that the
recommendations of this report have been followed.
5.6 Structural Fill and Compaction
Structural fill should consist of relatively clean, free draining, non-plastic, uniformly
graded sand and gravel free from organic matter or other deleterious materials and be
used in accordance with the following recommendations (WSDOT, 2023):
• Crushed surfacing as described in Section 9-03.9(3): beneath pavement or
sidewalks, trench backfill, or backfill behind catch basins, infiltration galleries, or
pipes.
• Quarry spalls as described in Section 8-15.3(6): stormwater drainage ditches.
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 15
Structural fill should be placed in loose, horizontal, lifts of not more than 8 inches in
thickness and compacted to at least 95 percent of the maximum dry density, as
determined using test method ASTM D 1557, Modified Proctor (ASTM, 2023).
However, compaction effort should not begin until 2 feet of backfill has been placed
over the pipe crown, to prevent deformation or breakage of the new utility. At the time
of placement, the moisture content of structural fill should be at or near optimum. The
procedure required to achieve the specified minimum relative compaction depends on
the size and type of compaction equipment, the number of passes, thickness of the layer
being compacted, and the soil moisture-density properties.
When the first fill is placed in a given area, and/or anytime the fill material changes, the
area should be considered a test section. The test section should be used to establish fill
placement and compaction procedures required to achieve proper compaction. The
geotechnical consultant should observe placement and compaction of the test section to
assist in establishing an appropriate compaction procedure. Once a placement and
compaction procedure is established, the contractor’s operations should be monitored
and periodic density tests performed to verify that proper compaction is being achieved.
5.7 Wet Weather Earthwork
The existing Site soils may be difficult to handle during periods of wet weather.
Therefore, general recommendations relative to earthwork performed in wet weather or
in wet conditions are presented below. These recommendations should be incorporated
into the contract specification and should be required when earthwork is performed in
wet conditions:
• Trench excavation, pipe placement, and backfilling should be accomplished in
small sections to minimize exposure to wet weather.
• Excavated soil that is stockpiled for later use should be covered with plastic
sheets. Soils that become too wet should be removed and replaced with clean
granular materials.
• Excavation and placement of fill should be monitored by someone experienced in
wet weather earthwork to determine that the work is being accomplished in
accordance with the project specifications and the recommendations contained
herein.
5.8 Trench and Pavement Restoration
To minimize the potential for undermining the existing pavement section, and to reduce
the potential for reflective cracking above the proposed utility trenches, the following
recommendations should be implemented during construction:
• No trench excavation should be advanced greater than 4 feet without
implementing a positive shoring system. Requiring excavation inside a temporary
shoring system will reduce the extent of soil relaxation adjacent to the excavation.
ASPECT CONSULTING
16 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
As discussed previously, normal trench box systems do not provide positive
support for the trench walls and are intended primarily to provide for worker
safety. Limiting the extent of trench wall relaxation is key to maintaining proper
support for adjacent pavements.
• All saw cuts associated with trenching excavations should be made 1.5 to 3 feet
back from the anticipated top of trench depending on proposed trench excavation
depth.
• If during excavation of any trench, the existing pavement section is undermined
at any location, the undermined pavement should be sawcut and removed prior to
pavement reconstruction.
• A minimum 6-inch-thick layer of Crushed Surfacing Base Course (CSBC) should
be placed and compacted to 95 percent of its maximum dry density, as
determined using ASTM D 1557, Modified Proctor (ASTM, 2023), below all
reconstructed pavement sections.
• The reconstructed pavement section should consist of Hot Mix Asphalt (HMA) or
Portland Cement Concrete Pavement (PCCP) to match the pavement type in the
roadway. The HMA or PCCP should match the adjacent pavement thickness.
• If included with the project, a full width overlay may then be placed over the
above-described trench patch section.
5.9 Temporary & Permanent Erosion and Sediment Control
Soil erosion can be minimized by careful grading practices, the appropriate use of silt
fences and/or straw bales, and by implementing the recommendations in the Wet
Weather Earthwork section of this report.
Surface runoff control during construction should be the responsibility of the contractor.
All collected water should be controlled and discharged in accordance with local
regulations. Grading measures, slope protection, ditching, sumps, dewatering, and other
measures should be employed as necessary to permit proper completion of the work.
Permanent control of surface water should be incorporated in the final grading design.
Water should not be allowed to pond immediately adjacent to foundations or paved
areas.
PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023 FINAL 17
6 Recommendations for Continuing Geotechnical
Services
The engineering analyses completed for this study were done so with careful
consideration of the existing and available Site data while making reasonable
assumptions about Site conditions not fully detailed or addressed by the current design
and existing data. Our recommendations may change as the Project develops further and
new information becomes available.
We recommend retaining Aspect to review the final design documents to ensure our
recommendations were properly implemented. The integrity of the geotechnical elements
depends upon proper Site preparation and construction procedures. During the
construction phase of the Project, we recommend that Aspect be retained to observe and
evaluate temporary excavations, subgrade preparation, check dam installation, and
structural backfill placement and compaction. The purpose of our observations is to
verify compliance with design concepts and recommendations, and to allow design
changes or evaluation of appropriate construction methods in the event that subsurface
conditions differ from those anticipated prior to the start of construction.
ASPECT CONSULTING
18 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
7 References
ASTM International (ASTM), 2023, 2023 Annual Book of ASTM Standards, West
Conshohocken, Pennsylvania.
BHC Consultants, LLC (BHC), 2023, City of Renton Windsor Hills Utility
Improvements Project, City Project: 27-04186, Preliminary 60% Review Set, Not
for Construction, March 2023.
City of Renton, 2022a, Renton Municipal Code (RMC) Critical Areas Regulations,
Chapter 4-03-050, accessed June 8, 2022.
City of Renton, 2022b, City of Renton Map Viewer (COR Maps), Website,
https://maps.rentonwa.gov/Html5viewer/Index.html?viewer=cormaps, Accessed
June 8, 2022.
City of Renton, 2022c, Surface Water Design Manual, Public Works Department,
Surface Water Utility, June 22, 2022.
Google, 2022, Google Earth, earth.google.com/web/. Accessed August 30, 2022.
Gower H.D., J.C. Yount, and R.S. Crosson (Gower et al.), 1985, Seismotectonic map of
the Puget Sound region, Washington: U.S. Geological Survey Miscellaneous
Investigations Series Map I-1613, p. 15, plate 1, scale 1:250,000.
Mullineaux, D.R., 1965, Geologic Map of the Renton Quadrangle, King County,
Washington, USGS Geologic Map GQ-405, 1965.
Nationwide Environmental Title Research (NETR), 2022, Nationwide Environmental
Title Research, LLC, at https://www.historicaerials.com/, Accessed August 30,
2022.
Palmer, S. P., 1992, Preliminary maps of liquefaction susceptibility for the Renton and
Auburn 7.5’ quadrangles, Washington: Washington State Department of Natural
Resources, Washington Division of Geology and Earth Resources Open File
Report 92-7, 24 p., 2 plates.
Schuster, J.E., Cabibbo, A.A., Schilter, J.F., and Hubert, I.J., 2015, Geologic map of the
Tacoma 1:100,000-scale quadrangle, Washington, Map Series 2015-03,
November 2015.
Varnes, D.J., 1978, Slope movement types and processes. In: Schuster RL, Krizek RJ (eds)
Landslides, analysis and control, special report 176: Transportation research board,
National Academy of Sciences, Washington, DC., pp. 11–33
Washington State Department of Transportation (WSDOT), 2023, Standard Specifications
for Road, Bridge and Municipal Construction, Manual M 41-10, 2023.
Washington State Legislature (WSL), 2022, Washington Administrative Code (WAC)
Chapter 296-155, Safety Standards For Construction Work, Website:
https://apps.leg.wa.gov/WAC/default.aspx?cite=296-155, July 19, 2022.
ASPECT CONSULTING
19 FINAL PROJECT NO. 210614 MARCH 17, 2023
8 Limitations
Work for this project was performed for BHC Consultants, LLC (Client), and this report
was prepared consistent with recognized standards of professionals in the same locality
and involving similar conditions, at the time the work was performed. No other warranty,
expressed or implied, is made by Aspect Consulting, LLC (Aspect).
Recommendations presented herein are based on our interpretation of site conditions,
geotechnical engineering calculations, and judgment in accordance with our mutually
agreed-upon scope of work. Our recommendations are unique and specific to the project,
site, and Client. Application of this report for any purpose other than the project should
be done only after consultation with Aspect.
Variations may exist between the soil and groundwater conditions reported and those
actually underlying the site. The nature and extent of such soil variations may change
over time and may not be evident before construction begins. If any soil conditions are
encountered at the site that are different from those described in this report, Aspect
should be notified immediately to review the applicability of our recommendations.
Risks are inherent with any site involving slopes and no recommendations, geologic
analysis, or engineering design can assure slope stability. Our observations, findings, and
opinions are a means to identify and reduce the inherent risks to the Client.
It is the Client's responsibility to see that all parties to this project, including the designer,
contractor, subcontractors, and agents, are made aware of this report in its entirety. At the
time of this report, design plans and construction methods have not been finalized, and
the recommendations presented herein are based on preliminary project information. If
project developments result in changes from the preliminary project information, Aspect
should be contacted to determine if our recommendations contained in this report should
be revised and/or expanded upon.
The scope of work does not include services related to construction safety precautions.
Site safety is typically the responsibility of the contractor, and our recommendations are
not intended to direct the contractor’s site safety methods, techniques, sequences, or
procedures. The scope of our work also does not include the assessment of environmental
characteristics, particularly those involving potentially hazardous substances in soil or
groundwater.
All reports prepared by Aspect for the Client apply only to the services described in the
Agreement(s) with the Client. Any use or reuse by any party other than the Client is at the
sole risk of that party, and without liability to Aspect. Aspect’s original files/reports shall
govern in the event of any dispute regarding the content of electronic documents
furnished to others.
Please refer to Appendix A titled “Report Limitations and Guidelines for Use” for
additional information governing the use of this report.
We appreciate the opportunity to perform these services. If you have any questions please
call Rory Kilkenny, Senior Geotechnical Engineer, at 206-780-7727.
FIGURES
GIS Path: Q:\_GeoTech\210614 Windsor Hills Water Quality Retrofit Project\2022-06 Geotechnical Engineering Report\GIS\01 Site Location Map.mxd || Coordinate System: NAD 1983 StatePlane Washington North FIPS 4601 Feet || Date Saved: 6/8/2022 || User: scudd || Print Date: 6/8/2022
Site Location MapGeotechnical Engineering ReportWindsor Hills Water Quality Retrofit ProjectRenton, Washington
FIG URE NO .1JUN-2022
PROJECT NO.210614
BY:JRG / SCC
REVISED BY:- - -
0 2,000 4,000
Feet
W A S H I N G T O N
Bellingham
Olympia
Port Angeles
Seattle Spokane
Tacoma Wenatchee
Yakima
!
!
!
#
!
Lake Washington
ElliottBay
P u g e tSound
Bellevue
Kirkland
Renton
Seattle
Basemap Layer Credits || Esri, HERE, Garmin, (c) OpenStreetMap contributors, and the GIS user communitySources: Esri, HERE, Garmin, Intermap, increment P Corp., GEBCO, USGS, FAO, NPS, NRCAN, GeoBase, IGN, Kadaster NL, Ordnance Survey, Esri Japan, METI, Esri China (Hong Kong), (c) OpenStreetMap contributors, and theGIS User Community
PROJECT AREA
SITELOCATION
SITELOCATION
AHA-03
AHA-02
AHA-01
Su
n
s
e
t
B
l
v
d
N
E
Grane
y
W
a
y
N
E
Bron
s
o
n
W
a
y
N
E
Wind
s
o
r
W
a
y
N
E
Ed
m
o
n
d
s
A
v
e
N
E
Wi
n
d
s
o
r
P
l
N
E
Bro
n
s
o
n
P
l
N
E
AHA-06
AHA-05
AHA-04
FIGURE NO.BY:
REVISED BY:PROJECT NO.
CA
D
P
a
t
h
:
Q
:
\
_
G
e
o
T
e
c
h
\
2
1
0
6
1
4
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
W
a
t
e
r
Q
u
a
l
i
t
y
R
e
t
r
o
f
i
t
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
\
2
0
2
2
-
0
8
A
d
d
i
t
i
o
n
a
l
f
i
g
u
r
e
s
\
2
1
0
6
1
4
-
0
3
.
d
w
g
L
a
y
o
u
t
:
F
i
g
3
|
|
D
a
t
e
S
a
v
e
d
:
3
/
1
5
/
2
0
2
3
4
:
1
6
:
1
8
P
M
|
|
U
s
e
r
:
j
r
e
i
n
h
a
r
d
t
Feet
0 150 300
Geotechnical Engineering Report
Windsor Hills Water Quality Retrofit Project
Renton, Washington
Site and Exploration Map
Mar-2023
2
JRG/CMV
-210614
Source: Base map provided by BHC Consultants, May, 2022. Critical area data provided by City of Renton "COR MAPS".
Legend
Shallow Exploration Location
Approximate Site Boundary
Puget Sound Energy Parcel
Geologically Hazardous Areas
Unregulated Slope (>15% and 25%)
Sensitive Slope (>25% and 40%)
Protected Slope (>40% and 90%)
Outer Limits of Landslide Hazard Area
Outer Limits of Erosion Hazard Area
Bronson Pl NE
Bronson Way NE
Grandey Way NE
Windsor Pl NE
Windsor Way NE
Project Work Areas
Work Area Within 15
Feet of Protected Slope
Work Area Within 15
Feet of Protected Slope
Existing Ditch
on PSE Parcel
Existing Ditch
between 514 and
550 Grandey Way NE
Existing Concrete-lined
Ditch between 472 and
476 Bronson Way NE
WIND
S
O
R
W
A
Y
N
E
ED
M
O
N
D
S
A
V
E
N
E
BRO
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
NE 3RD ST
R
E
E
T
SU
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
GRAN
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
N
E
WIN
D
S
O
R
APPROXIMATE
SITE BOUNDARY
PL
NE
CA
D
P
a
t
h
:
Q:
\
_
G
e
o
T
e
c
h
\
2
1
0
6
1
4
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
W
a
t
e
r
Q
u
a
l
i
t
y
R
e
t
r
o
f
i
t
P
r
o
j
e
c
t
\
2
0
2
2
-
0
6
G
e
o
t
e
c
h
n
i
c
a
l
E
n
g
i
n
e
e
r
i
n
g
R
e
p
o
r
t
\
2
1
0
6
1
4
-
0
2
G
e
o
l
o
g
i
c
M
a
p
.
d
w
g
0
2
G
e
o
l
o
g
i
c
M
a
p
|
|
D
a
t
e
S
a
v
e
d
:
M
a
r
1
7
,
2
0
2
3
1
:
2
7
p
m
|
|
U
s
e
r
:
jr
e
i
n
h
a
r
d
t
Geotechnical Engineering Report
Windsor Hills Water Quality Retrofit Project
Renton, Washington
3
BY:
JG/SCC
Geologic Map
Mar-2023
REVISED BY:
-
PROJECT NO.
210614
FIGURE NO.
Source: Base map from Mullineaux, D.R., 1965, Geologic Map of the Renton
Quadrangle, King County, Washington, USGS Geologic Map GQ-405, 1965.
APPENDIX A
Report Limitations and Guidelines
for Use
ASPECT CONSULTING
REPORT LIMITATIONS AND GUIDELINES FOR
USE
Geoscience is Not Exact
The geoscience practices (geotechnical engineering, geology, and environmental science)
are far less exact than other engineering and natural science disciplines. It is important to
recognize this limitation in evaluating the content of the report. If you are unclear how
these "Report Limitations and Guidelines for Use" apply to your project or property, you
should contact Aspect Consulting, LLC (Aspect).
This Report and Project-Specific Factors
Aspect’s services are designed to meet the specific needs of our clients. Aspect has
performed the services in general accordance with our agreement (the Agreement) with
the Client (defined under the Limitations section of this project’s work product). This
report has been prepared for the exclusive use of the Client. This report should not be
applied for any purpose or project except the purpose described in the Agreement.
Aspect considered many unique, project-specific factors when establishing the Scope of
Work for this project and report. You should not rely on this report if it was:
• Not prepared for you;
• Not prepared for the specific purpose identified in the Agreement;
• Not prepared for the specific subject property assessed; or
• Completed before important changes occurred concerning the subject property,
project, or governmental regulatory actions.
If changes are made to the project or subject property after the date of this report, Aspect
should be retained to assess the impact of the changes with respect to the conclusions
contained in the report.
Reliance Conditions for Third Parties
This report was prepared for the exclusive use of the Client. No other party may rely on
the product of our services unless we agree in advance to such reliance in writing. This is
to provide our firm with reasonable protection against liability claims by third parties
with whom there would otherwise be no contractual limitations. Within the limitations of
scope, schedule, and budget, our services have been executed in accordance with our
Agreement with the Client and recognized geoscience practices in the same locality and
involving similar conditions at the time this report was prepared
Property Conditions Change Over Time
This report is based on conditions that existed at the time the study was performed. The
findings and conclusions of this report may be affected by the passage of time, by events
such as a change in property use or occupancy, or by natural events, such as floods,
ASPECT CONSULTING
earthquakes, slope instability, or groundwater fluctuations. If any of the described events
may have occurred following the issuance of the report, you should contact Aspect so
that we may evaluate whether changed conditions affect the continued reliability or
applicability of our conclusions and recommendations.
Geotechnical, Geologic, and Environmental Reports Are
Not Interchangeable
The equipment, techniques, and personnel used to perform a geotechnical or geologic
study differ significantly from those used to perform an environmental study and vice
versa. For that reason, a geotechnical engineering or geologic report does not usually
address any environmental findings, conclusions, or recommendations (e.g., about the
likelihood of encountering underground storage tanks or regulated contaminants).
Similarly, environmental reports are not used to address geotechnical or geologic
concerns regarding the subject property.
We appreciate the opportunity to perform these services. If you have any questions please
contact the Aspect Project Manager for this project.
APPENDIX C
CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION PLAN
(under separate cover)
Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan
(SWPPP)
for
Windsor Hills Utility Improvement Project
Prepared for:
City of Renton, WA
Permittee / Owner Engineer Contractor
City of Renton BHC Consultants, LLC TBD
Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead (CESCL) or Qualified Inspector
Name Organization Contact Phone Number
TBD Contractor TBD
SWPPP Prepared By
Name Organization Contact Phone Number
Becca Ochiltree, PE BHC Consultants, LLC 206-357-9907
SWPPP Preparation Date
04/02/2024
Project Construction Dates (Anticipated)
Activity / Phase Start Date End Date
Facility Construction 06/01/2024 9/30/2025
I hereby state that this Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan for City of Renton
Windsor Hills Utility Improvements has been prepared by me or under my supervision and
meets the standard of care and expertise which is usual and customary in this community for
professional engineers. I understand that City of Renton does not and will not assume liability
for the sufficiency, suitability, or performance of Construct SWPPP BMPs prepared by me.
Becca Ochiltree, PE
BHC Consultants, LLC
04/02/2024
P a g e | 1
Table of Contents
1 Project Information .............................................................................................................. 4
1.1 Existing Conditions ...................................................................................................... 4
1.2 Proposed Construction Activities .................................................................................. 5
2 Construction Stormwater Best Management Practices (BMPs) ........................................... 7
2.1 The 13 Elements .......................................................................................................... 7
2.1.1 Element 1: Preserve Vegetation / Mark Clearing Limits ........................................ 7
2.1.2 Element 2: Establish Construction Access ............................................................ 8
2.1.3 Element 3: Control Flow Rates ............................................................................. 9
2.1.4 Element 4: Install Sediment Controls ...................................................................10
2.1.5 Element 5: Stabilize Soils ....................................................................................11
2.1.6 Element 6: Protect Slopes....................................................................................12
2.1.7 Element 7: Protect Drain Inlets ............................................................................13
2.1.8 Element 8: Stabilize Channels and Outlets ..........................................................14
2.1.9 Element 9: Control Pollutants ...............................................................................15
2.1.10 Element 10: Control Dewatering ..........................................................................18
2.1.11 Element 11: Maintain BMPs .................................................................................19
2.1.12 Element 12: Manage the Project ..........................................................................20
2.1.13 Element 13: Protect Low Impact Development (LID) BMPs .................................21
3 Pollution Prevention Team .................................................................................................22
4 Monitoring and Sampling Requirements ............................................................................23
4.1 Site Inspection ............................................................................................................23
4.2 Stormwater Quality Sampling ......................................................................................23
4.2.1 Turbidity Sampling ...............................................................................................23
4.2.2 pH Sampling ........................................................................................................23
5 Discharges to 303(d) or Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL) Waterbodies .........................24
5.1 303(d) Listed Waterbodies ..........................................................................................24
5.2 TMDL Waterbodies .....................................................................................................24
6 Reporting and Record Keeping ..........................................................................................25
6.1 Record Keeping ..........................................................................................................25
6.1.1 Site Log Book ......................................................................................................25
6.1.2 Records Retention ...............................................................................................25
6.1.3 Updating the SWPPP ...........................................................................................25
6.2 Reporting ....................................................................................................................26
6.2.1 Discharge Monitoring Reports ..............................................................................26
6.2.2 Notification of Noncompliance ..............................................................................26
P a g e | 2
List of Tables
Table 1 – Summary of Site Pollutant Constituents ................................................................ 5
Table 2 – Pollutants ................................................................................................................15
Table 3 – pH-Modifying Sources ............................................................................................16
Table 4 – Dewatering BMPs ....................................................................................................18
Table 5 – Management ............................................................................................................20
Table 6 – Team Information ....................................................................................................22
List of Appendices
Appendix/Glossary
A. Site Map and Select Construction Drawings
B. BMP Detail
C. Site Inspection Form
D. Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP)
P a g e | 3
List of Acronyms and Abbreviations
Acronym / Abbreviation Explanation
303(d) Section of the Clean Water Act pertaining to Impaired Waterbodies
BFO Bellingham Field Office of the Department of Ecology
BMP(s) Best Management Practice(s)
CESCL Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead
CO2 Carbon Dioxide
CRO Central Regional Office of the Department of Ecology
CSWGP Construction Stormwater General Permit
CWA Clean Water Act
DMR Discharge Monitoring Report
DO Dissolved Oxygen
Ecology Washington State Department of Ecology
EPA United States Environmental Protection Agency
ERO Eastern Regional Office of the Department of Ecology
ERTS Environmental Report Tracking System
ESC Erosion and Sediment Control
GULD General Use Level Designation
NPDES National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System
NTU Nephelometric Turbidity Units
NWRO Northwest Regional Office of the Department of Ecology
pH Power of Hydrogen
RCW Revised Code of Washington
SPCC Spill Prevention, Control, and Countermeasure
su Standard Units
SWMMEW Stormwater Management Manual for Eastern Washington
SWMMWW Stormwater Management Manual for Western Washington
SWPPP Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan
TESC Temporary Erosion and Sediment Control
SWRO Southwest Regional Office of the Department of Ecology
TMDL Total Maximum Daily Load
VFO Vancouver Field Office of the Department of Ecology
WAC Washington Administrative Code
WSDOT Washington Department of Transportation
WWHM Western Washington Hydrology Model
P a g e | 4
1 Project Information
Project/Site Name: Renton Windsor Hills Utility
Improvements
Street/Location: Windsor Hills neighborhood of Renton, east
of I-405, west of Edmonds Ave NE, and
north of NE 4th St.
City: Renton State: WA Zip code: 98056
Receiving waterbody: Stormwater conveyance draining to a
WSDOT pond area that discharges to
the Cedar River and eventually South
Lake Washington
1.1 Existing Conditions
Total acreage (including support activities such as off-site equipment staging yards, material
storage areas, borrow areas).
Total acreage: 35 acres developed
Disturbed acreage: 1.34
Existing structures: There are at least 140 residential parcels within the neighborhood, one
public park parcel, and four parcels owned by PSE.
Landscape
topography:
The geotechnical report prepared by Aspect Consulting for this project
states that the parcels range in inclination from less than 15 percent to
greater than 40 percent as mapped by the City of Renton. The PSE
parcels are generally sloped greater than 15 percent with some areas
inclined up to 40 percent. They found that the neighbor ROWs are more
gradually sloped than the parcels, with typical inclinations of less than 15
percent. There are five ROW sections with inclinations between 15 and 25
percent. The report found no evidence of slope instability, such as scarps
or skin slides, during the Site reconnaissance.
Drainage patterns: Stormwater conveyance draining to a WSDOT pond area that discharges
to the Cedar River and eventually South Lake Washington.
Existing Vegetation: Most disturbed areas within project site are existing pavement, some
storm conveyance project areas are vegetated with landscaped lawn and
shrubs
Critical Areas (wetlands, streams, high erosion
risk, steep or difficult to stabilize slopes):
None, all steep slopes in the project site
are currently paved
List of known impairments for 303(d) listed or Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL) for the
receiving waterbody: None
Soils: Aspect Consulting Engineers performed a geotechnical investigation (Geotech Report)
of the site by boring 6 hand auger holes to depths of 2-4.5 feet below the ground surface and
characterized the soil as follows:
· Recessional outwash deposits were encountered underneath the topsoil two of the hand
auger lcoations and mainly consisted of medium dense to dense, moist to wet,
brown silty sand with gravel (SM) and medium dense to dense, wet, brown silty
P a g e | 5
gravel with sand (GM).
· Up to 3 feet of fill was encountered in one of the hand auger locations and mainly
consisted of loose, moist to wet, brown silty sand with variable amounts of gravel (SM),
and soft, wet, dark gray to black organic silt with sand deposits (OL). Recessional
outwash deposits were encountered beneath the fill and consisted of medium dense,
wet, brown silty sand with gravel.
• Although not encountered, the recessional outwash is likely underlain by Vashon
till at varying depths throughout the Site.
Groundwater seepage was not encountered in three of the hand auger locations;
however, it is possible that groundwater may develop locally within the recessional
outwash over the Vashon till. Groundwater was encountered at 2.5 feet and 1.25 feet bgs
in two of the hand auger locations. Groundwater levels will vary by location, local
precipitation, local subsurface conditions, and other factors.
Table 1 includes a list of suspected and/or known contaminants associated with the construction
activity.
Table 1 – Summary of Site Pollutant Constituents
Constituent
(Pollutant) Location Depth Concentration
None
1.2 Proposed Construction Activities
Description of site development:
The Project will consist of replacing below-grade stormwater and water lines within streets of the
Windsor Hills neighborhood. While the project is located within several mapped critical areas
including high erosion hazards, high landslide hazards, and regulated slopes, the utility
replacements will occur within the paved Rights-of-Way(ROWs), apart from the following
stormwater features (BHC, 2023):
• Stormwater structures (Type 2 catch basins) and buried stormwater piping between 514
& 550 Grandey Way NE and 472 & 476 Bronson Way NE. Excavation depths in these
areas are expected to be 6 feet below ground surface (bgs) or less.
• A shallow quarry spall ditch on a Puget Sound Energy (PSE) parcel near 456 Bronson
Way NE.
The Geotech Report found that the proposed Project is consistent with the RMC critical area
regulations
Description of construction activities:
TESC, underground water and storm piping, stormwater facilities, hydrant installations, and
restoration of asphalt pavement and concrete sidewalks.
P a g e | 6
Description of site drainage including flow from and onto adjacent properties. Must be
consistent with Site Map in Appendix A:
There is an existing stormwater conveyance system in this residential neighborhood that is
being improved as part of this project. The existing drainage system is shown in Figure 2 -
Existing Conditions and includes both open channel flow and piped inlet flow. The site generally
drains from the southeast toward the west/northwest. Minimal offsite flows from Edmonds Ave
NE flow into the neighborhood.
Description of final stabilization:
The great majority of the disturbed area will be within the public ROW and restored with asphalt
paving or concrete sidewalk. A few areas of storm drainage improvements on private property
will be lined with riprap or hydroseeded.
P a g e | 7
2 Construction Stormwater Best Management Practices (BMPs)
The SWPPP is a living document reflecting current conditions and changes throughout the life
of the project. These changes may be informal (i.e., hand-written notes and deletions). Update
the SWPPP when the CESCL has noted a deficiency in BMPs or deviation from original design.
2.1 The 13 Elements
2.1.1 Element 1: Preserve Vegetation / Mark Clearing Limits
High Visibility Fence and Silt Fence will be used to clearly delineate the work area from the rest
of the site. There are no trees within the clearing limits for this project. Natural vegetation and
native topsoil outside of the delineated work area will not be disturbed.
List and describe BMPs: BMP C101: Preserving Natural Vegetation; BMP C103: High Visibility
Fence; BMP C233: Silt Fence
Installation Schedules: These Element 1 BMPs will be the first elements installed on the site
before more disruptive construction activities begin.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 8
2.1.2 Element 2: Establish Construction Access
Stabilized construction entrances will not be used since the majority of the project is within an
asphalt paved ROW. Street sweeping will be employed if sediment is tracked off-site.
List and describe BMPs: N/A
Installation Schedules: These Element 2 BMPs will be the second elements installed on the site.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 9
2.1.3 Element 3: Control Flow Rates
The site is steeply sloped in some areas, but the work area is generally paved asphalt so
erosion is not of great concern. Where there is work in undeveloped areas, silt fences will be
installed surrounding the work area to slow stormwater discharging downstream.
Will you construct stormwater retention and/or detention facilities?
Yes No
Will you use permanent infiltration ponds or other low impact development (example: rain
gardens, bio-retention, porous pavement) to control flow during construction?
Yes No
List and describe BMPs: BMP C233: Silt Fence; BMP C235: Wattles; BMP C150: Materials on
Hand
Installation Schedules: As needed.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 10
2.1.4 Element 4: Install Sediment Controls
The site is steeply sloped in some areas, but the work area is generally paved asphalt so
erosion is not of great concern. Silt fences will be installed surrounding the work area to collect
sediment from stormwater discharging downstream. If silt fences are not adequate, wattles may
be employed to further collect sediment. Storm drain inlet protection will be achieved using
catch basin filters.
List and describe BMPs: BMP C233: Silt Fence; BMP C220: Storm Drain Inlet Protection (using
catch basin filters); BMP C235: Wattles; BMP C150: Materials on Hand
Installation Schedules: Silt fences and catch basin filters will be the first elements installed on
the site before more disruptive construction activities begin. Wattles will be installed as needed.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 11
2.1.5 Element 5: Stabilize Soils
Stockpiles and exposed soils will be covered with plastic sheeting, mulch, or topsoil.
West of the Cascade Mountains Crest
Season Dates Number of Days Soils Can
be Left Exposed
During the Dry Season May 1 – September 30 7 days
During the Wet Season October 1 – April 30 2 days
Soils must be stabilized at the end of the shift before a holiday or weekend if needed based on
the weather forecast.
Anticipated project dates: Start date: 06/01/2024 End date: 9/30/2025
Will you construct during the wet season?
Yes No
List and describe BMPs: BMP C120: Temporary and Permanent Seeding; BMP C121:
Mulching; BMP C122: Nets and Blankets; BMP C123: Plastic Covering; BMP C125:
Topsoiling/Composting; BMP C140: Dust Control.
Installation Schedules: Element 5 BMPs will be installed according to the limits set forth above
for work west of the Cascade Mountains crest, as needed.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 12
2.1.6 Element 6: Protect Slopes
The site is steeply sloped in some areas, but the work area is generally paved asphalt so
erosion is not of great concern. Where there is work in undeveloped areas, the slopes are not
steep, and soil protection blankets will be used to cover soils when work is not actively
occurring.
Will steep slopes be present at the site during construction?
Yes No
List and describe BMPs: BMP C121: Mulching; BMP C122: Nets and Blankets; BMP C150:
Materials on Hand
Installation Schedules: These Element 6 BMPs will be installed as needed, if steep slopes
develop during construction.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 13
2.1.7 Element 7: Protect Drain Inlets
Several storm drain inlets exist in the various ROW tracts in the site. The inlets will be protected
with inlet protection devices, in addition to silt fencing installed around the perimeter of the non-
ROW work areas. Inlet protection devices will be cleaned (or removed and replaced) when
sediment has filled the device by one third, or as specified by the manufacturer.
List and describe BMPs: BMP C220: Storm Drain Inlet Protection
Installation Schedules: These Element 7 BMPs will be the first elements installed before more
disruptive construction activities begin.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 14
2.1.8 Element 8: Stabilize Channels and Outlets
Outlet protection will be implemented with the BMP C209 Outlet Protection.
Provide stabilization, including armoring material, adequate to prevent erosion of outlets,
adjacent stream banks, slopes, and downstream reaches, will be installed at the outlets of all
conveyance systems.
List and describe BMPs: BMP C209: Outlet Protection
Installation Schedules: These Element 8 BMPs will be installed before the adjacent conveyance
systems are installed.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 15
2.1.9 Element 9: Control Pollutants
The following pollutants are anticipated to be present on-site:
Table 2 – Pollutants
Pollutant (List pollutants and source, if applicable)
Fuel and lubricants for construction equipment.
Cast-in-place concrete for side walk restoration.
Fertilizers for permanent landscaping.
Pollutants will be handled with care and in accordance with applicable BMPs. Any spilled
contaminants or contaminated stormwater will be disposed of off-site at appropriate facilities.
List and describe BMPs: BMP C151: Concrete Handling; BMP C153: Material Delivery, Storage,
and Containment; BMP C154: Concrete Washout Area; BMP A2.4: Mobile Fueling of Vehicles
and Heavy Equipment; BMP A3.2: Concrete Pouring, Concrete Cutting, and Asphalt Application
at Temporary Sites;
Installation Schedules: These Element 9 BMPs will be installed as needed based on the current
and upcoming construction activities.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
Will maintenance, fueling, and/or repair of heavy equipment and vehicles occur on-site?
Yes No
List and describe BMPs: BMP A2.4: Mobile Fueling of Vehicles and Heavy Equipment
Installation Schedules: These Element 9 BMPs will be employed for all mobile vehicle and
equipment fueling.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
Will wheel wash or tire bath system BMPs be used during construction?
Yes No
P a g e | 16
List and describe BMPs:
Installation Schedules:
Inspection and Maintenance plan:
Responsible Staff:
Will pH-modifying sources be present on-site?
Yes No If yes, check the source(s).
Table 3 – pH-Modifying Sources
None
Bulk cement
Cement kiln dust
Fly ash
Other cementitious materials
New concrete washing or curing waters
Waste streams generated from concrete grinding and sawing
Exposed aggregate processes
Dewatering concrete vaults
Concrete pumping and mixer washout waters
Recycled concrete
Recycled concrete stockpiles
Other (i.e., calcium lignosulfate) [please describe: ]
List and describe BMPs: BMP C151: Concrete Handling; BMP C154: Concrete Washout Area;
BMP A3.2: Concrete Pouring, Concrete Cutting, and Asphalt Application at Temporary Sites;
Installation Schedules: These Element 9 BMPs will be installed as needed based on the current
and upcoming construction activities.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
Concrete trucks must not be washed out onto the ground, or into storm drains, open ditches,
streets, or streams. Excess concrete must not be dumped on-site, except in designated
concrete washout areas with appropriate BMPs installed.
Will uncontaminated water from water-only based shaft drilling for construction of building, road,
and bridge foundations be infiltrated provided the wastewater is managed in a way that prohibits
discharge to surface waters?
P a g e | 17
Yes No
List and describe BMPs:
Installation Schedules:
Inspection and Maintenance plan:
Responsible Staff:
P a g e | 18
2.1.10 Element 10: Control Dewatering
Groundwater dewatering may be necessary during excavation for water and storm pipe
instalaltion. Dewatering water should not be contaminated, as no known contaminants are
present onsite.
Table 4 – Dewatering BMPs
Infiltration
Transport off-site in a vehicle (vacuum truck for legal disposal)
Ecology-approved on-site chemical treatment or other suitable treatment technologies
Sanitary or combined sewer discharge with local sewer district approval (last resort)
Use of sedimentation bag with discharge to ditch or swale (small volumes of localized
dewatering)
List and describe BMPs: BMP C236: Vegetative Filtration with infiltration to undisturbed native
vegetation.
Installation Schedules: The Contractor shall be prepared to implement these Element 10 BMPs
at all times during the construction work.
Inspection and Maintenance plan: Inspect and maintain at least weekly, after a rain event, or
when deficiencies are observed.
Responsible Staff: General Contractor
P a g e | 19
2.1.11 Element 11: Maintain BMPs
All temporary and permanent Erosion and Sediment Control (ESC) BMPs shall be maintained
and repaired as needed to ensure continued performance of their intended function.
Maintenance and repair shall be conducted in accordance with each particular BMP
specification (see Volume II of the King County Stormwater and Site Development Manual).
Visual monitoring of all BMPs installed at the site will be conducted at least once every calendar
week and within 24 hours of any stormwater or non-stormwater discharge from the site. If the
site becomes inactive and is temporarily stabilized, the inspection frequency may be reduced to
once every calendar month. See Appendix C for Site Inspection Form.
All temporary ESC BMPs shall be removed within 30 days after final site stabilization is
achieved or after the temporary BMPs are no longer needed.
Trapped sediment shall be stabilized on-site or removed. Disturbed soil resulting from removal
of either BMPs or vegetation shall be permanently stabilized.
Additionally, protection must be provided for all BMPs installed for the permanent control of
stormwater from sediment and compaction. BMPs that are to remain in place following
completion of construction shall be examined and restored to full operating condition. If
sediment enters these BMPs during construction, the sediment shall be removed, and the
facility shall be returned to conditions specified in the construction documents.
P a g e | 20
2.1.12 Element 12: Manage the Project
The project will be managed based on the following principles:
· Projects will be phased to the maximum extent practicable and seasonal work limitations
will be taken into account.
· Inspection and monitoring:
o Inspection, maintenance and repair of all BMPs will occur as needed to ensure
performance of their intended function.
o Site inspections and monitoring will be conducted in accordance with all
applicable County and CSWGP requirements.
· Maintain an updated SWPPP.
o The SWPPP will be updated, maintained, and implemented in accordance with
the CSWGP and the requirements outlined in this Element (#12).
As site work progresses the SWPPP will be modified routinely to reflect changing site
conditions. The SWPPP will be reviewed monthly to ensure the content is current.
Table 5 – Management
Design the project to fit the existing topography, soils, and drainage patterns
Emphasize erosion control rather than sediment control
Minimize the extent and duration of the area exposed
Keep runoff velocities low
Retain sediment on-site
Thoroughly monitor site and maintain all ESC measures
Schedule major earthwork during the dry season – stormwater facilities
Other (please describe)
P a g e | 21
2.1.13 Element 13: Protect Low Impact Development (LID) BMPs
List and describe BMPs: Section 3.3 of Volume II of the King County Stormwater Management
and Site Development Manual, in particular, General Erosion and Sediment Control BMPs
Applicable to LID, Additional Construction Techniques for LID BMPs, and Infiltration and
Dispersion Facility Construction Techniques.
No LID BMPs are planned for this project.
P a g e | 22
3 Pollution Prevention Team
Table 6 – Team Information
Title Name(s) Phone Number
Certified Erosion and
Sediment Control Lead
(CESCL)
TBD TBD
Resident Engineer Becca Ochiltree, PE
BHC Consultants, LLC
206-357-9907
Emergency Ecology
Contact
Northwest Regional Office, Shoreline 206-594-0000
Emergency Permittee/
Owner Contact
Joe Farah, Surface Water Engineering
Manager, City of Renton
206-475-1390
Non-Emergency Owner
Contact
Jared McDonald, Project Manager, City
of Renton
425-757-7718
Monitoring Personnel TBD TBD
Ecology Regional Office Northwest Regional Office, Shoreline 206-594-0000
P a g e | 23
4 Monitoring and Sampling Requirements
Monitoring includes visual inspection, sampling for water quality parameters of concern, and
documentation of the inspection and sampling findings in a site log book. A site log book will be
maintained for all on-site construction activities and will include:
· A record of the implementation of the SWPPP and other permit requirements
· Site inspections
· Stormwater sampling data
See Appendix C for Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form.
The site log book must be maintained on-site within reasonable access to the site and be made
available upon request to Ecology or the local jurisdiction.
Numeric effluent limits may be required for certain discharges to 303(d) listed waterbodies. See
CSWGP Special Condition S8 and Section 5 of this template.
4.1 Site Inspection
Site inspections will be conducted at least once every calendar week and within 24 hours
following any discharge from the site. For sites that are temporarily stabilized and inactive, the
required frequency is reduced to once per calendar month.
The discharge point(s) are indicated on the Site Map (see Appendix A) and in accordance with
the applicable requirements of the CSWGP.
4.2 Stormwater Quality Sampling
4.2.1 Turbidity Sampling
Turbidity sampling is required because the site disturbs more than 1 acre.
4.2.2 pH Sampling
pH monitoring is not required for the site because it will not have greater than 1000 cubic yards
poured concrete over the life of the project.
P a g e | 24
5 Discharges to 303(d) or Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL)
Waterbodies
5.1 303(d) Listed Waterbodies
Is the receiving water 303(d) (Category 5) listed for turbidity, fine sediment, phosphorus, or pH?
Yes No
List the impairment(s):
None
5.2 TMDL Waterbodies
Waste Load Allocation for CWSGP discharges:
None
List and describe BMPs:
None
Discharges to TMDL receiving waterbodies will meet in-stream water quality criteria at the point
of discharge.
P a g e | 25
6 Reporting and Record Keeping
6.1 Record Keeping
6.1.1 Site Log Book
A site log book will be maintained for all on-site construction activities and will include:
· A record of the implementation of the SWPPP and other permit requirements
· Site inspections
· Sample logs
6.1.2 Records Retention
Records will be retained during the life of the project and for a minimum of three (3) years
following the termination of permit coverage in accordance with Special Condition S5.C of the
CSWGP.
Permit documentation to be retained on-site:
· CSWGP
· Permit Coverage Letter
· SWPPP
· Site Log Book
Permit documentation will be provided within 14 days of receipt of a written request from
Ecology. A copy of the SWPPP or access to the SWPPP will be provided to the public when
requested in writing in accordance with Special Condition S5.G.2.b of the CSWGP.
6.1.3 Updating the SWPPP
The SWPPP will be modified if:
· Found ineffective in eliminating or significantly minimizing pollutants in stormwater
discharges from the site.
· There is a change in design, construction, operation, or maintenance at the construction
site that has, or could have, a significant effect on the discharge of pollutants to waters
of the State.
The SWPPP will be modified within seven (7) days if inspection(s) or investigation(s) determine
additional or modified BMPs are necessary for compliance. An updated timeline for BMP
implementation will be prepared.
P a g e | 26
6.2 Reporting
6.2.1 Discharge Monitoring Reports
Cumulative soil disturbance is less than one (1) acre; therefore, Discharge Monitoring
Reports (DMRs) will not be submitted to Ecology because water quality sampling is not being
conducted at the site.
6.2.2 Notification of Noncompliance
If any of the terms and conditions of the permit is not met, and the resulting noncompliance may
cause a threat to human health or the environment, the following actions will be taken:
1. Ecology will be notified within 24-hours of the failure to comply by calling the applicable
Regional office ERTS phone number (Regional office numbers listed below).
2. Immediate action will be taken to prevent the discharge/pollution or otherwise stop or
correct the noncompliance. If applicable, sampling and analysis of any noncompliance
will be repeated immediately, and the results submitted to Ecology within five (5) days of
becoming aware of the violation.
3. A detailed written report describing the noncompliance will be submitted to Ecology
within five (5) days, unless requested earlier by Ecology.
P a g e | 27
Appendix/Glossary
A. Site Map and Select Construction Drawings
B. BMP Detail
C. Site Inspection Form
D. Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP)
Appendix A
Site Map and Select Construction Drawings
GIS Data Source: King C ounty G IS
Data sources supplied may not reflect current or actual conditions. This m ap
is a geographic representation based on inform ation available. It does not
represent survey data. No warranty is made concerning the accuracy, currency,
or completeness of data depicted on this map.
BH C Consultants LLC., assum es no responsibility for the validity of any
information presented herein, nor any responsibility for the use or m isuse of the data.
P:\Mapping\Maps_Generated\Renton\22-10795.00\600\mxd\Fig 1 Vicinity Map - 11x17.mxd 6/2/2023 dknight
COPYRIGHT © 2023 BHC CO NSULTANTS LLC., ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Wind so r Hills Utility Improvements
City of R enton
FigureVicinity Map
1June 2023
Legend
Project Area
Renton City
Boundary
0 1,200 2,400600
Feet $April 2024
GIS Data Source: King C ounty G IS
Data sources supplied may not reflect current or actual conditions. This m ap
is a geographic representation based on inform ation available. It does not
represent survey data. No warranty is made concerning the accuracy, currency,
or completeness of data depicted on this map.
BH C Consultants LLC., assum es no responsibility for the validity of any
information presented herein, nor any responsibility for the use or m isuse of the data.
P:\Mapping\Maps_Generated\Renton\22-10795.00\600\mxd\Fig 2 Existing Conditions - 11x17.mxd 6/2/2023 dknight
COPYRIGHT © 2023 BHC CO NSULTANTS LLC., ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Wind so r Hills Utility Improvements
City of R enton
FigureExisting Conditions
2June 2023
Legend
Project Area
Public Existing
Storm
Conveyance
Private Existing
Storm
Conveyance
Public Culvert
Private Culvert
U!;Public Discharge
Point
Existing Sewer
Piping
Surface Water
Ditch
0 240 480120
Feet $April 2024
Project Discharge Point
WINDSOR HILLS UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
CITY PROJECT: 27-04186
MARCH 2024
COPYRIGHT © 2024 BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC. ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Pa
t
h
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
g
n
\
d
F
il
e
n
a
m
e
:
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
P
l
o
t
d
a
t
e
:
M
a
r
0
7
,
2
0
2
4
-
0
2
:
58
:
1
0
p
m
C
A
D
U
s
e
r
:
a
c
a
r
i
a
s
o
.
X
r
e
f
F
i
l
e
n
a
m
e
:
|
X
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
S
t
a
t
u
s
|
G-1
85of1
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.comKING COUNTY
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES INC. - SURVEY
ASPECT CONSULTING, LLC - GEOTECHNICAL
TENW - TRAFFIC CONTROL AND SURFACE RESTORATION
KING COUNTY
PROJECT LOCATION
405
5
Seattle
Redmond
2
522
90
202
18
169
167
Skykomish
Maple Valley
Bellevue
Renton PREPARED BY:
IN ASSOCIATION WITH:
LOCATION MAP VICINITY MAP
520
NTS NTS
PROJECT MANAGER
KATIE MEDINA, P.E. Kmedina@rentonwa.gov 425-430-7335
JARED McDONALD, P.E. Jmcdonald@rentonwa.gov 425-430-7293
CITY OF RENTON
NE 4TH ST
W I N D S O R W A Y N E
B R O N S O N W A Y N EGRANDEY W A Y
B R O N S O N
PL
NE
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
I-405
S U N S E T B L V D N E
BRONSON WAY NE
B R O N S O N
W A Y N E
PROJECT
LOCATION
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
2
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
INDEX OF DRAWINGS G-2
2 86
M. McCrosky, P.E.
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
INDEX OF DRAWINGS
SHEET
NO.DRAWING TITLEDWG
NO.
GENERAL
1 G-1 COVER SHEET AND VICINITY MAP
2 G-2 INDEX OF DRAWINGS
3 G-3 GENERAL AND SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES
4 G-4 WATER AND WASTEWATER NOTES
5 G-5 LEGENDS AND ABBREVIATIONS
6 G-6 SURVEY CONTROL AND NOTES
7 G-7 ALIGNMENT TABLES 1 OF 2
8 G-8 ALIGNMENT TABLES 2 OF 2
9 G-9 EROSION CONTROL KEY PLAN
10 G-10 WATER KEY PLAN
11 G-11 STORMWATER KEY PLAN
12 G-12 CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING, GENERAL REQUIREMENTS, AND POTHOLING DATA
13 G-13 TRENCH DAM DETAIL
EROSION CONTROL
14 EC-1 TESC NOTES
15 EC-2 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 1+00 TO 8+25
16 EC-3 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 8+25 TO 17+50
17 EC-4 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 17+50 TO 22+50 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 29+80 TO 34+00
18 EC-5 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLANS STA 34+00 TO 42+50
19 EC-6 GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 42+50 TO 47+00 BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25
20 EC-7 BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 54+00 TO 57+50 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25
21 EC-8 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 83+25 TO 88+01 WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 60+00 TO 64+50
22 EC-9 WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLANS STA 64+50 TO 73+50
23 EC-10 WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 73+50 TO 75+76 BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 800+00 TO 802+10
24 EC-11 DITCH TESC PLAN
WATER
25 W-1 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 0+80 TO 4+50
26 W-2 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 4+50 TO 8+25
27 W-3 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 8+25 TO 13+00
28 W-4 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 13+00 TO 17+50
29 W-5 BRONSON WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 17+50 TO 22+50
30 W-6 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 29+80 TO 34+00
31 W-7 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 34+00 TO 38+50
32 W-8 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 38+50 TO 42+50
33 W-9 GRANDEY WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 42+50 TO 47+00
34 W-10 BRONSON PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 49+80 TO 54+00
35 W-11 BRONSON PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 54+00 TO 57+50
36 W-12 WINDSOR PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 79+80 TO 83+25
37 W-13 WINDSOR PL NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 83+25 TO 88+00
38 W-14 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 59+80 TO 64+50
39 W-15 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 64+50 TO 69+50
40 W-16 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 69+50 TO 73+50
41 W-17 WINDSOR WAY NE WATER MAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 73+50 TO 75+76
42 W-18 VUEMONT PL NE WATER MAIN STA 700+00 TO 702+00
43 W-19 1" WATER SERVICE CONNECTION DETAILS FOR 5/8" x 3/4" AND 1" METERS
44 W-20 WATER SERVICE CONNECTION DETAILS FOR 1 1/2" METER
45 W-21 1 1/2" METER MATERIAL LIST
46 W-22 WATER MAIN CONNECTIONS DETAILS
47 W-23 WATER MAIN POLYPIGGING PLAN
STORMWATER
48 SD-1 BRONSON WAY NE STORM DRAIN PLAN AND PROFILE STA 1+00 TO 4+50
49 SD-2 BRONSON WAY NE STA 4+50 TO 8+25
50 SD-3 BRONSON WAY NE STA 8+25 TO 13+00
51 SD-4 BRONSON WAY NE STA14+25 TO 18+50
52 SD-5 BRONSON WAY NE STA17+50 TO 22+50
53 SD-6 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 30+00 TO 34+00
54 SD-7 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 8+00 TO 13+00
55 SD-8 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 38+50 TO 42+50
56 SD-9 GRANDEY WAY NE STA 42+50 TO 47+00
57 SD-10 BRONSON PL NE STA 80+00 TO 83+25
58 SD-11 BRONSON PL NE STA 54+00 TO 57+50
59 SD-12 WINDSOR PL NE STA 80+00 TO 83+25
60 SD-13 WINDSOR PL NE STA 83+25 TO 88+00
61 SD-14 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 60+00 TO 64+50
62 SD-15 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 64+50 TO 69+50
63 SD-16 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 69+50 TO 73+50
64 SD-17 WINDSOR WAY NE STA 73+50 TO 75+76
65 SD-18 VUEMONT PL NE STA 700+00 TO 702+00 AND STORM STRUCTURE TABLE
66 SD-19 GRANDEY WAY DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
67 SD-20 BRONSON WAY NE DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
68 SD-21 BRONSON WAY NE DITCH PLAN AND PROFILE
69 SD-22 STORMWATER DETAILS
RESTORATION
70 R-1 RESTORATION KEY PLAN
71 R-2 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 1+00 TO 7+00
72 R-3 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 7+00 TO 13+00
73 R-4 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 13+00 TO 19+50
74 R-5 BRONSON WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 19+50 TO 22+50
75 R-6 GRANDEY WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 38+00 TO 44+50
76 R-7 GRANDEY WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 31+50 TO 38+50
77 R-8 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 61+00 TO 67+00
78 R-9 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 67+00 TO 72+50
79 R-10 WINDSOR WAY NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 72+50 TO 76+00
80 R-11 WINDSOR PL NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 80+50 TO 84+00
81 R-12 BRONSON PL NE RESTORATION PLAN STA 51+00 TO 57+00
82 R-13 DRIVEWAY DETAILS
TRAFFIC CONTROL
83 TC-1 WINDSOR WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
84 TC-2 WINDSOR PL & BRONSON PL NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
85 TC-3 BRONSON WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
86 TC-4 GRANDEY WAY NE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN
SHEET
NO.DRAWING TITLEDWG
NO.
GENERAL NOTES SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES (CONT.)
SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE NOTES
1. NOT USED
2. NOT USED
3. ALL STORM DRAINAGE IMPROVEMENTS SHALL BE DESIGNED AND CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LATEST
EDITION OF THE CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM), RENTON MUNICIPAL CODE
(RMC), AND THE STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS FOR ROAD, BRIDGE AND MUNICIPAL CONSTRUCTION PREPARED BY
WSDOT AND THE AMERICAN PUBLIC WORKS ASSOCIATION (APWA).
4. NOT USED
5. NOT USED
6. NOT USED
7. ALL UTILITY TRENCH BACKFILL AND ROADWAY SUBGRADE SHALL BE COMPACTED TO 95% MAXIMUM DRY DENSITY
PER SECTION 2-03.3(14)D - COMPACTION AND MOISTURE CONTROL TESTS OF THE WSDOT STANDARD
SPECIFICATIONS.
8. NOT USED.
9. ALL PIPE AND STRUCTURES SHALL BE STAKED FOR SURVEY LINE AND GRADE PRIOR TO THE START OF
CONSTRUCTION. WHERE SHOWN ON THE PLANS OR WHERE DIRECTED BY THE CITY, THE EXISTING MANHOLES,
CATCH BASINS, OR INLETS SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO THE GRADE AS STAKED.
10. NOT USED
11. ALL PIPE AND APPURTENANCES SHALL BE LAID ON A PROPERLY PREPARED FOUNDATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE
CURRENT STATE OF WASHINGTON STANDARD SPECIFICATION FOR ROAD AND BRIDGE CONSTRUCTION. THIS SHALL
INCLUDE NECESSARY LEVELING OF THE TRENCH BOTTOM OR THE TOP OF THE FOUNDATION MATERIAL, AS WELL AS
PLACEMENT AND COMPACTION OF REQUIRED BEDDING MATERIAL TO UNIFORM GRADE SO THAT THE ENTIRE LENGTH
OF THE PIPE WILL BE SUPPORTED ON A UNIFORMLY DENSE, UNYIELDING BASE. ALL PIPE BEDDING AND BACKFILL
SHALL BE AS SHOWN ON THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 220.00, 220.10, AND 220.20.
12. NOT USED.
13. ALL DRAINAGE STRUCTURES SUCH AS CATCH BASINS AND MANHOLES SHALL BE FITTED WITH DUCTILE IRON,
BOLT-LOOKING LIDS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 204.10, 204.20, 204.30, 204.40, AND 204.50. STRUCTURES SHALL
HAVE:
·RECTANGULAR OR ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND OUTSIDE OF THE ROADWAY.
·ROUND, SOLID LIDS WHEN NOT COLLECTING RUNOFF, AND LOCATED WITHIN THE ROADWAY, BUT OUTSIDE OF
THE CURB/GUTTER LINE.
·ROUND, SOLID LIDS DISPLAYING THE CITY LOGO WHEN WITHIN THE PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY OR IN AN EASEMENT
TO THE CITY. PRIVATE STRUCTURE LIDS OUTSIDE PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY AND EASEMENTS TO THE CITY SHALL
NOT DISPLAY THE CITY LOGO.
14. NOT USED
15. LIDS OF MANHOLES/CATCH BASINS WITHIN PUBLIC RIGHT-OF-WAY SHALL NOT BE ADJUSTED TO FINAL GRADE UNTIL
AFTER PAVING. ALL MANHOLE/CATCH BASINS RIMS SHALL BE ADJUSTED TO BE FLUSH WITH FINAL FINISHED GRADES,
UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN.
16. NOT USED.
17. ROCK FOR EROSION PROTECTION OF ROADSIDE DITCHES, WHERE REQUIRED, SHALL BE OF SOUND QUARRY ROCK
PLACED TO A MINIMUM DEPTH OF ONE (1) FOOT AND SHALL MEET THE FOLLOWING SPECIFICATIONS:
·4 - 8 INCH ROCK / 40 - 70% PASSING.
·2 - 4 INCH ROCK / 30 - 40% PASSING; AND
·LESS THAN 2 INCH ROCK / 10 - 20% PASSING.
18. NOT USED
19. THE END OF EACH STORM DRAIN STUB SHALL BE CAPPED. A CLEANOUT TOPPED WITH A BOLT-LOCKING LID MARKED
"STORM" OR "DRAIN" SHALL BE LOCATED AT THE PROPERTY LINE OR AT THE POINT OF CONNECTION OF A PRIVATE
STORM DRAINAGE CONVEYANCE SYSTEM PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 227.00.
20. ALL STORM SYSTEM EXTENSIONS SHALL BE STAKED FOR LINE AND GRADE BY A SURVEYOR LICENSED IN
WASHINGTON STATE, AND CUT SHEETS SHALL BE PROVIDED TO THE CITY PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
21. ALL NEWLY-INSTALLED AND NEWLY-REHABILITATED (PUBLIC AND PRIVATE) STORM CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS SHALL
BE INSPECTED BY MEANS OF REMOTE CCTV ACCORDING TO THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 266.00. CCTV INSPECTIONS
AND REPORTS SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY PRIOR TO RECEIVING APPROVAL TO INSTALL PROJECT CURBS,
GUTTERS AND/OR PAVEMENT.
1. ALL WORK AND WORK MATERIAL SHALL BE IN CONFORMANCE WITH THE STANDARDS AND SPECIFICATIONS OF THE
CITY OF RENTON PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT AND THE 2023 EDITION OF THE WSDOT/APWA STANDARDS AND
SPECIFICATIONS, AS APPROVED AND MODIFIED BY THE CITY OF RENTON IN THE RENTON STANDARD PLANS &
SPECIFICATIONS. A SET OF APPROVED PLANS SHALL BE KEPT ON SITE AT ALL TIMES DURING CONSTRUCTION.
2. THE HOURS OF WORK IN THE STREET RIGHT OF WAY SHALL BE PER CITY SPECIFICATIONS ON WEEKDAYS UNLESS
OTHERWISE APPROVED IN WRITING BY THE PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT, REFER TO SP 1-08.0(2).
3. THE CITY OF RENTON AND BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR EXISTING UTILITY LOCATIONS
AND ELEVATIONS. ALL LOCATIONS OF EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN ARE APPROXIMATE AND IT SHALL BE THE
CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO VERIFY THE TRUE AND CORRECT LOCATION AND ELEVATION SO AS TO AVOID
DAMAGE OR DISTURBANCE PRIOR TO COMMENCEMENT OF ANY CONSTRUCTION. THE INFORMATION IS PROVIDED
FOR CONTRACTORS CONVENIENCE ONLY. THERE MAY BE DISCREPANCIES AND OMISSIONS.
4. BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY OCCURS, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MEET WITH THE CITY FOR A
PRE-CONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE. A MINIMUM OF FIVE (5) WORKING DAYS NOTICE IS REQUIRED FOR SCHEDULING.
TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS NOTICE WILL BE REQUIRED PRIOR TO STARTING CONSTRUCTION.
REFER TO SP 1-07.6 and 1-08.0(1).
5. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL FOLLOW CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12. THE
CONTRACTOR MAY PROPOSE ALTERNATIVES FOR THE CITY'S APPROVAL.
6. INSPECTION WILL BE ACCOMPLISHED BY A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE CITY OF RENTON. IT SHALL BE THE
CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO NOTIFY THE CITY IN ADVANCE OF BACKFILLING ANY CONSTRUCTION.
7. PLANS APPROVED BY THE CITY OF RENTON, PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT SHALL TAKE PRECEDENCE OVER ALL
OTHER PLANS.
8. NOT USED.
9. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE THE CITY OF RENTON WITH AN AS-BUILT DRAWING OF THE STORM, WATER, AND
SEWER IMPROVEMENTS, WHICH HAS BEEN STAMPED AND SIGNED BY A LICENSED PROFESSIONAL ENGINEER OR
LICENSED PROFESSIONAL SURVEYOR, REFER TO SP 1-05.4
10. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL UTILITY LOCATIONS PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION BY CALLING THE
UNDERGROUND LOCATE LINE AT 1-800-424-5555 A MINIMUM OF 48 HOURS PRIOR TO ANY EXCAVATION,
REFER TO SP 1-7.17
11. A PROJECT GEOTECHNICAL ENGINEERING REPORT IS AVAILABLE FOR CONTRACTOR REFERENCE AS NOTED IN THE
CONTRACT BIDDING DOCUMENTS.
12. OVERHEAD ELECTRICAL POWER, TELEPHONE, CABLE TV, AND OTHER OVERHEAD LINES ARE GENERALLY NOT
SHOWN. THE LINES THAT ARE SHOWN ARE LOCATED BY POINT-TO-POINT, POLE OR TOWER TO POLE OR TOWER.
DETERMINE THE EXTENT OF HAZARDS OR IMPACTS ON CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITIES CREATED BY OVERHEAD OR
UNDERGROUND ELECTRICAL POWER, TELEPHONE, CABLE TV, AND OTHER LINES IN ALL AREAS, AND FOLLOW
PROCEDURES DURING CONSTRUCTION AS REQUIRED BY LAW AND REGULATIONS. PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION, MEET
WITH UTILITY OWNERS TO DETERMINE THE EXTENT OF HAZARDS AND TAKE WHATEVER PRECAUTIONS AND
REMEDIAL MEASURES THAT MAY BE REQUIRED TO PROTECT PERSONS AND PROPERTY AND TO AVOID DISRUPTION
OF SERVICE.
13. MANHOLES, CATCH BASINS, AND OTHER STRUCTURES ARE GENERALLY SHOWN ON PLAN AND PROFILE DRAWINGS
SYMBOLICALLY. CONSTRUCT MANHOLES, CATCH BASINS, AND OTHER STRUCTURES AS SHOWN ON DETAIL
DRAWINGS AND AS SPECIFIED.
14. ALL UTILITIES SHALL BE SUPPORTED AND MAINTAINED DURING CONSTRUCTION (INCLUDING THOSE IDENTIFIED AS
ABANDONED OR TO BE ABANDONED).
15. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROTECT PUBLIC AND PRIVATE PROPERTY. PROPERTY DISTURBED DURING CONSTRUCTION
TO BE RESTORED TO EXISTING CONDITIONS UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED BY THE CITY. THE CONTRACTOR IS
RESPONSIBLE FOR IDENTIFYING AND DOCUMENTING ANY DAMAGE THAT IS PRE-EXISTING OR CAUSED BY OTHERS.
REFER TO SS 1-07.16 AND SP 1-07.16.
16. PROTECTION OF THE ENVIRONMENT: NO CONSTRUCTION RELATED ACTIVITY SHALL CONTRIBUTE TO THE
DEGRADATION OF THE ENVIRONMENT, ALLOW MATERIAL TO ENTER SURFACE OR GROUND WATERS, OR ALLOW
PARTICULATE EMISSIONS TO THE ATMOSPHERE, WHICH EXCEED STATE OR FEDERAL STANDARDS. ANY ACTIONS
THAT POTENTIALLY ALLOW A DISCHARGE TO STATE WATERS MUST HAVE PRIOR APPROVAL OF THE STATE OF
WASHINGTON, DEPARTMENT OF ECOLOGY.
17. ALL DISTANCES SHOWN ON THE DRAWINGS AND DESCRIBED IN THE SPECIFICATIONS SHALL BE INTERPRETED TO REFER TO
THE HORIZONTALLY AND VERTICALLY PROJECTED PLANES UNLESS OTHERWISE INDICATED. LINEAL FOOTAGE OF PIPING
SHOWN ON THE DRAWINGS REFERS TO HORIZONTAL LENGTH. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL DIMENSIONS BEFORE
STARTING WORK AND SHALL IMMEDIATELY NOTIFY THE ENGINEER OF ANY DISCREPANCIES.
18. SYSTEM OPERATION AND SERVICES SHALL BE MAINTAINED DURING CONSTRUCTION. SOME DWGS HAVE SPECIFIC
SEQUENCING REQUIREMENTS TO MAINTAIN SERVICE. SEE NOTE 12 ON DWG G-12.
19. ALL EXCAVATIONS ADJACENT TO POWER POLES OR OTHER RELATED FACILITIES (VAULTS, HANDHOLES, ETC.) SHALL COMPLY
WITH WAC 296-155, PART N, EXCAVATION, TRENCHING AND SHORING. POLE PROTECTION/ SUPPORTING SYSTEMS USED
WHILE EXCAVATING SHALL COMPLY WITH WAC 155-655 GENERAL PROTECTION REQUIREMENTS, ITEM (9) AND SHALL NOT
AFFECT THE STRUCTURAL INTEGRITY OF POLES WHILE THE SYSTEMS ARE IN PLACE OR AFTER THE SYSTEMS HAVE BEEN
REMOVED.
20. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR FULL RESTORATION OF ALL EXISTING FEATURES DISTURBED DURING
CONSTRUCTION TO THEIR ORIGINAL CONDITION UNLESS OTHERWISE INDICATED BY THE ENGINEER. ALL MATERIALS USED
FOR THE CONSTRUCTION SHALL BE NEW AND UNDAMAGED, AND CATALOG CUTS FOR ALL MATERIALS SHALL BE
APPROVED IN WRITING BY THE CITY PRIOR TO BRINGING ANY MATERIALS ON SITE.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
3
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
GENERAL AND SURFACE WATER DRAINAGE
NOTES G-3
3 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
22. ALL STORM SYSTEMS AND CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING MAINS SHALL BE TESTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION
7-04.3(1) OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS AND IN THE THE PRESENCE OF A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE
CITY. STORM DRAIN STUBS SHALL BE TESTED FOR ACCEPTANCE AT THE SAME TIME THE MAIN STORM IS TESTED.
23. FOR ALL DISTURBED PERVIOUS AREAS (COMPACTED, GRADED, LANDSCAPED, ETC.) OF THE DEVELOPMENT
SITE, TO MAINTAIN THE MOISTURE CAPACITY OF THE SOIL EITHER STOCKPILE AND REDISTRIBUTE THE
EXISTING DUFF LAYER AND NATIVE TOPSOIL OR AMEND THE SOIL WITH COMPOST IN ACCORDANCE WITH
STANDARD PLAN 264.00.
24. ISSUANCE OF THE BUILDING OR CONSTRUCTION PERMITS BY THE CITY DOES NOT RELIEVE THE
CONTRACTOR OF THE CONTINUING LEGAL OBLIGATION AND/OR LIABILITY CONNECTED WITH STORMWATER
DISPOSAL. THE CITY DOES NOT ACCEPT ANY OBLIGATION FOR THE PROPER FUNCTIONING AND
MAINTENANCE OF THE STORM SYSTEM PROVIDED DURING CONSTRUCTION.
25. ADEQUATE SAFEGUARDS, SAFETY DEVICES, PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, FLAGGERS, AND ANY OTHER
ACTIONS NEEDED TO PROTECT THE LIFE, HEALTH, AND SAFETY OF THE PUBLIC, AND TO PROTECT
PROPERTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE PERFORMANCE OF WORK SHALL BE PROVIDED. ANY WORK WITHIN
THE TRAVELED RIGHT-OF-WAY THAT MAY INTERRUPT NORMAL TRAFFIC FLOW SHALL REQUIRE A TRAFFIC
CONTROL PLAN APPROVED BY THE CITY. ALL SECTIONS OF THE WSDOT STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 1-10
TEMPORARY CONTROL SHALL APPLY.
26. PROJECTS LOCATED WITHIN THE CITY'S AQUIFER PROTECTION AREA (APA) SHALL COMPLY WITH SPECIAL
REQUIREMENT #6 OF THE RENTON SWDM AND AQUIFER PROTECTION REGULATIONS (RMC 4-3-050).
27. PLACEMENT OF SURFACE APPURTENANCES (CATCH BASIN/MANHOLE LIDS, CLEANOUTS, INLETS, ETC.) IN
THE STREET TRAVEL LANE WHEEL PATH, INTERSECTIONS OF SIDEWALK OR CROSSWALK SHALL BE FITTED
WITH A NON-SLIP OR NON-SKID LID PER ADA REQUIREMENTS.
28. NOT USED.
29. MINIMUM COVER OVER STORM DRAINAGE PIPE SHALL CONFORM TO TABLE 4.2.1.A2 OF THE RENTON SWDM.
30. NOT USED
GENERAL NOTES (CONT.)
21. THESE DRAWINGS AND THE IDEAS AND DESIGNS INCORPORATED HEREIN SHALL NOT BE USED, IN WHOLE OR IN
PART, FOR ANY OTHER PROJECT WITHOUT WRITTEN AUTHORIZATION OF CITY OF RENTON AND BHC
CONSULTANTS, LLC.
22. CITY OF RENTON AND WSDOT STD PLANS REFERENCED ON THE DWGS ARE INCLUDED IN THE CONTRACT BIDDING
DOCUMENTS. SOME RENTON STANDARD PLANS HAVE BEEN MODIFIED FOR THE PROJECT. ANY OTHER STD
PLANS REQUIRED TO COMPLETE THE WORK IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS CAN BE
OBTAINED FROM THE CITY OF RENTON.
WATER NOTES WASTEWATER NOTES
1. EXISTING WATER MAINS, HYDRANTS AND SERVICES SHALL REMAIN OPERATIONAL THROUGHOUT THE COURSE OF
CONSTRUCTION. ABANDONMENT AND/OR REMOVAL OF EXISTING WATER MAINS SHALL TAKE PLACE ONLY AFTER
THE NEW MAIN HAS BEEN INSTALLED, TESTED, AND APPROVED BY THE CITY OF RENTON. REFER TO CONSTRUCTION
SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS ON DWG G-12.
2. MAIN SHUTDOWNS SHALL BE BY CITY MAINTENANCE STAFF ONLY. CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING MAINS SHALL ALSO
BE PERFORMED BY CITY FORCES, EXCEPT WET TAPS, WHICH MUST BE MADE BY CITY-APPROVED WET TAP
CONTRACTORS. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE TWO WEEK ADVANCED NOTICE TO CITY FOR SCHEDULING OF
CONNECTIONS AND SHUTDOWNS. ALL NECESSARY EXCAVATION AND MATERIALS ARE TO BE SUPPLIED BY THE
CONTRACTOR AND BE ON-SITE PRIOR TO CITY NOTIFICATIONS. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(19)A.
3. VERIFY LOCATION AND DEPTH OF EXISTING WATER MAINS AT ALL CONNECTION POINTS PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION.
THE CONTRACTOR SHALL FIELD VERIFY THE OUTSIDE DIAMETER (O.D.) OF ALL EXISTING CAST-IRON PIPES AND
PROVIDE THE PROPER LONG-BODY ADAPTERS AND TRANSITION COUPLINGS FOR THE FINAL CONNECTIONS BY CITY
FORCES. CONNECTIONS TO ALL DUCTILE IRON PIPES SHALL BE MADE WITH LONG-BODY SOLID SLEEVES (MJ).
REFER TO SP 7-09.3(19)A.
4. ALL CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING WATER MAINS SHALL BE MADE ONLY AFTER ALL THE NEW WATER MAINS AND
APPURTENANCES HAVE SUCCESSFULLY CLEANED WITH POLYPIGS, PASSED ALL PRESSURE TESTS, DISINFECTED
WITH CHLORINE SOLUTION, HAVE RECEIVED SATISFACTORY BACTERIOLOGICAL TEST LAB REPORTS, AND ARE
THOROUGHLY FLUSHED. A SUGGESTED POLYPIGGING PLAN IS INCLUDED ON W-23. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23) &
7-09.3(24)
5. NEW WATER MAIN PIPE MATERIALS SHALL BE DOUBLE THICK CEMENT-LINED DUCTILE IRON PIPE, THICKNESS CLASS
52. ALL DUCTILE IRON PIPES AND FITTINGS SHALL BE WRAPPED WITH 8-MIL BLACK, TUBE-TYPE, POLYETHYLENE
PLASTIC. REFER TO SP 9-30.1(1) & SP 9-30.1(2).
6. ALL WATER PIPES, FITTINGS, AND VALVES SHALL HAVE RESTRAINED JOINTS PER SPECIFICATIONS. ALL MECHANICAL
JOINT FITTINGS AND VALVES SHALL HAVE WEDGE-TYPE RETAINER GLANDS EQUAL TO MEGALUG SERIES 1100. ALL
FITTINGS AND VALVES SHALL ALSO HAVE CONCRETE THRUST BLOCKS PER COR STANDARD PLANS. REFER TO SP
9-30.2(6).
7. RESTRAINED-JOINT DUCTILE IRON PIPE SHALL HAVE A POSITIVE METAL TO METAL CONTACT LOCKING SYSTEM
WITHOUT THE USE OF GRIPPING TEETH. THE USE OF GASKETS FOR PUSH-ON PIPE WITH INTEGRALLY MOLDED
STEEL OR METAL TEETH (E.G. FIELD LOK GASKET, FAST GRIP GASKET, TALON RJ GASKET) SHALL NOT BE ALLOWED
AS SUBSTITUTE FOR RESTRAINED-JOINT PIPES. REFER TO SP 9-30.2(6).
8. ALL WATER MAINS 10 INCH DIAMETER AND SMALLER TO MAINTAIN A MINIMUM COVER OF 36 INCHES BELOW FINISH
GRADE AND ALL WATERMAIN 12 INCH DIAMETER AND LARGER SHALL BE AT A MINIMUM OF 48 INCHES BELOW FINISH
GRADE, UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS. WHERE UTILITY CONFLICTS OCCUR, WATER MAINS ARE TO BE
LOWERED OR RAISED BY PIPE JOINT DEFLECTION OR VERTICAL BENDS AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER TO CLEAR
CONFLICTS. PIPE DEFLECTION SHALL NOT EXCEED ONE-HALF OF PIPE MANUFACTURER’S SPECIFICATION FOR SIZE
OF PIPE USED. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(15).
9. AT UTILITY CROSSINGS MAINTAIN MINIMUM VERTICAL SEPARATION OF 18 INCHES FROM SANITARY SEWER OR
STORM DRAIN PIPE AND 12 INCHES FROM OTHER UTILITIES, MEAUSRED WALL TO WALL, UNLESS OTHERWISE
SHOWN ON THE PLANS. WHERE WATER MAIN CROSSES ABOVE OR BELOW SANITARY SEWER OR STORM DRAIN PIPE,
ONE FULL LENGTH OF WATER PIPE SHALL BE CENTERED FOR MAXIMUM JOINT SEPARATION.
10. ALL WATER MAIN VERTICAL BENDS SHALL INCLUDE VERTICAL THRUST BLOCKING PER COR STANDARD PLAN 330.3.
ALL WATER MAIN HORIZONTAL BENDS SHALL INCLUDE HORIZONTAL THRUST BLOCKING PER COR STANDARD PLAN
330.1.
11. CONTRACTOR TO PROVIDE END CAPS, PLUGS, TEMPORARY BLOW-OFF ASSEMBLIES AND TEMPORARY CONCRETE
THRUST BLOCKING, FOR TESTING AND PURITY ACCEPTANCE PRIOR TO FINAL TIE-INS TO EXISTING WATER SYSTEM.
REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23).
12. NEW WATER MAINS, HYDRANTS, AND SERVICE LATERALS SHALL BE PRESSURE TESTED AT A STATIC PRESSURE OF
150 PSI ABOVE WORKING PRESSURE WITH A MINIMUM OF 225 PSI TEST PRESSURE FOR 120 MINUTES WITH A
MAXIMUM OF 5 PSI PRESSURE DROP DURING THE ENTIRE TEST PERIOD. THE QUANTITY OF WATER LOST FROM THE
MAIN SHALL NOT EXCEED THE NUMBER OF GALLONS PER HOUR AS LISTED IN SP 7-09.3(23). ALL PRESSURE TESTING
SHALL BE DONE IN THE PRESENCE OF A REPRESENTATIVE OF THE CITY OF RENTON. REFER TO SP 7-09.3(23).
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
WATER AND WASTEWATER
NOTES G-4
4 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
R. NICOLAS
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
1. PROVIDE AS-BUILT INFORMATION SHOWING ALL INVERT AND RIM ELEVATIONS OF MANHOLES AND SIDE SEWER
VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL LOCATIONS.
2. INSTALL SEWER MAINS AND SERVICES A MINIMUM 2 FEET FROM PARALLEL GAS LINES WHERE CONFLICT OCCURS.
3. AT UTILITY CROSSINGS MAINTAIN MINIMUM TYPICAL VERTICAL SEPARATION OF 18 INCHES FROM WATER AND 12
INCHES FROM OTHER UTILITIES, MEAUSRED WALL TO WALL, UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS. NOTIFY
ENGINEER IF TYPIAL VERTICAL SEPARATION CAN NOT BE MET. 6-INCH ETHAFOAM PAD MAY BE USED IF APPROVED
BY THE CITY OF RENTON.
4. ALL SIDE SEWER COUPLINGS SHALL BE “FERNCO STRONG-BACK” OR APPROVED EQUAL.
G GENERAL
EC EROSION CONTROL
W WATER
SD STORMWATER
R RESTORATION
TC TRAFFIC CONTROL
AASHTO AMERICAN ASSOCIATION OF STATE HIGHWAY
TRANSPORTATION OFFICIALS
AB ANCHOR BOLT
AC ASPHALT CONCRETE
ACP ASPHALT CONCRETE PAVEMENT
ADA AMERICANS WITH DISABILITIES ACT
ADS ADVANCED DRAINAGE SYSTEMS (PIPE)
ANSI AMERICAN NATIONAL STANDARDS INSTITUTE
APPROX APPROXIMATE
APWA AMERICAN PUBLIC WORKS ASSOCIATION
AVE AVENUE
BF BLIND FLANGE
BGS BELOW GROUND SURFACE
BO BLOW-OFF
BOT BOTTOM
BSM BIORETENTION SOIL MIX
CB CATCH BASIN
CDF CONTROLLED DENSITY FILL
CED CEDAR
CF CUBIC FEET
CFS CUBIC FEET PER SECOND
CHLK CHAIN LINK FENCE
CI CAST IRON
C/L, CL CENTERLINE
CLR CLEAR
CMP CORRUGATED METAL PIPE
CO CLEANOUT
CONC CONCRETE
CPE CORRUGATED POLYETHYLENE PIPE
CPLG COUPLING
CRZ CRITICAL ROOT ZONE
CSBC CRUSHED SURFACING BASE COURSE
CSTC CRUSHED SURFACING TOP COURSE
CTR CENTER
CULV CULVERT
D DEPTH, DOUBLE, DRAIN
DI DUCTILE IRON
DHA DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES
DIA DIAMETER
DR DRIVE
DT DECIDUOUS TREE
DWG DRAWING
DWY DRIVEWAY
E EAST, EASTING, ELECTRICAL
EA EACH
EC EROSION CONTROL
EL, ELEV ELEVATION
EP EDGE OF PAVEMENT
EW EACH WAY
EX EXISTING
FCA FLANGED COUPLING ADAPTER
FF FINISHED FLOOR
FG FINISH GRADE
FH FIRE HYDRANT
FL FLANGE
FM FORCE MAIN
FT FEET, FOOT
G GAS
GALV GALVANIZED
GPM GALLONS PER MINUTE
GPS GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM
GRAV GRAVEL
H HORIZONTAL
HDPE HIGH DENSITY POLYETHYLENE
HMA HOT MIX ASPHALT
HP HORSEPOWER
HYD HYDRANT
ID INSIDE DIAMETER
IE INVERT ELEVATION
IPS IRON PIPE SIZE
JB JUNCTION BOX
L LENGTH
LF LINEAR FEET
LT LEFT
MAP MAPLE
MAX MAXIMUM
MB MAILBOX
MFR MANUFACTURER
MH MANHOLE
MIN MINIMUM
MJ MECHANICAL JOINT
MMA METHYL METHACRYLATE
MON MONUMENT
MPE MEDIUM DENSITY POLYETHYLENE
MUTCD MANUAL OF UNIFORM TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES
N NORTH, NORTHING
NAD NORTH AMERICAN DATUM
NAVD NORTH AMERICAN VERTICAL DATUM
NE NORTHEAST
NIC NOT IN CONTRACT
NO. NUMBER
NTS NOT TO SCALE
NW NORTHWEST
OC ON CENTER
OD OUTSIDE DIAMETER
OH OVERHEAD
OHWM ORDINARY HIGH WATER MARK
OP OVERHEAD POWER
OPG OPENING
P POWER
PE PLAIN END
PED XING PEDESTRIAN CROSSING
PKWY PARKWAY
P/L PROPERTY LINE
PLS PROFESSIONAL LAND SURVEYOR
PP POLYPROPYLENE PIPE
PRV PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE
PS PUMP STATION
PSE PUGET SOUND ENERGY
PSF POUNDS PER SQUARE FOOT
PSI POUNDS PER SQUARE INCH
PT POINT
PVC POLYVINYL CHLORIDE C-900 PIPE
PVMT PAVEMENT
PWR POWER
RCW REVISED CODE OF WASHINGTON
RD ROAD
REQ'D REQUIRED
RET RETAINING
RJ RESTRAINED JOINT
ROW RIGHT OF WAY
RPBA REDUCED PRESSURE BACKFLOW
ASSEMBLY
RPM REVOLUTIONS PER MINUTE,
RAISED PAVEMENT MARKER
RT RIGHT
S SOUTH, SLOPE, SOCKET, SINGLE
SCH SCHEDULE
SCO SEWER CLEANOUT
SD STORM DRAIN
SDMH STORM DRAIN MANHOLE
SDR STANDARD DIMENSION RATIO
SE SOUTHEAST
SERV SERVICE
SF SILT FENCE, SQUARE FEET
SMH SEWER MANHOLE
SS SANITARY SEWER
SSMH SANITARY SEWER MANHOLE
SST STAINLESS STEEL
ST STREET
STA STATION
STD STANDARD
STL STEEL
SW SOUTHWEST
SWPPP STORMWATER POLLUTION
PREVENTION PLAN
SYM SYMMETRICAL
T TELEPHONE
TBM TEMPORARY BENCHMARK
TDH TOTAL DYNAMIC HEAD
TELJB TELEPHONE JUNCTION BOX
TELR TELEPHONE RISER
TESC TEMPORARY EROSION AND
SEDIMENT CONTROL
THK THICK
TV TELEVISION (CABLE)
TVJB TELEVISION (CABLE)
JUNCTION BOX
TVR TELEVISION (CABLE) RISER
TYP TYPICAL
U/C UNDER CONSTRUCTION
UD UNDERDRAIN
UGP UNDERGROUND POWER
UGT UNDERGROUND TELEPHONE
UNO UNLESS NOTED OTHERWISE
V VENT, VERTICAL
W/ WITH
W WATER, WEST, WIDTH
WAC WASHINGTON ADMINISTRATIVE CODE
WM WATER METER
WS WATER SURFACE
WSDOT WASHINGTON STATE DEPARTMENT OF
TRANSPORTATION
WSRN WASHINGTON STATE REFERENCE
NETWORK
YRS YEARS
ABBREVIATIONS
X
LIMITS OF CONSTRUCTION WITHIN
PERMANENT EASEMENT
CENTERLINE STATIONING
TO BE REMOVED OR ABANDONED
PIPE
DIRECTION OF FLOW (PLAN)
CHAIN LINK FENCE
SILT FENCE
TEMPORARY CONSTRUCTION FENCE
STRAW WATTLE
CATCH BASIN INLET PROTECTION
CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 W/ GRATE
CATCH BASIN TYPE 2 W/ SOLID LID
CATCH BASIN TYPE 1 W/ GRATE
BIRD CAGE OVERFLOW STRUCTURE
STORM CULVERT END
VALVE
FIRE HYDRANT
WATER METER
PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE
COUPLING
FLANGE FITTING
MECHANICAL JOINT FITTING
RESTRAINED JOINT FITTING
CONCRETE THRUST BLOCK
SLOPE
DIRECTION OF FLOW
CAP
PLUG
POLYPIGGING STATION
AIR/VACUUM RELEASE ASSEMBLY
SEWER MANHOLE
o-o o-o o-o
LEGEND
EXISTING PROPOSED
WATER MANHOLE
FIRE HYDRANT
WATER VALVE
WATER METER
WATER VAULT
POST INDICATOR VALVE
POWER POLE W/ LIGHT
POWER POLE
POWER POLE ANCHOR
JUNCTION BOX
STREET LIGHT VAULT
CABLE TV VAULT
POWER VAULT
POWER/TELEPHONE JUNCTION BOX
STREET LIGHT VAULT
TELEPHONE VAULT
TELEPHONE MANHOLE
DHA SURVEY CONTROL
MONUMENT IN CASE
STORM/SANITARY SEWER MANHOLE
STORM DRAIN CATCH BASIN (TYPE I)I
STORM DRAIN CATCH BASIN (TYPE I)
YARD DRAIN
STORM CULVERT
WHEEL CHAIR RAMP
GAS METER
GAS VALVE
MAILBOX
SIGN
ROCKERY
POT HOLE
CONCRETE
PLAT LOT LINE
STREET R/W LINE
STREET R/W CENTERLINE
CONTOUR
FENCING
UNDERGROUND STORM LINE
UNDERGROUND SEWER LINE
CONIFER TREE
DECIDUOUS TREE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
5
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
LEGENDS AND
ABBREVEATIONS G-5
5 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
DESIGNATIONS
SECTION
TITLE
A
-SCALE: 1/2" = 1'-0"
TITLE
DETAIL
TITLE
1
M-1SCALE: 1/2" = 1'-0"
TITLE
4/M-1
DETAIL/SECTION CALLOUT
1
PHOTO
NUMBER
DIRECTION
OF PHOTO
PHOTO REFERENCE
1
M-1 DRAWING
REFERENCE
A
M-1
SECTION LETTER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE
SECTION IS DRAWN, DASH IF
SECTION APPEARS ON SAME
SHEET AS CUT
DASH IF SECTION IS TAKEN ON THE SAME
DRAWING, DRAWING NUMBER IF SECTION
IS TAKEN ON A DIFFERENT SHEET
SECTION, ELEVATION OR
PROFILE REFERENCE LETTER
DETAIL NUMBER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE DETAIL IS
REFERENCED, DASH IF DETAIL
APPEARS ON THE SAME SHEET AS
SHEET REFERENCED
ELEVATION
LETTER
DRAWING NUMBER WHERE
ELEVATION IS DRAWN, DASH
IF ELEVATION APPEARS ON
SAME SHEET AS REFERENCED
A
M-1
PIPING DESIGNATIONS
PIPING IS IDENTIFIED BY ITS SIZE FOLLOWED BY PIPING SYSTEM AS FOLLOWS:
NEW PIPING:
EXISTING PIPING:
FOR NEW PIPING MATERIAL, FITTINGS, AND VALVES, SEE SPECIFICATIONS.
PIPING SYSTEM DESIGNATIONS FOR EXISTING PIPING INDICATE TYPE OF
SERVICE AND TYPE OF MATERIAL IF KNOWN. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY ALL
EXISTING PIPE MATERIAL AND NOT RELY ON THIS DESIGNATION PRIOR TO
CONSTRUCTION.
PIPE SIZE
PIPING SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT DESIGNATIONS
EQUIPMENT IS IDENTIFIED AS FOLLOWS:
BOXED NUMBER DESIGNATES NEW EQUIPMENT TO BE SUPPLIED BY THE
CONTRACTOR:
UNBOXED NUMBER DESIGNATES EXISTING EQUIPMENT:
EQUIPMENT LIST IS INCLUDED FOR THE CONVENIENCE OF THE ENGINEER AND
CONTRACTOR, AND IS NOT INTENDED TO REPRESENT PRECISE LISTING OF ALL
EQUIPMENT AND DEVICES TO BE PROVIDED UNDER THIS CONTRACT.
XX-XXXX
8" W
XX-XXXX
8" W
DI GENERAL PIPE MATERIAL
DRAWING
REFERENCE
DETAIL NUMBER OR
SECTION LETTER
DRAWING REFERENCE
SEE R - DRAWINGS FOR RESTORATION SPECIFIC LEGEND.
NOTE
2+00
#
UNDERGROUND SEWER LATERAL LINE
(APROXIMATE LOCATION PER GIS)
UNDERGROUND WATER LINE
UNDERGROUND POWER LINE
UNDERGROUND NATURAL GAS LINE
UNDERGROUND TELEPHONE
UNDERGROUND CABLE TV LINE
UNDERGROUND FIBER OPTIC
OVERHEAD POWER LINE
LANE DELINEATIONS
DITCH
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
SURVEY CONTROL
AND NOTES G-6
6 85
M. McCrosky
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
SURVEY NOTES
SURVEY CONTROL
PT # SURVEY PT # DESCRIPTION NORTHING EASTING ELEVATION
1 1 MON IN CASE 181819.119 1305917.511 223.30
2 2 MON IN CASE 182293.286 1305907.472 247.20
3 3 REBAR/CONTROL CAP 181637.250 1305103.058 169.81
4 5 SCRIBED X 181637.301 1304474.387 122.28
5 6 SCRIBED X 181873.303 1304990.056 131.52
6 10 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181618.964 1306079.113 248.23
7 11 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181803.706 1306100.663 255.43
8 12 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181773.924 1305649.786 191.25
9 13 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181465.485 1305413.305 190.82
10 14 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181392.471 1305141.120 194.22
11 15 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181220.273 1304835.806 191.14
12 16 MAG NAIL/WASHER 180849.891 1304813.388 193.38
13 17 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181454.170 1304898.582 178.10
14 18 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182269.838 1305312.044 157.05
15 19 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182315.181 1305146.125 142.28
16 20 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182313.180 1304921.540 117.12
17 21 REBAR/CONTROL CAP 182130.996 1304970.591 114.24
18 22 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182069.184 1305115.024 131.51
19 23 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181472.124 1304413.897 125.08
20 24 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181314.536 1304477.880 144.41
21 25 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182065.805 1305567.432 171.64
22 26 MON IN CASE 182305.268 1305619.856 211.48
23 27 MAG NAIL/WASHER 182495.846 1305541.458 219.55
24 40 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181903.877 1305365.386 158.84
25 42 SCRIBED X 181322.086 1305018.983 192.93
26 43 MAG NAIL/WASHER 181723.615 1304690.202 125.73
27* 44 REBAR CONTROL CAP 180586.655 1304611.727 173.67
28 45 SCRIBED X 181814.454 1305383.172 160.57
29 46 REBAR CONTROL CAP 181734.055 1305460.777 169.50
30 47 TACK IN HUB 182059.632 1305159.048 137.35
31 48 TACK IN HUB 182038.776 1305208.637 138.48
32 80 REBAR CONTROL CAP 180717.094 1304783.081 190.95
33 81 MAG NAIL/PACE WASHER 182158.261 1305357.177 153.46
UTILITIES MAPPING:
ALL EXISTING UTILITIES SHOWN HEREIN ARE TO BE VERIFIED HORIZONTALLY AND VERTICALLY PRIOR
TO ANY CONSTRUCTION. ALL EXISTING FEATURES INCLUDING BURIED UTILITIES ARE SHOWN AS
INDICATED BY RECORD LOCATION OR FIELD TIED AS A RESULT OF A UTILITY PAINT-OUT DURING THE
COURSE OF THE FIELD SURVEY. DUANE HARTMAN & ASSOCIATES, INC. (DHA) AND BHC
CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO LIABILITY FOR THE ACCURACY OF THE RECORD INFORMATION. FOR
THE FINAL LOCATION OF THE EXISTING UTILITIES IN AREAS CRITICAL TO CONSTRUCTION, CONTACT
THE UTILITY OWNER/AGENCY AND UTILITIES UNDERGROUND CENTER (800/424-5555)
TOPOGRAPHIC MAPPING:
THE MAP SHOWN HEREON IS THE RESULT OF A TOPOGRAPHIC SURVEY BY DUANE HARTMAN &
ASSOCIATES, INC. (DHA) COMPLETED IN APRIL 2022. DHA AND BHC CONSULTANTS, LLC ASSUME NO
LIABILITY, BEYOND SAID DATE, FOR ANY FUTURE SURFACE FEATURE MODIFICATIONS OR
CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITIES THAT MAY OCCUR WITHIN OR ADJOINING THE PERIMETER OF THIS
SURVEY. CONTACT DHA (425) 483-5355 FOR SITE UPDATES AND VERIFICATIONS.
NOTE:
·PROPERTY LINES SHOWN HEREON GENERATED FROM KING COUNTY RECORDS, AND ARE
CONSIDERED APPROXIMATE IN LOCATION.
·SANITARY AND STORM SEWER MANHOLE LOCATION SHOWN HEREIN ARE FROM CENTER OF LID.
CENTER OF STRUCTURES ARE TO BE VERIFIED PRIOR TO ANY CONSTRUCTION.
HORIZONTAL DATUM:
WASHINGTON STATE COORDINATE SYSTEM, NORTH ZONE NAD83(91), US FEET UTILIZING RTK GPS
FIELD PROCEDURES EXTENDED FROM WSDOT LOCAL CONTROL POINTS.
CONTOUR INTERVAL: TWO (2) FOOT CONTOURS
VERTICAL DATUM:
NORTH AMERICAN VERTICAL DATUM 1988 (NAVD88), US FEET.
* POINT 27 LOCATED NORTH OF INTERSECTION
VUEMONT PL NE AND BRONSON WAY NE.
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
32
12
11
25
10
9
6 7
1
2
8
29
21
22
23
33
14
15
16
1718
5
24
28
3
13
26
4
19
20
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
27
30
31
VU E M O NT PL NE
S U N S E T B L V D N E
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
7
-
8
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
ALIGNMENT TABLES
1 OF 2 G-7
7 85
M. McCrosky
R. Nicolas
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
NOTES:
1. SEE DWG G-8 FOR ALIGNMENT TABLES.
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
VU E M O NT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E
4
T
H
S
T
S U N S E T B L V D N E
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+00 5+00
6+00
7+00
8+00
9
+
0
0
10+00
11+00
1
2
+
0
0
1
3
+
0
0
14+00
15+00 16+00 1 7 +0 0
1 8 +0 0
19+00
20+00
21+00
22+00
30+00
31+00
32+00
33+00
3 4 +0 0
35+00
36+00
3
7
+
0
0
3
8
+
0
0
3
9
+
0
0
4
0
+
0
0
4
1
+
0
0
4
2
+
0
0
4
3
+
0
0
44+00
45+00 46+00
47+00
50+00
5
1
+
0
0
5
2
+
0
0
53+00
54+00
55+00
5 6 +0 0
57+00
88+01
79+80
80+00
81+00
82+00
8 3 +0 0
8 4 +0 085+0086+00
87+00
8 8 +0 0
75+
76
59+50
60+00
6
1
+
0
0
62+00
6
3
+
0
0
6
4
+
0
0
6
5
+
0
0
6
6
+
0
0
6
7
+
0
0
6
8
+
0
0
69+00
7
0
+
0
0
7
1
+
0
0
72+00
73+00
74+00
75+00
20+00
21+00
21+75
43 +0 0
40+00
41+00
4 2 +0 043+00
9 0 +0 0
91+00
91+50
L73
C33
L74 L75
L
7
6
L77
C34
C 35
L78
L79
L80
L81
C 3 6
C37
C38
L82
L
8
3
C39
C40
L
8
4
L
8
5
L86
L87
L88
C41
C42
C43
C44
C45
L 8 9L90
L91
L92
L93
C46
C 4 7
C48
L94
L95
L96
L97
L98
L99
L100
L101
L102
L103
L104
L105
L 1 0 6
L107
L108
800+00
801+00
8
0
2
+
0
0
8
0
3
+
0
0 804+00
805+00
8
0
6
+
0
0
700+00
701+00
702+00
702+90
L118
L119
C61
C62
C63
L120
C64
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
7
-
8
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
ALIGNMENT TABLES
2 OF 2 G-8
8 85
M. McCrosky
R. Nicolas
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
NOTES:
1. SEE DWG G-7 FOR ALIGNMENT PLAN.
BRONSON - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L74
L75
C33
L76
C34
C35
L73
L77
BEGIN
STATION
0+80.00
4+97.23
5+56.64
10+25.12
10+53.95
18+04.01
19+51.85
20+26.03
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,740.51
181,157.70
181,217.11
181,586.64
181,598.22
182,227.27
182,301.85
182,299.78
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,796.94
1,304,802.36
1,304,803.13
1,305,048.05
1,305,074.45
1,305,320.03
1,305,202.33
1,305,128.18
END
STATION
4+97.23
5+56.64
10+25.12
10+53.95
18+04.01
19+51.85
20+26.03
22+22.29
END
NORTHING
181,157.70
181,217.11
181,586.64
181,598.22
182,227.27
182,301.85
182,299.78
182,294.30
END
EASTING
1,304,802.36
1,304,803.13
1,305,048.05
1,305,074.45
1,305,320.03
1,305,202.33
1,305,128.18
1,304,932.00
DISTANCE
417.23
59.41
28.83
74.18
196.26
BEARING
N0°44'42"E
N0°44'23"E
N66°19'32"E
S88°24'02"W
S88°24'02"W
RADIUS
409.30
477.50
124.77
TANGENT
263.68
477.50
83.98
CURVE
LENGTH
468.48
750.06
147.84
DELTA
65°34'50"
90°00'00"
67°53'19"
GRANDEY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L78
C36
L79
C37
L80
L81
C38
BEGIN
STATION
29+80.00
32+16.39
34+90.82
34+91.02
37+67.73
37+67.75
40+83.98
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,243.74
181,274.95
181,464.00
181,464.20
181,683.19
181,683.19
181,810.17
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,824.39
1,304,590.07
1,304,424.33
1,304,424.33
1,304,567.24
1,304,567.26
1,304,856.87
END
STATION
32+16.39
34+90.82
34+91.02
37+67.73
37+67.75
40+83.98
47+05.40
END
NORTHING
181,274.95
181,464.00
181,464.20
181,683.19
181,683.19
181,810.17
182,319.50
END
EASTING
1,304,590.07
1,304,424.33
1,304,424.33
1,304,567.24
1,304,567.26
1,304,856.87
1,305,124.85
DISTANCE
236.39
0.20
0.02
316.23
BEARING
N82°24'48"W
N0°04'01"W
N66°19'32"E
N66°19'32"E
RADIUS
190.95
238.80
461.50
TANGENT
167.01
156.24
368.08
CURVE
LENGTH
274.44
276.71
621.42
DELTA
82°20'47"
66°23'33"
77°09'00"
BRONSON PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L82
C39
C40
L83
BEGIN
STATION
49+80.00
50+88.92
56+32.68
57+06.43
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,927.24
181,970.97
182,427.97
182,494.90
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,331.25
1,305,431.00
1,305,553.16
1,305,559.69
END
STATION
50+88.92
56+32.68
57+06.43
57+54.57
END
NORTHING
181,970.97
182,427.97
182,494.90
182,527.22
END
EASTING
1,305,431.00
1,305,553.16
1,305,559.69
1,305,595.37
DISTANCE
108.92
48.14
BEARING
N66°19'32"E
N47°49'51"E
RADIUS
301.60
50.00
TANGENT
381.20
45.43
CURVE
LENGTH
543.76
73.75
DELTA
103°17'58"
84°30'54"
WINDSOR PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L92
L93
L91
C46
L89
C47
L90
C48
BEGIN
STATION
79+80.00
80+00.00
81+01.61
81+73.90
83+05.38
83+07.96
84+91.79
86+95.79
BEGIN
NORTHING
182,305.48
182,305.35
182,304.70
182,303.97
182,235.41
182,233.04
182,054.18
181,850.21
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,587.36
1,305,607.36
1,305,708.96
1,305,781.25
1,305,885.04
1,305,886.07
1,305,921.81
1,305,917.97
END
STATION
80+00.00
81+01.61
81+73.90
83+05.38
83+07.96
84+91.79
86+95.79
88+01.04
END
NORTHING
182,305.35
182,304.70
182,303.97
182,235.41
182,233.04
182,054.18
181,850.21
181,749.69
END
EASTING
1,305,607.36
1,305,708.96
1,305,781.25
1,305,885.04
1,305,886.07
1,305,921.81
1,305,917.97
1,305,944.36
DISTANCE
20.00
101.61
72.29
2.58
204.00
BEARING
S89°37'59"E
S89°37'59"E
S89°25'18"E
S23°40'48"E
S1°04'46"W
RADIUS
114.60
425.39
191.00
TANGENT
74.05
93.37
54.00
CURVE
LENGTH
131.48
183.82
105.25
DELTA
65°44'11"
24°45'34"
31°34'25"
WINDSOR WAY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L84
L85
C41
L86
C42
L87
C43
L88
C44
C45
BEGIN
STATION
59+50.00
61+43.27
61+57.14
62+52.38
64+11.19
68+99.76
69+14.11
72+12.45
72+14.32
73+61.37
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,227.06
181,302.52
181,308.94
181,344.14
181,379.06
181,665.13
181,677.75
181,820.63
181,820.60
181,749.69
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,757.97
1,304,935.90
1,304,948.20
1,305,036.26
1,305,191.18
1,305,569.00
1,305,575.83
1,305,820.93
1,305,822.80
1,305,944.36
END
STATION
61+43.27
61+57.14
62+52.38
64+11.19
68+99.76
69+14.11
72+12.45
72+14.32
73+61.37
75+76.14
END
NORTHING
181,302.52
181,308.94
181,344.14
181,379.06
181,665.13
181,677.75
181,820.63
181,820.60
181,749.69
181,656.32
END
EASTING
1,304,935.90
1,304,948.20
1,305,036.26
1,305,191.18
1,305,569.00
1,305,575.83
1,305,820.93
1,305,822.80
1,305,944.36
1,306,125.33
DISTANCE
193.27
13.87
158.81
14.35
1.87
BEARING
N67°01'14"E
N62°25'38"E
N77°17'42"E
N28°24'15"E
S88°54'14"E
RADIUS
299.25
573.00
272.90
143.85
191.00
TANGENT
48.03
260.24
166.05
80.67
120.35
CURVE
LENGTH
95.24
488.56
298.34
147.05
214.78
DELTA
18°14'06"
48°51'10"
62°38'14"
58°34'08"
64°25'43"
SD3 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L94
L95
L96
L97
BEGIN
STATION
20+00.00
20+12.90
20+44.12
21+40.50
BEGIN
NORTHING
182,105.43
182,098.73
182,082.53
182,051.94
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,085.77
1,305,096.79
1,305,123.47
1,305,214.87
END
STATION
20+12.90
20+44.12
21+40.50
21+74.56
END
NORTHING
182,098.73
182,082.53
182,051.94
182,042.49
END
EASTING
1,305,096.79
1,305,123.47
1,305,214.87
1,305,247.59
DISTANCE
12.90
31.22
96.38
34.06
BEARING
S58°43'34"E
S58°43'34"E
S71°29'40"E
S73°53'41"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
SD-06 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L103
L104
L105
L106
L107
L108
BEGIN
STATION
40+00.00
40+12.50
40+43.67
40+59.28
41+77.86
42+50.13
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,872.44
181,865.30
181,847.51
181,838.90
181,761.04
181,689.89
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,301.82
1,305,312.08
1,305,337.68
1,305,350.70
1,305,440.13
1,305,452.85
END
STATION
40+12.50
40+43.67
40+59.28
41+77.86
42+50.13
43+00.13
END
NORTHING
181,865.30
181,847.51
181,838.90
181,761.04
181,689.89
181,651.92
END
EASTING
1,305,312.08
1,305,337.68
1,305,350.70
1,305,440.13
1,305,452.85
1,305,485.39
DISTANCE
12.50
31.17
15.61
118.57
72.28
50.00
BEARING
S55°12'19"E
S55°12'19"E
S56°30'24"E
S48°57'09"E
S10°08'36"E
S40°35'34"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
SD-05 - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L98
L99
L100
L101
L102
BEGIN
STATION
90+00.00
90+27.65
90+59.30
90+68.95
91+19.96
BEGIN
NORTHING
181,658.11
181,634.42
181,607.34
181,598.85
181,557.68
BEGIN
EASTING
1,305,096.40
1,305,110.65
1,305,127.03
1,305,131.64
1,305,161.76
END
STATION
90+27.65
90+59.30
90+68.95
91+19.96
91+50.09
END
NORTHING
181,634.42
181,607.34
181,598.85
181,557.68
181,531.59
END
EASTING
1,305,110.65
1,305,127.03
1,305,131.64
1,305,161.76
1,305,176.82
DISTANCE
27.65
31.65
9.66
51.01
30.13
BEARING
S31°02'34"E
S31°09'53"E
S28°31'46"E
S36°11'10"E
S29°59'19"E
RADIUS TANGENT
CURVE
LENGTH DELTA
BRONSON WAY - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L118
C61
C62
L119
C63
BEGIN
STATION
800+00.00
800+68.77
802+13.49
803+98.89
804+68.65
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,537.96
180,598.25
180,705.23
180,847.30
180,911.35
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,607.47
1,304,640.54
1,304,736.14
1,304,851.62
1,304,879.27
END
STATION
800+68.77
802+13.49
803+98.89
804+68.65
806+00.00
END
NORTHING
180,598.25
180,705.23
180,847.30
180,911.35
181,024.15
END
EASTING
1,304,640.54
1,304,736.14
1,304,851.62
1,304,879.27
1,304,945.89
DISTANCE
68.77
69.76
BEARING
N28°44'32"E
N23°20'42"E
RADIUS
317.84
337.74
520.87
TANGENT
73.64
95.10
66.02
CURVE
LENGTH
144.72
185.40
131.35
DELTA
26°05'18"
31°27'09"
14°26'53"
VUEMONT PL - CONSTRUCTION CENTERLINE ALIGNMENT
SEGMENT
L120
C64
BEGIN
STATION
700+00.00
702+31.84
BEGIN
NORTHING
180,482.19
180,593.72
BEGIN
EASTING
1,304,709.09
1,304,505.84
END
STATION
702+31.84
702+90.11
END
NORTHING
180,593.72
180,642.38
END
EASTING
1,304,505.84
1,304,480.13
DISTANCE
231.84
BEARING
N61°14'38"W
RADIUS
50.00
TANGENT
32.95
CURVE
LENGTH
58.27
DELTA
66°46'35"
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
9
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
EROSION CONTROL KEY PLAN G-9
9 85
M. McCrosky
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
G
R
A
N
D
EY
W
A
Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
BR
ONS
ON PLA
CE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
BRONSON WAY NE
SUN SET BL VD NE
VUEMONT PL NE
B
R
O
N
S
O
N W
A
Y N
E
NE 4TH ST
1
2
3A
4
5
6
7
9
1
0
11 12
131415
16A
16B
17
18
3B
8
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
B
R
O
N
S
O
N W
A
Y N
E
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
BRONSON WAY NE
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
W
IN
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y N
E
N
E 4
T
H S
T
PLACE NE
WINDSOR PLACE NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
S U N S E T B L V D N E
VUE M O NT PL NE
E
C-10
EC-2
EC-4
E
C-5
E
C
-
3
E
C
-
5
EC-6 EC-4
E C -7
EC
-
7
EC-8
E
C
-
6
E
C
-
9
E C-10
E
C
-
9
EC-2
E
C
-
8
EC-3
EC-11
EC-11
EC-11
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING AND GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
1. WORK SHALL BE SEQUENCED AT THE CONTRACTOR’S DISCRETION. HOWEVER, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MINIMIZE
IMPACT TO THE NEIGHBORHOOD BY MAINTAINING INTERSECTIONS USED BY THE COMMUNITY FOR INGRESS AND
EGRESS AND BY LIMITING WORK TO A SINGLE STREET AS FEASIBLE.
2. DURING LANE OR STREET CLOSURE, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN LOCAL ACCESS TO ALL PROPERTIES IN
THE CLOSED AREA.
3. TOTAL ROAD CLOSURE LASTING MORE THAN TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS IS SUBJECT TO THE APPROVAL BY THE CITY
COUNCIL.
4. EMERGENCY SERVICES (253-852-2121) SHALL BE NOTIFIED TWENTY-FOUR (24) HOURS BEFORE ANY STREET OR LANE
CLOSURES.
5. RESIDENTS SHALL BE PROVIDED SEVENTY-TWO (72) HOURS OF NOTICE IF ACCESS TO PROPERTY IS IMPACTED OR IF
THE FRONTAGE ALONG THEIR PROPERTY IS IMPACTED.
6. CONTRACTOR SHALL NOT CLOSE NEIGHBORHOOD ENTRANCES FROM SUNSET BLVD NE, EDMONDS AVE NE AND NE
4TH ST SIMULTANEOUSLY. TO MAINTAIN NEIGHBORHOOD ACCESS, TWO OF THE ENTRANCES MUST BE OPEN DURING
CONSTRUCTION.
7. AT ALL LOCATIONS WHERE THERE IS CONFLICT BETWEEN NEW STORM AND EXISTING WATER, THE CONTRACTOR
SHALL SEQUENCE UTILITY INSTALLATION TO ENSURE WATER SERVICE IS PRESERVED FOR RESIDENTS.
INSTALLATION OF NEW STORM MAY NEED TO OCCUR AFTER NEW WATER MAIN IS OPERATIONAL, WATER SERVICES
HAVE BEEN TRANSFERRED FROM OLD TO NEW MAINS, AND EXISTING WATER MAINS HAVE BEEN ABANDONED.
THERE WILL BE NO ADDITIONAL ALLOWANCE FOR TEMPORARY WATER SERVICES IN THE CASE THAT EXISTING
WATER SERVICES ARE IN CONFLICT WITH THE NEW STORM UNDER THE CONTRACTOR'S SEQUENCING PLAN. THIS
SEQUENCING MAY ALLOW SECTIONS OF ABANDONED WATER MAIN TO BE CUT OUT OF THE WAY TO AVOID
CONFLICTS WITH NEW STORM PIPE ALIGNMENT AND TO MINIMIZE WATER SERVICE DISRUPTIONS FOR RESIDENTS.
THIS SUGGESTED SEQUENCING SHOULD BE FOLLOWED UNLESS THE CONTRACTOR PROVIDES IN WRITING AN
ALTERNATIVE APPROACH FOR MAINTAINING WATER SERVICE. THE ALTERNATIVE APPROACH MUST BE SUBMITTED
TO THE CITY PROJECT MANAGER 5 WORKING DAYS PRIOR TO THE ALTERNATIVE APPROACH WORK BEGINNING.
8. ALL NEW WATER MAIN PIPE AND FITTINGS SHALL BE FLUSHED AND CLEANED VIA FOAM POLYPIG PRIOR TO
DISINFECTION AND TESTING. SUGGESTED POLYPIGGING STATION LOCATIONS ARE SHOWN ON DWG W-23.
CONTRACTOR MAY PROPOSE ALTERNATIVE POLYPIGGING STATION LOCATIONS FOR THE CITY’S APPROVAL.
9. THE WINDSOR HILLS NEIGHBORHOOD HAS NARROW ROADWAYS AND LIMITED RESIDENTIAL PARKING. THEREFORE,
WITHIN THE EXISTING RIGHTS-OF-WAY, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL ONLY STAGE ENOUGH CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS
FOR THE CURRENT DAY’S WORK.
10. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL NOT LEAVE STOCKPILED MATERIAL ON CITY STREETS OUTSIDE OF WORK HOURS.
11. PRIOR TO EVERY WEEKEND, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL PATCH THE CONSTRUCTION SITE WITH HMA, STEEL PLATES,
ETC. AND LEAVE THE SITE IN A CLEAN AND ORDERLY CONDITION. ANY TRAFFIC DETOURS SHALL BE MAINTAINED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE APPROVED TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN.
12. SD-4, SD-5, SD-6, SD-7, SD-8, SD-9, SD-10, SD-15, SD-16, SD-17, SD-19, SD-20, AND SD-21, W-4, W-5,W-7, W-8, W-10, W-15,
AND W-16 HAVE SPECIFIC SEQUENCING REQUIREMENTS. SEE THOSE SHEETS FOR NOTES.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
G
-
1
2
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
20123392
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E D
M
YAT L
I
A
SD
O
M
c
R
C
O
P
R
O
F
E
SSIONAL E N G I N E ER
N
OR
YK
S
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO
03/08/2024
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCING, GENERAL REQUIREMENTS,
AND POTHOLING DATA G-12
12 85
M. McCROSKY, P.E.
P. SIMON
R. OCHILTREE, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
POTHOLING TABLE
POTHOLE
NUMBER DRAWING
ASPHALT
OVERLAY
THICKNESS
(IN)
UTILITY
TYPE
UTILITY
SIZE (IN)
UTILITY
MATERIAL
PIPE
DIRECTION
TOP OF
UTILITY FROM
GRADE (IN)
1 SD-1 4 FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 36
2 SD-1 4 GAS 4 STEEL WRAP N & S 38
3A W-6 N/A SEWER 8 CONCRETE E & W 74
3B W-6 6 GAS 1 PE N & S 30
4 SD-6 6 GAS 1 PE N & S 32
5 SD-19 5 SEWER 24 CONCRETE SE & NW 24
6 W-11 5 GAS 2 PE E & W 48
7 W-11 3 FIBER OPTIC 1 PVC E & W 34
8 SD-12 8 GAS 0.5 PE E & W 22
9 SD-15 5 GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 32
10 SD-16 5 GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 38
11 W-1 8 FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 10
12 W-1 5 GAS 4 STEEL WRAP N & S 38
13 SD-5 8 POWER 2 PVC N & S 25
14 W-5 8 POWER 2 PVC N & S 23
15 W-5 8 GAS 2 STEEL N & S 44
16A W-17 6 POWER COULD NOT LOCATE AFTER DIGGING TO 8-FEET BELOW GRADE
16B W-17 4 POWER 2 CABLE N & S 61
17 W-18 N/A GAS 2 STEEL WRAP SW & NE 38
18 W-18 N/A FIBER OPTIC 14D x 23W CONCRETE N & S 30
POTHOLING TABLE NOTE:
UTILITY POTHOLE DATA IS PROVIDED FOR REFERENCE ONLY. CONTRACTOR TO VERIFY LOCATION, DEPTH AND SIZE OF EXISTING
UTILITIES. REPORT ANY DISCREPANCIES TO THE OWNER.
CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE FOR WATER MAIN IMPROVEMENTS
1. THE CONTRACTOR MUST COMPLETE THE INSTALLATION OF EACH IDENTIFIED SEGMENT OF PIPES, INCLUDING
HYDRANTS, WATER SERVICE LINES, METER SETTERS AND RELATED APPURTENANCES AND PERFORM THE
POLYPIGGING, PRESSURE TESTING AND DISINFECTION OF THE INSTALLED SECTION OF PIPES AND HAVE IT
CONNECTED PER PLANS AND SPECIFICATIONS TO THE ACTIVE WATER SYSTEM BEFORE THE INSTALLATION OF THE
NEXT SEGMENT OF PIPES.
2. ALL WATER SERVICE TRANSFERS MUST BE COMPLETED FOR EACH SEGMENT OF THE NEW PIPES BEFORE THE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEXT SECTION OF PIPES
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO TESC NOTES EC-1
14 85
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
P. Simon
R. Dorn, P.E.
R. Ochiltree, P.E.
N/A
27-04186
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) STANDARD PLAN NOTES:
THE FOLLOWING IS A LISTING OF GENERAL NOTES THAT SHALL BE INCORPORATED IN THE EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC) PLAN SET. ALL THE NOTES
ON THE LIST MAY NOT PERTAIN TO EVERY PROJECT. THE APPLICANT OR OWNER, HEREBY REFERRED TO AS APPLICANT, MAY STRIKE OUT IRRELEVANT NOTES
IF NOT APPLICABLE TO THE PROJECT. HOWEVER, THE APPLICANT SHALL NOT RENUMBER NOR EDIT THE REMAINING NOTES. IF ADDITIONAL NOTES ARE
NEEDED FOR SPECIFIC ASPECTS, THEY SHALL BE ADDED AFTER THE ESC STANDARD PLAN NOTES.
1. BEFORE ANY CONSTRUCTION OR DEVELOPMENT ACTIVITY OCCURS, A PRE-CONSTRUCTION MEETING SHALL BE HELD AMONG THE CITY OF RENTON,
HEREBY REFERRED TO AS THE CITY, THE APPLICANT, AND THE APPLICANT'S CONTRACTOR.
2. THE APPLICANT IS RESPONSIBLE FOR OBTAINING THE WASHINGTON STATE DEPARTMENT OF ECOLOGY (ECOLOGY) CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER
GENERAL PERMIT, IF IT IS REQUIRED FOR THE PROJECT. THE APPLICANT SHALL PROVIDE THE CITY COPIES OF ALL MONITORING REPORTS PROVIDED TO
ECOLOGY ASSOCIATED WITH THE CONSTRUCTION STORM WATER GENERAL PERMIT.
3. THE ESC PLAN SET SHALL INCLUDE AN ESC CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE DETAILING THE ORDERED STEPS THAT SHALL BE FOLLOWED FROM
CONSTRUCTION COMMENCEMENT TO POST-PROJECT CLEANUP IN ORDER TO FULFILL PROJECT ESC REQUIREMENTS.
4. THE BOUNDARIES OF THE CLEARING LIMITS, SENSITIVE AREAS AND THEIR BUFFERS, AND AREAS OF VEGETATION PRESERVATION AND TREE RETENTION
AS PRESCRIBED ON THE PLAN(S) SHALL BE CLEARLY DELINEATED BY FENCING AND PROTECTED IN THE FIELD IN ACCORDANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF THE
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL (RENTON SWDM) PRIOR TO THE START OF CONSTRUCTION. DURING THE CONSTRUCTION PERIOD, NO
DISTURBANCE BEYOND THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE PERMITTED. THE CLEARING LIMITS SHALL BE MAINTAINED BY THE APPLICANT/ESC SUPERVISOR
FOR THE DURATION OF CONSTRUCTION.
5. STABILIZED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCES SHALL BE INSTALLED AT THE BEGINNING OF CONSTRUCTION AND MAINTAINED FOR THE DURATION OF THE
PROJECT. ADDITIONAL MEASURES, SUCH AS CONSTRUCTED WHEEL WASH SYSTEMS OR WASH PADS, MAY BE REQUIRED TO ENSURE THAT ALL PAVED
AREAS ARE KEPT CLEAN AND TRACK-OUT TO ROAD RIGHT OF WAY DOES NOT OCCUR FOR THE DURATION OF THE PROJECT. IF SEDIMENT IS TRACKED
OFFSITE, PUBLIC ROADS SHALL BE CLEANED THOROUGHLY AT THE END OF EACH DAY, OR MORE FREQUENTLY DURING WET WEATHER, AS NECESSARY TO
PREVENT SEDIMENT FROM ENTERING WATERS OF THE STATE.
6. WASHOUT FROM CONCRETE TRUCKS SHALL BE PERFORMED OFF-SITE OR IN DESIGNATED CONCRETE WASHOUT AREAS ONLY. DO NOT WASH OUT
CONCRETE TRUCKS ONTO THE GROUND, OR TO STORM DRAINS OR OPEN DITCHES. ON-SITE DUMPING OF EXCESS CONCRETE SHALL ONLY OCCUR IN
DESIGNATED CONCRETE WASHOUT AREAS.
7. ALL REQUIRED ESC BMPS SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED AND IN OPERATION PRIOR TO LAND CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION TO PREVENT
TRANSPORTATION OF SEDIMENT TO SURFACE WATER, DRAINAGE SYSTEMS AND ADJACENT PROPERTIES. ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE MAINTAINED IN A
SATISFACTORY CONDITION UNTIL SUCH TIME THAT CLEARING AND/OR CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE AND POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE EROSION HAS PASSED.
ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED AFTER CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETED AND THE SITE HAS BEEN STABILIZED TO ENSURE POTENTIAL FOR ON-SITE
EROSION DOES NOT EXIST. THE IMPLEMENTATION, MAINTENANCE, REPLACEMENT, ENHANCEMENT, AND REMOVAL OF ESC BMPS SHALL BE THE
RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT.
8. ANY HAZARDOUS MATERIALS OR LIQUID PRODUCTS THAT HAVE THE POTENTIAL TO POLLUTE RUNOFF SHALL BE DISPOSED OF PROPERLY.
9. THE ESC BMPS DEPICTED ON THIS DRAWING ARE INTENDED TO BE MINIMUM REQUIREMENTS TO MEET ANTICIPATED SITE CONDITIONS. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES AND UNEXPECTED OR SEASONAL CONDITIONS DICTATE, THE APPLICANT SHALL ANTICIPATE THAT MORE ESC BMPS WILL BE
NECESSARY TO ENSURE COMPLETE SILTATION CONTROL ON THE PROPOSED SITE. DURING THE COURSE OF CONSTRUCTION, IT SHALL BE THE
OBLIGATION AND RESPONSIBILITY OF THE APPLICANT TO ADDRESS ANY NEW CONDITIONS THAT MAY BE CREATED BY THE ACTIVITIES AND TO PROVIDE
ADDITIONAL ESC BMPS, OVER AND ABOVE MINIMUM REQUIREMENTS, AS MAY BE NEEDED, TO PROTECT ADJACENT PROPERTIES AND WATER QUALITY OF
THE RECEIVING DRAINAGE SYSTEM.
10. APPROVAL OF THIS PLAN IS FOR ESC ONLY. IT DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN APPROVAL OF STORM DRAINAGE DESIGN, SIZE NOR LOCATION OF PIPES,
RESTRICTORS, CHANNELS, OR STORMWATER FACILITIES.
11. ANY DEWATERING SYSTEM NECESSARY FOR THE CONSTRUCTION OF STORMWATER FACILITIES SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE CITY FOR REVIEW AND
APPROVAL.
12. ANY AREAS OF EXPOSED SOILS, INCLUDING ROADWAY EMBANKMENTS, THAT WILL NOT BE DISTURBED FOR TWO DAYS DURING THE WET SEASON
(OCTOBER 1ST THROUGH APRIL 30TH) OR SEVEN DAYS DURING THE DRY SEASON (MAY 1ST THROUGH SEPTEMBER 30TH) SHALL BE IMMEDIATELY
STABILIZED WITH THE APPROVED ESC COVER METHODS (E.G., SEEDING, MULCHING, PLASTIC COVERING, ETC.) IN CONFORMANCE WITH APPENDIX D OF
THE RENTON SWDM.
13. WET SEASON ESC REQUIREMENTS APPLY TO ALL CONSTRUCTION SITES BETWEEN OCTOBER 1ST AND APRIL 30TH, UNLESS OTHERWISE APPROVED BY
THE CITY.
14. ANY AREA NEEDING ADDITIONAL ESC MEASURES, NOT REQUIRING IMMEDIATE ATTENTION, SHALL BE ADDRESSED WITHIN SEVEN (7) DAYS.
15. THE ESC BMPS ON INACTIVE SITES SHALL BE INSPECTED AND MAINTAINED AT A MINIMUM OF ONCE A MONTH OR WITHIN 24 HOURS FOLLOWING A STORM
EVENT. INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE SHALL OCCUR MORE FREQUENTLY AS REQUIRED BY THE CITY.
16. BEFORE COMMENCEMENT OF ANY CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY, CATCH BASIN INSERTS PER THE CITY STANDARD PLAN 216.30 SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR ALL
STORM DRAIN INLETS DOWNSLOPE AND WITHIN 500 FEET OF A DISTURBED OR CONSTRUCTION AREA, UNLESS THE RUNOFF THAT ENTERS THE INLET WILL
BE CONVEYED TO A SEDIMENT POND OR TRAP. ALL CATCH BASIN INSERTS SHALL BE PERIODICALLY INSPECTED AND REPLACED AS NECESSARY TO
ENSURE FULLY FUNCTIONING CONDITION.
17. AT NO TIME SHALL SEDIMENT ACCUMULATION EXCEED 2/3 OF THE CAPACITY OF THE CATCH BASIN SUMP. ALL CATCH BASINS AND CONVEYANCE LINES
SHALL BE CLEANED PRIOR TO PAVING. THE CLEANING OPERATION SHALL NOT FLUSH SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER INTO THE DOWNSTREAM SYSTEM.
18. ANY PERMANENT STORMWATER FACILITY LOCATION USED AS A TEMPORARY SETTLING BASIN SHALL BE MODIFIED WITH THE NECESSARY ESC BMPS AND
SHALL PROVIDE ADEQUATE STORAGE CAPACITY. IF THE TEMPORARY FACILITY IS TO ULTIMATELY FUNCTION AS AN INFILTRATION SYSTEM IN ITS
PERMANENT STATE, THE TEMPORARY FACILITY SHALL BE ROUGH GRADED SO THAT THE BOTTOM AND SIDES ARE AT LEAST THREE FEET ABOVE THE FINAL
GRADE OF THE PERMANENT FACILITY.
19. AREAS DESIGNATED ON THE PLAN(S) CONTAINING EXISTING STORMWATER FACILITIES OR ON-SITE BMPS (AMENDED SOILS, BIORETENTION, PERMEABLE
PAVEMENT, ETC.) SHALL BE CLEARLY FENCED AND PROTECTED USING ESC BMPS TO AVOID SEDIMENTATION AND COMPACTION DURING CONSTRUCTION.
20. PRIOR TO THE BEGINNING OF THE WET SEASON (OCTOBER 1ST), ALL DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE INSPECTED TO IDENTIFY WHICH ONES SHALL BE
SODDED OR SEEDED IN PREPARATION FOR THE WINTER RAINS. DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED WITHIN ONE WEEK OF THE BEGINNING
OF THE WET SEASON. AN EXHIBIT OF THOSE AREAS TO BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND THOSE AREAS TO REMAIN UNCOVERED SHALL BE SUBMITTED TO THE
CITY FOR REVIEW.
21. PRIOR TO FINAL CONSTRUCTION ACCEPTANCE, THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE STABILIZED TO PREVENT SEDIMENT-LADEN WATER FROM LEAVING THE
PROJECT SITE, ALL ESC BMPS SHALL BE REMOVED, AND STORMWATER CONVEYANCE SYSTEMS, FACILITIES, AND ON-SITE BMPS SHALL BE RESTORED TO
THEIR FULLY FUNCTIONING CONDITION. ALL DISTURBED AREAS OF THE PROJECT SITE SHALL BE VEGETATED OR OTHERWISE PERMANENTLY STABILIZED.
AT A MINIMUM, DISTURBED AREAS SHALL BE SODDED OR SEEDED AND MULCHED TO ENSURE THAT SUFFICIENT COVER WILL DEVELOP SHORTLY AFTER
FINAL APPROVAL. MULCH WITHOUT SEEDING IS ADEQUATE FOR AREAS TO BE LANDSCAPED BEFORE OCTOBER 1ST.
22. ROCKERIES ARE CONSIDERED TO BE A METHOD OF BANK STABILIZATION AND EROSION CONTROL. ROCKERIES SHALL NOT BE CONSTRUCTED TO SERVE
AS RETAINING WALLS. ALL ROCKERIES IN CITY ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH CITY STANDARDS. ROCKERIES
OUTSIDE OF ROAD RIGHTS-OF-WAY SHALL BE CONSTRUCTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE INTERNATIONAL BUILDING CODE.
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 1+00 TO 8+25 EC-2
15 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MA
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
8+25
EC-2
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
4
+
5
0
-
S
E
E
A
B
O
V
E
4+
5
0
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 0 2 +1 0
E C -1 0
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
1
2
11 12
1+00
2+00 3+00 4+008
0
3
+
0
0
804+00
805+00
BRONSON WAY NE
NE 4TH ST
o -o
o -o
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
5 +0 0
6 +0 0
7+00
8+00
30+00
5
9
+
5
0
60+00
6
1
+
0
03+00
4 +0 0
5
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
W
I
N
D
S
O
R
W
A
Y
N
E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 8+25 TO 17+50 EC-3
16 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
+
2
5
E
C
-
2
1
3
+
0
0
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
1
7
+
5
0
E
C
-
4
MAT
CH
LIN
E
STA
- SEE ABO
VE
13+00
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
9+00
10+00
11+00
12+00
1 3 +0 0
3
0
+
0
0
31+00
32+00
33+00
33+59
90+00
91+00
BRO NSON WAY NE
13+00
14+00
15+00
1 6 +0 0
1 7 +0 0
5
0
+
0
0
5
1
+
0
0
5
0
+
0
0
5 1 +0 0
52+00
40+00
41+00
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
P
L
A
C
E
N
E
BRONSON WAY NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
2
-
4
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 17+50 TO 22+50
GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 29+80 TO 34+00 EC-4
17 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
1 7 +5 0
E C -3
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
3 4 +0 0
E C -5
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED TO BE
INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS CONSTRUCTION
PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR,
IMPROVE AND INCREASE MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN
WATER QUALITY STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
XX
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
13
14
15
1
8
+
0
0
19+00
2 0 +0 0
2 1 +0 0
2 2 +0 0
4
6
+
0
0
4
7
+
0
0
2
5
+
0
0
2 5 +7 5
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
G
R
A
N
D
E
Y
W
A
Y
3A
4
3B
5
+
0
0
6
+
0
0
30+00
3 1 +0 0
3 2 +0 0
33+00
3
4
+
0
0
5 9 +5 0
60+00
3+00
4
+
0
0
5 +0 0
6 +0 0
7+00
8
+
0
0
6 0 0 +0 0
6 0 0 +7 1
W I N D S O R W A Y N E
G R A N D E Y W A Y
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
5
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY TESC PLANS
STA 34+00 TO 42+50 EC-5
18 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
M A T C H LIN E S T A
- S E E B E L O W
M
A
T
C
H
LIN
E S
T
A
- S
E
E D
W
G
34+00
W
-6
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
3 8 +5 0
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
38+50
SD-7
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
4
2
+
5
0
S
D
-
9
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
34+00
3 5 +0 0
36+00
37+00
3
8+
00
1 0 0 +0 0
1 0 0 +7 5
G R A N D E Y W A Y
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
39+00
40+00
41+00
4 2 +0 0
200+00
200+75
GRANDEY WAY
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
5
-
6
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO GRANDEY WAY TESC PLAN STA 42+50 TO 47+00
BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25 EC-6
19 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
A. Cariaso
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
42+50
EC-5
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
5
4
+
0
0
E
C
-
7
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
5
19+00
2
0
+
0
0
43+00
44+00 4 5 +0 0
4 6 +0 0
4 7 +0 0
G R A N D E Y W A Y
B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
1 5 +0 0
1 6 +0 0
50+00
51+00
52+00
5 3 +0 0
5 4 +0 0
52+00 53+00
54+00
5 5 +0 0
BRONSON PLACE NE
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO BRONSON PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 54+00 TO 57+50
WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 80+00 TO 83+25 EC-7
20 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
54+00
EC-6
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
8 3 +2 5
E C -8
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
67
54+00
55+00
5 6 +0 0
5
7
+
0
0
90+00
90+75
B R O N S O N P L A C E N E
WINDSOR PLACE NE
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
8
54+00
5
5
+
0
0
79+80 80+00 81+00
82+00
8
3
+
0
0
57+06
5
6
+
0
0
57+00
7 0 +0 0
71+00
7
2
+
0
0
90+00
90+75
WINDSOR PLACE NE
BRONSO
N PL
ACE
NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 83+25 TO 88+01
WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 60+00 TO 64+50 EC-8
21 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
D
W
G
8
3
+
2
5
E
C
-
7
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DWG
64+50
EC-9
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
TREE PROTECTION
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
8 4 +0 0
85+00 86+00
87+00
8 8 +0 088+01
7 3 +0 0
7 2 +0 0
7 3 +0 0
74+00 75+00 75+75
8
5
+
0
0
8
6
+
0
0
4
0
0
+
0
0
4
0
1
+
0
0
5 0 0 +0 0
5 0 1 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
5+00
6+00
30+00
59+50
60+00
61+00
62+00
63+00
64+00
4+00
65+00
66+00
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
WINDSOR WAY NE
o
-
o
o-o
o-o
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR WAY NE TESC PLANS
STA 64+50 TO 73+50 EC-9
22 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
A
B
O
V
E
M A T C H L I N E S T A
- S E E D W G
7 3 +5 0
E C -1 0
6
9
+
5
0
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE DW G
64+50
EC-8 M
A
T
C
H
L
I
N
E
S
T
A
-
S
E
E
B
E
L
O
W
6
9
+
5
0
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
10
87+00
7 0 +0 0
7 1 +0 0 72+00
7
3
+
0
0
75+00
75+75
8 2 +0 0
8
3
+
0
0
8 4 +0 0
8 5 +0 0
8 6 +0 0
4 0 0 +0 0
4 0 1 +0 0
5
0
0
+
0
0
5
0
1
+
0
0
WINDSOR WAY NE
9
65+00
66+00
67+00
6 8 +0 0
6 9 +0 0
8 0 +0 0
8 1 +0 0
43+00
3
0
0
+
0
0
3
0
0
+
7
5
WINDSOR WAY NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
7
-
1
0
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO WINDSOR PLACE NE TESC PLAN STA 73+50 TO 75+76
BRONSON WAY NE TESC PLAN STA 800+00 TO 802+10 EC-10
23 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
KEY MAP
SCALE: 1" = 400'-0"
MATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
73+50
EC-9
M ATCHLINE STA
- SEE D W G
802+10
EC-2
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
XX
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES REQUIRED
TO BE INSTALLED BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, CONTRACTOR SHALL
INSPECT, MAINTAIN, REPAIR, IMPROVE AND INCREASE
MEASURES AS REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN WATER QUALITY
STANDARDS IN BOTH NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
B R O N S O N
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
B R O N S O N
VUEM
ONT PL NE
BRONSON WAY NE
G R A N D E Y W A Y N E
W I N D S O R
N E 4 T H S T
S
U
N
S
E
T
B
L
V
D
N
E
P
L
N
E
WINDSOR PL NE
EDMONDS AVE NE
WAY NE
W A Y N E
E
C
-
7
EC
-
6
EC-2
EC-2
E C -3
EC-3
EC-4
EC-4
E C-5
E C -5
EC-6
EC-7
EC-8
E C -8
E C-9
E C -9
E
C-10
E C-10
E
D
M
O
N
D
S
A
V
E
N
E
16A
16B
88+00
88+01 7 5 +7 6
74+00
7 5 +0 0
WINDSOR PLACE NE
17
18
800+00 801+00
802+00
00
70
1
+
0
0
BRONSON WAY NE
VUEMONT PL NE
DATE:
DRAWING NO:
SHEET:
DESIGNED:
DRAWN:
CHECKED:
APPROVED:
SURVEYED:
FI
L
E
N
A
M
E
:
S
:
\
C
a
d
\
R
e
n
t
o
n
\
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
W
i
n
d
s
o
r
H
i
l
l
s
\
D
e
s
i
gn
\
d
w
g
s
\
P
2
2
-
1
0
7
9
5
_
E
C
-
1
1
.
d
w
g
CITY OF
RENTON
Planning/Building/Public Works Dept.
SCALE:
COR PROJECT NO:
NO.REVISION BY DATE APPR
OF:
BHC Consultants, LLC
1601 Fifth Avenue, Suite 500
Seattle, Washington 98101
206.505.3400
206.505.3406 (fax)
www.bhcconsultants.com
45243
ST A T E O F WASHIN
G
T
O
N
R
E
GI S T E R E DP
R
OF
ESSIONAL E N G I N E E R
R
E
B
L DAY
O
C
H
I
L
TREE
ECC A
O V E WINDSOR HILLS
UTILITY IMPROVEMENTS PROJECT
MARCH 2024
1-800-424-5555 or 811
UNDERGROUND SERVICE
Call 48 Hours
Before You Dig
03/08/2024
ISSUED FOR BID MTM 03-2024 RLO DITCH TESC PLANS EC-11
24 85
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
S. Olsoe
R. Dorn, P.E.
B. Ochiltree, P.E.
AS SHOWN
27-04186
5
20+00
21+00
G R A N D E Y W A Y
o-o
o-o
NOTES:
1. EC SHEETS SHOW MINIMUM TESC MEASURES TO BE
INSTALLED PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION. AS
CONSTRUCTION PROGRESSES, ADDITIONAL TESC
MEASURES SHALL BE INSTALLED TO PROTECT BOTH
NEW AND EXISTING DRAINS.
o-o
LEGEND:
CATCH BASIN INSERT PER COR STD. PLAN 216.30
STRAW WATTLES PER COR STD. PLAN 213.40
SILT FENCE PER COR STD. PLAN 214.00
AND STAKE AND WIRE FENCE
PER COR STD PLAN 212.00
POTHOLE INFORMATION ON DWG G-12
TREE PROTECTION
XX
1 0 +0 0
1 1 +0 0
3 2 +0 0
3 3 +0 0
3
3
+
5
9
9
1
+
5
0
9
0
+
0
0
9
1
+
0
0
B R O N S O N W A Y N E
o-o
o-o
o-o
o-o
1
4
+
0
0
1
5
+
0
0
50+00
4 0 +0 0
41+00
4
2
+
0
0
43+00
300+00B
R
O
N
S
O
N
W
A
Y
N
E
o-o o-o
o-oo-oo-o
o-o
o-o
Appendix B
BMP Detail
APPENDIX D
CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER
POLLUTION PREVENTION (CSWPP) STANDARDS
EROSION AND SEDIMENT
CONTROL (ESC) STANDARDS
STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION
AND SPILL CONTROL (SWPPS) STANDARDS
CITY OF RENTON
SURFACE WATER
DESIGN MANUAL
June 22, 2022
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
APPENDIX D
CONSTRUCTION
STORMWATER
POLLUTION
PREVENTION
STANDARDS
CITY OF RENTON
SURFACE WATER
DESIGN MANUAL
Section Page
D.1 Principles of Construction
Stormwater Pollution Prevention
(CSWPP) D-5
D.1.1 Erosion and Sediment Control
Principles D-5
D.1.2 Stormwater Pollution Prevention and
Spill Control Principles D-7
D.2 General CSWPP Requirements D-9
D.2.1 ESC Measures D-9
D.2.1.1 Clearing Limits D-11
D.2.1.2 Cover Measures D-12
D.2.1.3 Perimeter Protection D-30
D.2.1.4 Traffic Area Stabilization D-40
D.2.1.5 Sediment Retention D-46
D.2.1.6 Surface Water Collection D-58
D.2.1.7 Dewatering Control D-66
D.2.1.8 Dust Control D-67
D.2.1.9 Flow Control D-68
D.2.1.10 Protect Existing and Proposed
Stormwater FacilitIes and On-site
BMPs D-69
D.2.1.11 Maintain Protective BMPs D-69
D.2.1.12 Manage the Project D-70
D.2.2 SWPPS Measures D-71
D.2.2.1 Concrete Handling D-72
D.2.2.2 Concrete Washout Area D-73
D.2.2.3 Sawcutting and Surfacing Pollution
Prevention D-78
D.2.2.4 Material Delivery, Storage, and
Containment D-78
D.2.2.5 Construction Stormwater Chemical
Treatment D-80
D.2.2.6 Construction Stormwater Filtration D-86
D.2.2.7 High pH Neutralization Using CO2 D-89
D.2.2.8 pH Control for High pH Water D-91
D.2.2.9 Use of High pH Soil Amendments on
Construction Sites D-92
D.2.2.10 Maintain Protective BMPs D-100
D.2.2.11 Manage the Project D-100
D.2.3 CSWPP Performance and
Compliance Provisions D-101
D.2.3.1 CSWPP Supervisor D-101
D.2.3.2 Monitoring of Discharges D-102
D.2.3.3 ESC Performance D-102
APPENDIX D CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION STANDARDS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D.2.3.4 SWPPS Performance D-103
D.2.3.5 Flexible Compliance D-103
D.2.3.6 Roads and Utilities Compliance D-103
D.2.3.7 Alternative Measures D-104
D.2.4 CSWPP Implementation
Requirements D-105
D.2.4.1 CSWPP Plan D-105
D.2.4.2 Wet Season Requirements D-106
D.2.4.3 Critical Areas Restrictions D-106
D.2.4.4 Maintenance Requirements D-107
D.2.4.5 Final Stabilization D-108
D.2.4.6 NPDES Requirements D-108
D.2.4.7 Forest Practice Permit Requirements D-109
D.2.5 Construction Stormwater Pollution
Prevention Plans D-109
D.2.5.1 ESC Plan D-109
D.2.5.2 SWPPS Plan D-112
D.3 Small Site CSWPP D-117
D.3.1 Introduction to Small Site CSWPP D-117
D.3.2 Small Site CSWPP Requirements D-118
D.3.3 Small Site CSWPP Implementation
Requirements D-120
D.3.4 ESC Measures Modified for Small
Sites D-120
D.3.4.1 Mark Clearing Limits/Minimize
Clearing D-120
D.3.4.2 Ditches D-121
D.3.4.3 Pipe Slope Drain D-122
D.3.5 Control of Other Pollutants (SWPPS) D-122
D.3.6 Small Site CSWPP Submittal
Requirements D-124
D.3.6.1 Small Site CSWPP Plan Map D-124
D.3.6.2 Features Required on Small Site
CSWPP Plans D-124
D.3.6.3 Sample Small Site CSWPP Plan D-125
D.4 Reference Section D-129
D.4.1 Standard ESC Plan Notes D-129
D.4.2 Recommended Construction
Sequence D-129
D.4.3 ESC and SWPPS Maintenance
Reports D-130
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-1
APPENDIX D
CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION
PREVENTION STANDARDS
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC)
STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION AND SPILL CONTROL (SWPPS)
Construction sites have a potential to pollute stormwater by sediment erosion and by ineffective
management of onsite construction-related activities and materials storage. The Construction Stormwater
Pollution Prevention (CSWPP) Plan is comprised of the Erosion and Sediment Control (ESC) Plan to
address erosion and sediment control requirements, and the Stormwater Pollution Prevention and Spill
Control (SWPPS) Plan to aid effective management of onsite activities and materials.
EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL (ESC)
The purpose of ESC is to prevent to the maximum extent practicable,1 the transport of sediment to
streams, wetlands, lakes, drainage systems, and adjacent properties during and following construction of a
proposed project or other land disturbing activity.2 In many circumstances it is difficult to completely
prevent the transport of sediment to these features, either because of the difficulty in removing silt and
clay-sized particles from runoff or because of large, infrequent storms that overwhelm the ESC facilities. It
is the responsibility of those involved in the design and construction of any project to utilize a variety of
strategies to minimize erosion and the transport of sediment to the maximum extent practicable. These
strategies shall include overall project planning that reduces the risk of erosion through appropriate design
and scheduling (see Section D.1) and traditional structural and cover measures, such as those described in
Section D.2.1.
Erosion and sediment control is necessary because erosion rates associated with uncontrolled construction
sites are much higher than normal rates—often a thousand or more times that of undeveloped land. The
erosion rates increase during construction due to the removal of soil cover, alteration of soil
characteristics, and changes in site topography. These vastly accelerated erosion rates, together with the
higher rates typical of urbanized areas, result in excessive deposition of sediment in water resources and
drainage facilities. This excessive erosion and consequent sediment deposition can result in devastating
1 Maximum extent practicable means the use of best management practices that are available and capable of being designed,
constructed and implemented in a reliable and effective manner including, but not limited to, consideration of site conditions
and cost.
2 Land disturbing activity means any activity that results in a change in the existing soil cover (both vegetative and non-
vegetative and/or the existing soil topography. Land disturbing activities include, but are not limited to demolition, construction,
clearing, grading, filling, excavation, and compaction. Land disturbing activity does not include tilling conducted as part of
agricultural practices, landscape maintenance, or gardening.
APPENDIX D CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION STANDARDS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-2
impacts to surface waters such as smothering of salmonid spawning beds, algal blooms in lakes, and
flooding due to obstruction of drainage ways.
Applying erosion and sediment controls to construction sites can greatly reduce the delivery of sediment to
surface waters. The chart on the next page shows how controls can significantly reduce the concentration
of sediment leaving the project site.3 Even with good controls, the concentration of sediment leaving the
site will still be significantly higher than either undeveloped or developed conditions and this may result in
significant adverse impacts; however, the likelihood of such impacts are dramatically less than if no
controls are used.
STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION AND SPILL CONTROL (SWPPS)
The purpose of stormwater pollution prevention and spill control is to prevent, reduce, or eliminate the
discharge of pollutants to onsite or adjacent stormwater systems or watercourses from construction-related
activities such as materials delivery and storage, onsite equipment fueling and maintenance, demolition of
existing buildings and disposition of demolition materials and other waste, and concrete handling, washout
and disposal.
Construction activities usually necessitate the onsite storage of earth-moving vehicles and provision for
parking for contractors and employees. Parking and typical fueling and maintenance can result in fuel
spills and dripping vehicular fluids. Construction practices often involve the use and storage of materials
such as soil treatments, flocculant chemicals, toxic solvents and building materials, and caustic concrete
materials that could cause negative impacts if allowed to leak, drip or otherwise escape into surface and
ground waters or become airborne. Concrete delivery, preparation, handling and disposal occur on most
construction sites. The resultant high pH concrete wastewater from placement and washout operations can
be toxic to aquatic resources and groundwater if left uncaptured or untreated or improperly disposed,
It is the responsibility of those involved in the design and construction of any project to utilize a variety of
strategies to prevent pollutants from entering stormwater runoff. These strategies shall include overall
project planning that reduces the risk of pollution through appropriate site management and project
scheduling (see Section D.1.1) and structural, cover, containment and handling measures, such as those
described in Section D.2.2.
Compliance with Surface Water Quality Requirements RMC 4-6-030
The City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual (SWDM), (including this Appendix D, Construction
Stormwater Pollution Prevention Standards) and the King County Stormwater Pollution Prevention
Manual (SPPM) collectively address the surface water quality requirements of the City of Renton
Municipal Code (RMC) 4-6-030. While the SWDM addresses impacts from construction, the SPPM spans
construction and post-construction time frames. For full compliance with RMC 4-6-030, the applicant
must address the requirements of the SPPM, which may include permanent structural elements requiring
separate permit review.
Organization of Appendix D
Appendix D is organized as follows:
Section D.1, “Principles of Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention (CSWPP)”
Section D.2, “General CSWPP Requirements”
Section D.3, “Small Site CSWPP”
Section D.4, “Reference Section”
3 Project site means that portion of a site and any offsite areas subject to proposed project activities, alterations, and
improvements. Site means a single parcel, or two or more contiguous parcels that are under common ownership or
documented legal control, used as a single parcel for purposes of applying for authority from the City of Renton to carry out a
development/project proposal. For projects located primarily within dedicated rights-of-way, site includes the entire width of
right-of-way within the total length of right-of-way subject to improvements proposed by the project.
APPENDIX D CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION STANDARDS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-3
MEDIAN STORM SEDIMENT CONCENTRATIONS
(METROPOLITAN WASHINGTON COUNCIL OF GOVERNMENTS, 1990)
0
500
1000
1500
2000
2500
3000
3500
4000
4500
UNCONTROLLED EROSION SEDIMENT URBANIZED NATURAL
CONSTRUCTION SITE CONDITION
SE
D
I
M
E
N
T
C
O
N
C
E
N
T
R
A
T
I
O
N
(
m
g
/
l
)
UNCONTROLLED - NO EROSION OR SEDIMENT CONTROL
EROSION - EROSION CONTROL ONLY
SEDIMENT - SEDIMENT AND EROSION CONTROL
URBANIZED - POST CONSTRUCTION (NURP, 1987)
NATURAL - PREDEVELOPMENT
4,145
680
283
50 25
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-5
D.1 PRINCIPLES OF CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER
POLLUTION PREVENTION (CSWPP)
D.1.1 EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL PRINCIPLES
This section provides basic information on the principles of erosion and sediment control that shall be
applied to all projects in the City of Renton. This section is intended to highlight certain principles that are
particularly critical to achieving effective control and that are the basis for the erosion and sediment
control requirements of the SWDM’s Core Requirement #5: Construction Stormwater Pollution
Prevention. Projects that are consistent with these principles will generally meet the intent of the ESC
aspects of Core Requirement #5 and this appendix, even if the details of the project are not entirely
consistent with City standards. If a more complete treatment of ESC is needed, there are a number of
useful references available (for example, Erosion and Sediment Control Handbook, Goldman et al., 1986).
Additionally, information on permanent erosion control in natural channels is available in the Guidelines
for Bank Stabilization Projects (King County, 1993).
Design the project to fit the natural topography, soils, and drainage patterns. Through such
practices as limiting disturbance of steeper slopes, avoiding disturbance of natural drainage ways, or
using soils with a high infiltration rate to treat polluted runoff, the characteristics of the site can be
used to minimize erosion and sediment transport.
Emphasize erosion control rather than sediment control. Erosion control minimizes the
entrainment of sediment by runoff or in the air due to wind, while sediment control removes entrained
sediment from runoff. Erosion control is more efficient and cost-effective because it is nearly
impossible to entirely remove sediment from runoff once it is entrained. Examples of erosion control
include covering disturbed soils and controlling surface runoff using measures such as dikes and lined
ditches. One illustration of the relative effectiveness of erosion control is straw mulch, which can
reduce sediment concentrations in runoff over 90%.
Since it is nearly impossible to entirely prevent erosion, it will also be necessary to incorporate
sediment control facilities such as sedimentation ponds and silt fences. Sediment controls vary in their
effectiveness, but typically reduce sediment concentrations 50 to 75%. However, sediment controls
have little effect on the very fine sediment that causes turbidity, whereas cover measures, such as
straw mulch, can be highly effective in reducing turbidity.
Minimize the extent and duration of area exposed. Restricting clearing to only those areas
necessary for construction is probably the single most effective form of erosion control. Additionally,
exposing areas only as long as necessary reduces the risk of erosion substantially. This can be
accomplished by planning the project so that areas are disturbed only when construction is imminent,
and by mulching or seeding disturbed areas as soon as grading is completed.
Keep runoff velocities low. While erosion of exposed soil begins with a single raindrop or the wind,
the largest volumes of eroded materials are typically associated with concentrated runoff forming rills
and gullies. One of the best ways to minimize erosion, therefore, is to reduce the possibility of
concentrated runoff by intercepting runoff and conveying it in a non-erosive manner to a sediment
pond or trap. This can include the use of dikes, swales, and benches to intercept runoff on slopes and
ditches or drains to convey the intercepted runoff.
Retain sediment on site. Sediment retention is less effective than erosion control measures, such as
cover, but it is nevertheless a vital part of most projects because it is impossible to completely prevent
erosion and the entrainment of sediment by runoff. Sediment can be retained by allowing it to settle
out in ponds and traps or by filtering runoff from small areas through vegetation or use of a silt fence.
Note that settling and filtration typically only remove sand-sized and coarse silt particles. Fine silts
and clays cannot be removed in these ways unless the runoff is released to vegetated areas, or unless
chemical treatment (e.g., with alum or chitosan introduction) or electroflocculation are used.
SECTION D.1 PRINCIPLES OF CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION (CSWPP)
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-6
Protect all existing and proposed Low Impact Development (LID) on-site BMPs from
sedimentation and compaction during construction. On-site BMPs rely on infiltration into the
native soils onsite. Sedimentation can clog and compaction can reduce the void space in the soil,
lessening the soil’s ability to infiltrate. Effective ESC measures can protect existing stormwater
facilities and on-site BMPs from sedimentation and intrusion by construction activities, while assuring
the areas planned for new BMPs/facilities retain their infiltrative capacity
Thoroughly monitor the site and maintain all ESC measures. Maintenance and vigilance are the
most vital components of effective ESC management. All measures require regular maintenance,
monitoring and inspection. The overall site also needs to be constantly examined to ensure that all
areas are protected, that the measures are working together to provide maximum protection, and that
all areas are mulched and/or vegetated as soon as possible.
Schedule major earthwork during the dry season. The climate in the Puget Sound region is unique
in that there are generally well-defined wet and dry seasons (see Figure D.1.1.A) and the wet season4
is characterized by a large number of low-intensity, but frequent and long-lasting, storms. As a result,
construction in the dry season5 is a very effective form of erosion control. If construction does occur
in the wet season, the need for regular maintenance is even more imperative.
FIGURE D.1.1.A YEARLY RAINFALL PATTERN
4 Wet season means October 1 to April 30.
5 Dry season means May 1 to September 30.
D.1.2 STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION AND SPILL CONTROL PRINCIPLES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-7
D.1.2 STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION AND SPILL
CONTROL PRINCIPLES
This section provides basic information on the principles of stormwater pollution prevention and control
that shall be applied to all projects in the City of Renton. This section is intended to highlight certain
principles that commonly apply to construction sites and are particularly critical to achieving effective
control. These principles are the basis for the stormwater pollution prevention and spill control
requirements of the SWDM’s Core Requirement #5: Construction Stormwater Pollution Prevention.
Projects that are consistent with these principles will generally meet the intent of the SWPPS aspects of
Core Requirement #5 and this appendix, even if the details of the project are not entirely consistent with
City standards. Additional information and BMP options other than those listed below can be found in the
King County Stormwater Pollution Prevention Manual (SPPM).
Follow effective pollutant handling and disposal procedures. Conduct handling and disposal of all
pollutants that occur onsite, including waste materials, in a manner that does not cause contamination
of stormwater. Ensure employees are following handling and waste protocols.
Provide cover and containment for materials, fuel and other pollutants. Cover, contain and
protect from vandalism all chemicals, liquid products, petroleum products, and non-inert wastes
present on the site (see Chapter 173-304 WAC for the definition of inert waste). Provide secondary
containment for onsite fueling tanks and as required for other materials.
Manage the project site to maximize pollutant control and minimize pollutant sources. Limit
onsite parking for construction equipment and contractor vehicles to a designated and controllable
area. Provide drip pans for fueling operations and disallow onsite parking for leaky vehicles. Schedule
construction and maintenance operations to avoid exposing pollutant sources to inclement weather.
Anticipate and prepare traffic routes through the site and limit traffic to those locations.
Protect from spills and drips of petroleum products and other pollutants. Limit maintenance and
repair of heavy equipment and vehicles to minor maintenance and fueling as much as possible. If
conducting maintenance or repair involving oil changes, hydraulic system drain down, solvent and de-
greasing cleaning operations, fuel tank drain down and removal, and other activities that may result in
discharge or spillage of pollutants to the ground or into stormwater runoff, provide spill prevention
measures, such as drip pans and temporary plastic sheet placed beneath the vehicle. Clean
contaminated surfaces immediately following any discharge or spill incident.
Avoid overapplication or untimely application of chemicals and fertilizers. Apply agricultural
chemicals, including fertilizers and pesticides, in a manner and at application rates that will not result
in loss of chemical to stormwater runoff. Plan ahead to avoid application prior to or during inclement
weather.
Prevent or treat contamination of stormwater runoff by pH modifying sources. These sources
include, but are not limited to, bulk cement, cement kiln dust, fly ash, new concrete washing and
curing waters, waste streams generated from concrete grinding and sawing, exposed aggregate
processes, and concrete pumping and mixer washout waters. Stormwater discharges shall not cause or
contribute to a violation of the water quality standard for pH in the receiving water.
CITY OF RENTON SURFACE WATER DESIGN MANUAL
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-9
D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
To satisfy the City of Renton’s requirements for CSWPP, the following steps are required of all
construction projects:
1. Design the plan: In accordance with Sections 2.3.1 and 2.3.3 of the SWDM, prepare and submit a
technical information report (TIR) and a CSWPP plan (comprised of the ESC plan and the SWPPS
plan) for City review. Utilize the standards and details for ESC (Section D.2.1) and SWPPS control
(Section D.2.2) of this appendix. Incorporate any City of Renton review comments as necessary to
comply with Core Requirement #5, Section 1.2.5 of the SWDM, the Erosion and Sediment Control and
Stormwater Pollution Prevention and Spill Control Standards in this appendix.
2. Construct the approved plan: Construct initial ESC, SWPPS and stormwater facility (flow control
facility, runoff treatment facility, and on-site BMP) protection measures on site according to the
approved CSWPP plan.
3. Maintain the BMPs: Inspect and maintain all CSWPP measures and stormwater facility (flow control
facility, runoff treatment facility, and on-site BMP) protection throughout construction in accordance
with the inspection and maintenance standards of Section D.2.4.4. Keep current any required
documentation and reporting.
4. Manage the project: Make any changes or additions necessary during construction to ensure that
CSWPP measures and stormwater facility (flow control facility, runoff treatment facility, and on-site
BMP) protection perform in accordance with Core Requirement #5 and Sections D.2.1, D.2.2 and
D.2.4. Coordinate construction in consideration of the applied BMP strategies. Ensure pollutant
controls, facility processes and reporting requirements are met in accordance with Section D.2.3. The
CSWPP supervisor is the primary point of contact for all ESC and SWPPP issues (see
Section D.2.3.1).
5. Conclude the plan: Prior to final construction approval, meet all the conditions in Section D.2.4.5 for
final stabilization.
A National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) General Permit for Construction (pursuant
to the Washington State Department of Ecology’s Construction Stormwater General Permit) may also be
required for projects that will disturb one or more acres (see SWDM Section 1.2.5.3 for additional
information). Proposed projects subject to Simplified Drainage Review as determined in SWDM
Section 1.1.2.1 may satisfy City of Renton CSWPP requirements by meeting the Small Site CSWPP
requirements specified in Section D.3 and reiterated in Appendix C of the SWDM titled, “Simplified
Drainage Requirements.”
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
This section details the ESC measures that are required to minimize erosion and sediment transport off a
construction site and protect areas of existing and proposed stormwater facilities (flow control facilities,
runoff treatment facilities, and on-site BMPs). These ESC measures represent Best Management Practices
(BMPs)6 for the control of erosion and entrained sediment as well as other impacts related to construction
such as increased runoff due to land disturbing activities. The measures and practices are grouped into nine
sections corresponding to each of the nine categories of ESC measures in Core Requirement #5, Section
1.2.5 of the SWDM. The introductory paragraphs at the beginning each section present the basic
requirement for that category of measures, the purpose of those measures, installation requirements
relative to construction activity, guidelines for the conditions of use, and other information relevant to all
measures in the section/category. Compliance with each of the nine categories of the ESC measures, to the
6 Best Management Practices (BMPs) means the best available and reasonable physical, structural, managerial, or behavioral
activities, that when singly or in combination, eliminate or reduce the contamination of surface and/or ground waters.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-10
extent applicable and necessary to meet the performance criteria in Section D.2.1, and compliance with the
ESC implementation requirements in Section D.2.4, constitutes overall compliance with the City’s ESC
Standards.
Note: Additional measures shall be required by the City if the existing standards are insufficient to protect
adjacent properties, drainage facilities, or water resources.
The standards for each individual ESC measure are divided into four sections:
1. Purpose
2. Conditions of Use
3. Design and Installation Specifications
4. Maintenance Requirements.
A code and symbol for each measure have also been included for ease of use on ESC plans. Note that the
“Conditions of Use” always refers to site conditions. As site conditions change, ESC measures must be
changed to remain in compliance with the requirements of this appendix.
Whenever compliance with the City’s ESC Standards is required, all of the following categories of ESC
measures must be considered for application to the project site as detailed in the following sections:
1. Clearing Limits: Prior to any site clearing or grading, areas to remain undisturbed during project
construction shall be delineated on the project’s ESC plan and physically marked on the project site.
2. Cover Measures: Temporary and permanent cover measures shall be provided when necessary to
protect disturbed areas. The intent of these measures is to prevent erosion by having as much area as
possible covered during any period of precipitation.
3. Perimeter Protection: Perimeter protection to filter sediment from sheet flow shall be provided
downstream of all disturbed areas prior to upslope grading.
4. Traffic Area Stabilization: Unsurfaced entrances, roads, and parking areas used by construction
traffic shall be stabilized to minimize erosion and tracking of sediment offsite.
5. Sediment Retention: Surface water collected from all disturbed areas of the site shall be routed
through a sediment pond or trap prior to release from the site, except those areas at the perimeter of
the site small enough to be treated solely with perimeter protection. Sediment retention facilities shall
be installed prior to grading any contributing area.
6. Surface Water Collection: Surface water collection measures (e.g., ditches, berms, etc.) shall be
installed to intercept all surface water from disturbed areas, convey it to a sediment pond or trap, and
discharge it downstream of any disturbed areas. Areas at the perimeter of the site, which are small
enough to be treated solely with perimeter protection, do not require surface water collection.
Significant sources of upstream surface water that drain onto disturbed areas shall be intercepted and
conveyed to a stabilized discharge point downstream of the disturbed areas. Surface water collection
measures shall be installed concurrently with or immediately following rough grading and shall be
designed, constructed, and stabilized as needed to minimize erosion.
7. Dewatering Control: The water resulting from construction site de-watering activities must be
treated prior to discharge or disposed of as specified.
8. Dust Control: Preventative measures to minimize wind transport of soil shall be implemented when a
traffic hazard may be created or when sediment transported by wind is likely to be deposited in water
resources.
9. Flow Control: Surface water from disturbed areas must be routed through the project’s onsite flow
control facility or other provisions must be made to prevent increases in the existing site conditions
2-year and 10-year runoff peaks discharging from the project site during construction (flow control
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-11
facility, runoff treatment facility, and on-site BMP areas [existing or proposed] shall not be used for
this purpose).
10. Control Pollutants: Stormwater pollution prevention (SWPPS) measures are required to prevent,
reduce, or eliminate the discharge of pollutants to onsite or adjacent stormwater systems or
watercourses from construction-related activities such as materials delivery and storage, onsite
equipment fueling and maintenance, demolition of existing buildings and disposition of demolition
materials and other waste, and concrete handling, washout and disposal. Section D.2.2 describes
BMPs specific to this purpose; additionally, several of the ESC BMPs described herein are applicable.
11. Protect Existing and Proposed Stormwater Facilities and On-site BMPs: Sedimentation and soil
compaction reduce the infiltration capacity of native and engineered soils. Protection measures shall
be applied/installed and maintained so as to prevent adverse impacts to existing stormwater facilities
and on-site BMPs and areas of proposed stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs for the project.
Adverse impacts can prompt the requirement to restore or replace affected stormwater facilities and
on-site BMPs.
12. Maintain Protective BMPs: Protection measures shall be maintained to ensure continued
performance of their intended function, to prevent adverse impacts to existing BMPs/facilities and
areas of proposed BMPs/facilities, and protect other disturbed areas of the project.
13. Manage the Project: Coordination and timing of site development activities relative to ESC
concerns, and timely inspection, maintenance and update of protective measures are necessary to
effectively manage the project and ensure the success of protective ESC and SWPPS design and
implementation.
D.2.1.1 CLEARING LIMITS
Prior to any site clearing or grading, those areas that are to remain undisturbed during project construction
shall be delineated. At a minimum, clearing limits shall be installed at the edges of all critical area buffers
and any other areas required to be left uncleared such as portions of the site subject to clearing limits under
RMC 4-4-060, areas around significant trees identified to be retained, on-site BMP areas to be protected,
and other areas identified to be left undisturbed to protect sensitive features.
Purpose: The purpose of clearing limits is to prevent disturbance of those areas of the project site that are
not designated for clearing or grading. This is important because limiting site disturbance is the single
most effective method for reducing erosion. Clearing limits may also be used to control construction
traffic, thus reducing the disturbance of soil and limiting the amount of sediment tracked off site.
When to Install: Clearing limits shall be installed prior to the clearing and/or grading of the site.
Measures to Use: Marking clearing limits by delineating the site with a continuous length of brightly
colored survey tape is sometimes sufficient. The tape may be supported by vegetation or stakes, and it
shall be 3 to 6 feet high and highly visible. Critical areas and their buffers require more substantial
protection and shall be delineated with plastic or metal safety fences or stake and wire fences. Fencing
may be required at the City’s discretion to control construction traffic or at any location where greater
protection is warranted. Permanent fencing may also be used if desired by the applicant. Silt fence, in
combination with survey flagging, is also an acceptable method of marking critical areas and their buffers.
D.2.1.1.1 PLASTIC OR METAL FENCE
Code: FE Symbol:
Purpose
Fencing is intended to (1) restrict clearing to approved limits; (2) prevent disturbance of critical areas, their
buffers, and other areas required to be left undisturbed; (3) limit construction traffic to designated
construction entrances or roads; and (4) protect areas where marking with survey tape may not provide
adequate protection.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-12
Conditions of Use
To establish clearing limits, plastic or metal fence may be used:
1. At the boundary of critical areas, their buffers, and other areas required to be left uncleared.
2. As necessary to control vehicle access to and on the site (see Sections D.2.1.4.1 and D.2.1.4.2).
Design and Installation Specifications
1. The fence shall be designed and installed according to the manufacturer’s specifications.
2. The fence shall be at least 3 feet high and must be highly visible.
3. The fence shall not be wired or stapled to trees.
Maintenance Requirements
1. If the fence has been damaged or visibility reduced, it shall be repaired or replaced immediately and
visibility restored.
2. Disturbance of a critical area, critical area buffer, native growth retention area, or any other area
required to be left undisturbed shall be reported to the City for resolution.
D.2.1.2 COVER MEASURES
Temporary and permanent cover measures shall be provided to protect all disturbed areas, including the
faces of cut and fill slopes. Temporary cover shall be installed if an area is to remain unworked for more
than seven days during the dry season (May 1 to September 30) or for more than two consecutive working
days during the wet season (October 1 to April 30). These time limits may be relaxed if an area poses a
low risk of erosion due to soil type, slope gradient, anticipated weather conditions, or other factors.
Conversely, the City may reduce these time limits if site conditions warrant greater protection (e.g.,
adjacent to significant aquatic resources or highly erosive soils) or if significant precipitation (see
Section D.2.4.2) is expected. Any area to remain unworked for more than 30 days shall be seeded or
sodded, unless the City determines that winter weather makes vegetation establishment infeasible. During
the wet season, slopes and stockpiles at 3H:1V or steeper and with more than ten feet of vertical relief
shall be covered if they are to remain unworked for more than 12 hours. Also during the wet season, the
material necessary to cover all disturbed areas must be stockpiled on site. The intent of these cover
requirements is to have as much area as possible covered during any period of precipitation.
Purpose: The purpose of covering exposed soils is to prevent erosion, thus reducing reliance on less
effective methods that remove sediment after it is entrained in runoff. Cover is the only practical method
of reducing turbidity in runoff. Structural measures, such as silt fences and sediment ponds, are only
capable of removing coarse particles and in most circumstances have little to no effect on turbidity.
When to Install: Any exposed soils that will remain unworked for more than the time limit set above shall
be covered by the end of the working day. If the exposed area is to remain unworked for more than
30 days, the area shall be seeded with the temporary seed mix or an equivalent mix that will provide rapid
protection (see Section D.2.1.2.6). If the disturbed area is to remain unworked for a year or more or if the
area has reached final grade, permanent seed mix or an equivalent mix shall be applied.
Measures to Use: Cover methods include the use of surface roughening, mulch, erosion control nets and
blankets, plastic covering, seeding, and sodding. Mulch and plastic sheeting are primarily intended to
protect disturbed areas for a short period of time, typically days to a few months. Seeding and sodding are
measures for areas that are to remain unworked for months. Erosion nets and blankets are to be used in
conjunction with seeding steep slopes. The choice of measures is left to the designer; however, there are
restrictions on the use of these methods, which are listed in the “Conditions of Use” and the “Design and
Installation Specifications” sections for each measure.
The methods listed are by no means exhaustive. Variations on the standards presented here are encouraged
if other cost-effective products or methods provide substantially equivalent or superior performance. Also,
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-13
the details of installation can, and should, vary with the site conditions. A useful reference on the
application of cover measures in the Puget Sound area is Improving the Cost Effectiveness of Highway
Construction Site Erosion and Pollution Control, Horner, Guedry, and Kortenhof (1990).
D.2.1.2.1 SURFACE ROUGHENING
Purpose
The purpose of surface roughening is to aid in the establishment of vegetative cover and to reduce runoff
velocity, increase infiltration, and provide for sediment trapping through the provision of a rough soil
surface. The rough soil surface may be created by operating a tiller or other equipment on the contour to
form horizontal depressions or by leaving slopes in a roughened condition by not fine grading.
Conditions of Use
1. All slopes steeper than 3H:1V and greater than 5 vertical feet require surface roughening to a depth of
2 to 4 inches prior to seeding.
2. Areas that will not be stabilized immediately may be roughened to reduce runoff velocity until seeding
takes place.
3. Slopes with a stable rock face do not require roughening.
4. Slopes where mowing is planned should not be excessively roughened.
Design and Installation Specifications
There are different methods for achieving a roughened soil surface on a slope, and the selection of an
appropriate method depends upon the type of slope. Roughening methods include stair-step grading,
grooving, contour furrows, and tracking. See Figure D.2.1.2.A for information on tracking and contour
furrows. Factors to be considered in choosing a method are slope steepness, mowing requirements, and
whether the slope is formed by cutting or filling. Sole reliance on roughening for temporary erosion
control is of limited effectiveness in intense rainfall events. Stair-step grading may not be practical for
sandy, steep, or shallow soils.
1. Disturbed areas that will not require mowing may be stair-step graded, grooved, or left rough after
filling
2. Stair Step grading is particularly appropriate in soils containing large amounts of soft rock. Each
“step” catches material that sloughs from above, and provides a level site where vegetation can
become established. Stairs should be wide enough to work with standard earth moving equipment.
Stair steps must be on contour or gullies will form on the slope.
3. Areas that will be mowed (slopes less steep than 3H:1V) may have small furrows left by disking,
harrowing, raking, or seed-planting machinery operated on the contour.
4. Graded areas with slopes greater than 3H:1V but less than 2H:1V should be roughened before
seeding. This can be accomplished in a variety of ways, including “track walking” or driving a crawler
tractor up and down the slope, leaving a pattern of cleat imprints parallel to slope contours.
5. Tracking is done by operating equipment up and down the slope to leave horizontal depressions in the
soil.
Maintenance Standards
Periodically check roughened, seeded, planted, and mulched slopes for rills and gullies, particularly after a
significant storm event. Fill these areas slightly above the original grade, then re-seed and mulch as soon
as possible.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-14
FIGURE D.2.1.2.A SURFACE ROUGHENING
50'
(15 m)
1
GROOVES WILL CATCH SEED,
FERTILIZER, MULCH, RAINFALL
AND DECREASE RUNOFF.
"TRACKING" WITH MACHINERY UP AND DOWN
THE SLOPE PROVIDES GROOVES THAT WILL CATCH
SEED, RAINFALL AND REDUCE RUNOFF.
CONTOUR FURROWS
TRACKING
6" MIN.
(150mm)
3 MAX.
SURFACE ROUGHENING BY TRACKING AND CONTOUR FURROWS
NTS
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-15
D.2.1.2.2 MULCHING
Code: MU Symbol:
Purpose
The purpose of mulching soils is to provide immediate temporary protection from erosion. Mulch also
enhances plant establishment by conserving moisture, holding fertilizer, seed, and topsoil in place, and
moderating soil temperatures. There is an enormous variety of mulches that may be used. Only the most
common types are discussed in this section.
Conditions of Use
As a temporary cover measure, mulch should be used:
1. On disturbed areas that require cover measures for less than 30 days
2. As a cover for seed during the wet season and during the hot summer months
3. During the wet season on slopes steeper than 3H:1V with more than 10 feet of vertical relief.
Design and Installation Specifications
For mulch materials, application rates, and specifications, see Table D.2.1.2.A. Note: Thicknesses may be
increased for disturbed areas in or near critical areas or other areas highly susceptible to erosion.
Maintenance Standards
1. The thickness of the cover must be maintained.
2. Any areas that experience erosion shall be remulched and/or protected with a net or blanket. If the
erosion problem is drainage related, then the drainage problem shall be assessed and alternate drainage
such as interceptor swales may be needed to fix the problem and the eroded area remulched.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-16
TABLE D.2.1.2.A MULCH STANDARDS AND GUIDELINES
Mulch
Material
Quality Standards Application
Rates
Remarks
Straw Air-dried; free from
undesirable seed and
coarse material
2″–3″ thick;
5 bales per
1,000 sf or 2–
3 tons per acre
Cost-effective protection when applied with
adequate thickness. Hand-application generally
requires greater thickness than blown straw. Straw
should be crimped to avoid wind blow. The
thickness of straw may be reduced by half when
used in conjunction with seeding.
Wood Fiber
Cellulose
No growth inhibiting
factors
Approx. 25–30 lbs
per 1,000 sf or
1,500–2,000 lbs
per acre
Shall be applied with hydromulcher. Shall not be
used without seed and tackifier unless the
application rate is at least doubled. Some wood
fiber with very long fibers can be effective at lower
application rates and without seed or tackifier.
Compost No visible water or
dust during handling.
Must be purchased
from supplier with
Solid Waste Handling
Permit.
2″ thick min.;
approx. 100 tons
per acre (approx.
1.5 cubic feet per
square yard)
More effective control can be obtained by
increasing thickness to 3″ (2.25 cubic feet per
square yard). Excellent mulch for protecting final
grades until landscaping because it can be directly
seeded or tilled into soil as an amendment.
Compost may not be used in Sensitive Lake7
basins unless analysis of the compost shows no
phosphorous release.
Hydraulic
Matrices
(Bonded
Fiber Matrix
[BFM])
This mulch category
includes hydraulic
slurries composed of
wood fiber, paper
fiber or a
combination of the
two held together by
a binding system.
The BFM shall be a
mixture of long wood
fibers and various
bonding agents.
Apply at rates
from 3,000 lbs per
acre to 4,000 lbs
per acre and
based on
manufacturers
recommendations
The BFM shall not be applied immediately before,
during or immediately after rainfall so that the
matrix will have an opportunity to dry for 24 hours
after installation. Application rates beyond 2,500
pounds may interfere with germination and are not
usually recommended for turf establishment. BFM
is generally a matrix where all fiber and binders
are in one bag, rather than having to mix
components from various manufacturers to create
a matrix. BFMs can be installed via helicopter in
remote areas. They are approximately $1,000 per
acre cheaper to install.
Chipped Site
Vegetation
Average size shall be
several inches.
2″ minimum
thickness
This is a cost-effective way to dispose of debris
from clearing and grubbing, and it eliminates the
problems associated with burning. Generally, it
should not be used on slopes above approx. 10%
because of its tendency to be transported by
runoff. It is not recommended within 200 feet of
surface waters. If seeding is expected shortly after
mulch, the decomposition of the chipped
vegetation may tie up nutrients important to grass
establishment.
7 Sensitive lake means a lake that has proved to be particularly prone to eutrophication; the City did not have any lakes that had
this designation at the time of SWDM adoption.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-17
D.2.1.2.3 NETS AND BLANKETS
Code: NE Symbol:
Purpose
Erosion control nets and blankets are intended to prevent erosion and hold seed and mulch in place on
steep slopes and in channels so that vegetation can become well established. In addition, some nets and
blankets can be used to permanently reinforce turf to protect drainage ways during high flows. Nets are
strands of material woven into an open, but high-tensile strength net (for example, jute matting). Blankets
are strands of material that are not tightly woven, but instead form a layer of interlocking fibers, typically
held together by a biodegradable or photodegradable netting (for example, excelsior or straw blankets).
They generally have lower tensile strength than nets, but cover the ground more completely. Coir (coconut
fiber) fabric comes as both nets and blankets.
Conditions of Use
Erosion control nets and blankets should be used:
1. For permanent stabilization of slopes 2H:1V or greater and with more than 10 feet of vertical relief.
2. In conjunction with seed for final stabilization of a slope, not for temporary cover. However, they may
be used for temporary applications as long as the product is not damaged by repeated handling. In fact,
this method of slope protection is superior to plastic sheeting, which generates high-velocity runoff
(see Section D.2.1.2.4).
3. For drainage ditches and swales (highly recommended). The application of appropriate netting or
blanket to drainage ditches and swales can protect bare soil from channelized runoff while vegetation
is established. Nets and blankets also can capture a great deal of sediment due to their open, porous
structure. Synthetic nets and blankets may be used to permanently stabilize channels and may provide
a cost-effective, environmentally preferable alternative to riprap.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.2.B and Figure D.2.1.2.C for typical orientation and installation of nettings and
blankets. Note: Installation is critical to the effectiveness of these products. If good ground contact is
not achieved, runoff can concentrate under the product, resulting in significant erosion.
2. With the variety of products available, it is impossible to cover all the details of appropriate use and
installation. Therefore, it is critical that the design engineer thoroughly consults the manufacturer’s
information and that a site visit takes place in order to ensure that the product specified is
appropriate.
3. Jute matting must be used in conjunction with mulch (Section D.2.1.2.2). Excelsior, woven straw
blankets, and coir (coconut fiber) blankets may be installed without mulch. There are many other
types of erosion control nets and blankets on the market that may be appropriate in certain
circumstances. Other types of products will have to be evaluated individually. In general, most nets
(e.g., jute matting) require mulch in order to prevent erosion because they have a fairly open structure.
Blankets typically do not require mulch because they usually provide complete protection of the
surface.
4. Purely synthetic blankets are allowed but shall only be used for long-term stabilization of waterways.
The organic blankets authorized above are better for slope protection and short-term waterway
protection because they retain moisture and provide organic matter to the soil, substantially improving
the speed and success of re-vegetation.
Maintenance Standards
1. Good contact with the ground must be maintained, and there must not be erosion beneath the net or
blanket.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-18
2. Any areas of the net or blanket that are damaged or not in close contact with the ground shall be
repaired and stapled.
3. If erosion occurs due to poorly controlled drainage, the problem shall be fixed and the eroded area
protected.
FIGURE D.2.1.2.B WATERWAY INSTALLATION OF NETS AND BLANKETS
FIGURE D.2.1.2.C SLOPE INSTALLATION OF NETS AND BLANKETS
DO NOT STRETCH BLANKETS/MATTINGS TIGHT - ALLOW THE ROLLS
TO MOLD TO ANY IRREGULARITIES.
SLOPE SURFACE SHALL BE SMOOTH BEFORE PLACEMENT FOR
PROPER SOIL CONTACT.
ANCHOR, STAPLE, AND INSTALL CHECK SLOTS AS PER
MANUFACTURER'S RECOMMENDATIONS.
AVOID JOINING MATERIAL IN THE CENTER OF THE DITCH.
LIME, FERTILIZE AND SEED BEFORE INSTALLATION.
MIN.4" OVERLAP'
MIN.6"
OVERLAP
SLOPE SURFACE SHALL BE SMOOTH BEFORE
PLACEMENT FOR PROPER SOIL CONTACT
STAPLING PATTERN AS PER
MANUFACTURER'S RECOMMENDATION
MIN. 2" OVERLAP
LIME, FERTILIZE AND SEED BEFORE
INSTALLATION. PLANTING OF SHRUBS, TREES,
ETC. SHOULD OCCUR AFTER INSTALLATION
DO NOT STRETCH BLANKETS/MATTINGS TIGHT - ALLOW
THE ROLLS TO MOLD TO ANY IRREGULARITIES
FOR SLOPES LESS THAN 3H:1V, ROLLS MAY BE PLACED
IN HORIZONTAL STRIPS
BRING MATERIAL DOWN TO A LEVEL
AREA, TURN THE END UNDER 4" AND
STAPLE AT 12" INTERVALS
ANCHOR IN 6"x6" MIN.
TRENCH AND STAPLE
AT 12" INTERVALS
STAPLE OVERLAPS
MAX. 5' SPACING
IF THERE IS A BERM AT THE
TOP OF SLOPE, ANCHOR
UPSLOPE OF THE BERM
MIN. 6" OVERLAP
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-19
D.2.1.2.4 PLASTIC COVERING
Code: PC Symbol:
Purpose
Plastic covering provides immediate, short-term erosion protection to slopes and disturbed areas.
Conditions of Use
1. Plastic covering may be used on disturbed areas that require cover measures for less than 30 days.
2. Plastic is particularly useful for protecting cut and fill slopes and stockpiles. Note: The relatively rapid
breakdown of most polyethylene sheeting makes it unsuitable for long-term applications.
3. Clear plastic sheeting may be used over newly-seeded areas to create a greenhouse effect and
encourage grass growth. Clear plastic should not be used for this purpose during the summer months
because the resulting high temperatures can kill the grass.
4. Due to rapid runoff caused by plastic sheeting, this method shall not be used upslope of areas that
might be adversely impacted by concentrated runoff. Such areas include steep and/or unstable slopes.
Note: There have been many problems with plastic, usually attributable to poor installation and
maintenance. However, the material itself can cause problems, even when correctly installed and
maintained, because it generates high-velocity runoff and breaks down quickly due to ultraviolet
radiation. In addition, if the plastic is not completely removed, it can clog drainage system inlets and
outlets. It is highly recommended that alternatives to plastic sheeting be used whenever possible and that
its use be limited.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.2.D for details.
2. Plastic sheeting shall have a minimum thickness of 0.06 millimeters.
3. If erosion at the toe of a slope is likely, a gravel berm, riprap, or other suitable protection shall be
installed at the toe of the slope in order to reduce the velocity of runoff.
FIGURE D.2.1.2.D PLASTIC COVERING
TIRES, SANDBAGS, OR
EQUIVALENT MAY BE USED
TO WEIGHT PLASTIC
SEAMS BETWEEN SHEETS
MUST OVERLAP A MINIMUM
OF 12" AND BE WEIGHTED
OR TAPED
TOE IN SHEETING
IN MINIMUM 4"X4"
TRENCH
PROVIDE ENERGY DISSIPATION
AT TOE WHEN NEEDED
10' MAX.
10' MAX.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-20
Maintenance Standards for Plastic Covering
1. Torn sheets must be replaced and open seams repaired.
2. If the plastic begins to deteriorate due to ultraviolet radiation, it must be completely removed and
replaced.
3. When the plastic is no longer needed, it shall be completely removed.
D.2.1.2.5 STRAW WATTLES
Code: SW Symbol:
Purpose
Wattles are erosion and sediment control barriers consisting of straw wrapped in biodegradable tubular
plastic or similar encasing material. Wattles may reduce the velocity and can spread the flow of rill and
sheet runoff, and can capture and retain sediment. Straw wattles are typically 8 to 10 inches in diameter
and 25 to 30 feet in length. The wattles are placed in shallow trenches and staked along the contour of
disturbed or newly constructed slopes.
Conditions of Use
1. Install on disturbed areas that require immediate erosion protection.
2. Use on slopes requiring stabilization until permanent vegetation can be established.
3. Can be used along the perimeter of a project, as a check dam in unlined ditches and around temporary
stockpiles
4. Wattles can be staked to the ground using willow cuttings for added revegetation.
5. Rilling can occur beneath and between wattles if not properly entrenched, allowing water to pass
below and between wattles
Design and Installation Specifications
1. It is critical that wattles are installed perpendicular to the flow direction and parallel to the slope
contour.
2. Narrow trenches should be dug across the slope, on contour, to a depth of 3 to 5 inches on clay soils
and soils with gradual slopes. On loose soils, steep slopes, and during high rainfall events, the trenches
should be dug to a depth of 5 to 7 inches, or ½ to 2/3 of the thickness of the wattle.
3. Start construction of trenches and installing wattles from the base of the slope and work uphill.
Excavated material should be spread evenly along the uphill slope and compacted using hand tamping
or other method. Construct trenches at contour intervals of 3 to 30 feet apart depending on the
steepness of the slope, soil type, and rainfall. The steeper the slope the closer together the trenches
should be constructed. Vertical distance between wattles is not to exceed 10 feet.
4. Install the wattles snugly into the trenches and abut tightly end to end. Do not overlap the ends.
5. Install stakes at each end of the wattle, and at 4 foot centers along the entire length of the wattle.
6. If required, install pilot holes for the stakes using a straight bar to drive holes through the wattle and
into the soil.
7. At a minimum, wooden stakes should be approximately ¾ x ¾ x 24 inches. Willow cuttings or
3/8 inch rebar can also be used for stakes.
8. Stakes should be driven through the middle of the wattle, leaving 2 to 3 inches of the stake protruding
above the wattle.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-21
Maintenance Standards
1. Inspect wattles prior to forecasted rain, daily during extended rain events, after rain events, weekly
during the wet season, and at two week intervals at all other times of the year.
2. Repair or replace split, torn, raveling, or slumping wattles
3. Remove sediment accumulations when exceeding ½ the height between the top of the wattle and the
ground surface.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-22
FIGURE D.2.1.2.E STRAW WATTLES
1. STRAW ROLL INSTALLATION REQUIRES THE PLACEMENT AND SECURE STAKING
OF THE ROLL IN A TRENCH, 3" x 5" (75-125mm) DEEP, DUG ON CONTOUR.
2. RUNOFF MUST NOT BE ALLOWED TO RUN UNDER OR AROUND ROLL.
ROLL SPACING DEPENDS ON SOIL
TYPE AND SLOPE STEEPNESS
STRAW ROLLS MUST BE PLACED
ALONG SLOPE CONTOURS
3'-4'
(1.2m)
10'-25'
(3-8m)
3"-5"
(75-125mm)
ADJACENT ROLLS
SHALL TIGHTLY ABUT
SEDIMENT, ORGANIC MATTER,
AND NATIVE SEEDS ARE
CAPTURED BEHIND THE ROLLS
LIVE STAKE
1" x 1" STAKE
8"-10" DIA.
(200-250mm)
NOTES:
STRAW WATTLES
NTS
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-23
D.2.1.2.6 TEMPORARY AND PERMANENT SEEDING
Code: SE Symbol:
Purpose
Seeding is intended to reduce erosion by stabilizing exposed soils. A well-established vegetative cover is
one of the most effective methods of reducing erosion.
Conditions of Use
1. Seeding shall be used throughout the project on disturbed areas that have reached final grade or that
will remain unworked for more than 30 days.
2. Vegetation-lined channels shall be seeded. Channels that will be vegetated should be installed before
major earthwork and hydroseeded or covered with a Bonded Fiber Matrix (BFM).
3. Retention/detention ponds shall be seeded as required.
4. At the City’s discretion, seeding without mulch during the dry season is allowed even though it will
take more than seven days to develop an effective cover. Mulch is, however, recommended at all
times because it protects seeds from heat, moisture loss, and transport due to runoff.
5. Prior to the beginning of the wet season, all disturbed areas shall be reviewed to identify which ones
can be seeded in preparation for the winter rains (see Section D.2.4.2). Disturbed areas shall be seeded
within one week of the beginning of the wet season. A sketch map of those areas to be seeded and
those areas to remain uncovered shall be submitted to the CED inspector. The CED inspector may
require seeding of additional areas in order to protect surface waters, adjacent properties, or drainage
facilities.
6. At final site stabilization, all disturbed areas not otherwise vegetated or stabilized shall be seeded and
mulched (see Section D.2.4.5).
Design and Installation Specifications
1. The best time to seed is fall (late September to October) or in spring (mid-March to June). Irrigation
is required during the first summer following installation if seeding occurs in spring or summer or
during prolonged dry times of year. Areas may also be seeded during the winter months, but it may
take additional spring seeding applications to develop a dense groundcover due to cold temperatures.
The application and maintenance of mulch is critical for winter seeding.
2. To prevent seed from being washed away, confirm that all required surface water control measures
have been installed.
3. The seedbed should not be compacted because soils that are well compacted will not vegetate as
quickly or thoroughly. Slopes steeper than 3H:1V shall be surface roughened. Roughening can be
accomplished in a variety of ways, but the typical method is track walking, or driving a crawling
tractor up and down the slope, leaving cleat imprints parallel to the slope contours.
4. In general, 10-20-20 N-P-K (nitrogen-phosphorus-potassium) fertilizer may be used at a rate of
90 pounds per acre. Slow-release fertilizers are preferred because they are more efficient and have
fewer environmental impacts. It is recommended that areas being seeded for final landscaping conduct
soil tests to determine the exact type and quantity of fertilizer needed. This will prevent the over-
application of fertilizer. Disturbed areas within 200 feet of water bodies and wetlands must use slow-
release low-phosphorus fertilizer (typical proportions 3-1-2 N-P-K).
5. The following requirements apply to mulching:
a) Mulch is always required for seeding slopes greater than 3H:1V (see Section D.2.1.2.2).
b) If seeding during the wet season, mulch is required.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-24
c) The use of mulch may be required during the dry season at the City’s discretion if grass growth is
expected to be slow, the soils are highly erodible due to soil type or gradient, there is a water body
close to the disturbed area, or significant precipitation (see Section D.2.4.2) is anticipated before
the grass will provide effective cover.
d) Mulch may be applied on top of the seed or simultaneously by hydroseeding.
6. Hydroseeding is allowed as long as tackifier is included. Hydroseeding with wood fiber mulch is
adequate during the dry season. Application of hydroseeded wood fiber mulch should be appropriate
for slope angle. Follow manufacturer specifications for application rates.
7. Areas to be permanently landscaped shall use soil amendments. Good quality topsoil shall be tilled
into the top six inches to reduce the need for fertilizer and improve the overall soil quality. Most
native soils will require the addition of four inches of well-rotted compost to be tilled into the soil to
provide a good quality topsoil. Compost used should meet specifications provided in Reference
Section 11-C of the SWDM.
8. The seed mixes listed below include recommended mixes for both temporary and permanent seeding.
These mixes, with the exception of the wetland mix, shall be applied at a rate of 80 to 100 seeds per
square foot. Wet sites should apply 120 to 150 seeds per square foot. Local suppliers should be
consulted for information on current Pure Live Seed (PLS) rates and species specific seeds per pound
in order to determine seed mix PLS pounds of seed per acre. The appropriate mix depends on a variety
of factors, including exposure, soil type, slope, and expected foot traffic. Alternative seed mixes
approved by the City may be used.
Table D.2.1.2.B presents the standard mix for those areas where temporary or permanent vegetative cover
is required. The following mix assumes a desired 150 seeds per square foot and should be applied at
approximately 37 pounds of pure live seed per acre.
TABLE D.2.1.2.B EROSION CONTROL SEED MIX
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
Spike bentgrass/Agrostis exarata 6 9 0.1
California brome/Bromus carinatus 15 23 9.8
Tufted hairgrass/Deschampsia cespitosa 15 23 0.4
Blue wildrye/Elymus glaucus 18 27 10.7
California oatgrass/Danthonia californica 18 27 5.6
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 18 27 2.4
Meadow barley/Hordeum brachyantherum 10 15 7.7
Table D.2.1.2.C provides just one recommended possibility for landscaping seed. It assumes a desired
100 seeds per square foot and should be applied at 18 pounds of pure live seed per acre.
TABLE D.2.1.2.C LANDSCAPING SEED MIX
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
Sideoats grama/Bouteloua curtipendula 20 30 6.8
California oatgrass/Danthonia californica 20 30 6.2
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 30 45 3.9
Prairie junegrass/Koeleria macrantha 30 45 0.8
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-25
This turf seed mix in Table D.2.1.2.D is for dry situations where there is no need for much water. The
advantage is that this mix requires very little maintenance.
TABLE D.2.1.2.D LOW-GROWING TURF SEED MIX
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
Hard fescue/Festuca brevipila 25 20 1.5
Sheep fescue/Festuca ovina 30 24 1.5
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 25 20 1.7
Prairie junegrass/Koeleria macrantha 20 16 0.3
Table D.2.1.2.E presents a mix recommended for bioswales and other intermittently wet areas. The mix
assumes a desired 150 seeds per square foot and approximately 29 pounds of pure live seed per acre. Sod
shall generally not be used for bioswales because the seed mix is inappropriate for this application. Sod
may be used for lining ditches to prevent erosion, but it will provide little water quality benefit during the
wet season.
TABLE D.2.1.2.E BIOSWALE SEED MIX
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
American sloughgrass/Beckmannia
syzigachne 15 23 0.9
Tufted hairgrass/Deschampsia cespitosa 20 30 0.5
Blue wildrye/Elymus glaucus 18 27 10.7
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 20 30 2.6
Meadow barley/Hordeum brachyantherum 12 18 9.2
Northwestern mannagrass/Glyceria
occidentalis 15 23 4.9
The seed mix shown in Table D.2.1.2.F is a recommended low-growing, non-invasive seed mix
appropriate for very wet areas that are not regulated wetlands (if planting in wetland areas, see
Section 6.3.1 of the SWDM). Other mixes may be appropriate, depending on the soil type and hydrology of
the area. This mixture assumes a target goal of 150 seeds per square foot and should be applied at a rate of
36 pounds per acre.
TABLE D.2.1.2.F WET AREA SEED MIX*
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
California brome/Bromus carinatus 15 23 9.8
Columbia brome/Bromus vulgaris 18 27 8.1
Tufted hairgrass/Deschampsia cespitosa 15 23 0.4
California oatgrass/Danthonia californica 15 23 4.7
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 17 26 2.2
Western manna grass/Glyceria
occidentalis
10 15 3.3
Meadow barley/Hordeum brachyantherum 10 15 7.7
* Modified Briargreen, Inc. Hydroseeding Guide Wetlands Seed Mix
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-26
The meadow seed mix in Table D.2.1.2.G is recommended for areas that will be maintained infrequently
or not at all and where colonization by native plants is desirable. Likely applications include rural road and
utility right-of-way. Seeding should take place in September or very early October in order to obtain
adequate establishment prior to the winter months. This seed mix assumes a target goal of 120 seeds per
square foot and an application rate of 23 pounds of pure live seed per acre.
TABLE D.2.1.2.G MEADOW SEED MIX
Common Name/Latin Name
% Species
Composition
Desired Seeds
per
Square Foot
PLS
Pounds/Acre
Common yarrow/Achillea millefolium 4 5 0.1
Pearly everlasting/Anaphalis margartacae 1 1 0.0
California brome/Bromus carinatus 15 18 7.8
California oatgrass/Danthonia californica 15 18 3.7
Blue wildrye/Elymus glaucus 16 19 7.6
Festuca idahoensis 15 18 1.7
Native red fescue/Festuca rubra var. rubra 18 22 1.9
Sickle keeled lupine/Lupinus albicaulis 1 1 2.2
Fowl bluegrass/Poa palustris 15 18 0.4
Maintenance Standards for Temporary and Permanent Seeding
1. Any seeded areas that fail to establish at least 80 percent cover within one month shall be reseeded. If
reseeding is ineffective, an alternate method, such as sodding or nets/blankets, shall be used. If winter
weather prevents adequate seed establishment and growth, this time limit may be relaxed at the
discretion of the City when critical areas would otherwise be protected.
2. After adequate cover is achieved, any areas that experience erosion shall be re-seeded and protected
by mulch. If the erosion problem is drainage related, the problem shall be fixed and the eroded area re-
seeded and protected by mulch.
3. Seeded areas shall be supplied with adequate moisture, but not watered to the extent that it causes
runoff.
D.2.1.2.7 SODDING
Code: SO Symbol:
Purpose
The purpose of sodding is to establish permanent turf for immediate erosion protection and to stabilize
drainage ways where concentrated overland flow will occur.
Conditions of Use
Sodding may be used in the following areas:
1. Disturbed areas that require short-term or long-term cover
2. Disturbed areas that require immediate vegetative cover
3. All waterways that require vegetative lining (except biofiltration swales—the seed mix used in most
sod is not appropriate for biofiltration swales). Waterways may also be seeded rather than sodded, and
protected with a net or blanket (see Section D.2.1.2.3).
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-27
Design and Installation Specifications
Sod shall be free of weeds, of uniform thickness (approximately 1-inch thick), and shall have a dense root
mat for mechanical strength.
The following steps are recommended for sod installation:
1. Shape and smooth the surface to final grade in accordance with the approved grading plan.
2. Amend four inches (minimum) of well-rotted compost into the top eight inches of the soil if the
organic content of the soil is less than ten percent. Compost used shall meet compost specifications
per SWDM Reference Section 11-C.
3. Fertilize according to the supplier’s recommendations. Disturbed areas within 200 feet of water bodies
and wetlands must use non-phosphorus fertilizer.
4. Work lime and fertilizer 1 to 2 inches into the soil, and smooth the surface.
5. Lay strips of sod beginning at the lowest area to be sodded and perpendicular to the direction of water
flow. Wedge strips securely into place. Square the ends of each strip to provide for a close, tight fit.
Stagger joints at least 12 inches. Staple on slopes steeper than 3H:1V.
6. Roll the sodded area and irrigate.
7. When sodding is carried out in alternating strips or other patterns, seed the areas between the sod
immediately after sodding.
Maintenance Standards
If the grass is unhealthy, the cause shall be determined and appropriate action taken to reestablish a
healthy groundcover. If it is impossible to establish a healthy groundcover due to frequent saturation,
instability, or some other cause, the sod shall be removed, the area seeded with an appropriate mix, and
protected with a net or blanket.
D.2.1.2.8 POLYACRYLAMIDE FOR SOIL EROSION PROTECTION
Purpose
Polyacrylamide (PAM) is used on construction sites to prevent soil erosion. Applying PAM to bare soil in
advance of a rain event significantly reduces erosion and controls sediment in two ways. First, PAM
increases the soil’s available pore volume, thus increasing infiltration through flocculation and reducing
the quantity of stormwater runoff. Second, it increases flocculation of suspended particles and aids in their
deposition, thus reducing stormwater runoff turbidity and improving water quality.
Conditions of Use
1. PAM shall not be directly applied to water or allowed to enter a water body.
2. PAM may be applied to wet soil, but dry soil is preferred due to less sediment loss.
3. PAM will work when applied to saturated soil but is not as effective as applications to dry or damp
soil.
4. PAM may be applied only to the following types of bare soil areas that drain to a sediment trap or a
sediment pond:
Staging areas
Stockpiles
Pit sites
Balanced cut and fill earthwork
Haul roads prior to placement of crushed rock surfacing
Compacted soil road base
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-28
5. PAM may be applied only during the following phases of construction:
During rough grading operations
After final grade and before paving or final seeding and planting
During a winter shut down of site work. In the case of winter shut down, or where soil will remain
unworked for several months, PAM should be used together with mulch.
6. Do not use PAM on a slope that flows directly to a stream or wetland. The stormwater runoff shall
pass through a sediment control measure prior to discharging to surface waters.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. PAM must be applied using one of two methods of application, “preferred” or “alternative.” The
specifications for these methods are described under separate headings below.
2. PAM may be applied in dissolved form with water, or it may be applied in dry, granular or powdered
form. The preferred application method is the dissolved form.
3. PAM is to be applied at a maximum rate of ½ pound PAM per 1000 gallons of water per 1 acre of
bare soil. Table D.2.1.2.H may be used to determine the PAM and water application rate for disturbed
soil areas. Higher concentrations of PAM do not provide any additional effectiveness.
4. Do not add PAM to water discharging from the site.
5. PAM shall be used in conjunction with other ESC measures and not in place of them. When the total
drainage area is greater than or equal to 3 acres, PAM treated areas shall drain to a sediment pond per
Section D.2.1.5.2. For drainage areas less than 3 acres, PAM treated areas must drain to a sediment
trap per Section D.2.1.5.1. Other normally required sediment control measures such as perimeter
protection measures (Section D.2.1.3) and surface water collection measures (Section D.2.1.6) shall be
applied to PAM treated areas.
6. All areas not being actively worked shall be covered and protected from rainfall. PAM shall not be the
only cover BMP used.
7. Keep the granular PAM supply out of the sun. Granular PAM loses its effectiveness in three months
after exposure to sunlight and air.
8. Care must be taken to prevent spills of PAM powder onto paved surfaces. PAM, combined with water,
is very slippery and can be a safety hazard. During an application of PAM, prevent over-spray from
reaching pavement as the pavement will become slippery. If PAM powder gets on skin or clothing,
wipe it off with a rough towel rather than washing with water. Washing with water only makes
cleanup more difficult, messier, and time consuming.
9. The specific PAM copolymer formulation must be anionic. Cationic PAM shall not be used in any
application because of known aquatic toxicity concerns. Only the highest drinking water grade PAM,
certified for compliance with ANSI/NSF Standard 60 for drinking water treatment, may be used for
soil applications. The Washington State Department of Transportation (WSDOT) lists approved PAM
products on their web page. All PAM use shall be reviewed and approved by CED.
10. The PAM anionic charge density may vary from 2 to 30 percent; a value of 18 percent is typical.
Studies conducted by the United States Department of Agriculture (USDA)/ARS demonstrated that
soil stabilization was optimized by using very high molecular weight (12 to 15 mg/mole), highly
anionic (>20% hydrolysis) PAM.
11. PAM must be “water soluble” or “linear” or “non-cross-linked.” Cross-linked or water absorbent
PAM, polymerized in highly acidic (pH<2) conditions, are used to maintain soil moisture content.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-29
TABLE D.2.1.2.H PAM AND WATER APPLICATION RATES
Disturbed Area (ac) PAM (lbs) Water (gal)
0.50 0.25 500
1.00 0.50 1,000
1.50 0.75 1,500
2.00 1.00 2,000
2.50 1.25 2,500
3.00 1.50 3,000
3.50 1.75 3,500
4.00 2.00 4,000
4.50 2.25 4,500
5.00 2.50 5,000
Preferred Application Method
1. Pre-measure the area where PAM is to be applied and calculate the amount of product and water
necessary to provide coverage at the specified application rate (1/2 pound PAM/1,000 gallons/acre).
2. Dissolve pre-measured dry granular PAM with a known quantity of clean water in a bucket several
hours or overnight. PAM has infinite solubility in water, but dissolves very slowly. Mechanical
mixing will help dissolve PAM. Always add PAM to water – not water to PAM.
3. Pre-fill the water truck about 1/8 full with water. The water does not have to be potable, but it must
have relatively low turbidity – in the range of 20 NTU or less.
4. Add PAM/Water mixture to the truck.
5. Completely fill the water truck to specified volume.
6. Spray PAM/Water mixture onto dry soil until the soil surface is uniformly and completely wetted.
Alternate Application Method
PAM may also be applied as a powder at the rate of 5 pounds per acre. This must be applied on a day that
is dry. For areas less than 5 to 10 acres, a hand-held “organ grinder” fertilized spreader set to the smallest
setting will work. Tractor mounted spreaders will work for larger areas.
Maintenance Standards
1. PAM may be reapplied on actively worked areas after a 48-hour period
2. Reapplication is not required unless PAM treated soil is disturbed or unless turbidity levels show the
need for an additional application. If PAM treated soil is left undisturbed, a reapplication may be
necessary after two months. More PAM applications may be required for steep slopes, silty and clay
soils, (USDA classification Type “C” and “D” soils), long grades, and high precipitation areas. When
PAM is applied first to bare soil and then covered with straw, a reapplication may not be necessary for
several months.
D.2.1.2.9 COMPOST BLANKETS
Code: COBL Symbol:
Purpose
Compost blankets are intended to:
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-30
Provide immediate temporary protection from erosion by protecting soil from rainfall and slowing
flow velocity over the soil surface.
Enhance temporary or permanent plant establishment by conserving moisture, holding seed and
topsoil in place, providing nutrients and soil microorganisms, and moderating soil temperatures.
Compost blankets, applied at the proper thickness and tilled into the soil, are also an option for
amending soils for permanent landscaping.
Compost generally releases and adds phosphorous to stormwater. Therefore, compost blankets are not
recommended for use in watersheds where phosphorous sensitive water resources are located. Unless
prior approval is given by the City, they should not be used in Sensitive Lake Watersheds.
Conditions of Use
1. Compost blankets may be used unseeded on disturbed areas that require temporary cover measures up
to 1 year. Compost applied as temporary cover may be reclaimed and re-used for permanent cover.
2. Compost provides cover for protecting final grades until landscaping can be completed as it can be
directly seeded or tilled into soil as an amendment.
3. Compost blankets meet mulch requirements for seed.
4. Seed may be applied to a compost blanket at any time for permanent or temporary stabilization of
disturbed areas. Seed may be applied prior to blanket application, on top of blankets, or injected and
mixed into the compost as it is applied.
5. Compost blankets may be applied on slopes up to 2H:1V.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Compost shall be applied at a minimum of 2 inches thick, unless otherwise directed by an ESC
supervisor or the City. At an application of 2 inches, this will equal approximately 100 tons per acre
(compost generally weighs approximately 800 lbs per cubic yard). Thickness shall be increased at the
direction of the design engineer for disturbed areas in or near critical areas or other areas highly
susceptible to erosion.
2. Compost shall meet criteria in Reference Section 11-C of the SWDM.
3. Compost shall be obtained from a supplier meeting the requirements in Reference Section 11-C.
4. Compost blankets shall be applied over the top of the slope to which it is applied, to prevent water
from running under the blanket
5. Compost blankets shall not be used in areas exposed to concentrated flow (e.g., channels, ditches,
dikes)
Maintenance Standards
1. The specified thickness of the blanket/cover must be maintained.
2. Any areas that show signs of erosion must be re-mulched. If the erosion problem is drainage related,
then the drainage problem must first be remedied and then the eroded area re-mulched.
D.2.1.3 PERIMETER PROTECTION
Perimeter protection to filter sediment from sheetwash shall be located downslope of all disturbed areas
and shall be installed prior to upslope grading. Perimeter protection includes the use of vegetated strips as
well as, constructed measures, such as silt fences, fiber rolls, sand/gravel barriers, brush or rock filters,
triangular silt dikes and other methods. During the wet season, 50 linear feet of silt fence (and the
necessary stakes) per acre of disturbed area must be stockpiled on site.
Purpose: The purpose of perimeter protection is to reduce the amount of sediment transported beyond the
disturbed areas of the construction site. Perimeter protection is primarily a backup means of sediment
control. Most, if not all, sediment-laden water is to be treated in a sediment trap or pond. The only
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-31
circumstances in which perimeter control is to be used as a primary means of sediment removal is when
the catchment is very small (see below).
When to Install: Perimeter protection is to be installed prior to any upslope clearing and grading.
Measures to Use: The above measures may be used interchangeably and are not the only perimeter
protection measures available. If surface water is collected by an interceptor dike or swale and routed to a
sediment pond or trap, there may be no need for the perimeter protection measures specified in this
section.
Criteria for Use as Primary Treatment: At the boundary of a site, perimeter protection may be used as
the sole form of treatment when the flowpath meets the criteria listed below. If these criteria are not met,
perimeter protection shall only be used as a backup to a sediment trap or pond.
Average Slope Slope Percent Flowpath Length
1.5H:1V or less 67% or less 100 feet
2H:1V or less 50% or less 115 feet
4H:1V or less 25% or less 150 feet
6H:1V or less 16.7% or less 200 feet
10H:1V or less 10% or less 250 feet
D.2.1.3.1 SILT FENCE
Code: SF Symbol:
Purpose
Use of a silt fence reduces the transport of coarse sediment from a construction site by providing a
temporary physical barrier to sediment and reducing the runoff velocities of overland flow.
Conditions of Use
1. Silt fence may be used downslope of all disturbed areas.
2. Silt fence is not intended to treat concentrated flows, nor is it intended to treat substantial amounts of
overland flow. Any concentrated flows must be conveyed through the drainage system to a sediment
trap or pond. The only circumstance in which overland flow may be treated solely by a silt fence,
rather than by a sediment trap or pond, is when the area draining to the fence is small (see “Criteria for
Use as Primary Treatment” in Section D.2.1.3 above).
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.3.A and Figure D.2.1.3.B for details.
2. The geotextile used must meet the standards listed below. A copy of the manufacturer’s fabric
specifications must be available on site.
AOS (ASTM D4751) 30–100 sieve size (0.60–0.15 mm) for slit film
50–100 sieve size (0.30–0.15 mm) for other fabrics
Water Permittivity (ASTM D4491) 0.02 sec-1 minimum
Grab Tensile Strength (ASTM D4632)
(see Specification Note 3)
180 lbs. min. for extra strength fabric
100 lbs. min. for standard strength fabric
Grab Tensile Elongation (ASTM D4632) 30% max. (woven)
Ultraviolet Resistance (ASTM D4355) 70% min.
3. Standard strength fabric requires wire backing to increase the strength of the fence. Wire backing or
closer post spacing may be required for extra strength fabric if field performance warrants a stronger
fence.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-32
4. Where the fence is installed, the slope shall be no steeper than 2H:1V.
5. If a typical silt fence (per Figure D.2.1.3.A) is used, the standard 4 x 4 trench may be reduced as long
as the bottom 8 inches of the silt fence fabric is well buried and secured in a trench that stabilizes the
fence and does not allow water to bypass or undermine the silt fence.
Maintenance Standards
1. Any damage shall be repaired immediately.
2. If concentrated flows are evident uphill of the fence, they must be intercepted and conveyed to a
sediment trap or pond.
3. It is important to check the uphill side of the fence for signs of the fence clogging and acting as a
barrier to flow and then causing channelization of flows parallel to the fence. If this occurs, replace the
fence or remove the trapped sediment.
4. Sediment must be removed when the sediment is 6 inches high.
5. If the filter fabric (geotextile) has deteriorated due to ultraviolet breakdown, it shall be replaced.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-33
FIGURE D.2.1.3.A SILT FENCE
2"X2" BY 14 Ga. WIRE OR
EQUIVALENT, IF STANDARD
STRENGTH FABRIC USED
NOTE: FILTER FABRIC FENCES
SHALL BE INSTALLED ALONG
CONTOURS WHENEVER POSSIBLE
JOINTS IN FILTER FABRIC SHALL BE SPLICED
AT POSTS. USE STAPLES, WIRE RINGS OR
EQUIVALENT TO ATTACH FABRIC TO POSTS.
FILTER FABRIC
BACKFILL TRENCH WITH NATIVE SOIL
OR 3/4" TO 1-1/2" WASHED GRAVEL
MINIMUM 4"x4" TRENCH
2"x4" WOOD POSTS, STEEL FENCE
POSTS, REBAR, OR EQUIVALENT
POST SPACING MAY BE
INCREASED TO 8' IF
WIRE BACKING IS USED
6' MAX.
2'
M
I
N
.
12
"
M
I
N
.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-34
FIGURE D.2.1.3.B SILT FENCE INSTALLATION BY SLICING
1. GATHER FABRIC AT POSTS, IF NEEDED.
2. UTILIZE THREE TIES PER POST, ALL
WITHIN TOP 8" OF FABRIC.
3. POSITION EACH TIE DIAGONALLY,
PUNCTURING HOLES VERTICALLY A
MINIMUM OF 1" APART.
4. HANG EACH TIE ON A POST NIPPLE AND
TIGHTEN SECURELY. USE CABLE TIES
(50 LBS) OF SOFT WIRE.
TOP OF FABRIC
BELT
DIAGONAL ATTACHMENT
DOUBLES STRENGTH
FLOW
ST
E
E
L
S
U
P
P
O
R
T
P
O
S
T
1. POST SPACING: 7' MAX. ON OPEN RUNS
4' MAX. ON POOLING AREAS.
2. POST DEPTH: AS MUCH BELOW GROUND
AS FABRIC ABOVE GROUND.
3. PONDING HEIGHT MAX. 24" ATTACH
FABRIC TO UPSTREAM SIDE OF POST.
4. DRIVE OVER EACH SIDE OF SILT FENCE
2 TO 4 TIMES WITH DEVICE EXERTING
60 P.S.I. OR GREATER.
5. NO MORE THAN 24" OF A 36" FABRIC
IS ALLOWED ABOVE GROUND.
6. VIBRATORY PLOW IS NOT ACCEPTABLE
BECAUSE OF HORIZONTAL COMPACTION.
100% COMPACTION
EACH SIDE
OPERATION
ROLL OF SILT FENCE
PLOW
FABRIC ABOVE
GROUND
HORIZONTAL CHISEL POINT
(76 mm WIDTH)200-300mm
SILT FENCE
TOP 8"
NOTES:
ATTACHMENT DETAILS:
SILT FENCE INSTALLATION BY SLICING METHOD
NTS
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-35
D.2.1.3.2 BRUSH BARRIER
Code: BB Symbol:
Purpose
The purpose of brush barriers is to reduce the transport of coarse sediment from a construction site by
providing a temporary physical barrier to sediment and reducing the runoff velocities of overland flow.
Conditions of Use
1. Brush barriers may be used downslope of all disturbed areas.
2. Brush barriers are not intended to treat concentrated flows, nor are they intended to treat substantial
amounts of overland flow. Any concentrated flows must be conveyed through the drainage system to a
sediment trap or pond. The only circumstance in which overland flow may be treated solely by a
barrier, rather than by a sediment trap or pond, is when the area draining to the barrier is small (see
“Criteria for Use as Primary Treatment” in Section D.2.1.3).
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.3.C for details.
2. The City may require filter fabric (geotextile) anchored over the brush berm to enhance the filtration
ability of the barrier.
Maintenance Standards
1. There shall be no signs of erosion or concentrated runoff under or around the barrier. If concentrated
flows are bypassing the barrier, it must be expanded or augmented by toed-in filter fabric.
2. The dimensions of the barrier must be maintained.
FIGURE D.2.1.3.C BRUSH BARRIER
IF REQUIRED, DRAPE FILTER FABRIC
OVER BRUSH AND SECURE IN 4"x4"
MIN. TRENCH WITH COMPACTED
BACKFILL
MAX. 6" DIAMETER WOODY DEBRIS
FOR BARRIER CORE. ALTERNATIVELY
TOPSOIL STRIPPINGS MAY BE USED
TO FORM THE BARRIER.
ANCHOR DOWNHILL EDGE OF
FILTER FABRIC WITH STAKES,
SANDBAGS, OR EQUIVALENT
2' MIN. HEIGHT
5' MIN.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-36
D.2.1.3.3 VEGETATED STRIP
Code: VS Symbol:
Purpose
Vegetated strips reduce the transport of coarse sediment from a construction site by providing a temporary
physical barrier to sediment and reducing the runoff velocities of overland flow.
Conditions of Use
1. Vegetated strips may be used downslope of all disturbed areas.
2. Vegetated strips are not intended to treat concentrated flows, nor are they intended to treat substantial
amounts of overland flow. Any concentrated flows must be conveyed through the drainage system to a
sediment trap or pond. The only circumstance in which overland flow may be treated solely by a strip,
rather than by a sediment trap or pond, is when the area draining to the strip is small (see “Criteria for
Use as Primary Treatment” in Section D.2.1.3).
Design and Installation Specifications
1. The vegetated strip shall consist of a 25-foot minimum width continuous strip of dense vegetation
with a permeable topsoil. Grass-covered, landscaped areas are generally not adequate because the
volume of sediment overwhelms the grass. Ideally, vegetated strips shall consist of undisturbed native
growth with a well-developed soil that allows for infiltration of runoff.
2. The slope within the strip shall not exceed 4H:1V.
3. The uphill boundary of the vegetated strip shall be delineated with clearing limits as specified in
Section D.2.1.1.
Maintenance Standards
1. Any areas damaged by erosion or construction activity shall be seeded immediately and protected by
mulch.
2. If more than 5 feet of the original vegetated strip width has had vegetation removed or is being eroded,
sod must be installed using the standards for installation found in Section D.2.1.2.7.
If there are indications that concentrated flows are traveling across the buffer, surface water controls must
be installed to reduce the flows entering the buffer, or additional perimeter protection must be installed.
D.2.1.3.4 TRIANGULAR SILT DIKE (GEOTEXTILE ENCASED CHECK DAM)
Code: TSD Symbol:
Purpose
Triangular silt dikes (TSDs) may be used as check dams, for perimeter protection, for temporary soil
stockpile protection, for drop inlet protection, or as a temporary interceptor dike. Silt dikes, if attached to
impervious surfaces with tack or other adhesive agent may also be used as temporary wheel wash areas, or
concrete washout collection areas.
Conditions of Use
1. May be used for temporary check dams in ditches.
2. May be used on soil or pavement with adhesive or staples.
3. TSDs have been used to build temporary sediment ponds, diversion ditches, concrete washout
facilities, curbing, water bars, level spreaders, and berms.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-37
Design and Installation Specifications
1. TSDs must be made of urethane foam sewn into a woven geosynthetic fabric.
2. TSDs are triangular, 10 inches to 14 inches high in the center, with a 20-inch to 28-inch base. A 2-foot
apron extends beyond both sides of the triangle along its standard section of 7 feet. A sleeve at one
end allows attachment of additional sections as needed
3. Install TSDs with ends curved up to prevent water from flowing around the ends
4. Attach the TSDs and their fabric flaps to the ground with wire staples. Wire staples must be No. 11
gauge wire or stronger and shall be 200 mm to 300 mm in length.
5. When multiple units are installed, the sleeve of fabric at the end of the unit shall overlap the abutting
unit and be stapled.
6. TSDs must be located and installed as soon as construction will allow.
7. TSDs must be placed perpendicular to the flow of water.
8. When used as check dams, the leading edge must be secured with rocks, sandbags, or a small key slot
and staples.
9. When used in grass-lined ditches and swales, the TSD check dams and accumulated sediment shall be
removed when the grass has matured sufficiently to protect the ditch or swale unless the slope of the
swale is greater than 4 percent. The area beneath the TSD check dams shall be seeded and mulched
immediately after dam removal.
Maintenance Standards
1. Triangular silt dikes shall be monitored for performance and sediment accumulation during and after
each runoff producing rainfall event. Sediment shall be removed when it reaches one half the height of
the silt dike.
2. Anticipate submergence and deposition above the triangular silt dike and erosion from high flows
around the edges of the dike/dam. Immediately repair any damage or any undercutting of the
dike/dam.
D.2.1.3.5 COMPOST BERMS
Code: COBE Symbol:
Purpose
Compost berms are an option to meet the requirements of perimeter protection. Compost berms may
reduce the transport of sediment from a construction site by providing a temporary physical barrier to
sediment and reducing the runoff velocities of overland flow. Compost berms trap sediment by filtering
water passing through the berm and allowing water to pond, creating a settling area for solids behind the
berm. Organic materials in the compost can also reduce concentrations of metals and petroleum
hydrocarbons from construction runoff. Due to the increase in phosphorous seen in the effluent data from
compost berms, they should be used with some cautions in areas that drain to phosphorus sensitive water
bodies, and should only be used in Sensitive Lake watersheds, such as Lake Sammamish, with the
approval from the City or the local jurisdiction.
Conditions of Use
1. Compost berms may be used in most areas requiring sediment or erosion control where runoff is in the
form of sheet flow or in areas where silt fence is normally considered acceptable. Compost berms may
be used in areas where migration of aquatic life such as turtles and salamanders are impeded by the
use of silt fence.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-38
2. Compost berms are not intended to treat concentrated flows, nor are they intended to treat substantial
amounts of overland flow. Any concentrated flows must be conveyed via a drainage system to a
sediment pond or trap.
3. For purposes of long-term sediment control objectives, berms may be seeded at the time of installation
to create an additional vegetated filtering component.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Compost berms shall be applied using a pneumatic blower device or equivalent, to produce a uniform
cross-section and berm density.
2. Compost berms shall be triangular in cross-section. The ratio of base to height dimensions shall be
2:1.
3. The minimum size of a compost berm is a 2-foot base with a 1-foot height.
4. Compost berms shall be sized and spaced as indicated in the table below.
SLOPE SLOPE
Maximum Slope Length or
Berm Spacing (linear feet)
Berm Size Required
(height x base width)
0% – 2% Flatter than
50:1 250 1 ft x 2 ft
2% – 10% 50:1 – 10:1 125 1 ft x 2 ft
10% – 20% 10:1 – 5:1 100 1 ft x 2 ft
20% – 33% 5:1 – 3:1 75 1 ft x 2 ft
33% – 50% 3:1 – 2:1 50 1.5 ft x 3 ft
5. Compost berms shall not be used on slopes greater than 2H:1V.
6. Compost shall meet criteria in Reference Section 11-C of the SWDM except for the particle size
distribution (see Bullet 8).
7. Compost shall be obtained from a supplier meeting the requirements in Reference Section 11-C.
8. Compost particle size distribution shall be as follows: 99% passing a 1 inch sieve, 90% passing a
3/4-inch sieve and a minimum of 70% greater than the 3/8-inch sieve. A total of 98% shall not exceed
3 inches in length.
9. Berms shall be placed on level contours to assist in dissipating flow into sheet flow rather than
concentrated flows. Berms shall not be constructed to concentrate runoff or channel water. Sheet flow
of water shall be perpendicular to the berm at impact. No concentrated flow shall be directed towards
compost berms.
10. Where possible, berms shall be placed 5 feet or more from the toe of slopes to allow space for
sediment deposition and collection.
11. In order to prevent water from flowing around the ends of the berms, the ends of the berm shall be
constructed pointing upslope so the ends are at a higher elevation than the rest of the berm.
12. A compost blanket extending 10 to 15 feet above the berm is recommended where the surface above
the berm is rutted or uneven, to reduce concentrated flow and promote sheet flow into the berm.
Maintenance Standards
1. Compost berms shall be regularly inspected to make sure they retain their shape and allow adequate
flow-through of stormwater.
2. When construction is completed on site, the berms shall be dispersed for incorporation into the soil or
left on top of the site for final seeding to occur.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-39
3. Any damage to berms must be repaired immediately. Damage includes flattening, compacting, rills,
eroded areas due to overtopping.
4. If concentrated flows are evident uphill of the berm, the flows must be intercepted and conveyed to a
sediment trap or pond.
5. The uphill side of the berm shall be inspected for signs of the berm clogging and acting as a barrier to
flows and causing channelization of flows parallel to the berm. If this occurs, replace the berm or
remove the trapped sediment.
6. Sediment that collects behind the berm must be removed when the sediment is more than 6 inches
deep.
D.2.1.3.6 COMPOST SOCKS
Code: COSO Symbol:
Purpose
Compost socks reduce the transport of sediment from a construction site by providing a temporary
physical barrier to sediment-laden water and reducing the runoff velocities of overland flow. Compost
socks trap sediment by filtering water that passes through the sock and allows water to pond behind the
sock, creating a settling area for solids. Organic materials in the compost also may reduce metal and
petroleum hydrocarbon concentrations in construction runoff. Compost socks function similarly to
compost berms; however, because the compost is contained in a mesh tube, they are appropriate for both
concentrated flow and sheet flow. Compost socks may be used to channel concentrated flow on hard
surfaces.
Conditions of Use
1. Compost socks may be used in areas requiring sediment or erosion control where runoff is in the form
of sheet flow or in areas that silt fence is normally considered acceptable. Compost socks may also be
used in sensitive environmental areas where migration of aquatic life, including turtles, salamanders
and other aquatic life may be impeded by the used of silt fence.
2. Compost socks are not intended to treat substantial amounts of overland flow. However, compost
socks may be subjected to some ponding and concentrated flows. If intended primarily as a filtration
device, the socks should be sized and placed so that flows do not overtop the socks.
3. For purposes of long term sediment control objectives, compost socks may be seeded at the time of
installation to create an additional vegetated filtering component.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Compost socks shall be produced using a pneumatic blower hose or equivalent to fill a mesh tube with
compost to create a uniform cross-section and berm density.
2. Socks shall be filled so they are firmly – packed yet flexible. Upon initial filling, the socks shall be
filled to have a round cross-section. Once placed on the ground, it is recommended to apply weight to
the sock to improve contact with the underlying surface. This may cause the sock to assume an oval
shape.
3. Compost socks shall be a minimum of 8 inches in diameter. Larger diameter socks are recommended
for areas where ponding is expected behind the sock.
4. Compost socks shall not be used on slopes greater than 2H:1V.
5. Compost shall meet criteria in Reference Section 11-C of the SWDM, except for the particle size
distribution (see Bullet 7).
6. Compost shall be obtained from a supplier meeting the requirements in Reference Section 11-C.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-40
7. Compost particle size distribution shall be as follows: 99% passing a 1-inch sieve, 90% passing a
3/4-inch sieve and a minimum of 70% greater than the 3/8-inch sieve. A total of 98% shall not exceed
3 inches in length.
8. In order to prevent water from flowing around the ends of compost socks, the ends must be pointed
upslope so the ends of the socks are at a higher elevation than the remainder of the sock.
Maintenance Standards
1. Compost socks shall be regularly inspected to make sure the mesh tube remains undamaged, the socks
retain their shape, and allow adequate flow through of surface water. If the mesh tube is torn, it shall
be repaired using twine, zip-ties, or wire. Large sections of damaged socks must be replaced. Any
damage must be repaired immediately upon discovery of damage.
2. When the sock is no longer needed, the socks shall be cut open and the compost dispersed to be
incorporated into the soil or left on top of the soil for final seeding to occur. The mesh material must
be disposed of properly as solid waste. If spills of oil, antifreeze, hydraulic fluid, or other equipment
fluids have occurred that have saturated the sock, the compost must be disposed of properly as a
waste.
3. Sediment must be removed when sediment accumulations are within 3 inches of the top of the sock.
D.2.1.4 TRAFFIC AREA STABILIZATION
Unsurfaced entrances, roads, and parking areas used by construction traffic shall be stabilized to minimize
erosion and tracking of sediment off site. Stabilized construction entrances shall be installed as the first
step in clearing and grading. At the City’s discretion, road and parking area stabilization is not required
during the dry season (unless dust is a concern) or if the site is underlain by coarse-grained soils. Roads
and parking areas shall be stabilized immediately after initial grading.
Purpose: The purpose of traffic area stabilization is to reduce the amount of sediment transported off site
by construction vehicles and to reduce the erosion of areas disturbed by vehicle traffic. Sediment
transported off site onto paved streets is a significant problem because it is difficult to effectively remove,
and any sediment not removed ends up in the drainage system. Additionally, sediment on public right-of-
way can pose a serious traffic hazard. Construction road and parking area stabilization is important
because the combination of wet soil and heavy equipment traffic typically forms a slurry of easily erodible
mud. Finally, stabilization also is an excellent form of dust control in the summer months.
When to Install: The construction entrance is to be installed as the first step in clearing and grading.
Construction road stabilization shall occur immediately after initial grading of the construction roads and
parking areas.
Measures to Use: There are two types of traffic area stabilization: (1) a stabilized construction entrance
and (2) construction road/parking area stabilization. Both measures must be used as specified under
“Conditions of Use” for each measure.
D.2.1.4.1 STABILIZED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCE
Code: CE Symbol:
Purpose
Construction entrances are stabilized to reduce the amount of sediment transported onto paved roads by
motor vehicles or runoff by constructing a stabilized pad of quarry spalls at entrances to construction sites.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-41
Conditions of Use
Construction entrances shall be stabilized wherever traffic will be leaving a construction site and traveling
on paved roads or other paved areas within 1,000 feet of the site. Access and exits shall be limited to one
route if possible, or two for linear projects such as roadway where more than one access/exit is necessary
for maneuvering large equipment.
For residential construction provide stabilized construction entrances for each residence in addition to the
main subdivision entrance. Stabilized surfaces shall be of sufficient length/width to provide vehicle
access/parking, based on lot size/configuration.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.4.A for details.
2. A separation geotextile shall be placed under the spalls to prevent fine sediment from pumping up into
the rock pad. The geotextile shall meet the following standards:
Grab Tensile Strength (ASTM D4632) 200 lbs min.
Grab Tensile Elongation (ASTM D4632) 30% max.(woven)
Puncture Strength (ASTM D6241) 495 lbs min.
AOS (ASTM D4751) 20–45 (U.S. standard sieve size)
3. Do not use crushed concrete, cement, or calcium chloride for construction entrance stabilization
because these products raise pH levels in stormwater and concrete discharge to surface waters of the
State is prohibited.
4. Hog fuel (wood based mulch) may be substituted for or combined with quarry spalls in areas that will
not be used for permanent roads. The effectiveness of hog fuel is highly variable, but it has been used
successfully on many sites. It generally requires more maintenance than quarry spalls. Hog fuel is not
recommended for entrance stabilization in urban areas. The inspector may at any time require the use
of quarry spalls if the hog fuel is not preventing sediment from being tracked onto pavement or if the
hog fuel is being carried onto pavement. Hog fuel is prohibited in permanent roadbeds because
organics in the subgrade soils cause difficulties with compaction.
5. Fencing (see Section D.2.1.1) shall be installed as necessary to restrict traffic to the construction
entrance.
6. Whenever possible, the entrance shall be constructed on a firm, compacted subgrade. This can
substantially increase the effectiveness of the pad and reduce the need for maintenance.
Maintenance Standards
1. Quarry spalls (or hog fuel) shall be added if the pad is no longer in accordance with the specifications.
2. If the entrance is not preventing sediment from being tracked onto pavement, then alternative
measures to keep the streets free of sediment shall be used. This may include street sweeping, an
increase in the dimensions of the entrance, or the installation of a wheel wash. If washing is used, it
shall be done on an area covered with crushed rock, and wash water shall drain to a sediment trap or
pond.
3. Any sediment that is tracked onto pavement shall be removed immediately by sweeping. The sediment
collected by sweeping shall be removed or stabilized on site. The pavement shall not be cleaned by
washing down the street, except when sweeping is ineffective and there is a threat to public safety. If
it is necessary to wash the streets, a small sump must be constructed. The sediment would then be
washed into the sump where it can be controlled. Wash water must be pumped back onto the site and
cannot discharge to systems tributary to surface waters.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-42
4. Any quarry spalls that are loosened from the pad and end up on the roadway shall be removed
immediately.
5. If vehicles are entering or exiting the site at points other than the construction entrance(s), fencing (see
Section D.2.1.1) shall be installed to control traffic.
FIGURE D.2.1.4.A SCHEMATIC REPRESENTATION OF A STABILIZED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCE
D.2.1.4.2 CONSTRUCTION ROAD/PARKING AREA STABILIZATION
Code: CRS Symbol:
Purpose
Stabilizing subdivision roads, parking areas and other onsite vehicle transportation routes immediately
after grading reduces erosion caused by construction traffic or runoff.
Conditions of Use
1. Roads or parking areas shall be stabilized wherever they are constructed, whether permanent or
temporary, for use by construction traffic.
2. Fencing (see Section D.2.1.1) shall be installed, if necessary, to limit the access of vehicles to only
those roads and parking areas that are stabilized.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. A 6-inch depth of 2- to 4-inch crushed rock, gravel base, or crushed surfacing base course shall be
applied immediately after grading or utility installation. A 4-inch course of asphalt treated base (ATB)
may also be used, or the road/parking area may be paved. It may also be possible to use cement or
PER KING COUNTY ROAD DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION STANDARDS (KCRDCS), DRIVEWAYS SHALL
BE PAVED TO EDGE OF R-O-W PRIOR TO INSTALLATION OF THE CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCE TO
AVOID DAMAGING OF THE ROADWAY.
IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE ENTRANCE BE CROWNED SO THAT RUNOFF DRAINS OFF THE PAD.
12" MIN.
THICKNESS
PROVIDE FULL WIDTH OF
INGRESS/EGRESS AREA
IF A ROADSIDE DITCH IS
PRESENT, INSTALL
DRIVEWAY CULVERT
PER KCRDCS
GEOTEXTILE
4"- 8" QUARRY
SPALLS
R=25' MIN.
100' MIN.
E X I S T I N G R O A D
1 5 ' M I N .
NOTES:
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-43
calcium chloride for soil stabilization. If the area will not be used for permanent roads, parking areas,
or structures, a 6-inch depth of hog fuel may also be used, but this is likely to require more
maintenance. Whenever possible, construction roads and parking areas shall be placed on a firm,
compacted subgrade. Note: If the area will be used for permanent road or parking installation later in
the project, the subgrade will be subject to inspection.
2. Temporary road gradients shall not exceed 15 percent. Roadways shall be carefully graded to drain
transversely. Drainage ditches shall be provided on each side of the roadway in the case of a crowned
section, or on one side in the case of a super-elevated section. Drainage ditches shall be designed in
accordance with the standards given in Section D.2.1.6.4 and directed to a sediment pond or trap.
3. Rather than relying on ditches, it may also be possible to grade the road so that runoff sheet-flows
into a heavily vegetated area with a well-developed topsoil. Landscaped areas are not adequate. If this
area has at least 50 feet of vegetation, then it is generally preferable to use the vegetation to treat
runoff, rather than a sediment pond or trap. The 50 feet shall not include vegetated wetlands. If runoff
is allowed to sheet flow through adjacent vegetated areas, it is vital to design the roadways and
parking areas so that no concentrated runoff is created.
4. In order to control construction traffic, the City may require that signs be erected on site informing
construction personnel that vehicles, other than those performing clearing and grading, are restricted
to stabilized areas.
5. If construction roads do not adequately reduce trackout to adjacent property or roadways, a wheel
wash system will be required.
Maintenance Standards
Crushed rock, gravel base, hog fuel, etc., shall be added as required to maintain a stable driving surface
and to stabilize any areas that have eroded.
D.2.1.4.3 WHEEL WASH
Code: WW Symbol:
Purpose
Wheel wash systems reduce the amount of sediment transported onto paved roadways and into surface
water systems by construction vehicles.
Conditions of Use
When a stabilized construction entrance is not preventing sediment from being tracked onto pavement:
Wheel washing is generally an effective erosion and sediment control method and BMP when
installed with careful attention to topography. For example, a wheel wash can be detrimental if
installed at the top of a slope abutting a right-of-way where the water from the dripping truck wheels
and undercarriage can run unimpeded into the street.
Pressure washing combined with an adequately sized and properly surfaced wash pad with direct
drainage discharge to a large 10-foot x 10-foot sump can be very effective.
Design and Installation Specifications
A suggested detail is shown in Figure D.2.1.4.B.
1. A minimum of 6 inches of asphalt treated base (ATB) over crushed base material or 8 inches over a
good subgrade is recommended to pave the wheel wash area.
2. Use a low clearance truck to test the wheel wash before paving. Either a belly dump or lowboy will
work well to test clearance.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-44
3. Keep the water level from 12 to 14 inches deep to avoid damage to truck hubs and filling the truck
tongues with water.
4. Midpoint spray nozzles are only needed in very muddy conditions.
5. Wheel wash systems should be designed with a small grade change, 6 to 12 inches for a 10-foot-wide
pond, to allow sediment to flow to the low side of the pond and to help prevent re-suspension of
sediment.
6. A drainpipe with a 2- to 3-foot riser should be installed on the low side of the wheel wash pond to
allow for easy cleaning and refilling. Polymers may be used to promote coagulation and flocculation
in a closed-loop system.
7. Polyacrylamide (PAM) added to the wheel washwater at a rate of 0.25 to 0.5 pounds per 1,000 gallons
of water increases effectiveness and reduces cleanup time. If PAM is already being used for dust or
erosion control and is being applied by a water truck, the same truck may be used to change the
washwater.
Maintenance Standards
1. The wheel wash should start out each day with clean, fresh water.
2. The washwater should be changed a minimum of once per day. On large earthwork jobs where more
than 10 to 20 trucks per hour are expected, the washwater will need to be changed more often.
3. Wheel wash or tire bath wastewater shall be discharged to a separate onsite treatment system that
prevents discharge to surface water, or to the sanitary sewer system with proper approval and/or
permits from King County and the City of Renton.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-45
FIGURE D.2.1.4.B WHEEL WASH AND PAVED CONSTRUCTION ENTRANCE
2%
SLOPE
15'15'20'15'50'
18'
12'
3'
5'
BUILD 8'x8' SUMP TO ACCOMODATE
CLEANING BY TRACKHOE.
SECTION A-A
NTS
8'x8' SUMP,
SEE NOTE
LOCATE INVERT OF TOP
PIPE 1' ABOVE BOTTOM
OF WHEEL WASH
DRAIN PIPE 1:1 SLOPE
WATER LEVEL
ELEVATION VIEW
NTS
PLAN VIEW
NTS
6" SLEEVE
CURB
ASPHALT CURB ON THE
LOW ROAD SIDE TO DIRECT
WATER BACK TO POND
6" ATB CONSTRUCTION
ENTRANCE
1-1/2" SCHEDULE 40
FOR SPRAYERS
2% SLOPE
MIDPOINT SPRAY
NOZZLES, IF NEEDED
3" TRASH PUMP WITH FLOATS
ON SUCTION HOSE
2" SCHEDULE 40
6" SLEEVE UNDER ROAD
8'x8' SUMP WITH 5'
OF CATCH
6" SEWER PIPE WITH
BUTTERFLY VALVES
1:1 SLOPE
A
A
5:1
SLOPE
5:1
SLOPE
15' ATB APRON TO PROTECT
GROUND FROM SPLASHING WATER
BALL VALVES
NOTE:
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-46
D.2.1.5 SEDIMENT RETENTION
Surface water collected from disturbed areas of the site shall be routed through a sediment pond or trap
prior to release from the site. An exception is for areas at the perimeter of the site with drainage areas
small enough to be treated solely with perimeter protection (see Section D.2.1.3). Also, if the soils and
topography are such that no offsite discharge of surface water is anticipated up to and including the
developed 2-year runoff event, sediment ponds and traps are not required. A 10-year peak flow using the
approved model with 15-minute time steps shall be used for sediment pond/trap sizing if the project size,
expected timing and duration of construction, or downstream conditions warrant a higher level of
protection (see below). At the City’s discretion, sites may be worked during the dry season without
sediment ponds and traps if there is some other form of protection of surface waters, such as a 100-foot
forested buffer between the disturbed areas and adjacent surface waters. For small sites, use the criteria
defined in Section D.2.1.3, Perimeter Protection to determine minimum flow path length. If the site work
has to be extended into the wet season, a back-up plan must be identified in the CSWPP plan and
implemented. Protection of catch basins is required for inlets that are likely to be impacted by sediment
generated by the project and that do not drain to an onsite sediment pond or trap. Sediment retention
facilities shall be installed prior to grading of any contributing area and shall be located so as to avoid
interference with the movement of juvenile salmonids attempting to enter off-channel areas or drainages.
Purpose: The purpose of sediment retention facilities is to remove sediment from runoff generated from
disturbed areas.
When to Install: The facilities shall be constructed as the first step in the clearing and grading of the site.
The surface water conveyances may then be connected to the facilities as site development proceeds.
Measures to Use: There are three sediment retention measures in this section. The first two, sediment
traps and ponds, serve the same function but for different size catchments. All runoff from disturbed areas
must be routed through a trap or pond except for very small areas at the perimeter of the site small enough
to be treated solely with perimeter protection (see Section D.2.1.3). The third measure is for catch basin
protection. It is only to be used in limited circumstances and is not a primary sediment treatment facility. It
is only intended as a backup in the event of failure of other onsite systems.
Use of Permanent Drainage Facilities: All projects that are constructing permanent facilities for runoff
quantity control are strongly encouraged to use the rough-graded or final-graded permanent facilities for
ponds and traps. This includes combined facilities and infiltration facilities. When permanent facilities are
used as temporary sedimentation facilities, the surface area requirements of sediment traps (for drainages
less than 3 acres) or sediment ponds (more than 3 acres) must be met. If the surface area requirements are
larger than the surface area of the permanent facility, then the pond shall be enlarged to comply with the
surface area requirement. The permanent pond shall also be divided into two cells as required for sediment
ponds. Either a permanent control structure or the temporary control structure described in Section
D.2.1.5.2 may be used. If a permanent control structure is used, it may be advisable to partially restrict the
lower orifice with gravel to increase residence time while still allowing dewatering of the pond.
If infiltration facilities are to be used, the sides and bottom of the facility must only be rough excavated to
a minimum of three feet above final grade. Excavation should be done with a backhoe working at “arm’s
length” to minimize disturbance and compaction of the infiltration surface. Additionally, any required
pretreatment facilities shall be fully constructed prior to any release of sediment-laden water to the facility.
Pretreatment and shallow excavation are intended to prevent the clogging of soil with fines. Final grading
of the infiltration facility shall occur only when all contributing drainage areas are fully stabilized (see
Section D.2.4.5).
Selection of the Design Storm: In most circumstances, the developed condition 2-year peak flow using
the approved model with 15-minute time steps is sufficient for calculating surface area for ponds and traps
and for determining exemptions from the sediment retention and surface water collection requirements
(Sections D.2.1.5 and D.2.1.6, respectively). In some circumstances, however, the approved model 10-year
15-minute peak flow should be used. Examples of such circumstances include the following:
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-47
Sites that are within ¼ mile of salmonid streams, wetlands, and designated sensitive lakes such as
Lake Sammamish
Sites where significant clearing and grading is likely to occur during the wet season
Sites with downstream erosion or sedimentation problems.
Natural Vegetation: Whenever possible, sediment-laden water shall be discharged into onsite, relatively
level, vegetated areas. This is the only way to effectively remove fine particles from runoff. This can be
particularly useful after initial treatment in a sediment retention facility. The areas of release must be
evaluated on a site-by-site basis in order to determine appropriate locations for and methods of releasing
runoff. Vegetated wetlands shall not be used for this purpose. Frequently, it may be possible to pump
water from the collection point at the downhill end of the site to an upslope vegetated area. Pumping shall
only augment the treatment system, not replace it because of the possibility of pump failure or runoff
volume in excess of pump capacity.
D.2.1.5.1 SEDIMENT TRAP
Code: ST Symbol:
Purpose
Sediment traps remove sediment from runoff originating from disturbed areas of the site. Sediment traps
are typically designed to only remove sediment as small as medium silt (0.02 mm). As a consequence,
they usually only result in a small reduction in turbidity.
Conditions of Use
A sediment trap shall be used where the contributing drainage area is 3 acres or less.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.5.A for details.
2. If permanent runoff control facilities are part of the project, they should be used for sediment retention
(see “Use of Permanent Drainage Facilities” in Section D.2.1.5).
3. To determine the trap geometry, first calculate the design surface area (SA) of the trap, measured at the
invert of the weir. Use the following equation:
SA = FS(Q2/Vs)
where Q2 = Design inflow (cfs) from the contributing drainage area based on the developed
condition 2-year or 10-year peak discharge using the approved model with 15-minute
time steps as computed in the hydrologic analysis. The approved model 10-year
15-minute peak flow shall be used if the project size, expected timing and duration of
construction, or downstream conditions warrant a higher level of protection, or if the
pond discharge path leaves the site (note provisions must made to prevent increases
in the existing site conditions 2-year and 10-year runoff peaks discharging from the
project site during construction, see Section D.3.9, Flow Control). If no hydrologic
analysis is required, the Rational Method may be used (Section 3.2.1 of the SWDM).
Vs = The settling velocity (ft/sec) of the soil particle of interest. The 0.02 mm (medium
silt) particle with an assumed density of 2.65 g/cm3 has been selected as the particle
of interest and has a settling velocity (Vs) of 0.00096 ft/sec.
FS = A safety factor of 2 to account for non-ideal settling.
Therefore, the equation for computing surface area becomes:
SA = 2 x Q2/0.00096 or 2080 square feet per cfs of inflow
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-48
Note: Even if permanent facilities are used, they must still have a surface area that is at least as large
as that derived from the above formula. If they do not, the pond must be enlarged.
4. To aid in determining sediment depth, all traps shall have a staff gage with a prominent mark one foot
above the bottom of the trap.
Maintenance Standards
1. Sediment shall be removed from the trap when it reaches 1 foot in depth.
2. Any damage to the trap embankments or slopes shall be repaired.
FIGURE D.2.1.5.A SEDIMENT TRAP
NOTE:
TRAP MAY BE FORMED BY BERM OR BY
PARTIAL OR COMPLETE EXCAVATION
3
H
:
1
V
M
A
X
.FLAT BOTTOM
1' MIN.
18" MIN.
1' MIN.
1' MIN. DEPTH OVERFLOW SPILLWAY
CROSS SECTION
TRAP OUTLET
NATIVE SOIL OR
COMPACTED
BACKFILL
GEOTEXTILE
6' MIN.
MIN.1' DEPTH
2"-4" ROCK
MIN. 1' DEPTH 3/4"-1 1/2"
WASHED GRAVEL
4' MIN.
3.5'-5'
SURFACE AREA DETERMINED
AT TOP OF WEIR
DISCHARGE TO STABILIZED CONVEYANCE,
OUTLET OR LEVEL SPREADER
3/4"-1 1/2"
WASHED
GRAVEL GEOTEXTILE
2"-4" ROCK
RIPRAP
1' MIN. OVERFLOW
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-49
D.2.1.5.2 SEDIMENT POND
Code: SP Symbol:
Purpose
Sediment ponds remove sediment from runoff originating from disturbed areas of the site. Sediment ponds
are typically designed to only remove sediment as small as medium silt (0.02 mm). As a consequence,
they usually reduce turbidity only slightly.
Conditions of Use
A sediment pond shall be used where the contributing drainage area is 3 acres or more.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.5.B, Figure D.2.1.5.C, and Figure D.2.1.5.D for details.
2. If permanent runoff control facilities are part of the project, they should be used for sediment retention
(see “Use of Permanent Drainage Facilities” in Section D.2.1.5).
Determining Pond Geometry
1. Obtain the discharge from the hydrologic calculations for the 2-year and 10-year peak flows using the
approved model with 15-minute time steps (Q2 and Q10). The approved model 10-year 15-minute peak
flow shall be used if the project size, expected timing and duration of construction, or downstream
conditions warrant a higher level of protection, or if the pond discharge path leaves the site (note
provisions must made to prevent increases in the existing site conditions 2-year and 10-year runoff
peaks discharging from the project site during construction, see Section D.3.9, Flow Control). If no
hydrologic analysis is required, the Rational Method may be used (Section 3.2.1 of the SWDM).
2. Determine the required surface area at the top of the riser pipe with the equation:
SA = 2 x Q10/0.00096 or 2080 square feet per cfs of inflow
See Section D.2.1.5.1 for more information on the derivation of the surface area calculation.
3. The basic geometry of the pond can now be determined using the following design criteria:
Required surface area SA (from Step 2 above) at top of riser
Minimum 3.5-foot depth from top of riser to bottom of pond
Maximum 3:1 interior side slopes and maximum 2:1 exterior slopes. The interior slopes may be
increased to a maximum of 2:1 if fencing is provided at or above the maximum water surface
One foot of freeboard between the top of the riser and the crest of the emergency spillway
Flat bottom
Minimum one foot deep spillway
Length-to-width ratio between 3:1 and 6:1.
Sizing of Discharge Mechanisms
Principal Spillway: Determine the required diameter for the principal spillway (riser pipe). The diameter
shall be the minimum necessary to pass the developed condition 10-year peak flow using the approved
model with 15-minute time steps (Q10). Use Figure 5.1.4.H (SWDM Chapter 5) to determine this diameter
(h = one foot). Note: A permanent control structure may be used instead of a temporary riser.
Emergency Overflow Spillway: Determine the required size and design of the emergency overflow
spillway for the developed condition 100-year approved model 15-minute peak flow using the procedure
in Section 5.1.1 (“Emergency Overflow Spillway” subsection) of the SWDM.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-50
Dewatering Orifice: Determine the size of the dewatering orifice(s) (minimum 1-inch diameter) using a
modified version of the discharge equation for a vertical orifice and a basic equation for the area of a
circular orifice.
1. Determine the required area of the orifice with the following equation:
hATg
hAA sso)10(81.43600x6.0
)2(6
5.0
5.0
where Ao = orifice area (square feet)
As = pond surface area (square feet)
h = head of water above orifice (height of riser in feet)
T = dewatering time (24 hours)
g = acceleration of gravity (32.2 feet/second2)
2. Convert the required surface area to the required diameter D (inches) of the orifice:
o
o AADx54.13x24
3. The vertical, perforated tubing connected to the dewatering orifice must be at least 2 inches larger in
diameter than the orifice to improve flow characteristics. The size and number of perforations in the
tubing should be large enough so that the tubing does not restrict flow. The flow rate should be
controlled by the orifice.
Additional Design Specifications
The pond shall be divided into two roughly equal volume cells by a permeable divider that will
reduce turbulence while allowing movement of water between cells. The divider shall be at least one-
half the height of the riser and a minimum of one foot below the top of the riser. Wire-backed, 2- to 3-
foot high, extra strength filter fabric (see Section D.2.1.3.1) supported by treated 4″ x 4″s may be used
as a divider. Alternatively, staked straw bales wrapped with filter fabric (geotextile) may be used.
If the pond is more than 6 feet deep, a different mechanism must be proposed. A riprap embankment
is one acceptable method of separation for deeper ponds. Other designs that satisfy the intent of this
provision are allowed as long as the divider is permeable, structurally sound, and designed to prevent
erosion under or around the barrier.
To aid in determining sediment depth, one-foot intervals shall be prominently marked on the riser.
If an embankment of more than 6 feet is proposed, the pond must comply with the criteria under
“Embankments” in Section 5.1.1 of the Surface Water Design Manual.
Maintenance Standards
1. Sediment shall be removed from the pond when it reaches 1 foot in depth.
2. Any damage to the pond embankments or slopes shall be repaired.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-51
FIGURE D.2.1.5.B SEDIMENT POND PLAN VIEW
FIGURE D.2.1.5.C SEDIMENT POND CROSS SECTION
INFLOW
NOTE:
POND MAY BE FORMED BY BERM OR BY
PARTIAL OR COMPLETE EXCAVATION
DISCHARGE TO
STABILIZED
CONVEYANCE,
OUTLET OR LEVEL
SPREADER
EMERGENCY
OVERFLOW
SPILLWAY
KEY DIVIDER INTO SLOPE TO
PREVENT FLOW AROUND SIDES
THE POND LENGTH SHALL
BE 3 TO 6 TIMES THE
MAXIMUM POND WIDTH
SILT FENCE OR
EQUIVALENT
DIVIDER
RISER
PIPE
POND LENGTH
3
H
:
1
V
M
A
X
.
RISER PIPE (PRINCIPAL
SPILLWAY) OPEN AT TOP WITH
TRASH RACK PER FIG. 5.1.1.C
DEWATERING
DEVICE (SEE
RISER DETAIL)
2
H
:
1
V
M
A
X
.3H
:
1
V
MA
X
.
WIRE-BACKED SILT
FENCE, STAKED STRAW
BALES WRAPPED WITH
FILTER FABRIC, OR
EQUIVALENT DIVIDER
CONCRETE BASE
(SEE RISER DETAIL)
DISCHARGE TO STABILIZED
CONVEYANCE, OUTLET OR
LEVEL SPREADER
DEWATERING
ORIFICE
CREST OF
EMERGENCY
SPILLWAY
1'
6' MIN. BERM WIDTH
EMBANKMENT
COMPACTED 95%
MODIFIED PROCTOR.
PERVIOUS MATERIALS
SUCH AS GRAVEL OR
CLEAN SAND SHALL
NOT BE USED.
1' MIN.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-52
FIGURE D.2.1.5.D SEDIMENT POND RISER DETAIL
D.2.1.5.3 STORM DRAIN INLET PROTECTION
Code: FFP or CBI or CBP Symbol: or or
Purpose
Storm drain inlets are protected to prevent coarse sediment from entering storm drainage systems.
Temporary devices around storm drains assist in improving the quality of water discharged to inlets or
catch basins by ponding sediment-laden water. These devices are effective only for relatively small
drainage areas.
Conditions of Use
1. Protection shall be provided for all storm drain inlets downslope and within 500 feet of a disturbed or
construction area, unless the runoff that enters the catch basin will be conveyed to a sediment pond or
trap.
2. Inlet protection may be used anywhere at the applicant’s discretion to protect the drainage system.
This will, however, require more maintenance, and it is highly likely that the drainage system will still
require some cleaning.
3. The contributing drainage area must not be larger than one acre.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. There are many options for protecting storm drain inlets. Two commonly used options are filter
fabric protection and catch basin inserts. Filter fabric protection (see Figure D.2.1.5.E) is filter fabric
(geotextile) placed over the grate. This method is generally very ineffective and requires intense
maintenance efforts. Therefore, filter fabric protection is not allowed in the City of Renton. Catch
basin inserts (see Figure D.2.1.5.F) are manufactured devices that nest inside a catch basin. This
method also requires a high frequency of maintenance to be effective.
3.5' MIN.
18" MIN.
2X RISER DIA. MIN.
CORRUGATED
METAL RISER
CONCRETE BASE ALTERNATIVELY, METAL
STAKES AND WIRE MAY
BE USED TO PREVENT
FLOTATION
DEWATERING ORIFICE,
SCHEDULE 40 STEEL
STUB MIN. DIAMETER
AS PER CALCULATIONS
6" MIN.
PROVIDE
ADEQUATE
STRAPPING
POLYETHYLENE CAP
PERFORATED
DEWATERING DEVICE,
SEE NOTE WATERTIGHT
COUPLING TACK
WELD
NOTE:
PERFORATED CORRUGATED
POLYETHYLENE (CPE)
DRAINAGE TUBING, DIAMETER
MIN. 2" LARGER THAN
DEWATERING ORIFICE. TUBING
SHALL COMPLY WITH ASTM
F667 AND AASHTO M294.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-53
Trapping sediment in the catch basins is unlikely to improve the water quality of runoff if it is treated
in a pond or trap because the coarse particles that are trapped at the catch basin settle out very quickly
in the pond or trap. Catch basin protection normally only improves water quality where there is
no treatment facility downstream. In these circumstances, catch basin protection is an important last
line of defense. It is not, however, a substitute for preventing erosion.
2. It is sometimes possible to construct a small sump around the catch basin before final surfacing of the
road. This is allowed because it can be a very effective method of sediment control.
3. Block and gravel filters, gravel and wire mesh filter barriers, and bag barriers filled with various
filtering media placed around catch basins can be effective when the drainage area is 1 acre or less and
flows do not exceed 0.5 cfs. It is necessary to allow for overtopping to prevent flooding. Many
manufacturers have various inlet protection filters that are very effective in keeping sediment-laden
water from entering the storm drainage system. The following are examples of a few common
methods.
a) Block and gravel filters (Figure D.2.1.5.G) are a barrier formed around an inlet with standard
concrete block and gravel, installed as follows:
Height is 1 to 2 feet above the inlet.
Recess the first row of blocks 2 inches into the ground for stability.
Support subsequent rows by placing a 2x4 through the concrete block opening.
Do not use mortar.
Lay some blocks in the bottom row on their side for dewatering the pooled water.
Place cloth or mesh with ½ inch openings over all block openings.
Place gravel below the top of blocks on slopes of 2:1 or flatter.
An alternate design is a gravel donut.
b) Gravel and wire mesh filters consist of a gravel barrier placed over the top of an inlet. This
structure generally does not provide overflow. Install as follows:
Cloth or comparable wire mesh with ½ inch openings is placed over inlet.
Coarse aggregate covers the cloth or mesh.
Height/depth of gravel should be 1 foot or more, 18 inches wider than inlet on all sides.
c) Curb inlet protection with a wooden weir is a barrier formed around an inlet with a wooden
frame and gravel, installed as follows:
Construct a frame and attach wire mesh (½ inch openings) and filter fabric to the frame.
Pile coarse washed aggregate against the wire/fabric.
Place weight on frame anchors.
d) Curb and gutter sediment barriers (Figure D.2.1.5.H) consist of sandbags or rock berms (riprap
and aggregate) 3 feet high and 3 feet wide in a horseshoe shape, installed as follows:
Bags of either burlap or woven geotextile fabric, filled with a variety of media such as gravel,
wood chips, compost or sand stacked tightly allows water to pond and allows sediment to
separate from runoff.
Leave a “one bag gap” in the top row of the barrier to provide a spillway for overflow.
Construct a horseshoe shaped berm, faced with coarse aggregate if using riprap, 3 x 3 and at
least 2 feet from the inlet.
Construct a horseshoe shaped sedimentation trap on the outside of the berm to sediment trap
standards for protecting a culvert inlet.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-54
4. Excavated drop inlet sediment traps are appropriate where relatively heavy flows are expected and
overflow capability is needed. If emergency overflow is provided, additional end-of-pipe treatment
may be required. Excavated drop inlets consist of an excavated impoundment area around a storm
drain. Sediment settles out of the stormwater prior to enter the drain. Install according to the following
specifications:
a) The impoundment area should have a depth of 1 to 2 feet measured from the crest of the inlet
structure.
b) Side slopes of the excavated area must be no steeper than 2:1.
c) Minimum volume of the excavated area should be 35 cubic yards.
d) Install provisions for draining the area to prevent standing water problems.
e) Keep the area clear of debris.
f) Weep holes may be drilled into the side of the inlet.
g) Protect weep holes with wire mesh and washed aggregate.
h) Weep holes must be sealed when removing and stabilizing excavated area.
i) A temporary dike may be necessary on the down slope side of the structure to prevent bypass
flow.
Maintenance Standards
1. Any accumulated sediment on or around inlet protection shall be removed immediately. Sediment
shall not be removed with water, and all sediment must be disposed of as fill on site or hauled off site.
2. Any sediment in the catch basin insert shall be removed when the sediment has filled one-third of the
available storage. The filter media for the insert shall be cleaned or replaced at least monthly.
3. Regular maintenance is critical for all forms of catch basin/inlet protection. Unlike many forms of
protection that fail gradually, catch basin protection will fail suddenly and completely if not
maintained properly.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-55
FIGURE D.2.1.5.E FILTER FABRIC PROTECTION (NOT ALLOWED)
FIGURE D.2.1.5.F CATCH BASIN INSERT
CATCH BASIN
NOTE: ONLY TO BE USED WHERE
PONDING OF WATER ABOVE THE
CATCH BASIN WILL NOT CAUSE
TRAFFIC PROBLEMS AND WHERE
OVERFLOW WILL NOT RESULT IN
EROSION OF SLOPES.
GRATE
STANDARD STRENGTH
FILTER FABRIC
NOTE: THIS DETAIL IS ONLY
SCHEMATIC. ANY INSERT IS
ALLOWED THAT HAS:
A MIN. 0.5 C.F. OF STORAGE,
THE MEANS TO DEWATER THE
STORED SEDIMENT,
AN OVERFLOW, AND
CAN BE EASILY MAINTAINED.
OVERFLOW
GRATECATCH BASIN
POROUS
BOTTOM
SOLID
WALLS
FILTER
MEDIA FOR
DEWATERING
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-56
FIGURE D.2.1.5.G BLOCK AND GRAVEL CURB INLET PROTECTION
1. USE BLOCK AND GRAVEL TYPE SEDIMENT BARRIER WHEN CURB INLET IS LOCATED
IN GENTLY SLOPING SEGMENT, WHERE WATER CAN POND AND ALLOW SEDIMENT TO
SEPARATE FROM RUNOFF.
2. BARRIER SHALL ALLOW FOR OVERFLOW FROM SEVERE STORM EVENT.
3. INSPECT BARRIERS AND REMOVE SEDIMENT AFTER EACH STORM EVENT. SEDIMENT
AND GRAVEL MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE TRAVELED WAY IMMEDIATELY.
2x4 WOOD STUD
OVERFLOW
WATER
A
A
PLAN VIEW
NTS
SECTION A-A
NTS
BLOCK AND GRAVEL CURB INLET PROTECTION
NTS
CATCH BASIN COVER
CURB INLET
CONCRETE BLOCKS
CATCH BASIN COVER
CURB INLET
CATCH BASIN
BACK OF SIDEWALK
CURB FACE
3/4" DRAIN
GRAVEL (20 mm)
WIRE SCREEN OR
FILTER FABRIC
POND HEIGHT
WIRE SCREEN
OR FILTER FABRIC
2x4 WOOD STUD
(100x50 TIMBER STUD)
3/4" DRAIN
GRAVEL (20 mm)
NOTES:
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-57
FIGURE D.2.1.5.H CURB AND GUTTER BARRIER PROTECTION
RUNOFF
RUNOFF
SPILLWAY
1. PLACE CURB-TYPE SEDIMENT BARRIERS ON GENTLY SLOPING STREET SEGMENTS,
WHERE WATER CAN POND AND ALLOW SEDIMENT TO SEPARATE FROM RUNOFF.
2. SANDBAGS OF EITHER BURLAP OR WOVEN GEOTEXTILE FABRIC ARE FILLED WITH
GRAVEL, LAYERED AND PACKED TIGHTLY.
3. LEAVE A ONE-SANDBAG GAP IN THE TOP ROW TO PROVIDE A SPILLWAY FOR OVERFLOW.
4. INSPECT BARRIERS AND REMOVE SEDIMENT AFTER EACH STORM EVENT. SEDIMENT
AND GRAVEL MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE TRAVELED WAY IMMEDIATELY.
GRAVEL FILLED SANDBAGS
STACKED TIGHTLY
DRAIN GRATE
GUTTER
CURB FACE
CURB INLET
SANDBAGS TO OVERLAP
ONTO CURB
BACK OF SIDEWALK
PLAN VIEW
NTS
CURB AND GUTTER BARRIER
NTS
NOTES:
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-58
D.2.1.6 SURFACE WATER COLLECTION
All surface water from disturbed areas shall be intercepted, conveyed to a sediment pond or trap, and
discharged downslope of any disturbed areas. An exception is for areas at the perimeter of the site with
drainage areas small enough to be treated solely with perimeter protection (see Section D.2.1.3). Also, if
the soils and topography are such that no offsite discharge of surface water is anticipated up to and
including the developed 2-year runoff event, surface water controls are not required. A 10-year approved
model 15-minute peak flow shall be used for sizing surface water controls if the project size, expected
timing and duration of construction, or downstream conditions warrant a higher level of protection (see the
introduction to Section D.2.1.5). At the City’s discretion, sites may be worked during the dry season
without surface water controls, if there is some other form of protection of surface waters, such as a
100-foot forested buffer between the disturbed areas and adjacent surface waters. Significant sources of
upslope surface water that drain onto disturbed areas shall be intercepted and conveyed to a stabilized
discharge point downslope of the disturbed areas. Surface water controls shall be installed concurrently
with rough grading.
Purpose: The purpose of surface water control is to collect and convey surface water so that erosion is
minimized, and runoff from disturbed areas is treated by a sediment pond or trap. Surface water control
essentially consists of three elements:
1. Interception of runoff on and above slopes
2. Conveyance of the runoff to a sediment pond or trap (if the runoff was collected from a disturbed
area)
3. Release of the runoff downslope of any disturbed areas.
When to Install: Surface water controls shall be constructed during the initial grading of an area and must
be in place before there is any opportunity for storm runoff to cause erosion.
Measures to Install: Interceptor dikes/swales intercept runoff, ditches and pipe slope drains convey the
runoff, and riprap or level spreaders help release the runoff in a non-erosive manner. Each measure is to be
used under different circumstances so there is very little overlap. However, the two options for releasing
water in a non-erosive manner, outlet protection and level spreaders, can be somewhat interchangeable.
See Figure D.2.1.6.A for a schematic drawing demonstrating the use of these measures.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-59
FIGURE D.2.1.6.A SKETCH PLAN OF SURFACE WATER CONTROLS
D.2.1.6.1 INTERCEPTOR DIKE AND SWALE
Code: ID or IS Symbol: or
Purpose
Interceptor dikes and swales intercept storm runoff from drainage areas on or above disturbed slopes and
convey it to a sediment pond or trap. They may also be used to intercept runoff from undisturbed areas and
convey the runoff to a point below any exposed soils. Interception of surface water reduces the possibility
of slope erosion. Interceptor dikes and swales differ from ditches (see Section D.2.1.6.4) in that they are
intended to convey smaller flows along low-gradient drainage ways to larger conveyance systems such as
ditches or pipe slope drains.
Conditions of Use
Interceptor dikes and swales are required in the following situations:
1. At the top of all slopes in excess of 3H:1V and with more than 20 feet of vertical relief.
2. At intervals on any slope that exceeds the dimensions specified in this section for the horizontal
spacing of dikes and swales.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.6.B for details of an interceptor dike and Figure D.2.1.6.C for an interceptor swale.
2. Interceptor dikes and swales shall be spaced horizontally as follows:
Average Slope Slope Percent Flowpath Length
20H:1V or less 3–5% 300 feet
(10 to 20)H:1V 5–10% 200 feet
(4 to 10)H:1V 10–25% 100 feet
(2 to 4)H:1V 25–50% 50 feet
INTERCEPTOR DIKE
TOP OF SLOPE
TOE OF SLOPE
OUTLET
PROTECTION
DITCH
SEDIMENT POND
SILT FENCE
STREAM
PIPE SLOPE DRAIN
FLOW
ID
PD
ID
OP
DI
SP
SF
SF
OP
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-60
3. For slopes steeper than 2H:1V with more than 10 feet of vertical relief, benches may be constructed
or closer spaced interceptor dikes or swales may be used. Whichever measure is chosen, the spacing
and capacity of the measures must be designed by the engineer and the design must include provisions
for effectively intercepting the high velocity runoff associated with steep slopes.
4. If the dike or swale intercepts runoff from disturbed areas, it shall discharge to a stable conveyance
system that routes the runoff to a sediment pond or trap (see Section D.2.1.5). If the dike or swale
intercepts runoff that originates from undisturbed areas, it shall discharge to a stable conveyance
system that routes the runoff downslope of any disturbed areas and releases the water at a stabilized
outlet.
5. Construction traffic over temporary dikes and swales shall be minimized.
Maintenance Standards
1. Damage resulting from runoff or construction activity shall be repaired immediately.
2. If the facilities do not regularly retain storm runoff, the capacity and/or frequency of the dikes/swales
shall be increased.
FIGURE D.2.1.6.B INTERCEPTOR DIKE
FIGURE D.2.1.6.C INTERCEPTOR SWALE
DIKE SPACING DEPENDS ON SLOPE GRADIENT
2' MIN.18" MIN.
2 MAX.
12 MAX.
1
DIKE MATERIAL COMPACTED
90% MODIFIED PROCTOR
SWALE SPACING DEPENDS ON SLOPE GRADIENT
2' MIN.
1' MIN.
LEVEL BOTTOM
2:1 MAX. SLOPE
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-61
D.2.1.6.2 PIPE SLOPE DRAINS
Code: PD Symbol:
Purpose
Pipe slope drains are designed to carry concentrated runoff down steep slopes without causing erosion, or
saturation of slide-prone soils. Pipe slope drains may be used to divert water away from or over bare soil
to prevent gullies, channel erosion, and saturation of slide prone soils
Conditions of Use
Pipe slope drains should be used when a temporary or permanent stormwater conveyance is needed to
move water down a steep slope to avoid erosion. Pipe slope drains may be:
1. Connected to new catch basins and used temporarily until all permanent piping is installed.
2. Used on any slope with a gradient of 2H:1V or greater and with at least 10 feet of vertical relief.
3. Used to drain water collected from aquifers exposed on cut slopes and convey it to the base of the
slope.
4. Used to collect clean runoff from plastic sheet cover and direct away from any exposed soils.
5. Installed in conjunction with silt fence to drain collected water to a controlled area.
6. Used to divert small seasonal streams away from construction. Pipe slope drains have been used
successfully on culvert replacement and extension projects. Large flex pipe may be used on larger
streams during culvert removal, repair, or replacement.
7. Connected to existing downspouts and roof drains used to divert water away from work areas during
building renovation, demolition, and construction projects.
8. Rock-lined ditches or other permanent, non-erosive conveyances used to convey runoff down steep
slopes that are not steep slope hazard areas.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.6.D for details.
2. The capacity for temporary drains shall be sufficient to handle the developed 10-year peak flow using
the approved model with 15-minute time steps. Up to 30,000 square feet may be drained by each
6--inch minimum diameter pipe without computation of the peak flow. Up to 2 acres may be drained
by each 12-inch minimum diameter pipe without computation of the peak flow. Otherwise, the peak
flow will need to be computed using the approved model with 15-minute timesteps. If no hydrologic
analysis is required for the site, the Rational Method described in Section 3.2.1 of the SWDM may be
used.
3. The maximum drainage area allowed for any sized pipe is 10 acres. For larger areas, more than one
pipe shall be used or a rock-lined channel shall be installed (see SWDM Section 4.4.1, “Open
Channels”).
4. The soil around and under the pipe and entrance section shall be thoroughly compacted.
5. The flared inlet section shall be securely connected to the slope drain and be fused or welded, or have
flange-bolted mechanical joints to ensure a watertight seal. Ensure that the entrance area is stable and
large enough to direct flow into the pipe.
6. Slope drains shall be continuously fused, welded, or flange-bolted mechanical joint pipe systems with
proper anchoring to the soil.
7. Where slope drains cross steep slope hazard areas or their associated buffers, the installation shall be
on the ground surface, accomplished with minimum alteration. In most circumstances, this requires
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-62
that slope drains be constructed of corrugated metal, CPE, or equivalent pipe and installed by hand
(see SWDM Section 4.2.1). Any area disturbed during installation or maintenance must be
immediately stabilized.
8. If the pipe slope drain will convey sediment-laden runoff, the runoff must be directed to a sediment
retention facility (see Section D.2.1.5). If the runoff is not from a disturbed area or is conveyed from a
sediment trap or pond, it must be conveyed to a stabilized discharge point (see Section D.2.1.6.5).
9. Re-establish cover immediately on areas disturbed by the installation.
Maintenance Standards
1. The inlet shall not be undercut or bypassed by water. If there are problems, the head wall shall be
appropriately reinforced.
2. No erosion shall occur at the outlet point. If erosion occurs, additional protection shall be added.
FIGURE D.2.1.6.D PIPE SLOPE DRAIN
D.2.1.6.3 SUBSURFACE DRAINS
Purpose
To intercept, collect, and convey ground water to a satisfactory outlet, using a perforated pipe or conduit
below the ground surface. Subsurface drains are also known as “French Drains.” The perforated pipe
provides a dewatering mechanism to drain excessively wet soils, provide a stable base for construction,
improve stability of structures with shallow foundations, or to reduce hydrostatic pressure and to improve
slope stability.
Conditions of Use
Use when excessive water must be removed from the soil. The soil permeability, depth to water table, and
impervious layers are all factors that may govern the use of subsurface drains.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Two types of drains may be used as follows:
a) Relief drains are used either to lower the water table in large, relatively flat areas, improve the
growth of vegetation, or to remove surface water. They are installed along a slope and drain in the
direction of the slope. They may be installed in a grid pattern, a herringbone pattern, or a random
pattern.
INLET AND ALL SECTIONS
MUST BE SECURELY
FASTENED TOGETHER
WITH GASKETED
WATERTIGHT FITTINGS
DIKE MATERIAL COMPACTED
90% MODIFIED PROCTOR
CPE PIPE (LINED OR
UNLINED) OR EQUIVALENT
INTERCEPTOR
DIKE
INTERCEPTOR
DIKE
PROVIDE RIPRAP PAD OR
EQUIVALENT ENERGY
DISSIPATION
DISCHARGE TO A STABILIZED
WATERCOURSE, SEDIMENT
RETENTION FACILITY OR
STABILIZED OUTLET
STANDARD
FLARED
END SECTION
12"
MIN.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-63
b) Interceptor drains are used to remove excess groundwater from a slope, stabilize steep slopes,
and lower the water table below a slope to prevent the soil from becoming saturated. They are
installed perpendicular to a slope and drain to the side of the slope. They usually consist of a
single pipe or single pipes instead of a patterned layout.
2. Size of Drains – Size subsurface drains to carry the required capacity without pressurized flow.
Minimum diameter for a subsurface drain is 4 inches.
3. Outlet – Ensure that the outlet of a drain empties into a channel or other watercourse above the
normal water level.
Maintenance Standards
1. Subsurface drains shall be checked periodically to ensure that they are free flowing and not clogged
with sediment or roots.
2. The outlet shall be kept clear and free of debris.
3. Surface inlets shall be kept open and free of sediment and other debris.
4. Trees located too close to a subsurface drain often clog the system with roots. If a drain becomes
clogged, relocate the drain or remove the trees as a last resort. Drain placement should be planned to
minimize this problem.
5. Where drains are crossed by heavy equipment, the line shall be checked to ensure that it is not crushed
and have adequate cover protection.
D.2.1.6.4 DITCHES
Code: DI Symbol:
Purpose
Ditches convey intercepted runoff from disturbed areas to and from sediment ponds or traps. They also
convey runoff intercepted from undisturbed areas around the site to a non-erosive discharge point.
Conditions of Use
Ditches may be used anywhere that concentrated runoff is to be conveyed on or around the construction
site. Temporary pipe systems may also be used to convey runoff.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Channels and ditches shall be sized to accommodate the developed condition 10-year approved model
15-minute peak flow with 0.5 feet of freeboard. If no hydrologic analysis is required for the site, the
Rational Method may be used (see Section 3.2.1 of the SWDM).
2. See SWDM Section 4.4.1 for open-channel design requirements.
3. The only exception to the requirements of SWDM Section 4.4.1 is the use of check dams, rather than
grass lining, for channels in which the design flow velocity does not exceed 5 fps. See Figure
D.2.1.6.E for details on check dam installation.
Maintenance Standards
1. Any sediment deposition of more than 0.5 feet shall be removed so that the channel is restored to its
design capacity.
2. If the channel capacity is insufficient for the design flow, it must be determined whether the problem
is local (e.g., a constriction or bend) or the channel is under-designed. If the problem is local, the
channel capacity must be increased through construction of a berm(s) or by excavation. If the problem
is under-design, the design engineer shall be notified and the channel redesigned to a more
conservative standard to be approved by the City of Renton.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-64
3. The channel shall be examined for signs of scouring and erosion of the bed and banks. If scouring or
erosion has occurred, affected areas shall be protected by riprap or an erosion control blanket or net.
FIGURE D.2.1.6.E CHECK DAMS
D.2.1.6.5 OUTLET PROTECTION
Code: OP Symbol:
Purpose
Outlet protection prevents scour at conveyance outlets.
Conditions of Use
Outlet protection is required at the outlets of all ponds, pipes, ditches, or other approved conveyances, and
where runoff is conveyed to a natural or manmade drainage feature such as a stream, wetland, lake, or
ditch.
Design and Installation Specifications
For the standard pipe slope drains in Section D.2.1.6.2 and other smaller conveyance systems, the standard
rock pad (6 feet by 8 feet) made of 1-foot thick quarry spall is adequate. For all other outlets, the outlet
protection shall meet the requirements of the “Outfalls” section of Core Requirement #4 and Section 4.2.2
of the SWDM.
Maintenance Standards for Outlet Protection
If there is scour at the outlet, the eroded area shall be protected with more conservative measures proposed
by the design engineer and approved by the City of Renton.
6" MIN.
ROCK MUST COMPLETELY COVER
THE BOTTOM AND SIDES OF THE DITCH
24" MIN.
2H:1V SLOPES
L 2"- 4" ROCKBA
L=THE DISTANCE SUCH THAT POINTS
A AND B ARE OF EQUAL ELEVATION
CROSS SECTION
CHECK DAM SPACING
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-65
D.2.1.6.6 LEVEL SPREADER
Code: LS Symbol:
Purpose
Level spreaders convert concentrated runoff to sheet flow and release it onto areas stabilized by existing
vegetation.
Conditions of Use
Level spreaders may be used where runoff from undisturbed areas or sediment retention facilities is
discharged. This practice applies only where the spreader can be constructed on undisturbed soil and the
area below the level lip is vegetated and low gradient (see below).
Note: Level spreaders are conceptually an ideal way to release stormwater since the vegetation and soil
allow for the removal of fines from runoff that cannot be removed by settling or filtration. Unfortunately,
the performance record of spreaders in the field is dismal. They are frequently under-designed and,
despite the best installations, are rarely perfectly level, which results in the release of stormwater at a
particular point. This concentrated runoff can result in catastrophic erosion downslope. Given such
design failures, the use of spreaders is not encouraged. However, where slopes are gentle and the water
volume is relatively low, spreaders may still be the best method. When proposing their use, the designer
shall carefully evaluate the site for possible concerns.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. See Figure D.2.1.6.F for detail. Other designs may be used subject to City approval.
2. If runoff velocity as it enters the level spreader is more than 4 fps for the developed condition 10-year
approved model 15-minute peak flow, a riprap apron must be provided to dissipate energy before the
runoff enters the spreader (Section D.2.1.6.5).
3. The total spreader length shall be at least the square root of the catchment area. The maximum
length for an individual spreader is 50 feet, limiting the catchment area that a single spreader may
serve to 2500 square feet. Although this is very small, four 50-foot level spreaders next to one another
could serve nearly an acre (40,000 square feet). Multiple spreaders shall not be placed uphill or
downhill from one another in a configuration that would allow water released from one spreader to
enter a downslope spreader.
4. The area below the spreader for a horizontal distance of 100 feet shall not exceed 20 percent and shall
be completely vegetated with no areas of instability or erosion. The topography for a horizontal
distance of 50 feet below the spreader shall be uniform so that runoff is not funneled into a swale or
channel immediately after its release.
5. The area below the level spreader shall be seeded and mulched in accordance with Section D.2.1.2.
Maintenance Standards
1. Any damage to the spreader shall be immediately repaired. Ensure flows do not bypass the spreader at
the ends of the spreader.
2. The downslope area shall be checked for signs of erosion and to verify that the spreader is not
functioning as a point discharge. Any eroded areas shall be immediately stabilized, and the cause
determined and eliminated if possible. If the erosion is recurrent and the design, even when properly
installed and maintained, is not adequate to prevent erosion, a new method of releasing runoff shall be
installed in accordance with the standards of this appendix. Any new design must be approved by the
City of Renton.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-66
FIGURE D.2.1.6.F LEVEL SPREADER
D.2.1.7 DEWATERING CONTROL
Any runoff generated by dewatering shall be treated through construction of a sediment trap
(Section D.2.1.5.1) when there is sufficient space or by releasing the water to a well vegetated, gently
sloping area. Since pumps are used for dewatering, it may be possible to pump the sediment-laden water
well away from the surface water so that vegetation can be more effectively utilized for treatment.
Discharge of sediment-laden water from dewatering activities to surface and storm waters is prohibited. If
dewatering occurs from areas where the water has come in contact with new concrete, such as tanks,
vaults, or foundations, the pH of the water must be monitored and must be neutralized prior to discharge.
Clean non-turbid dewatering water, such as well point ground water can be discharged to systems tributary
to, or directly to surface waters provided the flows are controlled so no erosion or flooding occurs. Clean
water must not be routed through a stormwater sediment pond. Highly turbid or contaminated dewatering
water must be handled separately from stormwater.
Purpose: To prevent the untreated discharge of sediment-laden water from dewatering of utilities,
excavated areas, foundations, etc.
When to Install: Dewatering control measures shall be used whenever there is a potential for runoff from
dewatering of utilities, excavations, foundations, etc.
Measures to install:
1. Foundation, vault, excavation, and trench dewatering water that has similar characteristics to
stormwater runoff at the site shall be discharged into a controlled conveyance system prior to
discharge to a sediment trap or sediment pond. Foundation and trench dewatering water that has
similar characteristics to stormwater runoff at the site must be disposed of through one of the
following options depending on site constraints:
a) Infiltration,
b) Transport offsite in a vehicle, such as a vacuum flush truck, for legal disposal in a manner that
does not pollute surface waters,
SPREADER MUST BE LEVEL
18" MIN. REBAR SUPPORTS
8' MIN. SPACING
CROSS SECTION
DETAIL OF SPREADER
DENSELY VEGETATED FOR
A MIN. OF 100' AND SLOPE
LESS THAN 5:1
PRESSURE-TREATED
2"X10"
3' MIN.
TREATED 2"x10" MAY BE ABUTTED END TO
END FOR MAX. SPREADER LENGTH OF 50'
6" MIN.
6" MIN.1" MIN.2H:1V MAX.1' MIN.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-67
c) Discharge to the sanitary sewer discharge with approval from King County and the City of Renton
if there is no other option, or
d) Use of a sedimentation bag with outfall to a ditch or swale for small volumes of localized
dewatering.
2. Clean, non-turbid dewatering water, such as well-point ground water, may be discharged via stable
conveyance to systems tributary to surface waters, provided the dewatering flow does not cause
erosion or flooding of receiving waters.
3. Highly turbid or contaminated dewatering water (high pH or other) shall be handled separately
from stormwater. See Section D.2.2 , SWPPS Measures.
D.2.1.8 DUST CONTROL
Preventative measures to minimize the wind transport of soil shall be taken when a traffic hazard may be
created or when sediment transported by wind is likely to be deposited in water resources or adjacent
properties.
Purpose: To prevent wind transport of dust from exposed soil surfaces onto roadways, drainage ways, and
surface waters.
When to Install: Dust control shall be implemented when exposed soils are dry to the point that wind
transport is possible and roadways, drainage ways, or surface waters are likely to be impacted. Dust
control measures may consist of chemical, structural, or mechanical methods.
Measures to Install: Water is the most common dust control (or palliative) used in the area. When using
water for dust control, the exposed soils shall be sprayed until wet, but runoff shall not be generated by
spraying. Calcium chloride, Magnesium chloride, Lignin derivatives, Tree Resin Emulsions, and Synthetic
Polymer Emulsions may also be used for dust control. Exposed areas shall be re-sprayed as needed. Oil
shall not be used for dust control. The following table lists many common dust control measures. Some of
the measures are not recommended for use in the City and must have prior approval prior to use from the
CED inspector assigned to specific projects.
TABLE D.2.1.8.A DUST CONTROL MEASURES
Method Considerations Site Preparation
Recommended
Application Rate
Water -Most commonly used practice
-Evaporates quickly
-Lasts less than 1 day
For all liquid agents:
-Blade a small surface
-Crown or slope surface to avoid
ponding
-Compact soils if needed
-Uniformly pre-wet at
0.03 – 0.3 gal/sq yd
-Apply solution under pressure.
Overlap solution 6 – 12 inches
-Allow treated area to cure
0 – 4 hours
-Compact area after curing
-Apply second treatment before first
treatment becomes ineffective
0.125 gal/sq yd every
20 to 30 minutes
Salts
Calcium
Chloride
(CaCl)
-Restricts evaporation
-Lasts 6–12 months
-Can be corrosive
-Less effective in low humidity
-Can build up in soils and leach by rain
Apply 38% solution at
1.21L/m2 (0.27 gal/yd2)
or as loose dry granules
per manufacturer
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-68
TABLE D.2.1.8.A DUST CONTROL MEASURES
Method Considerations Site Preparation
Recommended
Application Rate
Magnesium
Chloride
(MgCl)
-Restricts evaporation
-Works at higher temperatures and lower
humidity than CaCl
-May be more costly than CaCl
Apply 26 – 32%
solution at 2.3 L/m2
(0.5 gal/yd2)
Sodium
Chloride
(NaCl)
-Effective over smaller range of
conditions
-Less expensive
-Can be corrosive
-Less effective in low humidity
Per Manufacturer
Silicates -Generally expensive
-Available in small quantities
-Require Second application
Surfactants -High evaporation rates
-Effective for short time periods
-Must apply frequently
Copolymers -Forms semi-permeable transparent
crust
-Resists ultraviolet radiation and
moisture induced breakdown
-Last 1 to 2 years
750 – 940 L/ha (80 –
100 gal/ac)
Petroleum
Products
-Used oil is prohibited as a dust control
method
-Bind soil particles
-May hinder foliage growth
-Environmental and aesthetic concerns
-Higher cost
Use 57 – 63% resins as
base. Apply at 750 –
940 L/ha
(80–100 gal/ac)
Lignin
Sulfonate
-Paper industry waste product
-Acts as dispersing agent
-Best in dry climates
-Can be slippery
-Will decrease Dissolved Oxygen in
waterways therefore cannot be used
adjacent to surface water systems
Loosen surface
25–50 mm (1–2 inches)
Need 4–8% fines
Vegetable
Oils
-Coat grains of soils, so limited binding
ability
-May become brittle
-Limited availability
Per Manufacturer
Spray on
Adhesives
-Available as organic or synthetic
-Effective on dry, hard soils
-Forms a crust
-Can last 3 to 4 years
Per Manufacturer
D.2.1.9 FLOW CONTROL
Surface water from disturbed areas must be routed through the project’s onsite flow control facility or
other provisions must made to prevent increases in the existing site conditions 2-year and 10-year runoff
peaks discharging from the project site during construction.
Purpose: The purpose of surface water flow control is to mitigate increases in runoff peaks that occur
during construction as a result of clearing vegetation, compacting the soil, and adding impervious surface.
Such increases can cause or aggravate downstream flooding and erosion.
D.2.1 ESC MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-69
When to Install: Surface water flow control shall be installed or otherwise provided prior to any clearing
and/or grading of the site, except that required to construct the surface water flow control facilities.
Measures to Use: The project’s onsite flow control facility or other equivalent storage facility that meets
the peak-matching performance criteria stated above.
D.2.1.10 PROTECT EXISTING AND PROPOSED STORMWATER FACILITIES AND
ON-SITE BMPS
Protection measures shall be applied/installed and maintained so as to prevent adverse impacts to existing
stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs and areas of proposed stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs for
the project. Adverse impacts can prompt the requirement to restore or replace affected stormwater
facilities and on-site BMPs.
Purpose: The purpose of protecting existing and proposed stormwater facility and on-site BMP areas is to
avoid sedimentation and soil compaction that would adversely affect infiltration, and also avoid
contamination by other pollutants.
When to Install: Stormwater facility and on-site BMP area protection shall be installed or otherwise
provided prior to any clearing and/or grading of the site, except that required to construct stormwater
facilities and on-site BMPs.
Measures to Use:
1. Protect all stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs and proposed stormwater facility and on-site BMP
footprints from sedimentation through installation and maintenance of erosion and sediment control
BMPs on portions of the site that drain into the BMPs/facilities.
2. Stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs shall be restored to their fully functioning condition if they
accumulate sediment during construction. Restoring the stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs shall
include, at a minimum, removal of sediment and any sediment-laden bioretention soils, and replacing
the removed soils with soils meeting the design specification. Replacement with a new fully-
functioning stormwater facility and/or on-site BMP may be required if restoration to the fully-
functioning condition can’t be accomplished.
3. Prevent compacting Bioretention BMPs/facilities by excluding construction equipment and foot
traffic. Protect completed lawn and landscaped areas from compaction due to construction equipment.
4. Control erosion and avoid introducing sediment from surrounding land uses onto permeable pavement
BMPs. Do not allow muddy construction equipment on the base material or pavement. Do not allow
sediment-laden runoff onto permeable pavements.
5. Permeable pavement BMPs fouled with sediments or no longer passing an initial infiltration text must
be cleaned using procedures from Appendix A or the manufacturer’s procedures.
6. Keep all heavy equipment off existing soils under stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs that have
been excavated to final grade to retain the infiltration rate of the soils.
D.2.1.11 MAINTAIN PROTECTIVE BMPS
Protection measures shall be maintained to ensure continued performance of their intended function, to
prevent adverse impacts to existing stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs and areas of proposed
BMPs/facilities, and protect other disturbed areas of the project.
Purpose: The purpose of maintaining protective BMPs is to provide continuous erosion and sediment
control protection throughout the life of the project, and avoid sedimentation, soil compaction and
contamination by other pollutants that would adversely affect infiltration and surface runoff.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-70
When to Maintain: Protection measures shall be monitored per Section D.2.4.4 at a minimum, and
promptly maintained to fully functioning condition as necessary to ensure continued performance of their
intended function.
Measures to Use:
1. Maintain and repair all temporary and permanent erosion and sediment control BMPs as needed to
ensure continued performance of their intended function in accordance with BMP specifications.
2. Remove all temporary erosion and sediment control BMPs prior to final construction approval, or
within 30 days after achieving final site stabilization or after the temporary BMPs are no longer
needed.
3. Provide protection to all stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs installed for the permanent control of
stormwater from sediment and compaction. All stormwater facilities and on-site BMPs that are to
remain in place following completion of construction shall be examined and placed in full operating
conditions. If sediment enters the stormwater facilities and/or on-site BMPs during construction, it
shall be removed and the stormwater facility and on-site BMP shall be returned to the conditions
specified in the construction documents or as required for full stormwater facility and on-site BMP
replacement.
4. Remove or stabilize trapped sediment on site. Permanently stabilize disturbed soil resulting from
removal of erosion and sediment control BMPs or vegetation.
D.2.1.12 MANAGE THE PROJECT
Coordination and timing of site development activities relative to ESC concerns (Section D.2.4), and
timely inspection, maintenance and update of protective measures (Section D.2.3) are necessary to
effectively manage the project and ensure the success of protective ESC and SWPPS design and
implementation.
Projects shall assign a qualified CSWPP Supervisor (Section D.2.3.1) to be the primary contact for ESC
and SWPPP issues and reporting, coordination with subcontractors and implementation of the CSWPP
plan as a whole.
Measures to Use:
1. Phase development projects to the maximum degree practicable and take into account seasonal work
limits.
2. Inspection and monitoring – Inspect, maintain, and repair all BMPs as needed to ensure continued
performance of their intended function. Conduct site inspections and monitoring in accordance with
the Construction Stormwater General Permit and City requirements.
3. Maintaining an updated construction SWPPP – Maintain, update, and implement the SWPPP in
accordance with the Construction Stormwater General Permit and City requirements.
4. Projects that disturb one or more acres must have, site inspections conducted by a Certified Erosion
and Sediment Control Lead (CESCL) (see Section D.2.3.1). Project sites less than one acre (not part
of a larger common plan of development or sale) may have a person without CESCL certification
conduct inspections. By the initiation of construction, the SWPPP must identify the CESCL or
inspector, who shall be present onsite or on-call at all times.
The CESCL or inspector (project sites less than one acre) must have the skills to assess the:
Site conditions and construction activities that could impact the quality of stormwater.
Effectiveness of erosion and sediment control measures used to control the quality of stormwater
discharges.
The CESCL or inspector must examine stormwater visually for the presence of suspended
sediment, turbidity, discoloration, and oil sheen. They must evaluate the effectiveness of BMPs
and determine if it is necessary to install, maintain, or repair BMPs to improve the quality of
stormwater discharges.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-71
Based on the results of the inspection, construction site operators must correct the problems identified
by:
Reviewing the SWPPP for compliance with all construction SWPPP elements and making
appropriate revisions within 7 days of the inspection.
Immediately beginning the process of fully implementing and maintaining appropriate source
control and/or treatment BMPs as soon as possible, addressing the problems not later than within
10 days of the inspection. If installation of necessary treatment BMPs is not feasible within 10
days, the construction site operator may request an extension within the initial 10-day response
period.
Documenting BMP implementation and maintenance in the site log book (applies only to sites
that have coverage under the Construction Stormwater General Permit).
The CESCL or inspector must inspect all areas disturbed by construction activities, all BMPs, and
all stormwater discharge points at least once every calendar week and within 24 hours of any
discharge from the site. (For purposes of this condition, individual discharge events that last more
than one day do not require daily inspections. For example, if a stormwater pond discharges
continuously over the course of a week, only one inspection is required that week.) The CESCL
or inspector may reduce the inspection frequency for temporary stabilized, inactive sites to once
every calendar month.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
This section details the SWPPS measures that are required to prevent, reduce, or eliminate the discharge of
pollutants to onsite or adjacent stormwater systems or watercourses from construction-related activities
such as materials delivery and storage, onsite equipment fueling and maintenance, demolition of existing
buildings and disposition of demolition materials and other waste, and concrete handling, washout and
disposal. These SWPPS measures represent Best Management Practices (BMPs)8 for the control of
pollutant drips and spills as well as other impacts related to construction such as increased pH in concrete
construction and handling activities. Compliance with each of the SWPPS measures, and with any project-
specific control measures, to the extent applicable and necessary to meet the performance criteria in
Section D.2.2, and compliance with the CSWPP implementation requirements in Section D.2.4, constitutes
overall compliance with the City’s CSWPP Standards.
Note: Additional measures shall be required by the City if the existing standards are insufficient to protect
adjacent properties, drainage facilities, or water resources.
The standards for each individual SWPPS measure are divided into four sections:
1. Purpose
2. Conditions of Use
3. Design and Installation Specifications
4. Maintenance Requirements.
Note that the “Conditions of Use” always refers to site conditions. As site conditions change, SWPPS
measures must be changed to remain in compliance with the requirements of this appendix.
Whenever compliance with City SWPPS Standards is required, all of the following SWPPS measures must
be considered for application to the project site as detailed in the following sections. The construction
pollutant generating concerns addressed by the BMPs that follow include:
Concrete handling, washout and disposal(specifically portland cement concrete)
Sawcutting and surfacing activities
Materials delivery, storage and containment
8 Best Management Practices (BMPs) means the best available and reasonable physical, structural, managerial, or behavioral
activities, that when singly or in combination, eliminate or reduce the contamination of surface and/or ground waters.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-72
Filtration and chemical treatment of construction water to facilitate disposal or discharge to approved
locations
Reporting requirements and documentation availability for specific BMP processes
Additionally, several of the ESC BMPs described in Section D.2.1 can be applicable to the SWPPS plan,
e.g., use of cover, fencing and access protection to protect temporary materials storage locations. The
applicant’s material supplier may be a resource (subject to City approval) for BMPs to address specific
project applications or proposals. Conditions of approval on adjustments may also specify additional
requirements for the SWPPS plan.
D.2.2.1 CONCRETE HANDLING
Purpose
Concrete work can generate process water and slurry that contain fine particles and high pH, both of which
can violate water quality standards in the receiving water. Concrete spillage or concrete discharge to
surface waters of the State is prohibited. Use this BMP to minimize and eliminate concrete, concrete
process water, and concrete slurry from entering waters of the state.
Conditions of Use
Any time concrete is used, utilize these management practices. Concrete construction projects include, but
are not limited to, curbs, sidewalks, roads, bridges, foundations, floors, stormwater vaults, retaining walls,
driveways and runways.
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Ensure that washout of concrete trucks, chutes, pumps, and internals is performed at an approved off-
site location or in designated concrete washout areas. Do not wash out concrete trucks, chutes, pumps,
or internals onto the ground, or into storm drains, open ditches, streets, or streams. Refer to BMP
D.2.2.2 for information on concrete washout areas.
2. Return unused concrete remaining in the truck and pump to the originating batch plant for recycling.
Do not dump excess concrete on site, except in designated concrete washout areas.
3. Wash off hand tools including, but not limited to, screeds, shovels, rakes, floats, and trowels into
formed areas awaiting future concrete pours only.
4. Do not wash out to formed areas awaiting infiltration BMPs.
5. Wash equipment difficult to move, such as concrete pavers in areas that do not directly drain to
natural or constructed stormwater conveyances.
6. Do not allow washdown from areas, such as concrete aggregate driveways, to drain directly to natural
or constructed stormwater conveyances.
7. Contain washwater and leftover product in a lined container when no formed areas are available.
Dispose of contained concrete in a manner that does not violate ground water or surface water quality
standards.
8. Always use forms or solid barriers for concrete pours, such as pilings, within 15-feet of surface
waters.
9. Refer to BMPs D.2.2.7 and D.2.2.8 for pH adjustment requirements.
10. Refer to the Construction Stormwater General Permit for pH monitoring requirements if the project
involves one of the following activities:
Significant concrete work (greater than 1,000 cubic yards poured concrete or recycled concrete
used over the life of a project).
The use of engineered soils amended with (but not limited to) Portland cement-treated base,
cement kiln dust or fly ash.
Discharging stormwater to segments of water bodies on the 303(d) list (Category 5) for high pH.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-73
Maintenance Standards
Check containers for holes in the liner daily during concrete pours and repair the same day.
D.2.2.2 CONCRETE WASHOUT AREA
Purpose
Prevent or reduce the discharge of pollutants to stormwater from concrete waste by conducting washout
off-site, or performing onsite washout in a designated area to prevent pollutants from entering surface
waters or ground water.
Conditions of Use
Concrete washout area best management practices are implemented on construction projects where:
Concrete is used as a construction material
It is not possible to dispose of all concrete wastewater and washout off-site (ready mix plant, etc.).
Concrete trucks, pumpers, or other concrete coated equipment are washed onsite.
Note: If less than 10 concrete trucks or pumpers need to be washed out onsite, the washwater may be
disposed of in a formed area awaiting concrete or an upland disposal site where it will not contaminate
surface or ground water. The upland disposal site shall be at least 50 feet from sensitive areas such as
storm drains, open ditches, or water bodies, including wetlands.
Design and Installation Specifications
Implementation
The following steps will help reduce stormwater pollution from concrete wastes:
1. Perform washout of concrete trucks at an approved off-site location or in designated concrete washout
areas only.
2. Do not wash out concrete trucks onto the ground, or into storm drains, open ditches, streets, or
streams.
3. Do not allow excess concrete to be dumped onsite, except in designated concrete washout areas.
4. Concrete washout areas may be prefabricated concrete washout containers, or self-installed structures
(above-grade or below-grade).
5. Prefabricated containers are most resistant to damage and protect against spills and leaks. Companies
may offer delivery service and provide regular maintenance and disposal of solid and liquid waste.
6. If self-installed concrete washout areas are used, below-grade structures are preferred over above-
grade structures because they are less prone to spills and leaks.
7. Self-installed above-grade structures should only be used if excavation is not practical.
Education
1. Discuss the concrete management techniques described in this BMP with the ready-mix concrete
supplier before any deliveries are made.
2. Educate employees and subcontractors on the concrete waste management techniques described in this
BMP.
3. Arrange for contractor’s superintendent or Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead (CESCL) to
oversee and enforce concrete waste management procedures.
4. A sign should be installed adjacent to each temporary concrete washout facility to inform concrete
equipment operators to utilize the proper facilities.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-74
Contracts
Incorporate requirements for concrete waste management into concrete supplier and subcontractor
agreements.
Location and Placement
1. Locate washout area at least 50 feet from sensitive areas such as storm drains, open ditches, or water
bodies, including wetlands.
2. Allow convenient access for concrete trucks, preferably near the area where the concrete is being
poured.
3. If trucks need to leave a paved area to access washout, prevent track-out with a pad of rock or quarry
spalls (see BMP D.2.1.4.2). These areas should be far enough away from other construction traffic to
reduce the likelihood of accidental damage and spills.
4. The number of facilities you install should depend on the expected demand for storage capacity.
5. On large sites with extensive concrete work, washouts should be placed in multiple locations for ease
of use by concrete truck drivers.
On-Site Temporary Concrete Washout Facility, Transit Truck Washout Procedures:
1. Temporary concrete washout facilities shall be located a minimum of 50 feet from sensitive areas
including storm drain inlets, open drainage facilities, and watercourses. (See Figures D.2.2.2.A,
D.2.2.2.B, and D.2.2.2.C).
2. Concrete washout facilities shall be constructed and maintained in sufficient quantity and size to
contain all liquid and concrete waste generated by washout operations.
3. Washout of concrete trucks shall be performed in designated areas only.
4. Concrete washout from concrete pumper bins can be washed into concrete pumper trucks and
discharged into designated washout area or properly disposed of off-site.
5. Once concrete wastes are washed into the designated area and allowed to harden, the concrete should
be broken up, removed, and disposed of per applicable solid waste regulations. Dispose of hardened
concrete on a regular basis.
6. Temporary Above-Grade Concrete Washout Facility
a) Temporary concrete washout facility (type above grade) should be constructed as shown on the
details below, with a recommended minimum length and minimum width of 10 ft, but with
sufficient quantity and volume to contain all liquid and concrete waste generated by washout
operations.
b) Plastic lining material should be a minimum of 10 mil polyethylene sheeting and should be free of
holes, tears, or other defects that compromise the impermeability of the material.
7. Temporary Below-Grade Concrete Washout Facility
a) Temporary concrete washout facilities (type below grade) should be constructed as shown on the
details below, with a recommended minimum length and minimum width of 10 ft. The quantity
and volume should be sufficient to contain all liquid and concrete waste generated by washout
operations.
b) Lath and flagging should be commercial type.
c) Plastic lining material shall be a minimum of 10 mil polyethylene sheeting and should be free of
holes, tears, or other defects that compromise the impermeability of the material.
d) Liner seams shall be installed in accordance with manufacturers’ recommendations.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-75
e) Soil base shall be prepared free of rocks or other debris that may cause tears or holes in the plastic
lining material.
Maintenance Standards
Inspection and Maintenance
1. Inspect and verify that concrete washout BMPs are in place prior to the commencement of concrete
work.
2. During periods of concrete work, inspect daily to verify continued performance.
a) Check overall condition and performance.
b) Check remaining capacity (% full).
c) If using self-installed washout facilities, verify plastic liners are intact and sidewalls are not
damaged.
d) If using prefabricated containers, check for leaks.
3. Washout facilities shall be maintained to provide adequate holding capacity with a minimum
freeboard of 12 inches.
4. Washout facilities must be cleaned, or new facilities must be constructed and ready for use once the
washout is 75% full.
5. If the washout is nearing capacity, vacuum and dispose of the waste material in an approved manner.
a) Do not discharge liquid or slurry to waterways, storm drains or directly onto ground.
b) Do not use sanitary sewer without local approval.
c) Place a secure, non-collapsing, non-water collecting cover over the concrete washout facility prior
to predicted wet weather to prevent accumulation and overflow of precipitation.
d) Remove and dispose of hardened concrete and return the structure to a functional condition.
Concrete may be reused onsite or hauled away for disposal or recycling.
6. When you remove materials from the self-installed concrete washout, build a new structure; or, if the
previous structure is still intact, inspect for signs of weakening or damage, and make any necessary
repairs. Re-line the structure with new plastic after each cleaning.
Removal of Temporary Concrete Washout Facilities
1. When temporary concrete washout facilities are no longer required for the work, the hardened
concrete, slurries and liquids shall be removed and properly disposed of.
2. Materials used to construct temporary concrete washout facilities shall be removed from the site of the
work and disposed of or recycled.
3. Holes, depressions or other ground disturbance caused by the removal of the temporary concrete
washout facilities shall be backfilled, repaired, and stabilized to prevent erosion.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-76
FIGURE D.2.2.2.A CONCRETE WASHOUT AREA (ABOVE GRADE)
SECTION B-B
NTS
SECTION A-A
NTS
STAPLE DETAIL
NTS
PLAN
NTS
ABOVE GRADE TEMPORARY CONCRETE WASHOUT FACILITY
NTS
CONCRETE WASHOUT SIGN DETAIL
NTS 10 mil PLASTIC
LINING
PLAN
NTS
TYPE "ABOVE GRADE" WITH
WOOD PLANKS
TYPE "ABOVE GRADE" WITH STRAW BALES
10 mil PLASTIC
LINING
16 GAUGE
STEEL WIRE
2"
8"
LAG SCREWS ( 1
2" )
BLACK LETTERS
6" HEIGHT
PLYWOOD 4' X 2'
PAINTED WHITE
WOOD POST
312" x 312" x 8'
3'
3'
STRAW
BALES
(TYP.)
STAKE
(TYP.)
WEDGE LOOSE
STRAW
BETWEEN BALES
SAND OR GRAVEL-FILLED
BAGS IN CORNERS
10' MIN. RECOMMENDED
VARIES
WOOD OR
METAL STAKES
(2 PER BALE)
STRAW BALES (2
BALES HIGH, MAX.)
ORIGINAL GROUND
10 mil PLASTIC
LINING
STAPLES (2 PER BALE)
SAND OR GRAVEL-FILLED
BAGS IN CORNERS
NATIVE MATERIAL
(OPTIONAL)
10 mil
PLASTIC
LINING
WOOD FRAME SECURELY
FASTENED AROUND
ENTIRE PERIMETER WITH
TWO STAKES
TWO-STACKED
2x12 ROUGH
WOOD FRAME
STAKE
(TYP.)
10' MIN. RECOMMENDED
VARIES
NOTES:
1. ACTUAL LAYOUT DETERMINED IN
THE FIELD
2. THE CONCRETE WASHOUT SIGN
SHALL BE INSTALLED WITHIN 30'
OF THE FACILITY
1' MIN.
Adapted from CalTrans Fig4-14 SAC 8-14-02
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-77
FIGURE D.2.2.2.B CONCRETE WASHOUT AREA (BELOW GRADE)
FIGURE D.2.2.2.C PREFABRICATED CONCRETE WASHOUT CONTAINER W/RAMP
EARTHEN BERM
TYPICAL SECTION
NTS
BELOW GRADE TEMPORARY CONCRETE WASHOUT FACILITY
NTS
CONCRETE WASHOUT SIGN DETAIL
NTS
SANDBAG
PLAN
NTS
Adapted from CalTrans Fig4-14 SAC 8-14-02
10 mil
PLASTIC
LINING
LAG SCREWS ( 12" )
BLACK
LETTERS
6" HEIGHT
PLYWOOD 4' X 2'
PAINTED WHITE
WOOD POST
312" x 312" x 8'
3'
3'
EARTHEN
BERM
10 mil
PLASTIC
LINING
SANDBAG
10' MIN. RECOMMENDED
VARIES
BERM
3'
LATH AND
FLAGGING
ON 3 SIDES
NOTES:
1. ACTUAL LAYOUT DETERMINED IN
THE FIELD
2. THE CONCRETE WASHOUT SIGN
SHALL BE INSTALLED WITHIN 30' OF
THE FACILITY
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-78
D.2.2.3 SAWCUTTING AND SURFACING POLLUTION PREVENTION
Purpose
Sawcutting and surfacing operations generate slurry and process water that contains fine particles and high
pH (concrete cutting), both of which can violate the water quality standards in the receiving water.
Concrete spillage or concrete discharge to surface waters of the State is prohibited. Use this BMP to
minimize and eliminate process water and slurry created through sawcutting or surfacing from entering
waters of the State.
Conditions of Use
Utilize these management practices anytime sawcutting or surfacing operations take place. Sawcutting and
surfacing operations include, but are not limited to, sawing, coring, grinding, roughening, hydro-
demolition, bridge and road surfacing
Design and Installation Specifications
1. Vacuum slurry and cuttings during cutting and surfacing operations.
2. Slurry and cuttings shall not remain on permanent concrete or asphalt pavement overnight.
3. Slurry and cuttings shall not drain to any natural or constructed drainage conveyance including
stormwater systems. This may require temporarily blocking catch basins.
4. Dispose of collected slurry and cuttings in a manner that does not violate ground water or surface
water quality standards.
5. Do not allow process water generated during hydro-demolition, surface roughening or similar
operations to drain to any natural or constructed drainage conveyance including stormwater systems.
Dispose process water in a manner that does not violate ground water or surface water quality
standards.
6. Handle and dispose cleaning waste material and demolition debris in a manner that does not cause
contamination of water. Dispose of sweeping material from a pick-up sweeper at an appropriate
disposal site.
Maintenance Standards
Continually monitor operations to determine whether slurry, cuttings, or process water could enter waters
of the state. If inspections show that a violation of water quality standards could occur, stop operations and
immediately implement preventive measures such as berms, barriers, secondary containment, and vacuum
trucks.
D.2.2.4 MATERIAL DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND CONTAINMENT
Purpose
Prevent, reduce, or eliminate the discharge of pollutants to the stormwater system or watercourses from
material delivery and storage. Minimize the storage of hazardous materials onsite, store materials in a
designated area, and install secondary containment.
Conditions of Use
These procedures are suitable for use at all construction sites with delivery and storage of the following
materials:
Petroleum products such as fuel, oil and grease
Soil stabilizers and binders (e.g., Polyacrylamide)
Fertilizers, pesticides and herbicides
Detergents
Asphalt and concrete compounds
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-79
Hazardous chemicals such as acids, lime, adhesives, paints, solvents and curing compounds
Any other material that may be detrimental if released to the environment
Design and Installation Specifications
The following steps should be taken to minimize risk:
1. Temporary storage area should be located away from vehicular traffic, near the construction
entrance(s), and away from waterways or storm drains.
2. Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDS) should be supplied for all materials stored. Chemicals should be
kept in their original labeled containers.
3. Hazardous material storage onsite should be minimized.
4. Hazardous materials should be handled as infrequently as possible.
5. During the wet weather season (October 1 – April 30), consider storing materials in a covered area.
6. Materials should be stored in secondary containments, such as earthen dike, horse trough, or even a
children’s wading pool for non-reactive materials such as detergents, oil, grease, and paints. Small
amounts of material may be secondarily contained in “bus boy” trays or concrete mixing trays.
7. Do not store chemicals, drums, or bagged materials directly on the ground. Place these items on a
pallet and, when possible, and within secondary containment.
8. If drums must be kept uncovered, store them at a slight angle to reduce ponding of rainwater on the
lids to reduce corrosion. Domed plastic covers are inexpensive and snap to the top of drums,
preventing water from collecting.
Material Storage Areas and Secondary Containment Practices:
1. Liquids, petroleum products, and substances listed in 40 CFR Parts 110, 117, or 302 shall be stored in
approved containers and drums and shall not be overfilled. Containers and drums shall be stored in
temporary secondary containment facilities.
2. Temporary secondary containment facilities shall provide for a spill containment volume able to
contain 10% of the total enclosed container volume of all containers, or 110% of the capacity of the
largest container within its boundary, whichever is greater.
3. Secondary containment facilities shall be impervious to the materials stored therein for a minimum
contact time of 72 hours.
4. Secondary containment facilities shall be maintained free of accumulated rainwater and spills. In the
event of spills or leaks, accumulated rainwater and spills shall be collected and placed into drums.
These liquids shall be handled as hazardous waste unless testing determines them to be non-
hazardous.
5. Sufficient separation should be provided between stored containers to allow for spill cleanup and
emergency response access.
6. During the wet weather season (October 1 – April 30), each secondary containment facility shall be
covered during non-working days, prior to and during rain events.
7. Keep material storage areas clean, organized and equipped with an ample supply of appropriate spill
clean-up material (spill kit).
8. The spill kit should include, at a minimum:
1-Water Resistant Nylon Bag
3-Oil Absorbent Socks 3″ x 4′
2-Oil Absorbent Socks 3″ x 10′
12-Oil Absorbent Pads 17″ x 19″
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-80
1-Pair Splash Resistant Goggles
3-Pair Nitrile Gloves
10-Disposable Bags with Ties
Instructions
D.2.2.5 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER CHEMICAL TREATMENT
Purpose
This BMP applies when using stormwater chemicals in batch treatment or flow-through treatment.
Turbidity is difficult to control once fine particles are suspended in stormwater runoff from a construction
site. Sedimentation ponds are effective at removing larger particulate matter by gravity settling, but are
ineffective at removing smaller particulates such as clay and fine silt. Traditional erosion and sediment
control BMPs may not be adequate to ensure compliance with the water quality standards for turbidity in
receiving water.
Chemical treatment can reliably provide exceptional reductions of turbidity and associated pollutants.
Chemical treatment may be required to meet turbidity stormwater discharge requirements, especially when
construction is to proceed through the wet season.
Conditions of Use
Formal written approval from Ecology is required for the use of chemical treatment regardless of
site size. The City also requires review and approval. When approved, the chemical treatment systems
must be included in the SWPPS portion of the project’s CSWPP.
Design and Installation Specifications
Coagulation and flocculation have been used for over a century to treat water. It is used less frequently for
the treatment of wastewater. The use of coagulation and flocculation for treating stormwater is a very
recent application. Experience with the treatment of water and wastewater has resulted in a basic
understanding of the process, in particular factors that affect performance. This experience can provide
insights as to how to most effectively design and operate similar systems in the treatment of stormwater.
Fine particles suspended in water give it a milky appearance, measured as turbidity. Their small size, often
much less than 1 μm in diameter, give them a very large surface area relative to their volume. These fine
particles typically carry a negative surface charge. Largely because of these two factors, small size and
negative charge, these particles tend to stay in suspension for extended periods of time. Thus, removal is
not practical by gravity settling. These are called stable suspensions. Polymers, as well as inorganic
chemicals such as alum, speed the process of clarification. The added chemical destabilizes the suspension
and causes the smaller particles to agglomerate. The process consists of three steps: coagulation,
flocculation, and settling or clarification. Each step is explained below as well as the factors that affect the
efficiency of the process.
Coagulation: Coagulation is the first step. It is the process by which negative charges on the fine particles
that prevent their agglomeration are disrupted. Chemical addition is one method of destabilizing the
suspension, and polymers are one class of chemicals that are generally effective. Chemicals that are used
for this purpose are called coagulants. Coagulation is complete when the suspension is destabilized by the
neutralization of the negative charges. Coagulants perform best when they are thoroughly and evenly
dispersed under relatively intense mixing. This rapid mixing involves adding the coagulant in a manner
that promotes rapid dispersion, followed by a short time period for destabilization of the particle
suspension. The particles are still very small and are not readily separated by clarification until
flocculation occurs.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-81
Flocculation: Flocculation is the process by which fine particles that have been destabilized bind together
to form larger particles that settle rapidly. Flocculation begins naturally following coagulation, but is
enhanced by gentle mixing of the destabilized suspension. Gentle mixing helps to bring particles in contact
with one another such that they bind and continually grow to form “flocs.” As the size of the flocs
increases they become heavier and tend to settle more rapidly.
Clarification: The final step is the settling of the particles. Particle density, size and shape are important
during settling. Dense, compact flocs settle more readily than less dense, fluffy flocs. Because of this,
flocculation to form dense, compact flocs is particularly important during water treatment. Water
temperature is important during settling. Both the density and viscosity of water are affected by
temperature; these in turn affect settling. Cold temperatures increase viscosity and density, thus slowing
down the rate at which the particles settle.
The conditions under which clarification is achieved can affect performance. Currents can affect settling.
Currents can be produced by wind, by differences between the temperature of the incoming water and the
water in the clarifier, and by flow conditions near the inlets and outlets.
Quiescent water such as that which occurs during batch clarification provides a good environment for
effective performance as many of these factors become less important in comparison to typical
sedimentation basins. One source of currents that is likely important in batch systems is movement of the
water leaving the clarifier unit. Given that flocs are relatively small and light the exit velocity of the water
must be as low as possible. Sediment on the bottom of the basin can be resuspended and removed by fairly
modest velocities.
Coagulants: Polymers are large organic molecules that are made up of subunits linked together in a chain-
like structure. Attached to these chain-like structures are other groups that carry positive or negative
charges, or have no charge. Polymers that carry groups with positive charges are called cationic, those
with negative charges are called anionic, and those with no charge (neutral) are called nonionic.
Cationic polymers can be used as coagulants to destabilize negatively charged turbidity particles present in
natural waters, wastewater and stormwater. Aluminum sulfate (alum) can also be used as this chemical
becomes positively charged when dispersed in water. In practice, the only way to determine whether a
polymer is effective for a specific application is to perform preliminary or onsite testing.
Polymers are available as powders, concentrated liquids, and emulsions (which appear as milky liquids).
The latter are petroleum based, which are not allowed for construction stormwater treatment. Polymer
effectiveness can degrade with time and also from other influences. Thus, manufacturers’
recommendations for storage should be followed. Manufacturer’s recommendations usually do not provide
assurance of water quality protection or safety to aquatic organisms. Consideration of water quality
protection is necessary in the selection and use of all polymers.
Criteria for Chemical Treatment Product Use:
Chemically treated stormwater discharged from construction sites must be nontoxic to aquatic organisms.
The Chemical Technology Assessment Protocol (CTAPE) must be used to evaluate chemicals proposed
for stormwater treatment. Only chemicals approved by Ecology under the CTAPE may be used for
stormwater treatment. The approved chemicals, their allowable application techniques (batch treatment or
flow-through treatment), allowable application rates, and conditions of use can be found at the Department
of Ecology Emerging Technologies website:
<http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/newtech/technologies.html>.
Treatment System Design Considerations:
The design and operation of a chemical treatment system should take into consideration the factors that
determine optimum, cost-effective performance. It is important to recognize the following:
Only Ecology approved chemicals may be used and must follow approved dose rate.
The pH of the stormwater must be in the proper range for the polymers to be effective, which is
typically 6.5 to 8.5
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-82
The coagulant must be mixed rapidly into the water to ensure proper dispersion.
A flocculation step is important to increase the rate of settling, to produce the lowest turbidity, and to
keep the dosage rate as low as possible.
Too little energy input into the water during the flocculation phase results in flocs that are too small
and/or insufficiently dense. Too much energy can rapidly destroy floc as it is formed.
Care must be taken in the design of the withdrawal system to minimize outflow velocities and to
prevent floc discharge. Discharge from a batch treatment system should be directed through a physical
filter such as a vegetated swale that would catch any unintended floc discharge. Currently, flow-
through systems always discharge through the chemically enhanced sand filtration system.
System discharge rates must take into account downstream conveyance integrity.
Polymer Batch Treatment Process Description:
A batch chemical treatment system consists of the stormwater collection system (either temporary
diversion or the permanent site drainage system), a storage pond, pumps, a chemical feed system,
treatment cells, and interconnecting piping.
The batch treatment system shall use a minimum of two lined treatment cells in addition to an untreated
stormwater storage pond. Multiple treatment cells allow for clarification of treated water while other cells
are being filled or emptied. Treatment cells may be ponds or tanks. Ponds with constructed earthen
embankments greater than six feet high or which impound more than 10 acre-feet require special
engineering analyses. The Ecology Dam Safety Section has specific design criteria for dams in
Washington State (see <http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wr/dams/GuidanceDocs.html>).
Stormwater is collected at interception point(s) on the site and is diverted by gravity or by pumping to an
untreated stormwater storage pond or other untreated stormwater holding area. The stormwater is stored
until treatment occurs. It is important that the holding pond be large enough to provide adequate storage.
The first step in the treatment sequence is to check the pH of the stormwater in the untreated stormwater
storage pond. The pH is adjusted by the application of carbon dioxide or a base until the stormwater in the
storage pond is within the desired pH range, 6.5 to 8.5. When used, carbon dioxide is added immediately
downstream of the transfer pump. Typically sodium bicarbonate (baking soda) is used as a base, although
other bases may be used. When needed, base is added directly to the untreated stormwater storage pond.
The stormwater is recirculated with the treatment pump to provide mixing in the storage pond. Initial pH
adjustments should be based on daily bench tests. Further pH adjustments can be made at any point in the
process.
Once the stormwater is within the desired pH range (dependent on polymer being used), the stormwater is
pumped from the untreated stormwater storage pond to a treatment cell as polymer is added. The polymer
is added upstream of the pump to facilitate rapid mixing.
After polymer addition, the water is kept in a lined treatment cell for clarification of the sediment-floc. In a
batch mode process, clarification typically takes from 30 minutes to several hours. Prior to discharge
samples are withdrawn for analysis of pH, flocculent chemical concentration, and turbidity. If both are
acceptable, the treated water is discharged.
Several configurations have been developed to withdraw treated water from the treatment cell. The
original configuration is a device that withdraws the treated water from just beneath the water surface
using a float with adjustable struts that prevent the float from settling on the cell bottom. This reduces the
possibility of picking up sediment-floc from the bottom of the pond. The struts are usually set at a
minimum clearance of about 12 inches; that is, the float will come within 12 inches of the bottom of the
cell. Other systems have used vertical guides or cables which constrain the float, allowing it to drift up and
down with the water level. More recent designs have an H-shaped array of pipes, set on the horizontal.
This scheme provides for withdrawal from four points rather than one. This configuration reduces the
likelihood of sucking settled solids from the bottom. It also reduces the tendency for a vortex to form. Inlet
diffusers, a long floating or fixed pipe with many small holes in it, are also an option.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-83
Safety is a primary concern. Design should consider the hazards associated with operations, such as
sampling. Facilities should be designed to reduce slip hazards and drowning. Tanks and ponds should have
life rings, ladders, or steps extending from the bottom to the top.
Polymer Flow-Through Treatment Process Description:
At a minimum, a flow-through chemical treatment system consists of the stormwater collection system
(either temporary diversion or the permanent site drainage system), an untreated stormwater storage pond,
and the chemically enhanced sand filtration system.
Stormwater is collected at interception point(s) on the site and is diverted by gravity or by pumping to an
untreated stormwater storage pond or other untreated stormwater holding area. The stormwater is stored
until treatment occurs. It is important that the holding pond be large enough to provide adequate storage.
Stormwater is then pumped from the untreated stormwater storage pond to the chemically enhanced sand
filtration system where polymer is added. Adjustments to pH may be necessary before chemical addition.
The sand filtration system continually monitors the stormwater for turbidity and pH. If the discharge water
is ever out of an acceptable range for turbidity or pH, the water is recycled to the untreated stormwater
pond where it can be retreated.
For batch treatment and flow-through treatment, the following equipment should be located in a lockable
shed:
The chemical injector.
Secondary containment for acid, caustic, buffering compound, and treatment chemical.
Emergency shower and eyewash.
Monitoring equipment which consists of a pH meter and a turbidimeter.
System Sizing:
Certain sites are required to implement flow control for the developed sites. These sites must also control
stormwater release rates during construction. Generally, these are sites that discharge stormwater directly,
or indirectly, through a conveyance system, into a fresh water. System sizing is dependent on flow control
requirements.
Sizing Criteria for Batch Treatment Systems for Flow Control Exempt Water Bodies:
The total volume of the untreated stormwater storage pond and treatment ponds or tanks must be large
enough to treat stormwater that is produced during multiple day storm events. It is recommended that at a
minimum the untreated stormwater storage pond be sized to hold 1.5 times the runoff volume of the
10-year, 24-hour storm event. Bypass should be provided around the chemical treatment system to
accommodate extreme storm events. Runoff volume shall be calculated using the methods presented in
Chapter 3 of the SWDM. Worst-case land cover conditions (i.e., producing the most runoff) should be used
for analyses (in most cases, this would be the land cover conditions just prior to final landscaping).
Primary settling should be encouraged in the untreated stormwater storage pond. A forebay with access for
maintenance may be beneficial.
There are two opposing considerations in sizing the treatment cells. A larger cell is able to treat a larger
volume of water each time a batch is processed. However, the larger the cell the longer the time required
to empty the cell. A larger cell may also be less effective at flocculation and therefore require a longer
settling time. The simplest approach to sizing the treatment cell is to multiply the allowable discharge flow
rate times the desired drawdown time. A 4-hour drawdown time allows one batch per cell per 8-hour work
period, given 1 hour of flocculation followed by two hours of settling.
If the discharge is directly to a direct discharge exempt receiving water in Section 1.2.3 (Core
Requirement #3) of the SWDM, or to an infiltration system, there is no discharge flow limit.
Ponds sized for flow control water bodies must at a minimum meet the sizing criteria for direct discharge
exempt receiving waters.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-84
Sizing Criteria for Flow-Through Treatment Systems for Flow Control Exempt Water Bodies:
When sizing storage ponds or tanks for flow-through systems for flow control exempt water bodies, the
treatment system capacity should be a factor. The untreated stormwater storage pond or tank should be
sized to hold 1.5 times the runoff volume of the 10-year, 24-hour storm event minus the treatment system
flowrate for an 8-hour period. For a chitosan-enhanced sand filtration system, the treatment system
flowrate should be sized using a hydraulic loading rate between 6 to 8 gpm/ft². Other hydraulic loading
rates may be more appropriate for other systems. Bypass should be provided around the chemical
treatment system to accommodate extreme storms. Runoff volume shall be calculated using the methods
presented in Chapter 3 of the SWDM. Worst-case land cover conditions (i.e., producing the most runoff)
should be used for analyses (in most cases, this would be the land cover conditions just prior to final
landscaping).
Sizing Criteria for Flow Control Water Bodies:
Sites that must implement flow control for the developed site condition must also control stormwater
release rates during construction. Construction site stormwater discharges shall not exceed the discharge
durations of the pre-developed condition for the range of pre-developed discharge rates from ½ of the
2-year flow through the 10-year flow as predicted by an approved continuous runoff model. The pre-
developed condition to be matched shall be the land cover condition immediately prior to the development
project. This restriction on release rates can affect the size of the storage pond and treatment cells.
The following is how WWHM can be used to determine the release rates from the chemical treatment
systems:
1. Determine the pre-developed flow durations to be matched by entering the existing land use area
under the “Pre-developed” scenario in WWHM. The default flow range is from ½ of the 2-year flow
through the 10-year flow.
2. Enter the post developed land use area in the “Developed Unmitigated” scenario in WWHM.
3. Copy the land use information from the “Developed Unmitigated” to “Developed Mitigated” scenario.
4. While in the “Developed Mitigated” scenario, add a pond element under the basin element containing
the post-developed land use areas. This pond element represents information on the available
untreated stormwater storage and discharge from the chemical treatment system. In cases where the
discharge from the chemical treatment system is controlled by a pump, a stage/storage/discharge
(SSD) table representing the pond must be generated outside WWHM and imported into WWHM.
WWHM can route the runoff from the post-developed condition through this SSD table (the pond) and
determine compliance with the flow duration standard. This would be an iterative design procedure
where if the initial SSD table proved to be inadequate, the designer would have to modify the SSD
table outside WWHM and re-import in WWHM and route the runoff through it again. The iteration
will continue until a pond that complies with the flow duration standard is correctly sized.
Notes on SSD table characteristics:
The pump discharge rate would likely be initially set at just below ½ of the 2-year flow from the
pre-developed condition. As runoff coming into the untreated stormwater storage pond increases
and the available untreated stormwater storage volume gets used up, it would be necessary to
increase the pump discharge rate above ½ of the 2-year. The increase(s) above ½ of the 2-year
must be such that they provide some relief to the untreated stormwater storage needs but at the
same time will not cause violations of the flow duration standard at the higher flows. The final
design SSD table will identify the appropriate pumping rates and the corresponding stage and
storages.
When building such a flow control system, the design must ensure that any automatic adjustments
to the pumping rates will be as a result of changes to the available storage in accordance with the
final design SSD table.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-85
5. It should be noted that the above procedures would be used to meet the flow control requirements. The
chemical treatment system must be able to meet the runoff treatment requirements. It is likely that the
discharge flow rate of ½ of the 2-year or more may exceed the treatment capacity of the system. If that
is the case, the untreated stormwater discharge rate(s) (i.e., influent to the treatment system) must be
reduced to allow proper treatment. Any reduction in the flows would likely result in the need for a
larger untreated stormwater storage volume.
If the discharge is to a municipal storm drainage system, the allowable discharge rate may be limited by
the capacity of the public system. It may be necessary to clean the municipal storm drainage system prior
to the start of the discharge to prevent scouring solids from the drainage system. If the municipal storm
drainage system discharges to a water body not on the flow control exempt list, the project site is subject
to flow control requirements. Obtain permission from the owner of the collection system before
discharging to it.
If system design does not allow you to discharge at the slower rates as described above and if the site has a
retention or detention pond that will serve the planned development, the discharge from the treatment
system may be directed to the permanent retention/detention pond to comply with the flow control
requirement. In this case, the untreated stormwater storage pond and treatment system will be sized
according to the sizing criteria for flow-through treatment systems for flow control exempt water bodies
described earlier except all discharge (water passing through the treatment system and stormwater
bypassing the treatment system) will be directed into the permanent retention/detention pond. If site
constraints make locating the untreated stormwater storage pond difficult, the permanent
retention/detention pond may be divided to serve as the untreated stormwater storage pond and the post-
treatment flow control pond. A berm or barrier must be used in this case so the untreated water does not
mix with the treated water. Both untreated stormwater storage requirements, and adequate post-treatment
flow control must be achieved. The post-treatment flow control pond’s revised dimensions must be entered
into the WWHM and the WWHM must be run to confirm compliance with the flow control requirement.
Maintenance Standards
Monitoring:
At a minimum, the following monitoring shall be conducted. Test results shall be recorded on a daily log
kept on site. Additional testing may be required by the NPDES permit based on site conditions.
Operational Monitoring:
Total volume treated and discharged.
Flow must be continuously monitored and recorded at not greater than 15-minute intervals.
Type and amount of chemical used for pH adjustment.
Amount of polymer used for treatment.
Settling time.
Compliance Monitoring:
Influent and effluent pH, flocculent chemical concentration, and turbidity must be continuously monitored
and recorded at not greater than 15-minute intervals. pH and turbidity of the receiving water.
Biomonitoring:
Treated stormwater must be non-toxic to aquatic organisms. Treated stormwater must be tested for aquatic
toxicity or residual chemicals. Frequency of biomonitoring will be determined by Ecology.
Residual chemical tests must be approved by Ecology prior to their use.
If testing treated stormwater for aquatic toxicity, you must test for acute (lethal) toxicity. Bioassays shall
be conducted by a laboratory accredited by Ecology, unless otherwise approved by Ecology. Acute
toxicity tests shall be conducted per the CTAPE protocol.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-86
Discharge Compliance:
Prior to discharge, treated stormwater must be sampled and tested for compliance with pH, flocculent
chemical concentration, and turbidity limits. These limits may be established by the Construction
Stormwater General Permit or a site-specific discharge permit. Sampling and testing for other pollutants
may also be necessary at some sites. pH must be within the range of 6.5 to 8.5 standard units and not cause
a change in the pH of the receiving water of more than 0.2 standard units. Treated stormwater samples and
measurements shall be taken from the discharge pipe or another location representative of the nature of the
treated stormwater discharge. Samples used for determining compliance with the water quality standards
in the receiving water shall not be taken from the treatment pond prior to decanting. Compliance with the
water quality standards is determined in the receiving water.
Operator Training:
Each contractor who intends to use chemical treatment shall be trained by an experienced contractor. Each
site using chemical treatment must have an operator trained and certified by an organization approved by
Ecology.
Standard BMPs:
Surface stabilization BMPs should be implemented on site to prevent significant erosion. All sites shall
use a truck wheel wash to prevent tracking of sediment off site.
Sediment Removal and Disposal:
Sediment shall be removed from the storage or treatment cells as necessary. Typically, sediment
removal is required at least once during a wet season and at the decommissioning of the cells.
Sediment remaining in the cells between batches may enhance the settling process and reduce the
required chemical dosage.
Sediment that is known to be non-toxic may be incorporated into the site away from drainages.
D.2.2.6 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER FILTRATION
Purpose
Filtration removes sediment from runoff originating from disturbed areas of the site.
Background Information:
Filtration with sand media has been used for over a century to treat water and wastewater. The use of sand
filtration for treatment of stormwater has developed recently, generally to treat runoff from streets, parking
lots, and residential areas. The application of filtration to construction stormwater treatment is currently
under development.
Conditions of Use
Traditional BMPs used to control soil erosion and sediment loss from sites under development may not be
adequate to ensure compliance with the water quality standard for turbidity in the receiving water.
Filtration may be used in conjunction with gravity settling to remove sediment as small as fine silt
(0.5 μm). The reduction in turbidity will be dependent on the particle size distribution of the sediment in
the stormwater. In some circumstances, sedimentation and filtration may achieve compliance with the
water quality standard for turbidity.
The use of construction stormwater filtration does not require approval from Ecology as long as treatment
chemicals are not used. Filtration in conjunction with polymer treatment requires testing under the
Chemical Technology Assessment Protocol – Ecology (CTAPE) before it can be initiated. Approval from
the appropriate regional Ecology office must be obtained at each site where polymers use is proposed prior
to use. For more guidance on stormwater chemical treatment see BMP D.2.2.5.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-87
Design and Installation Specifications
Two types of filtration systems may be applied to construction stormwater treatment: rapid and slow.
Rapid sand filters are the typical system used for water and wastewater treatment. They can achieve
relatively high hydraulic flow rates, on the order of 2 to 20 gpm/sf, because they have automatic backwash
systems to remove accumulated solids. In contrast, slow sand filters have very low hydraulic rates, on the
order of 0.02 gpm/sf, because they do not have backwash systems. Slow sand filtration has generally been
used to treat stormwater. Slow sand filtration is mechanically simple in comparison to rapid sand filtration
but requires a much larger filter area.
Filtration Equipment
Sand media filters are available with automatic backwashing features that can filter to 50 μm particle size.
Screen or bag filters can filter down to 5 μm. Fiber wound filters can remove particles down to 0.5 μm.
Filters should be sequenced from the largest to the smallest pore opening. Sediment removal efficiency
will be related to particle size distribution in the stormwater.
Treatment Process Description
Stormwater is collected at interception point(s) on the site and is diverted to an untreated stormwater
sediment pond or tank for removal of large sediment and storage of the stormwater before it is treated by
the filtration system. The untreated stormwater is pumped from the trap, pond, or tank through the
filtration system in a rapid sand filtration system. Slow sand filtration systems are designed as flow
through systems using gravity.
Maintenance Standards
Rapid sand filters typically have automatic backwash systems that are triggered by a pre-set pressure drop
across the filter. If the backwash water volume is not large or substantially more turbid than the untreated
stormwater stored in the holding pond or tank, backwash return to the untreated stormwater pond or tank
may be appropriate. However, other means of treatment and disposal may be necessary.
Screen, bag, and fiber filters must be cleaned and/or replaced when they become clogged.
Sediment shall be removed from the storage and/or treatment ponds as necessary. Typically, sediment
removal is required once or twice during a wet season and at the decommissioning of the ponds.
Sizing Criteria for Flow-Through Treatment Systems for Flow Control Exempt Water Bodies:
When sizing storage ponds or tanks for flow-through systems for flow control exempt water bodies the
treatment system capacity should be a factor. The untreated stormwater storage pond or tank should be
sized to hold 1.5 times the runoff volume of the 10-year, 24-hour storm event minus the treatment system
flowrate for an 8-hour period. For a chitosan-enhanced sand filtration system, the treatment system
flowrate should be sized using a hydraulic loading rate between 6 to 8 gpm/ft². Other hydraulic loading
rates may be more appropriate for other systems. Bypass should be provided around the chemical
treatment system to accommodate extreme storms. Runoff volume shall be calculated using the methods
presented in Chapter 3 of the SWDM (if no chemicals are proposed for use). Worst-case conditions (i.e.,
producing the most runoff) should be used for analyses (most likely conditions present prior to final
landscaping).
Sizing Criteria for Flow Control Water Bodies:
Sites that must implement flow control for the developed site condition must also control stormwater
release rates during construction. Construction site stormwater discharges shall not exceed the discharge
durations of the pre-developed condition for the range of pre-developed discharge rates from 1/2 of the
2-year flow through the 10-year flow as predicted by an approved continuous runoff model. The pre-
developed condition to be matched shall be the land cover condition immediately prior to the development
project. This restriction on release rates can affect the size of the storage pond, the filtration system, and
the flow rate through the filter system.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-88
The following is how WWHM can be used to determine the release rates from the filtration systems:
1. Determine the pre-developed flow durations to be matched by entering the land use area under the
“Pre-developed” scenario in WWHM. The default flow range is from ½ of the 2-year flow through the
10-year flow.
2. Enter the post developed land use area in the “Developed Unmitigated” scenario in WWHM.
3. Copy the land use information from the “Developed Unmitigated” to “Developed Mitigated” scenario.
4. There are two possible ways to model stormwater filtration systems:
a) The stormwater filtration system uses an untreated stormwater storage pond/tank and the
discharge from this pond/tank is pumped to one or more filters. In-line filtration chemicals would
be added to the flow right after the pond/tank and before the filter(s). Because the discharge is
pumped, WWHM can’t generate a stage/storage /discharge (SSD) table for this system. This
system is modeled the same way as described Ecology’s BMP C250 (or BMP D.2.2.5 when
seeking City approval for non-chemical treatment) and is as follows:
While in the “Developed Mitigated” scenario, add a pond element under the basin element
containing the post-developed land use areas. This pond element represents information on the
available untreated stormwater storage and discharge from the filtration system. In cases where
the discharge from the filtration system is controlled by a pump, a stage/storage/discharge (SSD)
table representing the pond must be generated outside WWHM and imported into WWHM.
WWHM can route the runoff from the post-developed condition through this SSD table (the
pond) and determine compliance with the flow duration standard. This would be an iterative
design procedure where if the initial SSD table proved to be out of compliance, the designer
would have to modify the SSD table outside WWHM and re-import in WWHM and route the
runoff through it again. The iteration will continue until a pond that enables compliance with the
flow duration standard is designed.
Notes on SSD table characteristics:
The pump discharge rate would likely be initially set at just below ½ if the 2-year flow from
the pre-developed condition. As runoff coming into the untreated stormwater storage pond
increases and the available untreated stormwater storage volume gets used up, it would be
necessary to increase the pump discharge rate above ½ of the 2-year. The increase(s) above ½
of the 2-year must be such that they provide some relief to the untreated stormwater storage
needs but at the same time they will not cause violations of the flow duration standard at the
higher flows. The final design SSD table will identify the appropriate pumping rates and the
corresponding stage and storages.
When building such a flow control system, the design must ensure that any automatic
adjustments to the pumping rates will be as a result of changes to the available storage in
accordance with the final design SSD table.
b) The stormwater filtration system uses a storage pond/tank and the discharge from this pond/tank
gravity flows to the filter. This is usually a slow sand filter system and it is possible to model it in
WWHM as a Filter element or as a combination of Pond and Filter element placed in series. The
stage/storage/discharge table(s) may then be generated within WWHM as follows:
i. While in the “Developed Mitigated” scenario, add a Filter element under the basin element
containing the post-developed land use areas. The length and width of this filter element
would have to be the same as the bottom length and width of the upstream untreated
stormwater storage pond/tank.
ii. In cases where the length and width of the filter is not the same as those for the bottom of the
upstream untreated stormwater storage tank/pond, the treatment system may be modeled as a
Pond element followed by a Filter element. By having these two elements, WWHM would
then generate a SSD table for the storage pond which then gravity flows to the Filter element.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-89
The Filter element downstream of the untreated stormwater storage pond would have a
storage component through the media, and an overflow component for when the filtration
capacity is exceeded.
WWHM can route the runoff from the post-developed condition through the treatment systems in
4b and determine compliance with the flow duration standard. This would be an iterative design
procedure where if the initial sizing estimates for the treatment system proved to be inadequate,
the designer would have to modify the system and route the runoff through it again. The iteration
would continue until compliance with the flow duration standard is achieved.
5. It should be noted that the above procedures would be used to meet the flow control requirements. The
filtration system must be able to meet the runoff treatment requirements. It is likely that the discharge
flow rate of ½ of the 2-year or more may exceed the treatment capacity of the system. If that is the
case, the untreated stormwater discharge rate(s) (i.e., influent to the treatment system) must be
reduced to allow proper treatment. Any reduction in the flows would likely result in the need for a
larger untreated stormwater storage volume.
If system design does not allow you to discharge at the slower rates as described above and if the site has a
retention or detention pond that will serve the planned development, the discharge from the treatment
system may be directed to the permanent retention/detention pond to comply with the flow control
requirements. In this case, the untreated stormwater storage pond and treatment system will be sized
according to the sizing criteria for flow-through treatment systems for flow control exempt waterbodies
described earlier except all discharges (water passing through the treatment system and stormwater
bypassing the treatment system) will be directed into the permanent retention/detention pond. If site
constraints make locating the untreated stormwater storage pond difficult, the permanent
retention/detention pond may be divided to serve as the untreated stormwater discharge pond and the post-
treatment flow control pond. A berm or barrier must be used in this case so the untreated water does not
mix with the treated water. Both untreated stormwater storage requirements, and adequate post-treatment
flow control must be achieved. The post-treatment flow control pond’s revised dimensions must be entered
into the WWHM and the WWHM must be run to confirm compliance with the flow control requirement.
D.2.2.7 HIGH PH NEUTRALIZATION USING CO2
Purpose
When pH levels in stormwater rise above 8.5 it is necessary to lower the pH levels to the acceptable range
of 6.5 to 8.5, this process is called pH neutralization. pH neutralization involves the use of solid or
compressed carbon dioxide gas in water requiring neutralization. Neutralized stormwater may be
discharged to surface waters under the Construction Stormwater General permit.
Neutralized process water such as concrete truck wash-out, hydro-demolition, or saw-cutting slurry must
be managed to prevent discharge to surface waters. Any stormwater contaminated during concrete work is
considered process wastewater and must not be discharged to surface waters.
Reason for pH Neutralization:
A pH level range of 6.5 to 8.5 is typical for most natural watercourses, and this neutral pH is required for
the survival of aquatic organisms. Should the pH rise or drop out of this range, fish and other aquatic
organisms may become stressed and may die.
Calcium hardness can contribute to high pH values and cause toxicity that is associated with high pH
conditions. A high level of calcium hardness in waters of the state is not allowed.
The water quality standard for pH in Washington State is in the range of 6.5 to 8.5. Ground water standard
for calcium and other dissolved solids in Washington State is less than 500 mg/l.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-90
Conditions of Use
Causes of High pH:
High pH at construction sites is most commonly caused by the contact of stormwater with poured or
recycled concrete, cement, mortars, and other Portland cement or lime containing construction materials.
(See BMP D.2.2.1, Concrete Handling for more information on concrete handling procedures). The
principal caustic agent in cement is calcium hydroxide (free lime).
Advantages of CO2 Sparging:
Rapidly neutralizes high pH water.
Cost effective and safer to handle than acid compounds.
CO2 is self-buffering. It is difficult to overdose and create harmfully low pH levels.
Material is readily available.
The Chemical Process:
When carbon dioxide (CO2) is added to water (H2O), carbonic acid (H2CO3) is formed which can further
dissociate into a proton (H+) and a bicarbonate anion (HCO3-) as shown below:
CO2 + H2O ↔ H2CO3 ↔ H+ + HCO3-
The free proton is a weak acid that can lower the pH. Water temperature has an effect on the reaction as
well. The colder the water temperature is the slower the reaction occurs and the warmer the water
temperature is the quicker the reaction occurs. Most construction applications in Washington State have
water temperatures in the 50°F or higher range so the reaction is almost simultaneous.
Design and Installation Specifications
Treatment Process:
High pH water may be treated using continuous treatment, continuous discharge systems. These
manufactured systems continuously monitor influent and effluent pH to ensure that pH values are within
an acceptable range before being discharged. All systems must have fail safe automatic shut off switches
in the event that pH is not within the acceptable discharge range. Only trained operators may operate
manufactured systems. System manufacturers often provide trained operators or training on their devices.
The following procedure may be used when not using a continuous discharge system:
1. Prior to treatment, the appropriate jurisdiction should be notified in accordance with the regulations
set by the jurisdiction.
2. Every effort should be made to isolate the potential high pH water in order to treat it separately from
other stormwater onsite.
3. Water should be stored in an acceptable storage facility, detention pond, or containment cell prior to
treatment.
4. Transfer water to be treated to the treatment structure. Ensure that treatment structure size is sufficient
to hold the amount of water that is to be treated. Do not fill tank completely, allow at least 2 feet of
freeboard.
5. The operator samples the water for pH and notes the clarity of the water. As a rule of thumb, less CO 2
is necessary for clearer water. This information should be recorded.
6. In the pH adjustment structure, add CO2 until the pH falls in the range of 6.9 to 7.1. Remember that
pH water quality standards apply so adjusting pH to within 0.2 pH units of receiving water
(background pH) is recommended. It is unlikely that pH can be adjusted to within 0.2 pH units using
dry ice. Compressed carbon dioxide gas should be introduced to the water using a carbon dioxide
diffuser located near the bottom of the tank, this will allow carbon dioxide to bubble up through the
water and diffuse more evenly.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-91
7. Slowly discharge the water making sure water does not get stirred up in the process. Release about
80% of the water from the structure leaving any sludge behind.
8. Discharge treated water through a pond or drainage system.
9. Excess sludge needs to be disposed of properly as concrete waste. If several batches of water are
undergoing pH treatment, sludge can be left in treatment structure for the next batch treatment.
Dispose of sludge when it fills 50% of tank volume.
Sites that must implement flow control for the developed site must also control stormwater release rates
during construction. All treated stormwater must go through a flow control facility before being released
to surface waters which require flow control.
Maintenance Standards
Safety and Materials Handling:
All equipment should be handled in accordance with OSHA rules and regulations.
Follow manufacturer guidelines for materials handling.
Operator Records:
Each operator should provide:
A diagram of the monitoring and treatment equipment.
A description of the pumping rates and capacity the treatment equipment is capable of treating.
Each operator should keep a written record of the following:
Client name and phone number.
Date of treatment.
Weather conditions.
Project name and location.
Volume of water treated.
pH of untreated water.
Amount of CO2 needed to adjust water to a pH range of 6.9 to 7.1.
pH of treated water.
Discharge point location and description.
A copy of this record should be given to the client/contractor who should retain the record for 3 years.
D.2.2.8 PH CONTROL FOR HIGH PH WATER
Purpose
When pH levels in stormwater rise above 8.5 it is necessary to lower the pH levels to the acceptable range
of 6.5 to 8.5, this process is called pH neutralization. Stormwater with pH levels exceeding water quality
standards may be treated by infiltration, dispersion in vegetation or compost, pumping to a sanitary sewer,
disposal at a permitted concrete batch plant with pH neutralization capabilities, or carbon dioxide
sparging. BMP D.2.2.7, High pH Neutralization Using CO2 gives guidelines for carbon dioxide sparging.
Reason for pH Neutralization:
A pH level range of 6.5 to 8.5 is typical for most natural watercourses, and this pH range is required for
the survival of aquatic organisms. Should the pH rise or drop out of this range, fish and other aquatic
organisms may become stressed and may die.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-92
Conditions of Use
Causes of High pH:
High pH levels at construction sites are most commonly caused by the contact of stormwater with poured
or recycled concrete, cement, mortars, and other Portland cement or lime containing construction
materials. (See BMP D.2.2.1, Concrete Handling for more information on concrete handling procedures).
The principal caustic agent in cement is calcium hydroxide (free lime).
Design and Installation Specifications
Disposal Methods:
Infiltration
Infiltration is only allowed if soil type allows all water to infiltrate (no surface runoff) without causing
or contributing to a violation of surface or ground water quality standards.
Infiltration techniques should be consistent with Chapter 5 of the SWDM
Dispersion
Dispersion techniques should be consistent with Appendix C of the SWDM
Sanitary Sewer Disposal
Approval from King County and the City of Renton is required prior to disposal via the sanitary
sewer.
Concrete Batch Plant Disposal
Only permitted facilities may accept high pH water.
Facility should be contacted before treatment to ensure they can accept the high pH water.
Stormwater Discharge
Any pH treatment options that generate treated water that must be discharged off site are subject to flow
control requirements. Sites that must implement flow control for the developed site must also control
stormwater release rates during construction. All treated stormwater must go through a flow control
facility before being released to surface waters which require flow control.
D.2.2.9 USE OF HIGH PH SOIL AMENDMENTS ON CONSTRUCTION SITES
The use of soil amendments (including cement treated base [CTB] and cement kiln dust [CKD]) on
development sites must be approved by the City. The approval process is described in “Processing
Requirements for Use of Soil Amendments on Construction Sites” below.
Use of Soil Amendments
It is sometimes a construction practice to add soil amendments to the surfaces of some construction areas
in order to stabilize the ground for building. This practice includes placing an additive on the ground then
mixing with the soil to a specified depth and finally compacting the mix. When mixed with the soil, the
moisture in the ground may allow these additives to create a chemical reaction that cures similar to
concrete and may absorb excessive moisture to allow soils to be compacted. The end result is a stable site
for constructing a road or building pad.
Because soil amendments may be rich in lime content and other material, water runoff from these areas
can be affected. If not controlled and treated, this could result in a degradation of water quality and natural
drainage systems. Because these additives come in a fine powder form, the actual application can create
fugitive dust. When mixed with water, some additives can become corrosive.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-93
Definitions
The following are definitions of soil amendment products that are allowed for use under these procedures:
1. Cement Kiln Dust (CKD) is a by-product in the manufacturing of cement9.
2. Cement Treated Base (CTB) utilizes Portland Cement Type II as the soil additive.
CTB/CKD Soil Amendment BMPs
Table D.2.2.9.A on the following pages lists twelve BMP categories of action and specific BMPs for each
category to be applied when proposing CTB/CKD soil amendments or using soil amendments onsite.
Note: Additional BMPs may be required to prevent adverse impacts to the public and/or the environment.
It is the responsibility of the permit holder to remain in compliance with all other applicable local, state,
and federal regulations.
TABLE D.2.2.9.A CTB/CKD SOIL AMENDMENT BMPS
Category of
Action
Specific
Action CTB/CKD Best Management Practices
1. Materials
Source Analysis
Solubility Testing
& Specifications
A. If CKD is proposed, a chemical analysis of soluble pollutants of
the product to be used will be provided to the Washington State
Department of Ecology (Ecology) and the CED review staff in
advance of any product is applied.
B. CTB/CKD mixing percentage is anticipated to be approximately 3
percent to 5 percent.
C. A Geotechnical Engineer will establish the mixing percentage for
the onsite soils.
D. All treatment procedures shall be directed, monitored, and
verified by a Geotechnical Engineer.
E. Soil amendments will never occur in excess of the ability of the
onsite equipment and resources to meet all BMP requirements
specified herein.
2. Site
Preparation
Runoff Collection
System
A. Areas that are to be treated as shown on the plan are flagged off
to prevent equipment from leaving treated area and going onto
untreated areas, and to prevent unauthorized equipment from
entering the treated area.
B. Assessment of surface runoff collection points are noted.
C. Cutoff trenches, collection sumps, and pumps are installed.
D. Sealed storage tanks will be properly sized to contain all runoff
from treated areas.
E. Sealed storage tanks shall be set up and ready for use to treat
contact water.
F. An approved wheel wash will be constructed at the construction
exit, typically a paved ramp sump that utilizes high-pressure
washers.
G. Copies of Treatment Plan, Approval, and Contingency Plan area
are required to be located on site.
9 CKD is collected by air pollution control devices used to clean kiln exhaust during the manufacturing of Portland Cement. EPA
has classified CKD a non-hazardous waste product provided management standards are followed for groundwater protection
and control of fugitive dust releases.
CKD should not to be confused with Fly Ash, which is a by-product of burning coal or wood and incineration of other material.
Fly ash can contain major oxides and trace metals, depending upon the fuel source, and is considered too hazardous for use
as a soil amendment. Using this product is not authorized or endorsed by Ecology or the City.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-94
TABLE D.2.2.9.A CTB/CKD SOIL AMENDMENT BMPS
Category of
Action
Specific
Action CTB/CKD Best Management Practices
3. Lay-down
Mixing Equipment
A. Exposure of CTB/CKD materials to air to be minimized. Delivery
tankers shall be set up to place CTB/CKD directly into spreading
trucks or equipment.
B. CTB/CKD operations are only allowed during daylight hours.
C. Tarps or dust bags will be used over the discharge truck hose at
unloading to prevent dust particles for becoming airborne.
D. Unloading will occur at the lowest possible pump pressure.
E. Unloading and mixing will be avoided on high wind days.
PSAPCA Section 9.15 prohibits visible emissions of fugitive dust.
F. CTB/CKD to be placed on ground by large wheeled spreaders
designed for this purpose capable of measuring application.
G. When spreading CTB/CKD it shall be kept 2–3 feet away from
untreated areas boundaries to prevent the material from
migration and contaminating outside the treatment zone.
H. Treatment area will be kept damp/wet at all times CTB/CKD is
being spread and mixed. Skirting around applicator/spreader and
mixer is required to minimize CTB/CKD dust.
I. CTB/CKD is to be roto-tilled into soil immediately after being
spread onto soils and shall be done with a skirted tiller.
J. Direct auguring machine that measures, spreads, and mixes
CTB/CKD in one operation is preferred.
K. Compaction will be complete within 2 hours after CTB/CKD
application.
4. Site
Management
Work Progress
and Weather
Conditions
A. Dust suppression by use of water trucks shall be used on areas
where work on dry soil is performed and potential airborne
contamination may occur.
B. The volume of CTB/CKD allowed on site will be limited to the
amount that can be used within a normal workday. Every effort
will be made to forecast the daily delivery rate to match the daily
onsite use rate.
C. CTB/CKD will not be added to soils at a rate that exceeds the
ability of onsite resources to immediately commence mixing and
compacting.
D. No work will occur in rain heavier than drizzle, or under drizzle
that exceeds 6 hours duration, or under any rainfall which
generates runoff from the areas being worked.
E. Should the weather change to stop the application, remaining
CTB/CKD will be covered and contained to prevent stormwater
from entering storage containment, and causing runoff.
F. All vehicles and equipment leaving the treatment area/site must
be cleaned/washed to prevent CTB/CKD from leaving site. Wash
water will be contained and treated as needed.
G. CTB/CKD contact water in the wheel wash will be removed from
the site via a Vactor truck for transport to an approved off-site
treatment or disposal facility in accordance with all federal, state,
and local laws and regulations; or, if permitted, to the sanitary
sewer system.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-95
TABLE D.2.2.9.A CTB/CKD SOIL AMENDMENT BMPS
Category of
Action
Specific
Action CTB/CKD Best Management Practices
5. Surface Water
Collection
A. Surface runoff from the treated areas is to be collected and
stored in onsite sealed treatment tanks.
B. A rigid schedule of TESC inspection, maintenance, and drainage
controls will be maintained.
C. Temporarily plugging and using detention facilities is not allowed
as a storage practice.
D. Runoff from compacted areas amended with CTB/CKD will be
directed to previously sealed tank(s) until pH levels of water are
verified to be within acceptable background water limits. No
uncontrolled discharge or infiltration from the sealed tank(s) will
be allowed.
E. Drainage from areas amended with CTB/CKD within the past 72
hours will be prevented from co-mingling with any other project
drainage.
6. Discharge
Compliance
Applicable
Regulations
A. Any and all discharges from this site will be in compliance with all
applicable federal, state, and local laws and regulations
pertaining to health and safety, water, air, waste, and wildlife,
including the Federal Clean Water Act, Clean Air Act, and
Endangered Species Act. Laboratory analysis of water is
required prior to discharge to verify compliance.
B. No infiltration is allowed to occur if pH readings are above 8.5
standard pH units, or below 6.5 standard pH units.
C. A pH meter must be used to determine levels. pH meter is to be
calibrated following proper QA/QC procedures. Fresh buffers are
to be available to re-calibrate as needed.
D. A log of turbidity and pH readings will be kept on site for
inspection.
E. All treatment of water must be directed, bench tested, monitored
and verified by a qualified water quality specialist.
F. Treated area water runoff shall not enter the permanent
stormwater system.
G. Stormwater drainage system within treatment area is to be
cleaned out prior to use for regular water runoff conveyance from
untreated areas. Water from cleanout is to be tested and treated
following the approved treatment criteria.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-96
TABLE D.2.2.9.A CTB/CKD SOIL AMENDMENT BMPS
Category of
Action
Specific
Action CTB/CKD Best Management Practices
7. Natural
Treatment and
Discharge
A. The preferred method of disposal of the treatment water will be
discharge to the sanitary sewer, provided a permit is obtained to
do so.
B. If infiltration is proposed, the area of infiltration is to be identified,
capacity confirmed, and a contingency discharge plan in place in
the event facilities fail to infiltrate.
C. For infiltration, pH limits shall be strictly adhered to.
D. If a permit to discharge to the sanitary sewer is not obtained, a
National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES)
discharge permit is required from Ecology. The retention volume
of the lined pond(s) will also be increased to ensure complete
control of the retained volume. Monitoring, bench testing, and
controlled discharge rates, with prior approval by Ecology, would
be needed prior to discharge to an approved off-site surface
drainage system. Sites that currently have NPDES permits will
need to amend permit prior to discharge to cover this action. City
approval is still required.
E. Per RMC 4-6-030, discharges into receiving drainage systems
shall not have acid or basic pH levels.
F. Sealed storage tanks shall be used to reduce turbidity and pH
before discharge.
8. Chemical
Treatment
A. Carbon dioxide sparging (dry ice pellets) may be used as the
chemical treatment agent to reduce the water pH.
B. Any means of water treatment to reduce pH will require an
NPDES discharge permit from Ecology. Permit would only be
granted after bench testing performed by an independent
qualified party.
C. Active mixing will cease if the residual retention water volume
falls below the ability to treat and properly dispose of contact
storm water.
D. Discharge would only occur after the approval of Ecology,
following bench testing and consultation with Ecology.
E. All materials for chemical treatment will be on site and property
stored, during all phases of CTB/CKD treatment.
9. Water Quality Monitoring A. Turbidity and pH will be monitored on a twice-daily basis, prior to
operations and immediately upon ceasing operations, and these
measurements will be recorded. Monitoring will also occur
immediately after any storm event of ½ inch in 24 hours, or water
migration to the retention pond(s), and the measurements
recorded. If the pH approaches 8.0, monitoring frequency will
increase.
B. Turbidity and pH monitoring will occur in all treatment facilities,
stormwater detention facilities, infiltration areas (if infiltration is
used), and in all surface water areas adjacent to site where
stormwater potentially discharges. Additional upstream surface
water sites will be established to determine background levels of
turbidity and pH.
C. All water quality monitoring data will be conducted and evaluated
by an independent, qualified party and conducted using
professionally supportable test protocols and QA/QC procedures.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-97
TABLE D.2.2.9.A CTB/CKD SOIL AMENDMENT BMPS
Category of
Action
Specific
Action CTB/CKD Best Management Practices
10. Reporting Ecology and
CED
A. All water quality monitoring data will be included in weekly CED
TESC reports to CED, and in weekly NPDES reports to Ecology.
B. All work, testing, and monitoring associated with the application
of CTB/CKD shall be observed by engineer. The engineer shall
prepare and submit a report to the assigned CED project
inspector indicating BMPs were/were not being met.
C. Copies of all reports and logs will be available on site during the
soil and surface runoff treatment activities.
Other elements to consider:
11. Water
Quality – Soils
Source Controls A. There may be very small amounts of concrete washout produced
onsite as a result of construction of erosion control measures
during reclamation. Concrete washout, if any, would be retained
in a lined enclosure of at least 6-ml Visqueen or plastic sheeting,
with no outlet. The washout retention enclosure would be isolated
and separate from any CTB/CKD area runoff. Contents of the
lined concrete washout enclosure will be removed from the site
via a Vactor truck for disposal in an approved off-site treatment or
disposal facility in accordance with all federal, state, and local
laws and regulations. Signed trip tickets, as proof of proper
disposal, will be provided to Ecology and CED.
12. Water
Quality – pH
Cover Measures A. Areas amended with CTB/CKD for compaction after CTB/CKD
addition will be covered with plastic or Visqueen sheeting, or
other impervious material by the end of each working day.
B. Temporary cover will be maintained over all compacted areas
amended with CTB/CKD until testing confirms that pH levels are
stabilized to background measurements. [Note: Curing to avoid
pH effects has no relationship to the rate at which material can
be compacted in multiple lifts. Compaction will commence
immediately after application and mixing, and multiple lifts will
occur as quickly as each lift is compacted and ready to accept
the next.]
C. Should weather conditions prevent mixing, any unmixed
CTB/CKD remaining on site will be enclosed in a sealed
containment, such as portable silo, or removed from site.
Processing Requirements for Use of High pH Soil Amendments on Construction
Sites10
Purpose
This section establishes procedures for implementing BMPs when using high pH soil amendments on
construction sites. See Table D.2.2.9.A for a description of the BMPs. This section outlines an expedited
review process and typical approval conditions that will allow contractors and builders to use soil
amendments without impacting water quality. Additional BMPs may be required based upon site specific
conditions that may warrant more protection. This policy is limited to those amendments, defined below,
commonly known to add stability to sloppy soil conditions but which can alter water runoff quality.
Authority: RMC 4-6-030(J) prohibits discharges of polluted or contaminated water into surface or storm
water drainage systems. The purpose of this statute is to protect surface and ground water by regulating the
discharge of potentially contaminated surface water. If soil amendments are proposed with an initial
application, an environmental review is required, under SEPA, which assesses impacts, provides public
input and mitigated conditions for its use.
10 Excerpted from the King County Stormwater Pollution Prevention Manual (SPPM), BMP Info Sheet #11
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-98
The City of Renton also requires an engineered design for use of a soil amendment on road surfaces or
around drainage systems (see Appendix C). The design may incorporate a thorough assessment of soil
composition and laboratory analysis. The SWDM authorizes CED to adopt BMPs for the control and
protection of surface water. Currently, for all sites, the BMPs established in this policy are the minimum
standards that shall be applied.
Procedure
An applicant may apply for use of soil amendments allowed under this policy anytime during the permit
application review or after the permit has been issued and site construction is underway. After making a
submittal to CED, the applicant may receive approval conditions. Conditions may vary from site to site,
but typically will include many of the BMPs included in this policy.
Applicants should identify any use of soil amendments as early in the process as possible to avoid delays
in obtaining approval for use during the construction phase. If a site has known soil and water conditions
that might make work during rainy periods difficult, they may want to plan to use soil amendments on
their site. Obviously, if this issue is addressed at the permit review phase, implementation in the field can
occur without delay. However, because of the potential risks of surface water pollution discharge and
required treatment, an environmental assessment will be necessary before conditions for use can be
established.
Limitations
This policy applies to the intended use of soil amendments in areas that will be covered by impervious
surfaces. For areas not covered by impervious surfaces, additional reviews, study, and BMPs may be
required. In addition, alterations to original approved use plans will require a resubmittal for approval.
Approval for the use of the soil amendments can only occur by strictly following the procedures contained
herein and not by any other approval obtained from CED.
Submittal Requirements
To obtain approval for the use of soil amendments allowed under this policy, the applicant shall prepare a
submittal package to CED that includes the following:
Letter to CED requesting use of soil amendments at a construction site allowed under this policy.
Document or letter attachment that identifies source of materials and description of mixing and
laydown process, plan for disposal of treated contact water, sanitary sewer permits and/or BMPs, and
special precautions proposed to prevent the contamination of surface or stormwater drainage systems,
other than ‘sealed’ drainage systems.
Site Plan: Show a site plan map which:
1) Shows overall grading plan showing existing and proposed contours.
2) Identifies sensitive areas and permanent or temporary drainage facilities.
3) Identifies areas that soil amendment is planned.
4) Shows depths of application and percent of amendment to be used.
5) Shows location of special wheel wash facility.
6) Shows location of collection and conveyance swales or pipes for contact water.
7) Shows location of sealed storage/treatment tanks or temporary ponds (fully lined).
8) Identifies any discharge point from the site into natural drainage systems.
9) Includes soil log locations that identify seasonal high groundwater areas.
Report and analysis of engineering mix design which includes depths of application and percent of
amendment usage.
For proposals that use CKD and CKD additive, provide analysis of source material for soluble
contaminants. Include a description of fuel source.
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-99
Monitoring criteria, including locations for pH and turbidity testing.
Provide contingency plan should use of soil amendment and site and weather conditions result in
polluted or contact water entering natural drainage systems.
Provide contact information or water quality specialist assigned to monitor application of soil
amendments and BMPs.
If the project is under construction, the applicant shall contact the CED inspector assigned to the project to
initiate a review for compliance with the BMPs and requirements herein. Otherwise contact the planner or
engineer assigned to review the permit or land use application.
Review and Approval
Once the review has been completed, the applicant shall be notified by letter which stipulates the
conditions of approval. Prior to authorizing the use of soil amendments at the site, the applicant shall
provide a special restoration financial guarantee cash deposit in the amount as determined by the existing,
established processes. Note: It remains the applicant/contractor’s responsibility to comply with any other
applicable state or federal regulations such as use of NIOSH respiratory protection, safety goggles, gloves
and protective clothing whenever using hazardous materials.
Applicable Standards
Typically, all proposals using soil amendments shall have these conditions as standard requirements:
1. Prior to any application of CKD/CTB, the general contract shall hold a preconstruction meeting with
the assigned CED inspector at least 3 working days in advance.
2. CKD will not be permitted for use in areas adjacent to or in proximity to wetlands and streams areas.
CTB may or may not be permitted in these areas.
3. Areas not covered by impervious surfaces:
CKD will not be permitted in areas that will not be covered by impervious surfaces.
If CTB is proposed in these areas, an analysis of whether or not the soil amendment will change
the post-development runoff characteristics and the permanent stormwater facilities were sized
appropriately shall be submitted for review. Use of CTB in areas not permanently covered by
impervious surface may require re-sizing of the permanent stormwater facilities.
4. If CKD is proposed, the contractor shall provide mill certificates verifying the product composition.
The contractor/developer must be prepared to follow BMPs during and after soil treatment and be
prepared to treat runoff from the treatment area(s) immediately. All stormwater collection systems
must be in place and all equipment (pH meters, dry ice, etc.) must be onsite.
5. Collection of stormwater (see BMP #5 in Table D.2.2.9.A):
Stormwater from the application area shall be kept separate from and prevented from comingling
with uncontaminated stormwater.
During the application of CKD/CTB, stormwater runoff shall be collected in temporary collection
systems and shall not be allowed to enter the permanent facilities. Permanent drainage systems
shall be capped to prevent contact stormwater from entering the inlets of the catch basins.
Stormwater from the application area shall not be collected in the temporary/permanent detention
ponds, even if the underlying soils are ‘impermeable.’
6. Treatment: If necessary, pH adjustment shall be done in the collection tanks or temporary ponds and
not in the permanent detention ponds.
7. Disposal options: The proposal to use CKD/CTB must contain a disposal plan that may include one or
a combination of sanitary sewer or approved offsite disposal. Treated contact water may be discharged
to the sanitary sewer if authorizations are obtained from the King County and the City of Renton. All
discharge conditions (e.g., pH, settleable solids) must be followed. If a sanitary sewer is not available
at the site, contact water may be transported offsite to an approved site for disposal and proof of
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-100
proper disposal must be submitted to the City. All authorizations for disposal shall be obtained prior to
CKD/CTB application.
Infiltration: Depending on the site conditions, pH-adjusted stormwater may be infiltrated. Prior to
infiltration, pH must be between 6.5 and 8.5.
Surface Water: Contact water from the application area shall not be discharged to surface waters,
even if treatment has adjusted the pH.
8. Emergency backup plan: An emergency backup plan must be prepared and ready to implement to
handle large quantities of stormwater.
9. Monitoring shall be conducted to determine that contact stormwater is not leaving the site. Offsite
monitoring shall also be conducted to identify impacts to adjacent water bodies. Bonding may be
required to cover mitigation of impacts and restoration.
10. A soils specialist will establish the mixing percentage for onsite soils. Soil amendments will never
occur in excess of the ability of the onsite equipment and resources to meet all BMP requirements.
11. For sites one acre or larger, a Construction Stormwater General permit must be obtained from
Ecology. Construction Stormwater General permits and ‘Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plans
(SWPPPs) must be amended and the use of CKD/CTB must be approved by Ecology prior to
application.
The contractor/developer shall comply will all federal, state, and local regulations. A health and safety
plan may be required for the protection of CED inspectors.
Additional BMPs may be applicable depending on mix design, proximity of wetlands or streams (e.g.,
within 300 feet of class/type I and 100 feet or less for other types) and site conditions.
D.2.2.10 MAINTAIN PROTECTIVE BMPS
Pollutant protection measures shall be maintained to ensure continued performance of their intended
function. Reporting and documentation shall be kept current and made available to CED as indicated.
Purpose: The purpose of maintaining protective BMPs is to provide effective pollutant protection when
and where required by the plan and the project, and to provide timely and relevant project information.
When to Maintain: Protection measures shall be monitored per Section D.2.4.4 at a minimum,
continuously during operation, and promptly maintained to fully functioning condition as necessary to
ensure continued performance of their intended function. Documentation shall be kept current per specific
BMP requirements.
Measures to Use:
1. Maintain and repair all pollutant control BMPs as needed to ensure continued performance of their
intended function in accordance with BMP specifications.
2. Maintain and repair storage locations for equipment and materials associated with BMP processes.
Conduct materials disposal in compliance with City requirements.
3. As required, provide current reporting and performance documentation at an accessible location for
the site inspector and other CED staff.
4. Remove all temporary pollutant control BMPs prior to final construction approval, or within 30 days
after achieving final site stabilization or after the temporary BMPs are no longer needed.
D.2.2.11 MANAGE THE PROJECT
SWPPP requirements shall be implemented and managed as part of the overall CSWPP plan. Concrete
construction and its impacts are primary among pollutant concerns on site development projects. Fueling
operations and materials containment of treatment chemicals and other project materials are also typical
D.2.2 SWPPS MEASURES
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-101
pollutant concerns. Operations that produce these and other pollutants are often conducted by
subcontractors and their laborers, yet may require specific protective measures, documentation and
reporting. Protective measures and BMPs need to be made available prior to construction and suitable
oversight provided to ensure inspection, monitoring and documentation requirements are met.
Projects shall assign a qualified CSWPP Supervisor (Section D.2.3.1) to be the primary contact for
SWPPP and ESC issues and reporting, coordination with subcontractors and implementation of the
CSWPP plan as a whole.
Measures to Use:
1. Phase development projects to the maximum degree practicable and take into account seasonal work
limits.
2. Inspection and monitoring – Inspect, maintain, and repair all BMPs as needed to ensure continued
performance of their intended function. Conduct site inspections and monitoring in accordance with
the Construction Stormwater General Permit and City requirements. Coordinate with subcontractors
and laborers to ensure the SWPPP measures are followed.
3. Documentation and reporting – Inspect, maintain, and repair all BMPs as needed to ensure continued
performance of their intended function. Document site inspections and monitoring in accordance with
the Construction Stormwater General Permit, specific BMP conditions and City requirements. Log
sheets provided in Reference Section 8 may be used if appropriate. Follow reporting requirements and
provide documentation as requested to CED staff.
4. Maintaining an updated construction SWPPP – Maintain, update, and implement the SWPPP in
accordance with the Construction Stormwater General Permit and City requirements. Obtain approval
for specific SWPPP measures (e.g., chemical treatments of stormwater) well in advance of need.
Coordinate SWPPP plan updates with the site inspector (see Section D.2.4.1).
D.2.3 CSWPP PERFORMANCE AND COMPLIANCE PROVISIONS
The changing conditions typical of construction sites call for frequent field adjustments of existing ESC
and SWPPS measures or additional ESC and SWPPS measures in order to meet required performance. In
some cases, strict adherence to specified measures may not be necessary or practicable based on site
conditions or project type. In other cases, immediate action may be needed to avoid severe impacts.
Therefore, careful attention must be paid to ESC and SWPPS performance and compliance in accordance
with the provisions contained in this section.
D.2.3.1 CSWPP SUPERVISOR
For projects in Targeted, Full, or Large Project Drainage Review, or projects in Directed Drainage Review
as determined by CED review staff, the applicant must designate a CSWPP supervisor who shall be
responsible for the performance, maintenance, and review of ESC and SWPPS measures and for
compliance with all permit conditions relating to CSWPP as described in the CSWPP Standards. The
applicant’s selection of a CSWPP supervisor must be approved by the City. (City approval may be
rescinded for non-compliance, requiring the applicant to select another CSWPP supervisor and obtain City
approval prior to continuing work on the project site.)
For projects that disturb one acre or more of land, the CSWPP supervisor must be a Certified
Professional in Erosion and Sediment Control (see <www.cpesc.net> for more information) or a
Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead whose certification is recognized by the City.11 The City
may also require a certified ESC professional for sites smaller than one acre of disturbance if CED
determines that onsite ESC measures are inadequately installed, located, or maintained.
11 The City’s recognition of certification means that the individual has taken an approved third party training program and has
passed the approved test for that training program.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-102
For larger, more sensitive sites, the City may require a certified ESC professional with several years of
experience in construction supervision/inspection and a background in geology, soil science, or agronomy.
Typically, if a geotechnical consultant is already working on the project, the consultant may also be a
certified ESC professional designated as the CSWPP supervisor. The design engineer may also be
qualified for this position. This requirement shall only be used for sensitive sites that pose an unusually
high risk of impact to surface waters as determined by CED. At a minimum, the project site must meet all
of the following conditions in order to require the applicant to designate as the CSWPP supervisor a
certified ESC professional with such expertise:
Alderwood soils or other soils of Hydrologic Group C or D
Five acres of disturbance
Large areas (i.e., two or more acres) with slopes in excess of 10 percent.
Proximity to streams or wetlands or phosphorus-sensitive lakes, such as Lake Sammamish, shall also be a
factor in determining if such expertise in the CSWPP supervisor is warranted. However, proximity alone
shall not be a determining factor because even projects that are a considerable distance from surface
waters can result in significant impacts if there is a natural or constructed drainage system with direct
connections to surface waters.
The name, address, and phone number of the CSWPP supervisor shall be supplied to the City prior to the
start of construction. A sign shall be posted at all primary entrances to the site identifying the CSWPP
supervisor and his/her phone number. The requirement for a CSWPP supervisor does not relieve the
applicant of ultimate responsibility for the project and compliance with Renton Municipal Code.
D.2.3.2 MONITORING OF DISCHARGES
The CSWPP supervisor shall have a turbidity meter onsite and shall use it to monitor surface and storm
water discharges from the project site and into onsite wetlands, streams, or lakes whenever runoff occurs
from onsite activities and during storm events. The CSWPP supervisor shall keep a log of all turbidity
measurements taken onsite and make it available to CED upon request. If the project site is subject to a
NPDES general permit for construction issued by the Washington State Department of Ecology (Ecology),
then the project must comply with the monitoring requirements of that permit.
The CSWPP supervisor shall also use the specific SWPPS BMP procedures for monitoring surface and
stormwater discharge for pollutants and acceptable discharge levels. The CSWPP supervisor shall keep
logs as required by the procedures of all measurements taken onsite and make them available to CED on
request.
D.2.3.3 ESC PERFORMANCE
ESC measures shall be applied/installed and maintained so as to prevent, to the maximum extent
practicable, the transport of sediment from the project site to downstream drainage systems or surface
waters or into onsite wetlands, streams, or lakes or onto adjacent properties. This performance is intended
to be achieved through proper selection, installation, and operation of the above ESC measures as detailed
in the CSWPP Standards (Appendix D) and approved by the City. However, the CSWPP supervisor
designated per Section D.2.3.1 or the City may determine at any time during construction that such
approved measures are not sufficient and additional action is required based on one of the following
criteria:
1. IF a turbidity test of surface and storm water discharges leaving the project site is greater than the
benchmark value of 25 nephelometric turbidity units (NTU) set by the Washington State Department
of Ecology, but less than 250 NTU, the CSWPP Supervisor shall do all of the following:
a) Review the ESC plan for compliance and make appropriate revisions within 7 days of the
discharge that exceeded the benchmark of 25 NTU, AND
D.2.3 CSWPP PERFORMANCE AND COMPLIANCE PROVISIONS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-103
b) Fully implement and maintain appropriate ESC measures as soon as possible but no later than 10
days after the discharge that exceeded the benchmark, AND
c) Document ESC implementation and maintenance in the site log book.
2. IF a turbidity test of surface or storm water entering onsite wetlands, streams, or lakes indicates a
turbidity level greater than 5 NTU above background when the background turbidity is 50 NTU or
less, or 10% above background when the background turbidity is greater than 50 NTU, then corrective
actions and/or additional measures beyond those specified in SWDM Section 1.2.5.1 shall be
implemented as deemed necessary by the CED inspector or onsite CSWPP supervisor.
3. IF discharge turbidity is 250 NTU or greater, the CSWPP Supervisor shall do all of the following:
a) Notify the City by telephone, AND
b) Review the ESC plan for compliance and make appropriate revisions within 7 days of the
discharge that exceeded the benchmark of 25 NTU, AND
c) Fully implement and maintain appropriate ESC measures as soon as possible but no later than 10
days after the discharge that exceeded the benchmark, AND
d) Document ESC implementation and maintenance in the site log book. AND
e) Continue to sample discharges until turbidity is 25 NTU or lower, or the turbidity is no more than
10% over background turbidity.
4. IF the City determines that the condition of the construction site poses a hazard to adjacent property
or may adversely impact drainage facilities or water resources, THEN additional measures beyond
those specified in SWDM Section 1.2.5.1 may be required by the City.
D.2.3.4 SWPPS PERFORMANCE
SWPPS measures shall be applied/installed and maintained so as to prevent, reduce, or eliminate the
discharge of pollutants to onsite or adjacent stormwater systems or watercourses or onto adjacent
properties. This performance is intended to be achieved through proper selection, installation, and
operation of the above SWPPS measures as detailed in the CSWPP Standards (Appendix D) and approved
by the City. However, the CSWPP supervisor designated per Section D.2.3.1 or the City may determine at
any time during construction that such approved measures are not sufficient and additional action is
required based on the criteria described in the specific SWPPS BMP standard and/or conditions of an
approved adjustment.
D.2.3.5 FLEXIBLE COMPLIANCE
Some projects may meet the intent of Core Requirement #5 while varying from specific CSWPP
requirements in this appendix. If a project is designed and constructed such that it meets the intent of the
core requirement, the City may determine that strict adherence to a specific ESC requirement is
unnecessary; an approved adjustment (see Section 1.4) from the SWDM is not required in these
circumstances. Certain types of projects are particularly likely to warrant this greater level of flexibility;
for instance, projects on relatively flat, well drained soils, projects that are constructed in closed
depressions, or projects that only disturb a small percentage of a forested site may meet the intent of this
requirement with very few ESC measures. Note, however, that SWPPS requirements may actually be
emphasized on well-drained soils, particularly in groundwater protection or well-protection areas, or in
close proximity to water bodies.
D.2.3.6 ROADS AND UTILITIES COMPLIANCE
Road and utility projects often pose difficult erosion control challenges because they frequently cross
surface waters and because narrow right-of-way constrains areas available to store and treat sediment-
laden water. In most cases, the standards of this appendix may be applied to such linear projects without
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-104
modification. For instance, the ability to use perimeter control rather than a sediment retention facility for
small drainage areas (see Section D.2.1.3) will apply to many of these projects.
However, there may be some projects that cannot reasonably meet the standards of Core Requirement #5
and this appendix. In these cases, other measures may be proposed that will provide reasonable protection.
An adjustment is not required for such projects, unless the City determines that measures proposed by the
applicant fail to meet the intent of Core Requirement #5 and this appendix, and that significant adverse
impacts to surface water may result. Examples of other measures that may be taken in lieu of the standards
of this appendix are:
1. Phasing the project so that the site is worked progressively from end to end, rather than clearing and
grubbing the entire length of the project. This results in smaller exposed areas for shorter durations,
thus reducing the erosion risk. It is recommended that there be no more than 500 feet of open trench
during any phase of construction.
2. Placement of excavated materials from utility trenches on the upslope side of the excavation, to
minimize transport of sediment outside of the project area.
3. Mulching and vegetating cut and fill slopes as soon as they are graded. Frequently, this is done at the
end of construction when paving or utility installation is complete. Vegetating these areas at the start
of the project stabilizes those areas most susceptible to erosion.
4. Protecting all catch basin inlets with catch basin inserts or other inlet protection when these do not
drain to ponds or traps. This will not provide the same level of protection as a sediment pond or trap,
but can remove most of the sand-sized material entrained in the runoff.
5. Phasing the project so that all clearing and grading in critical area buffers occurs in the dry season.
This substantially reduces the chance of erosion and allows for rapid revegetation in the late summer
and early fall.
6. Using approved flocculent or other chemical treatment approved by the City to reduce the turbidity of
water released from sediment ponds.
7. Hiring a private consultant with expertise in ESC to review and monitor the site.
8. Limiting employee/contractor parking and overnight/weekend parking of construction vehicles to
dedicated and controlled areas prepared for drip and spill control. Options in the right-of-way for such
areas can be limited.
If alternatives are used, it may be appropriate to develop a monitoring program that would monitor
compliance with the performance standard of Core Requirement #5 and/or impacts to nearby water
resources. Of particular concern are impacts to salmonid spawning gravels. McNeil sampling is a possible
method of sampling to determine impacts to spawning gravels (see Section D.2.4.3).
D.2.3.7 ALTERNATIVE MEASURES
In general, the SWDM only contains those BMPs that are standards of the local industry. There are a
variety of other BMPs available that may also be used, even though they are not included in this appendix.
Such alternatives may be approved without an adjustment if the alternative will produce a compensating or
comparable result with the measures in this appendix. Variations on or modifications of the BMPs in this
appendix may also be granted based on the same criteria.
An adjustment may be required for products or techniques that are new and untested (see Section 1.4.4 of
the SWDM). In addition, the new product or technique must be approved through the state Department of
Ecology’s CTAPE program.12 The intent of this requirement is not to discourage new techniques, but to
12 CTAPE stands for Chemical Technology Assessment Protocol – Ecology. For more information, see Ecology’s website at
<https://ecology.wa.gov/Regulations-Permits/Guidance-technical-assistance/Stormwater-permittee-guidance-
resources/Emerging-stormwater-treatment-technologies>.
D.2.3 CSWPP PERFORMANCE AND COMPLIANCE PROVISIONS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-105
ensure that new techniques are monitored and documented for adequacy and possible inclusion in
subsequent versions of the SWDM.
D.2.4 CSWPP IMPLEMENTATION REQUIREMENTS
This section describes the CSWPP implementation requirements that are required at each construction site.
The measures and practices correspond to the implementation requirements in Core Requirement #5.
Three of the sections (the CSWPP report (Section D.2.4.1, below), CSWPP maintenance requirements
(Section D.2.4.4), and final site stabilization (Section D.2.4.5) are required of every project. The rest of the
sections are special requirements that may apply to the project depending on site conditions and project
type. The introductory paragraphs at the beginning of most sections present the purpose of the measures
and when they should be applied to the site. Compliance with the implementation requirements (as
appropriate for the site) ensures compliance with the CSWPP measures. Note, however, that additional
measures shall be required by the City if the existing standards are insufficient to protect adjacent
properties, drainage facilities, or water resources.
D.2.4.1 CSWPP PLAN
A CSWPP plan, containing the ESC plan and the SWPPS plan, and showing the location and details of
ESC and SWPPS measures, is required for all proposed projects. It shall include a CSWPP report, which
includes supporting information for providing ESC and SWPPS measures and meeting CSWPP
implementation requirements. A copy of the CSWPP plan with CSWPP report shall be kept at the project
site throughout all phases of construction. All of the materials required for the CSWPP report are standard
parts of engineering plan submittals for projects requiring drainage review. The simplest approach to
preparing this report is to compile the pieces during preparation for submittal and include the report as a
separate part of the CSWPP plan submittal package. The CSWPP report shall include the following:
1. A detailed construction sequence, as proposed by the design engineer or erosion control specialist,
identifying required ESC measures and implementation requirements;
2. A technical information report (TIR) and ESC and SWPPS plans for CED review in accordance
with Sections 2.3.1 and 2.3.3 of the SWDM. Incorporate any City review comments as necessary to
comply with Core Requirement #5 of the SWDM (Section 1.2.5) and the Construction Stormwater
Pollution Prevention Standards adopted in this appendix;
3. Any calculations or information necessary to size ESC measures and demonstrate compliance with
Core Requirement #5;
4. Descriptions and any supporting documentation, operating procedures, precautions, logging and
reporting requirements, etc., for the project’s SWPPS BMPs,
5. An inspection and maintenance program in accordance with Section D.2.4.4 that includes the
designation of a certified CSWPP supervisor as point of contact; and
6. Anticipated changes or additions necessary during construction to ensure that ESC and SWPPS
measures perform in accordance with Core Requirement #5 and Sections D.2.1 and D.2.2.
While the CSWPP plan focuses on the initial measures to be applied to the site, any changes or additions
necessary during construction to ensure that ESC and SWPPS measures perform in accordance with Core
Requirement #5 and Sections D.2.1, D.2.2 and D.2.4 must be identified in the CSWPP report. The City
may require large, complex projects to phase construction and submit multiple ESC plans for different
stages of construction. Development of new CSWPP plans is not required for changes that are necessary
during construction.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-106
D.2.4.2 WET SEASON REQUIREMENTS
Any site with exposed soils during the wet season (October 1 to April 30) shall be subject to the special
provisions below. In addition to the ESC cover measures (see Section D.2.1.2), these provisions include
covering any newly seeded areas with mulch and identifying and seeding as much disturbed area as
possible prior to September 23 in order to provide grass cover for the wet season. A “wet season ESC
plan” must be submitted and approved by the City before work proceeds or continues.
Wet Season Special Provisions
All of the following provisions for wet season construction are detailed in the referenced sections. These
requirements are listed here for the convenience of the designer and the reviewer.
1. The allowed time that a disturbed area may remain unworked without cover measures is reduced to
two consecutive working days, rather than seven (Section D.2.1.2).
2. Stockpiles and steep cut and fill slopes are to be protected if unworked for more than 12 hours
(Section D.2.1.2).
3. Cover materials sufficient to cover all disturbed areas shall be stockpiled on site (Section D.2.1.2).
4. All areas that are to be unworked during the wet season shall be seeded within one week of the
beginning of the wet season (Section D.2.1.2.6).
5. Mulch is required to protect all seeded areas (Section D.2.1.2.2).
6. Fifty linear feet of silt fence (and the necessary stakes) per acre of disturbance must be stockpiled on
site (Section D.2.1.3.1).
7. Construction road and parking lot stabilization are required for all sites unless the site is underlain by
coarse-grained soil (Section D.2.1.4.2).
8. Sediment retention is required unless no offsite discharge is anticipated for the specified design flow
(Section D.2.1.5).
9. Surface water controls are required unless no offsite discharge is anticipated for the specified design
flow (Section D.2.1.6).
10. Phasing and more conservative BMPs must be evaluated for construction activity near surface waters
(Section D.2.4.3).
11. Any runoff generated by dewatering may be required to discharge to the sanitary sewer (with
appropriate discharge authorization), portable sand filter systems, or holding tanks (Section D.2.2).
D.2.4.3 CRITICAL AREAS RESTRICTIONS
Any construction that will result in disturbed areas on or within a stream or associated buffer, a wetland or
associated buffer, or within 50 feet of a lake shall be subject to the special provisions below. These
provisions include, whenever possible, phasing the project so that construction in these areas is limited to
the dry season. The City may require more conservative BMPs, including more stringent cover
requirements, in order to protect surface water quality. Any project proposing work within 50 feet of a
steep slope hazard area shall evaluate the need for diverting runoff that might flow over the top of the
slope.
Critical Areas Special Provisions
Any project that disturbs areas on or within a stream or associated buffer, wetland or associated buffer, or
within 50 feet of a lake has the potential to seriously damage water resources, even if the project is
relatively small. While it is difficult to require specific measures for such projects because the CSWPP
plan must be very site specific, the following recommendations shall be incorporated into the plan where
appropriate:
D.2.4 CSWPP IMPLEMENTATION REQUIREMENTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-107
1. Whenever possible, phase all or part of the project so that it occurs during the dry season. If this is
impossible, November through February shall be avoided since this is the most likely period for large,
high-intensity storms.
2. All projects shall be completed and stabilized as quickly as possible. Limiting the size and duration of
a project is probably the most effective form of erosion control.
3. Where appropriate, sandbags or an equivalent barrier shall be constructed between the project area and
the surface water in order to isolate the construction area from high water that might result due to
precipitation.
4. Additional perimeter protection shall be considered to reduce the likelihood of sediment entering the
surface waters. Such protection might include multiple silt fences, silt fences with a higher AOS,
construction of a berm, or a thick layer of organic mulch upslope of a silt fence.
5. If work is to occur within the ordinary high water mark of a stream, most projects must isolate the
work area from the stream by diverting the stream or constructing a cofferdam. Certain small projects
that propose only a small amount of grading may not require isolation since diversions typically result
in disturbance and the release of some sediment to the stream. For such small projects, the potential
impacts from construction with and without a diversion must be weighed.
6. If a stream must be crossed, a temporary bridge shall be considered rather than allowing equipment to
utilize the streambed for a crossing.
For projects in or near a salmonid stream, it may be appropriate to monitor the composition of any
spawning gravels within a quarter-mile of the site with a McNeil sampler or similar method approved by
the City before, during, and after construction. The purpose of such monitoring would be to determine if
the fine content of the gravels increases as a result of construction impacts. Monitoring results could be
used to guide erosion control efforts during construction and as a threshold for replacing spawning gravels
if the fine content rises significantly.
D.2.4.4 MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS
All ESC and SWPPS measures shall be maintained and reviewed on a regular basis as prescribed in the
maintenance requirements for each BMP and in this section. The CSWPP supervisor shall review the site
for ESC and SWPPS at least weekly and within 24 hours of significant storms. The CWSPP supervisor
shall also review the site for ESC and SWPPS during periods of active construction where maintenance
conditions change with construction activity (e.g., site grading operations, or concrete construction and
dewatering operations for a detention vault). The City requires a written record of these reviews be kept on
site with copies submitted to CED within 48 hours.
Documentation
If CED requires that a written record be maintained, standard ESC and SWPPS Maintenance Reports
forms, included in Section D.4.1, may be used. A copy of all the required maintenance reports shall be
kept on site throughout the duration of construction. Detailed maintenance requirements for each ESC
measure are provided in Section D.2.1. Maintenance requirements for SWPPS BMPs are specified in
Section D.2.2 (as in the case of BMPs related to concrete handling or material containment) or may be
specified as part of a treatment or monitoring program, often accompanied with adjustment conditions of
approval.
Review Timing
Weekly reviews shall be carried out every 6 to 8 calendar days. Reviews shall also take place within
24 hours of significant storms. In general, a significant storm is one with more than 0.5 inches of rain in
24 hours or less. Other indications that a storm is “significant” are if the sediment ponds or traps are filled
with water, or if gullies form as a result of the runoff.
Note: The site is to be in compliance with the regulations of this appendix at all times. The requirement for
periodic reviews does not remove the applicant’s responsibility for having the site constantly in
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-108
compliance with Core Requirement #5 and the requirements of this appendix. The reviews are a
mechanism to ensure that all measures are thoroughly checked on a regular basis and that there is
documentation of compliance. The requirement for these reviews does not mean that CSWPP is to be
ignored in between.
D.2.4.5 FINAL STABILIZATION
Prior to obtaining final construction approval, the site shall be stabilized, the structural ESC and SWPPS
measures (such as silt fences, sediment traps, and concrete waste collection pits) removed, and drainage
facilities cleaned. The removal of ESC and SWPPS measures is not required for those projects, such as
plats, that will be followed by additional construction under a different permit. In these circumstances, the
need for removing or retaining the measures must be evaluated on a site-specific basis.
To obtain final construction approval, the following conditions must be met:
1. All disturbed areas of the site shall be vegetated or otherwise permanently stabilized. At a
minimum, disturbed areas shall be seeded and mulched (see Section D.2.1.2.6) with a high likelihood
that sufficient cover will develop shortly after final approval. Mulch without seeding is not adequate
to allow final approval of the permit, except for small areas of mulch used for landscaping. The only
exceptions to these requirements are lots within a plat that are to be developed under an approved
residential permit immediately following plat approval. In these cases, mulch and/or temporary
seeding are adequate for cover.
2. Structural measures such as, but not limited to, silt fences, pipe slope drains, construction entrances,
storm drain inlet protection, sediment traps and ponds, concrete washout and collection pits, and
pollutant storage shall be removed from the site. Measures that will quickly decompose, such as brush
barriers and organic mulches, may be left in place. In the case of silt fences, it may be best to remove
fences in conjunction with the seeding, since it may be necessary to bring machinery back in to
remove them. This will result in disturbed soils that will again require protection. The CED inspector
must approve an applicant’s proposal to remove fencing prior to the establishment of vegetation. In
some cases, such as residential building following plat development, it shall be appropriate to leave
some or all ESC measures for use during subsequent development. This shall be determined on a site-
specific basis.
3. All permanent surface water facilities, including catch basins, manholes, pipes, ditches, channels, flow
control facilities, and water quality facilities, shall be cleaned. Existing and newly constructed
BMPs/facilities shall be cleaned and/or mitigated as necessary to restore functionality. Any offsite
catch basin that required protection during construction (see Section D.2.1.5.3) shall also be cleaned.
4. If only the infrastructure of the site has been developed (e.g., subdivisions and short plats) with
building construction to occur under a different permit, then the critical area buffers, Critical Area
Tracts, or Critical Area Setback Areas shall be clearly marked as described in Section D.2.1.1 in order
to alert future buyers and builders.
D.2.4.6 NPDES REQUIREMENTS
As part of NPDES implementation, projects that will disturb one or more acres for purposes of
constructing or allowing for construction of a development, or projects disturbing less than one acre that
are part of a larger common plan of development or sale13 that will ultimately disturb one or more acres,
must apply for coverage under Ecology’s Construction Stormwater General Permit. In general, the
13 Common plan of development or sale means a site where multiple separate and distinct construction activities may take
place at different times or on different schedules, but still under a single plan. Examples include: 1) phased projects and
projects with multiple filings or lots, even if the separate phases or filings/lots will be constructed under separate contract or by
separate owners (e.g., a development where lots are sold to separate builders); 2) a development plan that may be phased
over multiple years, but is still under a consistent plan for long-term development; and 3) projects in a contiguous area that may
be unrelated but still under the same contract, such as construction of a building extension and a new parking lot at the same
facility.
D.2.4 CSWPP IMPLEMENTATION REQUIREMENTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-109
construction stormwater pollution prevention plan required by the SWDM is equivalent to that required by
the State. The Ecology stormwater permit application requires the filing of a Notice of Intent (NOI) at
least 30 days prior to the start of construction. The only major requirement of the stormwater permit that is
not included in the SWDM is a public notice requirement. Note that this public notice for Ecology’s
stormwater permit may be published concurrently with other public notices required for permits or SEPA.
Contact Ecology at (360) 407-7156 for complete information on permit thresholds, applications, and
requirements.
D.2.4.7 FOREST PRACTICE PERMIT REQUIREMENTS
Projects that will clear more than two acres of forest or 5,000 board feet of timber must apply for a Class
IV Special Forest Practice permit from the Washington State Department of Natural Resources (WSDNR).
All such clearing is also subject to the State Environmental Policy Act (RCW 43.21C) and will require
SEPA review. The City assumes lead agency status for Class IV permits and the application may be
consolidated with the associated City development permit or approval. The permit must be initiated with
WSDNR, but will then be transferred over to the City to conduct the SEPA review and grant the permit.
Contact the WSDNR for complete information on permit thresholds, applications, and requirements.
D.2.5 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION
PLANS
This section details the specifications and contents for CSWPP plans, containing ESC plans and SWPPS
plans. A CSWPP plan includes the plan’s drawings plus a CSWPP report, which provides all supporting
information and any additional direction necessary for implementing ESC and SWPPS measures and
meeting CSWPP implementation requirements. The CSWPP plan must be submitted to CED as part of a
complete engineering plan to facilitate proper drainage review. A copy of the approved CSWPP plan (with
CSWPP report) must be kept on the project site (see Section D.2.4.1) at all times during the construction
phase.
D.2.5.1 ESC PLAN
ESC Plan General Specifications
The site improvement plan shall be used as the base of the ESC plan. Certain detailed information (e.g.,
pipe catch basin size, stub-out locations, etc.) that is not relevant may be omitted to make the ESC plan
easier to comprehend. At a minimum, the ESC plan shall include all of the information required for the
base map of a site improvement plan (see Table 2.3.1A of the SWDM), as well as existing and proposed
roads, driveways, parking areas, buildings and drainage facilities (including existing and proposed
BMPs/facilities), utility corridors not associated with roadways, relevant critical areas14 and associated
buffers, and proposed final topography. A smaller scale may be used to provide better comprehension and
understanding.
The ESC plan shall generally be designed for proposed topography, not existing topography, since rough
grading is usually the first step in site disturbance. The ESC plan shall address all phases of construction
(e.g., clearing, grading, installation of utilities, surfacing, and final stabilization). The City may require
large, complex projects to phase construction and submit multiple ESC plans for different stages of
construction.
The ESC plan outlines the minimum requirements for anticipated site conditions. During construction,
ESC plans shall be revised as necessary by the CSWPP supervisor or as directed by the City to address
changing site conditions, unexpected storm events, or non-compliance with the ESC performance criteria
in Section D.2.3.3. If non-compliance with the ESC performance criteria occurs, the plan must be updated
14 Relevant critical areas, for the purposes of drainage review, include aquatic areas, wetlands, flood hazard areas, erosion
hazard areas, landslide hazard areas, steep slope hazard areas, and critical aquifer recharge areas.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-110
within 7 days of inspections or investigations. Implementation of the onsite changes must occur within
10 days.
The following list provides the basic information requirements for the ESC plan and its supporting
documentation. This information shall be consistent with that in Section 8 of the plan’s technical
information report (TIR) required in the engineering plan submittal (see Section 2.3.1 of the SWDM). Note
that the ESC plan’s drawings may be simplified by the use of the symbols and codes provided for each
ESC measure in Section D.2.1. In general, the ESC plan’s drawings shall be submitted as a separate plan
sheet(s). However, there may be some relatively simple projects where providing a separate grading and
ESC plan drawing is unnecessary.
1. Identify areas with a high susceptibility to erosion.
2. Provide all details necessary to clearly illustrate the intent of the ESC design.
3. Include ESC measures for all on- and offsite utility construction included in the permit.
4. Specify the construction sequence. The construction sequence shall be specifically written for the
proposed project. An example construction sequence is provided in Reference Section 7-B.
5. Include standard ESC plan notes. Standard ESC and SWPPS Notes are provided in Reference
Section 7-B.
6. Include an inspection and maintenance program for ESC measures, including designation of a
certified ESC supervisor and identification of phone numbers for 24-hour contact.
7. Include the basis and calculations for selection and sizing of ESC measures.
8. Include documentation, conditions of approval and discussion of approvals from other agencies for
alternative treatment and/or disposal methods.
ESC Plan Measure-Specific Information
The ESC plan must include the following information specific to applicable ESC measures and
implementation requirements. As noted above, this information may need to be updated or revised during
the life of the project by the CSWPP supervisor or as directed by the City.
Clearing Limits
1. Delineate clearing limits (areas to remain uncleared) and on-site BMP area protection limits.
2. Provide details sufficient for installation of markings for maintenance of clearing limits and protection
limits.
Cover Measures
1. Specify the type and location of temporary cover measures to be used on site.
2. If more than one type of cover measure is to be used on site, indicate the areas where the different
measures shall be used, including steep cut and fill slopes.
3. If the type of cover measures to be used will vary depending on the time of year, soil type, gradient, or
some other factor, specify the conditions that control the use of the different measures.
4. Specify the nature and location of permanent cover measures. If a landscaping plan is prepared, this
may not be necessary.
5. Specify the approximate amount of cover measures necessary to cover all disturbed areas.
6. If netting, blankets, or plastic sheeting are specified, provide typical details sufficient for installation
and maintenance.
7. Specify the mulch types, seed mixes, fertilizers, and soil amendments to be used, as well as the
application rate for each item. (Also include fertilizer and application rate information in the SWPPS
documents)
D.2.5 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION PLANS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-111
8. For surface roughening, describe methods, equipment and areas where surface roughening will be
use.
9. If PAM is used on a site, show location(s) and describe application method.
10. When compost blankets are used, show site location, application rates, and the name of the supplier
to document that compost meets quality specifications per SWDM Reference Section 11-C.
Perimeter Protection
1. Specify the location and type of perimeter protection to be used.
2. Provide typical details sufficient for installation and maintenance of perimeter protection.
3. If a silt fence is to be used, specify the type of fabric.
4. If compost berms or socks are used, documentation must be provide to ensure the supplier meets
quality specifications per SWDM Reference Section 11-C.
Traffic Area Stabilization
1. Locate the construction entrance(s).
2. Provide typical details sufficient for installation and maintenance of the construction entrance.
3. Locate the construction roads and parking areas.
4. Specify the measure(s) that will be used to create stabilized construction roads and parking areas.
Provide sufficient detail to install and maintain.
5. If a wheel wash or tire bath system will be installed, provide location, typical details for installation
and maintenance.
6. Provide a list of dust control products that will be used onsite and the location of potential application
areas.
Sediment Retention
1. Show the locations of all sedimentation ponds and traps.
2. Dimension pond berm widths and all inside and outside pond slopes.
3. Indicate the trap/pond storage required and the depth, length, and width dimensions.
4. Provide typical section views throughout the pond and outlet structure.
5. If chemical or electrocoagulation treatment of sediment-laden waters will be used, approval
documentation from Ecology must be included.
6. Provide details for disposal of contaminated or chemically treated waters (e.g., where Chitosan or
CO2 have been used).
7. Include here and in the SWPPS plan appropriate approval documentation from King County and
the City of Renton if contaminated or chemically treated water will be discharged to the sanitary
sewer.
8. Provide typical details of the control structure and dewatering mechanism.
9. Detail stabilization techniques for the outlet/inlet protection.
10. Provide details sufficient to install cell dividers.
11. Specify mulch and/or recommended cover of berms and slopes.
12. Indicate the required depth gage with a prominent mark at 1-foot depth for sediment removal.
13. Indicate catch basins that are to be protected.
14. Indicate existing and proposed BMP/facility areas that are to be protected.
15. Provide details of the catch basin and BMP/facility protection sufficient to install and maintain.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-112
Surface Water Control
1. Locate all pipes, ditches, and interceptor ditches, dikes, and swales that will be used to convey
stormwater.
2. Provide details sufficient to install and maintain all conveyances.
3. Indicate locations of outlet protection and provide detail of protections.
4. Indicate locations and outlets of any possible dewatering systems. Provide details of alternative
discharge methods from dewatering systems if adequate infiltration rates cannot be achieved.
Alternative dewatering systems may also require documentation per the SWPPS plan.
5. Indicate the location of any level spreaders and provide details sufficient to install and maintain.
6. Provide all temporary pipe inverts.
7. Provide location and specifications for the interception of runoff from disturbed areas and the
conveyance of the runoff to a non-erosive discharge point.
8. Provide locations of rock check dams.
9. Provide details, including front and side sections, of typical rock check dams.
Wet Season Requirements
1. Provide a list of all applicable wet season requirements.
2. Clearly identify that from October 1 through April 30, no soils shall be exposed for more than two
consecutive working days. Also note that this two-day requirement may be applied at other times of
the year if storm events warrant more conservative measures.
3. Clearly identify that exposed soils shall be stabilized at the end of the workday prior to a weekend,
holiday, or predicted rain event.
Critical Areas Restrictions
1. Delineate and label the following critical areas, and any applicable buffers, that are on or adjacent
to the project site: aquatic areas, wetlands, flood hazard areas, erosion hazard areas, landslide hazard
areas, steep slope hazard areas, and critical aquifer recharge areas.
2. If construction creates disturbed areas within any of the above listed critical areas or associated
buffers, specify the type, locations, and details of any measures or other provisions necessary to
comply with the critical area restrictions in this appendix and protect surface waters and steep
slopes.
D.2.5.2 SWPPS PLAN
SWPPS Plan General Specifications
The SWPPS plan, together with the ESC plan, comprise the CSWPP that must be submitted as part of the
engineering plans required for drainage review.
The SWPPS plan shall address all phases of construction (e.g., clearing, grading, installation of utilities,
surfacing, and final stabilization). The City may require large, complex projects to phase construction and
submit multiple SWPPS plans for different stages of construction.
The SWPPS plan outlines the minimum requirements for anticipated site conditions and construction
activity. During construction, SWPPS plan shall be revised as necessary by the CSWPP supervisor or as
directed by the City to address changing site conditions or construction activity, unexpected storm events,
or non-compliance with the SWPPS performance criteria in Section D.2.3.4. If non-compliance with the
SWPPS performance criteria occurs (e.g., a pollutant spill), immediate action may be necessary to address
the occurrence; otherwise, the plan must be updated within 7 days of inspections or investigations.
Implementation of the onsite changes must occur within 10 days.
D.2.5 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION PLANS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-113
The SWPPS plan must be kept on site during all phases of construction and shall address the
construction-related pollution-generating activities outlined in Subsection A below. The plan must
include a description of the methods the general contractor will use to ensure sub-contractors are aware of
the SWPPS plan. A form or record must be provided that states all sub-contractors have read and agree to
the SWPPS plan.
A SWPPS plan consists of the following three elements, which are further described in Subsections B, C,
and D below:
1. A site plan with supporting documentation, showing the location and description of BMPs required to
prevent pollution and control spills from construction activities and from chemicals and other
materials used and stored on the construction site. Supporting documentation (see the TIR Section 8
discussion in Section 2.3.1.1 of the SWDM) shall include:
all details necessary to clearly illustrate the intent of the SWPPS design;
the basis, supporting documentation and approvals, and any calculations for selection and sizing
of SWPPS measures; and
an inspection and maintenance program for SWPPS measures, including designation of a certified
ESC professional and CSWPP supervisor and identification of phone numbers for 24-hour
contact.
documentation, conditions of approval and discussion of approvals from other agencies for
treatment and/or disposal methods (e.g., discharge to sanitary sewer, Ecology-approved chemical
treatments).
The SWPPS plan shall also discuss the receiving waters, especially if the receiving water body
is listed on the 303d list. Information must be provided that shows the plan meets TMDL
requirements. Discuss the 303(d) listed pollutant generated or used onsite and any special
handling requirements or BMPs.
See Subsection B below for more specifics on the SWPPS site plan.
2. A pollution prevention report listing the potential sources of pollution and identifying the
operational, source control, and treatment BMPs necessary to prevent/mitigate pollution from these
sources. See Subsection C below for more specifics on the SWPPS pollution prevention report.
3. A spill prevention and cleanup report describing the procedures and BMPs for spill prevention and
including provisions for cleanup of spills should they occur. See Subsection D below for more
specifics on the SWPPS spill prevention and cleanup report.
A. ACTIVITY-SPECIFIC INFORMATION REQUIRED
At a minimum, the SWPPS plan shall address, if applicable, the following pollution-generating activities
typically associated with construction and include the information specified below for each activity. If
other pollution-generating activities associated with construction of the proposed project are identified, the
SWPPS plan must address those activities in a similar manner.
Storage and Handling of Liquids
1. Identify liquids that will be handled or stored onsite, including but not limited to petroleum products,
fuel, solvents, detergents, paint, pesticides, concrete admixtures, and form oils.
2. Specify types and sizes of containers of liquids that will be stored/handled onsite. Show locations on
the SWPPS site plan.
3. Describe secondary containment methods adequately sized to provide containment for all liquids
stored onsite. Show the locations of containment areas on the SWPPS site plan.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-114
Storage and Stockpiling of Construction Materials and Wastes
1. Identify construction materials and wastes that may be generated or stockpiled onsite. Show the
locations where these materials and wastes will be generated and stockpiled on the SWPPS site plan.
2. Specify type of cover measures to be used to keep rainwater from contacting construction materials
and wastes that can contribute pollutants to storm, surface, and ground water.
3. If wastes are kept in containers, describe how rainwater will be kept out of the containers.
Fueling
1. Specify method of onsite fueling for construction equipment (i.e., stationary tanks, truck mounted
tanks, wet hosing, etc.). If stationary tanks will be used, show their location on the SWPPS site plan.
2. Describe type and size of tanks.
3. Describe containment methods for fuel spills and make reference to the SWPPS site plan for
location information.
4. If fueling occurs during evening hours, describe lighting and signage plan. Make reference to the
SWPPS site plan for location information.
Maintenance, Repairs, and Storage of Vehicles and Equipment
1. Identify maintenance and repair areas and show their locations on the SWPPS site plan. Use of drip
pans or plastic beneath vehicles is required. A note to this effect must be shown on the SWPPS site
plan.
2. Describe method for collection, storage, and disposal of vehicle fluids.
3. If an area is designated for vehicle maintenance, signs must be posted that state no vehicle washing
may occur in the area. A note to this effect must be shown on the SWPPS site plan.
Concrete Saw Cutting, Slurry, and Washwater Disposal
1. Identify truck washout areas to ensure such areas are not within an Aquifer Protection Area. If they
are, the washout area must be lined with an impervious membrane. Show location information on the
SWPPS site plan.
2. Specify size of sumps needed to collect and contain slurry and washwater. Show location information
on the SWPPS site plan.
3. Identify areas for rinsing hand tools including but not limited to screeds, shovels, rakes, floats and
trowels. Show the locations of these areas on the SWPPS site plan.
4. Describe methods for collecting, treating, and disposal of waste water from exposed aggregate
processes, concrete grinding and saw cutting, and new concrete washing and curing water. Do not use
upland land applications for discharging wastewater from concrete washout areas.
Handling of pH Elevated Water
New concrete vaults/structures may cause collected water to have an elevated pH. This water cannot be
discharged to storm or surface water until neutralized.
1. Provide details on treating/neutralizing water when pH is not within neutral parameters.
2. Provide details on disposal of water with elevated pH or of the treated water.
3. If approvals from other agencies for treatment and/or disposal methods (e.g., discharge to
sanitary sewer, Ecology-approved chemical treatments) have been obtained, indicate such approvals
on the plan.
D.2.5 CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION PLANS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-115
Application of Chemicals Including Pesticides and Fertilizers
1. Provide a list of chemicals that may be used on the project site and the application rates.
2. Describe where and how chemicals will be applied. Show location information on the SWPPS site
plan.
3. Describe where and how chemicals will be stored. Show location information on the SWPPS site
plan.
B. SWPPS SITE PLAN
The site plan element of the SWPPS plan shall include all of the information required for the base map
(see SWDM Table 2.3.1.A), as well as existing and proposed roads, driveways, parking areas, buildings,
drainage facilities, utility corridors not associated with roadways, relevant critical areas15 and associated
buffers, and proposed final topography. A smaller scale may be used to provide more comprehensive
details on specific locations of each activity and specific prevention measure. In addition to this
information, the following items, at a minimum, shall be provided as applicable:
1. Include SWPPS measures for all on- and offsite utility and roadway construction included in the
permit.
2. Specify the construction sequence. The construction sequence shall be specifically written for the
proposed project. An example construction sequence is provided in Reference Section 7-B.
3. Append to the standard ESC plan notes any site specific SWPPS notes (see ESC Plans General
Specifications above) and specify the construction sequence, including offsite roadway/utility
construction and periods of concentrated construction of concrete structures (e.g., detention vaults).
Standard ESC and SWPPS Notes are provided in the Reference Section 7-B.
4. Identify locations where liquids will be stored and delineate secondary containment areas that will be
provided. (Secondary containment means placing tanks or containers within an impervious structure
capable of containing 110% of the volume contained in the largest tank within the containment
structure. Double-walled tanks do not require additional secondary containment.)
5. Identify locations where construction materials and wastes will be generated and stockpiled.
6. Identify location of fueling for vehicles and equipment if stationary tanks will be used.
7. Delineate containment areas for fuel spills.
8. Show location of lighting and signage for fueling during evening hours.
9. Delineate maintenance and repair areas and clearly note that drip pans or plastic shall be used
beneath vehicles. Also, clearly note that signs must be posted that state no vehicle washing may occur
in the area.
10. Delineate truck washout areas and identify the location of slurry/washwater sumps and rinsing
areas for tools. To ensure the wheel wash/tire bath from the ESC plan and the concrete washout areas
are at separate locations, show the location of the wheel wash or tire bath per the ESC plan. (ESC
wheel wash or tire bath wastewater shall not include wastewater from concrete washout areas.)
11. Delineate where chemicals will be applied and identify where they will be stored.
12. Identify where spill response materials will be stored.
13. Indicate whether written approval from Ecology has been obtained for the use of chemical treatment
other than CO2 or dry ice to adjust pH, and provide necessary details and conditions.
15 Relevant critical areas, for the purposes of drainage review, include aquatic areas, wetlands, flood hazard areas, erosion
hazard areas, landslide hazard drainage areas, and steep slope hazard areas.
SECTION D.2 GENERAL CSWPP REQUIREMENTS
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-116
C. POLLUTION PREVENTION REPORT
This report provides the specifics on pollution prevention and must include the following information in
addition to the activity-specific information specified in Subsection A above:
1. List the possible sources of pollution per Subsection A above and identify the BMPs to be used for
each source to prevent pollution. Include any supporting information (site conditions, calculations,
etc.) for the selection and sizing of pollution prevention BMPs.
2. Identify the personnel responsible for pollution prevention and clearly list the responsibilities of each
person identified. Contact information for these personnel must be clearly identified in the report and
on the SWPPS site plan.
3. Describe the procedures to be used for monitoring pollution prevention BMPs and for responding to a
BMP that needs attention, including keeping records/reports of all inspections of pollution prevent
BMPs (see Reference Section 4.3 in this appendix) for examples of worksheets that may be used).
D. SPILL PREVENTION AND CLEANUP REPORT
This report provides the specifics on spill prevention and cleanup and must include the following
information in addition to any activity-specific information in Subsection A above related to spill
prevention:
1. List the possible sources of a spill and identify the BMPs to be used for each source to prevent a spill.
2. Identify personnel responsible for spill prevention and cleanup and clearly list the responsibilities of
each person identified. Contact information for these personnel must be clearly identified in the
report and on the SWPPS site plan.
3. Describe the procedures to be used for monitoring spill prevention BMPs and for responding to a
spill incident, including keeping records/reports of all inspections and spills (see Reference Section
4.3 in this appendix for examples of worksheets that may be used).
4. Identify where spill response materials will be stored. Make reference to the SWPPS site plan for
location information.
5. Identify disposal methods for contaminated water and soil after a spill.
Appendix C
Site Inspection Form
SECTION D.4 REFERENCE SECTION
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-130
D.4.3 ESC AND SWPPS MAINTENANCE REPORTS
CED may require a written record of all maintenance activities to be kept to demonstrate compliance with
the Maintenance Requirements (Section D.2.4.4). A standard ESC Maintenance Report is provided on the
next page and typical SWPPS Maintenance Reports follow. Copies of the ESC and SWPPS Maintenance
Reports must be kept on site throughout the duration of construction.
E S C M A I N T E N A N C E R E P O R T
Performed By: ___________________________
Date: ___________________________
Project Name: ___________________________
CED Permit #: ___________________________
Clearing Limits
Damage OK Problem
Visible OK Problem
Intrusions OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Mulch
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Thickness OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Nets/Blankets
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Ground Contact OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Plastic
Tears/Gaps OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Seeding
Percent Cover OK Problem
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Mulch OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Sodding
Grass Health OK Problem
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Perimeter Protection Including Silt Fence
Damage OK Problem
Sediment Build-up OK Problem
Concentrated Flow OK Problem
Other OK Problem
BMP/Facility Protection
Damage OK Problem
Sedimentation OK Problem
Concentrated Flow OK Problem
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Intrusions OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Brush Barrier
Damage OK Problem
Sediment Build-up OK Problem
Concentrated Flow OK Problem
Other OK Problem
D.4.3 ESC AND SWPPS MAINTENANCE REPORTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-131
Vegetated Strip
Damage OK Problem
Sediment Build-up OK Problem
Concentrated Flow OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Construction Entrance
Dimensions OK Problem
Sediment Tracking OK Problem
Vehicle Avoidance OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Wheel Wash
Dimensions OK Problem
Sed buildup or tracking OK . Problem
Other OK Problem
Construction Road
Stable Driving Surf. OK Problem
Vehicle Avoidance OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Sediment Trap/Pond
Sed. Accumulation OK Problem
Overtopping OK Problem
Inlet/Outlet Erosion OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Catch Basin/Inlet Protection
Sed. Accumulation OK Problem
Damage OK Problem
Clogged Filter OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Interceptor Dike/Swale
Damage OK Problem
Sed. Accumulation OK Problem
Overtopping OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Pipe Slope Drain
Damage OK Problem
Inlet/Outlet OK Problem
Secure Fittings OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Ditches
Damage OK Problem
Sed. Accumulation OK Problem
Overtopping OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Outlet Protection
Scour OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Level Spreader
Damage OK Problem
Concentrated Flow OK Problem
Rills/Gullies OK Problem
Sed. Accumulation OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Dewatering Controls
Sediment OK Problem
Dust Control
Palliative applied OK Problem
SECTION D.4 REFERENCE SECTION
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-132
Miscellaneous
Wet Season Stockpile OK Problem
Other OK Problem
Comments:
Actions Taken:
Problems Unresolved:
D.4.3 ESC AND SWPPS MAINTENANCE REPORTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-133
Pollution Prevention Team
Completed by: ______________________
Title: ______________________________
Date: ______________________________
Responsible Official: Title: ___________________________
Team Leader: Office Phone:____________________
Cell Phone #: ____________________
Responsibilities:
_______________________________
_______________________________
_______________________________
(1) Title:____________________________
Office Phone: ____________________
Cell Phone #: ____________________
Responsibilities:
_______________________________
_______________________________
_______________________________
(2) Title:____________________________
Office Phone: ____________________
Cell Phone #: ____________________
Responsibilities:
_______________________________
_______________________________
_______________________________
D.4 REFERENCE SECTION
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-134
Employee Training
Completed by:______________________________________
Title:______________________________________________
Date: ______________________________________________
Describe the annual training of employees on the SWPPP, addressing spill response, good housekeeping, and material management practices.
Training Topics
1.) LINE WORKERS
Brief Description of Training Program/Materials
(e.g., film, newsletter course)
Schedule for Training
(list dates)
Attendees
Spill Prevention and
Response
Good Housekeeping
Material Management
Practices
2.) P2 TEAM:
SWPPP Implementation
Monitoring Procedures
D.4.3 ESC AND SWPPS MAINTENANCE REPORTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-135
List of Significant Spills and Leaks
Completed by:
Title:
Date:
List all spills and leaks of toxic or hazardous pollutants that were significant but are not limited to, release of oil or hazardous substances in excess of
reportable quantities. Although not required, we suggest you list spills and leaks of non-hazardous materials.
Description Response Procedure
Date
(month/day/
year)
Location
(as
indicated
on site
map)
Type of
Material
Quantity Source,
If Known
Reason for
Spill/Leak
Amount of
Material
Recovered
Material No
longer
exposed to
Stormwater
(Yes/No)
Preventive Measure Taken
D.4 REFERENCE SECTION
6/22/2022 2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual
D-136
Potential Pollutant Source Identification
Completed by:
Title:
Date:
List all potential stormwater pollutants from materials handled, treated, or stored onsite.
Potential Stormwater Pollutant
Stormwater Pollutant Source
Likelihood of pollutant being present in your
stormwater discharge. If yes, explain
D.4.3 ESC AND SWPPS MAINTENANCE REPORTS
2022 City of Renton Surface Water Design Manual 6/22/2022
D-137
Material Inventory
Completed by:
Title:
Date:
List materials handled, treated, stored, or disposed of at the project site that may potentially be exposed to precipitation or runoff.
Material Purpose/Location
Quantity (Units)
Likelihood of contact with stormwater Past Spill or
Used Produced Stored If Yes, describe reason Leak
(indicate per week or year) Yes No
Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form
Page 1
Project Name Permit # Inspection Date Time
Name of Certified Erosion Sediment Control Lead (CESCL) or qualified inspector if less than one acre
Print Name:
Approximate rainfall amount since the last inspection (in inches):
Approximate rainfall amount in the last 24 hours (in inches):
Current Weather Clear Cloudy Mist Rain Wind Fog
A. Type of inspection: Weekly Post Storm Event Other
B. Phase of Active Construction (check all that apply):
Pre Construction/installation of erosion/sediment
controls
Clearing/Demo/Grading Infrastructure/storm/roads
Concrete pours Vertical
Construction/buildings
Utilities
Offsite improvements Site temporary stabilized Final stabilization
C. Questions:
1. Were all areas of construction and discharge points inspected? Yes No
2. Did you observe the presence of suspended sediment, turbidity, discoloration, or oil sheen Yes No
3. Was a water quality sample taken during inspection? (refer to permit conditions S4 & S5) Yes No
4. Was there a turbid discharge 250 NTU or greater, or Transparency 6 cm or less?* Yes No
5. If yes to #4 was it reported to Ecology? Yes No
6. Is pH sampling required? pH range required is 6.5 to 8.5. Yes No
If answering yes to a discharge, describe the event. Include when, where, and why it happened; what action was taken,
and when.
*If answering yes to # 4 record NTU/Transparency with continual sampling daily until turbidity is 25 NTU or less/ transparency is 33
cm or greater.
Sampling Results: Date:
Parameter Method (circle one) Result Other/Note
NTU cm pH
Turbidity tube, meter, laboratory
pH Paper, kit, meter
Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form
Page 2
D. Check the observed status of all items. Provide “Action Required “details and dates.
Element # Inspection BMPs
Inspected
BMP needs
maintenance
BMP
failed
Action
required
(describe in
section F)
yes no n/a
1
Clearing
Limits
Before beginning land disturbing
activities are all clearing limits,
natural resource areas (streams,
wetlands, buffers, trees) protected
with barriers or similar BMPs? (high
visibility recommended)
2
Construction
Access
Construction access is stabilized
with quarry spalls or equivalent
BMP to prevent sediment from
being tracked onto roads?
Sediment tracked onto the road
way was cleaned thoroughly at the
end of the day or more frequent as
necessary.
3
Control Flow
Rates
Are flow control measures installed
to control stormwater volumes and
velocity during construction and do
they protect downstream
properties and waterways from
erosion?
If permanent infiltration ponds are
used for flow control during
construction, are they protected
from siltation?
4
Sediment
Controls
All perimeter sediment controls
(e.g. silt fence, wattles, compost
socks, berms, etc.) installed, and
maintained in accordance with the
Stormwater Pollution Prevention
Plan (SWPPP).
Sediment control BMPs (sediment
ponds, traps, filters etc.) have been
constructed and functional as the
first step of grading.
Stormwater runoff from disturbed
areas is directed to sediment
removal BMP.
5
Stabilize
Soils
Have exposed un-worked soils
been stabilized with effective BMP
to prevent erosion and sediment
deposition?
Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form
Page 3
Element # Inspection BMPs
Inspected
BMP needs
maintenance
BMP
failed
Action
required
(describe in
section F)
yes no n/a
5
Stabilize Soils
Cont.
Are stockpiles stabilized from erosion,
protected with sediment trapping
measures and located away from drain
inlet, waterways, and drainage
channels?
Have soils been stabilized at the end of
the shift, before a holiday or weekend
if needed based on the weather
forecast?
6
Protect
Slopes
Has stormwater and ground water
been diverted away from slopes and
disturbed areas with interceptor dikes,
pipes and or swales?
Is off-site storm water managed
separately from stormwater generated
on the site?
Is excavated material placed on uphill
side of trenches consistent with safety
and space considerations?
Have check dams been placed at
regular intervals within constructed
channels that are cut down a slope?
7
Drain Inlets
Storm drain inlets made operable
during construction are protected.
Are existing storm drains within the
influence of the project protected?
8
Stabilize
Channel and
Outlets
Have all on-site conveyance channels
been designed, constructed and
stabilized to prevent erosion from
expected peak flows?
Is stabilization, including armoring
material, adequate to prevent erosion
of outlets, adjacent stream banks,
slopes and downstream conveyance
systems?
9
Control
Pollutants
Are waste materials and demolition
debris handled and disposed of to
prevent contamination of stormwater?
Has cover been provided for all
chemicals, liquid products, petroleum
products, and other material?
Has secondary containment been
provided capable of containing 110%
of the volume?
Were contaminated surfaces cleaned
immediately after a spill incident?
Were BMPs used to prevent
contamination of stormwater by a pH
modifying sources?
Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form
Page 4
Element # Inspection BMPs
Inspected
BMP needs
maintenance
BMP
failed
Action
required
(describe in
section F)
yes no n/a
9
Cont.
Wheel wash wastewater is handled
and disposed of properly.
10
Control
Dewatering
Concrete washout in designated areas.
No washout or excess concrete on the
ground.
Dewatering has been done to an
approved source and in compliance
with the SWPPP.
Were there any clean non turbid
dewatering discharges?
11
Maintain
BMP
Are all temporary and permanent
erosion and sediment control BMPs
maintained to perform as intended?
12
Manage the
Project
Has the project been phased to the
maximum degree practicable?
Has regular inspection, monitoring and
maintenance been performed as
required by the permit?
Has the SWPPP been updated,
implemented and records maintained?
13
Protect LID
Is all Bioretention and Rain Garden
Facilities protected from
sedimentation with appropriate BMPs?
Is the Bioretention and Rain Garden
protected against over compaction of
construction equipment and foot
traffic to retain its infiltration
capabilities?
Permeable pavements are clean and
free of sediment and sediment laden-
water runoff. Muddy construction
equipment has not been on the base
material or pavement.
Have soiled permeable pavements
been cleaned of sediments and pass
infiltration test as required by
stormwater manual methodology?
Heavy equipment has been kept off
existing soils under LID facilities to
retain infiltration rate.
E. Check all areas that have been inspected.
All in place BMPs All disturbed soils All concrete wash out area All material storage areas
All discharge locations All equipment storage areas All construction entrances/exits
Construction Stormwater Site Inspection Form
Page 5
F. Elements checked “Action Required” (section D) describe corrective action to be taken. List the element number;
be specific on location and work needed. Document, initial, and date when the corrective action has been completed
and inspected.
Element
#
Description and Location Action Required Completion
Date
Initials
Attach additional page if needed
Sign the following certification:
“I certify that this report is true, accurate, and complete, to the best of my knowledge and belief”
Inspected by: (print) (Signature) Date:
Title/Qualification of Inspector:
Appendix D
Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP)
Issuance Date: November 18, 2020
Effective Date: January 1, 2021
Expiration Date: December 31, 2025
CONSTRUCTION STORMWATER
GENERAL PERMIT
National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) and State Waste Discharge
General Permit for Stormwater Discharges Associated with Construction Activity
State of Washington
Department of Ecology
Olympia, Washington 98504
In compliance with the provisions of Chapter 90.48 Revised Code of Washington (State of Washington Water Pollution Control Act) and Title 33 United States Code, Section 1251 et seq. The Federal Water Pollution Control Act (The Clean Water Act)
Until this permit expires, is modified, or revoked, Permittees that have properly obtained coverage under this general permit are authorized to discharge in accordance with the special and general conditions that follow.
__________________________________ Vincent McGowan, P.E. Water Quality Program Manager Washington State Department of Ecology
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page i
TABLE OF CONTENTS
LIST OF TABLES .................................................................................................................................. ii
SUMMARY OF PERMIT REPORT SUBMITTALS ...................................................................................... 1
SPECIAL CONDITIONS ......................................................................................................................... 3
S1. Permit Coverage .............................................................................................................................. 3
S2. Application Requirements ............................................................................................................... 7
S3. Compliance with Standards ............................................................................................................. 9
S4. Monitoring Requirements, Benchmarks, and Reporting Triggers ................................................. 10
S5. Reporting and Recordkeeping Requirements ................................................................................ 17
S6. Permit Fees .................................................................................................................................... 20
S7. Solid and Liquid Waste Disposal .................................................................................................... 20
S8. Discharges to 303(D) or TMDL Waterbodies ................................................................................. 20
S9. Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan .......................................................................................... 23
S10. Notice Of Termination ................................................................................................................... 32
GENERAL CONDITIONS ..................................................................................................................... 34
G1. Discharge Violations....................................................................................................................... 34
G2. Signatory Requirements ................................................................................................................ 34
G3. Right of Inspection and Entry ......................................................................................................... 35
G4. General Permit Modification and Revocation ............................................................................... 35
G5. Revocation of Coverage Under tPermit ......................................................................................... 35
G6. Reporting a Cause for Modification ............................................................................................... 36
G7. Compliance with Other Laws and Statutes .................................................................................... 36
G8. Duty to Reapply.............................................................................................................................. 36
G9. Removed Substance ....................................................................................................................... 36
G10. Duty to Provide Information .......................................................................................................... 36
G11. Other Requirements of 40 CFR ...................................................................................................... 37
G12. Additional Monitoring .................................................................................................................... 37
G13. Penalties for Violating Permit Conditions ...................................................................................... 37
G14. Upset .............................................................................................................................................. 37
G15. Property Rights .............................................................................................................................. 37
G16. Duty to Comply .............................................................................................................................. 37
G17. Toxic Pollutants .............................................................................................................................. 38
G18. Penalties for Tampering ................................................................................................................. 38
G19. Reporting Planned Changes ........................................................................................................... 38
G20. Reporting Other Information ......................................................................................................... 38
G21. Reporting Anticipated Non-Compliance ........................................................................................ 38
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page ii
G22. Requests to Be Excluded From Coverage Under the Permit ......................................................... 39
G23. Appeals........................................................................................................................................... 39
G24. Severability..................................................................................................................................... 39
G25. Bypass Prohibited .......................................................................................................................... 39
APPENDIX A – DEFINITIONS .............................................................................................................. 42
APPENDIX B – ACRONYMS ................................................................................................................ 50
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1 Summary of Required Submittals ................................................................................................ 1
Table 2 Summary of Required On-site Documentation ........................................................................... 2
Table 3 Summary of Primary Monitoring Requirements ....................................................................... 12
Table 4 Monitoring and Reporting Requirements ................................................................................. 14
Table 5 Turbidity, Fine Sediment & Phosphorus Sampling and Limits for
303(d)-Listed Waters ................................................................................................................ 22
Table 6 pH Sampling and Limits for 303(d)-Listed Waters ..................................................................... 22
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 1
SUMMARY OF PERMIT REPORT SUBMITTALS
Refer to the Special and General Conditions within this permit for additional submittal requirements.
Appendix A provides a list of definitions. Appendix B provides a list of acronyms.
Table 1 Summary of Required Submittals
Permit
Section
Submittal Frequency First Submittal Date
S5.A and
S8
High Turbidity/Transparency Phone
Reporting
As Necessary Within 24 hours
S5.B Discharge Monitoring Report Monthly* Within 15 days following the
end of each month
S5.F and
S8
Noncompliance Notification –
Telephone Notification
As necessary Within 24 hours
S5.F Noncompliance Notification – Written
Report
As necessary Within 5 Days of
non-compliance
S9.D Request for Chemical Treatment Form As necessary Written approval from
Ecology is required prior to
using chemical treatment
(with the exception of dry ice,
CO2 or food grade vinegar to
adjust pH)
G2 Notice of Change in Authorization As necessary
G6 Permit Application for Substantive
Changes to the Discharge
As necessary
G8 Application for Permit Renewal 1/permit cycle No later than 180 days
before expiration
S2.A Notice of Permit Transfer As necessary
G19 Notice of Planned Changes As necessary
G21 Reporting Anticipated Non-compliance As necessary
NOTE: *Permittees must submit electronic Discharge Monitoring Reports (DMRs) to the Washington State
Department of Ecology monthly, regardless of site discharge, for the full duration of permit coverage. Refer
to Section S5.B of this General Permit for more specific information regarding DMRs.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 2
Table 2 Summary of Required On-site Documentation
Document Title
Permit Conditions
Permit Coverage Letter See Conditions S2, S5
Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP) See Conditions S2, S5
Site Log Book See Conditions S4, S5
Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) See Conditions S5, S9
Site Map See Conditions S5, S9
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 3
SPECIAL CONDITIONS
S1. PERMIT COVERAGE
A. Permit Area
This Construction Stormwater General Permit (CSWGP) covers all areas of Washington State,
except for federal operators and Indian Country as specified in Special Condition S1.E.3 and 4.
B. Operators Required to Seek Coverage Under this General Permit
1. Operators of the following construction activities are required to seek coverage under
this CSWGP:
a. Clearing, grading and/or excavation that results in the disturbance of one or more
acres (including off-site disturbance acreage related to construction-support activity
as authorized in S1.C.2) and discharges stormwater to surface waters of the State;
and clearing, grading and/or excavation on sites smaller than one acre that are part
of a larger common plan of development or sale, if the common plan of
development or sale will ultimately disturb one acre or more and discharge
stormwater to surface waters of the State.
i. This category includes forest practices (including, but not limited to, class IV
conversions) that are part of a construction activity that will result in the
disturbance of one or more acres, and discharge to surface waters of the State
(that is, forest practices that prepare a site for construction activities); and
b. Any size construction activity discharging stormwater to waters of the State that the
Washington State Department of Ecology (Ecology):
i. Determines to be a significant contributor of pollutants to waters of the State
of Washington.
ii. Reasonably expects to cause a violation of any water quality standard.
2. Operators of the following activities are not required to seek coverage under this CSWGP
(unless specifically required under Special Condition S1.B.1.b, above):
a. Construction activities that discharge all stormwater and non-stormwater to
groundwater, sanitary sewer, or combined sewer, and have no point source
discharge to either surface water or a storm sewer system that drains to surface
waters of the State.
b. Construction activities covered under an Erosivity Waiver (Special Condition S1.F).
c. Routine maintenance that is performed to maintain the original line and grade,
hydraulic capacity, or original purpose of a facility.
C. Authorized Discharges
1. Stormwater Associated with Construction Activity. Subject to compliance with the terms
and conditions of this permit, Permittees are authorized to discharge stormwater
associated with construction activity to surface waters of the State or to a storm sewer
system that drains to surface waters of the State. (Note that “surface waters of the
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 4
State” may exist on a construction site as well as off site; for example, a creek running
through a site.)
2. Stormwater Associated with Construction Support Activity. This permit also authorizes
stormwater discharge from support activities related to the permitted construction site
(for example, an on-site portable rock crusher, off-site equipment staging yards, material
storage areas, borrow areas, etc.) provided:
a. The support activity relates directly to the permitted construction site that is
required to have an NPDES permit; and
b. The support activity is not a commercial operation serving multiple unrelated
construction projects, and does not operate beyond the completion of the
construction activity; and
c. Appropriate controls and measures are identified in the Stormwater Pollution
Prevention Plan (SWPPP) for the discharges from the support activity areas.
3. Non-Stormwater Discharges. The categories and sources of non-stormwater discharges
identified below are authorized conditionally, provided the discharge is consistent with
the terms and conditions of this permit:
a. Discharges from fire-fighting activities.
b. Fire hydrant system flushing.
c. Potable water, including uncontaminated water line flushing.
d. Hydrostatic test water.
e. Uncontaminated air conditioning or compressor condensate.
f. Uncontaminated groundwater or spring water.
g. Uncontaminated excavation dewatering water (in accordance with S9.D.10).
h. Uncontaminated discharges from foundation or footing drains.
i. Uncontaminated or potable water used to control dust. Permittees must minimize
the amount of dust control water used.
j. Routine external building wash down that does not use detergents.
k. Landscape irrigation water.
The SWPPP must adequately address all authorized non-stormwater discharges, except for
discharges from fire-fighting activities, and must comply with Special Condition S3. At a
minimum, discharges from potable water (including water line flushing), fire hydrant system
flushing, and pipeline hydrostatic test water must undergo the following: dechlorination to a
concentration of 0.1 parts per million (ppm) or less, and pH adjustment to within 6.5 – 8.5
standard units (su), if necessary.
D. Prohibited Discharges
The following discharges to waters of the State, including groundwater, are prohibited:
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 5
1. Concrete wastewater
2. Wastewater from washout and clean-up of stucco, paint, form release oils, curing
compounds and other construction materials.
3. Process wastewater as defined by 40 Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) 122.2 (See
Appendix A of this permit).
4. Slurry materials and waste from shaft drilling, including process wastewater from shaft
drilling for construction of building, road, and bridge foundations unless managed
according to Special Condition S9.D.9.j.
5. Fuels, oils, or other pollutants used in vehicle and equipment operation and
maintenance.
6. Soaps or solvents used in vehicle and equipment washing.
7. Wheel wash wastewater, unless managed according to Special Condition S9.D.9.
8. Discharges from dewatering activities, including discharges from dewatering of trenches
and excavations, unless managed according to Special Condition S9.D.10.
E. Limits on Coverage
Ecology may require any discharger to apply for and obtain coverage under an individual permit
or another more specific general permit. Such alternative coverage will be required when
Ecology determines that this CSWGP does not provide adequate assurance that water quality
will be protected, or there is a reasonable potential for the project to cause or contribute to a
violation of water quality standards.
The following stormwater discharges are not covered by this permit:
1. Post-construction stormwater discharges that originate from the site after completion of
construction activities and the site has undergone final stabilization.
2. Non-point source silvicultural activities such as nursery operations, site preparation,
reforestation and subsequent cultural treatment, thinning, prescribed burning, pest and
fire control, harvesting operations, surface drainage, or road construction and
maintenance, from which there is natural runoff as excluded in 40 CFR Subpart 122.
3. Stormwater from any federal operator.
4. Stormwater from facilities located on Indian Country as defined in 18 U.S.C.§1151,
except portions of the Puyallup Reservation as noted below.
Indian Country includes:
a. All land within any Indian Reservation notwithstanding the issuance of any patent,
and, including rights-of-way running through the reservation. This includes all
federal, tribal, and Indian and non-Indian privately owned land within the
reservation.
b. All off-reservation Indian allotments, the Indian titles to which have not been
extinguished, including rights-of-way running through the same.
c. All off-reservation federal trust lands held for Native American Tribes.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 6
Puyallup Exception: Following the Puyallup Tribes of Indians Land Settlement Act of
1989, 25 U.S.C. §1773; the permit does apply to land within the Puyallup
Reservation except for discharges to surface water on land held in trust by the
federal government.
5. Stormwater from any site covered under an existing NPDES individual permit in which
stormwater management and/or treatment requirements are included for all stormwater
discharges associated with construction activity.
6. Stormwater from a site where an applicable Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL)
requirement specifically precludes or prohibits discharges from construction activity.
F. Erosivity Waiver
Construction site operators may qualify for an Erosivity Waiver from the CSWGP if the following
conditions are met:
1. The site will result in the disturbance of fewer than five (5) acres and the site is not a
portion of a common plan of development or sale that will disturb five (5) acres or
greater.
2. Calculation of Erosivity “R” Factor and Regional Timeframe:
a. The project’s calculated rainfall erosivity factor (“R” Factor) must be less than five
(5) during the period of construction activity, (See the CSWGP homepage
http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/construction/index.html for a
link to the EPA’s calculator and step by step instructions on computing the “R”
Factor in the EPA Erosivity Waiver Fact Sheet). The period of construction activity
starts when the land is first disturbed and ends with final stabilization. In addition:
b. The entire period of construction activity must fall within the following timeframes:
i. For sites west of the Cascades Crest: June 15 – September 15.
ii. For sites east of the Cascades Crest, excluding the Central Basin:
June 15 – October 15.
iii. For sites east of the Cascades Crest, within the Central Basin: no timeframe
restrictions apply. The Central Basin is defined as the portions of Eastern
Washington with mean annual precipitation of less than 12 inches. For a map of
the Central Basin (Average Annual Precipitation Region 2), refer to:
http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/construction/resourcesguida
nce.html.
3. Construction site operators must submit a complete Erosivity Waiver certification form at
least one week before disturbing the land. Certification must include statements that the
operator will:
a. Comply with applicable local stormwater requirements; and
b. Implement appropriate erosion and sediment control BMPs to prevent violations of
water quality standards.
4. This waiver is not available for facilities declared significant contributors of pollutants as
defined in Special Condition S1.B.1.b or for any size construction activity that could
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 7
reasonably expect to cause a violation of any water quality standard as defined in Special
Condition S1.B.1.b.ii.
5. This waiver does not apply to construction activities which include non-stormwater
discharges listed in Special Condition S1.C.3.
6. If construction activity extends beyond the certified waiver period for any reason, the
operator must either:
a. Recalculate the rainfall erosivity “R” factor using the original start date and a new
projected ending date and, if the “R” factor is still under 5 and the entire project
falls within the applicable regional timeframe in Special Condition S1.F.2.b,
complete and submit an amended waiver certification form before the original
waiver expires; or
b. Submit a complete permit application to Ecology in accordance with Special
Condition S2.A and B before the end of the certified waiver period.
S2. APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS
A. Permit Application Forms
1. Notice of Intent Form
a. Operators of new or previously unpermitted construction activities must submit a
complete and accurate permit application (Notice of Intent, or NOI) to Ecology.
b. Operators must apply using the electronic application form (NOI) available on Ecology’s
website (http://ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/construction/index.html).
Permittees unable to submit electronically (for example, those who do not have an
internet connection) must contact Ecology to request a waiver and obtain instructions
on how to obtain a paper NOI.
Department of Ecology
Water Quality Program - Construction Stormwater
PO Box 47696
Olympia, Washington 98504-7696
c. The operator must submit the NOI at least 60 days before discharging stormwater
from construction activities and must submit it prior to the date of the first public
notice (See Special Condition S2.B, below, for details). The 30-day public comment
period begins on the publication date of the second public notice. Unless Ecology
responds to the complete application in writing, coverage under the general permit
will automatically commence on the 31st day following receipt by Ecology of a
completed NOI, or the issuance date of this permit, whichever is later; unless Ecology
specifies a later date in writing as required by WAC173-226-200(2). See S8.B for
Limits on Coverage for New Discharges to TMDL or 303(d)-Listed Waters.
d. If an applicant intends to use a Best Management Practice (BMP) selected on the
basis of Special Condition S9.C.4 (“demonstrably equivalent” BMPs), the applicant
must notify Ecology of its selection as part of the NOI. In the event the applicant
selects BMPs after submission of the NOI, the applicant must provide notice of the
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 8
selection of an equivalent BMP to Ecology at least 60 days before intended use of
the equivalent BMP.
e. Applicants must notify Ecology if they are aware of contaminated soils and/or
groundwater associated with the construction activity. Provide detailed information
with the NOI (as known and readily available) on the nature and extent of the
contamination (concentrations, locations, and depth), as well as pollution
prevention and/or treatment BMPs proposed to control the discharge of soil and/or
groundwater contaminants in stormwater. Examples of such detail may include, but
are not limited to:
i. List or table of all known contaminants with laboratory test results showing
concentration and depth,
ii. Map with sample locations,
iii. Related portions of the Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) that
address the management of contaminated and potentially contaminated
construction stormwater and dewatering water,
iv. Dewatering plan and/or dewatering contingency plan.
2. Transfer of Coverage Form
The Permittee can transfer current coverage under this permit to one or more new
operators, including operators of sites within a Common Plan of Development, provided:
i. The Permittee submits a complete Transfer of Coverage Form to Ecology,
signed by the current and new discharger and containing a specific date for
transfer of permit responsibility, coverage and liability (including any
Administrative Orders associated with the permit); and
ii. Ecology does not notify the current discharger and new discharger of intent to
revoke coverage under the general permit. If this notice is not given, the
transfer is effective on the date specified in the written agreement.
When a current discharger (Permittee) transfers a portion of a permitted site, the current
discharger must also indicate the remaining permitted acreage after the transfer.
Transfers do not require public notice.
3. Modification of Coverage Form
Permittees must notify Ecology regarding any changes to the information provided on
the NOI by submitting an Update/Modification of Permit Coverage form in accordance
with General Conditions G6 and G19. Examples of such changes include, but are not
limited to:
i. Changes to the Permittee’s mailing address,
ii. Changes to the on-site contact person information, and
iii. Changes to the area/acreage affected by construction activity.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 9
B. Public Notice
For new or previously unpermitted construction activities, the applicant must publish a public
notice at least one time each week for two consecutive weeks, at least 7 days apart, in a
newspaper with general circulation in the county where the construction is to take place. The
notice must be run after the NOI has been submitted and must contain:
1. A statement that “The applicant is seeking coverage under the Washington State
Department of Ecology’s Construction Stormwater NPDES and State Waste Discharge
General Permit.”
2. The name, address, and location of the construction site.
3. The name and address of the applicant.
4. The type of construction activity that will result in a discharge (for example, residential
construction, commercial construction, etc.), and the total number of acres to be
disturbed over the lifetime of the project.
5. The name of the receiving water(s) (that is, the surface water(s) to which the site will
discharge), or, if the discharge is through a storm sewer system, the name of the
operator of the system and the receiving water(s) the system discharges to.
6. The statement: Any persons desiring to present their views to the Washington State
Department of Ecology regarding this application, or interested in Ecology’s action on this
application, may notify Ecology in writing no later than 30 days of the last date of
publication of this notice. Ecology reviews public comments and considers whether
discharges from this project would cause a measurable change in receiving water quality,
and, if so, whether the project is necessary and in the overriding public interest according
to Tier II antidegradation requirements under WAC 173-201A-320. Comments can be
submitted to: Department of Ecology, PO Box 47696, Olympia, Washington 98504-7696
Attn: Water Quality Program, Construction Stormwater.
S3. COMPLIANCE WITH STANDARDS
A. Discharges must not cause or contribute to a violation of surface water quality standards
(Chapter 173-201A WAC), groundwater quality standards (Chapter 173-200 WAC),
sediment management standards (Chapter 173-204 WAC), and human health-based
criteria in the Federal water quality criteria applicable to Washington. (40 CFR Part 131.45)
Discharges that are not in compliance with these standards are prohibited.
B. Prior to the discharge of stormwater and non-stormwater to waters of the State, the
Permittee must apply All Known, Available, and Reasonable methods of prevention,
control, and Treatment (AKART). This includes the preparation and implementation of an
adequate SWPPP, with all appropriate BMPs installed and maintained in accordance with
the SWPPP and the terms and conditions of this permit.
C. Ecology presumes that a Permittee complies with water quality standards unless discharge
monitoring data or other site-specific information demonstrates that a discharge causes or
contributes to a violation of water quality standards, when the Permittee complies with the
following conditions. The Permittee must fully:
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 10
1. Comply with all permit conditions, including; planning, sampling, monitoring,
reporting, and recordkeeping conditions.
2. Implement stormwater BMPs contained in stormwater management manuals
published or approved by Ecology, or BMPs that are demonstrably equivalent to BMPs
contained in stormwater management manuals published or approved by Ecology,
including the proper selection, implementation, and maintenance of all applicable and
appropriate BMPs for on-site pollution control. (For purposes of this section, the
stormwater manuals listed in Appendix 10 of the Phase I Municipal Stormwater Permit
are approved by Ecology.)
D. Where construction sites also discharge to groundwater, the groundwater discharges must
also meet the terms and conditions of this CSWGP. Permittees who discharge to
groundwater through an injection well must also comply with any applicable requirements
of the Underground Injection Control (UIC) regulations, Chapter 173-218 WAC.
S4. MONITORING REQUIREMENTS, BENCHMARKS, AND
REPORTING TRIGGERS
A. Site Log Book
The Permittee must maintain a site log book that contains a record of the implementation of
the SWPPP and other permit requirements, including the installation and maintenance of
BMPs, site inspections, and stormwater monitoring.
B. Site Inspections
Construction sites one (1) acre or larger that discharge stormwater to surface waters of the
State must have site inspections conducted by a Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead
(CESCL). Sites less than one (1) acre may have a person without CESCL certification conduct
inspections. (See Special Conditions S4.B.3 and B.4, below, for detailed requirements of the
Permittee’s CESCL.)
Site inspections must include all areas disturbed by construction activities, all BMPs, and all
stormwater discharge points under the Permittee’s operational control.
1. The Permittee must have staff knowledgeable in the principles and practices of erosion
and sediment control. The CESCL (sites one acre or more) or inspector (sites less than one
acre) must have the skills to assess the:
a. Site conditions and construction activities that could impact the quality of
stormwater; and
b. Effectiveness of erosion and sediment control measures used to control the quality
of stormwater discharges. The SWPPP must identify the CESCL or inspector, who
must be present on site or on-call at all times. The CESCL (sites one (1) acre or more)
must obtain this certification through an approved erosion and sediment control
training program that meets the minimum training standards established by Ecology.
(See BMP C160 in the manual, referred to in Special Condition S9.C.1 and 2.)
2. The CESCL or inspector must examine stormwater visually for the presence of suspended
sediment, turbidity, discoloration, and oil sheen. BMP effectiveness must be evaluated to
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 11
determine if it is necessary to install, maintain, or repair BMPs to improve the quality of
stormwater discharges.
Based on the results of the inspection, the Permittee must correct the problems
identified, by:
a. Reviewing the SWPPP for compliance with Special Condition S9 and making
appropriate revisions within 7 days of the inspection.
b. Immediately beginning the process of fully implementing and maintaining
appropriate source control and/or treatment BMPs, within 10 days of the
inspection. If installation of necessary treatment BMPs is not feasible within 10
days, Ecology may approve additional time when an extension is requested by a
Permittee within the initial 10-day response period.
c. Documenting BMP implementation and maintenance in the site log book.
3. The CESCL or inspector must inspect all areas disturbed by construction activities, all
BMPs, and all stormwater discharge points at least once every calendar week and within
24 hours of any discharge from the site. (For purposes of this condition, individual
discharge events that last more than one (1) day do not require daily inspections. For
example, if a stormwater pond discharges continuously over the course of a week, only
one (1) inspection is required that week.) Inspection frequency may be reduced to once
every calendar month for inactive sites that are temporarily stabilized.
4. The Permittee must summarize the results of each inspection in an inspection report or
checklist and enter the report/checklist into, or attach it to, the site log book. At a
minimum, each inspection report or checklist must include:
a. Inspection date and time.
b. Weather information.
c. The general conditions during inspection.
d. The approximate amount of precipitation since the last inspection.
e. The approximate amount of precipitation within the last 24 hours.
f. A summary or list of all implemented BMPs, including observations of all
erosion/sediment control structures or practices.
g. A description of:
i. BMPs inspected (including location).
ii. BMPs that need maintenance and why.
iii. BMPs that failed to operate as designed or intended, and
iv. Where additional or different BMPs are needed, and why.
h. A description of stormwater discharged from the site. The Permittee must note the
presence of suspended sediment, turbidity, discoloration, and oil sheen, as
applicable.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 12
i. Any water quality monitoring performed during inspection.
j. General comments and notes, including a brief description of any BMP repairs,
maintenance, or installations made following the inspection.
k. An implementation schedule for the remedial actions that the Permittee plans to
take if the site inspection indicates that the site is out of compliance. The remedial
actions taken must meet the requirements of the SWPPP and the permit.
l. A summary report of the inspection.
m. The name, title, and signature of the person conducting the site inspection, a phone
number or other reliable method to reach this person, and the following statement:
I certify that this report is true, accurate, and complete to the best of my knowledge
and belief.
Table 3 Summary of Primary Monitoring Requirements
Size of Soil
Disturbance 1
Weekly Site
Inspections
Weekly
Sampling w/
Turbidity Meter
Weekly
Sampling w/
Transparency
Tube
Weekly pH
Sampling 2
CESCL
Required for
Inspections?
Sites that disturb less
than 1 acre, but are
part of a larger
Common Plan of
Development
Required Not Required Not Required Not Required No
Sites that disturb 1
acre or more, but
fewer than 5 acres
Required Sampling Required –
either method 3
Required Yes
Sites that disturb 5
acres or more
Required Required Not Required 4 Required Yes
1 Soil disturbance is calculated by adding together all areas that will be affected by construction activity.
Construction activity means clearing, grading, excavation, and any other activity that disturbs the surface of the
land, including ingress/egress from the site.
2 If construction activity results in the disturbance of 1 acre or more, and involves significant concrete work (1,000
cubic yards of concrete or recycled concrete placed or poured over the life of a project) or the use of engineered
soils (soil amendments including but not limited to Portland cement-treated base [CTB], cement kiln dust [CKD], or
fly ash), and stormwater from the affected area drains to surface waters of the State or to a storm sewer
stormwater collection system that drains to other surface waters of the State, the Permittee must conduct pH
sampling in accordance with Special Condition S4.D.
3 Sites with one or more acres, but fewer than 5 acres of soil disturbance, must conduct turbidity or transparency
sampling in accordance with Special Condition S4.C.4.a or b.
4 Sites equal to or greater than 5 acres of soil disturbance must conduct turbidity sampling using a turbidity meter
in accordance with Special Condition S4.C.4.a.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 13
C. Turbidity/Transparency Sampling Requirements
1. Sampling Methods
a. If construction activity involves the disturbance of five (5) acres or more, the
Permittee must conduct turbidity sampling per Special Condition S4.C.4.a, below.
b. If construction activity involves one (1) acre or more but fewer than five (5) acres of
soil disturbance, the Permittee must conduct either transparency sampling or
turbidity sampling per Special Condition S4.C.4.a or b, below.
2. Sampling Frequency
a. The Permittee must sample all discharge points at least once every calendar week
when stormwater (or authorized non-stormwater) discharges from the site or
enters any on-site surface waters of the state (for example, a creek running through
a site); sampling is not required on sites that disturb less than an acre.
b. Samples must be representative of the flow and characteristics of the discharge.
c. Sampling is not required when there is no discharge during a calendar week.
d. Sampling is not required outside of normal working hours or during unsafe
conditions.
e. If the Permittee is unable to sample during a monitoring period, the Permittee must
include a brief explanation in the monthly Discharge Monitoring Report (DMR).
f. Sampling is not required before construction activity begins.
g. The Permittee may reduce the sampling frequency for temporarily stabilized,
inactive sites to once every calendar month.
3. Sampling Locations
a. Sampling is required at all points where stormwater associated with construction
activity (or authorized non-stormwater) is discharged off site, including where it
enters any on-site surface waters of the state (for example, a creek running through
a site).
b. The Permittee may discontinue sampling at discharge points that drain areas of the
project that are fully stabilized to prevent erosion.
c. The Permittee must identify all sampling point(s) in the SWPPP and on the site map
and clearly mark these points in the field with a flag, tape, stake or other visible
marker.
d. Sampling is not required for discharge that is sent directly to sanitary or combined
sewer systems.
e. The Permittee may discontinue sampling at discharge points in areas of the project
where the Permittee no longer has operational control of the construction activity.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 14
4. Sampling and Analysis Methods
a. The Permittee performs turbidity analysis with a calibrated turbidity meter
(turbidimeter) either on site or at an accredited lab. The Permittee must record the
results in the site log book in nephelometric turbidity units (NTUs).
b. The Permittee performs transparency analysis on site with a 1¾ inch diameter, 60
centimeter (cm)-long transparency tube. The Permittee will record the results in the
site log book in centimeters (cm).
Table 4 Monitoring and Reporting Requirements
Parameter Unit Analytical Method Sampling
Frequency
Benchmark
Value
Turbidity NTU SM2130 Weekly, if
discharging 25 NTUs
Transparency Cm
Manufacturer
instructions, or
Ecology guidance
Weekly, if
discharging 33 cm
5. Turbidity/Transparency Benchmark Values and Reporting Triggers
The benchmark value for turbidity is 25 NTUs. The benchmark value for transparency is
33 centimeters (cm). Note: Benchmark values do not apply to discharges to segments of
water bodies on Washington State’s 303(d) list (Category 5) for turbidity, fine sediment,
or phosphorus; these discharges are subject to a numeric effluent limit for turbidity.
Refer to Special Condition S8 for more information and follow S5.F – Noncompliance
Notification for reporting requirements applicable to discharges which exceed the
numeric effluent limit for turbidity.
a. Turbidity 26 – 249 NTUs, or Transparency 32 – 7 cm:
If the discharge turbidity is 26 to 249 NTUs; or if discharge transparency is 32 to 7
cm, the Permittee must:
i. Immediately begin the process to fully implement and maintain appropriate
source control and/or treatment BMPs, and no later than 10 days of the date
the discharge exceeded the benchmark. If installation of necessary treatment
BMPs is not feasible within 10 days, Ecology may approve additional time when
the Permittee requests an extension within the initial 10-day response period.
ii. Review the SWPPP for compliance with Special Condition S9 and make
appropriate revisions within 7 days of the date the discharge exceeded the
benchmark.
iii. Document BMP implementation and maintenance in the site log book.
b. Turbidity 250 NTUs or greater, or Transparency 6 cm or less:
If a discharge point’s turbidity is 250 NTUs or greater, or if discharge transparency is
less than or equal to 6 cm, the Permittee must complete the reporting and adaptive
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 15
management process described below. For discharges which are subject to a
numeric effluent limit for turbidity, see S5.F – Noncompliance Notification.
i. Within 24 hours, telephone or submit an electronic report to the applicable
Ecology Region’s Environmental Report Tracking System (ERTS) number (or
through Ecology’s Water Quality Permitting Portal [WQWebPortal] – Permit
Submittals when the form is available), in accordance with Special Condition S5.A.
• Central Region (Okanogan, Chelan, Douglas, Kittitas, Yakima, Klickitat,
Benton): (509) 575-2490
• Eastern Region (Adams, Asotin, Columbia, Ferry, Franklin, Garfield,
Grant, Lincoln, Pend Oreille, Spokane, Stevens, Walla Walla, Whitman):
(509) 329-3400
• Northwest Region (Kitsap, Snohomish, Island, King, San Juan, Skagit,
Whatcom): (425) 649-7000
• Southwest Region (Grays Harbor, Lewis, Mason, Thurston, Pierce, Clark,
Cowlitz, Skamania, Wahkiakum, Clallam, Jefferson, Pacific): (360) 407-6300
These numbers and a link to the ERTS reporting page are also listed at the following
website: http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/construction/index.html.
ii. Immediately begin the process to fully implement and maintain appropriate
source control and/or treatment BMPs as soon as possible, addressing the
problems within 10 days of the date the discharge exceeded the benchmark. If
installation of necessary treatment BMPs is not feasible within 10 days, Ecology
may approve additional time when the Permittee requests an extension within
the initial 10-day response period.
iii. Sample discharges daily until:
a) Turbidity is 25 NTUs (or lower); or
b) Transparency is 33 cm (or greater); or
c) The Permittee has demonstrated compliance with the water quality
standard for turbidity:
1) No more than 5 NTUs over background turbidity, if background is less
than 50 NTUs, or
2) No more than 10% over background turbidity, if background is 50
NTUs or greater; or
*Note: background turbidity in the receiving water must be
measured immediately upstream (upgradient) or outside of the area
of influence of the discharge.
d) The discharge stops or is eliminated.
iv. Review the SWPPP for compliance with Special Condition S9 and make
appropriate revisions within seven (7) days of the date the discharge exceeded
the benchmark.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 16
v. Document BMP implementation and maintenance in the site log book.
Compliance with these requirements does not relieve the Permittee from responsibility to
maintain continuous compliance with permit benchmarks.
D. pH Sampling Requirements – Significant Concrete Work or Engineered Soils
If construction activity results in the disturbance of 1 acre or more, and involves significant
concrete work (significant concrete work means greater than 1000 cubic yards placed or
poured concrete or recycled concrete used over the life of a project) or the use of engineered
soils (soil amendments including but not limited to Portland cement-treated base [CTB],
cement kiln dust [CKD], or fly ash), and stormwater from the affected area drains to surface
waters of the State or to a storm sewer system that drains to surface waters of the State, the
Permittee must conduct pH sampling as set forth below. Note: In addition, discharges to
segments of water bodies on Washington State’s 303(d) list (Category 5) for high pH are subject
to a numeric effluent limit for pH; refer to Special Condition S8.
1. The Permittee must perform pH analysis on site with a calibrated pH meter, pH test kit,
or wide range pH indicator paper. The Permittee must record pH sampling results in the
site log book.
2. During the applicable pH monitoring period defined below, the Permittee must obtain a
representative sample of stormwater and conduct pH analysis at least once per week.
a. For sites with significant concrete work, the Permittee must begin the pH sampling
period when the concrete is first placed or poured and exposed to precipitation, and
continue weekly throughout and after the concrete placement, pour and curing
period, until stormwater pH is in the range of 6.5 to 8.5 (su).
b. For sites with recycled concrete where monitoring is required, the Permittee must
begin the weekly pH sampling period when the recycled concrete is first exposed to
precipitation and must continue until the recycled concrete is fully stabilized with
the stormwater pH in the range of 6.5 to 8.5 (su).
c. For sites with engineered soils, the Permittee must begin the pH sampling period
when the soil amendments are first exposed to precipitation and must continue
until the area of engineered soils is fully stabilized.
3. The Permittee must sample pH in the sediment trap/pond(s) or other locations that
receive stormwater runoff from the area of significant concrete work or engineered soils
before the stormwater discharges to surface waters.
4. The benchmark value for pH is 8.5 standard units. Anytime sampling indicates that pH is
8.5 or greater, the Permittee must either:
a. Prevent the high pH water (8.5 or above) from entering storm sewer systems or
surface waters of the state; or
b. If necessary, adjust or neutralize the high pH water until it is in the range of pH 6.5 to
8.5 (su) using an appropriate treatment BMP such as carbon dioxide (CO2) sparging, dry
ice or food grade vinegar. The Permittee must obtain written approval from Ecology
before using any form of chemical treatment other than CO2 sparging, dry ice or food
grade vinegar.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 17
S5. REPORTING AND RECORDKEEPING REQUIREMENTS
A. High Turbidity Reporting
Anytime sampling performed in accordance with Special Condition S4.C indicates turbidity has
reached the 250 NTUs or more (or transparency less than or equal to 6 cm), high turbidity
reporting level, the Permittee must notify Ecology within 24 hours of analysis either by calling
the applicable Ecology Region’s Environmental Report Tracking System (ERTS) number by
phone or by submitting an electronic ERTS report (through Ecology’s Water Quality Permitting
Portal (WQWebPortal) – Permit Submittals when the form is available). See the CSWGP website
for links to ERTS and the WQWebPortal. (http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/stormwater/
construction/index.html) Also, see phone numbers in Special Condition S4.C.5.b.i.
B. Discharge Monitoring Reports (DMRs)
Permittees required to conduct water quality sampling in accordance with Special Conditions
S4.C (Turbidity/Transparency), S4.D (pH), S8 (303[d]/TMDL sampling), and/or G12 (Additional
Sampling) must submit the results to Ecology.
Permittees must submit monitoring data using Ecology's WQWebDMR web application
accessed through Ecology’s Water Quality Permitting Portal.
Permittees unable to submit electronically (for example, those who do not have an internet
connection) must contact Ecology to request a waiver and obtain instructions on how to obtain
a paper copy DMR at:
Department of Ecology
Water Quality Program - Construction Stormwater
PO Box 47696
Olympia, WA 98504-7696
Permittees who obtain a waiver not to use WQWebDMR must use the forms provided to them
by Ecology; submittals must be mailed to the address above. Permittees must submit DMR
forms to be received by Ecology within 15 days following the end of each month.
If there was no discharge during a given monitoring period, all Permittees must submit a DMR
as required with “no discharge” entered in place of the monitoring results. DMRs are required
for the full duration of permit coverage (from the first full month following the effective date of
permit coverage up until Ecology has approved termination of the coverage). For more
information, contact Ecology staff using information provided at the following website:
www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/permits/paris/contacts.html.
C. Records Retention
The Permittee must retain records of all monitoring information (site log book, sampling
results, inspection reports/checklists, etc.), Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan, copy of the
permit coverage letter (including Transfer of Coverage documentation) and any other
documentation of compliance with permit requirements for the entire life of the construction
project and for a minimum of five (5) years following the termination of permit coverage. Such
information must include all calibration and maintenance records, and records of all data used
to complete the application for this permit. This period of retention must be extended during
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 18
the course of any unresolved litigation regarding the discharge of pollutants by the Permittee
or when requested by Ecology.
D. Recording Results
For each measurement or sample taken, the Permittee must record the following information:
1. Date, place, method, and time of sampling or measurement.
2. The first and last name of the individual who performed the sampling or measurement.
3. The date(s) the analyses were performed.
4. The first and last name of the individual who performed the analyses.
5. The analytical techniques or methods used.
6. The results of all analyses.
E. Additional Monitoring by the Permittee
If the Permittee samples or monitors any pollutant more frequently than required by this
permit using test procedures specified by Special Condition S4 of this permit, the sampling
results for this monitoring must be included in the calculation and reporting of the data
submitted in the Permittee’s DMR.
F. Noncompliance Notification
In the event the Permittee is unable to comply with any part of the terms and conditions of this
permit, and the resulting noncompliance may cause a threat to human health or the
environment (such as but not limited to spills or fuels or other materials, catastrophic pond or
slope failure, and discharges that violate water quality standards), or exceed numeric effluent
limitations (see S8 – Discharges to 303(d) or TMDL Waterbodies), the Permittee must, upon
becoming aware of the circumstance:
1. Notify Ecology within 24 hours of the failure to comply by calling the applicable Regional
office ERTS phone number (refer to Special Condition S4.C.5.b.i, or go to
https://ecology.wa.gov/About-us/Get-involved/Report-an-environmental-issue to find
contact information for the regional offices.)
2. Immediately take action to prevent the discharge/pollution, or otherwise stop or correct
the noncompliance, and, if applicable, repeat sampling and analysis of any noncompliance
immediately and submit the results to Ecology within five (5) days of becoming aware of
the violation (See S5.F.3, below, for details on submitting results in a report).
3. Submit a detailed written report to Ecology within five (5) days of the time the Permittee
becomes aware of the circumstances, unless requested earlier by Ecology. The report must
be submitted using Ecology’s Water Quality Permitting Portal (WQWebPortal) – Permit
Submittals, unless a waiver from electronic reporting has been granted according to S5.B.
The report must contain a description of the noncompliance, including exact dates and
times, and if the noncompliance has not been corrected, the anticipated time it is expected
to continue; and the steps taken or planned to reduce, eliminate, and prevent
reoccurrence of the noncompliance.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 19
The Permittee must report any unanticipated bypass and/or upset that exceeds any
effluent limit in the permit in accordance with the 24-hour reporting requirement
contained in 40 C.F.R. 122.41(l)(6).
Compliance with these requirements does not relieve the Permittee from responsibility
to maintain continuous compliance with the terms and conditions of this permit or the
resulting liability for failure to comply. Upon request of the Permittee, Ecology may waive
the requirement for a written report on a case-by-case basis, if the immediate
notification is received by Ecology within 24 hours.
G. Access to Plans and Records
1. The Permittee must retain the following permit documentation (plans and records) on
site, or within reasonable access to the site, for use by the operator or for on-site review
by Ecology or the local jurisdiction:
a. General Permit
b. Permit Coverage Letter
c. Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP)
d. Site Log Book
e. Erosivity Waiver (if applicable)
2. The Permittee must address written requests for plans and records listed above (Special
Condition S5.G.1) as follows:
a. The Permittee must provide a copy of plans and records to Ecology within 14 days of
receipt of a written request from Ecology.
b. The Permittee must provide a copy of plans and records to the public when
requested in writing. Upon receiving a written request from the public for the
Permittee’s plans and records, the Permittee must either:
i. Provide a copy of the plans and records to the requester within 14 days of a
receipt of the written request; or
ii. Notify the requester within 10 days of receipt of the written request of the
location and times within normal business hours when the plans and records
may be viewed; and provide access to the plans and records within 14 days of
receipt of the written request; or
Within 14 days of receipt of the written request, the Permittee may submit a
copy of the plans and records to Ecology for viewing and/or copying by the
requester at an Ecology office, or a mutually agreed location. If plans and
records are viewed and/or copied at a location other than at an Ecology office,
the Permittee will provide reasonable access to copying services for which a
reasonable fee may be charged. The Permittee must notify the requester
within 10 days of receipt of the request where the plans and records may be
viewed and/or copied.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 20
S6. PERMIT FEES
The Permittee must pay permit fees assessed by Ecology. Fees for stormwater discharges covered
under this permit are established by Chapter 173-224 WAC. Ecology continues to assess permit
fees until the permit is terminated in accordance with Special Condition S10 or revoked in
accordance with General Condition G5.
S7. SOLID AND LIQUID WASTE DISPOSAL
The Permittee must handle and dispose of solid and liquid wastes generated by construction
activity, such as demolition debris, construction materials, contaminated materials, and waste
materials from maintenance activities, including liquids and solids from cleaning catch basins and
other stormwater facilities, in accordance with:
A. Special Condition S3, Compliance with Standards.
B. WAC 173-216-110.
C. Other applicable regulations.
S8. DISCHARGES TO 303(d) OR TMDL WATERBODIES
A. Sampling and Numeric Effluent Limits For Certain Discharges to 303(d)-Listed
Water Bodies
1. Permittees who discharge to segments of water bodies listed as impaired by the State of
Washington under Section 303(d) of the Clean Water Act for turbidity, fine sediment,
high pH, or phosphorus, must conduct water quality sampling according to the
requirements of this section, and Special Conditions S4.C.2.b-f and S4.C.3.b-d, and must
comply with the applicable numeric effluent limitations in S8.C and S8.D.
2. All references and requirements associated with Section 303(d) of the Clean Water Act
mean the most current listing by Ecology of impaired waters (Category 5) that exists on
January 1, 2021, or the date when the operator’s complete permit application is received
by Ecology, whichever is later.
B. Limits on Coverage for New Discharges to TMDL or 303(d)-Listed Waters
Construction sites that discharge to a TMDL or 303(d)-listed waterbody are not eligible for
coverage under this permit unless the operator:
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 21
1. Prevents exposing stormwater to pollutants for which the waterbody is impaired, and
retains documentation in the SWPPP that details procedures taken to prevent exposure
on site; or
2. Documents that the pollutants for which the waterbody is impaired are not present at
the site, and retains documentation of this finding within the SWPPP; or
3. Provides Ecology with data indicating the discharge is not expected to cause or
contribute to an exceedance of a water quality standard, and retains such data on site
with the SWPPP. The operator must provide data and other technical information to
Ecology that sufficiently demonstrate:
a. For discharges to waters without an EPA-approved or -established TMDL, that the
discharge of the pollutant for which the water is impaired will meet in-stream water
quality criteria at the point of discharge to the waterbody; or
b. For discharges to waters with an EPA-approved or -established TMDL, that there is
sufficient remaining wasteload allocation in the TMDL to allow construction
stormwater discharge and that existing dischargers to the waterbody are subject to
compliance schedules designed to bring the waterbody into attainment with water
quality standards.
Operators of construction sites are eligible for coverage under this permit only after
Ecology makes an affirmative determination that the discharge will not cause or
contribute to the existing impairment or exceed the TMDL.
C. Sampling and Numeric Effluent Limits for Discharges to Water Bodies on the 303(d) List
for Turbidity, Fine Sediment, or Phosphorus
1. Permittees who discharge to segments of water bodies on the 303(d) list (Category 5) for
turbidity, fine sediment, or phosphorus must conduct turbidity sampling in accordance
with Special Condition S4.C.2 and comply with either of the numeric effluent limits noted
in Table 5 below.
2. As an alternative to the 25 NTUs effluent limit noted in Table 5 below (applied at the
point where stormwater [or authorized non-stormwater] is discharged off-site),
Permittees may choose to comply with the surface water quality standard for turbidity.
The standard is: no more than 5 NTUs over background turbidity when the background
turbidity is 50 NTUs or less, or no more than a 10% increase in turbidity when the
background turbidity is more than 50 NTUs. In order to use the water quality standard
requirement, the sampling must take place at the following locations:
a. Background turbidity in the 303(d)-listed receiving water immediately upstream
(upgradient) or outside the area of influence of the discharge.
b. Turbidity at the point of discharge into the 303(d)-listed receiving water, inside the
area of influence of the discharge.
3. Discharges that exceed the numeric effluent limit for turbidity constitute a violation of
this permit.
4. Permittees whose discharges exceed the numeric effluent limit must sample discharges
daily until the violation is corrected and comply with the non-compliance notification
requirements in Special Condition S5.F.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 22
Table 5 Turbidity, Fine Sediment & Phosphorus Sampling and Limits for 303(d)-Listed Waters
Parameter identified in
303(d) listing
Parameter
Sampled Unit Analytical
Method
Sampling
Frequency
Numeric Effluent
Limit1
• Turbidity
• Fine Sediment
• Phosphorus
Turbidity NTU SM2130 Weekly, if
discharging
25 NTUs, at the point
where stormwater is
discharged from the
site; OR
In compliance with
the surface water
quality standard for
turbidity (S8.C.2.a)
1 Permittees subject to a numeric effluent limit for turbidity may, at their discretion, choose either
numeric effluent limitation based on site-specific considerations including, but not limited to,
safety, access and convenience.
D. Discharges to Water Bodies on the 303(d) List for High pH
1. Permittees who discharge to segments of water bodies on the 303(d) list (Category 5) for
high pH must conduct pH sampling in accordance with the table below, and comply with
the numeric effluent limit of pH 6.5 to 8.5 su (Table 6).
Table 6 pH Sampling and Limits for 303(d)-Listed Waters
Parameter identified in 303(d)
listing
Parameter
Sampled/Units
Analytical
Method
Sampling
Frequency
Numeric Effluent
Limit
High pH pH /Standard
Units pH meter Weekly, if
discharging
In the range of
6.5 – 8.5 su
2. At the Permittee’s discretion, compliance with the limit shall be assessed at one of the
following locations:
a. Directly in the 303(d)-listed waterbody segment, inside the immediate area of
influence of the discharge; or
b. Alternatively, the Permittee may measure pH at the point where the discharge
leaves the construction site, rather than in the receiving water.
3. Discharges that exceed the numeric effluent limit for pH (outside the range of 6.5 – 8.5 su)
constitute a violation of this permit.
4. Permittees whose discharges exceed the numeric effluent limit must sample discharges
daily until the violation is corrected and comply with the non-compliance notification
requirements in Special Condition S5.F.
E. Sampling and Limits for Sites Discharging to Waters Covered by a TMDL or another
Pollution Control Plan
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 23
1. Discharges to a waterbody that is subject to a Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL) for
turbidity, fine sediment, high pH, or phosphorus must be consistent with the TMDL. Refer
to http://www.ecy.wa.gov/programs/wq/tmdl/TMDLsbyWria/TMDLbyWria.html for
more information on TMDLs.
a. Where an applicable TMDL sets specific waste load allocations or requirements for
discharges covered by this permit, discharges must be consistent with any specific
waste load allocations or requirements established by the applicable TMDL.
i. The Permittee must sample discharges weekly, unless otherwise specified by
the TMDL, to evaluate compliance with the specific waste load allocations or
requirements.
ii. Analytical methods used to meet the monitoring requirements must conform
to the latest revision of the Guidelines Establishing Test Procedures for the
Analysis of Pollutants contained in 40 CFR Part 136.
iii. Turbidity and pH methods need not be accredited or registered unless
conducted at a laboratory which must otherwise be accredited or registered.
b. Where an applicable TMDL has established a general waste load allocation for
construction stormwater discharges, but has not identified specific requirements,
compliance with Special Conditions S4 (Monitoring) and S9 (SWPPPs) will constitute
compliance with the approved TMDL.
c. Where an applicable TMDL has not specified a waste load allocation for construction
stormwater discharges, but has not excluded these discharges, compliance with
Special Conditions S4 (Monitoring) and S9 (SWPPPs) will constitute compliance with
the approved TMDL.
d. Where an applicable TMDL specifically precludes or prohibits discharges from
construction activity, the operator is not eligible for coverage under this permit.
S9. STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION PLAN
The Permittee must prepare and properly implement an adequate Stormwater Pollution
Prevention Plan (SWPPP) for construction activity in accordance with the requirements of this
permit beginning with initial soil disturbance and until final stabilization.
A. The Permittee’s SWPPP must meet the following objectives:
1. To identify best management practices (BMPs) which prevent erosion and sedimentation,
and to reduce, eliminate or prevent stormwater contamination and water pollution from
construction activity.
2. To prevent violations of surface water quality, groundwater quality, or sediment
management standards.
3. To control peak volumetric flow rates and velocities of stormwater discharges.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 24
B. General Requirements
1. The SWPPP must include a narrative and drawings. All BMPs must be clearly referenced in
the narrative and marked on the drawings. The SWPPP narrative must include
documentation to explain and justify the pollution prevention decisions made for the
project. Documentation must include:
a. Information about existing site conditions (topography, drainage, soils, vegetation, etc.).
b. Potential erosion problem areas.
c. The 13 elements of a SWPPP in Special Condition S9.D.1-13, including BMPs
used to address each element.
d. Construction phasing/sequence and general BMP implementation schedule.
e. The actions to be taken if BMP performance goals are not achieved—for example,
a contingency plan for additional treatment and/or storage of stormwater that
would violate the water quality standards if discharged.
f. Engineering calculations for ponds, treatment systems, and any other designed
structures. When a treatment system requires engineering calculations, these
calculations must be included in the SWPPP. Engineering calculations do not need to
be included in the SWPPP for treatment systems that do not require such calculations.
2. The Permittee must modify the SWPPP if, during inspections or investigations conducted
by the owner/operator, or the applicable local or state regulatory authority, it is
determined that the SWPPP is, or would be, ineffective in eliminating or significantly
minimizing pollutants in stormwater discharges from the site. The Permittee must then:
a. Review the SWPPP for compliance with Special Condition S9 and make appropriate
revisions within 7 days of the inspection or investigation.
b. Immediately begin the process to fully implement and maintain appropriate source
control and/or treatment BMPs as soon as possible, addressing the problems no later
than 10 days from the inspection or investigation. If installation of necessary treatment
BMPs is not feasible within 10 days, Ecology may approve additional time when an
extension is requested by a Permittee within the initial 10-day response period.
c. Document BMP implementation and maintenance in the site log book.
The Permittee must modify the SWPPP whenever there is a change in design,
construction, operation, or maintenance at the construction site that has, or could have,
a significant effect on the discharge of pollutants to waters of the State.
C. Stormwater Best Management Practices (BMPs)
BMPs must be consistent with:
1. Stormwater Management Manual for Western Washington (most current approved
edition at the time this permit was issued), for sites west of the crest of the Cascade
Mountains; or
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 25
2. Stormwater Management Manual for Eastern Washington (most current approved
edition at the time this permit was issued), for sites east of the crest of the Cascade
Mountains; or
3. Revisions to the manuals listed in Special Condition S9.C.1 & 2, or other stormwater
management guidance documents or manuals which provide an equivalent level of
pollution prevention, that are approved by Ecology and incorporated into this permit in
accordance with the permit modification requirements of WAC 173-226-230; or
4. Documentation in the SWPPP that the BMPs selected provide an equivalent level of
pollution prevention, compared to the applicable stormwater management manuals,
including:
a. The technical basis for the selection of all stormwater BMPs (scientific, technical studies,
and/or modeling) that support the performance claims for the BMPs being selected.
b. An assessment of how the selected BMP will satisfy AKART requirements and the
applicable federal technology-based treatment requirements under 40 CFR part 125.3.
D. SWPPP – Narrative Contents and Requirements
The Permittee must include each of the 13 elements below in Special Condition S9.D.1-13 in
the narrative of the SWPPP and implement them unless site conditions render the element
unnecessary and the exemption from that element is clearly justified in the SWPPP.
1. Preserve Vegetation/Mark Clearing Limits
a. Before beginning land-disturbing activities, including clearing and grading, clearly
mark all clearing limits, sensitive areas and their buffers, and trees that are to be
preserved within the construction area.
b. Retain the duff layer, native topsoil, and natural vegetation in an undisturbed state
to the maximum degree practicable.
2. Establish Construction Access
a. Limit construction vehicle access and exit to one route, if possible.
b. Stabilize access points with a pad of quarry spalls, crushed rock, or other equivalent
BMPs, to minimize tracking sediment onto roads.
c. Locate wheel wash or tire baths on site, if the stabilized construction entrance is not
effective in preventing tracking sediment onto roads.
d. If sediment is tracked off site, clean the affected roadway thoroughly at the end of
each day, or more frequently as necessary (for example, during wet weather).
Remove sediment from roads by shoveling, sweeping, or pickup and transport of the
sediment to a controlled sediment disposal area.
e. Conduct street washing only after sediment removal in accordance with Special
Condition S9.D.2.d.
f. Control street wash wastewater by pumping back on site or otherwise preventing it
from discharging into systems tributary to waters of the State.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 26
3. Control Flow Rates
a. Protect properties and waterways downstream of construction sites from erosion
and the associated discharge of turbid waters due to increases in the velocity and
peak volumetric flow rate of stormwater runoff from the project site, as required by
local plan approval authority.
b. Where necessary to comply with Special Condition S9.D.3.a, construct stormwater
infiltration or detention BMPs as one of the first steps in grading. Assure that
detention BMPs function properly before constructing site improvements (for
example, impervious surfaces).
c. If permanent infiltration ponds are used for flow control during construction,
protect these facilities from sedimentation during the construction phase.
4. Install Sediment Controls
The Permittee must design, install and maintain effective erosion controls and sediment
controls to minimize the discharge of pollutants. At a minimum, the Permittee must:
a. Construct sediment control BMPs (sediment ponds, traps, filters, infiltration
facilities, etc.) as one of the first steps in grading. These BMPs must be functional
before other land disturbing activities take place.
b. Minimize sediment discharges from the site. The design, installation and
maintenance of erosion and sediment controls must address factors such as the
amount, frequency, intensity and duration of precipitation, the nature of resulting
stormwater runoff, and soil characteristics, including the range of soil particle sizes
expected to be present on the site.
c. Direct stormwater runoff from disturbed areas through a sediment pond or other
appropriate sediment removal BMP, before the runoff leaves a construction site or
before discharge to an infiltration facility. Runoff from fully stabilized areas may be
discharged without a sediment removal BMP, but must meet the flow control
performance standard of Special Condition S9.D.3.a.
d. Locate BMPs intended to trap sediment on site in a manner to avoid interference
with the movement of juvenile salmonids attempting to enter off-channel areas or
drainages.
e. Provide and maintain natural buffers around surface waters, direct stormwater to
vegetated areas to increase sediment removal and maximize stormwater
infiltration, unless infeasible.
f. Where feasible, design outlet structures that withdraw impounded stormwater
from the surface to avoid discharging sediment that is still suspended lower in the
water column.
5. Stabilize Soils
a. The Permittee must stabilize exposed and unworked soils by application of effective
BMPs that prevent erosion. Applicable BMPs include, but are not limited to:
temporary and permanent seeding, sodding, mulching, plastic covering, erosion
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 27
control fabrics and matting, soil application of polyacrylamide (PAM), the early
application of gravel base on areas to be paved, and dust control.
b. The Permittee must control stormwater volume and velocity within the site to
minimize soil erosion.
c. The Permittee must control stormwater discharges, including both peak flow rates
and total stormwater volume, to minimize erosion at outlets and to minimize
downstream channel and stream bank erosion.
d. Depending on the geographic location of the project, the Permittee must not allow
soils to remain exposed and unworked for more than the time periods set forth
below to prevent erosion.
West of the Cascade Mountains Crest
During the dry season (May 1 - September 30): 7 days
During the wet season (October 1 - April 30): 2 days
East of the Cascade Mountains Crest, except for Central Basin*
During the dry season (July 1 - September 30): 10 days
During the wet season (October 1 - June 30): 5 days
The Central Basin*, East of the Cascade Mountains Crest
During the dry Season (July 1 - September 30): 30 days
During the wet season (October 1 - June 30): 15 days
*Note: The Central Basin is defined as the portions of Eastern Washington
with mean annual precipitation of less than 12 inches.
e. The Permittee must stabilize soils at the end of the shift before a holiday or
weekend if needed based on the weather forecast.
f. The Permittee must stabilize soil stockpiles from erosion, protected with sediment
trapping measures, and where possible, be located away from storm drain inlets,
waterways, and drainage channels.
g. The Permittee must minimize the amount of soil exposed during construction activity.
h. The Permittee must minimize the disturbance of steep slopes.
i. The Permittee must minimize soil compaction and, unless infeasible, preserve topsoil.
6. Protect Slopes
a. The Permittee must design and construct cut-and-fill slopes in a manner to minimize
erosion. Applicable practices include, but are not limited to, reducing continuous
length of slope with terracing and diversions, reducing slope steepness, and
roughening slope surfaces (for example, track walking).
b. The Permittee must divert off-site stormwater (run-on) or groundwater away from
slopes and disturbed areas with interceptor dikes, pipes, and/or swales. Off-site
stormwater should be managed separately from stormwater generated on the site.
c. At the top of slopes, collect drainage in pipe slope drains or protected channels to
prevent erosion.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 28
i. West of the Cascade Mountains Crest: Temporary pipe slope drains must handle
the peak 10-minute flow rate from a Type 1A, 10-year, 24-hour frequency storm
for the developed condition. Alternatively, the 10-year, 1-hour flow rate
predicted by an approved continuous runoff model, increased by a factor of 1.6,
may be used. The hydrologic analysis must use the existing land cover condition
for predicting flow rates from tributary areas outside the project limits. For
tributary areas on the project site, the analysis must use the temporary or
permanent project land cover condition, whichever will produce the highest flow
rates. If using the Western Washington Hydrology Model (WWHM) to predict
flows, bare soil areas should be modeled as "landscaped area.”
ii. East of the Cascade Mountains Crest: Temporary pipe slope drains must handle
the expected peak flow rate from a 6-month, 3-hour storm for the developed
condition, referred to as the short duration storm.
d. Place excavated material on the uphill side of trenches, consistent with safety and
space considerations.
e. Place check dams at regular intervals within constructed channels that are cut down
a slope.
7. Protect Drain Inlets
a. Protect all storm drain inlets made operable during construction so that stormwater
runoff does not enter the conveyance system without first being filtered or treated
to remove sediment.
b. Clean or remove and replace inlet protection devices when sediment has filled one-
third of the available storage (unless a different standard is specified by the product
manufacturer).
8. Stabilize Channels and Outlets
a. Design, construct and stabilize all on-site conveyance channels to prevent erosion
from the following expected peak flows:
i. West of the Cascade Mountains Crest: Channels must handle the peak 10-
minute flow rate from a Type 1A, 10-year, 24-hour frequency storm for the
developed condition. Alternatively, the 10-year, 1-hour flow rate indicated by
an approved continuous runoff model, increased by a factor of 1.6, may be
used. The hydrologic analysis must use the existing land cover condition for
predicting flow rates from tributary areas outside the project limits. For
tributary areas on the project site, the analysis must use the temporary or
permanent project land cover condition, whichever will produce the highest
flow rates. If using the WWHM to predict flows, bare soil areas should be
modeled as "landscaped area.”
ii. East of the Cascade Mountains Crest: Channels must handle the expected peak
flow rate from a 6-month, 3-hour storm for the developed condition, referred
to as the short duration storm.
b. Provide stabilization, including armoring material, adequate to prevent erosion of
outlets, adjacent stream banks, slopes, and downstream reaches at the outlets of all
conveyance systems.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 29
9. Control Pollutants
Design, install, implement and maintain effective pollution prevention measures to
minimize the discharge of pollutants. The Permittee must:
a. Handle and dispose of all pollutants, including waste materials and demolition
debris that occur on site in a manner that does not cause contamination of
stormwater.
b. Provide cover, containment, and protection from vandalism for all chemicals, liquid
products, petroleum products, and other materials that have the potential to pose a
threat to human health or the environment. Minimize storage of hazardous
materials on-site. Safety Data Sheets (SDS) should be supplied for all materials
stored. Chemicals should be kept in their original labeled containers. On-site fueling
tanks must include secondary containment. Secondary containment means placing
tanks or containers within an impervious structure capable of containing 110% of
the volume of the largest tank within the containment structure. Double-walled
tanks do not require additional secondary containment.
c. Conduct maintenance, fueling, and repair of heavy equipment and vehicles using
spill prevention and control measures. Clean contaminated surfaces immediately
following any spill incident.
d. Discharge wheel wash or tire bath wastewater to a separate on-site treatment
system that prevents discharge to surface water, such as closed-loop recirculation
or upland land application, or to the sanitary sewer with local sewer district
approval.
e. Apply fertilizers and pesticides in a manner and at application rates that will not
result in loss of chemical to stormwater runoff. Follow manufacturers’ label
requirements for application rates and procedures.
f. Use BMPs to prevent contamination of stormwater runoff by pH-modifying sources.
The sources for this contamination include, but are not limited to: bulk cement,
cement kiln dust, fly ash, new concrete washing and curing waters, recycled
concrete stockpiles, waste streams generated from concrete grinding and sawing,
exposed aggregate processes, dewatering concrete vaults, concrete pumping and
mixer washout waters. (Also refer to the definition for "concrete wastewater" in
Appendix A – Definitions.)
g. Adjust the pH of stormwater or authorized non-stormwater if necessary to prevent
an exceedance of groundwater and/or surface water quality standards.
h. Assure that washout of concrete trucks is performed off-site or in designated
concrete washout areas only. Do not wash out concrete truck drums onto the
ground, or into storm drains, open ditches, streets, or streams. Washout of small
concrete handling equipment may be disposed of in a formed area awaiting
concrete where it will not contaminate surface or groundwater. Do not dump excess
concrete on site, except in designated concrete washout areas. Concrete spillage or
concrete discharge directly to groundwater or surface waters of the State is
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 30
prohibited. At no time shall concrete be washed off into the footprint of an area
where an infiltration BMP will be installed.
i. Obtain written approval from Ecology before using any chemical treatment, with
the exception of CO2, dry ice or food grade vinegar, to adjust pH.
j. Uncontaminated water from water-only based shaft drilling for construction of
building, road, and bridge foundations may be infiltrated provided the wastewater is
managed in a way that prohibits discharge to surface waters. Prior to infiltration,
water from water-only based shaft drilling that comes into contact with curing
concrete must be neutralized until pH is in the range of 6.5 to 8.5 (su).
10. Control Dewatering
a. Permittees must discharge foundation, vault, and trench dewatering water, which
have characteristics similar to stormwater runoff at the site, in conjunction with BMPs
to reduce sedimentation before discharge to a sediment trap or sediment pond.
b. Permittees may discharge clean, non-turbid dewatering water, such as well-point
groundwater, to systems tributary to, or directly into surface waters of the State, as
specified in Special Condition S9.D.8, provided the dewatering flow does not cause
erosion or flooding of receiving waters. Do not route clean dewatering water through
stormwater sediment ponds. Note that “surface waters of the State” may exist on a
construction site as well as off site; for example, a creek running through a site.
c. Other dewatering treatment or disposal options may include:
i. Infiltration
ii. Transport off site in a vehicle, such as a vacuum flush truck, for legal disposal in
a manner that does not pollute state waters.
iii. Ecology-approved on-site chemical treatment or other suitable treatment
technologies (See S9.D.9.i, regarding chemical treatment written approval).
iv. Sanitary or combined sewer discharge with local sewer district approval, if
there is no other option.
v. Use of a sedimentation bag with discharge to a ditch or swale for small
volumes of localized dewatering.
d. Permittees must handle highly turbid or contaminated dewatering water separately
from stormwater.
11. Maintain BMPs
a. Permittees must maintain and repair all temporary and permanent erosion and
sediment control BMPs as needed to assure continued performance of their
intended function in accordance with BMP specifications.
b. Permittees must remove all temporary erosion and sediment control BMPs within
30 days after achieving final site stabilization or after the temporary BMPs are no
longer needed.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 31
12. Manage the Project
a. Phase development projects to the maximum degree practicable and take into
account seasonal work limitations.
b. Inspect, maintain and repair all BMPs as needed to assure continued performance
of their intended function. Conduct site inspections and monitoring in accordance
with Special Condition S4.
c. Maintain, update, and implement the SWPPP in accordance with Special Conditions
S3, S4, and S9.
13. Protect Low Impact Development (LID) BMPs
The primary purpose of on-site LID Stormwater Management is to reduce the disruption of
the natural site hydrology through infiltration. LID BMPs are permanent facilities.
a. Permittees must protect all LID BMPs (including, but not limited to, Bioretention and
Rain Garden facilities) from sedimentation through installation and maintenance of
erosion and sediment control BMPs on portions of the site that drain into the
Bioretention and/or Rain Garden facilities. Restore the BMPs to their fully
functioning condition if they accumulate sediment during construction. Restoring
the facility must include removal of sediment and any sediment-laden bioretention/
rain garden soils, and replacing the removed soils with soils meeting the design
specification.
b. Permittees must maintain the infiltration capabilities of LID BMPs by protecting
against compaction by construction equipment and foot traffic. Protect completed
lawn and landscaped areas from compaction due to construction equipment.
c. Permittees must control erosion and avoid introducing sediment from surrounding
land uses onto permeable pavements. Do not allow muddy construction equipment
on the base material or pavement. Do not allow sediment-laden runoff onto
permeable pavements or base materials.
d. Permittees must clean permeable pavements fouled with sediments or no longer
passing an initial infiltration test using local stormwater manual methodology or the
manufacturer’s procedures.
e. Permittees must keep all heavy equipment off existing soils under LID BMPs that
have been excavated to final grade to retain the infiltration rate of the soils.
E. SWPPP – Map Contents and Requirements
The Permittee’s SWPPP must also include a vicinity map or general location map (for example,
a USGS quadrangle map, a portion of a county or city map, or other appropriate map) with
enough detail to identify the location of the construction site and receiving waters within one
mile of the site.
The SWPPP must also include a legible site map (or maps) showing the entire construction site.
The following features must be identified, unless not applicable due to site conditions.
1. The direction of north, property lines, and existing structures and roads.
2. Cut and fill slopes indicating the top and bottom of slope catch lines.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 32
3. Approximate slopes, contours, and direction of stormwater flow before and after major
grading activities.
4. Areas of soil disturbance and areas that will not be disturbed.
5. Locations of structural and nonstructural controls (BMPs) identified in the SWPPP.
6. Locations of off-site material, stockpiles, waste storage, borrow areas, and
vehicle/equipment storage areas.
7. Locations of all surface water bodies, including wetlands.
8. Locations where stormwater or non-stormwater discharges off-site and/or to a surface
waterbody, including wetlands.
9. Location of water quality sampling station(s), if sampling is required by state or local
permitting authority.
10. Areas where final stabilization has been accomplished and no further construction-phase
permit requirements apply.
11. Location or proposed location of LID facilities.
S10. NOTICE OF TERMINATION
Partial terminations of permit coverage are not authorized.
A. The site is eligible for termination of coverage when it has met any of the following
conditions:
1. The site has undergone final stabilization, the Permittee has removed all temporary
BMPs (except biodegradable BMPs clearly manufactured with the intention for the
material to be left in place and not interfere with maintenance or land use), and all
stormwater discharges associated with construction activity have been eliminated; or
2. All portions of the site that have not undergone final stabilization per Special Condition
S10.A.1 have been sold and/or transferred (per Special Condition S2.A), and the
Permittee no longer has operational control of the construction activity; or
3. For residential construction only, the Permittee has completed temporary stabilization
and the homeowners have taken possession of the residences.
B. When the site is eligible for termination, the Permittee must submit a complete and
accurate Notice of Termination (NOT) form, signed in accordance with General
Condition G2, to:
Department of Ecology
Water Quality Program - Construction Stormwater
PO Box 47696
Olympia, WA 98504-7696
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 33
When an electronic termination form is available, the Permittee may choose to submit a
complete and accurate Notice of Termination (NOT) form through the Water Quality Permitting
Portal rather than mailing a hardcopy as noted above.
The termination is effective on the 31st calendar day following the date Ecology receives a
complete NOT form, unless Ecology notifies the Permittee that termination request is denied
because the Permittee has not met the eligibility requirements in Special Condition S10.A.
Permittees are required to comply with all conditions and effluent limitations in the permit
until the permit has been terminated.
Permittees transferring the property to a new property owner or operator/Permittee are
required to complete and submit the Notice of Transfer form to Ecology, but are not required
to submit a Notice of Termination form for this type of transaction.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 34
GENERAL CONDITIONS
G1. DISCHARGE VIOLATIONS
All discharges and activities authorized by this general permit must be consistent with the terms
and conditions of this general permit. Any discharge of any pollutant more frequent than or at a
level in excess of that identified and authorized by the general permit must constitute a violation of
the terms and conditions of this permit.
G2. SIGNATORY REQUIREMENTS
A. All permit applications must bear a certification of correctness to be signed:
1. In the case of corporations, by a responsible corporate officer.
2. In the case of a partnership, by a general partner of a partnership.
3. In the case of sole proprietorship, by the proprietor.
4. In the case of a municipal, state, or other public facility, by either a principal executive
officer or ranking elected official.
B. All reports required by this permit and other information requested by Ecology (including
NOIs, NOTs, and Transfer of Coverage forms) must be signed by a person described above
or by a duly authorized representative of that person. A person is a duly authorized
representative only if:
1. The authorization is made in writing by a person described above and submitted to
Ecology.
2. The authorization specifies either an individual or a position having responsibility for
the overall operation of the regulated facility, such as the position of plant manager,
superintendent, position of equivalent responsibility, or an individual or position
having overall responsibility for environmental matters.
C. Changes to authorization. If an authorization under paragraph G2.B.2 above is no longer
accurate because a different individual or position has responsibility for the overall
operation of the facility, a new authorization satisfying the requirements of paragraph
G2.B.2 above must be submitted to Ecology prior to or together with any reports,
information, or applications to be signed by an authorized representative.
D. Certification. Any person signing a document under this section must make the following
certification:
I certify under penalty of law, that this document and all attachments were
prepared under my direction or supervision in accordance with a system
designed to assure that qualified personnel properly gathered and evaluated the
information submitted. Based on my inquiry of the person or persons who
manage the system, or those persons directly responsible for gathering
information, the information submitted is, to the best of my knowledge and
belief, true, accurate, and complete. I am aware that there are significant
penalties for submitting false information, including the possibility of fine and
imprisonment for knowing violations.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 35
G3. RIGHT OF INSPECTION AND ENTRY
The Permittee must allow an authorized representative of Ecology, upon the presentation of
credentials and such other documents as may be required by law:
A. To enter upon the premises where a discharge is located or where any records are kept
under the terms and conditions of this permit.
B. To have access to and copy, at reasonable times and at reasonable cost, any records
required to be kept under the terms and conditions of this permit.
C. To inspect, at reasonable times, any facilities, equipment (including monitoring and control
equipment), practices, methods, or operations regulated or required under this permit.
D. To sample or monitor, at reasonable times, any substances or parameters at any location for
purposes of assuring permit compliance or as otherwise authorized by the Clean Water Act.
G4. GENERAL PERMIT MODIFICATION AND REVOCATION
This permit may be modified, revoked and reissued, or terminated in accordance with the
provisions of Chapter 173-226 WAC. Grounds for modification, revocation and reissuance, or
termination include, but are not limited to, the following:
A. When a change occurs in the technology or practices for control or abatement of pollutants
applicable to the category of dischargers covered under this permit.
B. When effluent limitation guidelines or standards are promulgated pursuant to the CWA or
Chapter 90.48 RCW, for the category of dischargers covered under this permit.
C. When a water quality management plan containing requirements applicable to the
category of dischargers covered under this permit is approved, or
D. When information is obtained that indicates cumulative effects on the environment from
dischargers covered under this permit are unacceptable.
G5. REVOCATION OF COVERAGE UNDER THE PERMIT
Pursuant to Chapter 43.21B RCW and Chapter 173-226 WAC, the Director may terminate coverage
for any discharger under this permit for cause. Cases where coverage may be terminated include,
but are not limited to, the following:
A. Violation of any term or condition of this permit.
B. Obtaining coverage under this permit by misrepresentation or failure to disclose fully all
relevant facts.
C. A change in any condition that requires either a temporary or permanent reduction or
elimination of the permitted discharge.
D. Failure or refusal of the Permittee to allow entry as required in RCW 90.48.090.
E. A determination that the permitted activity endangers human health or the environment,
or contributes to water quality standards violations.
F. Nonpayment of permit fees or penalties assessed pursuant to RCW 90.48.465 and Chapter
173-224 WAC.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 36
G. Failure of the Permittee to satisfy the public notice requirements of WAC 173-226-130(5),
when applicable.
The Director may require any discharger under this permit to apply for and obtain coverage
under an individual permit or another more specific general permit. Permittees who have their
coverage revoked for cause according to WAC 173-226-240 may request temporary coverage
under this permit during the time an individual permit is being developed, provided the request
is made within ninety (90) days from the time of revocation and is submitted along with a
complete individual permit application form.
G6. REPORTING A CAUSE FOR MODIFICATION
The Permittee must submit a new application, or a supplement to the previous application,
whenever a material change to the construction activity or in the quantity or type of discharge is
anticipated which is not specifically authorized by this permit. This application must be submitted
at least sixty (60) days prior to any proposed changes. Filing a request for a permit modification,
revocation and reissuance, or termination, or a notification of planned changes or anticipated
noncompliance does not relieve the Permittee of the duty to comply with the existing permit until
it is modified or reissued.
G7. COMPLIANCE WITH OTHER LAWS AND STATUTES
Nothing in this permit will be construed as excusing the Permittee from compliance with any
applicable federal, state, or local statutes, ordinances, or regulations.
G8. DUTY TO REAPPLY
The Permittee must apply for permit renewal at least 180 days prior to the specified expiration
date of this permit. The Permittee must reapply using the electronic application form (NOI)
available on Ecology’s website. Permittees unable to submit electronically (for example, those who
do not have an internet connection) must contact Ecology to request a waiver and obtain
instructions on how to obtain a paper NOI.
Department of Ecology
Water Quality Program - Construction Stormwater
PO Box 47696
Olympia, WA 98504-7696
G9. REMOVED SUBSTANCE
The Permittee must not re-suspend or reintroduce collected screenings, grit, solids, sludges, filter
backwash, or other pollutants removed in the course of treatment or control of stormwater to the
final effluent stream for discharge to state waters.
G10. DUTY TO PROVIDE INFORMATION
The Permittee must submit to Ecology, within a reasonable time, all information that Ecology may
request to determine whether cause exists for modifying, revoking and reissuing, or terminating
this permit or to determine compliance with this permit. The Permittee must also submit to
Ecology, upon request, copies of records required to be kept by this permit [40 CFR 122.41(h)].
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 37
G11. OTHER REQUIREMENTS OF 40 CFR
All other requirements of 40 CFR 122.41 and 122.42 are incorporated in this permit by reference.
G12. ADDITIONAL MONITORING
Ecology may establish specific monitoring requirements in addition to those contained in this
permit by administrative order or permit modification.
G13. PENALTIES FOR VIOLATING PERMIT CONDITIONS
Any person who is found guilty of willfully violating the terms and conditions of this permit shall be
deemed guilty of a crime, and upon conviction thereof shall be punished by a fine of up to ten
thousand dollars ($10,000) and costs of prosecution, or by imprisonment at the discretion of the
court. Each day upon which a willful violation occurs may be deemed a separate and additional
violation.
Any person who violates the terms and conditions of a waste discharge permit shall incur, in
addition to any other penalty as provided by law, a civil penalty in the amount of up to ten
thousand dollars ($10,000) for every such violation. Each and every such violation shall be a
separate and distinct offense, and in case of a continuing violation, every day’s continuance shall be
deemed to be a separate and distinct violation.
G14. UPSET
Definition – “Upset” means an exceptional incident in which there is unintentional and temporary
noncompliance with technology-based permit effluent limitations because of factors beyond the
reasonable control of the Permittee. An upset does not include noncompliance to the extent
caused by operational error, improperly designed treatment facilities, inadequate treatment
facilities, lack of preventive maintenance, or careless or improper operation.
An upset constitutes an affirmative defense to an action brought for noncompliance with such
technology-based permit effluent limitations if the requirements of the following paragraph are met.
A Permittee who wishes to establish the affirmative defense of upset must demonstrate, through
properly signed, contemporaneous operating logs or other relevant evidence that: 1) an upset
occurred and that the Permittee can identify the cause(s) of the upset; 2) the permitted facility was
being properly operated at the time of the upset; 3) the Permittee submitted notice of the upset as
required in Special Condition S5.F, and; 4) the Permittee complied with any remedial measures
required under this permit.
In any enforcement proceeding, the Permittee seeking to establish the occurrence of an upset has
the burden of proof.
G15. PROPERTY RIGHTS
This permit does not convey any property rights of any sort, or any exclusive privilege.
G16. DUTY TO COMPLY
The Permittee must comply with all conditions of this permit. Any permit noncompliance
constitutes a violation of the Clean Water Act and is grounds for enforcement action; for permit
termination, revocation and reissuance, or modification; or denial of a permit renewal application.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 38
G17. TOXIC POLLUTANTS
The Permittee must comply with effluent standards or prohibitions established under Section
307(a) of the Clean Water Act for toxic pollutants within the time provided in the regulations that
establish those standards or prohibitions, even if this permit has not yet been modified to
incorporate the requirement.
G18. PENALTIES FOR TAMPERING
The Clean Water Act provides that any person who falsifies, tampers with, or knowingly renders
inaccurate any monitoring device or method required to be maintained under this permit shall, upon
conviction, be punished by a fine of not more than $10,000 per violation, or by imprisonment for not
more than two years per violation, or by both. If a conviction of a person is for a violation committed
after a first conviction of such person under this condition, punishment shall be a fine of not more
than $20,000 per day of violation, or imprisonment of not more than four (4) years, or both.
G19. REPORTING PLANNED CHANGES
The Permittee must, as soon as possible, give notice to Ecology of planned physical alterations,
modifications or additions to the permitted construction activity. The Permittee should be aware
that, depending on the nature and size of the changes to the original permit, a new public notice
and other permit process requirements may be required. Changes in activities that require
reporting to Ecology include those that will result in:
A. The permitted facility being determined to be a new source pursuant to 40 CFR 122.29(b).
B. A significant change in the nature or an increase in quantity of pollutants discharged,
including but not limited to: a 20% or greater increase in acreage disturbed by construction
activity.
C. A change in or addition of surface water(s) receiving stormwater or non-stormwater from
the construction activity.
D. A change in the construction plans and/or activity that affects the Permittee’s monitoring
requirements in Special Condition S4.
Following such notice, permit coverage may be modified, or revoked and reissued pursuant to 40
CFR 122.62(a) to specify and limit any pollutants not previously limited. Until such modification is
effective, any new or increased discharge in excess of permit limits or not specifically authorized by
this permit constitutes a violation.
G20. REPORTING OTHER INFORMATION
Where the Permittee becomes aware that it failed to submit any relevant facts in a permit
application, or submitted incorrect information in a permit application or in any report to Ecology,
it must promptly submit such facts or information.
G21. REPORTING ANTICIPATED NON-COMPLIANCE
The Permittee must give advance notice to Ecology by submission of a new application or
supplement thereto at least forty-five (45) days prior to commencement of such discharges, of any
facility expansions, production increases, or other planned changes, such as process modifications,
in the permitted facility or activity which may result in noncompliance with permit limits or
conditions. Any maintenance of facilities, which might necessitate unavoidable interruption of
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 39
operation and degradation of effluent quality, must be scheduled during non-critical water quality
periods and carried out in a manner approved by Ecology.
G22. REQUESTS TO BE EXCLUDED FROM COVERAGE UNDER THE PERMIT
Any discharger authorized by this permit may request to be excluded from coverage under the
general permit by applying for an individual permit. The discharger must submit to the Director an
application as described in WAC 173-220-040 or WAC 173-216-070, whichever is applicable, with
reasons supporting the request. These reasons will fully document how an individual permit will
apply to the applicant in a way that the general permit cannot. Ecology may make specific requests
for information to support the request. The Director will either issue an individual permit or deny
the request with a statement explaining the reason for the denial. When an individual permit is
issued to a discharger otherwise subject to the construction stormwater general permit, the
applicability of the construction stormwater general permit to that Permittee is automatically
terminated on the effective date of the individual permit.
G23. APPEALS
A. The terms and conditions of this general permit, as they apply to the appropriate class of
dischargers, are subject to appeal by any person within 30 days of issuance of this general
permit, in accordance with Chapter 43.21B RCW, and Chapter 173-226 WAC.
B. The terms and conditions of this general permit, as they apply to an individual discharger,
are appealable in accordance with Chapter 43.21B RCW within 30 days of the effective date
of coverage of that discharger. Consideration of an appeal of general permit coverage of an
individual discharger is limited to the general permit’s applicability or nonapplicability to
that individual discharger.
C. The appeal of general permit coverage of an individual discharger does not affect any other
dischargers covered under this general permit. If the terms and conditions of this general
permit are found to be inapplicable to any individual discharger(s), the matter shall be
remanded to Ecology for consideration of issuance of an individual permit or permits.
G24. SEVERABILITY
The provisions of this permit are severable, and if any provision of this permit, or application of any
provision of this permit to any circumstance, is held invalid, the application of such provision to
other circumstances, and the remainder of this permit shall not be affected thereby.
G25. BYPASS PROHIBITED
A. Bypass Procedures
Bypass, which is the intentional diversion of waste streams from any portion of a treatment
facility, is prohibited for stormwater events below the design criteria for stormwater
management. Ecology may take enforcement action against a Permittee for bypass unless one
of the following circumstances (1, 2, 3 or 4) is applicable.
1. Bypass of stormwater is consistent with the design criteria and part of an approved
management practice in the applicable stormwater management manual.
2. Bypass for essential maintenance without the potential to cause violation of permit limits
or conditions.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 40
Bypass is authorized if it is for essential maintenance and does not have the potential to
cause violations of limitations or other conditions of this permit, or adversely impact
public health.
3. Bypass of stormwater is unavoidable, unanticipated, and results in noncompliance of this
permit.
This bypass is permitted only if:
a. Bypass is unavoidable to prevent loss of life, personal injury, or severe property
damage. “Severe property damage” means substantial physical damage to property,
damage to the treatment facilities which would cause them to become inoperable,
or substantial and permanent loss of natural resources which can reasonably be
expected to occur in the absence of a bypass.
b. There are no feasible alternatives to the bypass, such as the use of auxiliary
treatment facilities, retention of untreated wastes, maintenance during normal
periods of equipment downtime (but not if adequate backup equipment should
have been installed in the exercise of reasonable engineering judgment to prevent a
bypass which occurred during normal periods of equipment downtime or
preventative maintenance), or transport of untreated wastes to another treatment
facility.
c. Ecology is properly notified of the bypass as required in Special Condition S5.F of
this permit.
4. A planned action that would cause bypass of stormwater and has the potential to result
in noncompliance of this permit during a storm event.
The Permittee must notify Ecology at least thirty (30) days before the planned date of
bypass. The notice must contain:
a. A description of the bypass and its cause
b. An analysis of all known alternatives which would eliminate, reduce, or mitigate the
need for bypassing.
c. A cost-effectiveness analysis of alternatives including comparative resource damage
assessment.
d. The minimum and maximum duration of bypass under each alternative.
e. A recommendation as to the preferred alternative for conducting the bypass.
f. The projected date of bypass initiation.
g. A statement of compliance with SEPA.
h. A request for modification of water quality standards as provided for in WAC 173-
201A-110, if an exceedance of any water quality standard is anticipated.
i. Steps taken or planned to reduce, eliminate, and prevent reoccurrence of the
bypass.
5. For probable construction bypasses, the need to bypass is to be identified as early in the
planning process as possible. The analysis required above must be considered during
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 41
preparation of the Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) and must be included
to the extent practical. In cases where the probable need to bypass is determined early,
continued analysis is necessary up to and including the construction period in an effort to
minimize or eliminate the bypass.
Ecology will consider the following before issuing an administrative order for this type
bypass:
a. If the bypass is necessary to perform construction or maintenance-related activities
essential to meet the requirements of this permit.
b. If there are feasible alternatives to bypass, such as the use of auxiliary treatment
facilities, retention of untreated wastes, stopping production, maintenance during
normal periods of equipment down time, or transport of untreated wastes to
another treatment facility.
c. If the bypass is planned and scheduled to minimize adverse effects on the public and
the environment.
After consideration of the above and the adverse effects of the proposed bypass and any
other relevant factors, Ecology will approve, conditionally approve, or deny the request.
The public must be notified and given an opportunity to comment on bypass incidents of
significant duration, to the extent feasible. Approval of a request to bypass will be by
administrative order issued by Ecology under RCW 90.48.120.
B. Duty to Mitigate
The Permittee is required to take all reasonable steps to minimize or prevent any discharge or
sludge use or disposal in violation of this permit that has a reasonable likelihood of adversely
affecting human health or the environment.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 42
APPENDIX A – DEFINITIONS
AKART is an acronym for “All Known, Available, and Reasonable methods of prevention, control, and
Treatment.” AKART represents the most current methodology that can be reasonably required for
preventing, controlling, or abating the pollutants and controlling pollution associated with a discharge.
Applicable TMDL means a TMDL for turbidity, fine sediment, high pH, or phosphorus, which was
completed and approved by EPA before January 1, 2021, or before the date the operator’s complete
permit application is received by Ecology, whichever is later. TMDLs completed after a complete permit
application is received by Ecology become applicable to the Permittee only if they are imposed through
an administrative order by Ecology, or through a modification of permit coverage.
Applicant means an operator seeking coverage under this permit.
Benchmark means a pollutant concentration used as a permit threshold, below which a pollutant is
considered unlikely to cause a water quality violation, and above which it may. When pollutant
concentrations exceed benchmarks, corrective action requirements take effect. Benchmark values are
not water quality standards and are not numeric effluent limitations; they are indicator values.
Best Management Practices (BMPs) means schedules of activities, prohibitions of practices,
maintenance procedures, and other physical, structural and/or managerial practices to prevent or
reduce the pollution of waters of the State. BMPs include treatment systems, operating procedures, and
practices to control stormwater associated with construction activity, spillage or leaks, sludge or waste
disposal, or drainage from raw material storage.
Buffer means an area designated by a local jurisdiction that is contiguous to and intended to protect a
sensitive area.
Bypass means the intentional diversion of waste streams from any portion of a treatment facility.
Calendar Day A period of 24 consecutive hours starting at 12:00 midnight and ending the following
12:00 midnight.
Calendar Week (same as Week) means a period of seven consecutive days starting at 12:01 a.m. (0:01
hours) on Sunday.
Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead (CESCL) means a person who has current certification
through an approved erosion and sediment control training program that meets the minimum training
standards established by Ecology (See BMP C160 in the SWMM).
Chemical Treatment means the addition of chemicals to stormwater and/or authorized non-stormwater
prior to filtration and discharge to surface waters.
Clean Water Act (CWA) means the Federal Water Pollution Control Act enacted by Public Law 92-500, as
amended by Public Laws 95-217, 95-576, 96-483, and 97-117; USC 1251 et seq.
Combined Sewer means a sewer which has been designed to serve as a sanitary sewer and a storm
sewer, and into which inflow is allowed by local ordinance.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 43
Common Plan of Development or Sale means a site where multiple separate and distinct construction
activities may be taking place at different times on different schedules and/or by different contractors,
but still under a single plan. Examples include: 1) phased projects and projects with multiple filings or
lots, even if the separate phases or filings/lots will be constructed under separate contract or by
separate owners (e.g., a development where lots are sold to separate builders); 2) a development plan
that may be phased over multiple years, but is still under a consistent plan for long-term development;
3) projects in a contiguous area that may be unrelated but still under the same contract, such as
construction of a building extension and a new parking lot at the same facility; and 4) linear projects
such as roads, pipelines, or utilities. If the project is part of a common plan of development or sale, the
disturbed area of the entire plan must be used in determining permit requirements.
Composite Sample means a mixture of grab samples collected at the same sampling point at different
times, formed either by continuous sampling or by mixing discrete samples. May be "time-composite"
(collected at constant time intervals) or "flow-proportional" (collected either as a constant sample
volume at time intervals proportional to stream flow, or collected by increasing the volume of each
aliquot as the flow increases while maintaining a constant time interval between the aliquots.
Concrete Wastewater means any water used in the production, pouring and/or clean-up of concrete or
concrete products, and any water used to cut, grind, wash, or otherwise modify concrete or concrete
products. Examples include water used for or resulting from concrete truck/mixer/pumper/tool/chute
rinsing or washing, concrete saw cutting and surfacing (sawing, coring, grinding, roughening, hydro-
demolition, bridge and road surfacing). When stormwater comingles with concrete wastewater, the
resulting water is considered concrete wastewater and must be managed to prevent discharge to waters
of the State, including groundwater.
Construction Activity means land disturbing operations including clearing, grading or excavation which
disturbs the surface of the land (including off-site disturbance acreage related to construction-support
activity). Such activities may include road construction, construction of residential houses, office
buildings, or industrial buildings, site preparation, soil compaction, movement and stockpiling of
topsoils, and demolition activity.
Construction Support Activity means off-site acreage that will be disturbed as a direct result of the
construction project and will discharge stormwater. For example, off-site equipment staging yards,
material storage areas, borrow areas, and parking areas.
Contaminant means any hazardous substance that does not occur naturally or occurs at greater than
natural background levels. See definition of “hazardous substance” and WAC 173-340-200.
Contaminated soil means soil which contains contaminants, pollutants, or hazardous substances that do
not occur naturally or occur at levels greater than natural background.
Contaminated groundwater means groundwater which contains contaminants, pollutants, or hazardous
substances that do not occur naturally or occur at levels greater than natural background.
Demonstrably Equivalent means that the technical basis for the selection of all stormwater BMPs is
documented within a SWPPP, including:
1. The method and reasons for choosing the stormwater BMPs selected.
2. The pollutant removal performance expected from the BMPs selected.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 44
3. The technical basis supporting the performance claims for the BMPs selected, including any
available data concerning field performance of the BMPs selected.
4. An assessment of how the selected BMPs will comply with state water quality standards.
5. An assessment of how the selected BMPs will satisfy both applicable federal technology-based
treatment requirements and state requirements to use all known, available, and reasonable
methods of prevention, control, and treatment (AKART).
Department means the Washington State Department of Ecology.
Detention means the temporary storage of stormwater to improve quality and/or to reduce the mass
flow rate of discharge.
Dewatering means the act of pumping groundwater or stormwater away from an active construction site.
Director means the Director of the Washington State Department of Ecology or his/her authorized
representative.
Discharger means an owner or operator of any facility or activity subject to regulation under Chapter
90.48 RCW or the Federal Clean Water Act.
Domestic Wastewater means water carrying human wastes, including kitchen, bath, and laundry wastes
from residences, buildings, industrial establishments, or other places, together with such groundwater
infiltration or surface waters as may be present.
Ecology means the Washington State Department of Ecology.
Engineered Soils means the use of soil amendments including, but not limited, to Portland cement
treated base (CTB), cement kiln dust (CKD), or fly ash to achieve certain desirable soil characteristics.
Equivalent BMPs means operational, source control, treatment, or innovative BMPs which result in
equal or better quality of stormwater discharge to surface water or to groundwater than BMPs selected
from the SWMM.
Erosion means the wearing away of the land surface by running water, wind, ice, or other geological
agents, including such processes as gravitational creep.
Erosion and Sediment Control BMPs means BMPs intended to prevent erosion and sedimentation, such as
preserving natural vegetation, seeding, mulching and matting, plastic covering, filter fences, sediment traps,
and ponds. Erosion and sediment control BMPs are synonymous with stabilization and structural BMPs.
Federal Operator is an entity that meets the definition of “Operator” in this permit and is either any
department, agency or instrumentality of the executive, legislative, and judicial branches of the Federal
government of the United States, or another entity, such as a private contractor, performing
construction activity for any such department, agency, or instrumentality.
Final Stabilization (same as fully stabilized or full stabilization) means the completion of all soil
disturbing activities at the site and the establishment of permanent vegetative cover, or equivalent
permanent stabilization measures (such as pavement, riprap, gabions, or geotextiles) which will prevent
erosion. See the applicable Stormwater Management Manual for more information on vegetative cover
expectations and equivalent permanent stabilization measures.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 45
Groundwater means water in a saturated zone or stratum beneath the land surface or a surface
waterbody.
Hazardous Substance means any dangerous or extremely hazardous waste as defined in RCW
70.105.010 (5) and (6), or any dangerous or extremely dangerous waste as designated by rule under
chapter 70.105 RCW; any hazardous sub-stance as defined in RCW 70.105.010(14) or any hazardous
substance as defined by rule under chapter 70.105 RCW; any substance that, on the effective date of
this section, is a hazardous substance under section 101(14) of the federal cleanup law, 42U.S.C., Sec.
9601(14); petroleum or petroleum products; and any substance or category of substances, including
solid waste decomposition products, determined by the director by rule to present a threat to human
health or the environment if released into the environment. The term hazardous substance does not
include any of the following when contained in an underground storage tank from which there is not a
release: crude oil or any fraction thereof or petroleum, if the tank is in compliance with all applicable
federal, state, and local law.
Injection Well means a well that is used for the subsurface emplacement of fluids. (See Well.)
Jurisdiction means a political unit such as a city, town or county; incorporated for local self-government.
National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) means the national program for issuing,
modifying, revoking and reissuing, terminating, monitoring, and enforcing permits, and imposing and
enforcing pretreatment requirements, under sections 307, 402, 318, and 405 of the Federal Clean Water
Act, for the discharge of pollutants to surface waters of the State from point sources. These permits are
referred to as NPDES permits and, in Washington State, are administered by the Washington State
Department of Ecology.
Notice of Intent (NOI) means the application for, or a request for coverage under this general permit
pursuant to WAC 173-226-200.
Notice of Termination (NOT) means a request for termination of coverage under this general permit as
specified by Special Condition S10 of this permit.
Operator means any party associated with a construction project that meets either of the following two
criteria:
• The party has operational control over construction plans and specifications, including the
ability to make modifications to those plans and specifications; or
• The party has day-to-day operational control of those activities at a project that are necessary to
ensure compliance with a SWPPP for the site or other permit conditions (e.g., they are
authorized to direct workers at a site to carry out activities required by the SWPPP or comply
with other permit conditions).
Permittee means individual or entity that receives notice of coverage under this general permit.
pH means a liquid’s measure of acidity or alkalinity. A pH of 7 is defined as neutral. Large variations
above or below this value are considered harmful to most aquatic life.
pH Monitoring Period means the time period in which the pH of stormwater runoff from a site must be
tested a minimum of once every seven days to determine if stormwater pH is between 6.5 and 8.5.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 46
Point Source means any discernible, confined, and discrete conveyance, including but not limited to, any
pipe, ditch, channel, tunnel, conduit, well, discrete fissure, and container from which pollutants are or
may be discharged to surface waters of the State. This term does not include return flows from irrigated
agriculture. (See the Fact Sheet for further explanation)
Pollutant means dredged spoil, solid waste, incinerator residue, filter backwash, sewage, garbage,
domestic sewage sludge (biosolids), munitions, chemical wastes, biological materials, radioactive
materials, heat, wrecked or discarded equipment, rock, sand, cellar dirt, and industrial, municipal, and
agricultural waste. This term does not include sewage from vessels within the meaning of section 312 of
the CWA, nor does it include dredged or fill material discharged in accordance with a permit issued
under section 404 of the CWA.
Pollution means contamination or other alteration of the physical, chemical, or biological properties of
waters of the State; including change in temperature, taste, color, turbidity, or odor of the waters; or
such discharge of any liquid, gaseous, solid, radioactive or other substance into any waters of the State
as will or is likely to create a nuisance or render such waters harmful, detrimental or injurious to the
public health, safety or welfare; or to domestic, commercial, industrial, agricultural, recreational, or
other legitimate beneficial uses; or to livestock, wild animals, birds, fish or other aquatic life.
Process Wastewater means any non-stormwater which, during manufacturing or processing, comes into
direct contact with or results from the production or use of any raw material, intermediate product,
finished product, byproduct, or waste product. If stormwater commingles with process wastewater, the
commingled water is considered process wastewater.
Receiving Water means the waterbody at the point of discharge. If the discharge is to a storm sewer
system, either surface or subsurface, the receiving water is the waterbody to which the storm system
discharges. Systems designed primarily for other purposes such as for groundwater drainage, redirecting
stream natural flows, or for conveyance of irrigation water/return flows that coincidentally convey
stormwater are considered the receiving water.
Representative means a stormwater or wastewater sample which represents the flow and
characteristics of the discharge. Representative samples may be a grab sample, a time-proportionate
composite sample, or a flow proportionate sample. Ecology’s Construction Stormwater Monitoring
Manual provides guidance on representative sampling.
Responsible Corporate Officer for the purpose of signatory authority means: (i) a president, secretary,
treasurer, or vice-president of the corporation in charge of a principal business function, or any other
person who performs similar policy- or decision-making functions for the corporation, or (ii) the
manager of one or more manufacturing, production, or operating facilities, provided, the manager is
authorized to make management decisions which govern the operation of the regulated facility
including having the explicit or implicit duty of making major capital investment recommendations, and
initiating and directing other comprehensive measures to assure long term environmental compliance
with environmental laws and regulations; the manager can ensure that the necessary systems are
established or actions taken to gather complete and accurate information for permit application
requirements; and where authority to sign documents has been assigned or delegated to the manager in
accordance with corporate procedures (40 CFR 122.22).
Sanitary Sewer means a sewer which is designed to convey domestic wastewater.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 47
Sediment means the fragmented material that originates from the weathering and erosion of rocks or
unconsolidated deposits, and is transported by, suspended in, or deposited by water.
Sedimentation means the depositing or formation of sediment.
Sensitive Area means a waterbody, wetland, stream, aquifer recharge area, or channel migration zone.
SEPA (State Environmental Policy Act) means the Washington State Law, RCW 43.21C.020, intended to
prevent or eliminate damage to the environment.
Significant Amount means an amount of a pollutant in a discharge that is amenable to available and
reasonable methods of prevention or treatment; or an amount of a pollutant that has a reasonable
potential to cause a violation of surface or groundwater quality or sediment management standards.
Significant Concrete Work means greater than 1000 cubic yards placed or poured concrete or recycled
concrete used over the life of a project.
Significant Contributor of Pollutants means a facility determined by Ecology to be a contributor of a
significant amount(s) of a pollutant(s) to waters of the State of Washington.
Site means the land or water area where any "facility or activity" is physically located or conducted.
Source Control BMPs means physical, structural or mechanical devices or facilities that are intended to
prevent pollutants from entering stormwater. A few examples of source control BMPs are erosion
control practices, maintenance of stormwater facilities, constructing roofs over storage and working
areas, and directing wash water and similar discharges to the sanitary sewer or a dead end sump.
Stabilization means the application of appropriate BMPs to prevent the erosion of soils, such as,
temporary and permanent seeding, vegetative covers, mulching and matting, plastic covering and
sodding. See also the definition of Erosion and Sediment Control BMPs.
Storm Drain means any drain which drains directly into a storm sewer system, usually found along
roadways or in parking lots.
Storm Sewer System means a means a conveyance, or system of conveyances (including roads with
drainage systems, municipal streets, catch basins, curbs, gutters, ditches, manmade channels, or storm
drains designed or used for collecting or conveying stormwater. This does not include systems which are
part of a combined sewer or Publicly Owned Treatment Works (POTW), as defined at 40 CFR 122.2.
Stormwater means that portion of precipitation that does not naturally percolate into the ground or
evaporate, but flows via overland flow, interflow, pipes, and other features of a stormwater drainage
system into a defined surface waterbody, or a constructed infiltration facility.
Stormwater Management Manual (SWMM) or Manual means the technical Manual published by
Ecology for use by local governments that contain descriptions of and design criteria for BMPs to
prevent, control, or treat pollutants in stormwater.
Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) means a documented plan to implement measures to
identify, prevent, and control the contamination of point source discharges of stormwater.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 48
Surface Waters of the State includes lakes, rivers, ponds, streams, inland waters, salt waters, and all
other surface waters and water courses within the jurisdiction of the state of Washington.
Temporary Stabilization means the exposed ground surface has been covered with appropriate
materials to provide temporary stabilization of the surface from water or wind erosion. Materials
include, but are not limited to, mulch, riprap, erosion control mats or blankets and temporary cover
crops. Seeding alone is not considered stabilization. Temporary stabilization is not a substitute for the
more permanent “final stabilization.”
Total Maximum Daily Load (TMDL) means a calculation of the maximum amount of a pollutant that a
waterbody can receive and still meet state water quality standards. Percentages of the total maximum
daily load are allocated to the various pollutant sources. A TMDL is the sum of the allowable loads of a
single pollutant from all contributing point and nonpoint sources. The TMDL calculations must include a
"margin of safety" to ensure that the waterbody can be protected in case there are unforeseen events
or unknown sources of the pollutant. The calculation must also account for seasonable variation in
water quality.
Transfer of Coverage (TOC) means a request for transfer of coverage under this general permit as
specified by Special Condition S2.A of this permit.
Treatment BMPs means BMPs that are intended to remove pollutants from stormwater. A few examples
of treatment BMPs are detention ponds, oil/water separators, biofiltration, and constructed wetlands.
Transparency means a measurement of water clarity in centimeters (cm), using a 60 cm transparency
tube. The transparency tube is used to estimate the relative clarity or transparency of water by noting
the depth at which a black and white Secchi disc becomes visible when water is released from a value in
the bottom of the tube. A transparency tube is sometimes referred to as a “turbidity tube.”
Turbidity means the clarity of water expressed as nephelometric turbidity units (NTUs) and measured
with a calibrated turbidimeter.
Uncontaminated means free from any contaminant. See definition of “contaminant” and WAC 173-340-200.
Upset means an exceptional incident in which there is unintentional and temporary noncompliance with
technology-based permit effluent limitations because of factors beyond the reasonable control of the
Permittee. An upset does not include noncompliance to the extent caused by operational error,
improperly designed treatment facilities, inadequate treatment facilities, lack of preventive
maintenance, or careless or improper operation.
Waste Load Allocation (WLA) means the portion of a receiving water’s loading capacity that is allocated
to one of its existing or future point sources of pollution. WLAs constitute a type of water quality based
effluent limitation (40 CFR 130.2[h]).
Water-Only Based Shaft Drilling is a shaft drilling process that uses water only and no additives are
involved in the drilling of shafts for construction of building, road, or bridge foundations.
Water Quality means the chemical, physical, and biological characteristics of water, usually with respect
to its suitability for a particular purpose.
Waters of the State includes those waters as defined as "waters of the United States" in 40 CFR Subpart
122.2 within the geographic boundaries of Washington State and "waters of the State" as defined in
Chapter 90.48 RCW, which include lakes, rivers, ponds, streams, inland waters, underground waters, salt
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 49
waters, and all other surface waters and water courses within the jurisdiction of the state of
Washington.
Well means a bored, drilled or driven shaft, or dug hole whose depth is greater than the largest surface
dimension. (See Injection Well.)
Wheel Wash Wastewater means any water used in, or resulting from the operation of, a tire bath or
wheel wash (BMP C106: Wheel Wash), or other structure or practice that uses water to physically
remove mud and debris from vehicles leaving a construction site and prevent track-out onto roads.
When stormwater comingles with wheel wash wastewater, the resulting water is considered wheel
wash wastewater and must be managed according to Special Condition S9.D.9.
Construction Stormwater General Permit Page 50
APPENDIX B – ACRONYMS
AKART All Known, Available, and Reasonable Methods of Prevention,
Control, and Treatment
BMP Best Management Practice
CESCL Certified Erosion and Sediment Control Lead
CFR Code of Federal Regulations
CKD Cement Kiln Dust
cm Centimeters
CPD Common Plan of Development
CTB Cement-Treated Base
CWA Clean Water Act
DMR Discharge Monitoring Report
EPA Environmental Protection Agency
ERTS Environmental Report Tracking System
ESC Erosion and Sediment Control
FR Federal Register
LID Low Impact Development
NOI Notice of Intent
NOT Notice of Termination
NPDES National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System
NTU Nephelometric Turbidity Unit
RCW Revised Code of Washington
SEPA State Environmental Policy Act
SWMM Stormwater Management Manual
SWPPP Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan
TMDL Total Maximum Daily Load
UIC Underground Injection Control
USC United States Code
USEPA United States Environmental Protection Agency
WAC Washington Administrative Code
WQ Water Quality
WWHM Western Washington Hydrology Model